Sensibilità sinergica sensoriale.
( Sensire = Sentire contemporaneamente attraverso l'insieme dei
sensi )
Percezioni sensoriali
Il cavaliere
Jedi tiene presente ogni stimolo proveniente dalle fonti della
conoscenza sensoriale, consapevolmente e permanentemente. Ogni
momento i canali percettivi,
ricevono stimoli sia interni che esterni richiamando
l'attenzione dei neuroni specifici sulle diverse porzioni della
realtà, attraverso sistemi coscienti predeterminati. Coloro che
sono in grado di sensire avvertono pienamente, mutamenti
interiori come esteriori, consapevolmente. E' imperativa
categorica la conoscenza di quei fenomeni che possono produrre
variazioni dei campi, tali da creare ingerenza, interferenza o
altri condizionamenti propri e impropri che possono produrre
forzatura, limitazione, incapacità, inabilità, o per mezzo di
programmi senzienti precedentemente installati, innescare
risposte multiple consequenziali di tipo pre configurato senza
che l'ospitante ne sia pienamente consapevole, ma solo strumento
di reiterazione clonata al servizio dei protocolli. Ci si
appresti quindi allo studio e alla pratica dell'attenzione, e ci
si concentri costantemente sui seguenti campi.
1 TATTO
2 OLFATTO
3 VISTA
4 GUSTO
5 UDITO
6 MOVIMENTO CINESTESICO (
radiale, lineare, velocità....
)
7 EQUILIBRIO
8 CAMPO ELETTROMAGNETICO
9 SENSO DEL TEMPO
10 SENSO DELLO SPAZIO
11 PERCEZIONE VISCERALE (
fame, sazietà, sete...
)
12 DOLORE, PIACERE, PRURITO
13 SENSAZIONE TERMICA
14 INTUIZIONE
15 PESO E LEGGEREZZA
16 DIMENSIONE (
padronanza, goffo...
)
17 TELEPATIA (
Risonanza ritmo sintonia induzione empatia
)
18 ORDINE
19 MNEMONICA (
Analitica,
esperienziale, deduttiva, analogica, coincidente
)
20 SENSO DEL COMPORTAMENTO ANIMALE ISTINTIVO
21 SENSO DI PRESSIONE TIMPANICA, EPIDERMIDE
22 SENSO DI PERCEZIONE DELL’ESSERE
23 SENSO DI NUTRIMENTO E BENESSERE
24 FORO PERCETTIVO (
Zone cieche, mancanze, fori, invisibilità comandata, mimetismo...
)
25 SENSO DI MANCANZA O DI VUOTO
26 SENSO DI APPAGAMENTO E INSODDISFAZIONE
27 SENSO DI SOLLIEVO
28 SENSO DI MERAVIGLIA
29 SENSO DI LIBERTA
30 SENSO DELL'UMORISMO
31 SENSO DI COLPA
32 SENSO DI ATTRAZIONE E REPULSIONE
33 SENSO DI ELEVAZIONE E CADUTA GRAVITAZIONALE
34 SENSO DI ACCELERAZIONE E DECELERAZIONE
35 SENSO DEL PRINCIPIO E DELLA FINE
36 SENSO DEL VERO E DEL FALSO
37 SENSO DI RISPETTO
38 SENSO DI INADEGUATEZZA
39 SENSO MORALE
40 SENSO DEL PUDORE
41 SESTO SENSO
42 COMMON SENSE
43 SENSO DI INUTILITA
44 SENSO DI IMPOTENZA
45 SENSO DI ONNIPOTENZA
46 SENSO DI PULIZIA
47 SENSO D'ORDINE
49 SENSO DI MALATTIA
50 SENSO DI VERGOGNA
Gli organi di senso sono strutture fisiche
presenti nei corpi degli esseri viventi del regno animale che
servono essenzialmente a permetterci di interagire con il mondo
circostante.
Essi sono composti da strutture più o meno
complesse specializzate nella ricezione di stimoli provenienti
dall’esterno o dall’interno, di trasformarli in
impulsi nervosi
e infine di trasmetterli al
sistema nervoso centrale.
Questi recettori si classificano in base alla
provenienza dello stimolo:
-
Telecettori:
sensibili a forme di energia provenienti da lontano.
-
Esterocettori:
sensibili a forme di energia originate da fonti esterne
vicine al corpo.
-
Interocettori:
sensibili a fenomeni provenienti dall’interno
dell’organismo.
-
Propriocettori:
sensibili a stimoli provenienti dalle articolazioni, dai
muscoli e dai tendini. Servono a sentire dove si trova il
nostro corpo nello spazio.
Dal tipo di stimolo:
E in base al loro Adattamento sensoriale
cioè alla possibilità di far diminuire la frequenza di uno
stimolo prolungato nel tempo.
-
Fasici
o
Dinamici:
Si adattano facilmente. Ad esempio l'olfatto.
-
Tonici
o
Statici:
Si adattano poco o per niente. Per esempio i termocettori.
Trasmissione dello stimolo
Lo stimolo è, in realtà, una variazione della
polarità della
membrana.
Normalmente, l'interno del
derma
ha
polarità
negativa. Questo perché gli
ioni
negativi Cl-(cloro)
sono molti di più di quelli positivi K+ (potassio).
L'ambiente esterno, invece, è carico positivamente perché ricco
di
ioni
Na+ (sodio).
Quando c'è uno stimolo, i Cl- escono e i Na+ entrano invertendo
la polarità (depolarizzazione). I K+ escono molto più lentamente
e, quando ciò avviene, ristabiliscono l'equilibrio riportando la
polarità della
pelle
al negativo (ripolarizzazione). Lo stimolo recepito si trasforma
in potenziale recettoriale che si trasmette ai
neuroni
sensoriali afferenti (che portano al
sistema nervoso centrale).
I neuroni, prima di inviare il messaggio, lo trasformano in
potenziale d'azione
(trasduzione).
N.B.: se uno stimolo è prolungato nel
tempo,
aumenta la
frequenza
di trasmissione dello stimolo, e non l'intensità.
Anatomia umana
Sette sono gli organi di senso umani canonici
nonostante spesso si limiti a citare solo i primi cinque:
Altri organi di senso sono presenti nel corpo
umano (vedi
corpuscoli)
tuttavia sono considerati secondari rispetto a quelli citati e
solo gli specialisti ne conoscono il nome e la rispettiva
funzione.
Chemocettori
Fra i chemocettori si trovano i
glomi,
l'apparato gustativo e l'apparato olfattivo.
Glomi:
Sono interocettori che sono situati in presenza
delle grandi
arterie
(carotide, aorta, sacrale media), hanno la funzione di
registrare le alterazioni dei tassi di O2 (ossigeno)
e di CO2 (anidride
carbonica)
nel sangue.
Apparato gustativo:
È formato dai calici gustativi che sono presenti
nelle
papille linguali
Circumvallate (si trovano a forma di V nella parte più interna
della
lingua),
Foliate, e, in piccola parte anche nelle Fungiformi. Le
Filiformi, invece, sono papille tattili. Ogni calice è formato
da tre tipi di
cellule:
-
Basali
-
di
Sostegno
-
Gustative: sono i veri e propri recettori chimici, fornite
di
microvilli
che recepiscono le
molecole
disciolte nella saliva.
Ogni calice gustativo non riconosce una singola
categoria di gusto anche se ci sono aree specializzate come, ad
esempio, la punta della lingua che riconosce meglio il
dolce,
i lati della stessa che riconoscono l'acido e il
salato
e la parte più interna della lingua che è specializzata per l'amaro.
Apparato olfattivo:
Il tessuto specializzato per riconoscere gli
odori
è l'epitelio olfattivo che si trova nella parte superiore della
cavità nasale. Esso è ricoperto di
muco
dove si trovano le molecole da analizzare. L'epitelio olfattivo
è formato da tre tipi di cellule:
-
Basali
-
di
Sostegno: sono attorno alle cellule olfattive, hanno dei
microvilli usati per spostare il
muco.
-
Olfattive: sono le
cellule
atte a ricevere lo stimolo. Hanno delle ciglia immerse nel
muco.
Sono le stesse cellule a portare l'informazione al
sistema nervoso
centrale, invece di affidare il messaggio ad un
neurone
specializzato.
Meccanocettori
Tatto:
I meccanocettori presenti sull'epidermide
sono vari e sono sensibili alla
pressione
e al
dolore.
Si dividono in due:
-
Dischi di
Merkel:
sono sensibili alla
pressione
e sono
tonici.
-
Corpuscoli: che a loro volta si dividono in
Orecchio: apparato uditivo e vestibolare:
L'orecchio
è costituito da tre parti:
L'apparato uditivo è formato dalla coclea e dai
tre ossicini. Il martello è a contatto con la membrana del
timpano
e trasmette le vibrazioni all'incudine e alla staffa. Attraverso
la finestra ovale, le
vibrazioni
si trasmettano alla coclea. Qust'ultima è formata da tre
canali,
di cui il primo e il terzo sono collegati e contengono
perilinfa:
-
Canale
vestibolare: collegato alla staffa attraverso la finestra
ovale.
-
Canale
medio: si trova in mezzo agli altri due, contiene l'endolinfa
e l'organo del
Corti.
-
Canale
timpanico: collegato alla finestra rotonda.
Il
suono,
quindi, si trasmette dal
timpano
ai tre ossicini, passa nella coclea attraverso la finestra ovale
e comprime la perilinfa che trasmette le
vibrazioni
al canale vestibolare, quindi al canale timpanico e da questo al
canale medio. In quest'ultimo canale si trova l'organo del
Corti
dove si trovano le cellule sensoriali. Queste cellule sono
ricoperte da una membrana tettoria. Le loro ciglia, sfregando
sulla membrana tettoria, trasmettono le vibrazioni al
nervo
uditivo.
L'apparato vestibolare, invece, è composto dai
tre canali semicircolari che hanno all'estremità un'ampolla che
è in contatto con l'utricolo
e il
sacculo,
due cavità a forma, appunto, di sacco. Nell'utricolo e nel
sacculo ci sono le cellule sensoriali dell'equilibrio
che hanno delle ciglia immerse in una gelatina in cui sono
immersi degli
otoliti.
Gli otoliti sono sassolini di
carbonato di calcio
che, con il movimento, sfregano le ciglia dei recettori. Se il
movimento è rotatorio (angolare), l'endolinfa
presente nei tre canali semicircolari preme sulla
gelatina
presente nell'ampolla facendo muovere le ciglia delle cellule
sensoriali immerse in essa (nella gelatina).
Termocettori
I termocettori sono di due tipi:
-
Corpuscoli di
Ruffini:
per il caldo.
-
Corpuscoli di
Krause:
per il freddo.
Uno Jedi percepisce sincronicamente e
sinergicamente.
Egli "Sensice". Conosce e riconosce, e non si lascia ingannare
da certi trucchetti.
Avverte il movente prima dello stimolo, e ne
riconosce la frequenza sottile che sta per generare la sua
manifestazione.
Ciò significa che uno Jedi avverte gli stimoli
prima ancora che essi si manifestino.
E questa è una delle forme più antiche di
saggezza. Per questo uno Jedi non si lascerà ingannare da alcuna
sostanza capace
di ottundere la sua sensibilità, sia essa di
origine animale, minerale o vegetale, quindi si terrà lontano da
ciò che alteri
le proprie
percezioni e le altrui. Non ricorrerà quindi a bevande tossiche
come droghe di sorta, che alterino la sua coscienza.
Non ricorrerà altresì ad alcuna droga che lo
possa aiutare, risvegliandolo momentaneamente in modo
artificiale,
accelerandolo o rallentandolo, e creando
divergenze reali fra il sensito e i treni di impulsi ricevuti,
in modo da non alterare i
delicati
equilibri. Come un arpista, tratterà il proprio strumento e la
sua accordatura curandosi che essa non venga alterata.
Ciò che
momentaneamente innalza, o crea dimenticanza, poi
torna a far ricadere e ad essere presente.
Uno Jedi non danneggerà cosi, il proprio veicolo,
assumendo sostanze lecite o illecite, che mescolate in modalità
sinergica
per produrre
disergia all'interno dell'organismo che le assume,
possano
danneggiarlo,
temporaneamente o permanentemente.
Ogni qual volta egli si troverà innanzi a
sostanze tossiche, non ne dovrà accettare, in modo cortesie e
gentile.
Ogni cosa che tocca lascia un segno, ogni colpo
una ammaccatura. Come un frutto che venga battuto, porta
il livido sulla
propria scorza, così uomo che ha sofferto, non si
faccia la pena che ha vissuto e smetta di portarla con se
immedesimandosi
con errati
costumi.
Via quindi ove fosse possibile: alcool, tabacco, caffè ed
eccitanti, zucchero, oppiacei, acidi, antibiotici,
funghi curativi come di sintesi, e a tutte quelle
sostanze buone e giuste, che se assunte in maniera smodata, si
tradurranno
in veleno nel
proprio organismo.
Niente coloranti, addensati, conservanti,
additivi e esaltatori di sapidità. Che ciò che non è
cibo, resti fuori dal corpo. Meglio un sano
digiuno. Quel che intossica non sfama, ma apre la strada ai
grandi vermi che
prendono
possesso del corpo. Parco, misurato e proporzionale sia il suo
pasto. Meglio frugale e vario che d'una sola sorta.
Uno Jedi conosce la misura della misura. Si
chiama bastanza. Senza di essa c'e' bramosia e avidità, ma
quando la bastanza è
presente, non esiste cifra che possa comperarlo.
Nessuna tentazione può sviare quello Jedi che conosce e pratica
quanto ho
chiarito esplicitamente in poche righe. Nessun
valor può equipararsi a quanto non ha prezzo. Uno Jedi
persegue la via
dell'equilibrio, e quanto è funzione sufficiente
non diviene disfunzione.
Uno Jedi è capace di attivare sostanze
morfinogene in presenza di dolore, come di attivare endorfine,
per ravvivare stati
percettivi
e
l'attenzione, quando essa sia carente, o
alterata secondo il nostro metro usuale. Sostanze
autacoidi per guarire
il corpo indebolito da batteri, virus ed altre
malattie sono a disposizione di ognuno. Quel che ho detto e' già
miracolo
sufficiente a che
colui che
ospita un male, ospiti pure la sua propria guarigione. I grandi
vermi sfruttano le cattive abitudini
per
instaurare il loro governo. Il passo da compiere quindi è verso
tale chiarezza, e si ricordi che ogni volta che sorga un
dubbio,
l'azione corretta da compiere e' quella di rinunciarvi per
meditare meglio.
La percezione allargata di uno stimolo
offre, informazioni circa la sua origine e la provenienza, il
movente, il motivo,
la direzione, la velocità, la misura, lo
spostamento spaziale, il suono, la tendenza, la somma dei
vettori, i deflettori,
i mascheratori, l'energia che lo ha prodotto, il
meccanismo di rilascio, la frequenza, lo smorzamento, la
traiettoria,
la permanenza, la temporalità, e le concause
karmiche che lo hanno generato e prodotto. Questo e' quanto in
un solo
secondo,
riposta l'attenzione su un fatto, il Cavaliere Jedi e' in grado
di percepire simultaneamente su più livelli
contemporanei, e se il dettaglio fuori posto che solo l'occhio
attento percepisce, condisce una qualsiasi situazione, per farne
piatto
prelibato a chi l'offre, non partecipi a quel pranzo, ma
anzi si levi e non perda tempo in discorsi, ( dis- corsi = acque
stagnanti ),
che dal dialogo fra le parti, si tradurranno ben presto in
diatriba, dissertazione saccente e scontro. Mai rimestare,
qui e ora,
ricorda. Contratto, che in bella posta pare offrire, reca in
minuscolo la verità di quanto dice.
Questo e altro, fa parte della percezione
simultanea di uno Jedi. Volutamente la lista che vi ho oggi
riportata non è completa,
ma mancante e
carente,
nell'ordine scorretto, e puramente
indicativa. Eppure dice assai più di quanto, a coloro che sono
in
grado di
ascoltare.
Colui che fa orecchie da mercante non sente che
la cifra che lo smuove. Eppure quanto fa, vive e soffre, è senza
senso.
La sua bocca sporca di lamentazioni. Le sue
tasche ricolme di cianfrusaglie. Guardati da costoro.
Procedi e consenti. Cogli e migliora. Cosa da un
senso alle cose, al mondo, a quello che fai?
Legittimazione e giustificazione bastano a quei
poveri che s'accontentano di spettacolo, e agiscono per se.
Altro è la Gloria, la Via e il suo svolgimento,
libero, puro e non condizionato.
Rammenta le 8 vie che illuminano il
sentiero:
who? why? when? where? what? which? whose? how? whom?
e saprai già qualcosa. Fare incetta di sapere,
non rende saggi. Perdersi nelle filosofie, non dona chiarezza ma
apre il passo al
labirinto. Carezzali ed esci. Maestri, Profeti di
sventura, come Gerarchie Salde, intessute nel mondo, non possono
esserti
d'aiuto,
poiché ogni
protocollo d'intesa è un patto, e chiede in
cambio la tua vita.
Domandati chi sei, e sii la carne che sei,
incarnare altro da te corrompe la tua grandezza.
In nome di
posizione, potere e
reggenza,
troppi falliscono la prova. Ai ministri del
limite come dei confini, il Cavaliere Jedi
s'accosta sfiorandoli appena, e
senza tangirli, ne infliggere tocco
d'avvertimento, di misura come di rispetto, apre al cuore e
all'esempio del perdono,
che è mossa più onorevole e degna dello sguainar
la spada, angelica che sia. Colui che serve perché gli serve
qualcosa, s'e'
già venduto.
Ogni colpo che fende genera Due parti, non fare
l'errore di prestare sponda. Realizza l'unione dei principi in
te, e la risposta
come la domanda cesseranno.
Una colpa, e la metà del mondo è nel peccato.
Vivi, che ad ognuno tocca quel che gli compete.
Brama chi non è e serra il pugno quello che vuol
mantenere i suoi domini. Lascia quando il tempo è venuto.
Mura che sicure riparano, non valgono
l'incertezza di un abbraccio.
Sappi e ricorda quel che l'esperienza t'insegna.
Pratica quanto sei, che di scimmie e
di
pappagalli è pieno il mondo.
Impara a
Sensire da te, che la trasparenza non s'insegna. Quando il velo
svanisce, tenebre e mente più non sono.
Quando s'apre
il varco, china il capo e fatti avanti.
Jedi Simon
Questa via, e gli insegnamenti
qui elencati, dal Maestro Jedi Simon, chiamati in modo
collettivo "Jedi Yoga", a significare l'unione degli
insegnamenti Jedi con quello degli antichi insegnamenti che
riunivano la conoscenza Vedica, sono finalmente un tentativo
concreto di riunire quanto è stato fatto a pezzi dai vari
maestri dello Yoga occidentale. Troppi hanno preferito svoltare,
chi prima, chi dopo, e si sono persi lungo il sentiero. C'e' chi
l'ha fatto perche' era senza lavoro, chi per arricchirsi, chi ci
credeva ( ma non proprio sino in fondo ), e chi non ci credeva
davvero, ma ha funzionato lo stesso. Poi sono arrivati quelli
dei diplomi, e allora si e' passati dagli idealisti degli anni
sessanta ai nuovi diplomati. Tutti insieme appassionatamente,
alla sagra dell'ipocrisia, che se cercate "maestri Yoga" per
immagini su Google, scoprirete quale sorriso da telline mistiche
hanno tutti costoro, e capirete meglio cosa vi sto dicendo.
Si raffronti la stessa ricerca per immagini con quella su i
"contadini" del terzo mondo o dell'asia, e si comprenderà ancor
meglio la cosa. Chi sono costoro gli si legge in faccia.
Il kali yuga purtroppo non
risparmia nessuno, tantomeno coloro che si nutrono di queste
operazioni, perlopiù commerciali, vestiti di bianco spirituale,
un pò consunto dalle asana.
A parte le palestre che fanno bene alla gente sedentaria
dell'occidente, quindi nulla di nuovo sul fronte della coscienza
e tantomeno su quello della lotta contro l'ego, tralasciando
naturalmente di parlare di quella contro il possesso del "mio".
Nulla di
quanto l'occidente ha prodotto sulla via del degrado
mentale, culturale e vitale è stato seriamente riconsiderato da
questi maestri, che si danno da fare massimamente per il
mantenimento di uno status quo che non dia fastidi ne ad uno ne
all'altro. Ho sentito il bisogno di riunificare in una sola via,
i contenuti smembrati e fatti a pezzi di quegli insegnamenti,
anche se ormai, mi paiono cosi distanti che non è quasi più il
tempo di dedicarsi alle ripetizioni ma di passare alla pratica.
Qui di ritualità ormai
ce ne e' tanta e tale, che non basterebbero 100 vite a
percorrere tutte le varianti. L'unico problema e' che queste
strade non mirano
nella giusta direzione, e probabilmente, grazie anche a editori
e fautori delle deviazioni appartenenti ad ordini
religiosi che non vorrebbero vedersi sfilate certe questioni, si
assiste in termini di concetto, metodo e falsi insegnamenti,
allo sfacelo di discipline chiave che tanto hanno dato ed
aiutato coloro i quali le hanno seguite.
Non è un mistero il fatto palese che le maggiori istituzioni sportive
consorziate in multinazionali private che stanno dilagando in
tutti gli stati ove possano trovare una collocazione
territoriale consona ed economicamente proficua, ( lascio a voi
i nomi di tali entità ) stiano offrendo pacchetti di tipo
commerciale riguardo alle discipline antiche completamente
snaturati, e privati di qualsiasi contenuto filosofico, di
pensiero e di fede e religioso, che queste discipline
incarnavano, per vendersi come pura forma estetica, fisica, e
superficiale senza dare alcun disturbo alle istituzioni che
detengono i monopoli della fede, discreditando nel contempo gli
insegnamenti antichi.
Il fatto che attraverso gli
eccessi parossistici di un rito fisico composto da una somma di
sforzi eccessivi, non equilibrati e indubbiamente accolti in
modo masochistico da parte dei clienti, i contenuti di una
lezione di un paio di ore al massimo, non facciano che giovare a
quei poteri che attraverso il sadismo e il condizionamento di
gruppo saldano la loro presa al comando, al guadagno e al
mantenimento delle clientele, è una derivazione certa di questa
deriva che l'occidente ha presa, è indice del fatto che per
vantaggio chi corrompe e plagia per rivendere depauperati quegli
insegnamenti che si traducono in sola forma senza sostanza, ha
in mente solo i danari e null'altro.
Si ricordi che quando essi non
gettano nell'oblio una cosa, l'hanno già contaminata e passata
attraverso il grande nulla, in modo da renderla innocua.
Mille particolarismi
personali, e varianti sul tema, congeniali ai requisiti che
ricercano singoli maestri a seconda della scuola, non fanno
onore ad una scienza-arte cosi antica.
Ho immesso nel circuito dei
saperi quindi
alcuni concetti fondamentali dello Yoga
e non, definendoli
Jedi
Yoga, e non dilungandomi troppo sugli insegnamenti stessi,
( anche se ne ho rivelati i contenuti degli studi del primo anno
in dettaglio, e nulla più... ) dato che
non li volevo vedere degradati, perché ero certo che sarebbero stati
"lauto
pasto dell'esercito delle scimmie", sono stato ad aspettare, e
dopo aver immessa nero su bianco la lista ordinata dei semi, come al
seminario, ho lasciato che la copiassero in toto, e guardate cosa salta
fuori dal cappello....?
|
YogaFestival: dall'8 al 10 ottobre a Milano |
|
Nella sede del
SuperStudio
Più di via Tortona, tre
giornate dedicata all'antica disciplina orientale per
unire benessere fisico ed equilibrio mentale |
Argomenti trattati nell'ordine :
interessante argomento pienamente centrato
sullo Yoga!!!
Una full immersion nel mondo dello yoga, la disciplina che
unisce benessere fisico ed equilibrio mentale. È quanto propone
il Milano
Yogafestival
in programma
dall'8 al 10 ottobre
al
SuperStudio Più
di
via Tortona.
Oltre i Sensi
è il tema di questa quinta edizione: nella nostra cultura
occidentale, i sensi conosciuti sono cinque ma per le discipline
orientali,
i sensi sono molti di più.
Occorre
imparare a riconoscerli
per arrivare all’essenza superiore dell’uomo.
Per molti milanesi lo yoga è scudo efficace
contro i ritmi frenetici della città:
fermarsi ad ascoltare se stessi e il proprio corpo per
riscoprire un nuovo modo, più positivo e rilassato, di
rapportarsi al mondo. Ogni anno, in occasione di questo
festival, la città diventa punto di riferimento per molti
appassionati dell’antica pratica orientale e offre la
possibilità di approfondirne la conoscenza attraverso
lezioni,
seminari
e
conferenze
tenuti da
maestri noti a livello internazionale.
Al festival si accede con una
tessera
del valore di
5
euro,
valida un anno e per i tre giorni di evento, acquistabile presso
l'ingresso dell'evento. La tessera dà diritto all'accesso
a tutte le freeclass gratuite
(senza prenotazione), alle conferenze, alle attività musicali
non a pagamento, all'area espositiva, allo spazio Ayurveda, al
ristorante e ai vari servizi del festival.
Alcuni seminari dedicati a chi già pratica lo Yoga sono a
pagamento e su prenotazione: si prenotano online (www.yogafestival.it)
e si pagano alle casse del festival. Quest'anno sarà disponibile
una
Special Card
di
100 euro
per frequentare tutti i seminari da
25 euro.
E ora vediamo nel dettaglio:
vi elenco qui di seguito i dettagli del programma e degli
insegnamenti.
IL PROGRAMMA
Venerdì 8 ottobre
Ore 17.15-20.15 - Sala 1
Il senso dello
spazio
La sorgente del gesto e della sensazione
corporale
Livello avanzato – Per insegnanti - Contributo
40 Eu
Ore - 15.30-18.30 - Sala 2
Il senso della vista
interiore, la
chiaroveggenza
Dai sensi all’intuizione
Livello intermedio - Contributo 40 Eu
Ore 18.45-20.30 - Sala 2
Il senso motorio,
l’energia in movimento
Lo Yoga in Forma Liquida
Yoga Contemporaneo – Conduce
Livello intermedio - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 15.00-18.00 - SALA 3
Yoga e libertà. Il senso
termico
La Saggezza dell’Età Matura
Per Insegnanti - Contributo 40 Eu
Ore 18.15-20.00 - Sala 3
Il senso dell’equilibrio
(interno ed esterno)
Pratyahara - affrancarsi dai condizionamenti per
espandere il proprio spazio interiore
Ashtanga Yoga di Patanjali -
Livello intermedio - Ingresso libero su
prenotazione
Portare tappetino per la pratica e cuscino per
la meditazione
Ore 18.00–20.00 – Sala conferenze
Conferenza
-
Qi e Prana Zen e Yoga, due tradizioni a
confronto
Seguono esercizi energetici di consapevolezza
Zen e Hatha Yoga
Multilivello - Ingresso libero
Ore 17.00–20.00 – Sala Yantra
I sensi viscerali
Shodhanam e Moksha - Shatkarman - Purifcazione e
Liberazione
Per Insegnanti - Contributo 40 Eu
Ore 17.00-20.00 - Sala Mandala
GiocaYoga
Metodi basati su un antica disciplina per
crescere bambini sani e felici
Per insegnanti – Contributo 40 Eu
Ore 17.00–19.00 – Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso dell’udito
esteriore ed interiore
Curarsi con la Musica secondo l'Antica Filosofa
Vedica
Nada/Mantra Yoga (LoYogadell’Energia) –
IlPoteredelMantra byKrishnaDas
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 20.30 – Sala Yantra
Shanty Raga
Melodie di Pace - Mantra Meditation
Sabato 9
ottobre
Ore 9.30-11.30 - Sala 1
Il senso del
tatto
L'espansione tattile - Tattilità e creatività
nello shivaismo del Kashmir
Yoga Tantrico Kashmiro
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 11.45-13.45 - Sala 1
Il senso
della vibrazione sonora
Sentire, ascoltare, divenire - L'universo non è
altro che vibrazione
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.00-16.00 - Sala 1
Il senso
psicocinetico
Iyengar Yoga preliminari e fondamenti della
Pratica
Principianti - Contributo 25 Eu
Ogni allievo ha bisogno di: 4/5 coperte, 2
cinture, 1 mattone di legno
Ore 16.15-18.15 - Sala 1
Oltre il corpo
Bandha, oltre il corpo fsico -Tecniche
preparatorie per la Meditazione
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 18.30-20.30 - Sala 1
Il senso
della vista
Gli occhi, lo sguardo, la lucidità
Multilivello Contributo - 25 Eu
Ore 9.45-11.45 - Sala 2
Il senso
della libertà
Oltre i Sensi per raggiungere lo stato di
liberazione Moksha
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.00-14.00 - Sala 2
Il senso del
tatto
Yoga del Tocco - Prendere coscienza della
relazione corpo-mente attraverso il respiro e la
percezione tattile
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.15-16.15 - Sala 2
Il senso
della gravità
L'intelligenza del corpo
Multilivello Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 16.30-20.30 - Sala 2
I sensi
Le percezioni sensoriali nello Yoga Ratna
Per insegnanti ed avanzati - Contributo 50 Eu
Ore 9.30-12.30 - Sala 3
Il senso della vista
interiore
L'Astrologia evolutiva nella pratica dello Yoga
Ratna
Multilivello - Contributo 30 Eu
Ore 12.45-14.45 - Sala 3
Yoga al maschile
La necessaria trasformazione e la ricerca di un
migliore equilibrio fra il maschile ed il
femminile nell'uomo dei nostri giorni
Hatha Yoga -
Riservato ai soli uomini - Principianti -
Contributo 15 Eu
Ore 15.00-17.00 - Sala 3
Il senso del
gusto interno
Il cibo della Dea
Multilivello - Contributo 15 Eu
Ore 17.15-19.00 - Sala 3
Il sutra del cuore
Scuola Maestri Calligraf -
Multilivello
Ingresso libero con prenotazione
Ore 19.15-20.30 - Sala 3
Il senso del
movimento
Siva - Shakti
Danza Bharata Natyam e Kuchipudi -
Principianti - Incontro aperto al pubblico su
prenotazione
Ore 10.00-11.30 - Sala conferenze
Conferenza - L'espansione delle
percezioni sensoriali: le Radici dell'anima
Hara Yoga - Incontro
Ingresso libero
Ore 11.45-13.00 - Sala conferenze
Conferenza - La mente e la meditazione
Le basi neurofsiologiche dello Yoga, della
Meditazione e dei processi creativi
Ingresso libero
Ore - 13.30-14.45 - Sala conferenze
Conferenza - Ascolto.biz
Attivare l'ascolto nella catena del fare. "Ogni
mattina risveglia il mio orecchio, perché io
possa ascoltare come gli iniziati".
Pratica d'ascolto - Ingresso libero
Ore 15.00-16.00 - Sala conferenze
Conferenze - Salute ed Armonia attraverso
i Sensi secondo la visione dell'Ayurveda
Pratica d'ascolto - Ingresso libero
Ore 16.15-17.45 - Sala conferenze
Conferenze -
Oltre i sensi
La scoperta dell'ultima frontiera della scienza.
La coscienza dell' invisibile, oltre la materia
dei sensi -
Pratica d'ascolto - Ingresso libero
Ore 18.00-19.30 - Sala conferenze
Conferenza - Pratyahara e "corpo"
emozionale
Tradizioni Svami Sivananda - Svami Chidananda -
Svami Krishananda - Svami Dayananda
Pratica d'ascolto
Ore 15.00-16.00 - Sala ayurveda
Presentazione libro - L'Ashtanga Yoga
di Patanjali del Yogamaharishi dottor Swami
Gitananda Giri Guru Maharaj
Pratica d'ascolto
Ore 10.00-12.00 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso
dell'appetito sessuale
Arrendersi al sì - Osho Kundalini Meditation
Tradizione Osho
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.00-14.00 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso
dell'olfatto
Risveglia il tuo senso dell'olfatto
Yoga Sistemico
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.30-16.30 - Sala Om (Basement)
Lo yoga del
suono 1
Mantra Yoga
Tantrismo Shivaita del Kashmir, Buddismo
Tibetano, sufsmo Persiano
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 16.45-18.45 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso
dell'espressione
vocale
Trova la tua voce. Applicazioni artistiche e
terapeutiche
Multilivello - Contributo 15 Eu
Domenica 10
ottobre
Ore 07.00-10.00 (orario indicativo) -
Sala Yantra
Trekkinh Yoga in bicicletta
Meditazione in Movimento
Multilivello - Contributo 15 Eu
Obbligatorio presentarsi con bicicletta,
possibilmente mountain bike, e abiti comodi
Ore 9.45-11.45 - Sala 1
Il senso
dell'udito interiore
"Il terzo orecchio" - Introduzione teorico
pratico a Pratyahara ed iniziazione al Kriya
Yoga
Kriya Yoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.00-14.00 - Sala 1
La pratica del pranayama
Un sottile processo di trasformazione della
coscienza per predisporsi al risveglio della
visione del corpo di energia
Hatha Yoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.15-16.15 - Sala 1
Il senso dell'allineamento
Il "cosmo" del corpo umano
Moga DaoYoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 16.30-18.30 - Sala 1
Il senso
dell'udito interiore
La vibrazione cosmica sonora
Jivamukti Yoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 10.00-12.00 - Sala 2
Il senso del
dolore
La natura dei sensi, la loro funzione e
percezione
Tradizione Gitananda -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.15-14.15 - Sala 2
Il sesto
senso
Nutrirsi dall'interno
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.30-16.30 - Sala 2
L'irradazione
sensoriale
Le pratiche di incinerazione
Iyengar Yoga -Insegnanti ed allievi intermedi - Contributo 25
Eu
Ore 16.45-18.45 - Sala 2
Il senso
della libertà
Oltre i Sensi per raggiungere lo stato di
liberazione Moksha
Hatha Yoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 9.45-11.45 - Sala 3
Il senso
dell'equilibrio
Lo Yoga sul Tappeto Volante
Acroyoga -Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.00-14.00 - Sala 3
I cinque
sensi
Esplorare i fussi di energia armonica attraverso
il TriYoga
Livello intermedio - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.30-16.30 - Sala 3
Il senso
della vista
L'arte di vedere le cose come sono
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 16.45-18.45 - Sala 3
Speciale Africa Yoga Project
Yoga Asana, l'espressione della forza interiore
attraverso il linguaggio del corpo
Power Yoga -
Multilivello - Contributo 15 Eu
Ore 10.00-12.00 - Sala conferenze
Le
neuroscienze e la meditazione
Riprendere i sensi - La pratica di Mindfulness
Psicoterapia Cognitiva -
Ore 12.15-14.00 - Sala conferenze
Psicosomatica e antroposofia
Il corpo Astrale come veicolo della sensazione -
Ore 14.30 - 16.30 - Sala conferenze
Il senso del gusto
Le dimensioni sottili degli alimenti
Ananda Yoga -
Multilivello Contributo - 15 Eu
Ore 16.45 - 18.30 - Sala conferenze
Talk Show
Come lo Yoga ha cambiato la mia vita
Pratica d'ascolto - Ingresso libero
Ore 10.00 - 12.00 - Sala Om (Basement)
Lo Yoga del suono 2
NadaYoga
Tantrismo Shivaita del Kashmir, Buddismo
Tibetano, sufsmo Persiano
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 12.15 - 14.15 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso del ritmo
Hari
Yoga'n'Soul
Hari Yoga - Tradizione Tantrica -
Multilivello - Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 14.30 - 16.30 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso dell'udito e la meditazione
L'unità oltre il suono - Meditazione corporea e
terapia del suono attraverso le Campane Tibetane
Multilivello- Contributo 25 Eu
Ore 16.45 -18.45 - Sala Om (Basement)
Il senso
dell'udito
Il potere curativo del suono
Yoga Sistemico -
Multilivello - Contributo 15 Eu |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Dal quale si evince
come, data la pertinenza specifica dei precipui argomenti
riguardanti "i sensi", appartenenti a campi estranei
o prossimi
all'approccio Yogico, ma quasi mai trattati in tale ordine e in tal guisa, che gli argomenti quivi
elencati, siano stati correlati secondo
un tipo di ordinamento e una lista non facente direttamente
parte dei modelli usuali di riferimento, per quanto già la
psicologia della percezione negli anni sessanta aveva
investigato la maggior parte degli elementi qui riportati, ma in
modo completamente diverso.
Secondo l'ordinamento Jedi, quindi,
gli stessi argomenti trattati dai vari relatori paiono essere
stati inseriti secondo la lista che riporto di seguito,
e il
fatto che siano stati accolti pienamente, come argomenti di
discussione ed insegnamento da parte dei relatori, ci conferma
che il festival e chi lo ha organizzato per
fini di lucro,
abbia assorbito il format del
primo anno di studi dello Jedi Yoga,
implicitamente ed in modo esplicito sbandando da quelle che sono
le direzioni dello YOGA classico, che trattano di altre materie
e non pongono tanta e tali attenzioni circa il frutto dei sensi,
il sentire ed in sensire, che qui non viene neppure menzionato.
Riporto qui di seguito i sensi che uno Jedi nella modalità
risvegliata del Sensire al servizio degli uomini, della
coscienza e della presenza, deve avere chiari ed attivi al fine
di non cadere addormentato fra le braccia di Morfeo.
1 TATTO
2 OLFATTO
3 VISTA
4 GUSTO
5 UDITO
6 MOVIMENTO CINESTESICO (
radiale, lineare, velocità....
)
7 EQUILIBRIO
8 CAMPO ELETTROMAGNETICO
9 SENSO DEL TEMPO
10 SENSO DELLO SPAZIO
11 PERCEZIONE VISCERALE (
fame, sazietà, sete...
)
12 DOLORE, PIACERE, PRURITO
13 SENSAZIONE TERMICA
14 INTUIZIONE
15 PESO E LEGGEREZZA
16 DIMENSIONE (
padronanza, goffo...
)
17 TELEPATIA (
Risonanza ritmo sintonia induzione empatia
)
18 ORDINE
19 MNEMONICA (
Analitica,
esperienziale, deduttiva, analogica, coincidente
)
20 SENSO DEL COMPORTAMENTO ANIMALE ISTINTIVO
21 SENSO DI PRESSIONE TIMPANICA, EPIDERMIDE
22 SENSO DI PERCEZIONE DELL’ESSERE
Dei primi, a parte l'elettromagnetismo, per il quale le scuole
occidentali non sanno cosa fare, ma che nel periodo degli uomini
macchina e dell'elettronica dovrebbe essere assai più
sviluppato, saltano qui a piè pari tempo spazio, sui quali non
hanno nulla da dire. Di ordine, neppure
a parlarne, e quindi è meglio soprassedere piuttosto che esporsi
in una esplicita riformulazione delle cose, come fecero
Pantanjali e altri.
Animale e' la modalità, probabilmente istintiva, e
incontrollata, come quella della fame, sete, bisogni sessuali,
bisogni culturali, ecc... mentre gli ultimi due vengono spostati
su tatto e su coscienza interiore.
Della seconda lista, altresì dettagliata, ma di impatto
inferiore, se ne considerano qui solo 3 su 27, e a torto poiché
nel periodo della massima espansione di alcuni corpi, su altri,
quello causale volitivo, per esempio, come quello astrale
bramante, e mentale condizionante, nonché quello eterico,
interessato ai prossimi cambiamenti di carattere vibratorio, dal
puto di vista delle distorsioni elettromagnetiche
spazio-temporali, si capisce come tali concetti avrebbero potuto
produrre resistenza, e non solo.
La seconda lista qui in basso, la aggiungo per darvi modo di
comprende meglio di cosa stia parlando. ( Arriviamo a 50 ).
Rendo noto comunque
che i sensi che uno Jedi ha attivi in piena coscienza sono 240,
ma questi insegnamenti esulano dalla comune divulgazione, e
pertanto
non li ritroverete trascritti da nessuna parte, perché
rientranti nella tradizione orale e
diretta, detta marziale di alcuni eserciti, scuole e ordini
dell'antichità come del presente, e che non andranno divulgati
che a persone consone, di valore, rispetto, dignità e nobiltà
provate. Ogni offerta che di tali conoscenze si facesse a coloro
i quali sono di basso livello e bieche intenzioni, produrrebbe
danno, e quindi questa precauzione sensata si spiega e si
giustifica chiaramente in tale maniera. Riporto quindi di
seguito, i sensi interni leggeri, e non quelli marziali,
affinché a qualcuno che non ne ha ancora avuto abbastanza non
venga la malsana idea di rivenderli con il proprio brand, logo,
e pacchetto. Sensi leggeri interni:
23 SENSO DI NUTRIMENTO E BENESSERE
24 FORO PERCETTIVO (
Zone cieche, mancanze, fori, invisibilità comandata, mimetismo...
)
25 SENSO DI MANCANZA O DI VUOTO
26 SENSO DI APPAGAMENTO E INSODDISFAZIONE
27 SENSO DI SOLLIEVO
28 SENSO DI MERAVIGLIA
29 SENSO DI LIBERTA
30 SENSO DELL'UMORISMO
31 SENSO DI COLPA
32 SENSO DI ATTRAZIONE E REPULSIONE
33 SENSO DI ELEVAZIONE E CADUTA GRAVITAZIONALE
34 SENSO DI ACCELERAZIONE E DECELERAZIONE
35 SENSO DEL PRINCIPIO E DELLA FINE
36 SENSO DEL VERO E DEL FALSO
37 SENSO DI RISPETTO
38 SENSO DI INADEGUATEZZA
39 SENSO MORALE
40 SENSO DEL PUDORE
41 SESTO SENSO
42 COMMON SENSE
43 SENSO DI INUTILITA
44 SENSO DI IMPOTENZA
45 SENSO DI ONNIPOTENZA
46 SENSO DI PULIZIA
47 SENSO D'ORDINE
49 SENSO DI MALATTIA
50 SENSO DI VERGOGNA
Dei Sensi elencati dallo
Jedi Yoga, 18 di quelli segnalati in rosso, sono rientrati nel format
delle giornate dello Yoga, tenute a Milano, a parte l'argomento
sulla sessualità che tira sempre, che non è solo una appendice
del tatto. Con tali puntualizzazioni e
studio si vuole semplicemente affermare quanto in questo periodo ci sia
bisogno di Padri Generativi e di Ordinatori, che pongano le basi
per un miglioramento delle cose. Se costoro possedessero però
tali capacità, dubito che le metterebbero al servizio di qualcun
altro, a parte loro stessi o per esporsi in prima persona dinnanzi
alle ingiustizie ed iniquità del mondo.
Ci si espone con sorrisi
ipocriti per farsi conoscere e riconoscere, e vendersi,
attraverso la vanità e la pubblicità per danaro, e l'esposizione di
tali soggetti al pubblico e' vanitosa vetrina, edonismo e mostra di se
che il 99% delle volte è stata intesa come esca per raccogliere
profitti.
I sensi, qui ancora
vezzeggiati e giudicati positivamente, ricordo ai lettori,
secondo la cultura Indiana di quel periodo, come pure le
Siddhi,
tanto ricercate dai bramosi dell'occidente,
risultano essere
puro impedimento,
e sono considerati dai maestri alla stregua di
freni,
deviazioni,
motivo di disergie,
di involuzione, e
di impedimento
spirituale,
concausa delle tentazioni più basse, figlie dei sensi
grossolani, quivi mai citati come
condizionanti verso la
fase animale.
Basti pensare a quante volte compaiano le parole
potere, power, energia, ecc... associate al termine Yoga e
concetti vicini, deviandone il senso, la direzione e sviando per
divagazione interi percorsi.
Conoscerli per redimerli,...e cosa altro diceva
l'anello?....Insomma, quando il maglio del grande nulla colpisce
il mondo facendolo in pezzi, non ci si meravigli che le cose
vadano fuori posto, e che al posto di queste vi si dell'altro e
che ai nomi antichi corrispondano in realtà altri concetti.
Carpe Diem. L'estetica non cerca l'essenza, ma la "non-permanenza"
dell'attimo fuggente, al quale segue immediatamente il bisogno instaurato di un altro
attimo uguale al precedente, in un rituale senza fine chiamato
ipnosi. Imprinting, nella parola moderna. Neuro programmazione
linguistica, se volete, o ipnosi.
Aspettarsi che un clone prenda coscienza e'
chiedere troppo.
Che Smith arrivi a sensire Neo
in Matix, è cosa estremamente rara e che non capita per un caso
fortuito, ma solo se ci si è elevati e si sia raggiunta tale
elezione e livello, o se si sia nati per questo o con tali doni.
Shaktipat è il termine antico.
Una
certa Cabala sulla quale è riportato l'ordine dei disordini, al
quale i sistemi vigenti si confanno,
come le lancette di un orologio, millimetricamente precise e
costrette, è strumento di questi governi dell'ombra, che
attraverso disfunzione, scarsità, dolore e sofferenza, piegano
il mondo al loro volere.
Vi esorto quindi ad andare a cercare tali liste con tutte le
vostre forze, al fine di chiarire quale sia il nuovo ordine
che da secoli, riesce ad ingannare tutti gli inconsapevoli, facendo passare cose
che sono per altro, e cose che non sono per verità.
Tirare in causa la sincronicità, in merito alla presenza
simultanea di una scoperta o un modo di presentare le cose in
questo caso, allorché ci si trovi dinnanzi agli stessi
insegnamenti, o alla stessa scoperta in due punti distinti e
separati del mondo, va benissimo,
specialmente in frangenti che vorrebbero appropriarsi dell'idea
o dire che l'hanno avuta prima loro.
Sotto intendere che certe
cose siano nell'aria, si può fare, ma bisogna riconoscere che se
uno ha percorso18 gradini uno dopo l'altro, vano sarà il suo
giustificare la sua presenza al primo piano di un palazzo,
dicendo che ci è arrivato per caso.
Si tratta di percorsi intenzionali e somme di vettori, che sono
cosa chiara e certa, derivate e consecutive, come pure
scientificamente e scientemente relazionate, ordinate e
descritte chiaramente secondo liste che esulano dal sapere
comune, e che nelle radici stesse dei fondamenti trovano
spiegazione, giustificazione, senso e realtà inerente.
Sappiamo che esiste
un certo numero di Opinion Makers, come venivano chiamati tempo
addietro, e di
uomini pagati e stipendiati per formare menti fuligginose
cariche di contenuti deviati, secondo bisogni preconfezionati.
Si chiamava cultura una volta, ma oggi, i programmatori che
appartengono ai sotto sistemi di controllo e di induzione,
gestiti dai poteri consolidati, non fanno altro che plagiare
attraverso l'inserimento di impianti di memoria esterni,
concetti e comportamenti programmati, le menti di quelli che si
lasciano abbindolare dal gioco.
Di qui il passo successivo è stata una tragica conseguenza della
via ricorsiva dell'errore, che ha gettato le fondamenta
permanenti del vizio, al sevizio delle istituzioni e dei privati
che disponevano di forza condizionante derivata dal plagio, e
che hanno standardizzati comportamenti, e prodotto ciclicità
programmate delle quali non si trova traccia che nell'opera
Dantesca della Divina Commedia.
Contraddistinti da un marchio di fabbrica e protocollati, come
garantiti e al di sopra delle parti, gli
inviati di queste scuole di pensiero che sono stati formati
nelle Università più eccellenti, sono fin dai tempi antichi stati mandati in giro
a controllare, sviare, condizionare, e governare ambiti che
nulla hanno a che spartire con la veste che indossano, di volta
in volta, diversa e di parte, in un teatrino che il burattinaio
conosce e gestisce perfettamente.
Bisogni indotti e plagio
universale sono le modalità della clonazione elementale, che
vive di tensione sensoriale il più delle volte collegata a bassi
emozionali, istintuali, quali dolore, sofferenza, pena, paura...ed altre
nefandezze che potrete trovare in rete facilmente...legate all'illusione del dualismo.
Pensavamo
sarebbe stata rose e fiori questa avventura nel Kali yuga? Non
ci aspetta forse il giudizio universale, la fine dei tempi e
l'apocalisse? E' un bene che la
Consapevolezza Multiversale
si stia finalmente manifestando per quello che è, smascherando
coloro i quali non hanno alcun rispetto nè sono degni.
Senza sofferenza "costoro"
non comandano, senza paura non possono, senza incutere terrore
non riescono a guidare e condizionare quelli che loro chiamano
bestie, e se gli uomini li trattano come animali, si vede che
loro sono di un altra razza, e gli si dovrebbe insegnare il rispetto.
In merito al controllo dei
sensi quindi, considerati come colpevoli di distogliere
l'attenzione dalle cose più importanti e spirituali, si vedrà
qui cosa ne pensano gli Indiani, quindi prendete il dizionario
di sanscrito, il vocabolario di inglese, il testo degli aforismi
di Patanjali e ricominciamo da capo. E ogni volta che ricadete
nell'errore, lo rileggeremo nuovamente, sempre più velocemente,
sino a ricordarlo a memoria, qualora ve ne fosse bisogno. Della
sua traduzione e delle spiegazioni che sono state date al testo,
però, non essendo stato troppo felice di come siano state
distorte, vi rimando quindi alla seguente lettura, al fine di
chiarirvi meglio le idee sull'argomento.
Brahmacharya has two main meanings. In
the broad sense it means control of the senses or indriyas. More
specifically it refers to celibacy or chastity. Like all
traditional spiritual traditions, yoga advocates restraining
from indulging in sensual gratification. One of the many reasons
is that practicing the higher limbs of ashtanga yoga - dharana,
dhyana, samadhi - requires a tremendous amount of energy or
prana. This energy is built up through the practices of yoga
such as asanas, pranayama and japa but is dissipated during
sensual enjoyment. Of all the sensual activities, sex is the one
that will be the most depleting to the psychic and nervous
system. Most people don't like to hear this but, like the other
yamas, everyone should practice brahmacharya to the best of
their ability. It is a fact that the more people gratify their
senses, the less energy they have and the less ability they have
to meditate on the absolute.
The more broad definition of
brahmacharya also includes conduct that leads to the realisation
of the Self, or Brahman, study of the Vedas and scriptures, and
contemplation on Brahman.
Benefits of Brahmacharya: There
are many benefits to health and spiritual life that come from
the practice of brahmacharya.
Dal quale si evince come, a dispetto
delle raffigurazioni sacre riguardanti infiniti congiungimenti
carnali, animali e misti, apposte su migliaia di templi ancora
in piedi oggi in India, queste sensazioni e sensualità,
"facciano male", e quindi vadano represse e controllate, gestite
dalla mente e comandate a piacimento per aumentare potenziali
spirituali capaci di fare innalzare al di sopra....ma come
spesso accade, purtroppo la semplicità delle cose evidenti si
deve nascondere con mistiche e filosofiche spiegazioni e
dissertazioni riguardanti il valore simbolico di cose che non
vorrebbero intendere quello che mostrano ma sottintendere altro
da quello che ci dicono e da quello che mostrano. Sicuri?
proprio sicuri? non e' che qualcuno disturbato da qualcosa che
non gradisce, interpreta e spiega come meglio crede cose cosi
distanti da noi temporalmente e culturalmente che e' obbligato a
distorcerne senso e significato nella direzione a lui consona.
Il fatto che vi sia una sola interpretazione e spiegazione verso
la quale coincidono e concordano interpretazione e spiegazione,
rende certa la manipolazione.
Brachmacharya is considered one
of the cornerstones of a serious yoga practice. The conservation
of energy that comes from practicing celibacy is converted into
Ojas and Tejas (spiritual energy). Eventually yogic powers can
also manifest by the perfect practice of brahmacharya. There are
many famous yogis and spiritual leaders who were established in
this yama. Some of them are Sankara, Jesus, Gandhi, Hanuman,
Lakshmana, and Bhishma from the Mahabharata. From their practice
of brahmacharya they had incredible
amounts of energy, will-power and thought-power
to do great works for the world.
La parola Leader potente che
usi incredibili quantità di energia, potere della volontà e
potere mentale, calza qui piuttosto male a personaggi spirituali
indicati come maestri illuminati, che avrebbero cosi facendo
dato prova non di vera e pura essenza, nella forza, ma nello
sforzo, poiche' ciò che e' di propria natura non pesa a chi è se
stesso, mentre a quello che indossa una veste e un comportamento
pesa massimamente e richiede perciò incredibile fermezza per non
essere sviato dai mondi della sensualità.
Many people mistakenly believe that
practicing brahmacharya means suppression of the natural sexual
instincts. Suppression is not what is wanted, because anything
that is suppressed will eventually be released with redoubled
force when an opportunity arises, the will becomes weak or when
sadhana slackens.
The proper way to practice brahmacharya
is to sublimate these natural urges into Ojas by a strong yoga
practice that includes meditation, asanas, pranayama, japa,
kirtan, satsang, and reading of scriptures or yogic texts.
Contrary to some popular ideas and incorrect psychological
beliefs, celibacy improves health and all aspects of life when
practiced in the proper context.
It is worth noting that most religions
place emphasis on brahmacharya, considering it a higher state of
religious practice, and have nuns and monks who take vows of
chastity. While not everyone wants to take vows and enter a
religious order, there are also guidelines for householders to
practice brahmacharya within their personal relationships.
Non
soppressione ma sublimazione, anche se evidente a chiunque che
la via della ritenzione passa per un nodo, e solo il corretto
fluire di ciò che siamo e' cosa sana e giusta, quindi siamo in
presenza di una fattura probabilmente apposta successivamente
all'intero impianto filosofico, religioso, culturale per
piegarlo a immagine e somiglianza di quanto vige qui.
moderation should be practiced
ci consigliano moderazione,
It is beyond all doubt that a life of
Brahmacharya is glorious and marvellous. At the same time, a
life of moderation in the household life is equally good and
helpful for spiritual growth. Both have their own advantages.
You must have great strength to tread the path either way.
Questa è la posizione intermedia, piu
saggia e corretta da mantenere secondo l'usanza e il pensiero
Indiano, La forza è da entrambe le parti, poichè in realtà la
differenza serve solo quelli che cercano una sponda e vivono
della forza del dualismo.
Classical Period
The Classical Period is marked by another
creation - the Yoga Sutra. Written by Patanjali around the
second century, it was an attempt to define and standardize
Classical Yoga. It is composed of 195 aphorisms or sutras (from
the Sanskrit word which means thread) that expound upon the Raja
Yoga and its underlying principle, Patanjali's Eightfold path of
Yoga (also called Eight Limbs of Classical Yoga). These are:
- Yama, which means social
restraints or ethical values;
- Niyama, which is personal
observance of purity, tolerance, and study;
- Asanas or physical exercises;
-
Pranayama,
which means breath control or regulation;
- Pratyahara or sense withdrawal in
preparation for Meditation;
- Dharana, which is about
concentration;
- Dhyana, which means Meditation;
and
- Samadhi, which means ecstasy.
Patanjali believed that each individual is
a composite of matter (prakriti) and spirit (purusha). He
further believed that the two must be separated in order to
cleanse the spirit - a stark contrast to Vedic and Pre-Classical
Yoga that signify the union of body and spirit.
Patanjali's concept was dominant for some centuries that some
Yogis focused exclusively on Meditation and neglected their
Asanas. It was only later that the belief of the body as a
temple was rekindled and attention to the importance of the
Asana was revived. This time, Yogis attempted to use Yoga
techniques to change the body and make it immortal.
Pratyahara literally means ‘withdrawal’,
like a turtle withdrawing into its shell. It refers to various
‘internalization’ exercises designed to control the senses and
motor organs and introvert the mind. Such are
closing ones eyes
and ears
to look and listen within
or mauna, the practice of silence
and not speaking
in order to control
the vocal organ. However, there are common and more physical
forms of Pratyahara, which are mainly ‘relaxation exercises’;
tightening and releasing the energy in
various muscles and joints, which affects related marmas. This
also clears the energy in the organs and system that the related
marmas control.
Nodi ancora, e controllo sulla natura,
senza aver purificato la mente, incapace ormai di riconoscere il
reale delle convinzioni, il tutto in un meccanismo funzionale
applicabile perfettamente alla materia, ma qui traslato a
difetto, in ambito spirituale, fatto che a pensarci bene, suona
stonato, quando comprendiamo che se una cosa produce un suono
armonico per sua natura, la sua forma segue naturalmente una
qualche simmetria, ma se questa risulta fessa, e incapace di
riverbero come di persistenza, e sorda, rumorosa e dal timbro
povero, nulla potrà mai convincerla a suonar bene, per quanto
una volontà condizionante possa sforzarsi mai.
Dalla corretta manifestazione ed
espressione del Se, equilibrato e armonico, nasce il libero
fluire della vita. Cio che riguarda le funzione dell'ego, come
dell'io e del mio, sono fenomeni ricorsivi e ripetitivi, nodi,
definiti vizi, che sottendono il ritorno a medesime circostanze,
attaccamenti e procedimenti che invischiano e non consentono di
essere in essenza, puri e non permanenti come la realtà
cangiante e mutevole richiede. Asserire il contrario, significa
porre il mantenimento al massimo valore, ma purtroppo, il sogni
di essere immortali, per quanto bello, non consente a chi lo
vive vita eterna checche se ne dica. Ciò che principia finisce,
e al riguardo la vita che degnamente si è vissuta non manca di
nulla, mentre quella che affannosamente corre appresso a
qualcosa, s'e' persa per strada.
Pratyahara
Yoga Nidra is one of the practices of Pratyahara. The word
“Pratyahara” means abstracting, leaving
something, distancing or letting go. (Janakananda 1992) It
involves the process of withdrawing the
mind from distracting sensory impressions like sounds, smells,
sights and thoughts so that the mind
remains in a calm and undisturbed state of silent witnessing.
(Miller 2002) This is done by
surrendering to the experience of the sensory impression and
saturating the mind with it. The
experience becomes the object of meditation. In Pratyahara, we
constantly observe the process of
perceiving; we observe the sensory impression and the reactions
of the mind to it. We do not try to
change anything. (Janakananda 1992) “Any sensory impression that
is allowed to be in awareness
without either the movement of repression or expression,
dissolves back into the ever-present
background of awareness and disappears.” (Miller 2002)
Conversely, when we try to suppress a
sensation, we prevent the mind from studying it. The mind is
unable to conclude whether the sensation
is dangerous or useful. It is thus unable to let go and the
disturbance remains, consciously or
unconsciously. (Janakananda 1992) Hence, trying to withdraw from
anything ultimately ends in
failure. It is only when we are able to be with things as they
are that we are able to go beyond them.
Qui vediamo come la mente ingannata dal
dualismo non può nulla contro il disturbo che e',
indipendentemente da quanto potrebbe impugnare saldamente al
fine di non sopprimere ma neppure inseguire i pensieri. Colui
ilquale conosce la Talità, non cade in questo tranello. Ma
questa, come pure la bastanza, non sono modalità apprezzate da
coloro che fanno della colpa il movente delle cose del mondo,
sita sovente, nella memoria di un dolore impresso nella psiche.
Queste forme larvali elementali, dovrebbero essere spiegate
degnamente da Maestri puri, e cioè in grado di ricondurle al
padrone che avevano, e non, a farle rivivere settimanalmete e
reiteratamente al povero soggetto che vi e' rimasto invischiato.
Patanjali says Nonlust (brahmacharya).
Avoid lust for anything and see divinity in all your deeds and
thoughts. Posizione mediana corretta secondo il pensiero e la
filosofia Indiana. Nota quando la cosa pende, e comprenderai che
è storta, quindi è di parte e condizionante, in termini di fini
che coloro i quali la usano, conoscono bene, a dispetto di chi
non sa neppure cosa s'e' fatto mettere in testa e da chi, che lo
fa tale.
Pratyahara
Pratyahara involves rightly managing the senses and going beyond
them instead of simply closing and suppressing them. It involves
directing the concentration inward. With the withdrawal of the
senses, one no longer feels itch or hear or smell anything
around or feel hungry. Practice of pratyahara helps to forget
everything around and concentrate on meditation.
Andare oltre i sensi a parte il suono
poetico della cosa, non significa che, 1 abbandonarli, e la
rinuncia in questo caso pesa verso la non partecipazione, che
significa evitare un problema che si riaffaccerà karmicamente
subito dopo. 2 sublimarli per sentire cosa altro? e' un modo per
rendere innocuo un concetto, collegandolo ad uno dalla vaghezza
proverbiale, 3 o interpretare mentalmente quanto accade? c'e'
poco da interpretare con le spiegazioni funzionali, c'e' il
soggetto, il movente, il metodo, la maniera, e le modalità,
l'agente e la cosa agita, quindi fruitivo è il mentale di
costoro, e quel che non aggrada vien trattato da impedimento e
tirato giù.
Pratyahara is the fifth limb of
Ashtanga Yoga and is defined as “withdrawing the mind from the
objects of the senses”. It is the bridge towards the inner
quest of Yoga to concentration, meditation, and absorption in
spiritual states of awareness that take one beyond the notion of
a separate self, called
Samadhi.
Ecco il premio che infanga
l'equilibrata e armonica visione, comprando cosi col risultato
favorevole, e atteso, le attenzioni di coloro che muovono dal
desiderio per brama, d'essere, d'avere, o di soddisfazione, e
qui consentono a lasciarsi educare pagando maestri con in danari
sonanti e sforzando la loro natura, piegano se stessi. Ma
Patanjali afferma: Here it is the practice which reveals. It is
our experience which educates our beliefs. Our beliefs must
conform to "reality", not the other way around. Such then are
mutual synergists. Patanjali warns against domination of the
vrtti of preconceived beliefs (no matter how authoritative), and
tells us to be present in our experience.= La pratica che
rivela, che nasce dalla nostra esperienza ( non da quella
altrui o per interposta persona ). Il credo conforme alla
realtà, ( talità evidente ) e non una realtà compresa secondo un
credo, di tipo funzionale e legittimante, e organizzante il
senso logico cartesiano secondo modelli psicologici e deduttivi
semplicistico lineari. Il termine qui usato è "mutual synergists"
come concetto seme, e Patanjali mette in guardia contro il
dominio delle Vritti delle fedi preconfezionate, non importa
quanto autorevoli, e ci dice di essere presenti alla nostra
esperienza. Quindi nulla di fuori posto, il passato al passato,
e la sinergia sinestesica attiva permanentemente nella lettura e
comprensione di quanto accade.
Vyasa no matter how ingenuous
himself, offers a specific direction of interpretation which has
subsequently become standard, amassing a vast corpus of
interpreters, commentators, and glosses. Most subsequent
translators or interpreters translate what the commentators have
said, rather than what Patanjali has said. No matter how
creative or innovative such tactics have corrupted the original
intent and created what is now an institutionalized academic/intellectual
and religious non-yogic bias. Thus this new interpretation goes
back to the source, what Patanjali, himself has said, as the
authoritative basis of the translation. Taken in this way the
Yoga Sutras affords an intelligent and coherent integrity
capable of standing by itself in a way that has not been
presented in English previously.
Tattiche che corrompono le traduzioni,
il senso, il significato, interpretazioni, secondo periodo,
correnti di pensiero, idee in voga, mode ecc... non sono, come
direbbe uno Yogi, nella corretta postura, rendono l'equilibrio
di questo lavoro, d'insegnamento e di sintesi, scorretta
posizione.
It appears to this translator that at
least five qualities must be present in order to be at least
half way successful in the translation of the Yoga Sutras into
English. They are: Sanskrit knowledge, English knowledge, yogic
experience, knowledge of the Western mind and terminology, and
knowledge of the Indian era, cultural assumptions, language,
style, and mindset when the Yoga Sutras were written.
The following translation of the Yoga
Sutras however will show that yoga is aimed at universal truth,
beyond any one religion, culture, era, or nation -- certainly
beyond all concepts, ideology, religion, or language. This is
the Universal Truth that Patanjali (and authentic yoga) intends.
Here we make the assumption that the yogis of old were
individuals living mostly in forest hermitages, caves, in
nature, along rivers, a simple and natural meditative life - the
ancient rishis and Munis of India. Their teachings were strictly
oral in nature -- that is it was not knowledge gained through
book study. They did not go to temples to worship external gods,
they did not memorize and recite the ancient texts -- they did
not go to the caves and hermitages to train in grammar and
philosophy, but rather lived a very simple spartan (appearing
ascetic to the materialist) way of life. Rather they studied
with teachers who themselves were yogis living reclusive in
caves or forests. They studied in what was called the living
oral tradition which although involved some oral teachings, the
teachings were passed down through a living energetic yantra
composed of gestures, gazes, sounds (such as mantras or chants),
as well as other methods of non-verbal energetic wisdom
transmission. There was however one pre-requisite; i.e., the
student (sadhak) had to practice (sadhana). In such living
traditions, it is not the tradition. lineage, or the guru (the
one who removes the darkness) who is important, but rather that
this innate teaching/teacher be recognized and evoked from
within, and then outwards. When one's eyes opened -- all is seen
as truth. This is approximated in the ancient idea of the
gurukula. Here if we take the guru to reside within as the param
purusha (the teacher of even the most ancient teachers) then one
can glimpse the profundity and depth of the yogic teachings.
Sadhaks actively sought out teachers
and teachers tested the sadhak as to their sincerity, capacity,
and worthiness. If a physical teacher was not available, the
energy body/subtle body teachers appeared to the sincere seeker.
Sadhaks naturally took up such a life as a joyful liberation,
rather than as a willful act of self abnegation or sacrifice (we
will discuss in more detail the difference between tapas and
self abnegation/self hatred later). The practices consisted of a
simple way of life embracing ahimsa, satya, aparigraha, tapas,
vairagya, isvara pranidhana, (and the rest of the yam/niyams),
which all worked synergistically and naturally toward fulfilling
their practice of asana, pranayama, pratyhara, concentration (dharana),
contemplation, and especially meditation (which will be
discussed later). Here there was one aim only, not to master the
techniques nor the practices themselves -- not to master the
body or the lower self, but rather to gain ultimate
unconditional liberation -- kaivalyam.
Yoga sadhana has been practiced in the Indian subcontinent
(India, Afghanistan, Pakistan, Tibet, Nepal, Mongolia, China,
Ceylon, and parts of Russia) for thousands
of years. For example Buddha was a well known practitioner of
this yoga, which he most likely learned from the yogis Alara (Arada)
Kamala (Alar Kalam) and Udraka Râmaputra (Uddaka Ramaputta).
This type of yoga was taught many years before Buddha's birth
from an ancient oral tradition/transmission. Buddha's disciples
were the first to write down some of these teachings in the
sixth century BC, much of which which were incorporated in what
today is known as the Pali Canon. This is not say that Buddha
did not make some significant contributions to yoga in his
formulation of the middle way free from extremes, the
elimination of caste distinction, the rejection of blood
sacrifice, trans-theism, and so forth in comparison to the Vedic
religion of his time (Hinduism). However it must be brought into
question whether or not the Yogic tradition itself was rooted in
Vedism or simply co-existed in its dominant milieu. It will be
the assumption of this study that the yoga as taught by Buddha
and written down by Patanjali had the same roots in the munis
and sages of the indigenous pre-Aryan India. Approximately five
hundred years after the Buddha's parinirvana (somewhere between
250 BC and 250 AD) Patanjali practiced yoga and then after
realizing siddha he compiled the Yoga Sutras which were threads
(sutra means thread) of this same ancient teaching, being
entirely devoid of any sectarianism, religionism,
authoritarianism, or theism and containing much the same general
principles and practices of that which Buddha practiced and
taught himself.
Authentic spiritual teachings are teachings from direct
experience. Worse dead oral teachings and/or the written
teachings learned by memorization and obedience are prisons and
traps. Dead teachings act as poison, while true living dharma
liberates because they are designed to defeat and go beyond
ordinary ways of simple obsequiousness, conformity,
unquestioning faith, memorization, and mere intellectual ways of
knowing -- beyond words and definitions. They are deeper than
mere technical, grammatical, and reductionist analysis; because
such teachings recognize that these very same things are most
often corruptive forces. Thus the large differences in the terms
"spiritual" and "religious" must be pointed out where spiritual
refers to the universal spirit and teacher not bounded to place
or time; while religion is usually created by men most often
being species dependent based on temporal language, race,
nationality, philosophical systems, and other such non-universal
bias. External ideological structures created by the ideologues,
dogmatists, academicians, intellectuals, and religionists would
only lead to the expropriation, co-option, and corruption of
universal spirit. As such religion as an institution is the
antithesis of true self inquiry (swadhyaya), which leads to
"self" realization. Patanjali was aware of this tendency to
become seduced by words, symbols, neurotic objectified images,
and the like -- he specifically warned people against it, albeit
with less effect upon the human population than he may have
liked. But once something is written down with words, the
philosophers, intellectuals, and academicians take it as their
own possession and then claim authority over it. Here by the
word, "corruption", it is meant simply that the context becomes
corrupted simultaneously when the bias of the translator is
added. Yoga teachings are not dependent upon words or concepts,
but rather they are designed to eliminate such superficial and
limited ways of living. Yoga teachings are designed for us to
touch the heart of life and live from that non-dual omnipresent
universal core consciousness. In one sense, all translations
will be so corrupt, and this is true only if we do not affirm a
universal context. So for example if one has a Vedic and samkhya
bias, then one would interpret the Sutras with this slant being
predominant. That is unfortunately the norm, but it does not
work well for a truly spiritual interpretation. A universal
context is almost impossible to adhere to, but in this case we
have a unique opportunity because the Yoga Sutras were meant to
be Universal -- they are set in the Universal Eternal as will be
demonstrated, and thus the Yoga Sutras does not belong to any
one ideology, belief system, religion, nation, race, man made (artificial)
system, boundary, or separation as the context is all inclusive
(non-exclusive). We will show in plain language that the yoga
that Patanjali had advocated aims at the universal, immeasurable,
and unlimited -- the Timeless and Unbiased.
Regarding the various interpretations of Patanjali, I think it
is refreshing to assume that Patanjali was a yogi (versus a
scholar or grammarian), who wrote down threads that formed an
integral fabric (yoga). The Yoga Sutras reveal a profound
internal integrity sutra by sutra by themselves. They are not
random fragments as proposed by those whose eyes are still
closed. . To take his words as they are without the aid of Vyasa
is something not commonly published, but I feel it is of value.
Since Vyasa is usually dated around the 5th century AD, and
Patanjali about five centuries earlier, the author has decided
to then take that possibility further and see what came up as a
meditator and yoga practitioner. Such a possibility has yielded
rewards beyond trying to interpret Patanjali through Vyasa‘s
lens or through samkhya. After all yoga is yoga and samkhya is
samkhya – even the traditional classification of the Six
Darshanas recognize their differences. Maybe Patanjali expects
one to be well versed in samkhya first, but really, such is not
necessary, if we assume that the Yoga Sutras are a complete
system (its revelation coming through practice (abhyasa). It is
more than refreshing not having to interpret every sutra in
terms of a samkhya lens which leads to far reaching
possibilities. Although Patanjali uses some terms that samkhya
also uses, but it doesn't mean that he uses them the same way.
For example understanding samkhya is not essential to
understanding Buddhism or the teaching of Shakyamuni Buddha (unless
one wants to study Buddhism historically, philosophically, or
academically. Such may be useful for those with a historical
and/or intellectual/philosophical bent to study samkhya or the
Vedic backdrop. Buddha was also influenced by Mahavir and
Jainism, but also again it is not necessary to study Jainism in
order to understand the Buddhist teachings (except as a
historical or academic way) . rather Buddha and Patanjali taught
transconceptional knowledge and understanding, independent of
such (or at least that is their own words). Of course the reader
is welcome to view these teachings anyway they like, but both
Buddha and Patanjali taught practice – the main practice being
transconceptual meditation. Once the veil is lifted from in
front of the EYE, then all becomes clear/revealed through
practice. As we assume that the Yoga Sutras have a similar
connection to the yoga that the Buddha practiced prior to his
enlightenment, then the author here is making the fresh
assumption that it was not a teaching that required a library,
commentaries, glosses, book knowledge, and/or a heavy
grammatical emphasis or analysis. Simply then this translation
assumes that Patanjali wrote down the basic outline of the yoga
practice of his day with all the essential and basic teachings
included, albeit lacking in detailed instruction wherein he
believed that continued practice would be self instructing. No
one can say for certain, but this has been this author‘s
admitted assumption. Such a reading is more refreshing and more
useful than reading traditional commentaries which often seem to
miss the essential points of meditation entirely. I think many
other interpreters don‘t give Patanjali as much credit as he
deserves. The majority, of course take Patanjali as a
philosopher, a scholar, or even a grammarian, but from his own
words, such a reading does him justice. Some even worship him
and chant his sutras, which appears to this author antithetical
to his teachings. So occur the many abrogations of history.
In summary then, this author does not feel that it is necessary
to interpret Patanjali through a samkhya or orthodox lens nor as
a dualist. One can do so and of course and come up with the well
known ―classic‖ result, but if one does not, then one comes up
with another result. For example, it seems that Patanjali lived
during the tantric cusp. The tantric literature of hatha and
kundalini yoga did not just appear all at once, but cooked for
awhile as a proto-tantric soup. It has been useful to entertain
this possibility for the Yoga Sutras – that such realization was
realized by Patanjali, but not specifically elaborated nor
articulated upon. Here the translator admits then to a tantric,
Buddhist, and even dzogchen bias, but it is an honest bias, as
this interpreter is assuming that Patanjali was intimately
familiar in his spiritual experience with such experiences, even
though the philosophic terminology to fully express these views
had not yet been formulated. This interpretation does not claim
authority or superiority over the "other" interpretations, but
it is rather the translator's sincere attempt to suggest that
the Yoga Sutras is far deeper than traditional scholars have yet
given it its due. Patanjali's job thus was daring. It was to put
these sutras (threads) down as written words, while at the same
time warning the reader of the limitations and folly of words,
concepts, analytical dualistic thought processes, mere logic,
theories and beliefs (pramana), symbolic reality, and the
manifold artifices of the alienated/conditioned mind, while not
feeding those dualistic tendencies of the mind. From this
vantage point I think that was his clear intent -- an attempt to
avoid mis-interpretation and corruption by the religionists as
an authoritative scripture, by the academics as law, or the
samkhya dualists as a samkhya restatement. Thus he placed many
warnings about this kind of corruptive extrinsic interpretation
throughout the Yoga Sutras (as we have taken pains to point
out). Patanjali had scrupulously avoided the possibilities of
interpretations that fed the religionist or academic
expropriation of yoga. Despite this effort, history has shown
that so far Patanjali has been widely misappropriated, and hence
misunderstood (in my humble opinion). The religionists and
intellectual orthodox tradition have studiously succeeded in
institutionalizing their bias and color to the Sutras because
they felt threatened by it. This has occurred in India, but this
perversion doesn't have to be repeated elsewhere. So this all
the more reason to offer this nontraditional indigenously based
translation which is both inter-lineal and literal
re-establishing its yoga context. This translation is literal,
because we will not be reading in from the colorings of other
traditions (such as the Bhagavad Gita, Vedas, Upanishads,
Vedanta, etc.) nor will be reading through the eyes of the
traditional "experts" and commentators. Rather here will be
found an attempt to let the sutras stand on its own i.e., that
Patanjali is saying exactly what he means without putting words
into Patanjali's mouth. If there be any slant in the following
translation, it is due to the prejudice of the translator which
admits to an indigenous, tantric, and mother positive bias. One
thing will be true, that this translation will be fresh. The
objection by the orthodox that the sutras were intended to be
commentated upon and philosophized to death is a miscreant
contention, since sutra does not mean terse, but rather thread.
Sutras such as the Buddhist Sutras or Brahma Sutras can be long
and can stand on their own. This translation is also
inter-lineal because it addresses the silence, emptiness,
stillness, and ineffableness of which Patanjali centered his
compendium.
The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali Chapter
One: Samadhi Pada
Samadhi Pada (chapter one) is an overview of Raj Yoga describing
the situation of how the Unlimited Infinite Mind, Source of
Consciousness, causal spiritual essence, beginningless eternal
spirit, or seed of the Intelligent Consciousness Principle (called
citta) becomes obscured, distorted, corrupted, modified,
fragmented, covered, disconnected, interrupted and/or
discontinuous to the individual "mind", and then how the limited
individual mind is again re-united/connected through yoga (union).
In short, man's spiritual milieu is that his cognitive faculties
are disconnected from the Great Web of Creator/Creation. This
disconnection or spiritual self alienation is called ignorance (avidya)
and is the cause of his suffering (dukha).
Thus yoga is the process of taking us back home to our
unobscured true nature. In the Yoga Sutras, the modifications or
bias of the mind is called vrtti in Sanskrit. The state, called
citta-vrtti, is mankind's ordinary/normal (but not natural)
condition, rather it is a distorted and impaired state of
disturbed or agitated (vrtti) consciousness (citta) which
manifests as a wavelike ripple, a colored filter, pattern,
and/or limited skew which is habitually imposed (as normality)
upon the natural unobstructed, vast, and profound panorama of
pure natural unconditioned consciousness (citta). Vrtti attach
to the citta producing vrtti-citta; that is, producing
artificial, biased, skewed, prejudicial, and limited thought
patterns -- in short, a spin -- which solidifies the stagnant
and coarse state of chronic separation and spiritual self
alienation which characterizes common dualistic thinking. This
citta-vrtti, characterized by specific thought patterns and
activities, are our past programs and patterns of conditioning
which limit our experience of the now and hence it is the vrtti
(with its concomitant samskaras, kleshas, vasana, and karma)
which are the operating principles of avidya (ignorance) which
are the causal constituents of the spiritual disconnect/discontinuity.
Authentic yoga practice in turn cancels out and annuls (nirodha)
these vrtti and then we are thus enabled to reconnect --
reuniting eternal spirit with our embodiment -- as a
manifestation of living love in the present, thence it is said
that we abide in our own true self nature (swarupa). Thus yoga
is defined as the process which removes the vrtti while the
corpus of yoga are the processes and applications of the
techniques (sadhana) which attenuate and remove (nirodha) the
acquired component stains upon pure consciousness (citta), thus
allowing a balance, harmony, and synchronicity to occur between
our consciousness and our actual state of being or rather the
unitive state of pure consciousness, pure beingness, and pure
bliss co-arise (satchitananda). Then yoga is a process of
bringing us back into our natural true state (swarupa). Yoga is
the process, the action, verb, technique, and cause; while
samadhi (reunification) is the object, fruit, result. Simply
put, this is what the entire Yoga Sutras are about and which is
the essential statement of chapter I, sutras 1-3 of the Yoga
Sutras. "The chitta, by its own nature, is endowed with all
knowledge. It is made of sattva particles, but is covered by
rajas and tamas particles; and by pranayama this covering is
removed." -----Vivekananda, page 181 Raja Yoga
Thus the many practices (sadhana) of yoga can be described as "processes"
and procedures of deprogramming this negative conditioning --
liberating the individual's modified consciousness from the
conditioned matrix of limited"reality" back into this Original,
Natural, and Unmodified state -- Source of inspiration, genius,
and creativity. This is described as the realization of the
non-dual state (where eternal
spirit is no longer absent) of Union (as Yoga). Thus the Yoga
Sutras describe processes how a confused, lonely, alienated,
nihilistic, and fragmented existence can be reunited, harmonized,
and integrated with natural order and thus unite in forming a
natural and intimate sense of belonging in the world, of
profound well being, contentment, fulfillment, peace, and joy
devoid of fear or attachment. In the first three sutras (sutra
means thread) Patanjali weaves a concise definition of Yoga.
Concisely, he says; "Yoga is a process of becoming free from
limited definitions of the field of consciousness. Then the
unfettered Source of all Seeingness -- of pure consciousness
itself -- abides as the seer inside. To complete this union and
make it whole is to realize our true nature (Sutra I.2 and I.3).
This is the natural alignment and integration of beingness and
consciousness --Sat and Chit, which brings about absolute
fulfillment, completion, and peace (ananda). In a tantric
non-dual sense then, yoga becomes the culmination of love where
creator and creation (as shiva/shakti) join together in this
evolutionary creative action, spirit and nature are joined, sky
and earth, mind and body, sahasrara and muladhara, manifesting
as a continuous self abiding living implicate order of pure
integrity -- of All Our Relations. Through functional yoga
practice this "reality" is integrated more completely and
continuously -- increasingly shining through not only in
meditation and "spiritual" practices, but also in our daily
lives -- in all our relationships. Yoga is thus the process
which brings us into samadhi (the experience of transpersonal
and non-dual union/absorption), or rather more specifically into
the final stage of self realization called nirbija samadhi (samadhi
without seed), wherein even the seeds of future vrttis have
become eliminated and dissolved (nirodha) in the state of
citta-vrtti-nirodha.
The scene of Pada I, Sutra 1 is (as it always has been) the
underlying all pervasive Eternal Now, which is beyond words,
name, and form; yet includes and underlies all form. The
speaker, Patanjali, emerges out of this eternal now to break the
profound silence and describe in words for the benefit of the
present and future generations that all pervasive Great All
Inclusive Reality of Integrity in All Our Relations - That
Boundless Reality which is beyond the power of words to define
or describe. These teachings of yoga differ vastly from book
knowledge, where before Patanjali wrote them down they were part
of a living oral tradition passed on from generation to
generation into fit vessels, where the practice itself is
designed to reveal the teachings -- to activate the inner
teacher. Patanjali says in many places that success in yoga is
dependent upon going beyond the individual human process and
beyond words. For example in sutra 9, Patanjali says:
shabda-jnanaupati vastu-shunyo vikalpah (true wisdom where the
ordinary monkey mind stops its spinning is when the words and
concepts cease). Hence this translation will necessarily remain
an interlineal
interpretation, where the true and most profound teachings
awaits the sincere seeker in the more subtle and silent spaces
in-between the lines. Patanjali tells us right from the start in
pada One, that the context of yoga is all inclusive and lays
beyond the grasp of the intellect (conceptual mind), and thus he
tells us that we must develop the innate wisdom in order to
successfully "understand" the subject. Thus the way to study the
sutras is to read them and then to mediate and reflect upon them,
rather than to approach it as an intellectual exercise.
Christopher Chapple, in "The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali", Satguru
Publication, New Delhi, 1990, says in his introduction: "To
understand Patanjali's success, we must keep in mind that the
text is one not of positions but of practices. Furthermore, the
telos of the various practices, whether described as nirodha,
kaivalyam, or samadhi, lies beyond language, beyond intellectual
speculation: and this experience, which is itself beyond
syncretism or synthesis hold the text together. The text has
meaning in that its practice obliterates all meaning. Patanjali
has no point to prove: he does not advance one practice above
another. The practice which is effective is the one to be used,
as indicated in Sutra I:39; yatnah abhimata dhyanad va (or from
meditation as desired). Patanjali provides us with an important
clue regarding his method in the first pada. When listing all
the practices to be undertaken, he uses the connecting particle
va (or), not ca (and)... This method is similar to that employed
in the Bhagavad Gita where again and again Arjuna asks Krishna
for one truth and again and again Krishna offers Arjuna yet
another perspective, another chapter, another yoga. Each view,
whether that of a god being sacrificed to or a yogic discipline
being practiced, is given life as long as it proves effective.
Multiplicity is the rule, without one perspective, one god, or
one yoga gaining ascendancy. The culmination of yoga comes when
all differentiations are obliterated in nirodha or samadhi. This
is not to say that life ends, but a state of being is attained
wherein, paraphrasing Sutra I.41, 'like a crest jewel, one has
unity among the grasper, grasping, and grasped,' a state of yoga
wherein totality is embraced without denying multiplicity." This
translation will try to keep those wise words, in mind.
The Yoga Sutras begin by Patanjali breaking the silence -- the
roar of the great stillness, so to speak, to tell us how the
universal flux of pure consciousness and pure beingness becomes
corrupted, fragmented, restricted, rigidified, distorted, and
oppressed (by the action of vrtti -- causing one to experience
the vagaries of cit) -- and about the path called yoga, which
leads us back into direct communion, integration, wholeness, and
complete wholesome fulfillment - to our core center which is the
heart of hearts -- into our eternal home once again -- back into
sacred synchronicity - which intimately connects us to our true
authentic Self and Source.
INTERLINEAR TRANSLATION OF SAMADHI PADA
Samadhi Pada: Sutras 1-3 Sutra I Atha yoganushasanam From the
portal of the Eternal Now (atha) -- freed from the structure of
linear time and space -- from the non-ending beginningless
ineffable stillness -- the eternal truth -- the Universal
Intelligent Source from which all traditions and written laws
are mere poor substitutions-- from HERE -- emanates the
authentic instruction of the transcendental non-dual method that
restores integrity called yoga (the process of joining together
and making whole) -- unfettered by temporal limitation and
corruption. In Pure Integrity in All Our Relations, yoga is
all-ways available here and now (in the sacred present), and as
such, it is at once, the arrival, the abiding, and the unborn
universal presence which when experienced is recognized
instantaneously as our true spiritual home. We will then truly
know when we have arrived home. Sutra 1. 2 yogash
citta-vrtti-nirodah Yoga occurs when the machinations,
vacillations, perturbations, whirlings, spinning, and agitations
(vrtti) of the mind-field (citta) dissolve, cease, and become
still (nirodha) Commentary: Yoga is the process of dissolving (nirodha)
the wavelike operations or machinations of the ordinary thinking
processes (vrtti) of the dualistic mind which colors, limits,
and distorts the originalness Pure Universal Mind (citta). Yogic
processes are designed to annihilate, annul, still, or dissolve
(nirodha) the fractual and limited wavelike patterning and
conditioning (vrtti) of the perceiver's mind field (citta) so
that the unconditioned clarity can shine forth illuminating the
darkness and stilling all anxiety and stress continuously --
without interruption. Thus vrtti can be defined as the
interruptive patterns and wavelike operations which occlude the
continuous flow of citta from manifesting.
Here vrtti are defined as the wavelike movement of thought
patterns, thought processes, wavelike operations, mental
machinations, or oscillations which are the beginning of mental
turmoil, agitations, swirlings, revolutions, or spinning's that
occur in the ordinary restless, disturbed, or dulled mind field.
In short the vrtti evince the whirlpool of ordinary thinking
processes which create a turbulence, a directive spin, or bias
-- which condition, program, color, and distort the original
unobstructed true pure nature of the unbiased and universal
clear light of consciousness or Infinite Mind (citta). Thus
vrtti muddle, color, distort, and obscure that sweet wholiness
of consciousness (citta-prasadanam) from penetrating and
manifesting into everyday consciousness. The presence of
habitual vrtti upholds the fragmentary or corruptive mind which
thus becomes habituated to the secondary traumatic spiritual
rend of separation from our true Self (the primal trauma). In
yoga it is that compensatory habit, bondage, or attachment
formed to that afflictive state (klesha) which is the cause of
our suffering (dukha) as elucidated by Patanjali in Sutra I.5.
When the vrtti cease or become dissolved (nirodha) then the
clear light of absolute reality shines forth as our true nature
(swarupa). That is the process of yoga. The word, nirodha, means
cessation, dissolution, stillness, or extinguished. Literally it
presupposes a pre-existing blockage of some pre-condition.
Translators often confuse the word nirodha as being active as in
the act of stilling or even worse as the act of controlling, but
rather the word, nirodha, is definitely passive i.e., it is
stillness not stilling, dissolution not dissolving, cessation
not the act of restraint. Of course there is an object that is
being transformed from activity to stillness (the citta-vrtti),
but it is salient that it is not the mind-field (citta) that is
being stilled or controlled, but rather the machinations (vrtti)
which have become attached to it and have been revolving the
afflicted mind in circles, In yoga such machinations come to a
halt, then the larger Mind's eye is opened. The wisdom eye is
activated and shines forth inside out and then "Reality" is seen
as-it-is in its true nature (swarupa). Thus it is the vrtti
which occludes-- it causes distortion. obstruction, bias,
obscuration, and restlessness of the citta (pure consciousness)
which eventually ceases (nirodha). When such limited
associations, self identifications, or attachments with the
thought processes (vrtti) cease (nirodha), then the self resides
in its true non-biased abode -- as the True Self or natural
unconditioned mind (citta). Nirodha, as cessation is thus
passive to an extreme, yet yogic processes (sadhana) themselves
are activities (active) as we shall see. They are designed to
bring upon this effect (dissolution) of the vrtti. The ordinary
person who does not meditate has much to look forward to as
meditation practice reveals the truth and true happiness
contained herein, because meditation is the act of dissolution/cessation
of the citta-vrtti. As this dissolution occurs the practitioner
(sadhak) has the opportunity to know their own mind (the
instrument and window of consciousness) directly, thus becomes
clear and from inside out wherein the true nature of Self and
existence is revealed. What could be more empowering and direct?
When we meditate we become aware of the instrument of our own
mind, its wavelike operations, and mechanisms. This awareness
allows us to see more clearly -- fine tuning the instrument so
to speak and bestows upon the sadhak (practitioner of yoga)
great liberation. This is greatly empowering, because we now
have the opportunity to see how the mind mechanisms and habits
work to color and distort "reality-as-it-is. When the dirt and
obstructions from the lens is removed (shuddhi), perception
becomes unclouded and expanded as heightened awareness. After we
start to meditate, we notice that the "ordinary mind-field " (victimized
by the vrtti) is moving constantly from "place" to "place". We
can call that the monkey-mind which moves through the action of
vrtti. In Sanskrit there are many words for mind depending upon
what is governing the mind. The "normal" ordinary mind (called
manas) as well as intellectual function (buddhi) are a dim
reflections of pure citta. All intelligence depends upon the
pure citta (or as we will see in later sutras upon purusha) as
its source. Indeed the mind comes from citta, but it is severely
limited and distorted because the pure citta has become modified,
biased, taken on a spin, and conditioned (by the vrtti).
Meditation is the process where the vrtti reach cessation,
subside, and rest in stillness and complete dissolution. When
the cessation (nirodha) occurs, then samadhi begins -- the clear
light (the light that brings forth clarity) of pure universal
transpersonal consciousness (citta) dawns. At first there exits
small glimpses as the clouds of vrtti dissipate, while later the
experience of samadhi becomes increasingly integrated and
continuous as All Our Relations (culminating in nirbija samadhi).
Water, if you don‘t stir it, will become clear; the mind, left
unaltered, will find it own natural peace.‖ Sogyal Rinpoché
Thus nirodha can be interpreted as dissolution, removal,
purification, annihilation, stilling, quieting, the elimination,
or simply as cessation. Thus yogic practices (sadhana)
consistemntly applied (abhyasa) are designed to bring about
nirodha (cessation), which is devoid of any activity of the
individual conditioned dualistic mind. This doesn't mean that
the mind loses consciousness, rather the opposite. The entire
organism is connected with the Source of Goodness (Siva the
param purusha). It is filled with unlimited consciousness as
unobscured citta shines forth. The vrtti can take many shapes
and forms. Dynamically, the vrtti's wavelike operations form
patterns and vortices of manifold modifications, fluctuations,
movements, oscillations, agitations, disturbances, perturbations,
spins, disruption, revolvings, swirlings, or mental turmoil
which are at the root of our anxieties, bio-psychic and
spiritual tensions, conflicts, stress, afflictions (kleshas),
distortions of reality, and confusion. Vrtti can be described as
a corruptive agency or fractuous unsteady condition that
attaches itself to the citta (pure consciousness) and thence
obscures the individual's mind-field. This is the state of
ordinary dualistic fragmented and afflicted consciousness (the
ordinary mind called manas), where corruptive influences such as
spin, bias, taint, kleshas, vasanas, samskaras, karma, and
ignorance have become dominant and taken their toll in samsaric
(fragmented dualistic existence) as dukha (suffering). All that
is necessary is to still the vrtti. The following sutras
identify the five general categories of the vrtti and then
methods such as abhyasa and vairagya which allow us to become
free from the influences of vrtti. Devoid of vrtti, pure citta
is all inclusive and pervasive than any one isolated discrete
mind-scene consisting of a separate seer (the one who sees), the
object seen, and the process of seeing (See Sutra I.41), because
pure citta (when the vrtti has ceased) is universal -- it is not
defined within the dualistic context of a separate ego ("I"
sense) or the normal framework of object relations (pratyaya).
When this natural unmodified/unconditioned stage of citta
becomes churned, distorted, traumatized, rendered, disjointed,
perturbed, dis-continuous, or distorted into fragmented patterns,
then disharmony, conflict, anxiety, disturbance of the
mind-field, disease, discomfiture, and "lack" occur. In this
corrupted state of vrtti-citta the mind-stream is traumatized,
disrupted, and rended discontinuous.
Thus citta-vrtti-nirodha is accomplished (as yoga) when the self
limited thought patterns, biased programming, corruptive
fragmenting fluctuations, and negative conditioning on the
mind-stream, its mental faculties, and their bio-psychic
processes are de-stressed and all remediated. When that veil is
lifted, one's field of consciousness no longer being self
limited, distorted, nor inhibited, then citta shines forth as
inherent self luminous wisdom and lucidity allowing one to
arrive home to sacred ground of indigenous self abiding -- of
All Our Relations -- our natural state. Another way of saying
this is that functional yogic processes create
citta-vrtti-nirodha, yoga being both the process and the result.
(For more on nirodha, see nirodha parinama in Pada III-9).
Again when this yogic process is continuous, integrated, aligned,
and synchronized in All Our Relations -- synergistically in
delicate balance and harmony in the light of experiencing our
true nature (swarupa) then yoga is easily understood as the
process of interconnecting, reintegrating, and synchronizing
with our natural unconditioned true self. Then that result is
called samadhi (union/absorption, re-integration). Yoga being
the process while samadhi is the result, however Vyasa says that
yoga is samadhi. When our intimate alignment of pure
consciousness and pure being is artificially modified,
obstructed, made discontinuous, fragmented, interfered with,
strained, distorted, skewed, stressed, or agitated into
fragmented or disparate patterns, then we can recognize that the
vrttis are dominant. Then we can apply the remedy of yoga
sadhana (for example meditation, the eight limbs (ashtanga
yoga), samyama, etc. Thus once we have awareness of the true
nature of our afflictive conditions, we will naturally desire
release and then learn how to implement the remedies of yoga
effectively. Thus the practice of true authentic yoga eliminates
the vrtti (modifications of the citta) and establishes the
reunification of seer, seen, and process of seeing back into its
natural unconditioned, unconstructed, non-dual, uncontrived,
harmonious, and naturally interactive dynamic alignment with
creator, creation, and creativity (creative spirit). That
unification bears ultimate fulfillment in Nirbija Samadhi
without containing any seeds that allows one to fall back into
samsaric existence. Thus Patanjali defines at the end of Samadhi
Pada, nirbij samadhi as such. One thus aligns with all of
creation/creator and enters into that sacred realm, no longer
bearing the seed of further suffering stemming from the illusion
of a separate "self" (ego). Sutra I. 3 tada drashtuh sva-rupe'vasthanam
So that (tada) the original clear light (drashtuh) of our
inherent original true nature as-it-is (swarupa) can shine
through. We then strongly and firmly abide (vasthanam) and
become consummated in our original true nature (swarupa) of pure
consciousness [without being uprooted in false identification,
dissipation, dissuasion, distraction, or disease of
consciousness by action of the vrttis].
Commentary: It must be emphasized again that the term, nirodha,
is passive. Thus yoga is not the restraint, suppression, nor
control of the mind (as is too often mistranslated), but rather
it is the cessation, elimination, dissolution, or remediation of
the vrtti (which restrains, colors, conditions, and limits the
citta). When the vrtti cease, the mind field is silent and self
liberated, allowing space for a greater intrinsic intelligence
to appear -- the innate dormant wisdom that is not misidentified
to dawn. This is the realm of sat-chit-ananda (pure beingness,
pure consciousness, and absolute bliss). This experience is
gradually and increasingly experienced through effective yoga
practiced as one result. Such naturally calls out to the
practitioner who seeks integration/yoga. Swarupa, means
what-is-as-it-is, residing in its own abode or in its true
natural form without modification, distortion, or artificial
conditioning. Swa means as-it-is by itself, while rupa means
form. Thus swarupa can likewise be defined as being in its own
true form as-it-is or natural true "self". In yoga the true form
devoid of the modifications (vrtti) is not an existential,
indifferent, catatonic, nor neutral state, but rather a profound
transpersonal realization and expression of the unconditioned
natural mind. The universal mind stuff shines forth out of
Source and as such, beingness and existence are unified, One
then sees Reality and all things as-it-is in their true form
without distortion or spin. There is no externally imposed
limitation of a separate, limited, or biased viewpoint, viewer,
or seer, because one's eyes have been opened in this
transpersonal non-dual profound sense (as a Seer (Rishi or Rsi)
to see Self in all-- in the sacred sphere of All Our Relations.
Drastr in this context then is the seer (the one who sees), but
disclosing the principle behind seeing, the process of seeing,
the light behind the process because now the seer is resting in
its true abode, where vasthanam means simply to abide within --
resting as-it-is without any restlessness. Where the common
man's consciousness ordinarily wanders from object to object
through the attachment of the vrtti -- through attachment to
apparently separate "selves" through processes of limited false
identifications or in short through ignorance (avidya), here the
seer is not so attached, but rather rests in its true nature or
authentic self without delusion. HERE the seer "rests" (vasthanam)
in their own inherent true nature (swarupa). So this, yoga, is a
union of consciousness with beingness, then the seer rests in
his/her own true nature. In a tantric sense this is when siva
(the consciousness principle) and shakti (as the creatrix or
manifesting process) are wedded in shiva/shakti -- in the
profound union of satchitananda -- of pure consciousness, pure
being, and pure fulfillment and completion. Similarly we can say
that yoga is the process that brings us into this completeness
-- this resting in our natural unalienated and universal
timeless state where the machinations of the citta-vrtti have
ceased.
Yoga thus is the liberation of the individual mind from its
ordinary habitual illusory prison of fragmented estrangement,
held together by grasping onto conditioned imprints of
discontinuous past experiences framed in duality and
separateness; so it can abide again and dwell in its rightful
spotless natural abode (swarupa). In later day tantric terms the
practice of yoga then becomes the processes of clearing out the
pathways within the body/mind (nadis) and pranic sheaths for
unconditioned citta-shakti to evolve and manifest. When the
karmic obstacles are removed through applied yoga practice, the
prana that flows through the nadis will become balanced
and strong -- they will work together in mutual harmony
activating the dormant potential of transpersonal non-dual
knowledge and bliss. Eventually the alignment of the inner
ecology of the body/mind synchronizes with the outer ecology of
the universe and then the non-dual and trans-rational
synchronicity of yoga occurs in harmony with formless Source. In
hatha yoga terms this occurs when the pingala and ida nadis are
strong and synchronized so that they perfectly activate the
evolutionary energy in the central column (sushumna) which in
turn unites consciousness and being.-- sky and earth, spirit and
nature, sahasrara and muladhara, siva and shakti, eternal love
with embodied love, undifferentiated consciousness with
differentiated consciousness, creator/creation -- as a
continuous whole in All Our Relations. In hatha and tantric yoga
this is a gradual process that comes about through a balanced
and skillful practice (sadhana).
Sutra I. 4 Vrtti-sarupyam itaratra When
we are not "home" or not present (itaratra) -- not abiding in
our true self nature (swarupa) -- then consciousness (citta) is
colored and modified (vrtti). It assumes the form (sarupa) that
is shaped by the modifications of consciousness (vrtti) rather
than as unmodified universal citta (consciousness) as it truly
is in reality. Commentary: Otherwise or at other times (itaratra)
when the vrtti operate then our body/mind energetics will be out
of synch -- the citta (consciousness) will be distorted,
disturbed, agitated and fluctuate as it becomes swept up
identifying with objects (sarupa) and we will be out of sorts so
to speak. Sa, means with, while rupa means, form. When we are
not united, aligned, or connected in our true authentic nature (swa-rupa)
through yoga, then disharmony and distortion (vrtti) will appear
catching us up in "our fragmented dualistic world" where
phenomena appear disconnected (sa-rupa) or disjointed - a
separation between creation/creator, mother nature/father sky,
earth and heaven, root and crown, existence and consciousness,
natural manifest order and divine order, the weave of the
universe and the universal source obstruct and restrict our
synchronistic joyful participation.
Without previously recognizing our corrupted or perverse
condition, and without having taken up any expedient, proficient,
or skillful method of remediation or reintegration [such as
yoga], we become habitually lost identifying with the
modifications and aberrations (vrtti) of the mind as an
ingrained way of corruption (as "reality") to a point of
unconsciously reinforcing our own imprisonment and illusion at
the hellish altar of familiarity. Thus in this way, the
dualistic false identification and spiritual self alienation (as
existing separate as an ego) thus become our solidified as our
"reality".
In the sacred sense, our everyday experiences are best
approached as sacred grounds where authentic yoga is to be
practiced all the time, while identifying the forms that the
vrttis take, realizing how they distort and color our "reality",
and then taking this opportunity to remediate/transform the
fragmented situation into completeness and integrity -- so that
we abide in swarupa (true nature). In other words there truly
exists in reality our sacred true experience as-it-is within the
context of eternal Infinite Mind. On the other hand the"thinking
mind" which extracts us from Living Spirit thinks "about"
specific limited situations habitually revolves about one object
of thought to another object attachment to another. It gets lost
in simple fragmented object relationships. That way the ordinary
mind has become conditioned to skirt Reality, rather than to
abide within it. Normally the ordinary mind spins/whirls
outwards into various false identifications (sa-rupa) with the
vrtti unless we practice yoga that attenuates and eliminates the
vrtti -- unless we are graced to recognize and rest in our true
self nature -- in the great Unlimited and Absolute Integrity of
All Our Relations Pabhassarm 'idam' bhikkhave cittam 'tan' ca
kho 'agantukehi' upakkilesehi 'upakkilitthan' ti pabhassaram
idam bhikkhave 'cittam tan' ca kho 'agantukehi' upakkilesehi
vippamuttan ti Oh! 'Bhiksus'. The mind is pure! It is defiled by
the adventitious defilement. Oh! 'Bhiksus'. The mind is pure! it
obtains liberation through the adventitious defilement. Here in
the Anguttara-nikaya (1:5) the practice of meditation leads to a
luminous and inherently pure mind (pabhassar citta) devoid of
vrtti. Here also a secret of meditation is disclosed which
Patanjali later elaborates upon as well. In yogic practices such
as meditation we learn how to come back home to swarupa --
Reality-as-it-is. As we meditate we see how the interpretive
mind has the tendencies to get caught up in objects (either
physical objects or mental) and we learn how to let them go (through
vairagya and abhyasa as will be presented in I.13). Thus the
vrttis are at first lessened, recognized, then remediated, let
go, and eventually they cease. Sutras 5-11 then identify the
specific vrtti (modifications,spins, disturbances, fractuals,
agitations, and corruptive influences of the mind-field). Then
sutras 12 to the end provide their attenuation and removal (cessation)
so that one can eventually stabilize the realization of seedless
samadhi (nirbija samadhi). Sutra 5 Vrttayah panchatayah
klishtaklishtah
These vrttis (wavelike distortions, spins, and aberrations of
our psychic field of consciousness) are of two types (tayah)
i.e., those which lead to pain and suffering (imbued with klesha
or emotional defilement producing afflictions), and those which
are devoid of such emotional defilement and affliction, not
necessarily leading to pain or suffering being neutral (aklishta).
They can be classified and broken down into five (pancha) broad
categories (tayyah). Commentary: Here Patanjali broadly
classifies the vrttis in five broad categories each of which may
be afflictive (kleshas which cause suffering) or be neutral
(free of afflictive results). We remember from the previous
sutras that yoga is the removal of the influences of all vrttis
(fragmentary, conditioned, and biased thought patterns) so that
reconnection with spirit in All Our Relations is made whole and
continuous. The kleshas are defined as emotional defilements or
negative afflictive activities which cause suffering (dukha) are
generally agreed upon to stem from the primary ignorance/confusion
(avidya), of which a separate sense of self existence or ego
delusion (asmita), attachment (raga), aversion (dvesa), and fear
of discontinuity or "death" are also associated. They can be
broken down further in many permutations of the above such as in
lust, greed, pride, jealousy, hatred, anger, etc., but the major
point is that the kleshas are taints which poison and enslave
our mind and behavior, thus our liberation is dependent upon its
purification (cessation). Patanjali here does not attempt to
delineate which kleshas are caused by which vrtti or conversely
which vrtti add to which klesha. Suffice it to say that they are
associated in holding together the spiritual malaise of
alienation, disconnection and separation. Later we shall see
that Patanjali suggests tools as yoga processes/practices (called
sadhana) which are designed to remove these fragmentary
fluctuations of the mind (vrtti) by practices which remove the
kleshas, samskaras, vasana, and negative karma. Again as such,
this is a process of purification or cessation (nirodha). A
practitioner of authentic yoga can thus gauge their success in
practice, by asking if we are less enslaved and burdened by the
oppressions of the vrttis, kleshas, samskaras, vasana, and karma
or not? Are we less agitated, more empowered, more creative and
fulfilled, not only in our yoga practices, but also in our daily
activities as well? Do we notice (viveka) the disturbances
coming up sooner and do we stay in awareness residing inside of
our core energy, our true nature, our center, or heart ever more
increasingly? We may ask what helps remove (nirodha) the vrttis
and their manifest distractions, dissipations, cravings, anger,
grief, jealousies, greed, and other kleshas fall away and cease?
Patanjali says that some vrttis are associated with klesha and
others are neutral in respect to klesha (aklishta). The word, "klishta"
is most often misinterpreted as pain or suffering, but the
Sanskrit word, dukha, is the term used by Patanjali to mean pain
or
suffering. Also "aklishta" is sometimes misinterpreted as
something desirable or beneficial, but it is valuable to point
out that aklishta merely means the absence of afflictive emotion
(klesha) or neutral in this regard. This common
misinterpretation of klishta/aklishta occurs because of the bias
of the ideologues, religious fundamentalists, and academicians
attempting to exhort the "goodness" of pramana (the first vrtti
translated as proven theories or "right" knowledge). The common
confusion of pramana will be cleared up in the immediately
preceding sutras. What Patanjali simply states in I.5 is that
the following five categories of vrttis are capable of
reinforcing or exacerbating klesha (afflictive emotions and
defilements) or they simply may be neutral in this regard. In
the reverse way, it could be said that the kleshas, especially
ignorance (avidya), amplify the whirling of the mind (vrtti). In
any case when the vrtti cease, so do the kleshas, but one way to
get HERE is to abandon the kleshas (we will see how in later
chapters). Sutra 6 Pramana-viparyaya-vikalpa-nidra-smrtayah
Ordinary consciousness is full of a myriad combination of vrttis
(that which distorts the mind field preventing us from seeing
clearly); hence Patanjali breaks them up by the five
mind-vagaries (citta-vrittayas) of: 1) Pramana -- The filtering,
modification, and patterning of consciousness due to belief
systems, "conventional theories", so called proven theories or
so called right knowledge held together by ordinary dualistic
perception (pratyaksha), deductive reasoning or inference (anumana),
consensus reality, and the testimony of external authorities (agama)
is pramana. Pramana (so called accepted or politically correct
views/beliefs) is thus a vrtti (modification consciousness) and
thus a hindrance which must be eliminated (nirodha) in order for
the process of Yoga to be realized (see sutra I.2). A proven
theory or belief is just that, not the Reality, just like a map
is not the actual territory. It may or may not lead us to the "Real
thing". In fact, stubborn fixations upon belief systems is a
pervasive filter creating a strong barrier to the realization of
samadhi as we will show in detail later. Especially when people
believe strongly in their tradition, religion, ideology,
provincial prejudice, or "righteousness", these type of pramanas
are very difficult to surrender. HERE Patanjali says pramana has
to be surrendered up on the altar of truth. Further this is the
crucial statement that separates yoga from philosophical systems;
i.e., yoga is based on experiential practice which informs the
sadhak (practitioner) and transforms fragmented dualistic
consciousness back to its profound natural unconditioned state (swarupa).
It is not based on memorizing facts nor conforming to external
belief systems.
2) Viparyayah (Filtering and modifications of consciousness due
to mistaken beliefs based on errors of perception, lies,
propaganda, dis-information, confusion, ignorance, perversity,
false identification. falling into this category is anything
that may be proved to be wrong as well as incoherent, schizoid,
hypocritical, and/or corruptive thinking). This is similar to
pramana except there is an error in the process of perception,
the process of inference and/or deduction, and/or in the process
of the external confirmation (agama). 3) Vikalpa (Filtering and
modifications of consciousness due to fanciful thought processes,
contrived and artificial thinking methods, hallucination, day
dreaming, imaginary conditioned cognition, conceptionalization,
fabricated thought, and in general the monkey mind discursive
mentations of the ordinary mind, based on frontal cortex
processes). 4) Nidra (Filtering and modifications of
consciousness due to dullness of mind, inattentiveness, sleep,
being in a daze, torpor, stupor, and alike) 5) Smrti (Filtering
and modifications due to past memories, past legacies, residues,
impressions, experiences, nostalgia, grief, trauma, etc.)
Commentary: In everyday life these five vrttis usually do act
individually, but rather in combination with each other forming
and shaping the many obscurations, patternings, and
modifications of the citta-vrtti Hence we can have half truths,
inter-acting with stupor , logical reasoning, past conditioning,
and trauma which combine together as a karmic activity that was
activated by an afflictive emotion, which in turn was colored by
these vrttis. These five vrttis (fractious modalities) can be
either innocent distractions and dissipations possessing no
negative karmic effect (aklishta) or they may be part of a seed
bearing cycle of negative karma (with klesha) such as the vrttis
caused by negative propensities and reactions (the kleshas due
to ignorance, i.e., attachment, pride, anger, hatred, fear,
greed, jealousy, and similar) depending upon how occluded our
mind stream (chitta) has become and whose purification
eventually provides the antidote as the field of consciousness
expands.
The very wavelike operations of the citta-vrttis are always the
result of past negative karma (conditioning) and hence an
element of avidya (the chief klesha) is thus present. Here
though Patanjali is saying that the citta-vrtti can and do
produce more kleshas (literally poisons) and as in sutra I. 2
the goal of yoga is reached when the citta-vrtti cease (nirodha)
their operations. Then there is unalloyed. uninterrupted,
unfiltered, and unbiased continuity of cosmic consciousness. As
we will learn at the end of this chapter, it is the vrtti which
occlude the self luminous light (prakasa) of
consciousness which comes forth when the bonds of the intuitive
insight (prajna) is loosened. Yes, so yoga answers the question
of what is consciousness itself and what are the processes which
reveal it as well as what are the processes which occlude it. At
first we will discuss what it is that occludes and colors it
(the vrttis). Then how through practice (sadhana) how to see (vidya).
Yoga answers these questions through practice, not by giving
people ready made up answers or texts to memorize or chant. The
very process of perception is dealt with. The errors occur not
only how we interpret what we perceive such as assigning meaning
to a sense object through the filters of proven belief systems (pramana),
misconstrued beliefs (Viparyayah), contrived ideation processes
(vikalpa), through the limited interpretation filters based on
our past experiences (smrti), or through subconscious habits of
partial sleep (nidra), but more so than removing these clogged
filters *vrtti), yoga practice alters the way we perceive itself
-- the process of perception by rearranging the relationships of
the object which is observed, the observer, and the process of
observing. This new way of non-dual perception goes further than
the perception of ordinary sense objects as discrete self
existing objects through the agency of the five or six senses,
but rather yoga teaches the awakening to our evolutionary nature
-- to the true nature of Universal Mind. Sutra 7
Pratyakshanumanagamah pramanani The vrtti (spinning operations
of the mind) called pramana is constituted of pratyaksha (spinnings
around a sense object, then anumana or inference (operations of
the mental processes around the input of the sense object, and
finally the wavelike operation of the mental processes around
the validation process from scripture, authoritative teachers,
gurus, accepted authority, trusted friends, or even consensus
reality (agama) all of which externalize one's attention and
energy. Commentary: Some common English translations of the
word, pramana are valid cognition, valid proof, valid theory,
proven theory, proven conclusion, judgment, or right knowledge.
Pramana is most often the essential or core building block in
forming fixed belief systems (which is another vrtti of course).
As stated the problem of vrttis in general is that they agitate
and churn the mental processes providing a limited bias thus
occluding the full spectrum of mind-field possibilities. Thus
the pure citta, pure underlying source of intelligent awareness
(or param purusha) which lies at the Source of consciousness is
occluded, interrupted, and disrupted which is the opposite of
the goal of yoga practice.
As any experienced meditator knows such a biased mind has no
place in dhyana (meditation) as described by Patanjali. When we
meditate we must let go of all such vrttis or suffer the
negative consequences. "Right knowledge" or "proven theory" is
often is used in daily life to rigidify the mind stubbornly
fixated upon biased beliefs and creeds colored by culture,
geography, race, sex, religion, sect, nation, and species. In
other words, it is a veil/filter that man grasps upon stubbornly
because he/she finds their ego in "it" -- it reinforces their
view of separate self. When any true spiritual seeker (sadhak)
becomes so fixated, they only reinforce their alienation from
the universal Self -- they stand off their spiritual progress.
Especially when it it is colored by the belief that their creed
is right, good, superior, or better, thus it holds one back from
the universal citta. Pramana then is indeed another coloring of
the mind. Pramana is the conclusion or judgmental processes of
what is right (and thus what is wrong). It forms the basis of
assumptions, firmly held (stubborn or fixated) belief systems
and similar constructs of the mind which are supported and
upheld by the glue (proofs) of external authority (agamah),
inference and reductionist logical methods or proofs (anumana)
governed by the intellect, and by pratyaksha (dualistic
perception and ordinary provincial awareness) which may appear
true within a limited situation or context, but which if applied
elsewhere serves only to bolster bias, prejudice, pride, and/or
further confusion and limited dualistic false identification
which most often serves to reinforce straight plane left brain
thinking, but at the same time extracts us further from the
simultaneously arising universal ground of being. This is a key
sutra where Patanjali makes it clear that yoga is neither a
religion nor a philosophical system. It is not based on right
knowledge nor wrong knowledge, rather yoga is an empirical grass
roots inner experiential system based on practice (sadhana) or
direct experience. This direct experience is not pratyaksha as
ordinary dualistic perception, but rather a deeper kind of
non-dual wisdom (prajna) beyond subject/object duality. Nirbija
samadhi (as the goal of yoga) is also not based on pramana
(right knowledge), inference (anumana), or philosophical
speculation. Although philosophers and scholars are free to
speculate on the yoga Sutras, something that they have perhaps
over done, Patanjali says repeatedly that it is through practice
that the inner wisdom will shine forth and that this occurs when
the vrttis are dropped such as in dhyana or samadhi. Dropping
pramana then is a necessary step, albeit one of the hardest,
because most people have become fixated to external belief
systems. They find themselves in external structures and then
defend their ego fixation vehemently through argument. Indeed
this is the stuff that taken to the extreme religious arrogance,
bigotry, crusades, holy wars, pogroms, and jihads are made from
where even the murderers deny that they are doing anything
"wrong" or harmful, rather they believe that they are doing
God's work as interpreted by "authorities" from their holy book.
As such this sutra is most often left ignored, left unchallenged
critically, or misinterpreted by scholars, academicians,
intellectuals, ideologues, religionists, and philosophers, who
themselves have contributed to the plethoric morass of
traditional biased written interpretations (who also do most of
the translations). They are themselves addicted to pramanas and
if one dialogues with them they can not imagine dropping pramana.
It is unthinkable to them. Thus they most often translate
pramana as "right knowledge" and deny/ignore that Patanjali
considers it a vrtti (a coloring). Thus they "interpret" this
particular vrtti as being some how beneficial, despite
Patanjali's clear statements to the contrary. One can just pick
up most any translation of the yoga sutras and check out how
academicians and others who are frontal lobed dominated
translate and interpret this key sutra. Even the very idea of
valid cognition is dependent upon an object of cognition. This
is not meditation (dhyana) as Patanjali describes where one has
to let go of even the most subtle thought process. Reading 1.7
in other translations will let you know if the translator is a
parrot, ideologue, and/or traditionalist on one hand, or on the
other hand, an authentic yogi who is guided by inner wisdom and
light -- by their own genuine practice and direct yogic
experience. Parroting traditional authority without honest
critical or creative insight indicates little yogic experience
and integration which in turn creates a disservice to the
earnest student as it is misleading. "There are two kinds of
knowledge to be acquired – the higher and the lower; this is
what, as tradition runs, the knower's of the import of the Vedas
say. Of these, the lower comprises the Rig-Veda, Yajur-Veda,
Sama-Veda, Atharva-Veda, the science of pronunciation etc., the
code of rituals, grammar, etymology, metre and astrology. Then
there is the higher (knowledge) by which is attained that
Imperishable. (By the higher knowledge) the wise realize
everywhere that which cannot be perceived and grasped, which is
without source, features, eyes, and ears, which has neither
hands nor feet, which is eternal, multiformed, all-pervasive,
extremely subtle, and undiminishing and which is the source of
all. As a spider spreads out and withdraws (its thread), as on
the earth grow the herbs (and trees), and as from a living man
issues out hair (on the head and body), so out of the
Imperishable does the Universe emerge here (in this phenomenal
creation). Through knowledge Brahman increases in size. From
that is born food (the Unmanifested). From food evolves Prana (Hiranyagarbha);
(thence the cosmic) mind; (thence) the five elements; (thence)
the worlds; (thence) the immortality that is in karmas."
Mundaka Upanishad , Translated by Swami Gambhirananda
As we are beginning to see, yoga is based on direct yogic
experience that emanates from yogic practice (sadhana), not
theory (valid or not). It is this practice (called sadhana or
abhyasa) applied wisely which awakens the innate wisdom. In
order for
that journey to bear fruit, theory, ideology, theology, and even
logic must conform to the evidence -- it must be tempered by
yogic experience. For the average intellectual dominated by the
frontal lobe of the brain, the external locus of authority must
be shifted, eventually being surrendered upon the altar of
universal truth. Theory and the world of objective facts,
finally being seen as the stagnant matrix separating the
practitioner to the organic universal flux of where universal
spirit acts as the universal being. Patanjali is saying very
straightforwardly that what we tenaciously defend and grasp onto
as "right knowledge" -- what is politically correct; what we
believe to be right, true, or good -- is a coloring of Universal
reality -- is a vrtti, as long as it is supported by outside
authority, consensus reality of our trusted peers, scripture, or
any external source which we have become dependent upon (agama);
reductionist logic, inference, or reasoning methods (anumana);
and ordinary mental faculties of dualistic perception (pratyaksha).
This vrtti like the rest must ceased in order for the yogic
practitioner to realize the higher states of union (or samadhi).
Patanjali makes a very salient point in this profound sutra;
i.e., that people are suffering from the spin of ideology,
top-down mental processes, and theories imposed upon our moment
to moment experience by the imbalances and over dominant
processes of the cerebral cortex, where normal judgment and
decision making processes occur.In short the cognitive process
requires an object of cognition and the cognizer, thus creating
a dualistic separation from the process of consciousness itself.
Cognitive based people are constantly objectifying their
"reality" -- constantly placing a separate "it" from the
separate observer (I), thus dualistic bias is unfortunately
fixated upon. This escape from reality is really an aversion --
a pushing aside the subjective side of consciousness. Fear and
the other kleshas exacerbate this imbalance. The imposition of
fear and excess fixated pramana upon the rest of the
neurophysiology of the living human organism creates both
neuro-physiological as well as psycho-neurophysiological
impairment.
Although pramana may be a theory "proven" through certain
methods, one must also take into consideration the limitations
of the methods of proof. This glue which often forms the "apparently"
benign stagnant fortresses of fixated, opinionated, and stubborn
firm belief systems, dogma, ideology, radical fundamentalism,
prejudice, and prideful identifications actually is a self
limiting vrtti as false identification, a wedge of separateness
that separates us from the universal consciousness. Indeed
pramana it is a limited manmade, artificial thought construct,
bias -- a mind prison produced by preconceived notions,
prejudice, and institutionalized fear. -- all of which reinforce
false identification and avidya, is perhaps one of the most
tenacious and insidious of all the vrttis, because the adherents
of pramana, cling helplessly upon the very instrument which is
drowning them. The proofs of the theory which such people
who cling upon pramana hold as "right belief" winds up as the
justification of their own false identification with artifice
and continued methods of "Self" denial. We all know superficial
people who are walking encyclopedias of external knowledge,
experts or "authorities" in various fields of philosophy,
semantics, or religion, but who have no self knowledge or wisdom
-- who have no realization -- who have not brought this
knowledge into the heart. Patanjali doesn't say that "correct"
views or right knowledge are all "bad" or afflictive (klishta),
only that such can and often does get in the way obstructing the
complete realization of yoga. These vrtti given the right
circumstances create klesha, which in turn creates further
negative karma and suffering (dukha) such as aversion, hatred,
condemnation, fear, etc). Some vrttis may be neutral in relation
to being associated with afflictions (aklishta), but regardless
all vrtti, must be let go of and cease in order to walk into the
clear light of original deathless mind (in satchitananda).
Through practice uncomplicated, unbiased, and clear observation
will reveal that it is more difficult for some one to give up
their beliefs, valid theories, ideology, judgments, and prideful
attachment to false identifications which have become familiar
and comfortable veils and filters of reality because they are
rigidified through surface evidence (pratyaksha), logic or
inference (anumana), external authority (agama and smrti) or
consensus reality. Anyone who has tasted meditation knows that
such superficiality is a coloring (vrtti) and obscuration to the
full dawning of the inner light. It must be surrendered at the
altar of direct experience. Rather the type of "Realization"
that Patanjali is presenting is not dependent upon such
superficial and external dualistic means, but rather their
extinction. He is saying that such methods have to be given up
in order to realize citta vrtti nirodha. Here Patanjali
discusses the glue (proofs) that holds together the fixation of
pramana. Pramana, because it is assumed to be "right" knowledge"
and/or is otherwise most often reinforced by the group illusion
of the time, group prejudice, group pride, and temporal
authority and beliefs becomes more difficult to let go of than
knowledge or belief that can be proved to be wrong or perverse (viparyaya).
Classically the tenacious glue of pramana (fixated belief
systems, conclusions, judgments, theories, rigid mindsets, and
so forth) are glued together through the three agencies of:
pratyaksha (observation) is often defined as form of perception
undertaken by the five senses based on the dualistic assumption
that there exists a separate observer, an object of observation,
and the process of observation as being discrete. Pratyaksha
also assumes that the separate object is "real" and truly exists
in and by itself. This is the basic assumptive tool of the
Vaisesika
Darshana (along with anumana or logic). It is interesting to
note that Vaisesika differs from Nyaya only in so far as Nyaya
uses agamah (as well as comparative analysis) for determining
pramana (right knowledge). Pratyaksha holds true only in a
dualistic sense of a separate object and observer, i.e., the
objectified "I-it" world, as opposed to the yogic non-dual/transpersonal
world. In studying the Yoga Sutras Patanjali considers
pratyaksha and pratyaya limited forms of cognition which the
meditator must eventually abandon. Later in Pada II of the Yoga
Sutras Patanjali presents the practice of pratyhara (the fifth
limb of astanga yoga) which is designed to remediate the
dualistic limitations of pratyaksha (or mind grasping onto empty
objects). Here we must also recognize that modern physics and
linguistics also supports Patanjali's low regard of basing
pratyaya on pratyaksha. See Physicist David Bohm (River of Truth)
and also Bohm's dialogue with Krishnamurti,
anumana (inference) or logical, deductive, reductionist,
analytical, or intellectual machinations of the ordinary mind
which validate, support, or otherwise confirm the conviction or
conclusion (pramana) as appearing real, true, or substantive.
agamah authoritative witnesses, scripture, parents, expert
testimony, and others who testify toward the formation of the
conclusion (pramana). Agamah can be very insidious as every
race, country, religion, sect, time, and village has the
potential for reinforcing a mass illusion/delusion built on
prejudice, fear, and pride. Especially religious pride can be
very entrenched as is transgenerational pride, ignorance,
prejudice, aversion, anger, and violence especially found in
radical fundamentalist traditions. No where in the Yoga Sutras
does Patanjali advocate following tradition (sampradaya) for to
do so would contradict his purpose.
Following are a few examples. They can be broken down into two
categories; i.e., one where the pramana is later proven to be
false, but one at first thinks it to be true, and the second
category is that the pramana appears to be true, but it is still
limits our consciousness and spiritual experience (chit and sat).
A common example is that the world was once thought to be round
because people observed (pratyaksha) that the horizon appeared
to be flat, then inferring (anumana) that the earth was flat,
and this was then confirmed by the church and kings (agama).
Later some one came along and "proved" that the earth was round
and thus people fixated on that. In reality the earth is not
round but spherical and even that has many
subtle "anomalies", twists and turns to it. That is the theory
or picture of it still does not conform to what it really is.
Not even modern scientific theory can account for the shape of
the earth and its many changes, yet the earth is as it is
despite our many theories of it. That is-as-it-is is direct
non-dual perception known when the dualistic tendencies of the
mind are put to rest. Similarly at one time in Europe it was
considered to be proven that the universe revolved around the
earth. Advocates used certain observations (pratyaksha),
reasoning (anumana), and the church and kings (agama) to back
them up. If you disagreed you ran the risk of being tortured and
killed. Of course today we know that was a "mistaken view" (viparyayo),
but one may ask how many mistaken views do we hold today that
are generally considered pramana and how is that holding us back
from vital and functional living? A young Palestinian boy
observes that an Israeli bomb and soldiers have killed one's
mother, brother, sister, and father. That Israelis are occupying
his town and beat, arrest, and order around his few remaining
friends creating fear and poverty. Through inference, he sees
Israelis as the enemy. His religious authorities and town mayor
validates this. His hatred and anger (kleshas) toward the
Israelis thus reinforced and he decides to be a terrorist
killing Israelis and those who support their evil ways. In
Gujarat India, there has just been a murderous riot. One's
entire family and village has been murdered. You observed it and
saw the perpetuators (pratyaksha). Through inference (anumana)
it deduced to be Moslems and the tribal chieftain arrives and
declares that all Moslems are our enemies. Out of fear and
hatred a belief is validated (pramana) that all Moslems must be
killed in order to feel safe and survive. His parents, peers,
and leaders confirm that belief. Hence mob hysteria is fed from
a proven theory (proven by pratyaksha, anumana, and agama). One
can go on with a myriad examples of false generalities,
stereotyping errors, and false conclusions based on limited
observation, inference, and validation which are mistaken. Are
the above pramana or viparyaya? Now for the second category,
pramana which are not necessarily false, but are still limiting
-- still producing fractual modifications of the citta. It is
not only that relative observation through the sense organs can
be faulty, that logic can be faulty, but also what authority is
absolutely trustworthy except the Sat Guru? According to
Patanjali there is no external teacher separate from the innate
teacher, the teacher of the most ancient teachers (isvara as
purvesham). Even a theory which actually corresponds to the
Truth, if not derived from direct experience too often may
prevent such.
For example: "I am not the body". True
statement? It is stated in the negative and thus can create
limitation. In one sense we are not just the body, the ego, or
separate from the all, but who in truth am I 9the true seeker
asks)? If the "I" atman is one with Brahman, then it is all
inclusive and not separate (according to a certain school of
advaita), thus it includes the body (there being no place where
Brahman is not). One can use observation, inference, and
authority to validate neti, neti (not I, not I), but this is not
the same as experiencing its truth. One may be filled with pride
that one has this knowledge, but it is merely pramana, it did
not come from direct experience. The above is very similar to
the Buddhist negative pramana of proving that there is no
independent self. After all where does the ego abide? But
pramana based on observation, inference, and external validation
should never substitute for the spiritual experience itself
which is a more widespread mistake of academicians,
fundamentalists, philosophers, and intellectuals than they might
presume. One could go even further by categorizing pramana as to
being positive or negative, religious or scientific, partial and
contingent, or true and objective, but its common limitation to
a yogi is that pramana is both fractualizing and spiritually
dysfunctional as it blocks the natural flow of citta -- it holds
us back in practice. The larger spiritual knowledge beyond the
vrttis is not dependent upon the processes of mere observation,
rational inference, and external validation. Take it or leave it,
but don't stop there. Pramana is not labeled a vrtti only
because the processes of observation, inference, authority, and
validation may be limited or faulty, but rather pramana is a
very limited and fractional dualistic veil in which the common
man peers out into the world with a " spin" on life. It colors
the world and reinforces bias (avidya) and bondage preventing us
from going further into true spiritual experience, awakening,
and liberation (avidya being the major klesha). Patanjali is
really making a profound point here in categorizing pramana as a
vrtti precisely because of the common fixation of most of the
religious "authorities" and bigots of his day. As such this kind
of fundamental questioning forms the basis of heresy. Patanjali
is profoundly telling us that yoga sadhana is a search for truth
-- where theory and belief are derived from our own direct
experience. For this fundamentally spiritual search to be
successful it is necessary to first admit our ignorance by
saying that we do not know. Secondly yoga sadhana demands that
we do not adopt nor hide behind some one else's system, no
matter how politically correct it appears, but rather we must
find the truth within. Adopting an objectified world based on
agama and anumana spells death to the authentic spiritual
pursuit. There exists no dark soul of the night for those who
have given up their attachment to separateness.
Yes, orthodoxy will tell us that pramana is necessary, valid
cognitions, proven theories, belief systems, religion, and
ethics keeps us from going too far astray. "It
keeps us out of trouble", they say, but Patanjali is saying that
it also separates us from genuine spiritual sadhana and as such
it is the cause of spiritual affliction (klesha). Patanjali is
not attacking the "other" philosophical systems, but rather he
says that those who adhere to fixed beliefs or simply belief
systems (BS) in general that are not based on direct experience
will maintain spiritual stagnation. Thus they can not reach the
direct experience of universal consciousness -- of All Our
Relations. On the other hand, yoga sadhana such as advocated in
Sadhana Pada (Chapter 2) and in particular, meditation, takes us
considerably further beyond the limitations of fixations on any
belief systems (pramana) based on dualistic perceptions (pratyaksha),
authoritative testimony from books or authority figures (agama),
and logical or intellectual methods (anumana). So in sutra I
-12, Patanjali says not to get caught up with any vrttis,
because they reinforce the vrtti of pramana. Especially not
those things (such as agama, anumana, and pratyaksha) that
uphold the vrtti of pramana, because in the authentic yoga that
is being taught here, that is not where liberation or samadhi
comes from, rather they hold one back. Those methods may be
helpful for studying engineering, mathematics, law, mechanics,
or construction, but they should be put aside (vairagya) when
practicing yoga -- especially so when applied to the main method,
the practice of meditation. The point is that the theory is not
the experience, while rigid theories (even though not erroneous)
too often precludes it because it is severely "limited". Granted
a good theory may lead us eventually to the experience (and the
experience may even prove that the theory was correct), but in
truth the reductionist objectification process which is pramana,
must in either case cease altogether if we are to get to the
universal boundless Mind which is the true nature of Mind.
Pramana is like a theory, principle, or "derived" law while
agama, anumana, and pratyaksha are its apparent operators of
proof; but Patanjali says that as such this will reinforce the
vrtti. In other words walking around with such constructs in the
mind (mindsets), we superimpose artificially a very severe
limitation upon the potential and very profound/sacred innate
depth of our experience, i.e., Reality-As-It-Is -- or swarupa.
This filter, matrix, or veil serves as an obstruction, which
yoga meditation is designed to utterly destroy. When this
dissonance between consciousness and beingness (between sattva
and purusha) is destroyed the underlying profound non-dual
transpersonal and trans-conceptional REALITY is revealed. Thus
in the end of Pada III in Sutra 55, Patanjali says: III. 55
sattva-purushayoh shuddhi-samye kaivalyam. Translated: "By
perfectly balancing (samye) pure beingness (sattva) with pure
undifferentiated universal consciousness (purusha) the
obstructions are removed (shuddhi) thus disclosing and opening
the gate to kaivalyam (absolute liberation)."
Pramana as a surrogate or adopted belief system, ideology,
mindset, or "ism" may be difficult to let go of, especially so
when we have not been brought up to do our own critical/creative
thinking and true self inquiry; but rather to become dependent
upon the "boss", master, experts, or consensus external
prejudice of our culture or times (so called "reality"). This is
where the limitations of dogma and ideology become rigidified as
well. This is another good reason to drop it, because real yoga
can not be achieved in such a sorry state. This is also the
defect of religion, where it demands conformity to behavior, but
fails to provide revelation. In fact the dogma compensates for
authentic experience and most precludes such. Rather, genuine
spiritual discipline is based on providing direct communion.
Thus Patanjali quite clearly says that pramana, that which are
dependent upon the proofs of pratyaksha (observation), anumana (inference),
and agama (authority), may be at best neutral in some situations,
but for a yogi whose intention is to realize the Truth in
samadhi, all vrtti must be dropped. It should be mentioned that
some advanced spiritual souls may want to point out another kind
of belief or world view (which some may call a pramana but is
not so defined by Patanjali) which is not a theory, judgment, or
conclusion based upon observation (pratyaksha), anumana (inference),
and agama (external authoritative sources), but rather which is
derived from direct yogic experience of All Our Relations. Then
would that be the kind of pramana which Patanjali calls a vrtti?
No, Patanjali is defining pramana in his own way (as a theory
proven by agama, anumana, and pratyaksha), and as such it is a
vrtti (all of which are to be discarded). If however our view of
reality and self is conditioned by our yogic experience, that
understanding taught by the direct experience of the Great
Continuum is neither pramana nor vrtti according to Patanjali.
Ordinary people limit their experiences, sometimes quite
severely, through limited belief systems. In the past accepted
authoritative beliefs like: "the world is flat, the sun rotates
around the earth, such and such is impossible, and so forth held
people back". Likewise today many conventional beliefs supported
by apparent observation, inference, and authority severely
constrict people back (on and off the meditation cushion). This
limitation is due to the imposition of beliefs (right or wrong)
upon present experience so that we do not allow ourselves to
experience anything outside the box (except in dream or
fantasy). The opposite way to go is to have our experiences
inform the neo-cortex (where the conceptual functions reside) as
to what is going on instead of the neo-cortex dictating to the
neurology what is real and what is not. If our experiences can
actually feed the entire nervous system as a whole -- without
distortion, resistance, or conditioned interpretation born from
the imprints and adaptation of childhood games, fear of
punishment, desire, ego, pride, jealousy -- in short the kleshas,
then a greater sense of inter-connectedness is experienced,
greater wholistic function, health and creative expression is
realized. This in turn sparkles over into a deeper kind of
direct profound experience -- a deepening of the ordinary
modality of sense perception or mind perception to a synchrony
of both inner and outer worlds -- the inner and outer ecology
pulsate as one -- experience and consciousness --heaven and
earth -- are merged. It is this profound inner non-dual
transpersonal interconnection which then informs, leads the
mind, and shapes the view, not ordinary perception, logic, or
the testimony of others. When we acknowledge and honor our
deepest spiritual experiences as our guide in everyday life and
are open to this in All Our Relations, then we have no need of
the dictates or guideposts of beliefs that are born from books,
authority, the process of ideation, conceptional fabrication,
rational constructs, or ordinary dualistic methods of perception
for we have gained insight. Now the above statements may sound
bizarre to most people, but it is the common language of the
trade in meditation circles, which is my main practice. Also in
these same circles it well known through experiencing/practicing
meditation that the conceptual tendencies of the frontal cortex
(in its function of mental fabrication and rationalizing)
gratefully ceases, rests, or is stilled. Meditation may or may
not be the common man's game, but it is designed to provide this
fruit. That is why I recommended Patanjali's "Yoga Sutras". In
this non-dual "reality" which is not constructed by man, but
exists by itself from the very beginning then -- this profound
or sacred non-dual state, then even the process of feeling other
people's grief or simply -- of being empathic, is also not being
inter-connected with all beings and all things -- with the grand
integrity of everything, but rather it is a fixation on one
event or person at the sacrifice of everything else.
An example may reveal the common plight of those afflicted by
pramana. One may gather "right knowledge" and facts and has even
been taught how to organize these facts "correctly", so that for
instance, one may believe that God is omnipresent, Eternal, Pure
Love, and other similar details that may be true in one sense,
but still one is not closer to realization really. Unfortunately,
here we have even taken a step backwards if our acquired
external knowledge creates pride, delusion, false identification,
and even greater over-objectification and alienation, which is
often the case. Such beliefs are based simply on facts and logic,
not the experience. It is rather an objective theory, not the
experiential truth or realization. Part of the spiritual malaise
is that mankind (especially in the West has already become over
objectified -- lost in mental theories, abstraction, and mental
processes (vrtti) which have not been reconciled with his
everyday experience, but rather tend on the most part to
preclude or diminish subjective experience. This is not the way
to experience direct spiritual truth.
It does not matter much if these theories coincide with the way
things "really are" or on the other hand if they are a
miscalculation (viparyaya), dream, hallucination, etc., because
one still remains separate and estranged from experiencing
Reality directly if we become rigidified around it -- unable to
let it go, so that we can experience the universal reality which
awaits us HERE. One can try to put all these facts and beliefs
in one's pocket or computer or even learn to memorize them and
recite them at will, but that is not the enlightenment that
authentic yoga aims toward. The bigger danger here, is that such
walking encyclopedias of politically correct belief systems (BS)
too often confuse their external knowledge from spiritual wisdom
and thus self perpetuate their own spiritual stagnation
unknowingly. Rather it is far more expedient to skip this
neurotic behavior from the start as Patanjali recommends,
emphasizing the value of developing direct experience through
yogic practice, revealing the inner wisdom, or innate buddha
nature. This is why yogis always say, that yoga is neither a
philosophy nor a religion. It is not based on theory, on books,
nor words, but on direct experience through yoga sadhana. In
practice, we may find ourselves ignorant and not knowing. It is
far better to humbly acknowledge our ignorance and thus humbly
say to ourselves that we do not know, than to act in acts of
defensive/offensive denial and justification. By saying that we
do not know in humility, we bequeath upon ourselves the ability
to learn and become expanded. This way we seek out the truth and
reinforce our passion for self understanding. It would be
counter-productive to instead to adopt some one else's belief
system (BS), no matter how authoritative (agama), logical (anumana),
or seemingly objective (pratyaksha). Rather it is this very
humble search of the true seeker who is not afraid to say that
"I do not know" -- who is not satisfied with patented answers,
that serves as the flame that rekindles the eternal and
authentic spiritual fire within.
Another practical example which is relevant to our daily sadhana
occurs where one has acquired special or expert relative/dualistic
temporal "knowledge" that holds true (as real) in a limited
sense -- only conditionally (true for a given place, time, or
special condition), but which holds one back from Universal
Gnosis. Such relative fixation especially can create stagnation,
blockage, and disturbances in our meditation practice unless it
is identified and let go of. For instance, it may be true in a
relative sense that the body is sitting is a room meditating and
that one is witnessing one's body sitting thusly, but if one
holds onto this belief held together by ordinary perception of a
separate self perceiving apparently separate sense objects (pratyaksha),
one will miss the universal reality of one residing in all
places, at all times, with form and beyond form -- one will
continue to miss nirbij-samadhi. Here the real yogi must
constantly attempt to place oneself within the overall context
of yoga (continuity) -- in unity with the Great Continuum where
all is in creative flux when the practitioner aligns, abides in
and is in unity with the core/heart center (hridayam). This is
antarika (from the bottom of our heart) sadhana and as such it
destroys the vrtti. All vrtti then must enter into stillness,
become nullified, suspended, and cease because they have the
potential to produce further hindrances (kleshas) for yogis -
further obscuring the field of consciousness. This is at first
to be practiced in dhyana (meditation practice) which proves
Patanjali correct from our own experience. The practicing yogi
must go beyond ordinary pramana to Direct Inner Non-Dual
Experience -- to awaken the inborn self effulgent intelligence
within (Rtambhara -- see Sutra 48). Later on in the sutras
Patanjali elaborates the methods of yoga that destroy the vrttis
by destroying ignorance (avidya) itself, but this can not be
accomplished without giving up pramana in practice. It is this
basic ignorance which obstructs our essential self nature -- our
self existing innate natural wholeness called swarupa. For a
true yogi, any "view" which is not universal, eventually must be
surrendered into the fire of yoga -- all limited views based on
time and place must be thoroughly challenged, melted down,
purified, disengaged from, and surrendered -- this is the deeper
meaning of which the authentic practice of vairagya, isvara
pranidhana, tapas, and swadhyaya reveals by itself (through
practice). Now this is easier in meditation but the problem is
how do we extend that to all our relationships? If you are
working, driving an automobile, engaged in complex mathematical
calculations, or running dangerous machinery you have to depend
on your senses, reasoning, trusted indicators of course. Even
then though we can maintain as much awareness/communion with
transconceptional consciousness as possible as use it as a
guide, but such "demanding' everyday circumstances tend to draw
our energy and awareness outward and dissipate it. Living in
retreat and/or in nature it more easy to see the one in the many,
to live in a non-dual state where dualistic perception,
reasoning, and agama are irrelevant -- where sacred presence is
immanent. Thus in yoga we try to continue to extend that
non-dual realization (samadhi) into All Our Relations all the
time. Eventually we can throw out all of that "philosophy" thing,
all of good and evil, all of belief systems, dogmatic faith,
ideology, the imposition of a straight plane rigidity upon the
innate creative healing and beauty way of life, once we have
realized to some degree the living reality of the organic world
as being a reflection of the creator once we see its true nature
and how it is an obstruction.
But no, a beginner usually can not effectively throw out all
structure before they establish a trusted or firm grounding in
some true clarity of the nature of the unconditioned mind (IM),
but we can practice at least in meditation letting these
structures go (vairagya) while seeing what comes up. This doesn't
mean that we are losing anything, but rather we may be gaining
something by creating space, just as one clears out old junk
from the shelves, then something new that has more functionality
may fit there. This suspension of belief is the same as to
entertain asking for guidance -- surrendering to isvara. That is
part of the practice. If we are playing a game or buy into some
common rules, then within that framework there exists at least a
temporary or conditional belief system that has concluded a
right and wrong or good/bad, but if two people are of a
different religion or value system, how would anyone be able to
conclude good or bad or right or wrong. I already said this
before in this thread, but again, only if one presumes a
universal ethic or principle acceptable to all (such does not
exist) -- only then, it would be useful to use the words "good"
or "bad", so I avoid it as I have found these merely statements
that affirm personal like or dislike, preference or aversion,
desire or fear, and the like. that for example is a way one
could approach ethics as a philosophical system. This is not
just another way of saying that good/right and bad/wrong exist,
but that I chose different words in order to avoid relative
confusion. Well, yes it is by all means necessary to use
different words, because good/bad and right/wrong depend on the
game -- they are culturally or religiously conditioned/determined
-- they are artificial results (the works of man) unless we
assume the imposition of a universal ethic or principle.
Actually I do believe that Reality has such universal principles,
but it can't be translated in terms of good and bad. Secondarily
not everyone is ready to intimately see and live in such a
Reality (yet) so such principles can not be universally accepted
and described as even being desirable by all let alone "good".
But even beyond desirable and undesirable, that is where the
Reality of "what-is-as-it-is" (swarupa) the Reality of I-AM is
found without being filtered by preference or preconception.
That is not a neutral existential reality, but rather a profound
non-dual transpersonal sacred communion with everything,
everywhere, and all the time. To talk "about it" (philosophize)
extracts us from it. At this stage of my experience this is the
culmination of yoga for me. Here one even goes beyond dislike/like
(aversion and attraction) -- all attachment is dissolved in the
living presence of the Great Integrity in which we are.
Nothing is "wrong" or "bad" about the world as it is, it is only
people bitching and complaining or stating their preferences,
their needs, cravings, and sense of separation really. First
there was inseparable unity, but then came the rend, rift,
separation, estrangement, spiritual self alienation of ego. That
illusion/delusion has become institutionalized by a conspiracy
of men's forces aligned with the matrix of ignorance --
programming. manipulating, and exploiting future generations of
man to provide for their neurotic security, comfort, and self
gratification. The Reality is that such alienated men will never
find fulfillment unless they re-enter the living community --
the whole and find their place as one -- acknowledging their
place in the over all context of the inseparable
inter-connectedness of the web of life. The good news is that
this Reality is always accessible and by its originaless nature
inseparable, because the very fabric of the matrix is illusory
-- an artificial game . So Patanjali and Buddha give us
practices to transform illusion, ignorance, estrangement, and
suffering into realization. It is instructive that Patanjali not
once uses the words good or bad and his system of yama/niyama is
not at all meant to be a system of ethics or moral laws as so
defined in the Western context. The latter system of ethics is
simply another way of manipulating and intimidating people. The
Blight of Dogma, Ideology, Belief Systems, Radical
Fundamentalism, which are based on valid cognition but not on
non-dual insight. In a parallel way, if we look at any belief
system we see a structure or way of ordering the world. This
structure is always based on principles (conscious or not).
There is a cause and effect relationship formed in such "beliefs"
about reality. These structures or beliefs obey certain
inter-relationship rules. Many people have tried to map such out
in many systems. For example, Science of Mind, theology,
religion in general, cognitive science (or biology in general),
psychology, phenomenology (Hegel), philosophy in general,
physics, metaphysics, astrology, etc. These are all ways of
viewing or seeing which have their own laws or theories of
inter-relationships/connect-ability. Now when these "beliefs"
actually conform to the way it really is to a point synergistic
synergy is experienced -- wow it all becomes clear and things
work! Eureka! Here great inventions are discovered/expressed
rather than contrived. This is similar to how Einstein described
his own discovery. However all the above are recognized as
limited as they offer some doorways into discrete specificity
expressions of the whole, but still does it connect us with the
whole itself more completely? Not that there exists anything
"wrong" or "bad" about the specific expression, or that even one
must limit the whole by expressing it (which is not what I am
saying), but rather the natural uncontrived reality contains in
its completeness an inherent order that can not be contained by
man's intellect alone (as the intellect depends on words or
other symbols). It can not be contained within the brain or
nervous system, yet at the same time each and every cell can
resonate in harmony attuned with that all inclusive Infinite
Universal Integrity. That Reality is beyond belief. It has its
own innate order and laws which obviate the need for manmade
structure and artificial systems of thought -- which eliminates
neurotic need entirely. I think we agree on this.
This unfabricated "REALITY" is the profound "as-it-is-as-it-is"
goal of yoga meditation, according to Patanjali. Patanjali does
not define meditation as any
technique, any doing, any objective practice rather he defines
it as its absence. He defines the practices of mere techniques
as preparatory to meditation proper in order to help create the
stable stage of meditation where ordinary thought processes (the
monkey mind) ceases. So Patanjali's definition of meditation is
defined as the process of dropping all thought constructs,
objectifications, beliefs, as well as techniques unless we
define this cessation/dropping of techniques as a technique
itself. So then in the end this is the last technique to drop,
before samadhi self arises. (as David indicates as the true
nature of Mind or the Natural Mind itself (unconstructed from
the beginning). This type of meditation is experienced as an
emptying process of all these spinning mental processes (called
vrtti) which were produced and held together by the kleshas,
karma, vasana, and samskara. Then when this spinning is stilled,
the mind contents emptied, even beyond the most subtle objects
or processes of individual thoughts, then we are allowed to
merge in alignment/attunement to that which is profoundly and
innately present -- ineffable and unlimited. That is what he
calls nirvicara samadhi. In meditation we get glimpses of that.
When the mind starts to spin again and fill up, then we empty.
Then we taste nirvicara samadhi again. Eventually through
repeated practice, it becomes longer lasting and integrated
better. For some it becomes permanent samadhi (nirbija samadhi).
So in Patanjali's meditation practice (called dhyana) there is
no doingness or technique, rather the goal is the letting go of
doingness and technique itself -- emptiness, non-doingness, or
boundless big openness is experienced. Being open to THAT --
that inseparable inter-connectedness that permeates all and
everything which we allow to pierce through our close minded
veil when concepts and beliefs are suspended in meditation. That
BIGGER order of things -- the Logos, Dharma, Inherent Natural
Mind -- call it what you will -- when we are so connected -- we
are filled and don't need the crutch of belief systems.
Meditation is a great practice, but the meditative experiences
are to be gradually integrated into daily life, just like the
lessons or experiences learned from asana, pranayama,
contemplation, visualization, chanting, art, music, etc. In fact
pramana is vrtti for many reasons. Through dualistic subject/object
duality in the process of perception of an object, the
apprehension process of the mind in which the sense data is
being placed (called pratyaya) and then processed is inherently
dualistic. It may have value outside (it is first . The
inference process itself which in inherently limited (being a
mere faint reflection of the Intelligent Source (Param purusha)
as well as dependence upon any external validating authority --
all are inherently flawed.
Man falls back to the beliefs and conceptual mental constructs
only when there is an absence of divine Grace or Divine order,
like why Adam and Eve had to cover themselves after being kicked
out of the God's Garden, albeit that is a story with parallel/multi-dimensional
meanings. So in saying that in my experience there does exists a
divine order, cosmic laws and principles, does not say that I
feel it is contrived by man, nor that man can fully comprehend
it in his conceptual mind or belief systems, but rather man can
only experience it fully when he opens to it fully without any
pre-conceptions and especially after dropping belief systems
which create abstraction/extraction from "IT". Here one simply
aligns with it, abides in harmony with it as an integral part of
it (to borrow a phrase from Erich as a wave on the ocean). If we
are really there (centered and aligned with it, then there is no
other need to fabricate, no fear, no desire, no anger, rather an
ecstatic love rules. So maybe we can distinguish between three
types of belief systems, only the last one being no belief
system at all. The first are the common types based on dualistic
experience and ordinary perception (pratyaksha), conceptual and
rational thought (anumana), and/or authoritative witnessing and
testimony (agama). This creates a top down neuro-physiological
conditioning imposed by the frontal cortex upon our
psycho-neurophysiology and hence limits our experiences
according to the limitations that belong to such beliefs. Belief
systems thus can be broken down into three broad categories.
1. Ordinary dualistic experiences A) experiences that totally
dominated by the belief system so that new experiences and
information which does not conform to one's firmly held belief
system are discarded and or ignored -- they do not compute. This
is the common situation of arrogant, closed minded, bigoted,
prejudiced. dogmatic, stubborn, ideological, or fundamentalist
people. B) experiences are allowed to inform the belief system,
they are taken into consideration and are capable of expanding
one's vision of realty. But these are still limited, because the
nature of the experiences are based on mistake of dualism (separation
from all things) rather than one's intimate inter-connection.
Thus although the belief system and one's experiences is a two
way street, such still severely limits our "reality" and
experience. This is the experience of the true scientist, true
searcher, or beginner's mind of open-minded people.
2. The second type of person uses their spiritual non-dual
experiences to inform their belief system. here the belief
system still kicks in, but it is both
informed and allows for the non-dual and sacred more-so in
everyday life, switching back and forth to various degrees.
3. The third type of person is informed directly through
sustained or continuous non-dual experience where there is no
need for belief systems because one is being directed and guided
by it constantly or to a great degree. Here there is basically
no difference between one's belief about the existence and
non-existence and existence and non-existence as it truly
is-as-it-is, because the ordinary belief processes have become
suspended and replaced by an integration of being (sat) and
consciousness (citta) . That merger brings as a result ecstatic
joy (ananda) brings which is yet another Mahavakya (Satchitananda).
One could assert then that most of what is called pramana does
not differ from what Patanjali calls in the next sutra, false,
wrong, corrupted, perverse, or fragmented beliefs (viparyayo)
which are mistaken and confused, because any belief based on
dualistic cognitive functions are an error in judgment which
upholds ignorance -- the illusion of separateness and is hence
confused. Only in type two does the "theory" of what-is actually
start to conform with the "Reality" of it. Only in part two does
the imposition of self limiting theory start to loosen up and
allow for more authentic and sacred experiences. In the third
type then the conditioning/programming by our past dualistic
experiences cease as the unconditioned natural state of Mind
dawns. Here yoga practice and especially meditation is a
powerful deprogramming tool; then we rest in the natural mind (swarupa).
Yes, to experience number three it requires some trust or
courage, but not blind faith. Rather asking for guidance is
trusting in the sacred enough to seek it out in All Our
Relations settling for nothing less. If we can not find the
sacred, at least we are conscious of its absence, so that we are
able to continue the search/practice. Now if THAT relationship
is not functioning (is ignored), if it is not present, when we
can't find the great breath, or our practice (sadhana) isn't
working, only then, does one desire a need for belief systems
such as in #2 or #1 to compensate for that rend from
Reality-As-It-Is.
See the essay "Yoga Sutras Made Accessible" for more on the
institutionalization of self gratuitous intellectual
provincialism, self indulgent, and stubborn fixed beliefs which
fixate traditional values and prejudice that have become
dominant within the established order and tradition of Indian
(status quo) academia. Such a rigid institutionalization of
"right" and "wrong" severely stifles creative thought, fending
off its detractors utilizing defensive/offensive modalities of
self denial which ultimately is spiritually corrupt. The only
"right knowledge" which is worth anything (according to
Patanjali) is not ordinary beliefs (based on observation (pratyaksha),
anumana (inference), and agama (authority), but rather direct
Gnosis/Jnana based on yogic experience, i.e., the type of right
knowledge i snot pramana but prajna, It is the result of
authentic yoga practice (sadhana) produced through direct
spiritual experience, where sattva and purusha are united --
where the vrtti are eliminated. This "prajna (gnosis) is not be
confused with pramana. It has to be coincident with direct yogic
experience (not held together through agama, anumana, smrti, nor
pratyaksha). That knowledge (gnosis) that is gained through
authentic yoga is thus based on an experiential unity (samadhi),
not separateness -- it is not learned through simple
memorization, parroting, obedience, conformity, and jumping
through hoops; but rather it is the non-dualistic Gnosis (Jnanam)
of being inextricably united with the holographic Universal
Transpersonal Non-Dual All Pervading Infinite Self (no separate
self). This is what separates yoga from philosophy and religion.
It is thus authentic knowledge of the Heart of Hearts (Hridayam),
which is thus the authentic goal of yoga, and as such it is not
pramana. See for example Sutras I-47, 48, and 49. Some people
say that Patanjali contradicts himself here, after all he wrote
the "Yoga Sutras". Yes, he wrote them down, but not as a belief
system to follow. Rather he added this wisdom for a very
important reason; i.e., that it should not replace one's inner
way of knowing, but rather bring forth the inner wisdom/teacher,
so that one comes face to face with the eternal teacher --
teacher of the most ancient teachers (isvara as purvesham). He
says that through yoga we develop direct experience leading to
samadhi, yoga being a tool, his book a guide book to the
intrinsic guide, an aide toward perfecting the inner realization
of the yogic process. Thus the Yoga Sutras are not meant to be
scripture nor an authoritative work from an outside authority,
but rather a lab book or user guide offered by one who has well
traveled the path of yoga before us, compassionately pointing
out some things to look for on one hand, and on the other hand,
the potential dead end roads. Instead of selling us the map, the
map is only temporarily borrowed, being meant to take us into
the territory of direct experience. It is that direct experience
of God, truth, or Reality (call her by any name you chose) that
is the goal of authentic yoga. As such this direct numinous
experience should be the goal of any spiritual discipline as
well as religion. Any manmade system that substitutes
compensatory or symbolic representation for this direct
experience is at best a distraction. The latter adds to man's
confusion and institutionalizes man's spiritual alienation.
Worshipping Patanjali would also be an oxymoron, as that would
only reinforce the spiritual estrangement and alienation that
yoga intends to heal and put back together. The Yoga Sutras is
thus a tool to cut through belief systems, to cut through books,
words, religion, superstition, ritual, ceremony, past concepts,
and symbolic forms of worship to the real thing -- the universal
inner teacher/teachings which remove the veil of illusion. "The
head (sahasrara) is the ocean of delight, The seat of bliss, The
thousand-petalled lotus, The seat of liberation. Knowledge of
this is not found in books -- It is inherent in the brain! Books
are made up of parts But the knowledge that shines in the head
is One undivided whole. A book has many chapters, But this
knowledge has only one. Books are for those not established In
this knowledge. For the person with realization, Knowledge is
stable, eternal, and indivisible. A person is born with a brain
-- not a book! At the moment of death, there is no book. Only in
between do you take up a book. Swami Nityananda, translated by
M.U. Harengdi Similarly "When the heart is full, tongue is
silent; when the mind is still, intuition functions; when the
passions are quelled, devotion dawns; when the senses are
controlled, soul force is obtained; when the intellect is silent
God speaks; when the 'I' dies, 'He' shines as Radiant Reality"
Swami Sivananda Sutra 8 Viparyayo mithya-jnanam
a-tad-rupa-pratishtham False beliefs, wrong theories, or
corrupted cognition (viparyaya) are rooted (pratistham) in
corruptive and perverse process of cognition where the process
of establishing the cognition has been corrupted (mithya-jnanam)
where contexts become confused (a-tad-rupa-pratistham) -- where
one's very perceptual process is mistaken. Commentary: Here
false identifications and mistakes of perception as well as the
processes of inference are also faulty (one or both) lead to
misconceived perceptions creating wrong conclusions, theories,
and beliefs because they are based on a lack of perception (pratyaksha)
and/or an overall inaccurate context in which to ascribe true
meaning to it - such as the common fragmented and dualistic
context of seeing things in separate pieces. Here the modern
idiom, "garbage in, garbage out" bears a similar message. Many
examples abound. In a perceptual sense one's faulty vision is
blurred and sees an object faintly at twilight which looks like
a tiger to a mind already biased toward the klesha of fear.
Combined with one's faulty vision, one believes/concludes that a
tiger is there, but later one finds out it was only a large cat.
Is it the "mind's bias that has created the wrong conclusion or
the fault of the yes? We can call this an error of perception
due to lack of light, but really it is an error due to a
combination of events both mental and physical. In a simple
sense, one may hear a sound of an engine and conclude/believe
that it is a lion and run away. That is a result of a faulty "interpretation"
of the sound (a mistake in the computational function (anumana).
Both are viparyayo (false beliefs or wrong views). But on a
spiritual sense any conclusion or belief based on separation or
duality that one is separate from All Our Relations is ignorance
or based on a false belief. Even though in a physical sense a
belief appears to be confirmed through the ordinary channels of
pratyaksha, anumana, and agama unless it is informed by direct
spiritual insight it upholds the fragmented limited view, rather
than the view that includes the sacred whole. In other words we
have become conditioned to see "objects" as solid and the
physical only, but physicists and babies tell us that all things
are fluid, energetic, and inseparable.
Like I might see a light in the sky distorted in the smog and
because I have astigmatism it may appear as something else. Can
the sense organs be fooled? Certainly. Viparyaya is not
dependent solely upon either faulty inference or faulty
perception, but either or both can be faulty. I can conclude it
is a flying saucer. Even others may verify that it is a UFO or
maybe not. Is my sense perception incorrect, my process of
inference, or my system of validation incorrect in making such a
conclusion? What if my parents and teachers (agama) taught me
that the world was flat. My limited sense perception (pratyaksha)
might seem to corroborate it, but then
in the 15th century we learned that this was an illusion or
wrong knowledge even though it was based on sense perception,
inference, and agama. is that pramana or viparyaya or does it
matter? History is full of examples of established theories
being demolished by new correct theories established by new data
and confirmation. Rather it doesn't matter very much to
Patanjali if it is viparyaya (erroneous views or pramana (valid
cognition) they are both dualistic vrttis to dissolve. In one
sense only when we abide in the true Self as-it-is (swarupa)
will have have an undistorted view -- will vidya shine forth
destroying avidya. As long as we see things in the dualistic
context of I-it (as separate) instead of the non-dual
transpersonal world of All Our Relations then in a profound
sense, we suffer from errors of perception. Obviously many
people are afflicted with the vrtti of wrong and misleading "views"
either through a misapprehension of objects of the senses even
before the objects become processed (anumana), but also through
basic errors of the objects of the mind (where we place our
thoughts). Here this basic state of viparyayah can be called
simply confusion or delusion, but more specifically here
Patanjali is saying that confusion including false
identification (viparyayo) false knowledge (mithya-jnanam) which
is based upon (pratistham) a misapprehension of an object either
by the senses or the mind (a-tad-rupa). Here Patanjali is not
even referring to confusion caused by faulty inference or
reasoning abilities (anumana), nor even faulty methods of
validation (agama), but merely the confusion arising out of
perception (a-tad-rupa). Wrong views are similar to right views,
but they are based on an erroneous methodology. Why is the
methodology faulty, because it is based on a mistaken perception
in the first place (here faulty perception), let alone errors in
logic, misreadings, superimpositions of fragmented contexts,
incorrect application of context or standards -- or any
combination of these and more. The anumana and agama will fail,
because the pratyaksha (correct perception) is lacking, but even
if we were to assume "accurate perception", infallible logic is
actually as rare as infallible expert testimony or external
indicators. These erroneous assumptions thus color the citta and
obstruct the sadhana and thus also have to be given up. Here
viparyaya are often more easily given up, than pramana (so
called "right" views), because they are not widely backed up by
external authority (except in cases of mass insanity or
conventional held illusions/prejudice), logical proofs, or
ordinary objective methods of perception (such as found holding
together pramana). Here at least viparyayo caused by errors in
perception can be more easily pointed out, identified, and
recognized, thus capable of being eliminated more easily. They
are more easily given up, i.e., because they may have less
external reinforcements and support (pratistham) so that true
wisdom (prajna) can come forth more easily.
This is made clear in Sutra 48-49: Rtambhara tatra prajna
shrutanumana-prajnabhyam anya-vishaya vishesharthatvat: "Then
Supreme Truth Bearing (rtam-bhara) Wisdom (prajna) self-arises,
dawns and prevails, which must be distinguished (anya) from the
mere knowledge (prajnabhyam) based on anumana (inference,
deduction, logic) and shruti (scriptures, belief, faith,
external or objective authoritative sources of knowledge) no
matter how "seemingly" authoritative, which is always less
reliable and more coarse than this very special insight (visaya)
of direct truth bearing wisdom (rtam-bhara), which is based on
inner direct spiritual experience and knowledge." On a daily
basis, there are many possible examples. We sit in dharana
staring at a candle. The eyes tell us that it turns into two
candles. We come out of concentration and shift our position
slightly and see that it is really one candle, but the eyes (instruments
of perception) had gotten tired and slightly crossed, so that
the object was misapprehended as two. A policeman goes into a
dark bar and sees what appears to be a gun handle in a man's
side pocket. This man sees the policeman and almost immediately
appears to grab for the gun. The policeman hurriedly grabs his
gun and fires it at the man. When the man is searched, it is
found at a closer look that he was grabbing for a metal flask of
liquor. We live in Chicago, Illinois. A loud noise rings out,
like a gunshot. Without thinking we duck for cover, but later
find out it is only an automobile backfiring. This is an example
of a conditioned viparyayo or a conditioned reflex without using
anumana or agama. We hear an airplane, but are reminded by its
noise an airplane crash that we witnessed 20 years ago while
serving in the military as a soldier. On an emotional level we
start to sweat and want to run for safety, but we are walking
down the street with other people, so we try to cope. This is an
example how two vrttis can work together; i.e., viparyayo and
smrti (memory) as a citta-vrtti. A person is brought up in a
cave where the source of light is a torch. Bigger torches bear
greater light. One concludes logically (with anumana) and this
is confirmed by the elders (agama), that light comes from a
torch. At an advanced age, the inhabitants of the cave finally
find an exit and see the stars, moon, and sun. They then believe
that the sky contains very large torches (in their sense they
are correct), but in reality something far deeper is occurring.
There is almost no end to the permutations of the vrtti. When
the vrtti are all given up in yoga, then we are able to see
clearly.
Once we are shown our error (in viparyayah), we are usually much
more receptive and open minded toward exploring something new --
letting go of the mistaken view or in this case exploring better
ways of knowing such as "inner" knowledge and direct experience.
However those who are "settled" in pramana (proven theories)
backed up by perception and inference) however, may more often
stubbornly cling onto their own self made limitations unless
"the view" dictates them to look within, give up the glue (observation,
inference, and validation) of the vrtti, and experience
"reality" for one self directly, without any such filters. This
is what Patanjali is saying in the rest of the Yoga Sutras,
i.e., self realization comes forth from within from direct
experience when the mental processes and external clinging are
completely remediated - their interfering waves (vrtti) are
annihilated (nirodha). This is why Patanjali includes pramana as
the first vrtti, as it is the most stubborn (more difficult to
let go of than viparyayo). Pramana is vrtti that most lends
itself to the kleshas of self delusion (avidya), attraction (raga),
pride (asmita), arrogance, false identification, hatred, envy,
fear, and the rest. Here we will include both objects of sense
perception as well as objects that the mind focuses upon in our
definition of Viparyayah, noting that the classic commentators
take the mind's wandering upon objects of thought as vikalpa (as
in the next vrtti). Sutra 9 Shabda-jnanaupati vastu-shunyo
vikalpah Knowledge and notions (jnana) dependent upon (anupati)
on language, words, or such symbols (shabda) often propel the
mind into machinations (vrtti) of imaginative daydreams and
fancies -- the contrived products of the conceptualization
process (vikalpa). They are empty (shunyo) of real meaning (vastu)
by themselves and thus are mere semantic fancy entirely
manufactured by the mental processes. Commentary: Vikalpa are
the artificially constructed preferential propensities based on
manmade words (which we will see are essentially empty) and thus
carry our attention away from realizing true intimate union
(yoga) unless they are surrendered in authentic meditation.
Vikalpas are mental constructs, ideations, and conceptionally
based thinking processes, and no matter how logical they may be,
they remain artificial. What is "bad", about artificial one may
ask? Patanjali does not say that it is "bad", only that it being
a vrtti, it will hold the yogi back from realizing the
underlying unconstructed and unconditioned truth which uncovers
the profound Reality of the Great Integrity -- of All Our
Relations.
In general the ordinary minds get stuck in the severe limited
filter of conceptional realities (vikalpa) just as as they do in
other vrttis such as fixed beliefs (pramana) or erroneous
beliefs based on faulty logic, perception, or misreadings (viparyayo).
Vikalpa (misconception) differs from the confusion of Viparyayah
in such that it is dependent upon the more complex processes of
a series of words (shabda) which are placed in various sequences
and patterns that further fragment and corrupt the mind acting
as citta-vrtti. Here these patterning of words (shabda) form
conceptional processes accompanied by neuro-psycho-physiological
patterning that distract and bias the body/mind energetics when
mental objects are engaged, thus severe limitations/modifications
results (by what a meditator would call the monkey mind. The "normal"
discursive activity of the ordinary mind) occludes the pure mind
and stainless mind. This skewed assignment of meaning through
coloring/filtering the perceptional processes is another vrtti
which meditation practice destroys (in nirvikalpa samadhi).
Conceptualization imposes an insulated wall between the observer
and that which is observed and prevents direct Gnosis in samyama
or samadhi -- in direct knowing reality as-it-is; hence vikalpa
upholds/creates a modification (vrtti) of the citta. Words (shabda)
themselves are the basic coarse building blocks of vikalpa,
while all words, are mere symbolic representations, not the
actual reality. Thus they are devoid (sunya) of any true
substantiality (vastu). Meditation is designed to destroy
vikalpa by first recognizing the conceptualization and
fabrication habits of the conditioned mind. Vikalpa also thus
includes elements of daydreaming, fancy, speculation, and all
artificial induced thought constructs based upon conditioning
and words where there is an object, which because they serve as
substitutes for "reality" as-it-is. As such we call them also,
hallucinations. We participate in this farce by assigning words
to objects (objective reality) which appear useful in everyday
conventional reality to the extent that these objects do not
block out the overall vista (vision) causing avidya. Negative
conditioning based on chronic left brain over dominance
institutionalizes a chronic state of cognitive dissociation
where one's daily reality becomes habituated into a symbolic
representations (vikalpa) which bounds the ordinary man to his
self perpetuating neuroses. Here again we are reminded that the
map is not the territory.
The ordinary person who has not cultivated self awareness,-- who
has not practiced meditation which provides access to the self
luminous wisdom of residing in the intrinsic gnosis of
things-as-they-are does not know yet how self limiting and
dysfunctional their ordinary mental thinking process has become.
When such starts to meditate, one sees things as they are, hears
what is heard, smells what is smelled, tastes what its tasted
and does not impose conditioned meanings upon experience.
Although this new awareness of the chattering monkey mind may be
alarming to the ego's delusion of "self" at first, it is
eventually seen as the liberation of grace once one realizes
that it has been pre-existing, but previously unnoticed. It is
through the sadhana of meditation that we start to observe that
our attention (what we call the ordinary mind) wanders from
object to object. What we call ordinary "thinking" about "something"
is thus also vikalpa. After a bit of self awareness and expanded
consciousness, we gradually begin to notice that the mind tends
to attach itself to objects as we ordinarily "think 'about' an
object".
Ordinarily these objects of attention change from one object to
another driven by the winds of karma, vasana, and the kleshas. "This"
or "that" object is described (usually in words) and thus we
observe it as mind chatter (shabda). In meditation we do not "judge"
this wandering as "bad" nor do we try to suppress or control it,
but simply notice the monkey mind's propensities. We do not
repress nor react to it, thus we do not indulge it. We neither
ignore nor attempt to transcend it, thus we do not fuel our
aversion, fear, or preferential mind. By giving it no fuel
whatsoever, and we thus do not allow it to deplete our cit-prana
(attention and energy). Eventually it ceases to command our
attention at all and ceases by itself (as being self liberatory).
This happens through a joint effort of vairagya (non-attachment)
and abhyasa consistent practice). See sutra I.12 below. That is,
as we notice as the monkey mind wanders, we become aware of the
process of noticing, the presence of a more expansive underlying
awareness that is aware of the wandering attention of the small
mind, and which is aware of itself. Thus through repeated
practice (abhyasa) we stop getting caught in and carried away by
the vikalpa. In other words we observe that the mind is
wandering, but there is some larger "Mind" (citta) that is
watching the individual mind's machinations (manas). In
meditation we get to know and cultivate this more expansive and
all encompassing Mind which does not wander which is timeless,
universal, and eternal -- we discover its headwaters so to speak.
When this stage becomes stabilized or rather when we abide
within this awesome all encompassing stillness, then if the mind
starts to "think", roam, or chatter, we automatically,
spontaneously, and naturally notice this as it arises and even
before the first word in the process is uttered, it disappears
and is engulfed into this roaring silence until the wandering
ceases altogether (in nirvikalpa samadhi). Yet Patanjali tells
us that nirvikalpa is not the end, rather we have to go through
nirvicara samadhi and finally nirbija samadhi (see Sutras
I.47-51 below).
After consistent practice (abhyasa), the yogi realizes that the
ordinary thinking of the monkey mind always depends upon an
object. Even when that object doesn't change, for example in
concentration (called dharana), there is still an object of
attention, a separation between the "I" and the "object". Later
on in the Yoga Sutras Patanjali suggests allied practices which
help to remove the restless characteristics of the individual
mind, how to still the thought process, eliminate the vrtti, and
empty the mind from what often appears as a cacophony of chatter.
But concentration on objects (dharana) no matter how "holy"
eventually needs to be let go of in authentic meditation (dhyana).
After practice we eventually come to see that obsessing/fixating
around any separate object of attention -- what we are thinking
about, is not only bondage, but an illusion, i.e., that it only
appears separate because we have defined it to be so in our
limited belief systems. In the "Reality" of All Our Relations,
this seemingly separate object that is grasping our attention)
or rather which our attention has temporarily become fixated
upon and/or is attracted toward) is empty (sunya), it does not
exist as a separate object of the mind (pratyaksha). Thus we
enter the more subtle formless realm void of coarse form -- void
of form and duality (nirguna) -- an ever present
undifferentiated and non-dual consciousness is embraced. We
increasingly become aware of this underlying sacred presence in
All Our Relations. Although Patanjali has only briefly touched
upon the conditioned tendency of the ordinary mind to grasp upon
objects (called pratyaksha), he elucidates this subtle process
on how to identify and remediate this and other similar
hindrances (all of which which become revealed during meditation)
in the rest of the Yoga Sutras. In fact when read correctly, one
understands that Patanjali's purpose is to explain the process
of success in Raj Yoga. The yogi does not have to understand any
of these terms in order to gain success in yoga. Sadhana such as
meditation alone is capable of bringing success, but it is
Patanjali's aim to aid us in this sadhana. Thus to sum up,
vikalpa can be said to be the "ordinary" mind's thinking process
which artificially isolates our attention from Reality as-it-is
in All Our Relations. Vikalpa as the normal state is thus often
symbolized as a daydream, a mirage, or hallucination, while
"reality as-it-is is revealed when we awake from the our dream.
Thus as a vrtti, vikalpa is distinguished from the true nature
of the Awakened Mind -- which is non-dual, universal, all
inclusive, and eternal. Thus vikalpa too must be eliminated (nirodha)
like all the other vrttis. When the distraction of vikalpa is
annulled/eliminated (nirodha), then thought constructs also
cease, then the mind rests in its own intrinsic self nature (swarupa).
Then the real nature of Mind thus can be directly realized. See
in also Sutra I.42. Sutra 10 Abhava-pratyaya-alambana vrttir
nidra The vrtti of drowsiness, stupor, torpor, inattentiveness,
and sleep (nidra) is experienced (pratyaya) when the supporting
base (alambana) of the content of the mind (pratyaya) is not
present (abhava) -- [the overall continuity or integrity in All
Our Relations of the intelligent principle of consciousness] is
occluded that links the contents of the mind in an overall
intelligent integrity (through bhava).
Commentary: Because of the word structure, this sutra is often
interpreted that Patanjali is only referring to the experience
of deep dreamless sleep. Certainly in deep dreamless sleep the
mind is empty and devoid of consciousness and conscious intent (bhava)
and the contents of thought (pratyaya) stops. Although a deep
rest may occur and any object that occludes or disturbs
consciousness (cit-vrtti) is eliminated, there none-the-less
exists a deep modification/occlusion (vrtti) of consciousness
because here consciousness is entirely blocked even in deep
dreamless sleep (sushupti).
It is valuable here in order to clear up unfortunate common
traditional misconceptions to point out that the word, nidra,
refers to any state of sleep; while specifically, the word,
sushupti, is the Sanskrit word for deep dreamless sleep. Nidra,
as any aspect of sleep, is another particular vrtti that
occludes recognition of any object or non-object -- of any
individual consciousness itself also ceases. This is indeed a
severe cit-vrtti where consciousness appears to be entirely
absent in the individual. Here some temporary deep respite,
regeneration, and rest from the conceptional (monkey) mind can
occur, but actually without conscious integration what remains
is the possibility of a severe dissociation and blockage between
the source of consciousness and the individual's ordinary daily
consciousness. Consciousness and its modifications are often
broken down into fours states. The first is called jagrit which
is a severely modified, limited, identification -- what we call
ordinary daily dualistic waking consciousness which supports (alambana)
the illusion of incompleteness, the ignorance of separation,
desire, aversion, greed, and of lust may be very stressful and
greatly unselfconsciousness. Although we call it waking
consciousness, it is mostly ignorant and thus characterized as
as a dream, illusory, partially asleep, or unenlightened. Such
differs from dreaming only relatively to the degree of conscious,
intellectual control, individual will, and one's degree of
interaction with coarse sense objects. The second unawakened
state is what we call normal sleep with dreams (usually
occurring at night, napping, or day dreaming).
In Sanskrit it is called swapna. This state is where the deeper
unconscious forces dominates relatively more as compared to that
of jagrit (the above state where daytime worldly dualistic and
coarser sense object activities supported by the intellect and
will) conscious intent predominate. Both of these first two
states of partial sleep (jagrit and swapna) can be very restless
until they are integrated as one non-dual consciousness through
yoga. Dream yoga integrates these by at first realizing the
relative interactive nature between jagrit and swapna and then
seeing that unitive connection of actions and results within
both jagrit and swapna reflect an overall continuity (yoga) of
consciousness and karma revealing the innate timeless unformed
great universal unconditioned (turiya). Details of dream yoga
will only be roughly outlined here.
The third state of ordinary limited states of mind called
sushupti, or deep dreamless state. Another common name for this
is swapna nidra, which simply means dreamless sleep. The
individual's mental processes (manas) are entirely at rest. That
fact alone is beneficial, because the monkey mind (such as
vikalpa) are absent. Here by the absence of the other vrttis,
mental objectifications, and false identifications one can
approach experiencing pure beingness to a great extent. Here
rest and regeneration can be achieved. The yoga scriptures (Shastas)
proclaim that deep dreamless sleep (sushupti) is very close to
samadhi, because the discursive mind is absent (indeed it is
nirvikalpa), but for samadhi to occur recognition or
consciousness must also be present -- for absolute pure
beingness to occur there must be mergence with absolute pure
consciousness (as we shall see later on in the Yoga Sutras.
However in deep dreamless sleep we are not conscious (abhava) of
anything. Here also there are no objects of the mind, so pramana
and Viparyayah is absent as well. Only in deep dreamless sleep,
is consciousness entirely absent and there is no linkage to the
other three states. Obviously any spiritual intent (bhava) is
also latent. Thus this state of deep dreamless sleep is very
restful and beneficial because the discursive monkey mind is no
longer chattering, but this is not the fulfillment of yoga
because it lacks consciousness, rather it is simply deep rest.
So to avoid the common outsider's misinterpretation (which
includes many Buddhists as well) that samadhi or sunya is merely
a swoon, a self hypnotic state, or a self induced catatonia,
Patanjali makes it clear that yoga is definitely about
consciousness, not sleep, and hence nidra is classified as a
vrtti. This confusion is exacerbated by some classical
interpreters who equate sushupti with prajna (wisdom) or sunya (emptiness)
because their "reality" assumes a fundamental split (the
dualistic separation of Atman and Brahman). Rather yoga. prajna,
or true sunya is about waking up which Patanjali clarifies
unmistakably in Chapter 4. Yes, indeed if we include all three
sleep states of partial wakefulness (jagrat), partial sleep (swapna),
and deep dreamless sleep as having Turiya as its underlying (but
unrealized basis) then there is from the beginning no separation
(only consciousness has become isolated and discontinuous).
Indeed this is the goal of yoga -- to unite the illusory
fragmentation (vrtti) and split offs of consciousness and make
it complete, whole and continuous (yoga). Thus in yoga one does
not go off into a separate dualistic trance merging with the
absolute while ignoring manifest creation (the natural world of
evolution) but rather samadhi is an all encompassing
transconceptional non-dual experience. Similarly this example
should make it clear that nirvikalpa samadhi is not the goal of
yoga either. This is because in dreamless sleep there exists no
vikalpa, but yet there is still no samadhi (enlightenment). The
goal of yoga thus as being merely the nirvikalpa state has to
also be given up. Such a dualistic assumption is unfortunately a
very common error first promulgated by Vyasa and followed to
this day. Rather the authentic goal of yoga according to
Patanjali is not dreamless sleep (sushupti), but rather the
innate turiya state which Patanjali defines as nirbija samadhi
which can only be accomplished through the merger of pure
consciousness and pure existence where all suffering is
dissolved -- in Sat-Chit-Ananda.
Waking up is also synonymous with samadhi. Thus as shown the
third stage of deep sleep; i.e., the deep dreamless sleep of
classical sushupti, is considered very close to samadhi as that
there exists no objects of thought that are grasped onto, no
restlessness of the mind, no attachment, no fear, no stress, no
aversion, no kleshas
(except the samskara of ignorance), and no sense of separateness
except for one -- separateness from consciousness. Here all one
has to do is wake up! Wake up not into the dualistic world of
sense objects but into that non-dual transpersonal emptiness
which completes all time, everything, and everyone. Hence jagrit,
swapna, and sushupti all are linked by an element of sleep --
even deep sleep would not be necessary for rest, respite, and
regeneration if jagrit and swapna were not by their nature
stressful and tiring. This waking up process heralds in turiya,
the fourth or "other" state beyond sleep. It is synonymous with
samadhi and encompasses and truly makes the previous three
states obsolete. Turiya is not limited by time nor place, nor
dimension. In turiya there is no separation, no stress, no
conflict, no degeneration, no corruption and hence no need for
regeneration or integration. Turiya is the trans-dimensional
aligned and integral state represented by the great living
yantra. Jagrit thus is the ordinary dualistic fragmented
consciousness governed by sense objects, intellect, and
individual intentions and kleshas. Although called conscious,
contains much subconscious forces. The second state of ordinary
dreaming sleep (swapna) is usually translated as subconscious,
but it has many semi-conscious elements and is influenced by our
daily life (jagrit). Study proves that the conscious and
semi-conscious states as defined in Western terms can not be
entirely separated. Likewise sushupti is specifically
differentiated as being "unconscious"; yet it too is influenced
by and influences both our daily life (jagrit) and dream states
(swapna). Given the above all three states of jagrit, swapna,
and sushupti can also be considered unawakened states (simply
variations of nidra). Here we can "see" deep dreamless sleep (sushupti)
as a relative calm in the overall hurricane of cit-vrtti (fluctuations
and disturbances of the ordinary mental patternings). Only in
turiya, which is the natural unconditioned state of freedom and
which is the same as nirvicara samadhi, do we truly wake up.
Likewise in yoga nidra (yogic sleep), consciousness and
continuity exists between the states of deep restfulness,
awareness of the surroundings, and dream like images that well
up from the unconscious and the collective unconscious. Yoga
nidra occurs in modified states of turiya and includes the
elements of what is called lucid dreaming.
So we take the term, nidra, to pertain not only to deep
dreamless sleep, but rather elements of nidra operate in any
ordinary situation where the average man has their bhava
(spiritual focus) distracted, subdued, limited, and distorted.
In fact most of mankind are deep asleep to Self, thus yoga
becomes the process of awakening us to our true self (in swarupa)
-- to our higher creative potential -- awakening the kundalini,
latent Buddha nature, or innate potential Christ within, through
the elimination/cessation (nirodha) of the vrtti. Thus in the
integrity which is yoga, nidra can mean any awakened state
including drowsiness, dullness of mind, or in a gross form a
sluggish and stupor like ignorance. Bhava means spiritual intent,
mood, or focus -- the divine passion and presence that twinkles
in the eyes of a "turned-on" practitioner. Abhava then is the
opposite, where divine passion or sacred mood is absent. As one
progresses in yoga, the vrtti dissipate -- the citta is less
turbulent, the spiritual passion increasingly becomes focused,
and thus a greater inward clarity, calm, peace, and strength
abides. Here, nidra becomes less dominant, and indeed in many
realized souls ordinary sleep also ceases. In deep dreamless
sleep with consciousness, yogic sleep is possible (yoga nidra).
The sadhak (practitioner) increasingly becomes more awakened and
attuned to divine presence -- beyond even the most subtle
continuously without a break between night and day, but rather
the integrity of the night and day is affirmed. Divine bhava
awakens us to Self. This is called waking up from the sleep of
ignorance (avidya) or mukti. Abiding increasingly "HERE" in All
Our Relations -- devoid of inner psychic disturbances, tensions,
conflict, or stress one will need less sleep to regenerate --
there is less to recover from. Another interpretation of sutra
10 is that the vrtti of nidra (sleep) is experienced (pratyaya)
when the individual mind is occupied by phantom-like objects
supported (alambana) by empty symbolic representations devoid of
real form (abhava). Another similar interpretation is that in
lack of spiritual presence and intent (bhava) creates the
conditions of nidra (sleep) where thought devoid of any coherent
context is generated. Simply this can describe the ordinary
unawakened mental processes (manas) of the common "normal"
modern man who is asleep to one's true nature -- to All Our
Relations. Since bhava means spiritual intent, mood, or focus --
the divine passion and presence that twinkles in the eyes of a "turned-on"
practitioner, thus abhava is the opposite, i.e., absence of
sacred presence.Thus the vrtti of sleep (vrttr-nidra) is the
result (alambana) of absence of bhava (abhava-pratyaya). Compare
this with Sutra I.19, the practice of waking up in
transcognitive awareness (asamprajnata) by bhava-pratyayo (where
the spiritual mood is focused and present). Prayer by
Shankaracharya, Translation & Commentary by Vimala Thakar Pratah
smarami hridi samsphura ta twam Sthitau paramahansa gatim
turiyam Yat swapna jagara sushupta mavaiti nityam Tad brahma
nishkalamaham na cha bhuta sanghaha.
"In the morning as I meet the dawn, I remember that my heart
contains the God, the Beloved, who has not yet been defined and
described. I remember that it is He who vibrates within my heart,
enables me to breathe, to talk, to listen, to move. When I am
thus aware, that it is He who lives and moves within me, then
the three phases of consciousness, jagrat, swapna, sushupti :
wakefulness, dreaming, and profound sleep, they are transcended
into turiya, the fourth dimension, which is behind the
wakefulness, the dream-consciousness, and the
sleep-consciousness. When I thus remember, that the underlying
current behind the wakefulness, the dream, and the
sleep-consciousness is He, who lives and moves within me, then
that awareness gives me sat chit sukham, the flavor of the truth,
the reality, and the bliss that is the nature, the basic primary
nature of life. Sat chit sukham. When I am always thus aware of
the real nature of life, then I arrive at paramahansagatim
turiyam. I arrive at a state of being that has been called by
the ancient wise Indians "Paramahansa", a swan that swims
through the waters of duality. That is how a sanyasi is called a
paramahansa, one who lives in the renunciation of that austere
awareness that it is not he who lives, as separate from the
universe, but that he is only an expression of the universal.
The state of paramahansa is the state where a person is aware
that he is not a conglomeration of sense organs and only the
five elements, but he is the nishkala Brahman, the supreme
Brahman, the divinity, who has taken the dense form of a mind
and a physical body." Sutra 11 Anubhuta-vishayasampramoshah
smrti The vrtti of smrti (memory) is the process where objects (vishaya)
of past experiences (anu-bhuta) still occupy (a-sampramoshah)
the present. This identification from the past obscures and
interferes with the mind-field creating disturbances (vrtti) of
the mind-field (citta). Commentary: Smrti includes all colorings
of past experiences, our past conditioning and programming, the
knee jerk reflexes from past traumas, acquired habits (vasana),
and the like. Normally we "think" that memory is "good" and
useful and in ordinary everyday experiences it can be as long as
it does not seriously distort the sacred profundity of the
eternal now -- of "Reality-As-It-Is" without the distorted
imposition of past impressions. However in the practice of
meditation, which is what raj yoga is all about, ordinary memory
is a vrtti which holds back, restrains, and obscures the pure
self effulgence of infinite consciousness. When we meditate, we
want to let go of such obstructions and habits of past
modalities of the thinking processes (vrtti). That is the
subject of the next sutra (Sutra 12).
The ordinary problem is that the ordinary dualistically oriented
person carries this black cloud of past traumas, dramas,
memories, and past dualistic false identifications
and fixations along with them wherever they go. Thus a new
experience may occur such as hearing a sound, seeing a color,
tasting, smelling, touching, sensing, but then that experience
then is patterned and re-ordered according to one's memory of
past experiences rather than allowing the experience to be
experienced fully as it is without prejudice. Past events,
traumas, samskaras, verbal, preverbal, post natal, prenatal,
peri-natal, karma, and their associations make up the past
imprints which fuel the myriad dramas and compulsive habits (vasanas)
that occupy our attention and thus occlude the mind-field (vrttis
created from smrti). Past experiences and habits condition and
often color the way we view "Self" in a biased, prejudicial, and
limiting way which obscures Universal Presence. It is worthwhile
to note that also on a physiological level, past memories are
stored not only in an energetic and psychic field (now
identified by modern neuro-physiological psychology) in which
they shape individual mental, emotional, and behavior processes,
but also they are stored as cellular memory, neuromuscular
armoring, and the neuro-endocrine system often far removed from
the central nervous system and brain. Body psychotherapy and
psycho-neuroimmunology recognizes such memory imprints and
attempts to both read and access them through trans-verbal
(right brain) methods such as through touch, tonality, gesture,
and movement. Later Patanjali will address how specific types of
actions produce certain effects such as psychic impressions (samskaras)
and afflictions (kleshas) that impinge upon and color the
present. Indeed yogic sadhana (practice) is designed to
subsequently remediate/integrate our past experiences so that
they no longer obscure profound presence in swarupa by creating
vrtti. Smrti is also the same word used for the vast body of
stories and dramas found in the indigenous ancient Puranic
literature -- the legacy of the past so to speak. When these
stories become wisdom stories clarifying the mind field rather
than dissuading consciousness away from the eternal present,
only then do they cease to be a distraction, diversion, or vrtti.
Ordinary dualistic memory processes are thus to be distinguished
from Divine (non-dual remembering. Mostly people simply memorize
the smrti, so that they act as surrogate/symbols for divine
rememberance but stop short of removing dualistic veils. In fact
they can reinforce the separateness (or duality) -- the rend
from our own divine spiritual nature. Likewise it is through
divine re-memberance (as non-dual as opposed to ordinary
dualistic memory processes) that remembrance of who we truly are
(swarupa) in the great integrity of All Our Relations
accompanies the cessation (nirodha) of the cit-vrtti.
Past actions thus leave a karmic residue which can be said to
reside in a personal storehouse consciousness (called alaya
vijnana). These residues have an impact upon our present
relationship and consciousness until cleared.
When this is cleared then one no longer is victimized by the
karma of the past actions, but is free *mukti) or liberated.
Here the citta-vrtti cease for the individual. Collectively all
past actions of all beings are stored in a collective karmic
storehouse (the collective alaya vijnana).
When the collective storehouse consciousness (alaya vijnana) has
become remediated, then the present world of suffering ends --
all beings are liberated and unconditionally happy.
Here all the citta-vrtti cease. All past karma (actions) are
evidenced in the storehouse of our own or our collective
storehouse of consciousness. The realization of alaya vijnana
thus remediates the limitations, colorings, and patternings (vrtti)
of ordinary smrti upon the citta itself. Indeed it is through
yogic practices (sadhana) that we "see" that the common man who
is immersed in everyday dualistic fragmented consciousness is
most often living inside of an old drama/story, while yoga
brings us to greater awareness of our role and scripts freeing
us from its grasp, acknowledging sacred presence. Likewise smrti
(modifications of the thinking process due to the impositions of
past memories, past legacies, residues, impressions, experiences,
nostalgia, grief, trauma, etc) implies a limited, colored,
biased, or false identification and hence attachment to specific
objects or events that occurred in the past. As such, the vrtti
of smrti acts as the residual framework for bondage to klesha,
karma, vasana, and samskara. Those tendencies prevent us from
being present. Yoga is designed to break up old habits (vasana),
remove old samskaras (psychic imprints and trauma), remove
afflictive emotions (kleshas), and remediate old karmic patterns.
In memory we often call up past experiences to identify an
object or situation. This is not being in the present, but
rather coloring our present unique experience with the past.
Each moment "in reality" has the potential to contain all of
Reality (past and future) -- The present as it is -- not colored
by past habits is precious as well as timeless -- it is a self
luminous manifestation (sat) of pure consciousness (cit) which
rests in the feeling of ananda (ecstasy). Too often when we see,
smell, hear, taste, or feel an object, it is the memory which
ascribes meaning to "it" in a past context which discolors,
occludes, and modifies our experience. Through yoga we learn to
see things as they are in the magical and sacred moment of
eternity This timeless way of seeing is ultimately fulfilling,
but can not be rushed. It is not dependent upon our past
experience, yet through consistent yogic practice (abhyasa) it
can be realized.
"When one has removed all trace of delusion together with the
habitual tendencies producing it, this is called ‗fruition‘
Buddha nature. States of confusion do not belong to the essence
of mind. When they have been removed, clear light luminosity,
which is essential to mind, directly manifests. When this takes
place, fruition sugatagarbha is achieved. One has achieved the
enlightenment of the Buddhas. At the point when the Buddha
nature is obscured by the adventitious stains of delusion one
might think, 'If the basic nature of my own mind is obscured by
the incidental stains coming from my own delusion, how am I
supposed to know how to rectify the situation?' The point is,
such knowledge is accessible, because the Buddha nature contains
within it the seeds of knowledge (prajna) and compassion.
Because the seed of knowledge is naturally present, listening to,
reflecting over and meditating on the dharma is able to catalyse
a growth and development of this knowledge. This growth in
knowledge in turn corrects the deluded state." from "Beautiful
Song of Marpa the Translator" by Khenpo Tsultrim Gyamtso
Rinpoche & Zhyisil Chokyi Ghatsal Publications 2002. The
practice of yoga that Patanjali teaches brings out our natural
uncontrived state which is ever-present inherent and within, but
remains obscured through the wavelike operation of the kleshas
and vrtti. We will see in Sutra 12 how vairagya is the perfect
remediation for all the vrtti. See also Sutra 43. Sutra 12
Abhyasa-vairagyabhyam tan-nirodhah These vrttis (operations and
machinations of the mental processes) are dissolved, eradicated,
eliminated and cease (nirodha) by sustained and continuous
application in All Our Relations of the practice (abhyasa) of
vairagya (letting go, non-attachment, non-craving, non-grasping
and non-expectation). Commentary: Another similar translation
would be that the cessation/dissolution of the vrttis (machinations)
can be accomplished through engaging the process of consistent
integrated practice (abhyasa) without attachment to results (vairagya)
. Thirdly, the most common translation, has Patanjali saying in
effect that the cessation of the vrttis (nirodha) can be
obtained through two non-contradictory methods, i.e., of
non-attachment (vairagya) and also through consistent practice (abhyasa).
These different statements share a common direction and differ
only subtly, but not in intent (i.e., the cessation of the vrtti
occur through consistent applied yogic practice with vairagya (without
attachment to results) or perhaps the vrttis cease through
sustained application of releasing the tendencies toward mental
processes as a whole.
Please note that abhyasa, consists of abhy (repeatedly and
intensely facing the goal) and asa (to sit or abide). Thus
abhyasa connotes intensely abiding in the practice. Vairagyam
being non-attachment to results, expectation, preference, or any
desire then connotes that abhyasa-vairagyabhyam are not two
separate practices to eliminate the vrtti, but are to be taken
both as one together as one practice, never separated. The
spirit of vairagya is to be accompany and applied in every yoga
practice. This is a most profound process oriented (versus goal
oriented) synthesis. As practitioners know from experience, it
is too easy to get goal oriented and lose the sense of sacred
presence. Too often a practitioner will become drawn into,
obsessed, and fixated/attached to the goal of the practice that
the result is not precluded such as in incessant striving. Here
is the yoga statement that success comes from both grace (isvara
pranidhana) and sadhana (practice). It is not an either/or
proposition (is it grace or sadhana). The two meet as one --
divine will and individual will are married/synchronized here.
This is how nirodha (cessation) of the vrtti is established. Now
the ordinary man who has become addicted to cognitive processes
of objectification and who has lost their sense of subjective
experiential wholeness (beingness) may not be able to imagine
surrendering his mental operations/processes (vrtti) or having
them cease. Indeed in everyday life that discursive mind (often
labeled as the monkey mind) with its inertia of incessant mental
processing is usually chattering save for brief times of taking
pause, awe, grace, or serendipity. However in meditation the
monkey mind can calm down and cease as the mind lets go of its
grasping onto mental objects. This letting go process of
grasping onto mental objects as well as concepts in meditation
practice is vairagya. To sustain that in sitting meditation (dhyana)
is abhyasa. One continually applies abhyasa-vairagyabhyam
Applying abhyasa-vairagyabhyam continually, intensely, and
repeatedly creates much open space eventually leading to the
dissolution of the vrtti back to its source, allowing a mergence
into the of self effulgence luminous big space empty space --
sunyata or the boundless mind to coalesce. This is where taking
a retreat, going to the mountain, roaming in the desert, vision
quest, meditation (dhyana), as conscious practices manifest.
Most modern people can‘t afford elaborate retreats but but
everyone can meditate (as a complete let go) for ½ hour or so a
day and practice other yoga techniques as well in this same
spirit. Then we can start trying to modify our life style (aparigraha)
so that abhyasa-vairagyabhyam allows for complete and continuous
illumination eventually ending in samadhi. The idea of the
co-existence of "non-attachment" (vairagya) in relation to
practice ("abhyasa") is understandingly difficult to the Western
novice, because too often non-attachment and consistent practice
may appear oppositional; i.e., the word, practice, too often
connotes willful effort, hard work, and control. However what
about a freely flowing enthusiastic type of practice which is
loving, passionate, playful, joyful, and not based on putting
one's nose to the grindstone? In other words a successful
practice does not have to be forced. fixated, driven, willful,
and neurotic.
By abhyasa-vairagyabhyam, we understand that vairagya
(non-attachment to results) is the essential key practice (abhyasa)
in and by itself which can be applied consistently in All Our
Relations, then the contradiction between abhyasa and vairagya
ceases. Indeed we shall see how sustained intense practice (abhyasa)
applied without attachment to results (vairagyam) is a profound
principle when applied to All Our Relations is the key to yogic
union. Such activities expand (tan) the process of citta-vrtti
nirodha. The non-yogi may logically ask how then can a loving,
passionate, enthusiastic, and dedicated practice exist without
attachment. This is precisely where Patanjali is heading -- the
uninterrupted flow of Divine consciousness. It requires two
things for attachment to take place. In terms of yoga there
seems to exist the seeker or practitioner (sadhak) on one hand,
and there seems to exist the object or goal of yoga on the other,
but in the Integrity/Reality of All Our Relations there exists
no separation, rather in yoga the true self abides in swarupa
(in one's true form) which is not governed by the vrtti. This
profound theme is what Patanjali will be addressing throughout
the remaining of the Yoga Sutras. Here there exists a natural
propensity, love, dedication, devotion, and zeal without
attachment because it exists only in the sacred world of the
Natural Mind -- without expectation. There in Indigenous Time --
in the Eternal Present, there is no goal orientation, no
separate object relationships, and no sense of alienation from
Self. Indeed the natural inspiration for practice is due to this
communion with this timeless Reality, while effective practice
moves us deeper. In other words sustained practice must be
framed within the non-dual context of the eternal here-now in
order for it to become effective/expedient (upaya). This eternal
now is where we are going in yoga, but at the same time it is
now and always has been from beginningless time. To mistakenly
think that it is somewhere else, is reinforcing an illusion.
Thus again we are encouraged to entertain instant presence in
All Our Relations. Starting here with Sutra I.12, Patanjali
enters into exposition of the specific remedial activities (sadhana)
of yoga which lead to samadhi and foremost of them is the very
causative application of tan-vairagya (extending the
non-grasping) - the process of letting go -- of non-attachment,
which facilitates the mind being present -- having arrived home.
If there exists one basic application in meditation which is
infallible, it is this -- Being present -- at one with Sacred
Presence.
Here vairagya can be translated not only as non-attachment to
results and release, but perhaps more valuable as letting go of
all expectation (non-expectation) -- to expect the unexpected.
This is the necessary open minded attitude where functional
success in yoga is realized. The cessation (nirodha) of the
fluctuations, modifications, and distortions (vrtti) of the
citta (mind) are catalyzed through the practice of vairagya --
the non-expectation of the beginner's mind. How else could rapid
dissolution of the vrtti occur? HERE in this context is where we
can achieve liberation. The practice itself (abhyasa) teaches us
vairagya (non-attachment as release). It teaches us that it is
futile to clutch, grasp, or hang on to the vrttis (although this
can be a life time lesson for many). The major vrtti are pramana
(politically correct and logical beliefs), viparyayah (erroneous
or false notions), and vikalpa (conceptional artificial thought
constructs in general) which glue together the largest false
identification/belief i.e., that of a separate self (ego). It is
this liberation from the limitations of ego delusion which must
be realized. It is done so through the consistent application of
the practice of vairagya in All Our Relations The practice
itself is an opportunity to let go of grasping and to get into
that beginners mind (expecting the unexpected). This kind of
non-willful practice itself thus facilitates the vairagyam. Such
is not performed by using the judgmental process (should I
practice or should I not practice), the intellect, or will (which
belong to avidya), but rather this kind of practice facilitates
vidya by itself. "Clear mind is like the full moon in the sky.
Sometimes clouds come and cover it, but the moon is always
behind them. Clouds go away, then the moon shines brightly. So
don't worry about clear mind: it is always there. When thinking
comes, behind it is clear mind. When thinking goes, there is
only clear mind. Thinking comes and goes, comes and goes, You
must not be attached to the coming or the going." —Zen Master
Seung Sahn The importance of vairagya as an integral part to all
yoga sadhana cannot be over emphasized. It along with isvara
pranidhana (surrender to our higher potential) occupy more space
in the yoga sutras than any other practices. Vairagya indeed
leas us to kaivalyam (absolute liberation). See III. 50
tad-vairagyad api dosa-bija-kshaye kaivalyam
Summary of the above Sutras 1-12 so far.
Patanjali first has stated the goal of yoga, the nature of the
modifications of consciousness to be eliminated (citta-vrtti
nirodha), then he described their oscillating operations. Sutras
4-11 thus name, describe, and categorize the causes of the
vrttis (disturbances, agitations, or fractuals of the mind field)
while sutras 12- 16 introduce the two proficient remedies that
dissolve, remove, and/or eliminate vrtti i.e., vairagya (the
continuous practice of letting go, non-attachment, or
non-expectation) and abhyasa (consistent or continuous yoga
practice). According to this pada, when vrtti is dissolved or
annihilated, yoga or union with infinite mind is realized which
is called samadhi. Sutras 4-11 have been given far too much
academic attention than they merit (mostly by scholars rather
than yogis). Those dependent upon mental constructs (vrtti) tend
to make this appear far more complex than it really is, because
they themselves are not able to step outside of thought
constructs i.e., they are unwilling to take Patanjali's remedy
which meditation affords. Here Patanjali is simply saying that
the vrttis can be classified into five categories. These five
categories of vrttis again can be analyzed whether or not they
are associated with kleshas (defilements) or not). Here
Patanjali addresses the disconnection i.e., what is not yoga--
what obstructs our spiritual unification. Intellectual scrutiny
especially through reductionist means of inquiry will be found
to be counter-productive, rather it will be found later that
Patanjali prescribes trans-rational methods. To demystify verses
I. 5-11, Patanjali is addressing the vrttis and how to eliminate
them. He does not limit the vrttis to five, but simply says that
they can be so arranged or classified --placing them into five
possible categories. Most vrttis exist as a combination of two
or more of these basic categories. This is a cogent point,
because the vrttis (as conditioned thought patterns/machinations)
can take on myriad forms. We all know what a vrtti is (the
ordinary person experiences vrttis almost all the time except in
rare moments of clarity, vision, inspiration, beauty, satori,
revelation, meditation, or samadhi). The problem being is that
when cit-vrtti is dominant, we are not normally conscious of its
coloring effects; i.e., we are unable to step outside of it and
notice or be aware of its influence. Thus one who meditates
starts to notice the arising and falling of the vrttis.
Eventually through awareness they no longer are capable of
misleading us. Thus vrtti is not meant to be some abstract
intellectual, but any thought pattern that occupies or possesses
our mind field of attention -- any limiting modality of
patterning that colors, obscures, perverts, corrupts, limits,
restrains, or prejudices our experience of our inherent true
nature (swarupa), original mind or infinite mind.
Likewise kleshas are also not to be viewed as some abstract or
esoteric mystical concept, but rather referring to everyday
ordinary experiences which unfortunately
arise and surface at many times during the day or night (as well
as in meditation) - anytime our buttons are pushed, our chain is
yanked, fuses are blown, red flags are waved, -- when we feel
disconnected. desirous, or incomplete; when we "react", become
perturbed, uncomfortable, needy, compulsive, defensive, angry,
fearful, paranoid, grievous, anguished, jealous, hateful,
judgmental, disparaging, or are otherwise modify the basic
natural condition of Infinite Mind with the aberrations,
confusions, or disturbances associated with negative
conditioning, past programming, and habits -- when we act out of
ignorance, rather than wisdom. Thus simply stated, it is the
removal (nirodha) of these vrttis and kleshas which the process
of yoga facilitates as we move into greater clarity and self
empowerment -- into our true and authentic Self (swarupa). The
traditional intellectually bent commentaries often enter into
dense nitpicking and often obtuse philosophical detailing on the
specific mechanisms and dynamics of the vrttis (disturbances and
fractuals of the ordinary machinations of the dualistic mind),
but it is precisely this intellectual academic reductionist
circumlocution that Patanjali tells us can be circumvented in
yoga meditation. These are the pitfalls that must be dropped for
they will bear no lasting fruit. Sutras 5-11 are not important
sutras because they simply describe what yoga is not about;
however they have elsewhere been made so overly complicated and
obtuse through self indulgent over intellectualization on behalf
of scholars, intellectuals, and religionists (versus practicing
yogis) that many interested readers have been discouraged to
continue. Since I have already pointed out this tendency to
bastardize the sutras, from now on this translation will pay
less attention on what yoga is not, but rather attempt to spend
more time on what yoga is, namely samadhi or union, which is the
main focus undertaken in I. 17- 51. In this middle section of
Pada One (13-15) Patanjali discloses two key remediations that
lead to nirodha (vairagya and abhyasa). Patanjali is saying in
effect that the cessation of the vrttis (nirodha) can be
obtained through two non-contradictory methods, i.e., of
non-attachment (vairagya) and also through consistent practice (abhyasa).
We will actually see later that the entire remainder of the Yoga
Sutras deals with letting go (releasing) our attachment upon
objects (coarse or even the most subtle). This is achieved in
asana practice as well at the end of dharana where we surrender
the dualism of any object as well as the observer of
concentration into the objectless/goalless state beyond "even
the most subtle" where all separation melts down. HERE through
successful dhyana thought modifications (vrtti) no longer arise
-- there is no longer anything left to let go of. Sutra 13 Tatra
sthitau yatno'bhyasah There (tatra) through a consistent and
sustained dedication, devotion, zeal, or concentrated enthusiasm
(yatnah) in our practice (abhyasa), then a certain steady, still,
stable, and balanced (sthitau) self supporting state is achieved.
Commentary: This way we form the stable base to progress in yoga
practice. A sustaining, dedicated, devotional zeal, and/or
natural concentrated enthusiasm enters into our practice. It is
provides an increasingly accessible still, stable, and balanced
self supporting impetus in which to proceed. Thus, Patanjali
defines yoga practice (abhyasa) as that activity which leads us
toward, supports, and strengthens the presence of a sense of
balanced and steady stillness (sthiti) where the polar
turbulences or conflicts no longer tug nor nag the mind stream.
Here the word, sthitau, is translated as a passive firmness,
stillness, or a restful steadiness, something like what we can
experience in sama-sthiti or tadasana, rather than associate it
with the idea of, fixity, which conjures up a contracted and
active image of rigidity. Yogis do not pursue rigid minds and
bodies. One translation of sthitau is a coming into a stable
situation of rest, stillness, and quietude -- a steady abiding
at REST. Abhyasa should lead to a relaxed, stable, calmness,
steadiness, restful, and self supporting stillness and stability
of the mind-filed (sthiti). After it is firmly established it
self perpetuates its own power and intelligence. Swami Veda
Bharati interestingly translates Vyasa's commentary (bhashya) on
I.13 as: "Stillness or stability (sthiti) means the mind-field (citta)
flowing pacifically when it is without vrttis. The endeavor
tending towards this purpose is virility or exertion. Practice
is the observance of the means thereto, with the will to achieve
its fulfillment." Later SW. Veda Bharati comments on Vyasa's
commentary: "The endeavor is directed towards sthiti and is
explained by Vyasa by offering two synonyms: virya: virility,
vigour, strength, energy, potency, the qualities of a hero
utsaha: enthusiasm, perseverance, fortitude, firmness, exertion,
vigorous pursuit. Obviously an endeavour should be undertaken
with these heroic qualities turned inwards and their intense
concentration directed at the effort to bring the mind to
stillness."
from the Yoga Sutras of Patanjali with the exposition of Vyasa,
Volume I, Pandit Usharbudh Arya (Swami Veda Bharati), Himalayan
Intl, Inst. 1988. Again the mutuality of abhyasa (as the
sustaining practice) and vairagyam (letting go) in I-13-16 is
very profound skillful balance taken together (upaya) because "ordinary"
mental processes which are operating under the dictation of
dualistic mentation (the normal situation of the ordinary
discursive mind) very often create a confusion between "practice"
on one hand, and " letting go" (vairagya) on the other. This
occurs because ordinarily we often confuse/associate practice
with individual willfulness. In yoga balance is key. For example
in India where there may be much abundance of indifference and
surrender then abhyasa is often emphasized as vairagya is taken
for granted. However in the West there is more fixation, goal
orientation, obsession, and attachment so vairagya has to be
emphasized in order to achieve synergistic balance. For the
hatha yogi, HA or pingala nadi represents abhyasa and THA or the
ida nadi represents vairagya. Their balance provokes a mutual
synchronization, synergy, and activation in the central channel
(sushumna nadi) where a stable self supporting (sthitau)
enthusiasm (yatnah) manifests. Those of us lost in duality
mistakenly think that practice on one hand and non-attachment to
results on the other, are conflicting, and thus a needless
tension is created. Really they are meant to work together as
will be illustrated in the following sutras. Consistent practice
eventually reveals what we are holding onto; i.e., what is
holding us back. Thus release (via vairagya) catalyzes our
liberation (mukti) from bondage. Similarly, just the intent of
taking up a practice is an affirmation of making a change in
one's life and that it concomitant with letting go of something.
Here effort and non-effort form the yang and yin -- the two
poles of the great process of yoga sadhana that Patanjali is
describing in Samadhi Pada. Just as profound is the question
whether it is through man's work or divine grace that ultimate
realization dawns. Is it earned or is it is bestowed? This is
easily answered that by vairagya one does not mean a passive
collapse or state of inertia because Patanjali calls it a
practice. It is a particularly advanced practice that lets go of
all attachments, even that of practice, thus creating space for
Grace -- for the higher transpersonal wisdom to dawn (as we will
see in Sutra 49 (Rtambhara prajna). One finds that in order to
even find our practice and to have the grace to "do" practice,
as well as to be successful in practice, such is due to to Grace
alone due in the end to Grace -- a higher and more profound
transpersonal wisdom and identification. But this does not mean
that abhyasa does not act as an invitation to Grace when
practiced wisely (upaya).
Consistent practice over time by itself builds up its own
intelligent momentum and acts as the innate always accessible
transpersonal teacher, especially apparent when we are able to
give up expectation and preference (attachment to results) other
than to simply abide in the sacred space which is always
available and present within. This enables us to focus upon the
innate beauty and power of the practice as an ongoing self
revelatory process which provides access within to the timeless
attributeless eternal universal transpersonal source which
resides in all (isvara). HERE inspiration, zeal, dedication,
devotion, and natural enthusiasm (yatnah) work reciprocally so
that the practice becomes self perpetuating, self sustaining,
effortless, energizing, and self inspiring. All activity becomes
a moving meditation which reveals the ever present true Self and
thus the practice takes on a life by itself, becomes energized
and empowered, self actualizing, self empowering, self
liberating, fertilizing the pregnant fields (abhumih) which
gives forth beginningless birth, and which endows the fount of
inspiration (virya). Eventually this practice become continuous
(the esoteric meaning of the word, yoga, in All Our Relations!
Sutra 14 Sa tu dirgha-kala-nairantarya-satkarasevito
drdha-bhumih Then after a sustained period of time (dirgha kala),
with attentiveness (satkara), and consistent dedication (a-sevitah),
then the practice itself will become self perpetuating and inner
directed (nairantarya). Commentary:Practice will eventually
spontaneously manifest from the inside out as a natural result.
Practice becomes continuously inner directed (nairantarya),
gains its own integrity, maturity and basically becomes well
established through repeated prolonged or consistent application
(dirgha-kala) especially when combined with the concentrated
energetics of dedication, diligence, devotional attentiveness (satkara)
which are assiduously cultivated (asevito). Simultaneously as
our practice matures in stages, the quality of our enthusiasm,
dedication, devotion, and desire to practice synergistically
improves. In other words we find that functional practice leads
to even more enthusiasm to the fertile soil (abhumih) of an even
more functional (a-sevitah) practice i.e., it becomes natural,
flowing, and self perpetuating. In terms of
psycho-neuro-physiology a positive biofeedback loop is formed.
This is a natural continuation of Sutra 13. Although Patanjali
will offer many specific practices (sadhana) later, he expands
upon this theme that through a consistent and sustained
dedication, inspired enthusiasm, and devoted concentration (yatnah)
in our daily practice (abhyasa), then a certain steady and
balanced (sthitau) state is achieved which liberates the
naturally fertile and self perpetuating potential of the
practice over time. Here the practice itself becomes steady,
self established, self liberating, and inner directed (nairantarya)
having established a direct communion and intelligent energetic
dynamic of its own because the inner conduits (nadis) of the (cit-prana)
animated by cit-shakti has now become opened. A good practice
grows on us naturally and is naturally expansive, self
liberating, and self instructive.
This practice creates a realignment and karmic shift paralleling
that of the intelligent energetic dynamic which the functional
practice itself creates over time. We can call this regaining
the natural intelligence of the body-mind or simply a
spiritually self empowered, practice which empowers our inner
wisdom while irrigating the evolutionary centers. To go deeper
in trying to express this profound mutuality of an empowered
practice most often becomes difficult to express in words. At
first (to those who have not yet experienced it), it may sound
like "mumbo jumbo", but advanced practitioners will take this
reading as a confirmation. This activated power of the practice
becomes a springboard itself -- its ability to become
spontaneously self instructing and self liberating has become
fertilized. This is what is meant by virya (as shakti pat) in
its more esoteric sense. Thus the true yogi goes to his/her
practice for instruction and guidance as it brings forth the
inner wisdom and inner teacher, while a religionist or
academician goes to ancient books or external authorities for
guidance.
"The moon and sun unite within your body when the breath resides
in the meeting place of the two nadis ida and pingala. It is the
spring equinox when the breath is in the muladhara, and it is
the autumn equinox when the breath is in the head. And prana,
like the sun, travels through the signs of the zodiac; each time
you inhale, hold in your breath before expelling it. Lastly, an
eclipse of the moon occurs when the breath reaches the abode of
kundalini via the channel ida, and when it follows pingala in
order to reach kundalini, then there is an eclipse of the sun!
The Mount Meru is in the head and Kedara in your brow; between
your eyebrows, near your nose, know dear disciple, that Benares
stands; in your heart is the confluence of the Ganges and the
Yamuna; lastly, Kamalalaya is to be found in the muladhara.
To prefer 'real' tirthas to those concealed in your body, is to
prefer common potsherds to diamonds laid in your hands. Your
sins will be washed away... if you carry out the pilgrimages
within your own body from one tirtha to the another! True yogis
who worship the atman within themselves have no need for water
tirthas or of gods of wood and clay. The tirthas of your body
infinitely surpass those of the world, and the
tirtha-of-the-soul is the greatest of them: the others are
nothing beside it. The mind when sullied, cannot be purified in
the tirthas where man bathes himself, ...Siva resides in your
body; you would be made to worship him in images of stone or
wood, with ceremonies, with devotions, with vows or pilgrimages.
The true yogi looks into himself, for he knows that images are
carved to help the ignorant come nearer to the great mystery."
Yoga Darshana Upanishad,4.40-58 trsl., J. Varenne, Yoga in the
Hindu Tradition, Univ. of Chicago Press, 1976. Then in I.15 (after
addressing abhyasa) Patanjali addresses the practice of vairagya
(what some may call the practice of non-practice). Sutra 15
Drsta-anusravika-visaya-vitrsnasya vasikara-samjna vairagyam
When the mental operations no longer is focused (drsta) upon
external teachings found in tradition (anusravika) nor any
externalized objects based within a relative conditional
framework (visaya), then a mastery (visikara) and freedom from
desire (vrtrsnasya) toward the external world of the sense
objects (visaya) is established. Then our practice comes
together and is touched by the intimate knowledge (samjna)
[which is gained through the activity of efficacious release
called non-willful doing (vairagyam)]. Commentary: HERE we are
moved by the non-dual wisdom which brings joy, being free from
the limitations of ordinary conceptually and extrinsic grasping
-- the outward spinning discursive thought patterns and
mind-sets which oscillate in the narrow corridors of the
conditioned (visaya) neurotic mind (citta-vrtti). The expedient
proficient activity which cultivates inner flow when outflowing
cit-prana is redirected inward (vasikara), is vairagya (release
of self efforting and attachment to results); which is
accomplished when the yogi is no longer possessed by nor
possesses neurotic cravings of external objects (visaya) of
fulfillment (vitrsnasya) in the dualistic mindset of a separate
"I" and "it"; thus the seer rests in undisturbed non-attachment
and release (vairagya). Thus desirelessness (vitrsnasya) is
achieved through perfection (vasikara) of vairagya which
coincides when one comes into an integrated inner understanding
(samjna) that the objects of senses (visaya) such as what we see
(drsta) and hear (anusravika) and all other such conditional
frameworks based on sense objects (visaya) will only distract
the mind and energy (cit-prana) further. When the cit-prana is
no longer drawn outward by apparently separate objects (seen,
heard, heard of, sensed, or imagined), then vairagya is
perfected. Thus the consistent practice (abhyasa) of vairagya
greatly aids us remain centered in our core (heart). It also
brings us into kaivalyam when we let go of the artificial
distinction between purusa and sattva (Sutra III.50) Perhaps a
simpler interpretation is that the word, samjna, merely means
equivalent, so that Patanjali is saying that the practice of
vairagya produces an accomplished state where a freedom from (vitrsnasya)
from limited relativistic and dualistic frameworks (visaya) is
achieved which were previous limited to things seen, heard, or
imagined in the past. Here one wakes up in true attentiveness,
no longer being distracted and dissipated into a disparate
dualistic world where the separateness of self (spiritual self
alienation) is validated. An esoteric interpretation is that
Patanjali is saying that through truly seeing (drsta) and
listening (anusravika) with the third eye (beyond the dualistic
method limited by the senses) then true understanding (samjna)
of the emptiness (sunya) of the sense objects will be realized,
thus leading to the natural mastery and freedom from desire (vitrsnasya),
therein vairagya becomes perfected in swarupa (abiding in our
natural true self). HERE in the profound non-dual transpersonal
sense there is no separate self and separate object of attention.
Traditionalists, fundamentalists, and orthodox Hindus however
take anusravika in the Vedic sense of "listening to tradition,
authority, or the Vedas", but since Patanjali never mentions the
Vedas nor since he considers pramana to be a vrtti, this would
seem to be putting a Vedic spin on his rather plain and obvious
meaning regarding vairaga and abhyasa. Such adherents also of
course take vasikara as being forceful and willful control as
opposed to referring to the occurrence of a mastery which no
longer subject to the polar assaults of separate subject/object.
Traditionalists seem to read-in a lot of their own ideological
agenda in their interpretations. However if we take Patanjali
literally as meaning exactly what he says; i.e., as the
authority rather than his Vedic interpreters then the value of
the sutra takes on a profound Yogic message rather than a Vedic
message. If Patanjali meant something very different, then he
would have said it. When we look at the Yoga Sutras in that way
they make a lot of sense in regard to what our own practice
teaches, but when we take the institutionalized orthodox
interpretations, such makes little sense other than as an
intellectual exercise or philosophical discourse on the Vedas or
samkhya philosophy. In any case, in this sutra Patanjali states
that by releasing our hold on things that hold us back -- things
of the past as well as fixations (expectations) upon the future
and especially the way the mind grasps onto "objects" we can
achieve a thirstless/desireless state which in its positive side
provides fulfillment and completion. This desireless state (vitrsnasya)
awaits us in the non-dual present of All Our Relations. Along
the same lines it seems that the idea of subjugation, control,
nor even anything to do with the Vedas (as in the common
interpretation of may be reading in something that was not
intended (certainly it was not said by Patanjali). For example
vasikara/vashikara can be mastery or perfection, not necessarily
stemming from active methods of willful control or subjugation (especially
so when we are applying this to vairagya). If Patanjali meant
willful control, then we must ask "who" is it that gains that
mastery and over what? Control refers to struggle, but vairagya
refers to release. The inclusion of normal willfulness would
just be reinforcing the illusion of separateness, avidya, and
specifically the klesha of asmita? Patanjali however is far more
advanced than that, rather he specifically says that vairagyam
is accomplished when thirst/desire ceases (vitrsnasya). It's
simply over when we relinquish it. Similarly the word, samjna,
is here translated as "coming into understanding" or born of
self awareness . Samjna is composed of sam (together) and jna (to
know or understand), so that vairagya and vitrsnasya are being
equated.
Again there is no intention of restraint or control (which is
unfortunately too often mistakenly attributed to vairagya), but
rather mastery or perfection (vitrsnasya) so that the outflowing
of the cit-prana ceases (in perfected vairagya). To a willful
and left brain dominant person mastery may conjure up force,
control, or restraint, but here it should be obvious that the
mastery is one of release, letting go, and surrender pertaining
to vairagya (non-attachment -- non-control). Vairagya is a let
go, a release,
or simply non-attachment of any anticipation and hence anxiety
also departs. Here goal orientation is utterly defeated as well
as dependence upon conditioning (visaya). In this way
unconditional joy and well being is naturally affirmed and self
sustaining. It is not unusual that the traditionalists will
bring in the Vedic spin and issues of control in their
interpretations in 1.12-16, because Patanjali is speaking about
the exact opposite of control, tradition, and the past, i.e.,
vairagyam. Vairagya as release becomes clear to advanced
meditators (those who practice over time). The ordinary mind
tends to wander toward objects of attention, yet applying
vairagya consistently (not through control, suppression, nor
restraint but simply by repeatedly releasing the the thoughts
and words of the monkey mind as they start) then the arising of
thoughts eventually becomes pacified and eventually cease for
longer and longer durations until this becomes recognized as our
Natural (unconditioned) Mind in swarupa. "If while speaking of
the samadhi of oneness, you fail to practice straightforward
mind, you will not be disciples of Buddha. Only practicing
straightforward mind, and in all things having no attachments
whatsoever, is called the samadhi of oneness. The deluded person
clings to the characteristics of things, adheres to the samadhi
of oneness, and thinks that straightforward mind is sitting
without moving and casting aside delusions without letting
things arise in the mind. This they consider to be the samadhi
of oneness. This kind of practice is the same as being
insentient like a rock and is the cause of obstruction to the
Tao. Tao must be something that circulates freely; why should we
impede it? If the mind does not abide in things, the Tao
circulates freely; if the mind abides in things, it becomes
entangled." from the "Platform Scripture", Hui-Neng Through
tasting the effects of vairagya in daily practice (on or off the
meditation cushion or practice mat) in All Our Relations as to
where our thoughts are wandering and letting them go (not
following them), then our attention is naturally brought back to
the core center in vasikara samjna vairagyam. We become aware of
the discursive (monkey) mind wandering and we bring it back
through pratyahara. Here vairagya is the remedy for all outward
cravings and anticipation -- specifically the remedy for the
kleshas of raga (attraction) and dvesa (repulsion). It is the
very reversing outward flow as in pratyahara away from outward
dissipation/distraction, then back into the center or sushumna
creating inward and upward flow in the core center (sushumna).
Through vairagyam and/or pratyhara we withdraw the clinging of
the mental energies toward duality (external objects either
mental or physical) and draw the energy back to the Source of
consciousness. Thus we prevent the cit-prana (consciousness and
vital energy) from dissipating and spinning outwards through
implementing and directing the inner gaze. This rekindles our
natural innate yearning and passion for Self -- it is at once
inspiring, strengthening, potenizing, and invigorating. When
this re-alignment is well established over time (through
authentic abhyasa and vairagyam), it establishes its own
energetic dynamic revealing the non-dual (inner/outer) teacher.
This creates a karmic shift paralleling that intelligent
energetic which the practice itself creates over time. We can
call this regaining the natural intelligence of the body or
simply a self empowered, practice which empowers our inner
wisdom. This way we re-educate our pre-existing errant mental.
emotional, physical, and energetic proclivities toward seeing
the Universal Self continually in All Our Relations. Thus we
conjoin the process of unifying with the intelligent Source of
cit-prana) more deeply communing with it here and now in sacred
presence. We both welcoming it while it simultaneously it
welcomes us in the Reality of the Great integrity of the
unconditional eternal (Infinite Mind). We gradually become more
at home residing in the Eternal HERE. Such reprogramming is the
result of functional and authentic yoga practice. This is done
by releasing old thought patterns which obsess upon the future
or the past, old karmic patterns, old mind sets, or any such
other goal oriented fixations, false identification,
neuropsychological dysfunctional patterns, goal dependent
orientations, or more simply put attachments, expectations,
prejudices, and anticipations dependent upon the past or future.
This release of anticipation spontaneously directs the vital
energy and attention inward to a centered and still place, and
thus one's proclivity and passion toward its benefits increases
automatically and naturally; i.e., a new positive biofeedback
loop or habit is formed, while the practice of "vasikara samjna
vairagyam" becomes the practice of no practice -- effortless,
invigorating, energizing, self inspiring. self liberating, and
free from "self"-will.
On a simple level, vairagya is the acceptance of the present
without anticipation, apprehension, fear, desire, longing,
expectation, or even preference. Vairagya does not mean some
neutral passionless state of detachment, spaciness, indifference,
withdrawal, or abstraction; but rather as we will see in the
next sutra, vairagya can be equated with the divine passion for
ultimate union with param-purusa (reconnection/reunification
with universal spirit and consciousness) as our everyday
embodiment/manifestation --as our Reality in All Our Relations)
is maturing. In other words when we empty out the pot of dank
water, it can then be filled with fresh nectar. Thus this is a
simultaneous process of letting go of dysfunctional attractions
and anticipations (the kleshas of raga and dvesa) while at the
same time deepening our passion/communion in sacred presence.
Vairagya as such redirects the cit-prana from an outward,
dissipating externalized distraction, back into Source and back
into the body as an inner directed act that catalyzes divine
passion. As such on many parallel levels with such practices as
pratyhara, pranayama, aparigraha, santosha, tapas, isvara
pranidhana, bandhas, mudras, and others. When that sense of a
deep heart felt "connection" is strengthened through practice,
then in turn neurotic distractions spontaneously and naturally
lessen. That light of consciousness (citta) which was previously
obscured through the action of vrtti (the veil of ignorance)
starts to shine through more often, further reminding us to let
go of old corrupting and dysfunctional modalities of tension,
strife, and disintegration. As vasikara (mastery) becomes slowly
perfected (as no longer being subjugated to outward flows of
consciousness and prana), it is here also that the bandhas
become engaged spontaneously, the inner seeing becomes amplified,
our practices become extended to All Our Relations producing
virya (empowerment), and unconditional joy re-enters into daily
life more continuously. Sw. Venkatesananda's commentary on this
Sutra talking of samjna and vasikara says; "The attention that
was flowing outwards suddenly begins to flow toward yourself.
That is called vasikara which means that it comes under your
control. That is control of a very different kind. There is
neither expression nor suppression, but intense self-awareness.
When in the light of self-awareness the mental colouring is seen
and the object is then seen not to have that value,
simultaneously the craving disappears...That is not yoga because
you get so dreadfully committed to the vrtti called control.
Yoga has slipped through your fingers". This state of
thirstlessness leads us well into the key of understanding and
applying sutra 1.16 in the lofty terms of nonattachment to the
gunas (guna-vaitrsnyam) as param-purusa-khyater (the revelation
of param purusa). Sutra 16 Tat param purusa-khyater
guna-vaitrsnyam Through that [practice] where total non-fixation
and independence (vaitrsnyam) from the illusion of
differentiated physical objects (the gunas) occur then one
realizes (khyater) the param purusa (the Infinite Mind).
Commentary: Progressively then as the strength of one's practice
increases, the vrttis also correspondingly subside, we
eventually wind up in stillness and clarity of the bigger
transpersonal non-dual and transconceptional Mind. Then the
individual mind has become transformed/enlarged resting/abiding
in its true nature (swarupa) as a realization (khyater) dawns of
param purusha (Infinite Mind, Supreme Self, or Absolute
Universal Transpersonal Consciousness). this awareness grows on
us through practice. It becomes increasingly present as sacred
divine presence. Thus through this dawning realization (khyater)
of param purusa one wins the freedom
from any distractive desires (vaitrsnyam) for external objects
(the attractive outward spinning of the mind toward the gunas
are stilled) as we focus on the unitive Cause of relativistic
duality/differentiation (the gunas). This is the realization (khyter)
of param purusha (the transcendent All Encompassing Universal
Consciousness) [which is brought about through not being caught
up (vairagya) in the multitude differentiations of mundane
relativistic existence (gunas) as being separate individual/differentiated
forces (discrete). Simultaneously the yogi wins freedom (vaitrsnyam)
from the cause of bondage to differentiated objects which only
appear to be separate but in Reality are all united in the Whole.
By realizing the transpersonal non-dual whole (param purusa) --
the Great Integrity, Big Self, or Boundless Mind, by the
cessation (nirodha) of habitual superficial dualistic mappings
of the mind (visaya) which occur through the distorted lens
where consciousness is abstracted into differentiated physical
objects of existence (gunas), then the dualistic colorings,
filters, veils, shrouds, enslavements, hindrances, and other
such limitations based on the delusion of separate object and a
separate perceiver (ego), which is called ignorance (avidya),
are loosened, eventually dissolve, and are utterly destroyed (nirodha)
Here the word, guna, simply refers to the differentiating
process of any or all physical phenomena i.e., the phenomenal
world consisting of separate things and qualities. At this stage
in our practice we realize that further extrinsic pursuits into
the myriad characteristic differentiations of material existence
as separate phenomena (as symbolized by the gunas) will not
bring forth true and lasting happiness. Rather Spirit/Source
lies in a different direction. When it is realized inside, it is
simultaneously realized in all things -- as omnipresent and
eternal. No separate thing (phenomena) can be such. That is,
reductionist and analytical thinking (although useful in
mathematics and technology) is not up to the spiritual task
which is yoga. It will not be adequate nor helpful toward
bringing forth integration -- the Integrity which is yoga.
Rather the practitioner is learning through the practice (abhyasa)
of vairagya that it is the process of knowing this very
instrument of seeing itself-- the inherent intelligence behind
the eye (the inner or third eye) which determines everything (whether
we see clearly and completely on one hand, or not clearly in the
confused and fragmented way called avidya or ignorance).
It is valuable to point out that in yoga, the param purusa is
not itself a separate object like God, but it is a state of self
realization (khyater) -- it is an heightened way of observing/seeing.
It is not a separate witness consciousness although at first it
may appear to be separate from our inner intelligence. rather it
is the great flame which
lights intellect and all intelligence (the intelligent principle
if you wish) but it is a principle not based upon any condition
or theory. This way the practitioner begins to pursue the
non-pursuable, expects the unexpected, begins to see beyond the
sense (the third eye is opened), and the yogi then becomes more
attuned to the underlying ever present eternal unifying
universal current of unbounded consciousness (param purusha)
which has always existed behind the scenes of what we have
previously labeled as gross temporal materiality. As we become
increasingly aware of this absolute, universal, and eternal
consciousness underlying the consciousness principle (param
purusha) and see through the clear glass of its Reality, we
abide effortlessly in our true nature (swarupa) thoroughly
devoid of desire (vaitrsnyam) . It is this lens which is no lens
at all, which is free of distortion and all aberration. Then the
agitating and disturbing patterns (vrtti) moving us away from
our core energy naturally subside and come to rest in a joyful
and timeless stillness (nirodha). It is valuable to point out
that vaitrsnyam refers to freedom from desire or distractions
and connotes the successful completion of vairagya
(non-attachment). It would be contradictory to the essential
purport of the word, vairagya, to misinterpret vaitrsnyam in
terms of any willful control (as traditionalist left brain
dominant academia assert) for certainly HERE there is no
ordinary effort, but rather natural transpersonal inspiration,
spiritually motivated zeal, enthusiasm, and divine passion reign.
Also it is perhaps salient to point out that vairagya and
vaitrsnyam as meaning freedom from distraction and dissipative
cravings, then it would connote (samjna) the accomplishment of
the opposite direction of distraction which would be
attentiveness and attention. Similarly the opposite direction of
vaitrsnyam would be continuous fulfillment or completeness such
as santosha, aparigraha, and kaivalyam (See the following padas
for more on these). Here the cit-prana is remediated inward
activating the previously dormant non-dual evolutionary energy
leading to Sat-Chit-Ananda. Guna is simply the word that denotes
a patterned philosophical system (the samkhya) that
characterizes, defines, and creates separation and
differentiation between the various aspects of what we normally
call the phenomenal or objective world. It is superimposed upon
the world of phenomena as an artificially imposed filter by the
samkhya philosophers to evaluate/quantitate the differentiations
of dualistic existence. Samkhya adherents will say that is the
way it really is. For them they believe it, but it is just their
preferred filter, coloring, or vrtti.
For a philosopher, scientist, or other reductionist thinkers who
wish to catalogue phenomena one may become immersed in endlessly
elaborating upon the gunas in analytical and reductionist
thought, but it is not an effective methodology for a yoga
practitioner who is rather attempting to extract themselves from
the causal extraction process itself. Not that Patanjali is
saying that analytical techniques are not of use in "the world",
but rather in functional yoga practice, one eventually benefits
from a transcendental release or freedom from such reductionist
practices. The samkhya idea of the gunas is simply the unfolding
and differentiation of the physical world which can be discerned
or identified as form having discrete qualities Here in yoga
(versus samkhya) Patanjali says repeatedly in different ways
that no, they objects of form may appear isolated, fragmented,
and separate, but from the unitive non-dual and transpersonal
standpoint of param purusha or Infinite Mind, they are
inextricably woven together (yoga). The Buddhists call this
relative truth, the world of cause and effect where all things
are mutually interdependent within the whole (not separate). In
Sanskrit it is called pratityasamutpada. Here Patanjali is not
denying the richness of prakrti (as traditional interpreters
surmise), but au contraire, he is affirming that the
reductionist approach of separating creation into its parts, is
distracting and limit the magnificence of the non-dual unbounded
whole of All Our Relations as it truly is in swarupa. Thus one
needs not to know the intricacies of samkhya or Vedic
philosophical systems to understand the import of the Yoga
Sutras according to the teachings of Patanjali, because the
teachings of pure yoga is independent of such systems. One does
however need to understand well the value and efficacy of the
practice of release (vairagya) of grasping onto separate objects
of attention, onto external systems, upon objective fixations,
upon any "god" that is not omnipresent. This release is a
release of distractions and dissipations which keep us
imprisoned in duality -- a process of reclaiming the outward
spinning of the cit-prana's distraction which then provides the
energization necessary for evolutionary embodiment which in turn
frees the psycho-neurological circuits that have become
overloaded, bonded, blocked, fixated, distracted, externalized,
and dissipated in temporal outward flow through negative
conditioning, programming, habits, vasana, samskara, vrtti,
and/or karma. Hence Patanjali is slowly outlining the way toward
the empowerment of samadhi. Here some translators point out that
in the previous sutra (I.15) Patanjali introduces the basic
practice of vairagya (as freeing the mind from objects through
release), but here in I.16 Patanjali is describing a natural and
more mature (param) vairagya which happens after the yogi has
obtained a more complete glimpse, clearer insight and vision of
our innate integrity and identity as purusa. Indeed vairagya
leads the yogi into the highest insight and realization, and for
such it is a direct vehicle to ultimate attainment. Shankara
says in his commentary on this sutra, that for a yogi so
possessed (by the skill of the unpossessor) there is no need for
further practice of any other means for attaining kaivalyam (absolute
liberation) or "etasya hi nantariyakam kaivalyam", Sutra 16 then
is simply an extension of Sutra 15 where vaitrsnyam (16) is the
strengthened form of vitrsnasya (15). So some may call this the
highest (param) type of vairagyam where desireless is obtained.
I prefer to have this refer to the beginning of the dawning
realization of the highest self (param purusha) or the innate
buddha nature. To reiterate, vairagya is not just a neutral
dispassion, indifference, an escape, nor a catatonic withdrawal
from Reality, but rather the opposite; it is part of the process
where we withdraw from the illusion of fragmented existence and
then almost simultaneously commune more passionately with the
divine in All Our Relations. Thus proficient vairagya (release)
produces at first a realization (khyater) about how the basic
ways that we are ordinarily dissuaded from Infinite Mind (param
purusa). Through realization we learn how not to be so uprooted
from it. By light of consciousness we become aware that the mind
and energy (cit-prana) has wandered and become misappropriated
to an external object, so then we implement "letting go" by
releasing our own chains which is the same as embracing the
Param Purusa. This Reality becomes experiential -- we experience
it inside. On an energetic level, vairagya is the process of
turning our attention or consciousness away from external
distractions and shifted inward upon the Great Self (the Great
all inclusive Integrity of Infinite Mind -- param purusha) or
inner teacher which exists inside ALL things; and as such it is
closely allied with the practice of bandha on the physical level,
as well as the practice of pratyhara as being the bridge between
the energetic or pranic level and dharana (concentration). Such
yoga practices are designed to free the practitioner from being
preoccupied and fascinated by illusory dualistic existence and
its recurring cycles of physical and emotional craving, desire,
aversion, envy, greed, anticipation, anxiety, tension,
disappointment, grief, anger aversion, and suffering. As our
practice progresses over time, the joyous realization and
spontaneous celebration of "Self" as the imperishable Reality of
the truth of existence -- of "who we truly are" considerably
deepens. Here we are letting go of everything which fuels old
mind sets, compulsive and dysfunctional emotional patterns, old
mental activities (vrttis), old politically correct belief
systems (parama) which didn't fit, as well as old life styles
which were based on past ignorance. Vairagya as such is closely
associated with the spontaneous practices of saucha, santosha,
aparigraha, tapas, swadhyaya, isvara pranidhana, as well as
pratyhara, pranayama, dharana (samyama), the implementations of
the bandhas, and especially in the practice of dhyana (meditation).
"The Kensei comes to see that his light and the light of the
sages is essentially one and the same. The way of action
emerging from stillness is the non-action of the sages." from
the "Light of the Kensei" by G. BlueStone
Also : "You have these obstacles only because you have not
realized the emptiness of the eons... If you were able to stop
the mentality in which every thought is running after something,
then you would be no different from a Zen master or a Buddha. Do
you want to know what a Zen master or a Buddha is? Simply that
which is immediately present, listening to the Teaching. It is
just because students do not trust completely that they seek
outwardly...If you want to be no different from a Zen master or
a Buddha, just do not seek outwardly. Do not allow any more
interruptions at any time, and everything you see is It....
Don't stop with learning Zen or Tao on the surface as something
outside yourself...seeking 'buddahood', seeking 'mastery',
seeking 'teachers', considering them conceptually. Make no
mistake about it; turn your attention back on yourself and
observe." from "The Five Houses Of Zen", Lin-chi (9th century)
Translated by Thomas Clearly (1997) As an analogy, eventually we
are able to see the valley once we have climbed the mountain.
Here the true operation of the gunas (the dualistic conditioned
reality of cause and effect) become instantaneously revealed,
thus removing their power to obstruct, color, or limit
consciousness. This is facilitated through our acknowledgment
and embrace of param purusa (the non-dual transpersonal self).
This is achieved through releasing our tendencies to seek
answers within the sea of our pre-existing dualistic conditioned
confusion. No matter how familiar we are with our prisons, we
can never leave it, if we are not willing to surrender its
chains. We can not shoot a picture of the sun until we get out
of our shadow and hence Patanjali says in Sutra I.43 "Smrti-parishuddhau
svarupa-sunye va artha-matra-nirbhasa nir-vitarka" This is the
gradual direction which we are headed. The gradual realization
of vairagyam has to penetrate into our life styles and become
integrated in All Our Relations in order to remove/release
spiritual tension/resistance. When our cravings end, We arrive
In the present When we arrive home Here -- Abiding in the
Natural Mind In our natural Self. Complete Fulfilled
Grateful All separations Cease
All Cravings end What else is there to say? Purusa (introduced
first here in Sutra I.16) is a much misunderstood term because
the Vedic, samkhya, and academics tend to read-in their own
agenda into it. Patanjali is leading us in increasing intensity
toward isvara pranidhana the surrender omni-present purusa,
which is defined in 1.23-27. There is no coincidence that
vairagyam (as release) and purusa (as in isvara pranidhana) are
thus linked, because isvara pranidhana as will be elaborated
later is the surrender to our highest potential or Buddha
nature. Indeed vairagya and isvara pranidhana operate as two
sides of the same coin as we shall see through practice.
Vairagya and isvara pranidhana are not only practices, but also
profound teachings. Abhyasa as presented here is also both a
practice and a teaching in itself. This then leads us into the
discussion leading to the progressively deeper stages of samadhi
or infinite mind and how can this be realized. This is the theme
of the remaining verses (17-51) of chapter I and in particular
Sutras 17-45, which depends upon the acknowledgement of this
deeper transpersonal Self (param purusa) which we are told in
the next sutra is devoid of egotism (false identifications of a
separate self). See Sutra III.50 regarding the practice of
vairagya in relationship to purusa and sattva and how that leads
to absolute liberation (kaivalya). See also Pada IV. Sutras
32-34 along the same lines of the unification of purusa and
sattva. Here we have introduced the two major remedies and
teachings of yoga (vairagya as non-attachment and abhyasa as
consistent and regular practice). Thus following we
progressively exposed to the yogic ideal of a continuously and
permanently accessible samadhi (nirbija samadhi) -- an all
encompassing spiritual connection which includes both life and
death in All Our Relations -- a sacred presence within the
context of a Great Universal Integrity outlining the various
gradual processes and steps of temporary and partial
realizations, revelations, and satoris as minor temporary
samadhis (sabija samadhi) which forerun nirbija samadhi (samadhi
without seed). This is realized when one realizes the
fundamental unity of pure absolute consciousness and pure
absolute being -- where pure consciousness manifests in the
human form as pure awareness and receptivity -- as absolute
beingness. HERE in Sat-Chit-Ananda -- only in param purusa can
absolute and pure objectivity and absolute and pure subjectivity
be married. In the Great Integrity of universal Consciousness
and being siva/sakti, spirit/nature, and the mind/body become
completely non-dually integrated.
Here the clear road to nirbija samadhi in Samadhi Pada continues
on its own accord through the self liberatory practices rooted
in vairagya (the process of non-expectation). Sutra 17
vitarka-vicara-ananda-asmita-rupanugamat samprajnatah [This
gradual process which is called the practice without attachment
to any results] is at first accompanied by the attainment of a
limited knowledge based on the cognitive processes (samprajnata),
which in turn is accompanied with (anugamat) various forms of
pleasure (ananda), due to coarse false identification/objectification
processes (vitarka), subtle identification/objectifications (vicara)
such as attachment to mental objects of form (rupa), giving
forth a limited sense of pleasurable gratification associated
with a definite feeling of "I-it" belongingness/gratification as
well as I-It separateness (asmita). Commentary: Here we must
start the journey from where we are at. We move from mental
attachment and identifications with the gross (vitarka) forms (rupa),
to the more subtle (vicara) forms, to the most subtle, to beyond
even the most subtle (sunya) as we will see toward the end of
this chapter, Samadhi pada). Thus samprajnata (ordinary
cognition processes that are fixated on form) is an incomplete
poorly integrated form of self identification or self absorption
(asmita), which is still polluted by gross and discursive
thought processes (vitarka) which have become distracted outward
toward physical objects. This abstraction process (samprajnata)
and false identification (asmita) includes as well mental
attachment to the more subtle mental objects (vicara); all of
which are still caught up with fragmented mentations of an
apparently separate objects as in the appearance of objective
form (rupa) and the confining sense of a separate self (asmita)
which reinforces the klesha (affliction) of separateness. that
is the nature of the world of form (coarse and subtle
objectification processes) accompanied (anugamat) by objects of
temporary self gratification (ananda). We will learn that
Patanjali later calls asmita (sense of ego or ownership) is one
of the five broad classifications of afflictions (kleshas) -- it
is due to ignorance (avidya), grasping, (raga), and dualistic
false identification. Hence it is clear that Patanjali is saying
that vairagya is designed to destroy asmita, which eventually
leads us into the broader and ultimate (param) identification or
integration with param purusa (IM). This is not complete (param)
until vitarka and vicara fixations which give rise to temporary
self gratification (ananda-asmita) cease (nirodha).
Avidya is a confining space of nescience which calls out to be
released by the practice of vairagya. introducing the words,
vitarka and vicara here, thus show where Patanjali is going with
them and the entire idea of cognition; i.e., he is going from
the dualism of a separate seer and object that is seen (samprajnata)
toward a clarity of pure lucidity and grace -- the self
effulgent light of "vaisharadye'dhyatma-prasadah" mentioned in
sutra I.47. However in the mental state of restricted object
relations (called samprajnata) which is characterized by
vitarka-vicara-ananda-asmita-rupa-anugamat. the small self or
ego (asmita) still falsely identifies with the process of
attraction, attachment, and (be)longing (raga) for/to gross (vitarka)
or subtle (vicara) objects (of form or rupanugamat) which is
associated with the glue of temporary pleasure (ananda) when one
finally apprehends, comprehends, or grasps the object of craving.
The pleasure (ananda) attendant upon this temporary union (goal
gratification which is the result of craving after an object,
and then its possession) is both temporary and neurotic
providing a short release of tension, stress, or striving until
the next craving arises. This feeling which is normally ascribed
to as pleasure rather is due to the temporary extinction of the
craving, when the individual mind obtains its object. But since
grasping upon objects of self gratification (through asmita)
never bring lasting happiness, then this monkey mind which is
confusedly looking for completion, fulfillment, and lasting
happiness in dualistic objects, being lost in avidya, starts its
search into separate objects looking for happiness again (rupanugamat
samprajnatah) and then again experiencing temporary experiences
of ananda and then dukha -- then ananda and dukha, etc. The
temporary release of the craving through union with an object of
thought is called the pleasure of self gratification (ananda-asmita),
while its loss manifests in a suffering mistaken by the deluded
mind as the klesha called raga (desire or craving). This can be
likened to any fulfillment or possession of any object of desire
(gross of subtle). The desire for sexual union may be the most
obvious symbolic representation of being lost in the cycle of
craving, fulfillment, and separation. However all these
activities based on samprajnata (object relations), which here
we define as the process of dualistic objectification (the
separation of the seer from the seen) reinforces the illusory
separation from seeing eternal sacred presence in All Our
Relations. Such chronic dualistic objectification processes (samprajnata)
thus reinforces the spiritual split. These cycles exist within
avidya, ego delusion, or what is commonly called, samsara.
Writhing in the cycle of dukha (suffering) is thus the all too
common experience and it is mandated until the lesson is learned,
past karma annihilated, and samskaras extinguished, thus
allowing entry into transpersonal sacred space in All Our
Relations. Here the remedial practice is again vairagya --
releasing the object from the mental apparatus.
The normal person lost in avidya and in particular the klesha of
asmita confuses the craving with pleasure (ananda) because they
"expect" to achieve the goal. Thus
tragically need, desire, and craving become held onto
insidiously. Patanjali is calling this ordinary way of "seeing",
samprajnata, where one falsely identifies with the process of
identification with the object which one perceives (one becomes
objectified). In other words, without vairagya, the monkey mind
tends to wander onto objects (physical or mental). This is the
nature of samprajnata. This craving toward "something" and its
gratification provides a certain amount of temporary self
gratification (ananda-asmita) and pleasure (ananda). Thus in the
beginning of practice, the yogi runs into samprajnata both
coarse (vitarka) and subtle (vicara). It actually is one's
common experience. But first we have to recognize it and go from
where we are at. Just this recognition of the suffering of
samprajnata is thus helpful to over come it. Next in I.18
through practice immersed in vairagya we see that eventually
this tendency is reduced (asamprajnata). Thus samprajnata goes
hand in hand with the nature of the kleshas and especially raga
(craving), while the successful application of vairagya
obviously brings forth its remediation. Vitarka can be defined
as absorption in a gross object while vicara is absorption in a
discursive thought process. Although vicara is subtle as
compared to vitarka, both are forms of limited absorption
because the i-it dualistic fixation is still present (there
exists an object separate from the perceiver which occupies and
limits the mental contents of the mind (cognition). In this
intermediary and fragmented state called by Patanjali
samprajnatah, there still exists goal orientation, conflict,
dissociation, disorganization, sequential fixations, and
discursive thought in meditation. A compensatory sense of joy (ananda)
which accompanies release and then fixation (the false self's
sense of loss and then possession/apprehension) wavers and is
transitory because as one releases one attachment another
eventually attracts our attention, but as soon as it is
apprehended another rises up again and again. Samprajnatah is a
temporary and unstable beginning part of meditation practice on
the path to samadhi accompanied with much mental agitation which
is mistaken for pleasure by the ego (asmita). Later Patanjali
will give many other practices to remediate samprajnata such as
isvara pranidhana, aparigraha, santosha, pratyhara, samyama,
tapas, brahmacharya, dhyana, etc.
Unfortunately this sutra is generally misunderstood by an
intellectually based tradition which has become entrenched in
academia that attempts to classify numerous kinds of samadhis
(the word, samadhi, there in this tradition being defined in a
loose sense of any absorption) and thus samprajnata is
mistakenly categorized as a base samadhi by such interpreters.
They say that this is what Patanjali means, but the truth is
that Patanjali never called this, samadhi. If such an absurd
definition of samadhi were allowed, we would have football
samadhi, TV samadhi, and countless others. It is salient to note
that samprajnata as well as the term samapatti (attainments) are
not synonymous with samadhi as academic classifiers mistakenly
are wont. In other words some call savitarka (focusing on
physical objects) as a samadhi by itself, which opens the next
door to savichara samapatti (focusing on the more subtle mental
objects of of the mental concentration itself), which in turn
leads to a third samadhi which some call sa-ananda samadhi (joyful
samadhi). In truth there are a myriad types of minor absorptions
possible, but they are not samadhis as defined by Patanjali,
rather they are all disparate attachments and fixations of the
cit-prana that call for release (vairagya) through yogic
practice (abhyasa). Although certain mental states may occur in
gradations moving from the coarse (vitarka) to more subtle (vicara)
thus releasing the tension and suffering implicit in the past,
only the more inclusive and integrative non-dualistic,
trans-rational, and transpersonal samadhis are worth pursuing
such as nirvitarka (devoid of gross fixations), nirvicara (devoid
of subtle mental fixations), and nirbij (devoid of seed).
Patanjali clearly states that only nirbij (seedless) samadhi
brings about enduring liberation and that is the stated goal.
These other gradated absorptions that Patanjali herewith
addresses, although perhaps indicative of graduated stages of
freedom, are all to be released (in vairagya) -- they are not to
be held onto nor should one become engrossed nor self satisfied
with them. Regardless on what tack we take on the interpretation
of this sutra, the progressive stages of the expansion of
consciousness progresses from: Prenatal non-awareness or
consciousness of the world including any objects (the objective
world). Post natal subjective awareness of the world where one
identifies with the objects. Mature development of
differentiated consciousness (elementary discriminating
awareness) where one discriminates between the variety of
objects and learns to separate subjective feelings from external
events.
The divine non-dual awareness where the world of seemingly
separate objects appears to be real, they are experienced as
inter-connected --All Our Relations - in the unitive wholistic
experience where one simultaneously perceives an object as an
effect of a cause and as a possible further cause in the chain
of karmic events while at the same time the Source awareness
that has no beginning or end persists -- beginningless time and
uncreated space abides as eternal profound and sacred presence.
This last stage is beyond any human words or power to objectify.
It can neither be grasped by the individual mind, but rather
exists within the innate unity where pure consciousness and pure
beingness reside -- in the non-dual holographic multidimensional
mesh of turiya -- in satchitananda or Natural Great and Perfect
Awareness As-It-Is
undisturbed by manmade colorings (vrtti) and projections. HERE
the goal of yoga has become achieved where cit-vrtti has ceased
(nirodha). Here Patanjali is pointing us toward the goal (samadhi)
of yoga in stages. For a further elaboration on vitarka,
savitarka, nirvitarka, vicara, savicara, or nirvicara, see the
similar discussion in sutras I.42-44. In short one progresses
from the coarse to the most subtle. For a further discussion of
the kleshas of raga, dvesa, and asmita see Sutra II.6-8. Then
once prepared we enter beyond even the most subtle into the
formless, objectless, non-dual, non-separate, non-dual, and
timeless realization of All Our Relations when the ground has
become prepared -- when we are readied through authentic yogic
sadhana. Sutra 18 Virama-pratyayabhyasa-purvah samskara-seso'nyah
As yogic practice deepens (abhyasa), another (anya) deeper kind
of trans-objective absorption (not dependent upon
objectification) is practiced (virama-pratyaya-abhyasa). This is
not dependent upon support by the cognitive faculties and is not
dependent upon an object of thought nor objects of attention (pratyaya)
either coarse or subtle (nirvitarka or nirvicara). Here
objectification (samprajnata) which is based on apparent or
superficial causes dependent upon objects or form (pratyaya)
ceases (virama). Thus leaving only the residual (seso) imprints
(samskaras) of the past (purvah) to be cleared away. Commentary:
This describes the process of creating the requisite space
through vairagya for the dawning of the highest samadhi (nirbija
samadhi). Since this practice (virama-pratyaya-abhyasa) is
devoid of objectification or attachment to form it is often
labeled as asamprajnata (versus samprajnata of sutra 17). Here
Patanjali is saying every attachment is cleared away --
consciousness no longer attached to any objects of form, but it
is only the residual imprints (samskaras) which now have to be
dissolved. This is why commentators say that Patanjali is
calling this asamprajnata samadhi (devoid of objects of form),
but in reality Patanjali never uses the word, samadhi here.
The Sanskrit word, pratyaya, is often misunderstood. The term.
pratyaya, refers to ordinary dualistic perception where there
appears to pre-exist a separation between the viewer and the
object which is being viewed. In one sense this type of
cognition or recognition is a necessary element in ordinary
dualistic analytical or reductionist mentation where the mind
compares the differences between one physical "isolated" object
and another. However in a yogic sense, which is not dependent
upon such processes of dualistic objectification processes (pratyaya),
but rather yoga is based on the Reality of the unitive
realization of All Our Relations which is a higher
transcognitive realization, where we are capable of relating on
a more intimate transpersonal non-dual ongoing modality, then
pratyaya is seen as superficial and incomplete, and hence false
as its true nature remains obscured by being engrossed by the
denseness of the apparent separate object. In other words much
more can be included in our every day modality of consciousness,
but it is the dualistic rigidification of the mind-set
strengthened by pratyaya which must be dropped. Thus for this
higher process to be activated Virama-pratyayabhyasa-purvah is a
realization due to practice where any separate object of focus
by the mind is seen as a distraction, an obscuration, and
impediment and no longer heeded (in successful practice of
vairagya). Cognition as a processes is not entirely discarded,
but rather it is put on pause -- it no longer limits the scope
of the known, rather the Universal Mind is called into play.
Thus the direction where the ordinary mind is headed can be
redirected through virama-pratyaya; i.e., by resisting the
tendency to objectify, name, or identify with any independent
object as separate from the intrinsic unity of All Our
Relations. This dissociation ultimately leads to the
dissociation of a separate self (ego) but at the same time it
creates the requisite space to embrace the All and Everything.
For the common man (non-yogi) most ordinary thought processes
are limited, unfocused, unclear, and blurred, but yogis do not
take objective thought forms as being an ultimate beneficial
influence toward their spiritual goal of samadhi (non-dual union).
Rather the yogic direction is to go beyond ordinary mentation,
ordinary individual cognitive functions, and goal orientation
itself. Pratyaya is thus a necessary "element" in "ordinary"
cognition processes of objectification it is an essential
element in ordinary dualistic cognition itself, which Patanjali
called samprajnata in the previous sutra (17). But here since
virama means cessation, so this practice (abhyasa) is one where
intentional dualistic thought processes toward an object (pratyaya)
is terminated. Since pratyaya is necessary for samprajnata (objectification)
to occur, then this virama-pratyaya causes a transcognitive
state which many commentators call , asamprajnata (where
ordinary samprajnata is defeated). This practice is called
purvah (former or proceeding), which means that by constant
practice of eliminating the objectification motive force (virama-pratyaya-abhyasa-purvah)
then what remains to be accomplished (purvah) is only the past
imprints (samskara-seso'nyah) or samskaric residues to be
eliminated. We will see later that only in the very highest
samadhi (nirbija samadhi) in I.51 will these residues of
samskara be fully eliminated. Indeed removing the samskaras is
at the forefront of all yoga practices and much more is to be
said about them.
A similar interpretation is that this sutra advocates a practice
(abhyasa) called virama pratyaya which eliminates ordinary
cognition (dependent upon superficial
appearances and secondary causes (pratyaya), which in turn the
past residual imprints (purvah--samskara-shshos) are loosened.
This next type of absorption (which is not an objectification)
occurs in the beginning stagers of successful meditation. Vyasa,
the earliest commentator on the Yoga Sutras, interprets this to
be a "asamprajnata" or trans-cognitive samadhi (as compared to
samprajnata which is described in sutra I.17, because it is not
accompanied by i-it objectification (duality). Rather it is
devoid of both coarse objects (vitarka) as well as more subtle
discursive thought (vicara), form (rupa), and any sense of
separateness (asmita). Virama here also means cessation and
refers to the cessation of pratyaya (the objectification process
where objects are experienced as apparent mental contents/fixations
of the mind). The ordinary contents of the dualistic ordinary
mind who cognizes "reality" based on superficial appearances out
of context with the non-dual whole (pratyaya) then cease (virama).
What is left is a transcognitive consciousness. However the
residues of past psychic signatures, cellular memory,
psycho-neuro-physiological lesions, neuromuscular armoring,
energy cysts, and the like (called samskaras) are still not yet
completely destroyed. Only after the samskaras are destroyed,
then one conjoins nirbija samadhi as described in Sutras I.
50-54. In general this is an accurate overall statement of where
we are headed (to nirbija-samadhi) by eliminating all mental
fixations (asamprajnata) -- the world of object relations or all
limited self identifications (asmita) is ceases to imprison Self.
In the previous sutra we saw that samprajnata (cognitive)
absorption was difficult and unstable creating an rigidified
externalization, fixation, and over objectification, but after
consistent yogic practice (abhyasa) which attenuates, empties,
and eliminates the secondary causes of these fixations, they
become loosened especially in the practice of meditation where
vairagya can be most easily practiced. Then the transcognitive
and non-dual asamprajnata (objectless or acognitive) absorption
process which is starts to occur more regularly. This is an
objectless state, but still it is not completely wholly
conscious, rather it creates the space for more consciousness.
Most people are not used to not grasping onto an external object
nor are they used to not fixating the mind on a mental object,
so it takes some practice to allow this experience to occur and
have it grow on us. This asamprajnata realization is not a
situation where the mind wanders being being spaced out or
incapable of focusing, rather it is a result of a liberating,
transconceptional, and very centering experience. It is easily
achieved in meditation through consistent practice of vairagya.
It can also be reached through other yogic practices which will
be delineated in padas II and III.
This graduation (into what is called asamprajnata) develops over
time from consistent regular practice (abhyasa) and vairagya (letting
go of the mind's tendency to fixate upon objects) where the
previously existing state of over objectification, self
extraction, and spiritual self alienation of externalization
cease (virama), but the
samskaras (the residual imprints of past conditioning) which
still remain awaiting final exorcism. Indeed the Yoga Sutras are
full of describing this process in many different terms.
Especially se sutras III.2 and III.3 in a further discussion of
pratyaya and its dissolution (sunya) through meditation allowing
for the intrinsic clear light of lucidity to shine forth from
within (nirbhasam) in swarupa. Pratyaya being the relational and
comparative contents of the mind-field -- the view of the
ordinary dualistic mind in terms of external objects -- the "normal"
realm of I-it separation where it appears that objects (mental
or physical) are possessed by the mind. this is the realm of "normal"
perception which occurs in the corrupt state where separate
objects appear to be solid and real, while the observer appears
to live in a chronically estranged and disconnected world
detached from the apparent separate objects as a separate viewer
which defines the biased context of ignorance of the true nature
of mind -- Satchitananda. When however we practice
virama-pratyaya-abhyasa then asamprajnata (a non-dual or
transcendental way of seeing) dawns. Thus we emphasize that the
"objectlessness" state is not one of a space cadet, but au
contrae, the mind simply stops craving after external objects to
grasp. Being at peace, objects are no longer desired or a source
of self gratification or neurotic pleasure, thus allowing space
for greater natural expansive awareness and clarity to shine
forth. Even the more subtle waves of mental abstraction cease (nirvicara)
for awhile, and a sense of interconnectedness and wholeness is
experienced in a deep peaceful non-dual stillness, although
momentary and temporary. There exists no ulterior future goal,
goal orientation ceases, the sense of separateness and craving
is remediated. However this asamprajnata type of absorption is
intermediary as it does not destroy the samskaras. So these
respites from the dualistic mind are temporary, i.e., the old
patterns (vrtti) start up again after a short respite. Further
practice thus is still necessary in order to exorcise and
cathart the samskaras (past energetic signatures, the deepest
and most subtle biopsychic imprints and impressions, and
cellular memories). Asamprajnata thus is a short glimpse into or
taste of nirbij samadhi which is to come. "Think not thinking.
How do you think not thinking? Non thinking. That in itself is
the essential art of zazen." or "Sit stably in samadhi. Think of
not-thinking. How do you think of not-thinking? Beyond-thinking.
This is the way of doing zazen in accord with the dharma. Zazen
is not learning (step-by-step) meditation. Rather zazen itself
is the dharma-gate of great peace and joy (nirvana). It is
undefiled practice-enlightenment."
from "The Way of Zazen" by Eihei Dogen Zenji.
After giving up striving (virama) by practicing vairagya
(non-attachment) and abhyasa (as consistent application), then
further success in yoga is accomplished (here through
virama-pratyaya). Here during meditation even the idea of
practice itself can get in the way -- goalless, objectless,
formless the sky clears disclosing the brightest sun. The
meditator starts to become educated as to the true nature of
formless mind and gradually integrates this experience into his/her
life. In sutra I.50, Patanjali mentions the samskara that ends
all the others; i.e., that precious truth bearing wisdom which
is not derived from scripture (sruti), from inference (anumana),
nor objective knowledge of things or events. It is this sutra
where it is pointed out that yoga clears out the residual (seso)
imprints (samskara) of the past (purvah). It is thus through
abhyasa (consistent practice) and vairagya that this
transcognitive (asamprajnata) state is achieved, but then only
the samskaras remain as the sole impediment. Later Patanjali
will present how yoga practice clears out all samskaras (a major
benefit of effective yoga practice) in the summum bonum of yoga,
nirbija samadhi. Sutra 19 Bhava-pratyayo videha-prakrti-layanam
By melting into (layanam) the formless nature (videha) of nature
(prakrti) a special spiritual attitude or feeling awareness (bhava-pratyayo)
permeates the content of the mind. To put this in another way it
could also be said that through the practice of bhava-pratyayo a
non-cognitive (asamprajnata), formless absorption (layanam) into
the unconditioned state of nature as-it-is dawns. Commentary:
When one becomes absorbed (layanam) in the true nature of nature
(prakrti), a transcognitive state (asamprajnata) allowing one to
overcome the duality of ordinary pratyaya dawns. This is
catalyzed by the practice of bhava-pratyaya in which ordinary
dualistic processes of cognition is defeated. Here one generates
spiritual bhava and becomes absorbed in communion with formless
prakrti (creation). As such one reaches the creator (as creation
and creator can not be separated) in the Reality of All Our
Relations. Again pratyaya refers to the mind's habitual tendency
(vasana) to fragmentize the natural Mind.
Bhava may be defined as the power of pure intention, but more so
spiritual motivation. In yoga, if intention is truly pure, it is
pure not only in the technical sense, but more so in the
spiritual sense. Thus it is clear that Patanjali, by utilizing
the word, bhava, here is addressing the great power of pure
non-dual spiritual intention/motivation which clears the mind
out of limited fixations. Here spirit shines through the yogi as
divine intention. Generating bhava, or the idea of divine union
is both on one hand a well known yogic technique to clear the
mind and set the mood, and on the other hand for the more
advanced practitioner it is a spontaneous and
natural expression. Likewise spontaneous and natural self
realization is possible simply through spiritual reflection (bhava)
into our intrinsic "re-memberance" of our part in the
unconditioned formless aspect of nature. Are we apart from it or
a part of it? Does such bhava samadhi as divine rapture break up
the extrinsic tendency to over objectify and hence lead us into
an asamprajnata (transcognitive state)? We are able to envision
the mental tendencies in their "normal" formative processes
creating the content of our normal mindfields and occupying the
mind (pratyaya) within the greater identification of
bhava-pratyaya (spiritual vision) -- within the integrity of All
Our Relations then the awareness of how self imposed limiting
dualistic thought processes occur which chronically obfuscate
the normal dualistic mentations, then through that awareness,
such dualistic limitations can easily be let go (vairagya) and
cease (nirodha). What is left is the pure natural unconditioned
intelligence itself (videha-prakrti-layanam) as the intelligence
of siva/sakti. This is our natural and unconditioned state that
can be experienced beyond normal human cognition (in
asamprajnata) where ordinary cognition again is preempted by a
spiritual direction (bhava-pratyaya) where we are not fixated
upon any one limited object. In this case we become absorbed in
the nature of nature which some call the divine creatrix or
mother. As creation comes HERE through the creative act of
creation -- through the Divine formless beginningless spark of
the creator, then it is natural that prakrti provides the ground
that the true self is known. As we have seen ordinary dualistic
cognition is dependent upon pratyaya, which as we have seen
depends in turn upon a focused intent and direction on the part
of the ordinary mind toward an isolated object (physical and/or
mental -- coarse or subtle; i.e., a form is thus formulated).
Since bhava meaning the power of spiritual intent, motivation,
mood, spiritual focus, or loving feeling -- the divine passion
and presence that twinkles in the eyes of a "turned-on" and
accomplished yogi carries along with it its own intelligent
powerful force and direction. Then bhava-pratyaya is a focused
and reinforced spiritual intent and motive power based on the
communion/absorption (layanam) into the formless nature of
creation -- of sacred presence in All Our Relations.
There exists much confusion about the word, bhava and hence the
intellectuals and traditionalist non-yogis severely
misunderstand this sutra. Technically bhava is used by
philosophers as the technical "intent" to be, or then the force
that brings things into existence (a "bad" thing for the
nature-phobic and other-worldly", but in authentic yoga where
the task is to embody spirit here and now, its meaning is
entirely spiritual as first put forward above. It means that our
spiritual intent that we generate as our spiritual mood is
equated with divine intent or pure love -- that what we hold in
our mind, directs the mind toward the desired goal (divine union).
In the pursuit of non-dual yoga the goal is sacred union and as
such bhava manifests as the backdrop -- setting the spiritual
mood and intent of our practice and keeping us on track. In a
Buddhist sense it can be equated to the generation of bodhimind
(bodhicitta) the powerful divine motivation or wish to gain
enlightenment in order to free all others from the suffering of
unenlightenment. Bhava, as in establishing our firm intent is a
very powerful organizing force in our practice, in meditation,
and in our everyday life. It focuses and strongly moves the
cit-prana. In similar bhakti yoga circles, bhava is the
trans-conditional intent equated with divine inspiration,
rapture, or the spiritual gaze. If our practice is devotional,
then the practice of bhava-pratyayo is even more relevant. In
India bhava samadhi (as spiritual rapture) is well known. It is
looked down upon as a trap by the intellectuals, philosophers,
and staid priests, but none-the-less practitioners claim that
such practice is transformative -- adherents claim that they
become moved by God and they experience stages of samadhi. As a
yogi, Patanjali was well aware of bhava, and is suggesting a
transcognitive (asamprajnata) practice that we can go (bhava-pratyayo)
which leads to this formless absorption in nature (videha-prakrti-layanam).
Thus bhava-samadhi can be an aid helping a practitioner to
experience transcognitive samadhi as long as they do not get
addicted to the rapture (spiritual rapture and divine attitude
being another common definition of bhava samadhi). As such
prabhava is the act of coming into swarupa --our true natural
self beyond the limited and false extrinsic identification
processes (pratyaya) related to ordinary cognition processes (samprajnata).Here
we affirm and generate the "good mind" and simultaneously
embrace the profound "right view" beyond judgment, methods of
inference, willfulness, philosophical ideas, conceptual artifice,
or perception. Thus this"right" view is the one beyond
conception and any artifice. It is established through direct
spiritual experience and is thus due to the dawning of the
intrinsic light in authentic darshan untouched by form, time,
and limitation. Thus in this way we practice the special
spiritual attitude (bhava) born of an absorption (layanam) on
the ongoing process of an unconditioned formless (videha)
natural mind as-it-is -- creation (prakrti) as manifested
through the intelligent evolutionary force disclosing the
creator/source in every atom. This is a special formless and
objectless spiritual intention called bhava-pratyayo, which is
not directed by individual cognition (asamprajnata), but rather
directed by transpersonal and non-dual absorption (as
asamprajnata type of knowing without an object). See the end of
Pada IV for more about this profound mergence.
Especially when one identifies with the underlying formlessness
(videha) that is united and underlies (layam) all of nature (prakrti),
there exists kinship and a lack of separateness -- a formless (videha)
quality which pervades the entire universe (prakrti) is
acknowledged and recognized. This created and uncreated (shakti/shiva)
is available to those who have become reabsorbed (laya),
re-united, and have reclaimed the birthright of their formless
non-dual self nature in nature which is the unity of self in
nature and nature in transpersonal Self (prakrti layanam). This
transpersonal acknowledgement is not the result of ordinary
cognition (pratyaya), but rather is asamprajnata formed by
bhava-pratyaya. This taste of the universal intrinsic authentic
true self is the dawning of swarupa (the realization of our true
natural unconditioned self) where the matrix or veil of
superficial appearances (maya) is cleansed revealing the Reality
of Creator/Creation (Shiva/Shakti). It is not dependent upon
form; rather it is achieved through recognizing the underlying
authentic formless true nature of "Self" in All Our Relations.
Here shakti is the gateway to shiva, creation the gateway to the
creator, nature is the gateway to our true nature. In fact this
is a two way street. They define each other. We go to
undifferentiated Source from creation, but within the reality of
seemingly individuated creation, lies the dance of Self.
Embodiment is the spirit's container. The journey is neither
just to the up to Source, nor down to the earth, but rather it
pulsates between the two in a greater Divine Integrity. See
Sutra II 18: prakasa-kriya-sthiti-silam bhutendriyat-makam
bhogapavargartham drsyam When we perceive an object through the
dynamic activity of the inner light of consciousness -- from our
light and energy body (prakasa) -- we are able to see its
inherent light as well. From this unity consciousness gazing
upon what previously appeared as a fragmented material object (something
steady, solid, and stable (sthhiti-silam) being composed of the
apparent slow vibratory motion of the elements (bhutas), but by
acknowledging the splendor of this inner light (prakasa) then
know the senses (indriyat) to be a liberator and revealer (apavarga)
of the Great unity -- as all our experiences in everyday life
becomes our teacher, rather than as an avenue for dissipation,
duality, and fragmentation. Or similarly, the true non-dual
intelligent liberatory energetic nature of the unity of creator/creation
which is the essence of "things" seen or unseen, is illuminated
and disclosed by this deeper power of transcognition (in which
the seer, all which is seen, and the processes of seeing) are a
common reflection of an inherent all inclusive and all pervasive
luminous intrinsic power (prakasa) and common Source, which is
simultaneously experienced (bhoga) and thus this process of
identification with this self illuminating activity (prakasa-kriya)
becomes self liberating (apavarga) even in our daily experiences.
See also: IV Sutra 2 jati-antara-parinama prakrty-apurat. The
diverse embodiments (of spirit) are conveyed through the flux of
creative natural evolution. Spirit as such is intrinsic, part of
our essential nature although hidden by ignorance in the ―normal‖
condition. And similarly Sutra IV.3 nimittam aprayojakam
prakrtinam varana-bhedas tu tatah ksetrikavat Through our daily
intercourse and experience with nature/creation the coverings (varana)
which are obstacles to the realization of the Great Integrity
and continuity of THAT manifestation are removed (bhedas)
naturally without necessitating force; but rather can occur
naturally like a cultivator with a green thumb who naturally
gravitates toward cultivating both the soil and the plants as
part of one‘s larger family or kin – as a partner or co-creator.
Also see Sutra I.33 for more on generating bhava to clarify the
mind (citta prasadanam). So how is bhava-pratyaya cultivated?
One can live in forest hermitages, huts, near the banks of holy
rivers, inside the caves of sacred mountains, or elsewhere in
the wilderness seeking the transpersonal inspirational blessings
that is inherent in natural creation which in turn reflects the
creator. Here communing with and worshipping the divine creatrix
in nature accelerates the practitioner swiftly into the non-dual
transpersonal Reality of All Our Relations. The ancient Rishis,
Munis, and yogis knew this and always sought out the wilderness
as a valued ally to their practice. In the modern urban age, it
is not always easy to find a quiet place in nature for spiritual
retreat and practice, but such influences are non-the-less very
powerful in creating asamprajnata. All aspirants are encouraged
to practice in this way in order to help activate the bhava of
the mother -- the Divine Creatrix. Bhava-pratyaya can also be
generated by divine re-memberance by remembering who we are in
All Our Relations, that separate forms are illusory, that we are
not separate from the trees, oceans, stars, deer, the formless
realms and each others. In this way we can invoke the presence
of the yogis of the three times (past, present, and future) to
help instruct and guide us.
In a similar sense we can receive darshan and grace from
creator/creation -- shiva/shakti in All Our Relations at every
moment in all things everywhere. In this way we receive darshan
from nature as well as from inside the body as being an integral
part of nature (not apart from it). Thus antar darshan melds
with the darshan of the mother as hridayam darshan. This is the
culmination of bhava-pratyayo or non-dual spiritual intent where
our own intent melds with the intent of the universe and as such
a non-dual synergistic and synchronistic alignment comes into
being. The generation of divine intention/motivation or the "good
mind" (bhava-pratyaya) is a very powerful motive force linking
both practice and grace. Pure gratitude being perhaps the
deepest natural expression of divine grace. "thy will be done,
on earth as it is in heaven." also "suddha-sattva-visesatma
prema-suryamsu-samya-bhak rucibhis citta-masrnya- krd asau bhava
ucyate" Sri Caitanya Caritamrta Madhya-lila 23.5)
Please note that Patanjali is indicating here a profound
practice which available to us through recognizing the formless
nature inside of all of nature; i.e., that purusa is shining out
at us from All Our Relations. It is obvious that Patanjali is
not addressing samkhya dualism here, but an integrative
relationship between prakrti and purusa; i.e., within THAT which
is contained in prakrti (nature) there is a formless presence (purusa)
which is the true nature of the Self (swarupa). Here the
profound mergence of sattva, purusa, prakrti, isvara, and
swarupa is being pointed out which is flatly stated in the last
Sutra of the last Pada the most lofty (Kaivalyam) Sutra IV.34.
Indeed purusa as isvara is known as self only through the agency
of prakrti, not as a separate Self. Sutra 20
Shradda-virya-smrti-samadhi-prajna-purvaka itaresham In the case
of others (itaresham), [if bhava-pratyaya or virama-pratyaya
have not been successful through consistent practice and
vairagya to loosen up duality, then as a recourse] others may
proceed (purvaka) through the self disciplines that cultivate
confidence and devotion to our practice (shradda); enthusiasm,
zeal, courage, and strength of practice (virya); reminding
oneself of the path, its purpose, and practice (smrti); and the
cultivation of gnosis, insight, and vigilant self awareness (prajna).
These practices will help augment the occurrence of asamprajnata
(transcognitive and non-dual) samadhi.
Commentary: For those others (itaresham) when asamprajnata
through virama pratyaya or bhava-pratyaya is not sufficient to
move us forward -- where abhyasa and vairagya appear to need
some further assistance, then it is time to augment our practice
and ramp it up, so that transcognitive absorption can eventually
result (purvaka). Here purvaka, thus denotes that shradda, virya,
and smrti are preliminary practices which catalyze prajna and
samadhi. One can ramp up their practice and
increase effort and energy (virya), engage upon practices which
increases confidence (shradda) in one's overall practice,
surround oneself with an environment that tends to remind us in
ways of sacred reverence (smrti) to cultivate that which
increases absorption (samadhi) in wisdom (prajna). Implementing
such remedies will positively affect our practice. Here also we
are reminded that the practice is intended to evoke the
intuition or innate wisdom and bring it forward into effecting
an even more efficacious practice.
Swami Venkatesananda says, from "Enlightened Living" : "In the
case of others, when such spontaneous realization of the
unconditioned does not happen, such realization is preceded by
and proceeds from faith or one-pointed devotion, great energy
and use of willpower, constant remembrance of teachings and
one's own experience, the practice of samadhi (the state of
inner harmony), and a knowledge or discernment of such harmony -
all of which lead one gradually on to that state of yoga." In
other words an effective practice automatically creates its own
enthusiasm, strength, zeal, a greater degree of self confidence
and centered empowerment, sense of purpose, rememberance,
insight, inspiration, and feeling of being connected with All
Our Relations. A yogi/yogini who is to be successful really
needs great courage and strength, but sometimes our practice may
be lacking or unskillful. Then we might lose sight of our
spiritual focus. Then confidence (shradda), zeal, and direction
in our practice may be diminished, lost, or doubt may set in,
that may create a significant impediment toward practice and
thus our eventual realization. So confidence and enthusiasm for
the practice must be increased by remembering and being reminded
(smrti) of what we really are striving toward (nirbija samadhi).
Here these methods can become invoked as remedial safeguard (as
a practice to increase the practice), when our practice needs a
boost. As such shradda, virya, smrti, prajna, can help us to
become focused and engaged in our practice, but should only be
seen as a temporary adjunct toward reestablishing an effective
practice which provides its own natural inspiration, spiritual
passion, insight, enthusiasm, and encouragement. Here an
effective practice creates its own and increases prajna (insight)
virya (inspiration and courage), shradda (centeredness and self
confidence), and re-memberance of All Our Relations -- so that
our practice doesn't become mechanical or deadened.
Various practical methods help in this regard such as studying
inspiring works, satsang, engaging upon a deeper connection with
spiritual friends and/or a spiritual community, living in an
inspiring spiritual environment, darshan (being in the presence
of enlightened beings human or otherwise), removing distractions
(aparigraha), tapas, isvara pranidhana (the practice of
listening for and surrendering to the eternal teacher/teachings
in All Our Relations, eating pure and sattvic food, assimilating
clean air and water (saucha), practicing the hatha yoga kriyas,
meditation, the practicing of the other yam/niyams such as found
in astanga yoga, the practice of layanam such as found in the
dharanas, etc. All these will act synergistically to empower
one's practice. See also Pada 2 for the practice of Tapas that
also kindles the spiritual flame when practice appears to sag.
Sutra 21 tivra-samveganam asannah Such practices will increase
the passion and strength of one's overall practice. Samadhi is
most close at hand and reachable (asannah) to those whose
passion (samveganam) for it is the most intense (tivra) for they
are less likely to be dissuaded from it). Those remain centered
in their core energy and claim their natural position in the
greater scheme of things. They find success, grace, and poise in
the greater integrity of All Our Relations which is always very
near. Sutra 22 Mrdu-madhyadhimatratvat tato'pi visesah Thus one
may further measure (visesah) one's momentum toward samadhi
dependent upon the strength of one's spiritual passion and focus
as to weak (mrdu), medium (madhya), or complete, ultimate, or
immeasurable (adhimatra). Commentary: Clearly Patanjali is
saying that if we are fickle in our passion for yoga, if we are
easily distracted or allured, unfocused and insincere in our
practice and intention, then our success in yoga will be delayed
or adversely affected. Conversely, if our practice and passion
for yoga is strong, enthusiastic, sincere, undivided, attentive,
and sublime, then success will be insured. Those who merely
dabble in yoga as a fad, fancy, or ego gratification will find
that they are wasting their time holding on to such an approach.
Through the aforesaid methods we eventually become naturally
ardent practitioners (samveganam) The nearer (asannah) we get to
realization, the closer aligned we are with our natural self,
the stronger (tivra) the intensity of natural inspiration,
enthusiasm, dedication, attentive devotion, and zealousness will
spontaneously manifest, so that self discipline becomes
completely transformed (adhimatra) where an effortless self
perpetuating divine passion manifests.
So as we become more dedicated to our practice in I.21-22 we
also become dedicated to realizing our highest potential or
highest self (purusa). Next, it is fitting that Patanjali
dedicates Sutra 23-29 to the practice of Isvara Pranidhana to
indicate that success is not a matter of individual will power
or individual intention alone, but rather it involves an
transpersonal but intimate affirmation. Also see the discussion
in pada II on isvara pranidhana as a niyama practice) as well as
Pada III-1 (Kriya Yoga). As a path of surrender to the ultimate
intimate transpersonal, isvara pranidhana, is a "non-practice"
practice as it is non-willful -- as in "thy will be done on
earth as it is in heaven". As such a sincere and dedicated
practice becomes equated with an inspired and devotional
practice (abhyasa). Sutra 23 isvara-pranidhanad va Or (va)
further progress is realized through surrender, dedication, or
devotion (pranidhanat) to the great all inclusive Integrity - to
the body of Great Belonging - the final and complete integration
which is the untainted Self without skew or blemish and which
knows not the limits of separateness (isvara pranidhana) -- the
Great Integrity of All Our Relations Commentary: Simply put we
surrender here to our highest potential or highest self (isvara).
One could also translate isvara pranidhana as the surrender of
the limited dualistic illusion of separateness and delusionary
self identifications in favor of the identification with the
Supreme Integrity or Self (purusa). Isvara is that which is not
capable of being defined, but Patanjali will give some of
isvara's characteristics in the succeeding sutras. Isvara is the
name given to our higher Self, who we really are when all the
vrtti are dissolved. This is thus a dedication of our small
"self" of limited consciousness to realizing our true "Self",
our higher or buddha potential. Yogis often surrender to the
lord of Yoga, Siva, while Buddhists surrender to the innate
Buddha nature. As tantric yoga developed, Maheshvara became
identified with Siva. Followers of Christ affirm the Christ
within and embody that, while the advanced yogis who have
realized their true self nature (swarupa) have surrendered to
Self -- they have remembered who they really are as the
manifestation of Infinite Love. Tat Tvam Asi. Svara means
master, while the word, ishta, means, special, precious, or
intimate. Another breakdown says that Is means command and vara
means eminent or precious, but the secret meaning is that Isvara
means the innermost teacher. Who is isvara, we will see next.
For more on Isvara see commentaries in Sutra 24-27 above, Pada
II: sutras 1 and 45. Sutra 24 Klesha-karma-vipakasayair
apara-mrshta purusa-visesa isvarah Isvara is the purest (a-para-mrshta)
aspect (visesa) of pure undifferentiated universal consciousness
(purusa) which is untouched and unaffected by taint (klesha),
karma, and the seed germs (asayair) that result (vipaka) from
ordinary desire and propensities. Commentary: Isvara is the one
purusa untouched by klesha, karma, results, or dormant seeds.
Isvara is formless. How does one perceive or conceptualize the
formless? Obviously this is not possible. It is beyond
perception and conception, yet it is available through direct
experience. Isvara is always available through isvara pranidhana
(see Pada II. Sutra I and 45). Always available, that is, if we
look for that formless grace as All Our Relations -- if we ask
for eternal and sacred spiritual presence to guide us at each
moment. Again we are "re-minded" that isvara is the highest
purusa (pure being). Reminded of Sutra 16 where Patanjali first
talks about purusa, it is vairagya which leads to param purusa.
Thus surrender to isvara and vairagya are two sides of the same
coin; i.e., losing the small self (ego identifications) while
simultaneously embracing and being embraced by expansive
non-dual reality of siva/sakti. "The Purusha is Divine, formless,
existing inside and outside, unborn, free from Prana and mind,
pure, and greater than the great unmanifest. Purusha is one who
fills all space or who resides in the cavity of the heart. The
Purusha is immaterial, and therefore, divine in nature. For the
same reason it is inside and outside. It is unborn because it is
causeless. It does not undergo any process such as of life and
its experiences.
The Universal Self knows without the ordinary Pramanas or proofs
of knowledge. Its knowledge does not consist in perception,
inference, verbal testimony or any kind of commonly known proof.
Worldly knowledge is relative and mediate. There is no necessity
for the cognitive or perceptive organs in the highest Self,
because in it knowledge consists in Self-realisation or
realisation of Itself. Even the distinction which is ordinarily
made between the sheaths of a person, cannot be made in the true
Self. Virat, Hiranyagarbha and Isvara are of the nature of Pure
Consciousness. The apparent distinction which is seen to exist
among these three aspects of the Divine Being, is more the
result of a convention or habit of the mind to find objectively
what it experiences in itself. Logically this distinction cannot
be proved, though it is simply believed in. Hence, the Upanishad
says that the Divine Being is without Prana or mind. The Pranas
and the mind are limiting factors, and therefore, they have no
basis in the unlimited Divine Being. The Mantras of the Vedas
and the declarations of the Upanishads which describe the Divine
Being as having heads, eyes, feet, etc., are only figurative,
meant to convey its universal nature. There is neither the
vibration of Iccha Sakti nor of Kriya Sakti in the Divine Being;
therefore, there are no sense-organs also. In short, there is
nothing in It which belongs to the special characteristic of the
individual."
Swami Krishnananda, on the Mundaka Upanishad, The Divine Life
Society, Rishikesh. Sutra 25 Tatra-nir-atishayam sarvajna-bijam
There (tatra) [isvara] is the seed and origin (bija) of absolute
(nir-atishayam), unsurpassed, and complete omniscience (sarvajna).
Commentary: See also Pada II.1 and II.45. Isvara is the all
inclusive and unlimited identification containing all
differentiations and diversity and their seeds (bijam) within
its most wholesome and all inclusive great integrity within the
non-dual realization of All Our Relations, wherein all feelings
of loneliness and incompleteness are fulfilled. By remembering
to practice we affirm and generate the "good mind" and
simultaneously embrace the profound "right view" beyond judgment,
methods of inference, willfulness, philosophical ideas,
conceptual artifice, or perception. Thus this"right" view is the
one beyond conception and any artifice. It is established
through direct spiritual experience and is thus due to the
dawning of the intrinsic light in authentic darshan untouched by
form, time, and limitation, Although religionists attempt to
limit isvara with names and form, Patanjali clearly indicates
that such tendencies are an externalized corruption by assigning
the meaning to a symbolic representation, while extracting the
meaningful experience from intimate experience. Here the yoga of
isvara pranidhana is the alignment and integration of divine
will with individual will, spirit with nature, grandfather Sun
with grandmother moon, consciousness with beingness (satchitananda),
sahasrara (crown) and muladhara (earth), pingala (ha) and ida (tha),
or siva/shakti in the sushumna (central channel). Sutra 26
purvesham api guruhkalena anavacchedat Unlimited by time (kalena)
this great integrity (anavacchedat) is the primal (purvesham)
eternal teacher (guru) even (api) the teacher of the most
ancient teachers. Being all inclusive, unlimited, and eternal (kalena),
Isvara is found within the unobscured instantaneous eternal
moment -- here and now -- ever accessible to the true devotee.
Commentary: Isvara pranidhana is a practice. HERE our every
intimate experience becomes our teacher when we ask for guidance
in the eternal moment by not identifying with false and limited
dualistic beliefs of separation (avidya), but rather when we see
eternal spirit as sacred presence in All Our Relations. This
Scared Presence is also called "being present". The teacher/teaching
is always HERE. The teacher/teaching is always HERE. The teacher/teaching
is always HERE.
The most common definition for the word, guru, in yoga circles
is the remover of the darkness, and in a secondary way, the guru
is the one who brings forth light and grace. In one sense then
all of our experiences and relationships act as our teachers (in
the long run), but certainly most of us appear to suffer from
the "hard" lessons not quickly learned that has brought about
some temporary darkness, avidya, and pain (dukha). When we
reside in sacred presence, HERE, when our HeartMind is open, we
are all learning our lessons. Thus everyone everywhere and
everything in is in this greater perspective our gurus -- in the
integrity which is All Our Relations. The true teacher thus
directs us back to the true Self within. That true teacher
resides in the cave of the heart. That said, in the the
classical orthodox Hindu guru-shishya -- parampara diksha system
the guru once evaluated and accepted is to be obeyed
unquestioningly and in complete surrender seeing her or him as a
manifestation of the Sat Guru. This interpretation of guru is
not what Patanjali is referring to. Rather in the Yoga System as
put forth by Patanjali the situation is quite different than
orthodox Brahmanism, where the guru is not even mentioned except
in this very sutra alone. Rather Patanjali refers to devotion to
the PRACTICE as the practice, and here there is surrender only
to the highest formless "Self" (purusa) in isvara pranidhana (which
becomes a constant practice). Patanjali suggests surrendering
directly to isvara, as it is said that isvara is the teacher
(guru) of even (api) the teacher of the most ancient teachers --
the darkness dispeller of the darkness dispellers. Isvara is the
innermost teacher and is always accessible inside. As such
isvara is our highest potential or said in another way, our
innate Buddha nature, or yet in other words, the eternal teacher
(Sat Guru) as the light removes the darkness. In yoga, the
practice (isvara pranidhana) is indeed the teaching, the
teaching is in the practice, and the teacher is in the teaching.
Every time we do the practice in an attentive way all of this
comes together (if we are lucky) in our own embodiment of it
(more or less). So practically Patanjali tells us that
worshipping idols, books, or external teachers is dissociative
and distracting unless they point us back to the eternal light
which resides within. We can thus look at each of our yoga
teachers as reflections of isvara or purusa (as their true
nature) and try to allow that light to brighten us up (Sri) as
much as the pre-existing darkness of our conditioned mind (in
its habitual mode of ignorance) can allow. This is darshan
acknowledging the inner light in All Our Relations. In a similar
way all our interactions with the trees, stars, moon, other
animals, star systems, and formless dimensions also are our
teachers reflecting the eternal light -- the darshan of all the
teachers and enlightened ones of all times. HERE we surrender at
all times to the ever present teacher. This is pure grace to
allow this to be continuous.
Sutra 27 Tasya vachakah pranavah Isvara is expressed and
represented (vachakah) by the vibratory energy contained in the
pranava (the sacred syllable, om). Commentary: Isvara can not be
defined or limited because Isvara by definition is indefinable
infinite mind, however he can be symbolically represented by the
expression of pranava - by the vibratory essence that the sacred
sound, om, approximates. Thus isvara is often accessed through
the pranava which is om. Tasya means "it". Vacakah means "expression"
from the root vac to speak. Pranavah means "the sacred syllable
AUM" derived from "pra" (before) and nava (from the root,
sound). So the straight translation is simply, Its' (referring
to isvara as the teacher of all the teachers as discussed in the
previous three sutras) expression is the pranavah (the sacred
sound).Notice Patanjali himself never mentions AUM, but rather
pranava. It is also of interest that Patanjali does not say
"word", but rather pranava, sacred "sound". Who can really say
adequately in words, what is essentially ineffable, an all
encompassing supramundane transgalactic Reality which exists by
itself unable to be boxed in by human words, concepts, or
fabrication. IM by definition is infinite, it's boundaries can
not be defined or limited because it has none. Thus to try to
define it is both counterproductive and impossible (not that we
don't try sometimes :blush ) . So to define any word that
represents IM or God would depreciate it/demean it, and that is
why I believe that the name of God is sacred and unutterable.
Words are by definition symbolic representations for things --
it is not the thing itself. Like looking at a map is not the
same thing as experiencing subjectively the here and now of the
territory (as in the well known adage the map is not the
territory), words likewise (although useful at times) can and do
tend to over objectify our situation, create separation, and
reinforce dualistic thinking (dualistic conceptualization is
impossible without words or symbolic logic). Simply put, words
and concepts may be useful for some tasks, but in meditation or
yoga they are counter-productive tending to hold up the
separation and duality.
So the question then, is AUM an exception? As a sadhana (practice)
I agree with Patanjali, it can be effective, but like all
practices, I question whether it is the integrative experience
itself. The universe may indeed be pregnant with AUM --
permeating all of space and emptiness -- or it may be deafening
silent -- or it may well be far beyond sound itself (some
animals do not have ears). So from my limited experience of
Infinite Mind (isvara), I think that the intoning of AUM is
still a
conveyer, a pathway, a sadhana which leads us into the greater
vibration, pulsation, and inter-dimensional energetic hologram
which has no beginning or end -- where both sound and words have
little meaning. Some commentators who see God in all religions
try to show how they all point to the same living Spirit. So in
the West it is often attempted to take examples from from
Judeo-Christian texts as well "In the beginning there was the
word, and the Word was with God, and the word was God". Such has
been hacked over literally by thousands of scholars, but to this
commentator the relevance to this sutra means that there is a
creative and meaningful vibration of God/from God at the time of
creation (big bang) -- AT THAT MOMENT between non-creation and
creation, a meaning to life or "word" emerged -- a word thus was
spoken -- is BEING SPOKEN NOW as creation/evolution as the
creative evolutionary energy (shakti). But this is not an
ordinary word, as we may find in English, Hebrew, or even
Sanskrit as it was not pronounced by man in the beginning. I
believe is all we can do is hear THAT and maybe sing a long a
bit. Thus if I concentrate on the pranava, AUM, it is a powerful
sound capable of leading me into dhyana or samadhi. One can take
many directions from HERE but first I'd like to acknowledge that
in Sanskrit which is a highly developed phonetic language -- in
Sanskrit linguistic structure, the word, AUM, can be proved to
convey all the other sounds in the alphabet -- all possible
sounds that human's can make. As such (and Hindus take the
Sanskrit language and script as being sacred), AUM represents
more than the whole. One would have to study Sanskrit to go
further and such is beyond the scope of this translation.
However Patanjali is going for a universal and eternal Truth in
isvara, beyond man's language and culture. To be fair the Jews
for example, believe the same thing about the Hebrew language
and their bible. There are huge volumes of books written trying
to figure out the right pronunciation of the word, for God,
(some call it Jehovah) as they also believe that it is sacred.
Other religions (including native American) believe that their
language is also sacred and that the word for the creator has
great transformative power as well. So in presenting yoga sutra
(I.27) to Westerners in terms that they may understand (Judeo-Christian)
may often miss what patanjali is really saying here. Patanjali
actually said that the pranava is the expression of isvara --
the omniscient teacher of all the teachers. Practically speaking
however all vital and living religions agree, that is to focus
on the creator in creation. That is spiritual practice. So the
practical meaning would be the same i.e., practice intoning aum
and/or listening for aum as the self existing expression of
isvara (the divine purusha).
Patanjali is thus offering this sutra as one practice that may
be effective in clearing out the vrttis and obscurations leading
us eventually to Infinite Mind. Sutra 28 taj-japas
tad-artha-bhavanam Through generating (bhavanam) constant
repetition (taj-japa) of the pranava (om) the meaning (artha)
behind the sound is realized and becomes manifest (bhavanam).
Commentary: The vibratory energy contained in the vibration of
the sound, Om (the pranava), connects with isvara. Japa means
the repetition of mantra, in this case the sound of OM. Thus
japa (mantra repetition of om) is given as a practice. Much is
available elsewhere on the significance of the vibratory nature
of OM and how to practice japa. One simple suggestion is to
allow the AUM to be expressed in three parts after inhaling deep
into the core, i.e., Ahhh rising up from the depths through the
abdomen and chest and back of throat OOO rising through the
throat to the top of the palate and on to the crown MMM
finishing the SHAPE of the sound labially -- all as a natural
energetic expression of isvara at the crown.
Experiment with the various effects of the different rhythms,
durations, speeds, strengths, and locations of the breath and
sound energy. There exist many ways to practice japa, all
producing different effects. It is pointed out (contrary to
orthodox Vedism) that this is the only mantra that Patanjali
recommends in the entire Yoga Sutras. Sutra 29 tatah
pratyak-cetanadhigamo'py antarayabhavash ca Thence through the
practice of the pranava, aum, as a dedication toward realizing
isvara (through isvara pranidhana) consciousness (cetana) is
redirected inwards (pratyak) toward the realization (adhigamo)
of the intrinsic light of consciousness (pratyak-cetana-adhigamo)
and (ca) also (api) obstacles and hindrances (antarayah) are
thus removed (abhava).
Commentary: By practicing surrender to our highest potential
Self, then obstacles, hindrances, blockages, psychic lesions,
and such are uncovered, dissolved, eradicated, or transformed
while the cit-prana is reunited and brought back from its
wandering distractions to Source -- to the infallible implicate
guide/teacher which awaits us all as an innate ever-present
effulgence. This practice is a two way street -- redirecting (pratyak)
light and consciousness (cetana) to Source -- Source shining
forth in our embodiment -- and embodiment to Source, which when
the pathway is cleared out, then the natural flow as natural
innate wisdom can be brought forth and manifest. This flow or
divine pulsation (spanda) is actually non-dual, neither
exclusively "from" Source (crown) to embodiment (muladhara), nor
exclusively from embodiment to eternal source, but rather
simultaneous Both/And. This is one way we "re-mind" the small
and limited mindset of the greater reality of the greater
holographic whole (Self) or purusa. This practice of redirecting
the consciousness to Source not only removes obstacles, but
allows the inner light to shines forth even more in All Our
Relations. The more the inner light illumines the path, the more
the obstacles fall away. At the end all is seen as Self in All
Our Relations. Now begins the practices which remove the
obstacles and distractions of the citta allowing entrance into
absorption into the deeper and more continuous experience of
samadhi (Sutras 30-51) Sutra I. 30
Vyadhi-styana-samsaya-pramadalasya-virati-bhranti-darsanalabdhabhumi-katvanavasthitatvani
citta-viksepas te'ntarayah The distractions of the mind field (citta-viksepas)
and obstacles (antarayah) to samadhi [which are removed by the
above practice] are: 1) disease (vyadhi) 2) doubt, uncertainty,
hesitation, inhibition, lack of self worth (samshaya) 3)
fixation, stagnation, rigidity, stubbornness, stupor, dullness,
inertia, and procrastination (styana) 4) carelessness or
negligence (pramada) 5) laziness and languor (alasya) 6)
frivolousness, dissipation of energy and consciousness into
meaningless sense indulgence or distractions, attraction to
external objects or the involvement in the dual world of I-it
illusion, externalized or materialistic consciousness (a-virati)
[the opposite of pratyhara] 7) false views, false beliefs, false
identifications, conclusions, adherence to blind and/or stubborn
beliefs, confusion, and delusion (bhranti-darshana)
8) ungroundedness, poiselessness, fickleness, wandering, state
of being lost or in transition, not present, agitation,
constantly shifting positions, chronically clueless, spaced out
or bipolar, the inability to rest or return to in one's core
energy or poise (a-labdha-bhumikatva) 9) and instability,
imbalance, stage of oscillation, uncenteredness, in general not
being able to be still (an-avasthitatvani). Commentary: When the
cit-prana is distracted, distorted, and/or dissipated all sorts
of imbalances and difficulties arise. These are the hindrances
that are removed by the practice of isvara pranidhana and/or
through focused repetition of isvara's' sound, the pranava,
which brings us into isvara's realm. Sutra I. 31
Dukha-daurmanasyangamejayatva-svasa-prasvasa viksepa-sahabhuvah
The symptoms or manifestations of this distracted state (viksepa)
are concomitant to (saha-bhuvah) mental suffering (dukha);
psychic frustration, despair, and anguish (daurmansya); turmoil,
unsteadiness, and/or physical unstableness (angam-ejayatva); and
rough, uneven, and.or erratic breathing (svasa-prasvasa).
Commentary: When we get distracted from our true purpose, goal,
vital energetics, or alignment with Source, then we lose
alignment with Self and its restorative and regenerative powers
that establish well being and health. This state of distraction
is unfortunately the normal state of ordinary neurotic people (dukha),
being extracted into the external physical dualistic world
versus living in the innate synchronicity an alignment with a
living spirituality. The symptoms of general nervousness and
anxiety are the natural consequences (saha-bhuvah) of this
suffering (dukha) state which is caused by being caught up in
distractive activities (viksepa) in general. Please notice the
importance that Patanjali ascribes to distraction as effecting
an unsteady, uneven, or rough unbalanced breathing. As we refine
our awareness on the breath with practice we become more
conscious of when our breathing changes in relationship to or
emotions and state of mind. Here we will discover also that
making the breathing refined, even, steady and continuous, all
the distractions (viksepa) can be remediated.
Especially in chapter two, Sadhana Pada, Patanjali gives
practices (sadhana) that reclaims our distracted energy and
consciousness (cit-prana) and returns it inside to kindle the
yogic process of self realization. All yoga practices are
designed to do so, but more specifically here in sutra 31, if
one feels distracted (viksepa) , one may recommend dharana (concentration
and visualization processes), pratyhara (bringing the cit-prana
inside thus preventing it from wandering, pranayama (extending
the essential evolutionary energy through conscious breath
work), asana, and meditation (dhyana). Such practices are a
combination of astanga yoga as outlined in Sadhana Pada, but
also many similar practices that produce similar results can be
found in the various samyama practices as outlined in chapter 3,
Vibhuti Pada. Sutra I. 32 Tat-pratishedhartham eka-tattvabhyasah
Therefore (tat) the remedy (pratishedha) [for these obstacles (viksepa)]
is ever increasing our practice (abhyasa) of one pointed
dedication and devotion to the truth (eka-tattvabhyasa) -- the
continued focused practice of rooting out those obstacles of
self delusion, and letting go of falsehood. Commentary: In this
sutra Patanjali describes the practice of eka-tattvabhyasah as
removing the obstacles (viksepa) by bringing together of one's
focus in a one pointed dedication to the eternal truth of the
Great Integrity -- the Reality of the All in the One and the One
in the All (eka-tattva) as the practice (abhyasa) of isvara
pranidhana (surrender and dedication to our highest potential as
That). See I.23-26, Pada II.2 and II.45. There is but one
underlying intent or purpose here; i.e., to allow for the
continuous flow of Divine Grace or Consciousness uninterruptedly.
This is realized in a a non-dual transpersonal and continuous
non-interrupted flow throughout all the koshas, chakras, nadis,
strota, marmas, and multi-dimensional fields of infinite
consciousness up into to Hiranyagarbha kosha, not as a separate
or personal realization. Otherwise it would not be the Great
Integrity/Yantra at all. Tat Tvam Asi -- All Our Relations.
Sutra I. 33 maitri-karuna-muditopeksanam
sukha-dukha-punyapunya-vishayanam bhavanatas citta-prasadanam By
generating and cultivating the intent and deep feelings (bhavanatas)
of friendliness and loving kindness (maitri), love and
compassion (karuna), happiness (mudita), equanimity (upeksanam)
and sympathetic joyfulness (sukha) in [all] conditions and
events (visayanam) whether it be potentially joyful (sukha) or
painful (dukha), auspicious (punya-apunya) or not, a sweet grace
arises that establishes a clarity of the heartmind (citta-prasadanam).
Commentary: The cultivation (bhavanatas) of these sentiments of
friendliness and loving kindness (maitri), love (karuna),
sympathetic joy and desire for the happiness of others (mudita),
and equanimity (upeksanam) toward all beings and events
regardless if people are happy or suffering, the events
auspicious or inauspicious (punya-apunya) or whatever their
conditional circumstances (visayanam) may be, the underlying
serenity and clarity of the citta (citta-prasadanam) is always
cultivated and
thus can manifest. This powerful practice or cultivation (bhavanatas)
as a attitudinal stance toward all beings and things in all
circumstances will help maintain serenity and keep us centered
in the heart (chitta-prasadanam). It will counteract polar
imbalances of pleasure (sukha) or pain (dukha) caused by
external events (visayanam), and prove to considerably enhance
the continuous experience of the Eternal Reality -- of All Our
Relations. This is a two way practice (citta-prasadanam) in that
we both cultivate it and it manifests through us. The embodiment
of maitri, mudita, karuna, and upeksanam reflects, reveals, and
discloses an underlying universal non-dual and transpersonal
consciousness reflecting Self in all and as all. When the "good
mind" or heart/mind has been sufficiently purified and clarified
by this practice, when we sufficiently see who we really are and
are able to somewhat better reside in our true nature. When one
has applied maitri, mudita, karuna, and upeksanam as skillful
means in All Our Relations, then from that clarified Heart-Core
Consciousness such emanates spontaneously and naturally as
divine expression. As such it is an effective remedy for
distractions of the mind (citta-viksepas). These practices
summed up correspond to the Buddhist Four Boundless Minds which
are compassion, loving kindness, equanimity, and sympathetic joy.
All these are designed as remedies (pratisedha) for our
fundamental distraction (viksepa) from our true nature (swarupa).
See also the commentary to Sutra I.19 (the practice of
bhava-pratyaya). To clarify this, upeksanam (equanimity) does
not mean a bland indifference or neutral withdrawal or attitude
toward people or the world. It does not just mean evenmindedness,
but rather it reflects one who has become stabilized around an
innate happiness (citta-prasadanam) where one is not bothered,
overly excited, troubled, pained (dukha), or unbalanced by
outside events or people, but remains unaffected by such
influences while being deeply rooted and centered in HeartMind
awareness. Here he can see all beings and things -- in All Our
Relations from this deeply centered place of Grace. Here it is
clear that Patanjali is suggesting that we do not condemn the
nonvirtuous (apunya), be dismayed by those causing suffering (dukha),
nor praise the virtuous (punya) or the those who create
happiness (sukha). It is more than enough to rest and abide in
citta-prasadanam where sweet grace flows forth without
obstruction. To that end friendliness, compassion, sympathetic
joy, and equanimity are never lost.
Taken as a whole chitta-prasadanam is a profound practice in
itself. At the base level it can refer to a mind-field (citta)
which is innately wholesome and non-afflictive. Abiding in that,
then zero negative karma is generated. In fact citta-prasadanam
is the sum total result of maitri, karuna, mudita, and upeksanam.
As such it is available as a remedy for all afflictions (kleshas)
and negative propensities. On a practical level we can apply
this in all our relations (visayanam). Citta-prasadanam as a
practice removes all obstacles and interruptions of clarity. How
often have you seen yourself become angry, upset, irritated,
depressed, jealous, or other wise afflicted by the kleshas? For
most people these afflictions are deeply imbedded (in the
samskaras) and must be flushed out in order for liberation to
occur. As they are kleshic, they are also have karmic
consequences. Thus flushing them out purifies the negative karma
as well. Many suffer from these kleshas chronically (such as in
chronic depression, anger, irritation, etc). Hence Patanjali is
presenting us with a remedy that reminds us to practice
citta-prasadanam as a pleasant and positive non-afflictive
mindfield devoid of negativity whenever we recognize an
affliction. Thus the application of maitri (loving kindness and
friendliness), karuna (love and compassion), mudita (sympathetic
joy), and upeksanam (equanimity toward others and all events)
will be propitious in all our relations (visayam) so that
citta-prasadanam is effected (bhavanatas). On another more
profound level one could consider these activities to cause
citta-prasadanam as a wholistic manifestation of uninterrupted
flow from the param-purusha or Siva. Thus the sadhak places
one's mind-stream into direct connection with Divine
Auspiciousness (Maheshvara or Siva) and receives his sweet
blessing manifesting as a spontaneous outpouring,
citta-prasadanam, as sweet Divine Grace. Sutra I. 34
Pracchardana-vidharanabhyam va pranasya Or (va) through
controlling the expiration (pracchardana) and retention (vidharanabhyam)
of energy (pranasya) [the mind can be purified, clarified, and
stabilized while grace also is evinced -- citta-prasadanam is
brought forward]. Commentary: Or we can remediate (pratisedha)
the distraction and interruptions (viksepa) of the
citta-prasadanam (the graceful flow divine consciousness
stemming from the param-purusha or Maheshvara) directly through
working with the expiration and letting the interruption of the
flow of divine consciousness empty and die, thus getting down to
the underlying core energetics wherein the distractions of the
ordinary mind and emotions causally rides.
Here we are not merely discussing the control of the outward
bound breath (pracchardana) alone, but more so the outward bound
energy, as the exhalation corresponds to outward flowing of
energy which in turn correlated directly to the dissipation and
distraction of prana and consciousness (cit-prana). Thus a key
practice in yoga is given by Patanjali here; i.e., the
remediation and regulation of suffering and distraction by
retaining the energy (prana) inside, rather than simply a
practice of controlling or holding the breath out (bahya
kumbhaka). Pracchardana also means to vomit out or to expire.
The word, prana, can be broken down to "pra", meaning to bring
forth; while "na" means vibration. Prana is the underlying
energy of all existence as well as consciousness. As such it is
the animating principle of Spirit as it manifests in the body.
We have mentioned previously and will mention it again that it
is a law of existence that where the mind's attention goes, so
does one's energy. Taken as a unit, this is called the cit-prana.
Here Patanjali is saying that by controlling the outflow of the
prana and regulating that, then the citta is stabilized,
clarified, and readied for samadhi. This works with the
underlying energy behind the negative thought patterns and
allows us to release them. Thus the outflow of the breath, being
associated with release, it is used to release the negative
energy, thoughts, and emotions which interrupt the Divine
mind-stream. Since breath is related to our basic energy, in
this light then, we can also understand how we can can regulate
the cit-prana and soothe and clarify the mind by bringing our
awareness back to the exhalation of the breath and the
regulation of the breath. This will bring freshness and
clarification to the mindstream. Thus as a practical method as
in meditation and in daily life, we can go back to the breath as
a gross way of redirecting our awareness from outward flows
toward sense objects (vishaya) or external events (visayanam) so
in turn preventing any interruption of the Divine mood or
chitta-prasadanam. Thus in meditation we release the negative
thought with the exhalation (pracchardana) and holding it
outside gently (vidharanabhyam). Thus Patanjali refers to the
emphasis on the exhalation to release negative thoughts or
attachment in general so it gently dissolves into a subtle
external release into emptiness. This is akin to the well known
Buddhist practice of Patanjali's day called anapana-sati which
observes the breath, except here in Sutra I.24 the expulsion
process is emphasized to effect release. In laya yoga, one can
add the visualization of blackish air to the exhalation and
whitish air to the inhalation, sounds and so forth, eventually
seeking through the breath heightened balance, equipoise,
equality, self supporting mutual steadiness, symmetry,
synchronicity, synergy, and continuity permeating body, breath,
energy, and mind with the greater mindfield. However this works
far better if we keep in mind that this is an indirect
substitute for the direct regulation of the primary cit-prana by
the param-purusa, Maheshvara as are all practices. In fact the
practices are necessary precisely because this divine breath has
become discontinuous.
This is why success in pranayama (see Pada II: Sutras 49-53) is
entirely dependent upon first developing a direct experiential
sensitivity to and conscious relationship with the prana and its
source. After practice one realizes that the wavelike operations
of the mind (cit-vrtti) are dependent upon the operations of the
prana. the vibrations of the prana are available through the
vibrations in the air. By refining the air and prana -- by
making then increasingly subtle, eventually the mind opens up to
its vast potential. This requires a requisite amount of direct
experiential sensitivity -- of inner wisdom. As the mind empties,
as the breath empties, as the prana becomes less than subtle (empty),
as the mental objects dissolve, then samadhi dawns as we are
filled with Divine vibration (spanda). Further practice thus
focuses cultivating this samadhi to be continuous without
interruption. As an extension of this see the practices of
pranayama (energy extension) and pratyhara (balancing and
cultivating the awareness/attention and biopsychic energy and
moving such for inner transformation) in Pada II and the
practice of dharana in Pada III. Sutra I. 35 Vishayavati va
pravrttir utpanna manasah sthiti-nibandhani Concentrating the
individual mind (manas) on a specified object (vishayavati)
prevents (nibandhani) the birth (utpanna) of the further vrtti (pravrttir).
This gates (nibandhani) the wanderings of the ordinary mind and
thus steadies (sthiti) it by creating a continuity [which
removes the infirmities of mind]. Commentary: If the ordinary
dualistic mind (manas) wanders from one thought object to
another (vishayavati), one way to bind and redirect it and thus
gain steadiness of the mind, while preventing the wavering cycle
of attaching to an endless succession of further attachments, is
to focus the wandering mind from attachment to sense objects (vishayavati)
through techniques (usually through concentrating on one object
only). This tames the waves of the vrtti and causes a stability
(sthiti) of the ordinary mind (manas), thus allowing it a chance
to calm down and become clarified. Although here the vrtti are
not destroyed but simply pacified and reduced, there is still
attachment to an object present, never-the-less the mind has
been stilled quickly and easily through this simple
implementation. Thus manasah sthiti-nibandhani firmly
establishes the mind in a stable base made fit for meditation.
It is another practice in which one unites and focuses the
cit-prana in order to cultivate samadhi.
Two parallel corresponding techniques in astanga yoga (expounded
in Pada II and Pada III) are pratyhara and dharana. Pratyahara
is bringing one's attention, energy, and awareness back inside
and up to one's internal energy self regulatory centers. Dharana
is concentration which is a preliminary to dhyana. In dharana
the sadhak (practitioner) first focuses the mind on external (coarse)
objects of the senses (vishaya) such as candles, flowers,
pictures, mantra (japa), mandalas, tip of the nose, etc. Later
one focuses on the more subtle and internal objects such as the
breath, the chakras, the energy bodies, yantras, internal and/or
psychic sounds, bandhas, mudras, etc. One is able to move from
the gross (vitarka) to the more subtle (vicara) and eventually
dissolve this inherently dualistic object orientation allowing
us to then enter into the transpersonal non-dual space where
meditation. From this stillness of mind the other techniques of
yoga can be applied to move one even closer to objectless and
formless samadhi eventually taking one step at a time. In our
path to samadhi, we can first steady the wandering mind (manas)
and our wandering internal energies by first limiting its
excursions, then through concentration (dharana) on chosen
objects that reflect the innate wisdom, then we gradually
removing all object relationships, attachments, limitations, and
impositions of duality as we go from the coarse and outer to the
subtle and inner and then beyond even the most subtle -- all
inclusive of both inner and outer -- the ultimate samadhi,
nirbij-samadhi. Sutra I. 36 visoka va jyotismati [Concentration]
through the cultivation of the inner light (jyotismati) of clear
lucidity that knows no sorrow (visoka) removes the infirmities
of the ordinary mind (manas). Commentary: Another simple method
of clarifying the restless mind is to "re-mind" oneself of the
innate light (prakasa) of clear lucidity within all things which
liberates afflictions and suffering. All this will help create
clarity, self confidence, remove obscurations and dross, and
thus prepare the mind for meditation and samadhi. Here awareness
is turned back into its Source. This magnifies the light
exponentially. This sutra is a clear reference to an innate
eternal unconditional joy and ultimate happiness that is not
dependent upon events and our reactions to them or judgment.
Make no mistake! Sutra I. 37 Vita-raga-visayam va cittam Also
from cultivation, association, and intercourse with and/or
reflection of (visayam) those dear friends of the path who have
achieved release (vita-raga). Those whose HeartMind's who have
achieved clear lucidity, mirror that back into our own lives --
they act as clear channels and vehicles of its further
expression.
Commentary: Especially in the beginning of our spiritual
practice when the pathways call to be opened up -- when the mind
still is heavily addicted and afflicted with kleshas and vrtti,
it is very helpful to not only to associate with spiritual
friends who are on the path who reflect, reinforce, and remind
us of light, love, clarity, and grace, but also to avoid people
and situations who being dominated by their own kleshas
(ignorance, fears, jealousies, hatred, anger, desire, greed, and
the like) might reinforce our negative tendencies and illusions.
Before each and every practice if not throughout the day, the
yogis of the three times who have passed through the veil -- the
beings of eternal light are available for help if we ask for it
and invite them in (invoke them). Sutra I. 38
Svapna-nidra-jnanalabanam va Or (va) cultivation of wisdom of
direct experience (jnana) is available while sleeping (nidra)
turning normal dreams (svapna) into lucid dreams (jananalabanam).
Commentary; Every night we sleep and dream. This is a wonderful
opportunity when the will, the intellect, and limited belief
systems rest and no longer dominate our experience. Normally
when this limitation disappears, our cognitive faculty is given
up as well so that the dreams are not integrated, but are
relegated to a subconscious level. But if we are able to relax
the the mind while remaining conscious, then this knowledge (janam-alabanam)
gleaned from the dream state augments our lucidity in daily
life. The lucidity that links both dream and ordinary
wakefulness is eventually disclosed as the clear light that
knows no sorrow. Sutra I. 39 Yathabhimata-dhyanad va Or (va)
from an agreeable, suitable, and customized meditation (dhyana)
as one is drawn to (abhimata), [all of these practices will
ripen the mind for samadhi]. Commentary: Va means or. thus this
sutra is the last of a list of practices that prepares the mind
(citta-vrtti) for samadhi. Yatha is simply an indicative meaning,
"as". Thus the key word is abhimata-dhyanad. Abhimata means
drawn to, desired, longed for, or wished for. Dhyana is most
often translated as meditation. By meditation Patanjali means
silent seated practice where the mind is extended (tanata) from
subject/object duality. See Yoga Sutra II.11 and III.2 for more
on dhyana. The literal translation is ―or from meditation as
longed for/drawn to‖ which indicates a natural type of
meditation or pure abiding.
There are many types of meditation differing in specific
characteristics of preparation, beginning, duration, finishing,
etc. Here Patanjali is saying that one shoe does not fit all and
there is no exclusive supreme method, but one must explore and
choose the method of meditation which the HeartMind is attuned
to the most -- the one which brings forth clarity and peace and
leads toward samadhi. Why not utilize all these? One thus needs
to customize one's personal meditation practice to make it fit
into one's unique circumstances in order for it to serve your
highest potential. All the following sutras in Samadhi Pada
refer to realizing the supreme goal of yoga, nirbija samadhi,
through the process of meditation (dhyana). Make no mistake
about it! Sutra I. 40 Paramanu-parama-mahattvanto'sya vashikarah
The deepening and extension of this accomplishment (vashikarah)
[of meditation] will extend into and include the smallest (most
finite) atom (parama-anu) and also unto the whole of creation or
the greater whole (mahattva, antah, asya). Commentary: Through
the knowledge gained from meditation by knowing our own mind,
the practitioner gets to know the true nature of all finite (anu)
phenomenon from the most minute (anu) to the most large (mahattvanto)
extending into the very limits (antah) of existence (parama).
Here the instrument of seeing has been perfected to the point
that the lens no longer creates a distortion. Things then are
perceived as they are by a mind that has reached lucidity
through meditation, but at this stage the true nature of the
mind is still not known, just the nature of "things". When they
are known in the holographic sense -- in terms of the objectless,
formless (nirguna) non-dual siva/sakti wholeness, then a freedom
from their influence is established (vasikarah). Such extrinsic
situations can no longer negatively influence the mind and thus
nirbija samadhi will be near. All objects are held together by
energy fields. Even the physicists know that what we call the
physical or solid world is really all moving/fluid being
comprised of empty space, electrons, neutrons, protons, and such,
all configured in specific energy patterns forming the
characteristics of what we call elements, compounds, DNA, cells,
tissues, organs, glands, nerves, brains, animals, people, and
objects of perception -- all a product of millions of years of
co-evolution emanating from Source. All of creation is moving/dancing
and can only be fully related to as a whole -- in context of All
Our Relations. A problem of cognitive dissonance and
fractualization arises when the conditioned dualistic mind
artificially attempts to freeze this process through conditioned
thought patterns (vrtti), but through meditation this
fascination with the physical is abandoned and eventually
dislodged. We then become free from the illusion of materiality.
Solid matter as apparent physical "objects" then becomes only a
small minded and limited way of seeing things, identifying,
and/or relating.
In meditation as the dualistic fixations with apparently
separate objects fade, they are gradually replaced by the the
universal vision which penetrates and unites the spaces between
the smallest atom and the wholeness of the entire created
universe all the way to Source. In short, through effective
meditation practices all dualistic fixations of objective
knowledge eventually become dislodged as clarified Heart
Consciousness as universal non-dual awareness arises. First
extrinsic or coarse perception is noticeably improved and one is
able to separate the actual event or situation from any
emotional/samskaric reaction to it. Later the samskaric seeds
themselves are removed through continued practice. This is
another reference to the liberating power of remembering or
affirming the Great Integrity in All Our Relations -- The
inherent implicate order of the All and Everything found in the
Great Integrity and that One that is contained in everything.
Such is the multidimensional non-dualistic holographic reference
field that is indigenous/inherent, natural/unconditioned,
unlimited/universal and not contrived or biased in anyway. That
is at the same time a sutric reference to the profound
experiential unity of the micro/macrocosm. Sutra I. 41
Ksina-vrtter abhijatasye va maner grahitr-grahana-grayeshu
tat-stha-tad-an janata samapattih When the vrtter (machinations,
iperations, agitations, spinnings, and coloring of the
mind-field) have become almost entirely stilled, dissolved, or
considerably subsided (kshina), then a stable and still (tat-stha)
alignment and synchronicity (samapattih) between the seer (grahitr),
the seen (grahyeshu), and the process of seeing (grahana) is
attainable (tat-stha). This is to say that the deep state of
integrity (tad-an janata samapattih) between the process of
cognition, that which is cognized and the cognizer is stabilized,
bridged, brought together, and harmonized (samapatti) so that
instead of operating as separate cognitive functions they evolve
into and activate what was a previously a dormant
trans-cognitive non-dual function, so that the the preexisting
individual colorings (tat-stha-tad-an janata) of the mind are
now transformed to reflect a greater light likened (iva) to a
nobly born transparent radiance (abhijatasye) of a crest jewel (manes).
Commentary: Here the conditioned state of the vrttis have become
weakened and thus the illusory dualistic and fragmented splits
of a delusional separate or "small self" identification of the
"I - it" of the gross physical sense world falls away,
simultaneously as this samapatti (attainment) coalesces
cleansing the ordinary mind so that the pure citta as HeartMind
can flow through. Here the Clear Light of the Immanent Universal
Citta of the Great Integrity of All Our Relations shines through
a partially cleansed or translucent mind like the colorings of a
highly polished and reflective jewel (maneh). One no longer is
fixated upon the object and the seer, nor the object and the
seer, nor the process of seeing, because those limitations based
in duality have become liberated by a clarified and stabilized
Heart Consciousness, yet
Universal Clear lIght has not yet fully dawned, because even
this attainment is seen as limited fixation which although
expansive must still be further purified. So when through
authentic yogic practice then, the negative influences of the
vrttis (spinning of the discolored/tainted consciousness) become
weakened, thus allowing the light of pure undistorted
consciousness (citta) to shine forth even more. Christopher
Chapple in his book; The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali", Sat Guru
Publ. Delhi, 1990 comments: "[The accomplished mind] of
diminished fluctuations, like a precious (or clear) jewel
assuming the color of any near object. has unity among grasper,
grasping, and grasped." See also Sutras II.20 and II.21 Sutra I.
42 Tatra shabdartha-jnana-vikalpaih sankirna sa-vitarka
samapattih This is because (tatra) when knowledge (jnana) of an
apparently separate object (artha) is produced through the
process of mixing together (sankirna) words or naming (shabda)
with processes of mere conceptualization and reasoning (vikalpaih),
then an unsteady and vacuous state of coarse over
objectification (savitarka samapatti) is produced [which
prevents/interferes with the establishment of total integration
in samadhi]. Commentary: Jnana-vikalpa is conceptionally based
knowledge is based on specific meanings derived from words (shabdartha).
It is a limited kind of knowledge which may have application in
certain technological applications, but is an impediment when
applied incessantly in yoga practice. Conceptualization,
imagination, and daydreaming (vikalpa) is defined by Patanjali
as vrttis. When fed with the fuel of words (shabda) they
reinforce vrttis even more (see I-6). These are the components
of vikalpa (conceptual constructs and the discursive ramblings
of the monkey mind) which as all of the sutras clearly indicate
must be remediated for the inner consciousness to shine forth.
Ordinarily one becomes locked into habitual disconnection or
spiritual estrangement. It becomes habitual and the normal
individual mistakenly concludes that it is even necessary. This
is one belief based on false ideas and conceptual processes (vikalpa)
that must cease for spiritual progress to unfold. It produces
unsteadiness in regard to the deeper state of non-dual union/absorption
(in nirbija-samadhi) -- actually drawing us out from its
completion. In meditation we learn how to let go of the the
coarse oscillation (vitarka) toward various external separately
defined objects of attention uphold the duality (the duality of
the illusion of the separateness of an object, the observer of
the object, and the process of observing). This process occurs
in the mindstream of the novice meditator. Such coarseness (vitarka)
interferes with the most subtle and beyond even the most subtle
realms of consciousness which eventually must be pierced in
yoga. So here the meditator must become conscious of the
mistaken coarse fixations of the mental processes, how they
arise and cease one after another, and how to release the
process. This is done at first simply by noticing the process as
it arises. Later, one gains insight, through the practice itself
-- through awareness of the awareness. The prefix, sa, means "with"
or accompanied by. Vitarka means coarse or gross. So savitarka
means thought processes that are based on gross or physical
objectification -- physical objective or dualistic thoughts
based on events in the objective world. This will later be
differentiated from nir-vitarka (devoid of such an
externalization) and savicara (subtle thoughts based on internal
objects of thought itself). In other words the beginners energy
and attention gets drawn out and distracted into the objective
frameworks of the external world. We mistakenly think this
dualistic distraction is reality and so the individual's
conditioned mind has been trained to cling to it, but we can use
yogic practices to uncondition/remediate such distractions. We
start then with the gross/coarse or physical objects/objectification
processes (vitarka). Then we work toward the more subtle (vicara)
which are the awareness of the thought process itself as objects
of attention. That too must be seen as a distraction eventually.
When all coarse and subtle thought processes cease (nirvitarka
and nirvicara) then and only then, can the clear light of the
natural mind spontaneously arise. This statement is not a
statement of faith or belief, but comes from direct yogic
experience. is not Thus Patanjali is identifying an obstruction
to realizing non-dual samadhi that arises in meditation practice,
called vitarka. There our meditative absorption is distracted,
disturbed, unstable, and limited by coarse objectifications --
fixations upon separate gross objects. This is because the
objects and words start to come up, the mind starts to name them,
objectify them as "this" is "that", differentiate and compare
the objects, evaluate, conceptualize, daydream, etc. One's
attention and energy is habitually distracted into such mind
patterns or vrtti, but the meditator is attempting to recognize
this distraction.
Patanjali here is helping us to recognize that such coarse
distractions (savitarka) occur at first. That is normal. With
continued practice (abhyasa) they will cease. For us to
recognize this process is still an attainment (a samapatti)
because the non-meditator has no awareness of even this or even
the inner workings of his/her own mental processes. Thus
meditation practice is at first a retraining and reconditioning
process where one starts to wake up to our way of seeing and
being in the world -- how our innate knowledge or Gnosis (jnana)
becomes dissolute upon objects (artha-jnana) and we simply
become objectified, fixated, separate extracted, and estranged
-- that is where the union of yoga becomes corrupted. Knowledge
of the causes of distraction/disunion of course is not an end in
itself. Rather it simply allows us to drop our dissolute ways as
soon as we become aware of them. With continued practice in
meditation these savitarka (accompanied with coarse or gross)
thought tendencies of the dualistic mind are recognized as they
arise and thus the awareness itself no longer disappears with
the momentum of the distracted thought, but rather the energy of
that momentum is brought back to the source of the awareness --
the cit-prana is no longer dissipated. Eventually the mind moves
from the coarse (vitarka) to the more subtle (vicara), to devoid
of even the most subtle objectification/separation. This then
eventually is a landmark step that leads to genuine samadhi
versus a limited state of union called samapatti. Thus in
meditation before a conceptualization is formed, before the mind
wanders in thought, before a sentence is formed, before a word
appears first, but as the process itself just begins arise, it
is recognized and released into the vast ocean pure awareness.
Beginning meditators learn to watch the words arise, become
aware of it arising, then no longer feed their arising. The
resultant stillness and silence becomes naturally and
increasingly more recognizable and constant. The words stop
arising by themselves as we become more aware of the subtle
energy behind their arising as we move more fully and naturally
toward that great stillness and vast open space of pure
awareness. Hence the ordinary dualistic mind stops revolving
(the citta-vrtti cease in nirodha). This occurs eventually
through practice. The the individual consciousness is merged
with the universal mind, the Universal Citta -- it rests in the
innate effulgence clear light stillness. Another definition of
vitarka is gross thoughts being accompanied by names of physical
objects, i.e., thus one can how our our absorption becomes
disturbed and noisy by such gross thought forms and as such as
the processes dominate they keep on arising/coming forth
producing an unsteady and wavering body/mind distraction. Thus
one may temporarily experience some connection with Self, but it
is fleeting, until one experiences nirvitarka (devoid of gross
objectification processes).
Next Patanjali addresses nir-vitarka (meditation devoid of gross
thought processes but still containing subtle thought processes
(savicara). Vitarka is still a coarse stage in meditation
practice, then nirvitarka (devoid of coarse objectification),
while vicara is the next subtle stage, then nirvicara (devoid
even of the most subtle mind processes). Both engage dualistic
thought processes (objects of the mind) and are thus a temporary
stage of limited and transitional realization leading from the
coarse to more subtle, then beyond object/subject duality
entirely -- samadhi.
"Just sit in the Reality of Life seeing hell and paradise,
misery and joy, life and death, all with the same eye. No matter
what the situation, we live the life of the Self. We must sit
immovably on that foundation. This is essential; this is what ―becoming
one with the universe‖ means. If we divide this universe into
two, striving to attain satori and to escape delusion, we are
not the whole universe. Happiness and unhappiness, satori and
delusion, life and death; see them with the same eye. In every
situation the Self lives the life of the Self -- such a self
must do itself by itself. This universal Life is the place to
which we return." Uchiyama Kosho Roshi Also see the commentary
in Sutra 9 on on vikalpa and sutra 17 on vitarka. Sutra I. 43
Smrti-parishuddhau svarupa-sunye va artha-matra-nirbhasa
nir-vitarka However when the mind stream which is normally
polluted and conditioned by past experiences (smrti) is
completely purified (pari-shuddham) from any taint of the mental
contents toward a coarse and limited objectivity (nirvitarka)
which is characterized by (iva) clarity [and the absence of (wandering)
vikalpa], then the innate natural effulgent light (nir-bhasa) of
inner realization without taint of the illusion of an
independent self (svarupa-sunya) shines forth. Commentary:
Another way of saying the same thing is that nirvitarka
samapatti is produced by virtue of pure rememberance of our
unobscured true nature (swarupa) not defined and limited in
terms of form, separate objects, words, or name (free of the
limitations of mere gross objectivism and cognitive faculties --
free from the limitations of vitarka). Here the prefix, nir,
means without or devoid of. Thus the coarse wandering of the
mind is stilled in nirvitarka samadhi. How does this voiding
occur? Here we no longer assign words to the objects nor limit
them in any dualistic system nor process them through any
dualistic of object oriented relations method. This is easily
experienced in meditation but difficult to conceptualize because
we have moved beyond the limitations of individual cognitive or
conceptional functions. Here we must experience what is meant.
Patanjali says it is through the application of swarupa-sunya
which purifies the relationship between separate subject and
object which allows space for the inner effulgence to be be
invoked (nirbhasa). Here the profound truth of the emptiness
(sunya) of separateness is simultaneously revealed and applied,
i.e., there is no separate reflection of "self", no stain, no
separate object, no dissuasion, etc. Through the emptiness of a
separate "i-ness", our inherent true nature (swarupa) magically
shines forth (bhasa) while meditating so that a state may be
created that may be called nirvitarka samadhi. I hesitate to
call this a samadhi in order to avoid confusion that this is an
end. Rather I prefer to call this plateau, a stage (necessary as
it is). Here the coarse fixations of the mind are eradicated,
but the yet the subtle (vicara) mental obscurations may still
remain. Here we are gradually learning to abide more frequently
in our true nature, yet nirvicara samadhi let alone nirbij
samadhi is still to be disclosed. Sutra I. 44 Etayaiva savicara
nirvicara ca suksma-visaya vyakhyata In a similar fashion, the
mental state which is accompanied by subtle thoughts (sa-vicara)
and the stage of realization devoid even of the most subtle
thought (nir-vicara) upon even the most pure domain (suksma-visaya)
is now differentiated (vyakhyata). Commentary: Where vitarka
describes the thought processes that become attached to gross
physical objects, the world of form (such as pictures, sounds,
lights, etc.), external events, or our experiences framed in an
objectified dualistic world, vicara is different as it connotes
the subtle or non-externalized objects of thought itself. Here
the thinking process is an object, the awareness process is an
object. The energy processes are objects of awareness. This is
akin to the yogic practice of antar dharana (focusing of the
inner and subtle processes) except that here, the savicara
processes are not consciously brought into being rather they are
on automatic. By becoming aware of these we can notice how they
arise and eliminate them (nirodha). So here Patanjali now
describes the thought processes that become attached to the more
subtle objects of thought and boundaries such as concepts,
conceptual frameworks, beliefs, ideas, the conceptional process
itself, cognitive function, etc. Not that he says that we should
focus on these, but rather that we should go beyond such
fixation by letting them go. Nirvicara is akin to the cessation
of even the arising of the first word in a thought process -- to
even the urge to think itself. This creates the stillness where
the energy is no longer distracted and dissipated into any
objectification process -- it is the stillness that invites the
innate light.
An example: The mind is thinking to itself, "there is no mind,
there is no mind, Siva is All -- All is Siva". This is still
savicara samapatti, because there is still an object and
fixation and thus a limitation is produced by the thought
process. In order to enter into the more complete and wholesome
samadhi such thought processes (even the most subtle) still must
be purified so that one can know THAT which is greater than even
the most subtle -- greater than any or all the words -- THAT
which is simultaneously all Inclusive Universal Eternal and
Non-dual. Here Patanjali is simply delineating the graduated
stages of meditation from coarse fixations, to more subtle, to
the most subtle, and eventually free from any objective fixation
whatsoever -- Infinite Mind. These higher samapattis (nirvitarka
and nirvicara) are stages leading to samadhi (inseparable
spiritual identification in All Our Relations. Sutra I. 45
suksma-visayatvam ca alinga-paryavasanam As thought wanderings
become more rarified and subtle (suksma), the attachments to
objects (visayatvam) subsides and eventually ceases (paryavasanam)
in an undifferentiated and attributeless stage -- falling short
(parya-avasanam) as being possible to define, name, or quantify
(alinga). Commentary: As the mind ceases to wander on even the
subtlest object of thought, nirvicara samapatti is reached where
there exist no objects of thought -- a formless (nirguna) and
non-dual attributeless (alinga) place is entered upon which is
no place at all. Yet nirbija (seedless) samadhi is still not yet
realized. Only in the nirvicara phase (devoid of even the most
subtle objectification processes), then can one speak of truly
tasting samadhi albeit temporarily. As the subtle thoughts
become cleared away substantially, leading toward nirvicara
samadhi, only here experiencing the absence of even the most
subtle thought can one begin to speak of true samadhi. Alinga is
the most subtle objectification state, but it is not yet devoid
of subtlety -- of form. Rather the formless unconditioned nature
of nature beyond the boundaries of man's systems of
classification in nirvicara (absence of even any trace of subtle
object) goes beyond alinga, which remains undesignated,
attributeless, but not empty (sunya) of form. It is not calling
for a name or description so it is capable of whispering god's
name for those whose ears have become so attuned. This then
approximates emptiness (sunyam) which is described in
Patanjali's definition of Samadhi in Sutra III.3 as III. 3 Tad
evarthamatra-nirbhasam svarupa-sunyam iva samadhih Samadhi is
realized when the artificial separations between the object (arthamatra)
being meditated upon, the meditator, and the process of
meditation are voided (sunya) disappearing into its true state,
then the natural self existent effulgent source of the
luminosity (nirbhasam) of the object in its natural unbiased
place in all of existence as-it-is (swarupa) is known. In
samadhi all prejudice and limited consciousness not only are
illuminated but are also dissolved in the implicate self
effulgent light of ultimate truth which is our true nature (natural
precondition).
Here where the vrtti have become considerably stilled and the
obstructions rarified so that glimpses of the eternal light of
the unobstructed natural unconditional mind which is our true
nature becomes more accessible and integrated. Please notice
that Patanjali has not yet called the nirvicara stage a samadhi.
Sutra I. 46 ta eva sa-bijah samadhih All these previous
attainments are at best temporary samadhis (mere glimpses having
with them the seeds for falling back). Commentary: These
samapattis (communions) still have a dualistic seed in them
unless it is nirvicara samadhi. But even in nirvicara samadhi
devoid of the even the most subtle cognitive state of taking any
limited form whatsoever, they are still characterized as samadhi
with seed (sa-bijah samadhi). Sa means with and bija means seed.
Savitarka extends up to even the most subtle objects of
cognition i.e., the modality of consciousness that still
ascribes to an "I-it", dualistic, or relative world consisting
of manmade (artificial and conditioned) cognitions, but not
including the direct interconnection, union, or fusion of siva/shakti
(purusha/prakriti). Nirvicara however is however direct
spiritual non-dual realization beyond any process of individual
ideation or cognition. All the previous attainments (samapattis)
before the nirvicara stage contain seeds because their vision is
still occluded and limited by the false identification of
separate objects. In such duality, universal Clear Heart
Consciousness is still not liberated. As long as one identifies
as a separate object with a separate object, one is still
afflicted in mundane fragmented relationships. When that
separateness is rarified through the realization and application
of sunya, then one has arrived -- abiding in union -- the
unitive stage of All Our Relations. In nirvicara the samadhi is
one of genuine insight, but is discontinuous and incomplete. The
sadhak continues to fall back at other times into the dualism of
savicara or savitarka. Even if all all false notions of
separation is relinquished, the union can still become rended
until the final samskara is lifted. Sutra I. 47
Nirvicara-vaisharadye'dhyatma-prasadah Upon reaching that
samadhi state of direct experience devoid even of the most
subtle thought processes or reflection on a separate object (nirvicara
samadhi arises); i.e., when the restlessness of the mind is
completely satisfied, quieted, and rested, and still -- when the
mental faculties are stilled entirely in the deep nourishing
peace and clarity of grace (prasadah), a very clear lucidity or
natural transparency (vaisharadya) is realized -- the authentic
spiritual light emanating from the Supreme Source dawns which is
none other than our authentic self (adhyatma).
Commentary: In nirvicara samadhi, the reflection process has
become stilled and clarified as the peace of grace (prasadah)
giving birth to the transparency (vaisharadya) of the innate
light of the inner primal Source to shine forth on its own (without
obscuration). All conceptual processes (vikalpa) of course also
cease. Here what is often called nirvicara (free from even the
most subtle thought) samadhi is described, which is
pre-requisite to attaining the sacred grounds of nirbija (seedless
samadhi) in the sacred continuous transpersonal state of All Our
Relations. This corresponds with the last sutras in Pada 4
describing Kaivalyam (ultimate liberation). The Guhyasamaja
Tantra states: In terms of ultimate reality, meditate on the
things of the three worlds as insubstantial. The actual
meditation on insubstantiality is meditation having nothing on
which to meditate.Therefore meditation on substances and
non-substances is without an object. The Primary Tantra states:
The cultivation of single-pointed contemplation entails thinking
of nothing whatever. The Glorious Tantra of Royal Ambrosia
States: By meditating on the clear light, whose nature is empty,It
is not found, nor is it found by not meditating. Meditation
itself is conceptualization,and not meditating is also
conceptualization. Without having a speck of anything on which
to meditate, do not be distracted for an instant". from "Naked
Awareness: Practical Instructions on the Union of Mahamudra and
Dzogchen" by Karma Chagme, Snow Lion 2000 Sutra I. 48 Rtambhara
tatra prajna Then Supreme Truth Bearing (rtam-bhara) Inner
Wisdom (prajna) self-arises, dawns and prevails.
Commentary: Here the inner truth, knowledge, or Gnosis (prajna)
which bears the truth within itself (rtambhara) shines forth on
its own unimpeded. This is a pivotal statement of the most
sublime goal of Yoga according to Patanjali. It should be noted
that Patanjali once again states that this wisdom is intrinsic
and innate, but was simply obscured. It is innate, unconditioned,
and natural, not needing cultivation or contrivation. Thus yoga
works on the pre-existing contrived and conditioned mental
processes (the vrtti) and eliminates them (by eventually
eliminating all samskara) so that the practitioner abides in
their natural true Self (swarupa). Christopher Chapple and Yogi
Ananda in "The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali" (Sri Satguru
Publications, Delhi, 1990) translate this as: "This wisdom
sustains the movement of life. Ignorance is to fall from this [intrinsic]
order." To summarize, nirvicara samadhi leads toward nirbija
samadhi, but still is not capable by itself of destroying the
seeds which cause the falling out of this intimate unitive state
(samadhi) which is the realization/embodiment of our innate
wisdom potential (the inner Buddha, Christ, Sat Guru, or Brahman)
in the form of the jivamuktan. To remove this seed (caused by
past samskaras), Patanjali next addresses the removal of
samskaras. Sutra I. 49 Shrutanumana-prajnabhyam anya-vishaya
visesa-arthatvat This innate intuitive wisdom (prajnabhyam) must
be differentiated (anya) from the mere objective forms of
knowledge based on anumana (inference, deduction, logic) and
shruti (scriptures, belief, faith, external or objective
authoritative sources of knowledge) [no matter how "seemingly"
authoritative], which is always less reliable and more coarse
than this very special (visaya) [insight of direct truth bearing
wisdom (rtam-bhara), which is based on inner direct spiritual
experience and knowledge]. Commentary: This is because the
former knowledge is confined and limited to a particular object,
language, limited attitude, symbols, and such dualistic
perspectives, thus carrying the seed of a fractal taint, a
prejudiced and particular relative "point of view", i.e., it is
superficially based, externally imposed, alien, and artificial;
while that Truth of Universal Reality or Infinite Mind (available
only through rtam-bhara prajna) is inherent, self arising,
unconditioned, omnipresent, universal, and infinite. The
pre-existing state of chronic disconnection (which calls forth
yoga as the remedy) is dictated by an external and over
objectified knowledge where spiritual self alienation and
duality are fixated; while recognition of rtambhara is the
dawning of the intrinsic all encompassing universal inner wisdom.
The former is artificially and objectively derived and imposed,
while the latter is from our own subjective experience. There
can be no comparison. Here unification, integration, and yoga
reign. For one to successfully continue to bathe in nirbija (seedless)
samadhi, it is necessary to recognize the difference between
true inherent spontaneously self arising wisdom (rtambhara
prajna) on one hand, and shrutanumana-prajnabhyam on the other.
Our experience must thus inform and instruct our world views and
belief; i.e., in order for our daily consciousness to not get in
the way and extract us from yoga, it
must correspond to our experience. Liberation does not occur the
other way around; i.e., where ordinary people attempt to dictate
their experience according to the domination of specific belief
systems, bias, prejudice, thought patterns, samskaras, kleshas,
preconceptions, and karma all of which simply produce more
suffering (dukha). Thus being able to tune into the inherent
implicate inner wisdom and let it guide us stimulates a mutually
synergistic acceleration once this mechanism is recognized (inner
wisdom is brought forth and is increasingly respected,
acknowledged, and accessed) -- where the now educated and
vitalized mind in turn allows one hence greater breadth of
experience. Then greater breadth of experience then in turn
synergistically stimulates a broader consciousness and so on
like that until boundless universal Mind is disclosed.
Intelligently educated and informed awareness through experience
in turn allows an even more greater expansion of experience,
then further the education of the conscious mind even more is
achieved, and so forth, until eventually synergistic synchrony
coincides -- Yoga is accomplished -- All is Known and Self is
Experienced in Satchitananda. Sutra I. 50 Taj-jah samskaro'nya-samskara-pratibandhi
From the psychic signature (samskara) born from (taj-jah) [the
inner self realization of the Age-old Supreme Truth Bearing
Wisdom (rtam-bhara prajna)], all further samskaric seeds are
annulled (pratibandhi). Commentary: From the strong imprint that
issues forth from the dawning of the innate wisdom (rtambhara)
the arising of any further samskaras (past psychic imprints,
psychic signatures, programmed latent triggers, and the like
hidden in the cellular memory, neurology, energy body, and
etheric body due to past unresolved trauma, conflict, habit,
karma, or conditioning) are disengaged (pratibandhi),
annihilated, and cease to operate. Here then Rtambhara wells up
from within as a great wave upon the entire being creating a
deep shift to the core as the overriding imprint which
integrates/aligns us with Self.
Self realization is a strong experience, not realized without
sustained practice (abhyasa) or by the complete surrender of
effort (vairagya). In turn it leaves a very deep and lasting
imprint. This imprint thus triggers our dna -- the innate wisdom
at a cellular self-organizing level, which in turn spontaneously
responds to every situation inside the non-dual holographic and
trans-dimensional context of All Our Relations. Some say that
this imprint is what the Sri Yantra represents. Others say that
it realized through the repetition of the pranava, etc. Yet
others say that nirvicara samadhi will in time set in motion,
the samskara necessary to return us to our original true self
nature (swarupa) in nirbij-samadhi.
So here Sutra 50 says that continuous and permanent samadhi (nirbija
samadhi) occurs after all the samsaric samskaras (imprints due
to conditioning) are over ridden by our innate Buddha potential
-- intrinsic awareness which is always available but widely
ignored (because of avidya the main klesha). So according to
Patanjali yoga practice eliminates the veil of ignorance that
has occluded/obscured that pre-existing inherent love/wisdom
which has always existed from beginningless time. It's like a
treasure awaiting to be discovered. Yogis are thus like treasure
finders and maybe also if they are adept, able to point out to
others where their own inner treasures are buried. Also see III.
9-12 for a discussion on the three parinamas (nirodha parinama,
samadhi parinama, and ekgrata parinama) especially III. 11 for a
discussion of samadhi parinama. Sutra I. 51 Tasyapi nirodhe
sarva-nirodhan nir-bijah samadhih Upon the final dissolution,
cessation, and removal of all samskaras (past conditioned latent
imprints) thus Seedless Samadhi (Nirbija Samadhi) spontaneously
co-arises [from the beginningless pure sky. Commentary: When all
the samskaras (past imprints and trigger points that have run
the reactive programs in the past) have been purified and have
ceased (nirodha), there is no any wavering back into ignorance.
Here citta-vrtti nirodha is realized. "Nir" means devoid of;
while bija is "seed". Thus nirbija samadhi is translated as the
union or absorption without seed -- without being propelled back
into ignorance or duality. One may play at shifting scenes or
contexts, but one is free from the pulls of unconscious
impressions (samskaras) and hence Consciousness and Beingness
have merged as one without a second. Here the sadhak abides
joyfully because his samskaras have been washed clean, being
bathed and matured in and by the self luminous light inherent in
his/her own true natural abode (swarupa) which is of the same
taste inside or out in the non-dual reality of All Our
Relations. Here even nirodha ceases as one enters into the
non-dual abode of non-doing -- of absolute stillness and
openness where all latent seeds of past impressions have been
removed -- where all and everything reside as-it-is. This is not
the annihilation of consciousness (citta), but on the contrary,
the end of the vrtti, prejudice, bias, and spin of citta. HERE
is great abundance and fulfillment where santosha.and all the
yam/niyams are effected spontaneously and all at once.
To Summarize the end of Pada I, the vrtti are thus eliminated (nirodha)
through first the integration or dawning of rtambhara which
produces a core impression which in
turn remediates and ends all the other past triggers; i.e., that
precious innate truth bearing wisdom which is not derived from
scripture (sruti), from inference (anumana), nor from objective
knowledge of things or events. Rather it is aa deeper way of
knowing, where the inner Heart purifies and clarifies all.
Nirbija samadhi is the summum bonum of yoga because there is no
longer any falling back into the estrangement and disempowerment
of separateness (dualism). There is no place to go but HERE -
from whence we all originated. This is our natural uncontrived
state (swarupa) prior to avidya's conditioning, the disturbances
of the vrttis, and so forth. Although timeless it is expressed
in the Sacred Now. Nirbija samadhi is not discontinuous,
although the yogi may enter at will into many worlds, contexts,
and "situations", the overall context of Ultimate Integrity --
of Eternal Spirit is always present -- as such sacred space is
continuously present. Thus wandering in the seas of karma,
samskaras, or avidya has ended for such a yogi, for such knows
only unending and beginningless bliss - for such All Our
Relations is the way it is.
The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali -- Chapter Two -- Sadhana Pada (The
Chapter on Effective Practices)
Synopsis: Sadhana means spiritual practice. Yoga sadhana is
something we "do" in order to move from a disconnected spiritual
state and connect more fully with spirit. Here we learn
experientially through practice, versus from following dictums,
memorizing politically correct beliefs, through proven theories,
inference, conceptionalization, or any of the other vrtti.
Practice, practice. practice, is the mantra here. Although
Patanjali gave many practices as remedies for spiritual
estrangement (pratishedha) in Pada I (such as vairagya, nirodha,
virama-pratyaya, isvara pranidhana, dhyana, eka-tattvabhyasa,
japa, shradda, virya, prajna, maitri, karuna, upeksanam, mudita,
bhava, and especially rtam prajna, the self arising truth
bearing seed which is the practice of no practice), rather it is
here in Pada II, that Patanjali focuses upon practices in a more
concrete way. Practice is a thus the way we learn in yoga which
is different from the methodology of philosophy, logic, religion,
or any "ism". Practice assumes a pre-existing disconnection (from
samadhi) and hence remedy (pratishedha). Pada I (Samadhi Pada)
outlined the framework of the disconnection or spiritual malaise,
so thus Pada II acts as a continuation of the outline sketched
in Pada I, where now Patanjali focuses upon the basic and
auxiliary practices as remedies. If our yoga practice keeps its
focus on spirit, then it is a practice of bringing more clarity,
heart consciousness, and love into our lives. As such it has its
own innate and profound momentum and enthusiasm and as such
authentic yoga sadhana has nothing to do with externally imposed
discipline, hard work, force, or an individual willfulness. It
is not willful in the ordinary sense because the authentic goal
of yoga is to align the individual will with the universal will,
thus it is a surrendering to an all encompassing intelligent
sacred dynamic. This is the kind of completion and santosha (sense
of fulfillment and peace) that authentic yoga includes even from
the very beginning -- from our entry into the process of yoga.
In the end -- when re-union is achieved in samadhi) we surrender
the practice, because there is no need for it. May your sadhana
be graced with love, peace, and wisdom. Sadhana Pada Patanjali
then progresses from the overall context of yoga delineated in
Pada I, to presenting the various techniques and practices of
yoga (sadhana), starting off with kriya (pre-requisite
purification) yoga activities (tapas, swadhyaya, and isvara
pranidhana). These three are often greatly misinterpreted by
intellectuals, academicians, and religionists who look at them
from the outside. We will point out the common mistakes of such
coarse misinterpretations. Then Patanjali discusses the causes
of suffering (being ignorance or avidya) in a clear cut way
discussing avidya in relation to the kleshas, vrttis, and karma
and then how to remedy them (through tapas, swadhyaya, isvara
pranidhana, dhyana, pratiprasava, vairagya, viveka, prajna, and
similar practices).
Pada II ends with the introduction of ashtanga (eight-limbed)
yoga, discussing in detail the first five limbs (yama, niyama,
asana, pranayama, and pratyhara). Toward
the end of Pada II in the discussion of ashtanga yoga, Patanjali
again brings up the valuable practices of swadhyaya (self study),
tapas (kindling divine passion through renouncing nonproductive
activity), and isvara pranidhana (surrender to the highest
formless Self), thus emphasizing their value when they are
functionally understood both as purification practices as well
as mutual synergists with the other limbs (of astanga). Thus
here in Pada II, Patanjali, briefly prepares us for the last
three and most subtle practices of ashtanga yoga found in the
beginning of Chapter III (Vibhuti Pada). These last three limbs
are generally considered the higher or more subtle inner
practices of astanga yoga being dharana (concentration
techniques), dhyana (meditation), and samadhi (integrative
absorption) to a gradual degree of increasing subtleness, until
the samadhi beyond all subtlety, where all seeds of falling back
out of union ceases in (nirbij samadhi). Pada II Sutra 1
Tapah-svadhyayesvara-pranidhanani kriya-yogah Tapas (spiritual
passion, energy, or heat generated through forgoing dissipative
activities), swadhyaya (self study), and isvara pranidhana (the
function of surrender to or the embrace of the all encompassing
comprehensive integrity which interconnects us all (who we
really are) are the three essential prerequisite (kriya)
activities that lead us to realizing the fruit of yoga.
Commentary: Another way of translating this is that a successful
yoga practice is based upon the activities (kriya) of increasing
spiritual passion/inspiration (or the spiritual engine), self
study (understanding self), and surrendering to that divine
intelligence which is at the universal center core/heart of *HEART*
[which is formless]. Technically yoga is the process, the verb
and activity, the interface tool/procedure, the intelligent
configuration of the technique that allows us to mesh in harmony
with the deepest currents of Reality (wherein the true self
nature or true identity can be realized in swarupa). In this
first sutra of pada two, Patanjali is telling us that to begin
yoga practice -- as its preliminaries (kriyas) so that it can be
eventually successful, these powerful practices are of immense
value leading to the deepening of the yogic process (connecting
eternal spirit in our daily life as Divine Presence). Indeed the
universalist definition of isvara pranidhana is just that,
surrendering to eternal spirit in everyday life -- at every
moment -- in All Our Relations. This is knowing the true Self as
it is (swadhyaya), and it is tapas which kindles the fire to
help us get HERE.
We will run into these three practices (tapas, swadhyaya, and
isvara pranidhana) again many times in the Yoga Sutras (as they
also comprise the three of the five niyams of ashtanga yoga) and
we have already dealt with isvara pranidhana as the teacher of
all teachers (purvesham) in Pada I, Sutras 23-27. So why does
Patanjali put them here at the beginning of Sadhana Pada (the
Chapter of Practices) again? This is because they are the
foundation upon which successful sadhana is based. This
translation thus can read: Kriya yoga prepares the yogic
aspirant (sadhak) for success in all further sadhana, because
the necessary elements for success are the cultivation of
spiritual fire and passion (tapas), the desire to study and know
self, and the desire to know, embrace, and be guided by (isvara
pranidhana) the eternal divine -- teacher of all teachers (isvara).
Unfortunately, these three foundational practices are widely
misinterpreted as austerities (tapas), study of scripture (swadhyaya),
and surrender to God (isvara pranidhana) by those immersed in
dualism and religionism . Before going into a discussion on
these three preliminary practices which constitute kriya yoga,
and which may be applied both in daily life as well in other
sadhana, it's always wise to investigate how these practices are
applied in meditation (the main practice of raj yoga). So in one
sense we may view these three as activities that prepare us for
meditation. First one makes the effort to sit in meditation.
Withdrawing one's energy from ordinary temporal pursuits, one
redirects it internally to fire the meditation. This is the
application of tapas (spiritually redirecting one's energy from
the "normal" dualistic distractions of outer materialistic
objects of attraction and activities, back into our inner Source
core/center (on a physical and energetic level it is related to
the fifth limb of ashtanga yoga, pratyhara, and the hatha yoga
bandhas). As one sits in awareness, greater awareness of the
mental contents of the mind is revealed. how the mind works and
how it colors "reality" is revealed. The sadhak becomes aware of
the ordinary mind's karmic propensities, habits, psychic
signatures, and imprints, and eventually through consistent
application of the energy brought forth from tapas fueling
awareness its essential nature is revealed. One understands
oneself because one understands the mind. This is authentic
swadhyaya (self study). This self study is not the same as
analytical intellectualization, but rather we simply observe
that the ordinary mind wavers, fluctuates, and is unstable (cit-vrtti)
and acknowledge it. While observing the pauses between these
fluctuations (nirodha) space is created for the formless (isvara
as the eternal formless attributeless eternal teacher/teaching
then enters).
Eventually one becomes aware of the objectless, timeless,
transpersonal ultimate -- that universal formless intelligence
which underlies the entire universe and embraces it as formless
Self -- that unites eternity with this very moment. That is
isvara pranidhana. It is coming HOME to what has always been
HERE and always will.
Isvara is unreachable through the analytical process, but must
be experienced (usually through meditation or else through grace).
Applying these three procedures many times (as needed) even in
one meditation sitting can be productive in directing its
successful outcome. Thus the three kriyas (activities) of tapas
(which is often the renouncing of one activity to fire catalyze
all the other practices), self study (swadhyaya), and isvara
pranidhana can be applied as techniques as yoga sadhana in all
our relationships. The above example is applied to meditation
practice, because it is the main practice of Raj Yoga, the main
teaching of Patanjali; however all the limbs are meant to be
synergistic and hence kriya yoga forms a basis both of intent
and activity for the success in yoga in general, but only in the
non-dualist, non-exclusive, transpersonal, and universal sense.
For example the immense existence of widespread
mis-interpretation of these three activities, exist mainly
because they are interpreted through non-yogic eyes by those who
believe in dualism and separation. Such a dualist bias protects
the dualists and hence attempts to prevent the culmination of
authentic yoga. Indeed in "another" non-yogic system, these
terms mean different things, but here we will attempt to
translate these terms in the context of Yoga, specifically raj
yoga. Tapas: As we will see tapas means the generation of energy
and its direction in order that we have the requisite energy to
power our sadhana. Tapas is the spiritual fuel, fire, or [passion
for the divine which is associated strongly with the practice of
vairagya (non-attachment/non-grasping). In other words, we
create space, time and energy through the practice of vairagya
by emptying and eliminating the dissipating energies and
distractions of our attention (imprisonment with the I-It world
of duality) by allowing the spiritual energy and fire to become
kindled. This turns up the heat, builds up momentum, and
activates the spiritual circuitry -- our deeper spiritual
potential becomes activated. By emancipating our addiction to
external objects of gratification and dissolute habits, this
previously bound up energy is also liberated and made available.
Thus tapas is closely associated with the fifth limb of ashtanga
yoga, pratyhara and in the body with the hatha yoga bandhas.
In this sense tapas has nothing to do with the negative or fear
based practices of self abnegation, self defacement, penance,
sacrifice (as is more commonly misinterpreted), self harm, self
punishment, or self mutilation. This unfortunate negative
association is the result of a confusion (avidya) due to the
kleshas of egotism (asmita), raga (attraction/attachment) and
dvesa (aversion/repulsion). It is absurd to hypothesize that
through repression or by hurting ourselves or denying ourselves
health or comfort, that spiritual progress will necessarilly
follow, yet this is a stubbornly held and not uncommon delusion.
Indeed much of what passes for tapas is really dvesa (aversion)
and self delusion (pride), albeit one is trying. But spiritual
progress is not so simpleminded as the mechanical action of
sacrificing one thing in exchange for another, for instance like
cutting off one's finger in barter for "spiritual" progress.
This absurdity is taken to extremes by some unfortunate souls
who believe that if cutting off one's finger is good then
cutting off two will certainly bring more benefit. Such futile
arguments can go ad absurdum into the more pain that one can
withstand the stronger they become spiritually. Unfortunately
such a confusion is not uncommon. Tapas as meant by Patanjali is
actually much more practical than turning away (as in disgust or
aversion (dvesa), but rather it is an affirmation. In one sense
it there exist two sides of tapas. One side is renouncing
activities which do not lead toward spiritual evolution, while
the other side is the firing up of that spiritual side, i.e., it
is the affirmation side of tapas. As such it is like recycling
or energy conservation. As such it is not simply a plain
renunciation, but rather an integral part of an affirmation,
acknowledgement of, and surrender to of the higher Self (isvara
pranidhana). The misconception surrounding tapas arose from the
quagmire of those who have become habituated to dualistic
thinking. They observed the yogis who were living simple lives
in bliss in the mountain caves or reclusive forests as those who
were denying themselves pleasure; rather than understanding that
what these observers deemed as pleasure was mere neurotic
sublimation, while their so called austere yogis were content
with a far more primal joy. In other words those who observed
such yogis mistook affirmation and fulfillment for negation and
sacrifice -- they assumed that the yogis had the same values and
desires that they themselves read into the picture. In other
words these interpreters who were attached to fancy food,
clothes, money, and worldly activities "interpreted" what they
saw within the mire of their own attachments and values, rather
than in understanding that these yogis had no need nor desire
for such attachments. Consequently, in the modern day, yogis
choosing a life of simplicity may be viewed as being self hating
or self abnegating, while in fact these yogis may be
experiencing and reflecting a deep and profound state of
wellness and spiritual fulfillment. A modern analogy might
expand on this further, such as rather than "viewing" the bliss
of a true yogi living without the need of TV, air conditioning,
fancy clothes, microwave ovens, rich pastries, automobiles, or
other such superfluous if not unhealthy attractions/addictions
as a sacrifice; we can rather more correctly view that within a
positive context of affirmation i.e., that the yogi has attained
something more primal, fulfilling, and satisfying and has no
ersatz external attachments or desires in these regards, rather
he/she is focused on attaining moksha (liberation). In other
words, these yogis may look like they are sacrificing something
if viewed from the eyes of a greedy, lustful, or fear based ego,
but from the yogi's point of view it is the ego bound individual
who has sacrificed the ALL, for something empty.
Later on in this chapter, Patanjali describes the practice of
vairagya as well as ashtanga yoga (of which tapas, swadhyaya,
and isvara pranidhana are included as niyams) as techniques (sadhana)
in order to eliminate the kleshas. Authentic tapas is far more
straightforward than self sacrifice or self defacement i.e.,
rather through authentic tapas we relieve ourselves of the
neurotic obsessions of ego gratification thus freeing ourselves
from needless stress and distraction. The processes of tapas,
swadhyaya, and isvara pranidhana are intertwined. For example we
first may make an affirmation become free of neurotic behavior
by knowing our "self" better -- study our "self" more, see how
and why it becomes imprisoned and caught up in suffering (dukha).
This is the momentum in alignment with swadhyaya (self study).
We might at the same time affirm our higher potential of spirit
side and wish to integrate eternal presence more into our life.
This is isvara pranidhana. Then, tapas naturally follows because
in the light of the former, we can analyze each action whether
or not it will lead toward more self understanding, liberation,
and spirit or not. In other words, will the habit of attachment,
neurotic greed, new clothes, entertainment, distraction, fancy
or rich foods lead toward the desired spiritual goal or not. If
not, then we decide not to do that anymore. That is authentic
tapas. It is not renunciation or repentance in the Western sense,
because it is an affirmation. It is not discipline, because we
are doing what we truly desire. Tapas in everyday practice can
first liberate us from the obvious addictions that are
possessing our vital energy and attention (cit-prana). They are
given up on the spiritual altar -- as an affirmation of the
Great Integrity. Then, more subtle hindrances are removed, and
as such tapas is also closely aligned with the yams of
aparigraha, asteya, and brahmacharya (See Sutra 37-39 below).
Sometimes tapas is translated as discipline, in the sense of
externally applied rules or duties such as found in
authoritarian systems or religions. Nor is tapas obeying moral
or legal precepts, but what distinguishes authentic yoga from
religion is that the yogi is self disciplined. The yogi's self
discipline is his/her daily sadhana (practice), which is applied
continuously (day and night) eventually as an affirmation and
love not as an aversion (dvesa). So tapas means much more than
discipline, rather it is a specific self-discipline that is
applied to boost and fuel our spiritual progress -- to realize
yoga in All Our Relations.
Again tapas is to be applied not only in meditation, but
integrated into our simple every day relationships. Tapas is
simply letting go of attachment or self involvement in an
activity which is seen as neurotic, distracting, entertaining,
or diversionary such as neurotic entertainment, recreation,
consuming ersatz objects of gratification, or the engagement in
any action which is imbued with kleshas. In every day terms we
have many choices, so we can ask how does this activity or that
activity fit into my spiritual evolution. How does going to the
movies, going shopping, acquiring more things, going out to eat
and so forth compare with doing meditation, asana, pranayama,
karma yoga, or study tonight in regard to our spiritual progress
and happiness? Tapas is not simply renunciation for
renunciation's sake, nor will any success come from hatred, fear,
or an aversion (dvesa). Nor is it a simple minded remedy for
raga (attraction), nor should it be motivated by ego (asmita) or
pride; but rather tapas involves giving up afflictions (kleshas),
attachments, vasana, and old habits (any dualistic separate
identification) upon the altar of love -- in the context to free
up more energy for our spiritual activities --as a yoga kriya.
As such it is always an affirmation. On the other hand acting
from afflictions of attachment, aversion, ego, greed, jealousy,
ignorance, and the rest of the kleshas will dissipate/distract
the energy; so the yogi who achieves a certain amount of self
awareness through self study (swadhyaya) will make better use
out of their time and energy applying it to fire the kiln of
effective practice instead. This is how swadhyaya and tapas
interface on the mundane level to increase the spiritual
vibrations and sacred presence. Tapas is not simply renunciation,
but rather a recycling of the energy that could have been placed
into further distraction and dissipation -- placing that energy
into the service of further fueling one's spiritual evolution --
tapas becomes the activity that freshens up and sparks a
practice that has become sluggish and dull. As such then it is
an affirmation of the higher Self. This is the action of
authentic tapas. Very simply by letting go of one's attachment
in such neurotic activities or propensities, then space and
energy is liberated and reclaimed that can now be directed
toward ultimate liberation.
For example, mouna. or the practice of silence, is a traditional
way yogis build up "spiritual heat" to ward off spiritual stasis.
Simply by refraining from verbal chatter that energy (chatter
can be a severe drain on the throat chakra) is recycled as it
were for "other" activities. This is effective for those of us
who are subject to this kind of energy suck. Another common
physical practice of tapas is fasting, but again not to
reinforce the false identifications of pride, ego, or
willfulness (as in look how long I fasted), but rather for
spiritual energy -- living on the more subtle sources of prana
-- becoming more attuned to the Source of true Sustenance. Many
yogis say that the best and most effective tapas is entering
into silence of the mind, or meditation (dhyana).
Swadhyaya: Swadhyaya is most often mis-translated as scriptural
study, but that is more often the cause of false identification
than its remedy. Although scriptural study has become a
institutionalized philosophical tradition in India for thousands
of years, swadhyaya in the yogic sense means exactly as it says;
self study. Of course the religious and academic types will deny/ignore
this last statement, declaring that one can find oneself only in
books (scripture). Yogis meditating do not accept being defined
by authoritative books or external authorities; but rather they
are dedicated toward finding that Source intimately within as
the authentic living modality of true Gnosis. Patanjali meant
swadhyaya as just that i.e., studying the self at each moment.
As such it is an important technique in meditation practice (raj
yoga). In meditation activity however we do not want to analyze
the mind processes or self, nor "do" anything other than to
simply observe in awareness. In this sense meditation then could
be called the activity of no activity where the Self discloses
itself. Here swadhyaya in its highest form is pure awareness --
where the small self disappears and the True Self is revealed.
That is where authentic swadhyaya can lead. Swadhyaya is
misinterpreted widely by scholars and religionists as "scriptural
study" or book study. Although studying "correct" philosophy and
practicing contemplation on mental and psychological phenomena (jnana
yoga) can provide some specific benefits of clarification or
inspiration for some students (but only when placed in the
context of the heart), such external study can be often very
misleading and disorientating (unless balanced with inner study),
as it merely leads toward the reinforcement of institutionalized
mass illusion and as such is not characterized as an authentic
yogic path. too often we find that those who study external
authoritative systems become obsequious, robotic, quarrelsome
with others sects, conformists, and jealous of others who do
follow the injunctions of the guru or scripture. Too often the
books substitute for the book of the Heart, but the map is not
the territory, nor will the symbols delineated by words, serve
well to replace our direct experience. Indeed we must learn from
our direct experience what is Self -- no one can be spared this
experience who wishes to know the authentic Self.
Thus in a yogic sense swadhyaya means studying, observing, and
eventually knowing our true self nature, not through the
conceptual confines and objective externalized eyes of the
intellect, books, scripture, or authority, but rather through
Gnosis acquired through meditation -- from an authentic direct
transpersonal experience. This study or inquiry into Self is an
essential practice of the process of self realization via the
removal of delusion/illusion. It is a moment to moment
university culminating in Self Knowledge or inner realization.
See "Who am I" and "Self Enquiry" by Ramana Maharshi, "You Can
Be A Light Unto Yourself" from the Collected Works of J.
Krishnamurti, vol. 13, "Krishnamurti and the Direct Perception
of Truth", and similar.
Isvara pranidhana: Isvara is often mistranslated with the
English term, "God", which in the Western sense of the term, is
almost the opposite of what is meant because isvara specifically
is not a theistic idea (as yoga is not theistic). In other words
the word isvara specifically refers to the formless and
deity-less aspect of Reality -- isvara specifically means the
formless and attributeless, hence "aspectless aspect" of the
divine and as such even to name it is a contradiction. Thus
Isvara pranidhana is to surrender to the great integrity of
formless infinity which is the eternal (beginning-less and never
ending) beginning-ness -- the all inclusive creator/creation --
the Great Integrity while anything short of that is being short
changed. The word, isvara, thus expresses or symbolizes
completeness, the whole, or infinite mind and as such can not be
represented by symbols being the nothingness that includes
everything. It remains formless and undifferentiated in order to
not exclude even the minuteness differentiation of existence.
What does this mean then as a practice. It means that Divine
intelligence and Divine will is always available if we look for
it and we can always surrender to THAT. THAT larger momentum,
force, or grace (if you like) can and does lead us into the
Great Transpersonal Presence -- into the natural and true Self
that knows no bounds and as such isvara pranidhana is a daily
moment to moment practice. In meditation we allow THAT ineffable
immeasurable Light and Love to shine forth -- we create time and
space for this communion. Always we surrender to THAT which is
taintless and pure -- which has no definition -- exists but does
not exist -- that which is beyond all names; yet may be called
isvara only if we realize that it can not be contained by form.
If we do not devote our energy and attention to that which is
COMPLETE and WHOLE, how will we ever accomplish yoga? If we are
not focused in this direction, then we remain incomplete,
corrupted, fragmented, diverted, rended, neurotic, and
vulnerable to repeated fragmentation and separation in the
corrupted and confused mire of dualistic reality (samsara).
Isvara is always available. When we let go of our willful
practices -- when certain karma is extinguished -- then we make
room for Grace -- Guidance from the teacher of teachers, isvara
(see Pada 1.26).
The confusion generated by what Patanjali meant by isvara
pranidhana, has been created because various religious and
analytical "schools" project their own "definitions" upon the
term, isvara. For example the pre-existing older samkhya school
of Patanjali's day, did not recognize any god at all. Then
samkhya itself changed. Later schools such as Vedanta attribute
an impersonal absolute (state devoid of any attributes) only to
nirvisesha (without attributes) nirguna (without qualities), and
nirakar (formless), which is distinguished from isvara. Some
bhakti yoga schools attribute isvara pranidhana to mean worship
or devotion while also one may interpret it to mean selfless
service (as is found in karma yoga). There are numerous other
interpretations displaying the specific bias of the schools
predilections or cosmology. Indeed in Hinduism alone there are
thousands of names for god, and ten times that number of books
which attempt at different definitions for each. The point that
concerns the yogi after liberation, is that the "name" doesn't
matter, i.e., that in order to rest in the universal ultimate
one must surrender all attachments to these separate forms, be
they religious or philosophical -- in Reality -- we are that --
Tat Tvam Asi. That is assuming that we are sincerely on a
genuine spiritual search versus simply finding solace in ersatz
external systems. (See also Pada 1.23-27) Rather than harp any
further on this subject, we will assume that Patanjali meant the
practice in the context of a Raj Yoga enhancement. This practice
is not only a kriya (essential or prerequisite activity) for
spiritual transformation, but also a niyama and as such it is
perhaps more valuable to point out that isvara pranidhana is not
a practice that can be accomplished through the intellect, nor
is it difficult to access and practice like some scholars might
indicate. Rather it is a simple yet profound practice of
touching our highest potential which in the non-dual
transpersonal sense of yoga simultaneously co-exists both inside
and outside of our own being in the instantaneousness of the
sacred moment. "The importance that all these Indian metaphysics,
and even the ascetic technique and contemplative method that
constitute Yoga, accord to ―knowledge‖ is easily explained if we
take into consideration the causes of human suffering. The
wretchedness of human life is not owing to a divine punishment
or to an original sin, but to ignorance. Not any and every kind
of ignorance, but only ignorance of the true nature of Spirit,
the ignorance that makes us confuse Spirit with our psychomental
experience, that makes us attribute ―qualities‖ and predicates
to the eternal and autonomous principle that is Spirit -- in
short, a metaphysical ignorance. Hence it is natural that it
should be a metaphysical knowledge that supervenes to end this
ignorance. This metaphysical knowledge leads the disciple to the
threshold of illumination -- that is, to the true 'Self'. And it
is this knowledge of one‘s Self -- not in the profane sense of
the term, but in its ascetic and spiritual sense -- that is the
end pursued by the majority of Indian speculative systems,
though each of them indicates a different way of reaching it.
For Samkhya and Yoga the problem is clearly defined. Since
suffering has its origin in ignorance of ―Spirit‖ -- that is, in
confusing ―Spirit‖ with psychomental states -- emancipation can
be obtained only if the confusion is abolished. The differences
between Samkhya and Yoga on this point are insignificant. Only
their methods differ: Samkhya seeks to obtain liberation solely
by gnosis, whereas for Yoga an ascesis and a technique of
meditation are indispensable. In both darshanas human suffering
is rooted in illusion, for man believes that his psychomental
life -- activity of the senses, feelings, thoughts, and volition
-- is identical with Spirit, with the Self. He thus confuses two
wholly autonomous and opposed realities, between which there is
no real connection but only an illusory relation, for
psychomental experience does not belong to Spirit, it belongs to
nature (prakriti); states of consciousness are the refined
products of the same substance that is at the base of the
physical world and the world of life. Between psychic states and
inanimate objects or living beings, there are only differences
of degree. But between psychic states and Spirit there is a
difference of an ontological order; they belong to two different
modes of being. ―Liberation‖ occurs when one has understood this
truth, and when the Spirit regains its original freedom. Thus,
according to Samkhya, he who would gain emancipation must begin
by thoroughly knowing the essence and the forms of nature (prakriti)
and the laws that govern its evolution. For its part, Yoga also
accepts this analysis of Substance, but finds value only in the
practice of contemplation, which is alone capable of revealing
the autonomy and omnipotence of Spirit experimentally." Mircea
Eliade, Immortality and Freedom Thus vairagya, tapas, swadhyaya,
and isvara pranidhana are the individual parts of an integrated
and potent process of spiritual transformation and liberation.
Success in yoga proceeds from here. Thus it is valuable not to
forget nor misinterpret these kriyas as they are very useful
when properly understood and applied. In this sense we let go of
ego involvement or attachment which is self enslaving, but not
in a rigid, static, or willful framework of self denial or
repression nor as a religious or moral duty, but as a passionate
and joyful release/relief -- as divine longing and intention --
as Divine Love -- as a portal into THAT wholistic and joyful
interaction which provides us completion in the heart, true
happiness, and fulfillment. Thus we embrace and reside in our
core energy -- in the heart relinquishing our unhappiness. How
to stay thus centered is brought about through self observation
(how our energy shifts or our attention and consciousness
becomes obscured and modified by the vrttis. In this way self
study (swadhyaya), leads to self knowledge -- or knowledge of
the Self or Source. When we observe ourselves to be occupied
with activities that do not lead in this direction, we perform
tapas and this feeds the fire of our practice. When we feel lost
or corrupted, we search out the omnipresent sacred and all
intelligent presence in all and surrender to THAT. For more on
Isvara see Pada I: Sutra 23-27 and Pada II Sutra 45. Tapas,
swadhyaya, and isvara pranidhana all are mutually synergistic
i.e., the more we understand who we are, simplify our activities
and involvement, and dedicate our attention and energy toward
staying connected and in harmony with the Great Integrity, the
more natural, accelerated, and fulfilling our yoga practice
becomes. Kriya yoga as preliminary activity or preparatory
action clears a path, creates a pathway, and removes an
obstruction and as such means purification. In a similar way we
can use the word, prerequisite, for kriya. As such see
Patanjali's further elaboration of tapas, swadhyaya, and isvara
pranidhana as niyama (the branch of astanga yoga called
beneficial actions to undertake) starting at Pada II, sutra
43-46) following. II. 2. Samadhi-bhavanarthah
klesa-tanu-karanarthas ca [Tapas, swadhyaya, and isvara
pranidhana are practices] that brings forth (bhavanarthah)
samadhi (the synchronization of all the koshas, chakras, marmas
on all levels with the universal Self) by attenuating (tanu-karana)
the causation of the kleshas (actions that are motivated by
negative emotions negative emotions which bring about sorrow).
Kriya yoga thus thus eventually facilitates (bhavana) the
realization of samadhi. Commentary: The practice of kriya yoga
purifies the body/mind serving to reduce (tanu-karana) their
embedded afflictions, occlusions, obscurations, or taints (kleshas)
eventually allowing for natural flow to occur. As we cultivate (bhavana)
our practice, the purpose (artah) becomes refined, the
afflictions (kleshas) lessen (tanu), thus samadhi becomes more
accessible and continuous (bhavana). When the kleshas (as taints,
poisons, afflictions, and hindrances) are lessened then our
practice is less hindered and more successful. Kriya yoga
lessens these obstructions and hindrances so that our practice
blossoms. A wise practitioner who has found that his/her
practice has become stagnant, can go to tapas, swadhyaya, and
isvara pranidhana to remove the hindrance, blockages, and
obscurations by building up the spiritual fire (tapas), the
passion to know Self (swadhyaya), and the surrender to that
highest transpersonal wisdom that comes from divine and
infallible guidance (isvara pranidhana). So if our intent (artah)
is to cultivate samadhi (samadhi-bhavanarthah) we should learn
how to attenuate the kleshas in All Our Relations. See II.43-46
for more details about tapas, swadhyaya, and isvara pranidhana).
II -3. Avidyasmita-raga-dvesabhinivesah klesah The afflictions
that cause sorrow (kleshas) are all caused by avidya (ignorance)
of our true self nature. As a result of this ignorance which
veils the light of truth, ignorance and confusion further
manifests as asmita (the false identification of separateness,
aloneness, pridefulness, or egoism), raga (the illusion that
conjoining to, identifying with, or possessing separate I-It
objects will provide fulfillment i.e., attraction/attachment),
dvesa (repulsion, dislike, hatred, anger, and aversion), and the
fear of death (abhinivesah).
Commentary: the kleshas are activities which lead to dukha (pain
or suffering). they are ordinarily classified by five general
categories of kleshas which functional and effective yoga
practice is designed to eliminate. Kleshas are emotional
afflictions, taints or poisons which if acted upon increase
suffering (dukha). Another way of saying this is that ignorance
(avidya) of our true self nature is the basic confusion or
erroneous mindset which separated us from embracing the flux of
the eternal now, wherein we habitually ignore the truth of our
essential true nature; i.e., swarupa.
This ignorance creates a habitual and familiar milieu of
separation, a rend, split, trauma, and separation which is the
primal cause of all other obstructions which appear as the
myriad afflictive modalities which Patanjali calls kleshas.
Although there exist innumerable combinations of these kleshas,
their source is ignorance and here Patanjali breaks them down
into five toxic dynamics. The kleshas can be viewed as the
various frictions of separateness or ignorance (as compensatory
neurotic displacements) which causes the experiences of
discomfort, desire, craving, dissatisfaction, restlessness,
angst, and the myriad other negative afflictions (kleshas) of
spiritual self alienation which lead to pain and suffering. Of
these innumerable kleshas, Patanjali simply classifies them into
these general groups all emanating from this state of spiritual
alienation which is in reality, the absence of vision (avidya)
-- the process of ignoring the profound reality of who we really
are in wholeness and integrity -- in All Our Relations. Thus the
five broad categories of kleshas are avidya (ignorance or
confusion) which is the base of all the others, asmita (ego
delusion, the belief in the separate or small self, prideful
conceit, arrogance, denial, etc), raga (attraction, desire,
attachment, etc.), dvesa (repulsion, aversion, hatred, fear),
and, abhinivesah (the fear of death which negates the eternal
spiritual presence). It naturally follows that when we are
fragmented from our true love and vision, we would desire a
compensatory replacement. This is called raga or desire. Thus in
the yoga paradigm, desire goes away when we come back to the
True Self -- the All and Everything of the great Integrity. It
should be noted that fear in this context is really negative
desire; i.e., desiring something not to happen is fear. Fear is
also an aversion (dvesa) to something while raga is following
the attraction. Attraction and repulsion occur naturally, but
any activity or dominance of them become afflictions and cause
suffering. Repulsion or aversion is also manifested as hatred,
anger, disgust, and condemnation. Most people do not acknowledge
such in themselves due to their conceit and self deceit, but
they manifest in many ways in the ordinary man on a daily basis.
Also ignorance causes asmita (pride, ego delusion, conceit, and
belief in separateness). More will be said about this later, but
asmita again like the other kleshas is merely a compensatory
neurotic coping mechanism to replace the identification with the
true Self.
Note the Buddhists similarly trace the source of the kleshas to
clinging onto false views and ignorance and group them similarly
into aversion (anger, hatred, and fear), desire (raga), pride
(or arrogance and delusion), greed, and envy. One can see that
all the manifold varieties of kleshas such as jealousy, anger,
hatred, possessiveness, arrogance, condemnation, self
righteousness, aggressiveness, etc are simply permutations of
two or more of these basic kleshas -- all stemming from
ignorance.
For example jealousy is based on a combination of desire (raga),
dvesa (aversion), and asmita (pride). Abhinivesah is often
translated as clinging onto physical existence, but I have
chosen to translate it in its negative as the fear of death. But
really it is the clinging onto a false sense of continuity or
security onto something which is ever changing. Abhinivesa is
really is rooted in the fear of change. In other words we do not
fear the discontinuity of eternal love or consciousness when we
reside in the firm experience of its continuity. It is only when
we are disconnected within the realm of false and confused
identifications, does the fear of discontinuity and death arise.
Both say the same thing. Abhinivesah is one of the greatest
sources of desire, fear, and separation and hence suffering (dukha).
It entirely goes away when we identify more continuously with
the eternal imperishable Self (that which never dies which is
always present.) in All Our Relations. Abhinivesah is one of the
most profoundly misunderstood kleshas, especially in this modern
materialistic age where consensus reality has sunk deeply into
the coarse, external, physical, materialistic, and temporal
"reality' at the detriment to the subtle, the inner, the
energetic, spiritual, and eternal. Indeed these two worlds are
not meant to be split into two, but our conditioning does this
all too successfully. Yoga on the other hand is designed to
embrace that re-connection i.e., of eternal spirit as divine
presence at each and every juncture of physical manifestation as
its basis. The young infant is born fresh from the eternal,
while the elderly prepares to re-enter the "reality" of eternal
flux, but for those who live it, they have never left it and it
never leaves. In dualistic religions, Spirit is said to exist in
the beginning and the end (alpha and omega), but precisely that
statement betrays abhinivesa, i.e., the clinging onto a life
bias. Rather, REALITY, as-it-is says that life and death both
belong to a greater wholistic continuum -- the beginningless
never-ending. In other words, in Reality there is an "I" which
is bornless and deathless that exists right HERE and now -- in
the Eternal Now -- the Continuity and Great Integrity which is
authentic yoga. If we were able to shed the conditioning that
frames "reality" as we know it, only in terms of temporal life,
but rather in terms of the eternal now -- the never ending
continuum, then our life would become far richer and productive.
It would be inter-dimensional and holographic. When we embrace
this great continuum -- when we lose our materialistic bias and
prejudice, then we also give up all fear of death -- fear itself
vanishes. HERE the Universal non-dual transpersonal
transpersonal Sacred Presence of All Our Relations -- as Reality
as-it-is -- becomes revealed. II. 4. Avidya ksetram uttaresam
prasupta-tanu-vicchina-udaranam
All the psycho-emotive afflictions, hindrances, obstructions,
and impurities (kleshas) abide within (ksetram) avidya (the
process of ignoring or unawareness) and thus all the other (uttaresam)
kleshas are encompassed by avidya, be they attenuated or subtle
(tanu), active and dominant (udaranam), dormant (prasupta), or
temporally restrained (vicchinna). Avidya (lack of awareness of
what is-as-it-is) being the primary conditioned obscuration and
misapprehension of the self evident Eternal Now (the Great
Integrity) which is self existing in all things and at all times.
Commentary: Vidya means vision or to see. Avidya is the lack of
vision -- the obscuring sliver in our field of vision, the veil
that filters and distorts "reality" -- it is the blinder that
prevent us from seeing what is-as-it-is or Thusness. The problem
of stasis arises (or rather our vision becomes obscured) when we
become conditioned (habituated) to seeing the world, explaining
our existence, and identifying through this distorted lens, veil,
or sliver in our eye. When our familiarity and comfort with this
duality becomes confused with security and "reality", then we
are in trouble (dukha) because we start to demand, prefer, or
mistake our obscured and limited familiar "state of reality" in
favor of REALITY AS IT IS -- unobstructed clarity, true vision,
or the "real thing". Then consciousness becomes occluded and
patterned (chit-vrtti). Then past patterning (vrtti),
conditioning, and negative programming (karmic propensities) are
dominant. Authentic yoga practice is thus geared to both
attenuating kleshas which gives us breather space to work
eventually destroying them all. Avidya is the major klesha in
which all others (uttaresam) fall within its field (ksetram).
Thus the goal of yoga is reached through vidya (through the
removal of ignorance and the kleshas), which brings us back to
this natural unobscured visionary ability of All Our Relations.
Thus yoga practice concentrates on destroying ignorance because
avidya is the cause of all the afflictions and obstructions. Our
unlimited and ever present innate true self nature (swarupa)
awaits us always in the eternal now when all the spins, bias,
and vrttis cease -- when the illusory veil of false
identification and ignorance is lifted. this buddha potential,
our higher self, or the kundalini lies dormant in waiting while
we are lost in this dualistic veil of suffering (samsara), but
when we emerge even for an instant we then see that this very is
our true essential nature, and as such this gives us impetus to
become entirely free (in nirbij samadhi).
Although there are almost an infinite amount of combinations of
kleshas,some of these combinations are: anger, hatred, jealousy,
pride, prejudice, bigotry, arrogance, contempt, disgust,
abhorrence, condemnation, bitterness, resentment, acrimony,
dismissiveness, haughtiness, self righteousness, fear, envy,
paranoia, confusion, insecurity, contentiousness, squabbling,
attachment, competitiveness, revenge, mania, habitual discomfort,
angst, anxiety, vengeance, and self centeredness.
Some of these are often extended in behavior manifestations
which cause collective suffering and bad karma such as:
extensions of ego into group egos, religionism, chauvinism,
nationalism, crusades. jihads, wars, clanism, ethnocentrism,
bigotry, prejudice, tribalism, racism, sexism, regionalism,
languagism, kinsmanism, geocentricism, egocentrism, exploitive
propensities, theft, violence, group predation, scarcity
psychology, self adversity, xenophobia, etc. To a yogi being
free mukti (liberation) depends upon the elimination of the
kleshas. In turn the kleshas such as ignorance, hatred, fear,
ego false identification, religious, ethnic and nationalistic
pride; self righteousness, bigotry, and prejudice is the
manipulative fuel for militaristic/totalitarian and
authoritarian societies. II 5. Anityasuci-dukhanatmasu
nitya-suci-sukhatmakhyatir avidya Thus avidya (ignorance) is
that embedded, programmed, or conditioned state of sorrow (dukha)
where we habitually identify with and fixate upon as something
pleasurable (sukha), but which is transitory (anitya), impure (asuci),
and painful (dukha), confusing the true, real, eternal (nitya),
and pure (suci) Self (atman) of which brings true and lasting
happiness with that which brings more pain and suffering.
Commentary: Avidya (ignorance) is the cause of pain, suffering,
or craving (dukha). Ignorance as avidya confuses the non-self (anatama)
as the true self (atman) in false identification; the impure (asuci)
with the pure (suci); that which is ever changing (anitya) as
being static and eternal (nitya).This is dualism as ignorance as
well as false identification (asmita). Yoga makes the connection
between eternal spirit and nature in a sacred embodiment where
the eternal is continuously present (as divine presence) in the
sacred Now as it always has and will be. This is Reality, where
ignorance is illusory -- the fabrication of erroneous conceptual
processes. By the liberating light of vidya (vision), then
confusion, craving, and suffering (dukha) ceases. The
pre-existing common dichotomous and confused dualistic situation
which Patanjali comments upon is that the common man confuses
suffering as joyful. He confuses craving and desire with
pleasure having confused the anticipation of self gratification
with it's satiation. He has not woken up to how he creates his
own pain. It is likened to a man who eats slow acting poisons
during the day and enjoys it then only to suffer extreme pain at
night. The next day this same man eats and enjoys the poison
again, thinking how good it is, and then again at night he again
experiences pain, suffering, discomfort, craving, or a further
feeling of incompleteness (dukha).
Another example is having an itch. The bigger the itch the
greater the ecstasy becomes when it is scratched and satiated.
But are we not better off without the itch itself? The common
man who has lost his way only knows the temporary pleasures that
occur from satisfying neurotic desires, confusing the presence
of desire with the process of pleasure and thus happiness. But
where is the lasting happiness that spiritual passion is
directed toward? There are many examples like this, but another
more esoteric example is the man who becomes addicted to
massage. He loves the massage so well and it is so pleasurable,
but that type of pleasure is conditional , resting upon the
pre-existing condition where he habitually creates tension and
pain in his body/mind acting unconsciously and ignorantly. the
pleasure that he is experiencing is really the result of his
ignorance i.e., previous actions based on ignorance. This type
of "pleasure" is thus contrived and dependent upon suffering and
can become addictive, while on the other hand yoga is designed
to eliminate the cause of suffering (avidya) and that is why it
is said that it brings True and Lasting Happiness. True and
lasting happiness is found through remediating all neurotic
ersatz attachment to duality. Coming back into wholeness -- into
Samadhi -- into the Eternal Now -- Sacred Presence and All Our
Relations, then there is nothing lacking -- nothing is ignored.
IV Sutra 28 hanam esham kleshavad uktam These samskaras create
kleshas and thus can be eradicated [by the previously mentioned
remediations of the kleshas, samskaras, vasanas, and avidya].
Commentary: See Sutra 30-32 IV Sutra 29 prasankhyane 'py
akusidasya sarvatha viveka-khyater dharma-meghah samadhih Free
from selfish motivation while abiding steadily (sarvatha) in
self luminous discriminatory awareness (viveka-khyater) the
rain-cloud of natural law (dharma-megha) is absorbed (samadhih).
Commentary: Pure awareness or vigilance (in viveka) applied
steadily will create viveka-khyatir (luminous self revealing
discriminating lucidity), the remedial propensity where old
samskaras, old mind habits (vasanas), and vrtti become nipped in
the bud as soon as they arise. IV Sutra 30 tatah
klesha-karma-nivrittih In this way the waves of karma and klesha
are destroyed.
IV Sutra 31 tada sarvavarana-malapetasya
jnanasyanantyaj-jneyam-alpam Then all veils (sarvavarana) and
impurities (mala) are removed (apetasya) so that the knowledge
of infinite mind (jnanasyanantyaj-jneyam) is revealed which
leaves little more (alpam) to be disclosed. Similarly in a
Buddhist perspective kleshas are caused by ignorance. Acting on
the kleshas cause bad karma. "The six poisons are: hatred, or
anger, which creates the experience of the hell realm; greed, or
miserliness, which creates the hungry ghost realm; ignorance of
how to act virtuously is the cause of rebirth in the animal
realm; attachment (virtuous action performed with attachment to
the meritorious results) is the cause of human rebirth; jealousy
(virtuous action sullied by jealousy) causes rebirth in the
demigod realm; and pride, or egotism (virtuous action performed
with pride) causes a godly rebirth. The defilements lead to
unskillful actions, which generate karma, the infallible
operation of cause and effect in the mental continuum of each
individual. The negative karma caused by the defilements is the
origin of the sufferings of the six realms. The only way to
eliminate suffering is to practice the path, method or remedy
that will remove the defilements and the negative karma that
they produce. By developing loving-kindness and compassion it is
possible to diminish the defilements, but in order to uproot
them completely, it is necessary also to develop the
discriminating awareness (Skt. prajna; Tib. she-rab) that arises
from the wisdom of emptiness. The development of loving-kindness
together with wisdom is the result of following the path of
Dharma, otherwise known as the five paths: path of accumulation,
path of unification, path of seeing, path of meditation, and
path of no learning.
The first, the path of accumulation, has three subdivisions. The
first stage consists of taking the first step in the right
direction, that is, taking refuge and practicing tranquility
meditation (Skt. shamatha, Tib. shinay). The aspect of wisdom
that is involved is that of listening to teachings (called the
wisdom of hearing), and of reflecting on them with the
analytical mind (called the wisdom of contemplation). The
contemplation appropriate to this stage is known as the four
applications of mindfulness, which is an examination of the true
nature of (1) the body, (2) the feelings, (3) the mind, and (4)
all phenomena. By logical analysis it is possible to come to the
intellectual understanding that all of these are merely names
for interdependent occurrences that lack any true self-existence,
this prepares the way for an acceptance of the idea of emptiness
(Skt. sunyata; Tib. tong-pa-nyi). The second stage of the path
of accumulation involves the abandonment of negative actions and
the cultivation of virtuous actions, by which merit is
accumulated. The third stage consists of the development of four
qualities, without which further progress on the path will not
be possible: (1) aspiration (strong determination to practice
Dharma), (2) diligence (enthusiastic effort), (3) recollection (not
forgetting the practice), and (4) meditative concentration (one-pointedness
of mind without distractions). What was developed on the first
path becomes stronger on the second, the path of unification,
which is a linking of the ordinary level to the exalted. On this
path the practitioner experiences greater tranquility, more joy
in virtuous action and fewer negative thoughts; confidence,
energy, reflection, concentration, and wisdom increase, and
tolerance of obstacles is developed. Finally the highest
possible mundane realization is reached, a momentary experience
that occurs during meditation, in which the nature of emptiness
is perceived directly. After having this perception, the
practitioner is called a noble or exalted one (Skt. arya; Tib.
pag-pa), one who has immediate insight into the four noble
truths. This experience is like that of blind person whose
blindness is cured and who sees colors for the first time;
therefore, it is called the path of seeing. " Based on a seminar
given by Khenpo Karthar Rinpoche II 6. Drg-darsana-saktyor
ekatmatevasmita The particular aspect of ignorance called asmita
(ego delusion) is the result of the more specific process of
confusing the inherently transpersonal and eternal powers and
processes of consciousness with that of individual
intellectualization or cognition which then results in false or
faulty identification with fragmented existence -- a sense of a
separate "I" or ego.
Commentary: Another way of saying this is that asmita (ego
delusion) occurs when we falsely identify the Infinite power of
consciousness (cit-sakti) which emanates simultaneously both
from within ourselves and within all things-- which is a
reflection (darsana) of eternal and infinite omnipresent spirit
-- as that of a separate intellectual power of a self separate
self standing as an alone seer (drg). In the "ordinary" state of
dualistic consciousness as separate self (asmita) the seer is
not aware that one's vision is being severely limited by this
false identification or bias. When we view an object of
cognition in that framework of duality where there is a separate
self viewing a separate "self" (as object) but we are not aware
of this duality but rather falsely understand it to be one
process (eka), then we suffer from the particular manifestation
of avidya called asmita (or ego sense), rather than as being a
participant and reflection of the universal transpersonal
Undifferentiated Eternal Source which permeates and animates the
entire universe. Asmita is the klesha of the delusion that
identifies oneself falsely as a separate entity (self), ego, in
short an ego delusion, pride, self deceit, arrogance, desire for
recognition, status seeking, power mongering, and related
permutations. In the modern age arrogance and pride are knee
jerk afflictive emotions where the victim attempts to defend and
build up their ego insecurity by reinforcing their delusion
through methods of self aggrandizement, justification, arrogance,
denial of any wrong doing, avoidance of seeing past faults,
demonization or condemnation of others, self righteousness,
inflated sense of superiority -- in short through the many self
deluding reactive methods of arrogance and denial. Asmita is one
of the most difficult kleshas to remedy, because the ego
misidentifies with itself and thus falsely misinterprets signals
that do not support its delusional assumptions as threats to
"ego self", thus either defending "ego selfhood" and/or
attacking the purveyors of the signals (truth bearers and truth
bearing seeds). Arrogance, hubris, overbearing pride, conceit,
smugness, narcissism, dismissiveness, presumption, cavalierism,
condescension, pretension, prejudice, pompousness, disdain,
imperiousness, haughtiness, braggadocio, smugness, cockiness,
over confidence, snobbery, patronage, affectiveness, vanity,
mockery, causticness, flashiness, prestigiousness, snootiness,
boorishness, foppishness, ostentation, self centeredness, self
cherishing, self involvement, egocentricity, ego mania, close
mindedness, narrow mindedness, jealousy, competitiveness,
sibling rivalry, desire for fame, prestige, or status, etc.,
primarily are variants of and/or an admixture of asmita with
raga, dvesa, abhinivesa, and/or the other vagaries of avidya.
Self absorbed or egocentric individuals tend toward delusions of
pride and tend to join groups which reinforce their delusion and
conceit such as organizations that reinforce group pride, racial,
national, religious, or similar supremist organizations. Much of
what is called radical fundamentalism and all other chauvinistic
tendencies stem from this need to reinforce one's already
diminished feelings of self worth and false identification. Such
chauvinistic groups thus feed one's need for delusion and self
deceit. Such people seek out like-minded support groups and
teachings/teachers and ideologies which tell them how great and
superior they are as compared to other groups which differ from
them, thus encouraging provincial close mindedness, while
avoiding, disparaging and/ or demonizing the harbingers of
different minded groups or messengers that contradict their
predilections and narrow mindedness. The powerful remedies for
asmita klesha are the cultivation of humbleness, isvara
pranidhana, citta-prasadanam (I.33), the implementation of true
equanimity, compassion, and loving kindness. When we approach
the truth of our real situation, then the identification with
the transpersonal, eternal, and universal non-dual vision has
taken root and the organism has attuned itself to the Greater
Self Integrity which is eternal, universal, imperishable and
self effulgent. THAT of course is the ultimate remedy to keep in
mind. Swami Venkatesananda translates II. 6 as: The particular
aspect of ignorance called asmita (ego delusion) is the result
of the more specific process of confusing the inherently
transpersonal and eternal powers and processes of consciousness
with that of individual intellectualization or cognition which
then results in false or faulty identification with fragmented
existence -- a sense of a separate "I" or ego. See the last
sutra of the yoga sutras (Pada IV Sutra 34) for a further
elaboration of asmita. Following. Patanjali describes the last
three kleshas of raga (attraction), dvesa (repulsion), and
abhinivesah (fear of death) as all emanating from a primary
ignorance. What is this that we are ignoring -- Reality as-it-is
- our true self nature. II 7 Sukhanusayi ragah Part and parcel
with this ego state of separation caused by ignorance (asmita
and avidya) is the anticipated pleasure (sukha) of attaining the
object of attraction (raga). The anticipation of pleasure in
union creates desire and craving.
Commentary: Raga (attraction or attachment to the appearances of
objects) is the specific false identification or rather
confusion that misinforms us that objects of attraction will
bring about cessation of our cravings or rather create happiness.
Raga is a compensatory displacement of our more primary desire
for union (yoga) with the true imperishable Self misdirected to
a temporal replacement which is secondary, neurotic, and
compensatory. Thus a a habit, fixation, and vicious circle is
created which causes attachment, compulsion, and bondage. This
is the statement of the first Noble truth in Buddhism; that the
ego's tendency to grasp onto objects which are impermanent or
temporal constitutes the major cause of suffering. The fixation
upon an ego, a physical body, or that which is always changing
is just another grasping onto a limited way of being. Life is so
much richer when we let go of such fixations.
Ordinary pleasure is often experienced as the satisfaction of a
desire and thus tension or stress is resolved. One rests in the
present rather than being goal oriented (toward an object). Also
the release or removal of fear, a threat, or pain (physical or
mental) is also associated with pleasure. This type of self
gratification although part and parcel of raga (desire or
attachment) is confused with an anticipation of pleasure (its
gratification), rather than as a struggle or suffering state (dukha).
Here in confusion (avidya) the process of goal orientation is
confused with obtaining its object (they are blurred together as
one) and hence the average person perpetuates their own
confusion of pain with pleasure. One easily can be conditioned
and fall victim in associating the attraction/repulsion as an
anticipation of pleasure/pain. Too often while suffering from
neurotic ego afflictions man puts in front of him neurotic
objects of desire to be grasped or obtained by the ego, such as
in goal oriented pursuits of fame, objects of self worth,
amassing of wealth, symbols of success, authority, privilege,
power, status, commodity consumption (consumerism), etc. The
pain of not obtaining these objects is obvious in raga
(attachment) but the pain associated in craving them in the
first place is less obvious, never-the-less it exists and can be
discerned by the discerning. In yoga the apparent separation
between the seer and seen -- the object of gratification to be
possessed is seen as being based on a false assumption -- the
assumption of duality, ignorance, avidya, and ego (asmita). In
authentic yoga one perceives these false assignations to be
distractive and neurotic -- being both contrived and
compensatory for a greater longing for union due to a more
primary and spiritual dissociation/separation which when
reunified and completed (as authentic yoga) brings santosha (true
contentment) and bliss (ananda) versus ordinary pleasure. Thus
the completion of ordinary desire by obtaining the object of the
desire can at best bring about temporary pleasure, but
eventually more craving is sure to arise until the primary and
non-neurotic passion is completed. A vicious cycle is often
formed where the craving itself is confused with the expectation
of its consummation so that there becomes a perverse association
of pleasure with the process of craving/desire itself. The
greater the anticipation or expectation (raga) the greater the
resultant suffering, yet at the point of obtaining the object
there is a temporary sense of gratification (which is really a
release of tension or strife in getting "there").
The pursuit of security when one is afraid of losing something
because they feel insecure, can be said to be a desire/craving
as well as an aversion, just as the feeling of temporary well
being can over come one after they have escaped from robbers or
murderers. Pleasure is the reward and pain is the payment [for
ordinary neurotic craving]. Ordinary pleasure and pain are two
sides of one coin. Some one carves something and then is
rewarded by its union. That is part of the cycle of samsara.
More craving (pain), then the more pleasure that is sought.
Removing the kleshas (emotional afflictions) springing from
ignorance, then spiritual suffering is eliminated.
Then is lasting happiness possible outside the cycle of craving,
desire, fear, aversion, ego (asmita), pride, greed, jealousy,
and death). All the kleshas when understood come from the same
dualistic source, the estrangement/fragmentation from Self.
Similarly, pleasure can also be accomplished through aversion/repulsion
(dvesa) just like raga, not only in the process of assuaging or
removing fears, but in exacting revenge in gaining "satisfaction",
ego gratification, a compensatory sense of self worth and
victory or justice by exacting punishment to one's enemies or to
those who have inflicted pain upon oneself. Regardless, it is
futile to find lasting happiness in neurotically chasing these
phantoms caused by raga (attraction) or dvesa (hatred or fear).
Raga and sukha have a strong mental component that reinforces
the false identification of ego and pride (asmita) by addicting
the mind to stories, messages, dramas, people and and world
views that tells the story that is pleasurable, gratifying, and
praising to ego pride (asmita) -- that strokes the limited ego
fixation telling it that it is good and worthy. Likewise this
desire for stroking the ego shows up in our preferences,
prejudice, and predilections which anticipate the future and as
such severely limit it and/or create disappointment. The
affliction (klesha) of mental preference occurs when the deluded
ego sees what it desires to see, what is most pleasing to the
ego and supports it, rather than to see what-is as truth. In
other words the spiritual seeker seeks the truth, rather than to
serve its vanity, mechanisms of self gratification, self
justification, and pleasure (of which the latter serves asmita,
pride, delusion, and self deceit). In everyday life because of
our grasping and attachment man becomes subject to manipulation,
corruption, graft, avarice, greed, covetousness, acquisitiveness,
paranoia, rapaciousness, infatuation, possessiveness, addictive
behavior, lust, malfeasance, perversion, prostitution, neuroses,
selfishness, and so forth because the desire for the object
supercedes other priorities such as spiritual values or
conscience. Remember Sutra 17
vitarka-vicara-ananda-asmita-rupanugamat samprajnatah [This
gradual process which is practice without attachment to results]
is at first accompanied by the attainment of a limited knowledge
based on the cognizing mindset (samprajnata), which in turn is
accompanied with (anugamat) various forms of pleasure (ananda),
coarse objectification processes (vitarka), subtle
objectifications (vicara) such as attachment to mental objects
of form (rupa), but such experiences are still associated with a
definite feeling of "I-it" separateness and false identification
(asmita) and thus also has the potential that serves to
reinforce it.
Again fear is simply a negative desire ; i.e., the desire for
something not to happen.Thus any predilection or preference for
something to happen or not to happen
will bring with it some tension and affliction unless we remain
unattached. The larger the attachment, the greater the dukha (pain).
As we shall see raga (attraction) and dvesa (repulsion) are
simply two sides of one coin being the main motor power of
normal neurotic living. The obvious immediate yoga remedy of the
kleshas of raga, dvesa, and asmita is vairagya (non-attachment)
and as a practical application aparigraha. In ashtanga yoga the
practice of the bandhas, tapas and pratyhara serve the same end.
In everyday life generating compassion and engaging in
generosity and selfless service as well as the practice of
chitta-prasadanam (remembering the divine) is remedial to raga.
See I. II 8. dukhanasayi dvesah The anticipated pain or
suffering (dukha) or aversion or repulsion (dvesa) of hatred and
fear of losing an object, and the fear of death that accompanies
those who have not integrated their life with Eternal Source in
the Eternal Now. Commentary: Just as in the previous sutra the
anticipation of suffering or pain (dukha) creates aversion (hatred,
disgust, fear, anger and the like). Dvesa (repulsion, aversion,
hatred, or fear) is based on the confusion that possession of or
identification with other objects, or the fear of losing objects,
or the change of states from one false identification (seemingly
secure) to another will bring about pain or sorrow. Mental
aversion is very often a supporting cause of ignorance where
one's compensatory mechanism of pride is averse to hearing the
truth about its delusion or where one's fixated identification
with the framework of one's existing dualistic world view (avidya)
appears "threatened" by the truth -- where the ego views new
information as a threat to the old identification/fixation of
self (anataman). The mental affliction of fear occurs when we
are confronted by a message that we associate with pain or past
trauma or which is painful to our ego's identification, which
contradicts our sense of security or world view, or else wise
appears as a threat to our identification with the small "self".
In order to avoid that pain (of ego) in aversion, we armour
around it or else protect ourselves from it through mechanisms
of aversion/repulsion and thus maintain our affliction (klesha)
while at the same time reinforcing avidya.
Likewise when we dislike something, that is when we do not
desire it to happen or occur, we say we hate or despise it. It
is a way of disagreeing with "reality' and registering our
dislike which is the other side of raga (desire) which would
consider something desirable, Condemnation, disapproval, blame,
censure, denunciation, blameworthy criticism, abhorrence,
disgust, disdain, and the similar are all statements of extreme
displeasure and horridness -- a decision that a desired result
has not been achieved and more so the undesired result has
occurred. Such is merely an evaluation of the intellect and
belief system based on good and bad (ethics and esthetics) and
is thus both a vrtti and a klesha. Thus all the kleshas are
creations of the dualistic mind and are illusory. Once they are
seen for what they are, they then disappear. hatred is an
aggressive compensatory adaptive way of coping with our pain,
sorrow, and grief. As such it leads us even further astray
feeding the illusion that we are not in reality in pain or in a
grievous situation. Just like raga, aversion can manifest in
many ways in daily life as it is the result of grasping also.
More specifically, aversion and/or its combination mixed with
the other kleshas manifest as hatred, contempt, extreme dislike,
anger, abhorrence, disgust, distaste, rancor, derision, mockery,
hostility, resentment, irritation, disapproval, condemnation,
demonization, antipathy, repugnance, revulsion, haughtiness,
disdain, overbearance, pomposity, scorn, arrogance, and the like.
The ordinary man though, lost in samsara as he is, clings on to
his hatreds, loathing, predilections, bias, hatreds, blame,
disapproval, condemnation of others, desires, pride and
arrogance -- in short his many combinations of afflictive
emotions and obstructions (kleshas) thus not only blocking out
his true nature but most often creating more fuel to feed more
bad karma. This is why the Buddha said that dualistic "life is
hard when we are attached to our ignorance, but very sweet (when
sorrow ends) -- when we have realized the fruit of the path of
our latent innate wisdom (buddha nature or Christ potential). II
9. svarasa-vahi viduso pi tatha rudho bhinivesah The fear of
death (abhinivesa) arises (rudah) from the desire for continuity
in this life. It is perpetuated (vahi) even in the wise (viduso)
through inclination (svarasa).
Commentary: Abhinivesa can more literally be interpreted a "desire
for continuity" and predictability, while svarasa literally
means own (sva) taste (rasa). The ego tends to want to
perpetuate and defend itself. Because it is lost in ignorance,
confusion, and delusion and hence separated from direct contact
with the innate order and meaning of the true Self, it tends to
grasp onto "things" as it is has been known; i.e., the ego tries
to perpetuate itself in terms of the past. Ordinary non-seekers
fear change, defend their egos and views, and habitually define
themselves within a rigid and tight framework of reference which
they cling to. Such a stubborn klesha tends to obscure our
larger transpersonal non-dual identity with All our Relations --
the larger Self. As such it obscures vidya (clarity). That is
the literal translation of this sutra. That creates a rut; the
prison of seeking out predictability in the old order a d thus
one resists change and spiritual growth being locked into a self
perpetuating prison of "the already known". Thus this sutra is
most often interpreted as a statement of some type of fear of
physical death, but in reality Patanjali is addressing ego death.
Since the physical body is the most common and most coarse false
identification of the ego, most interpreters thus take this
sutra only in its most dense and coarse sense (of fearing
physical death). So over time, svarasa has become "interpreted"
as meaning physiological inclination; while abhinivesa has been
"interpreted" as desire for physical existence or even clinging
to life), but readers should know that such an interpretation is
common, but not based on the Sanskrit meaning. Rather if we take
the larger view, then any clinging onto physicality devoid of
energetic or spiritual integration will cause suffering (dukha).
In other words how can we fear the discontinuity of eternal love
or consciousness when we are firmly centered in the experience
of its continuity? It is only when we feel separated and
disconnected from that eternal flow, does the fear of
discontinuity and death arise.That is, clinging onto the
physical body is only one example of abhinivesa. Even if we do
take this fifth klesha, abhinivesah, as the clinging onto
physical existence (or to say it another way the fear of a
physical end) regardless this too is the result of the
insecurity due to not fully accepting life as temporal -- the
true nature of nature which is fire. That is a false
identification or error of mentation. Ii is an error in judgment
that concludes that the earth and the body are discontinuous
with the universe and its origin (shakti/shiva)-- that the
continuity of eternal spirit -- of Sacred Presence - is not
present. It is the fear of the unknown and death -- of
discontinuity itself (the perpetuation of the self or familiar
ordered structure which underlies that specific fear. It is of
course due to ignorance of the innate order -- of knowing the
self within. Thus abhinivesa is based on the illusion of death
or rather the materialistic over emphasis that is most often
placed upon an exclusive physical existence which is not
harmonized with a living creation story -- with a living and
present all inclusive omnipresent god. Physical death is feared
by those who have not integrated (joined) the eternal with the
living -- spirit and nature (or purusha with prakriti) in the
eternal now (while living). This union accomplishes kaivalya,
absolute and unconditional liberation.
Physical death is the big unknown only if one has not
investigated where the body and the universe has originated (shakti
or prakriti) -- where one has not integrated the "timeless
uncreated eternal") Shiva or Purusa) as a living continuity in
their daily life. For these people suffering from the ignorance
(avidya) of false and limited identifications of ego (asmita)
death is frightening. The fear of death represents the end of
everything they possess or are holding onto including their
identification of "self" as the assumption of an ego who is
surrounded by a bag of bones and temporal objects (possessions
or "other' people). In that limited way, then physical death
becomes equated with the great fear of losing "everything"--
total annihilation. But such fear is based on a limited (ignorant)
dualistic assumption of separateness with a
living creation/creator (Shiva/Shakti) in the first place. So
what needs to die in "reality" is only the delusion (ego) of
separateness. With that the fear dies as well. Although,
abhinivesa is more commonly translated as attachment to the
physical body and its physiological function (and hence the fear
of its cessation), when we become attached to that imperishable
great integrity, which encompasses our many rounds of births
from beginningless time, in All Our Relations, then even though
these physiological functions are to be honored and respected,
they will not dominate our emotions, create fear or false
grasping, nor pain (dukha). It's temporal nature will thus be
acknowledged and respected, at the simultaneously as we
acknowledge the imperishable -- as we integrate self within Self
-- crown with root -- spirit and nature, Shiva/shakti. It is a
profound truism that until the fear of physical death is
overcome, the fear of life will always be present. We must
acknowledge, respect, and cherish the human form for what it is,
temporary , subject to disease, old age, and death. Then we do
not become complacent (like the devas) and do not waste our time
here. With this wise perspective we can maximize our opportunity
for spiritual practice (sadhana). The certainty of physical
death actually helps us to embrace the larger Self that connects
us with all of life, all of creation, as well as uncreated
Source which is unending/timeless and eternally present.
Physiological death is always part of an ongoing process of
continual transformation on the physical plane (shakti) and thus
Siva is the traditional governing deity of the end of
manifestation as transformation/death. This sutra assumes that
inherent to the body, there exists a self sustaining life
preserving intelligence -- the innate life supporting energy (prana)
intelligence that is part of prana-shakti which animates the
entire universe. When the yogi's body/mind has become purified,
refined, and tempered through authentic yogic sadhana then one's
consciousness merges with shakti (nature's creative force) --
one's prana shakti merges with cit-shakti, kundalini shakti, and
para-shakti. Then the continuity of eternal consciousness
(Shiva/shakti) is harmonized in the body just as siva/shakti as
represented in prana/shakti are harmonized in the gross physical
body -- spirit and nature -- the body and the mind -- heaven and
earth work in harmony, love, and synchronicity in All Our
Relations. This is where we go for true nurturance and support -
to the love that never dies. Here there is no fear of death nor
attachment to physical objects, rather only ETERNAL LOVE and
life.
There is only one instance where one is still in avidya and also
does not fear death, which occurs by those who are severely
afflicted with dvesa (aversion) so that their pain and suffering
in life are so great, that they crave the end of their physical
existence. here the pain of continuing to live is greater than
the pain of annihilation
(suicide). Such have an opportunity to attain realization at
this time, by letting go of all attachments and embracing the
eternal, but unfortunately more often this opportunity for vidya
is over-powered by dvesa and ignorance (avidya). the dying
process has thus been part of spiritual traditions and practices
for waking up. The dying process being an integral part of the
living process, thus fully coming to terms with death, allows us
to also fully come to terms with life without fear. What is all
too common is that the fear of death will be so strong so that
it inhibits/restricts the full embrace of living -- people
contract from experience and duck life. In fact since physical
birth is the cause of physical death (everybody dies), many
people unconsciously run away from life in the mistaken hope
that they will escape death (by not fully accepting their
birth). For these people life is judged as full of grief and (dukha),
as scary -- full of aversion, fear, hatred, sin, and evil,
because they so much fear dying, misidentifying ego loss and
physical death nihilistically as a personal annihilation.
Another factor here to consciously harmonize is to respect the
body's natural intelligence and instinct to stay alive and to
maintain life (resist disease and death). As above, aversion to
life will not save us, and as such attachment to it only creates
aversion to death. The basic idea of holding onto our grief and
pain is fundamentally flawed. "Who" does that morbid attachment
serve other than the pain body (the egoic dependent self) to
inflict more pain and grief in our lives? Is pain good? Is grief
good? Is death bad? These are judgments that are made by the
conceptual dualistic mind. this error of the mind assumes
falsely that if physical death were "bad", than birth was also
bad, because physical birth is the cause of physical death. Now
if we were able to accept the temporal nature of the body and
CELEBRATE it as an expression of infinite love, then ―who‖ is it
that dies and who/what continues to live? Yes universal
transpersonal non-dual and definitely transconceptual Universal
Soul (Brahman) lives HERE ETERNALLY. That is who we really are,
if we dare to embrace it or accept its possibility. Love never
dies!
On the other hand we have this cult of fear and pain going on
that is crying to be defeated. It says that life is scary, it is
painful, ―bad‖ things are happening, ―life‖ is bad because ―death
is bad‖. That is what the ego fixation surrounded by the "haunting"
bag of bones when one identifies as a separate body from the
life force, creation, nature, and shiva/shakti. That separation
created by the fragmented mind establishes a false
identification and dualistic mindset fraught with fear and doom
for one who has bought into this false assumption. Of course in
Reality there exists a vast non-dual beginningless Reality that
will never die. That is why Patanjali specifically mentions
abhinivesa as one of the chief kleshas built upon ignorance (avidya),
asmita (ego), raga (attachment), and dvesa (aversion). This cult
of fear and doom is opposed to the above mentioned belief that
Unending Intelligent Loving Source presence is always present --
is All There Is in Everything all the time. This last experience
and resultant realization is what wholistic non-dual yoga is all
about. Here the human body is put in harmony with infinite
Source acting as a spontaneous and wise integrator -- a
co-evolutionary instrument in creation for universal creator.
Here body, nature, and beginningless Source are all aligned and
a profound synchronicity occurs. Here divine will and individual
will are synchronized; earth and heaven; muladhara/sahasrara
chakras joined through the sushumna; conflict, stress, and
duality are destroyed. Here the profound teachings of the three
bodies ((physical, energy/astral, and spirit bodies). the five
koshas, the bindu, winds, and channels are all integrated as
divine seva -- love in action (perfect karma and bhakti yoga).
So here abhinivesa is remediated as a profound teaching, that
when learned puts one's neurophysiology and biopsychic
instrument in total harmony with the unconditioned life force --
spiritual non-dual universal and eternal love and healing! Once
one experiences and realizes the continuity (yoga) that always
exists here and now -- the "always-is" beginningless "never-ending"
sacred presence of All Our Relations, then the fear of the
discontinuity of temporal existence will also disappear. The
physical bodies may come and go -- come and go -- but eternal
spirit -- ineffable LOVE is all-ways HERE. Divine love is wisdom.
It conquers fear, aversion, carnal/neurotic/compensatory lust,
attachment, small minded self centeredness, dualistic thinking,
and ignorance -- in short all the kleshas. For each klesha (poison)
yoga offers a profound remediation teaching (pratiprasava)_-- an
antidote. II 10. te pratiprasava-heyah suksmah Even the most
subtle (suksmah) of these five afflictions (kleshas) can be
eliminated (heya) by tracing and redirecting (pratiprasava) them
back into their most subtle origin. Commentary: Here Patanjali
presents the remedy of pratiprasava (redirection of the
manifestation backwards toward the Source) for the elimination
of the above five major kleshas of avidya (ignorance), asmita
(ego), aversion/repulsion (dvesa), raga (attraction or desire),
and abhinivesah (fear of death) while the next sutra discloses
the remedy of meditation.
Pratiprasava (redirecting a phenomena back into its cause) is a
very valuable technique to refine. It is essential to success in
meditation. See the last sutra in the last chapter (Pada IV.34)
II 11. dhyana-heyas tad-vrttayah Meditation (dhyana) is the
efficacious practice that annihilates (heyas) these fractures,
limitations, hindrances, agitations, and turmoil's of
consciousness (cit-vrtti). Commentary: Meditation (dhyana) also
remediates the effects of the kleshas which in turn uphold the
vrtti (agitations and thought patternings that obscure the citta
or consciousness). Similarly, the mental patternings that are
caused by the domination of the kleshas are eliminated through
meditation (dhyana). When the vrtti are eliminated, then chitta
shines forth unimpeded and yoga is accomplished (in samadhi).
See Sutra III.2 for more about dhyana (meditation) which leads
to samadhi. II 12. klesa-mulah karmasyao
drstadrsta-janma-vedaniyah The root (mula) of the kleshas is
rooted in past actions (karma) through the laws of cause and
effect be they realized and active in the present (drsrta) or
imprinted upon the subconscious being latent to be realized in
the future (adrsta). This explains what is experienced (vedaniyah)
in life (janma) and how kleshas arise. Commentary: In this way
the accumulation of negative karma which resides in the
subconscious, cellular memory, neurology, and energy body are
both produced and supported by the kleshas, but further actions
based on the kleshas in turn create the birth of future karma.
The ordinary person is imprisoned by this vicious cycle, while
the sadhak (spiritual aspirant) has taken up functional practice
(sadhana) as its remediation. Another way to translate this is
that the kleshas are a root cause for the continuation of
negative karma. negative karma causes further kleshas, and the
kleshas cause further negative karma. Such forms the basis of
the suffering inherent in this cyclic existence (samsara). thus
authentic yoga teachings attenuates the kleshas and eliminates
our imprisonment to karma. Through good karma (variously called
merit, skilful means, wise and compassionate activities, the
karmic cycles of past programs come to an end. Necessarily here
the kleshas end as well because there is no cause for them to
arise. What arises is thus a pure natural expression of
universal love.
So when we are meditating for example when a klesha first comes
up we can notice it (viveka) such as; "Oh anger, or jealousy, or
desire for a soda pop, oh lust, oh envy, oh mental discomfort.
or .…" But we don‘t have to act nor react to the klesha. What‘s
next we can ask ―show it to me‖ without fear or expectation.
Guess what, they go away then. That is how the monkey mind plays
hide and go seek. Not acting on the kleshas, the karmic
propensities are de-energized and then we rest deeper and more
energized in a peaceful and clear state. Then off the meditation
mat we are more clear minded and peaceful and more quickly
recognize if/when a klesha is arising and just let it go --
noticing it and letting it pass without reacting. When the karma
is eliminated then there arises the unconditioned (natural)
state or unconditional liberation and happiness (not dependent
upon causes. Here we should not confuse physical pain or normal
pleasure (as the reward for desire or rather its satisfaction.
Patanjali is addressing spiritual suffering not neurotic craving.
As Yogeshwar Muni says: Pleasure is the reward and pain is the
payment [for ordinary neurotic craving]. ordinary pleasure and
pain are two sides of one coin. Some one carves something and
then is rewarded by its union. That is part of the cycle of
samsara. More craving (pain), then the more pleasure that is
sought. Removing the kleshas (emotional afflictions) springing
from ignorance, then spiritual suffering is eliminated. Then is
lasting happiness possible outside the cycle of craving, desire,
fear, aversion, ego (asmita), pride, greed, jealousy, and death).
All the kleshas when understood come from the same dualistic
source, the estrangement/fragmentation from Self. We saw in Pada
I how vrtti is associated with klesha and how additional klesha
comes from vrtti. Now Patanjali is telling us about the
relationship between karma and klesha -- how vrtti will no
longer continue to affect, pre-dominate, pre-determine,
re-afflict, obstruct, and cause further negative effects which
limit and condition our experience in the present and future (which
are operational even now) until we remediate the basis (mula) of
klesa and karma. This is accomplished through meditation. In
other words, vrtti (fluctuations of citta) will continue to
manifest in meditation until they are annihilated through
uprooting the causes of the kleshas. Thus in meditation we
become more aware, identify, and re-cognize (viveka) the kleshas
as they arise, and then have the opportunity to let them go
cultivating in turn the natural unconditioned state. This is how
they are remediated (pratiprasava). See II.10 and IV.34) II 13.
sati mule tad-vipako jaty-ayur-bhogah, As long as this basis
(mule) of karma and klesha i.e., ignorance and self grasping, is
not remediated, its undesirable results (vipakah) will occur
(sati) giving birth (vipakah) to a variety of experiences
appearing as they pleasurable (bhoga) or not throughout life
starting at birth (jati) and affecting one's vitality and health.
Without eliminating the basic causes for the appearance of karma
and kleshas then further undesirable results will continue to
appear to arise (vipakah) influencing characteristics from birth
(jati), our vital life force and health (ayur), and experiences
so that we continue to chase pleasures (bhoga) and/or avoid what
is not not pleasurable. Moms and dads start programming children
from the very start. The children are terribly vulnerable at
that stage. Depending on the parents own unconsciousness the
ignorance and neuroses is absorbed directly (via right brain
receptive mechanisms) for "survival purposes. This early
conditioning is very strong, albeit mostly unconscious and forms
the single most hard shell to crack by psychologists as there is
often BIG trauma associated with these early life traumas. Most
definitely positive or negative identifications and preferences
(associations with pleasure and the avoidance of non-pleasurable
experiences) are formed in early life which often effect and
haunt the person throughout the rest of their life.
Children are very sensitive, intelligent, and receptive; albeit
not sophisticated. They get programmed in the womb and in early
infancy. They also come in with past karma (good or bad). Most
moms and dads recognize that to some extent. Psychotherapists
now are recognizing both prenatal and peri-natal traumas. Here
is a link to the Assn. for Pre- and Peri-natal Psychology and
Health is housed. Also the Santa Barbara Graduate Institute
teaches similar prenatal and peri-natal trauma remediation work.
Stan Grof of who developed Holotropic Breathwork also focuses on
that reconnecting process as well. It‘s fascinating but new in
the West, but still big in the East. Yoga of course recognizes
that both siddhas and/or samskaras from past births can and do
have an influence. Yoga is designed to recognize these programs,
samskaras, vasanas, and resultant kleshas (state of ignorance)
and clear them out -- be liberated from them should one desire,
but such requires dedication. These old habits based on
obtaining pleasure and avoiding pain form habitual prisons that
are difficult to break, but our liberation depends on their
remediation. This is well recognized by yogis and psychologists
(although most psychologists will not recognize past life
samskaras and karmic influences). So what my teachers taught me
and what I teach, is to get rid of all the karma and all the
afflictions so that one resides in the natural unconditioned
state (swarupa) regardless where the false identifications and
limited mindsets are coming from. "Where", "why", and "how"
depend on the engagement of the analytical discursive mind. Just
watch it in pure awareness and that clear Light luminosity will
destroy the vrtti.
Kids learn how to play roles and even conform to those roles (identities)
that are expected of them, which they are rewarded to play, are
encouraged, where their sense of existence and security are
acknowledged, or their sense of insecurity is diminished. . They
learn (are conditioned) to chose various roles to play out of
fear and need -- out of ignorance of who they truly are. The
tragedy is of course that is who they learn to be – what they
believe is their ―reality‖ and within that contrived ―reality‖
the reality of who they think they are as they define ―self‖ in
terms of ―other‖ is taken into adult life governing their
destiny and coloring/covering the expression of their creative
evolutionary potential. That is not the aim of authentic yoga of
course. Such fixations and habits have to be surrendered in
authentic yogic practices such as dhyana or authentic hatha
yoga. I can‘t imagine sitting in meditation with all that
garbage going through my mindstream or surrendering deep into an
open posture. The more common problem is that most people forgot
in the first place that they are even playing an acquired role
or that they have fallen inside of some one else‘s
transgenerational dream or trap II 14. te hlada-paritapa-phalah
punyapunya-hetutvat In this way (through the result of avidya
and the resultant kleshas) we become victims upon the winds of
karma which condition the degree, type, and length of the
recurring vrttis which in turn further potentiate undesirable
karma. These karmic winds may produce as fruits (phalah)
temporary pleasure (hlada) or pain (paritapa) depending upon
their causative factors (hetutvat) due to meritorious or
favorable karma (punya) or negative karma (apunya) which result
in joy or sorrow respectively. Thus one becomes locked up, bound,
and enslaved to cyclic existence and dysfunctional thought
patterns. II 15. parinama-tapa-samskara-dukhair
guna-vrtti-virodha ca dukham eva sarvam vivekinah The wise
through discriminating awareness (viveka) witness these
seemingly endless transformations (parinama) and changes from
one mental stage to another (vrtti) as the past habits and
imprints (samskaras) and false identifications with fragmented
reality (dukhair guna-vrtti-virodha) as being needlessly
stressful and painful. To them this wheel of change (parinamas)
[fueled by past karma] is abandoned as suffering (dukha). The
transforming fires (parinama-tapa) of old samskaras are now
redirected towards THAT which knows no suffering.
Commentary: Through abiding in pure awareness without judgment (viveka),
we longer falsely identify with duality, mistaking the temporary
and changing nature of "external objects" as being permanent,
separate, or substantial, thereby avoiding (false identification)
while uprooting samskaras (old psychic imprints and energy
signatures imbedded in the cellular memory and neurophysiology.
so that the actual patterns of suffering (dukha) implicit in
perceiving the world in terms of its apparent disparate
fragments (guna-vrtti) are themselves discerned (viveka). Here
the conflicting and confusing world sparked by the manifold
permutations (parinama) of samskaras and karma are identified
and abandoned. All that which exists in the world of form (as
the gunas) is on fire. For a tantric it is experienced as being
a celebrating fire and oblation -- ever changing and impermanent
-- an offering of self to Self -- as the Divine Spark of Love
being the immutable underlying Source and our true essence (swarupa).
This way one avoids conflict and confusion in true discernment.
Here we train the mind to abide simultaneously in the ineffable,
changeless, core/heart (hridayam) center which knows no bounds,
no end and no beginning. Here viveka is mentioned for the first
time in Pada II. Although most often misunderstood as
discriminating awareness or the discernment process that uses
comparison or reductionist methods, viveka is not to be confused
with merely an intellectual, analytical, reductionist, or
comparative activity of the intellect. Rather viveka is that
application of pure awareness that notices, watches, and
observes what is happening without imposing any further
philosophical frameworks, reference points, words, values,
comparative analysis, conceptual frameworks, or judgment. As
such in raj yoga (the Yoga of Patanjali) the word, viveka,
differs from the usage found in the philosophical and
metaphysical approaches found in the more popular schools of
vedanta and samkhya philosophy which characterize what is often
called jnana yoga. However in the case raj yoga, viveka is not
intellectual inquiry or vikalpa, but rather it is cultivated and
applied in practice (sadhana) of which meditation is the main
focus. Thus in the yoga context, viveka is developed to a sharp
point through abhyasa (consistent or repeated practice over time)
so that the mental processes (cit-prana) does not become
distracted, stray, fixated, or dissipated upon objects of
thought. In meditation practice the ordinary mind often wanders
at first (because of vasana, vrtti, karma, samskara, klesha, etc).
This wandering is noticed and cut short by the sharpness of
viveka and through the application of vairagya (non-attachment).
Through yogic viveka one rests the mind in pure and effortless
awareness -- awareness of awareness -- and as such the innate
Intelligent Source of awareness is eventually disclosed (through
patient practice).
In classical meditation practice there exist three classic ways
to deal with the wandering (monkey) mind after wandering has
been noticed in viveka. One school recommends reigning it back
in to the present -- to sitting meditation, the breath,
concentration or meditation. A second school recommends simply
letting go of the discursive monkey mind thoughts once one
realizes (through viveka) that the mind contents (pratyaksha)
have wandered, thus coming back to the meditation. These two are
similar but in the former there is more of an effort or force
and thus the possibility of inhibition, repression, and even
hypervigilence. In the second school there it is more of a
letting go (vairagya) and thus effort is not applied except in
noticing -- in applying viveka as pure awareness. However in
this second application vairagya alone can create stupor,
dullness, sleepiness, or spaciness in extreme. So what is needed
is balance or sattva. Here viveka and vairagya act as a team.
Here we are training the mind through meditation to eliminate
the vrtti and kleshas through viveka and vairagya. A third
classic way to deal with the wandering of the monkey mind is
through active visualization practice, specific dharanas, and
similar practices such as found in laya, hatha, kundalini, and
tantra yoga thus riding the dragons to heaven. This third way is
only faintly alluded to in Patanjali's Yoga Sutras (mainly in
pada three under the many samyama practices), but is prevalent
in later day hatha, kundalini, laya, and tantra yoga. By no
longer dissipating one's energy (cit-prana) in the dissipating
distractions of the monkey mind caused by past samskaras, karma,
and avidya, then tapas (psychic heat) is generated and harnessed
which feeds the dynamo for further spiritual growth. Here
skillful meditation serves as the gateway for knowing "Self".
For more on viveka see also sutra 26, 28 here in Sadhana Pada
and in Pada IV: Kaivalyam Sutras 8, 15, 21, 26, 27, 29 II 16.
Heyam dukham anagatam Thus the misery (dukham) which is not yet
come, can and is to be, avoided. Commentary: Cyclic existence is
destroyed whence karma, kleshas, and vrtti are annihilated
through an effective meditation practice. II 17. drastr-drsyayoh
samyogo heya-hetuh This confusion of suffering is caused (hetuh)
by our false identification, fixation, and fascination (samyogah)
with the objects of perceptions (objectification), the
objectification of a separate "self' being the greatest
confusion (delusion) is to be avoided (heya).
Commentary: See also the commentary in II. 6. The seer (drastir)
identifies (samyogah) itself as an object in comparison with
another sense object (drsyayoh). This limited fixation (samyogah)
is man's conditioned (karmic) folly -- a love affair with
suffering which is to be avoided. The ordinary mind is in
constant seduction and fascination. It is habitually brought out
(externalized and objectified) into the external material world
of the sense objects which it identifies as such. That "appears"
to be real and we identify and define our "self" in relationship
to that. That is the world of an independent seer and the object
that is seen. As a unit, this is a severe limitation,
preoccupation and a fascination that must be broken asunder (via
viveka). Patanjali says that this ego fixation is a basic
confusion that creates suffering. It consists of not being aware
(ignorance) of the artificiality of the difference our mind
creates between the perceiver, that which is being perceived,
and how the process of perception can color our view. Here
Patanjali is not just pointing out that there is a difference
between the seer and the object that is being viewed (which is
still an edited externalization and abstraction -- a severe
limitation where we ascribe meaning to self and the universe
from dualistic and fragmented means. Here Patanjali is
addressing the profound importance of attitude, stance, and view;
i.e., whether it is fixated, frozen, corrupted, and dead or is
it Universal and alive. When it is frozen we are incomplete, we
start to crave, suffer, and neurotic. When we live in the Heart,
we are completed, artificial fixations are dropped. The latter
is yoga, the former samyoga. In Pada Three we learn the advanced
practice of samyama which connects the objective focus of
concentration with the process of consciousness itself, but here
Patanjali simply is reminding us that in meditation we should
avoid the pitfall of getting sucked into the objectification
process as well as the fascination process as they are two sides
of the same coin, i.e., ignorance or duality. Later on in
Sadhana Pada as part of the eightfold practice (ashtanga) we
will learn how pratyhara is a related effective practice that
redirects our cit-prana from external fixations -- from getting
caught up in dualistic sense experiences, and hence preventing
us from becoming distracted from or forgetful of our true nature
of Self (swarupa). So in the beginning of practice (sadhana) it
is helpful to discern fixations of false identification by
utilizing viveka, withdraw our attention (cit-prana) away from
these false identifications and distractions and then eventually
(in advanced practice) connect as the integration which affirms,
combines, and embraces the same wholistic and energetic
intelligent process of universal consciousness which lies
underneath at the root of the process of seeing, all and
everything that is seen, and the one who sees as the Unborn
spark of infinite love -- . as the purusha. In ordinary
consciousness however, we either blur the process, are not aware
of the differences and functions of the process, or artificially
create distortions and false boundaries which are clung to. In
short we have become conditioned to duality and thus have become
externally fixated. For example, an event may occur. the
observer may react with passion if a samskara is triggered, in
turn activating a vasana or klesha. We may confuse the external
event, object, or phenomena with our feelings (reaction) while
it is really the mind in conspiracy with the samskara which has
created the reaction. Thus a prude may label a sexually
attractive woman as being evil because her presence has
stimulated a samskara where "evil" thoughts or feelings are
triggered. Thus a cause has been confused with an effect. There
exist numerous daily illusions based on such ignorance of our
mental processes and deeply buried samskara (both of which need
to be rooted out in order for self realization to occur).
The resolution to this conflict is simple; i.e., we disrupt the
karmic patterns, reprogram it, burn it up, and free oneself from
avidya through swadhyaya, tapas, isvara pranidhana (kriya yoga),
pratiprasava, and meditation (dhyana) where one changes from the
relational dualistic fixation that defines a separate seer and a
separate object --where the conditioned consciousness is
occupied by these two apparently separate elements into viewing
from the Center -- from the perspective of Universal Heart
Consciousness --when we learn to abide in the Heart of Hearts
through functional sadhana and view All Our Relations from this
vantage point. Jnaneshwar says in the "Jnaneswari" (6-40); "Oh
Infinite One in your Universal form is there anything in which
you do not abide? Is there any spot in which you do not dwell… I
realize now that you are not different from this universe, but
rather that you ARE all this universe". here samyoga is
transformed into authentic yoga as spiritual union. The divine
non-dual awareness where the world of seemingly separate objects
appears to be real, they are experienced as inter-connected --
All Our Relations -- in the unitive wholistic experience where
one simultaneously perceives an object as an effect of a cause
and as a possible further cause in the chain of karmic events
while at the same time the Source awareness that has no
beginning or end -- beginningless time and uncreated space
abides as eternal presence persists. This last stage is beyond
any human words or power to objectify. It can neither be grasped
by the individual mind, but rather exists within the innate
unity where pure consciousness and pure beingness reside -- in
satchitananda. II 18. prakasa-kriya-sthiti-silam
bhutendriyat-makam bhogapavargartham drsyam When we perceive an
object through the dynamic activity of the inner light of
consciousness -- from our light and energy body (prakasa) -- we
are able to see its inherent light as well. From this unity
consciousness gazing upon what previously appeared as a
fragmented material object (something steady, solid, and stable
(sthhiti-silam) being composed of the apparent slow vibratory
motion of the elements (bhutas), but by acknowledging the
splendor of this inner light (prakasa) then know the senses (indriyat)
to be a liberator and revealer (apavarga) of the Great unity --
as all our experiences in everyday life becomes our teacher,
rather than as an avenue for dissipation, duality, and
fragmentation.
Or similarly, the true non-dual intelligent liberatory energetic
nature of the unity of creator/creation which is the essence of
"things" seen or unseen, is illuminated and disclosed by this
deeper power of transcognition (in which the seer, all which is
seen, and the processes of seeing) are a common reflection of an
inherent all
inclusive and all pervasive luminous intrinsic power (prakasa)
and common Source, which is simultaneously experienced (bhoga)
and thus this process of identification with this self
illuminating activity (prakasa-kriya) becomes self liberating (apavarga)
even in our daily experiences. Commentary: The "normal"
dualistic perception and apprehensions of a separate seer
experiencing an apparent separate object that is seen, is not
instructive, but rather dysfunctional and extractive in that it
tends toward further fragmentation, dissipation, and corruption.
However when the meditator rests in the sattvic equipoise, there
the fascination with the gunas (saguna) ceases, while the
nirguna nature of eternal spirit shines forth as the inherent
spark of universal consciousness that pervades the entire
universe (praksa sa) acting as the universal university. The
yogi is not fascinated nor possessed with the gunas, but rather
as we have learned in chapter one, yoga moves our awareness from
the gross (vitarka, to the more subtle (vicara), to beyond even
the most subtle (nirvicara), to nirguna (devoid of the gunas),
and eventually nirbija samadhi (the goal of yoga). HERE the
universal eternal imperishable light which is the beginningless
sourceless source of Mind is everywhere present. Our experience
becomes our teacher within the common trans-personal
non-dualistic union. It is HERE that we have the opportunity to
see behind appearances to the causal. Through functional
authentic yoga practice we eventually see that all is Brahman --
that we are kin to all of creation within the non-dual context
of All Our Relations. In the non-dual and tantric sense then all
our experiences is a vehicle for our liberation (bhoga-apavarga)
-- they are in one sense self liberatory. II 19.
visesavisesa-lingamatralingani guna-parvani Relative and
transitory phenomenon (gunas) can be further broken down,
classified, distinguished, differentiated, or compared (parvani)
as being discrete, concrete, separate, and diverse (visesa) or
on the other hand as being undiverse, indistinct, or
undifferentiated (avisesa), as well as being given symbolic
attributes associated with a substantial form (lingamatra), or
very subtle and without being assigned attributes (alinga) or
qualitative aspects.
Commentary: There is no limit in the way the mind can classify
nature's endless diversity (saguna), but the yogi is not
interested in that kind of external classification system which
is more properly the venue of the physical sciences, engineering,
or academia. All these are ultimately indefinable (alinga) and
empty by themselves. Here the yogi affirms the reality of the
great integrity -- of All Our Relations. There exist myriad ways
men constantly classify, differentiate, categorize, and ascribe
meaning to manifest temporal reality (the gunas), but such is
always biased and colored by the viewpoint (time and place) of
the viewer unless one all from the perspective the
eternal universal principle. The yogi is not interested in mere
symbolic representations and apparitions. The yogi realizes the
vacuousness of such attempts, and thus is not satisfied nor
caught up or distracted in the gunas (manifestations) as being
separate characteristics, but he/she penetrates beyond even the
most subtle to the connection of eternal spirit in the eternal
now. The yogi has become initiated to the eternal consciousness
principle of the attributeless "Self" (purusa as isvara) which
resides in all. See also commentary to Sutra I.19, I.26, and
I.45. II 20. drasta drsimatrah suddho 'pi pratyaya-nupasyah The
cognizer (the one who sees -- drasta) is empowered by a more
pure fundamental underlying power of seeing (drsi) that is
capable of seeing the process of cognition itself once this
process is recognized and turned back into itself
pratyaya-anupasyah). Thus the eyes of the seer is purified (suddho).
Commentary: So what is it that you see when you look out from
your eyes? What happens to you when you sit in meditation? Who
is it who is seeing? In what direction does the cit-prana move
and how can you shift it so that sattva is realized? In yoga we
are looking to go beyond coarseness (nirvitarka), all form, all
characteristics (nirguna) beyond even the most subtle (nirvicara)
-- to the profound what-is. This is a direct perception that is
not dependent upon the five senses. One could say that we now
perceive from the sixth sense -- a way of knowing (gnosis) that
is not limited by time and space. Others say that this is
realized when the kundalini (evolutionary creative energy) has
become activated in the sushumna and has reached the hridaya
(the herat of hearts). From that core center our view is clear
-- splendorous and majestic -- expanded ad infinitum in all
directions and dimensions -- transcendent of linear space and
time -- it is devoid of qualification (nirguna). When who we
really are starts to become disclosed in authentic yoga practice,
we see that what we previously thought of as being the
individual mind, is merely a dim reflection of that great all
encompassing universal mind which encompasses all things. In
fact nothing exists separate from THAT. The intelligent light of
consciousness shines through the eyes of the beholder, but how
many can turn back to see this light of consciousness. Those who
have done so have used conscious awareness to reveal its Source
and then when they see "the so called world" they see all as the
light of God everywhere as All Our Relations. For such the doors
of perception have become cleansed and transformed.
Jnanadeva in the "Jnaneswari" (6-38) speaking of the Supreme
Self says: "You are the source of both prakriti and purusha and
also beyond both. You are the eternal Spirit and there is no one
prior to you. You are the very spring and support of life and in
you alone are contained the eternal knowledge of the three times
and manifest in unlimited form." Here Jnaneshwar reveals what
Patanjali will reveal later that Purusa and Prakrti are in
Reality, One. See III.35, III. 49 and Pada 4 for much more on
this profound unity, granting this is a tantric interpretation.
See also Sutra I.41 II 21. tad-artha eva drsyaya-atma But in
Reality the "apparent" separate existence of subject and object
is merely the result of the observer's false identification with
fragmentary existence. In "Reality" the true purpose (artha) of
that which is seen (drsyaya) exists for the revelation of "Self"
-- self realization (drsyaya-atma). Commentary: Albert Einstein
said: "A human being is part of the whole called by us 'Universe',
a part limited in time and space. We experience ourselves, our
thoughts and feelings as something separate from the rest...
This delusion is a kind of prison for us, restricting us to our
personal desires and to affection for a few persons nearest to
us. Our task must be to free ourselves from the prison by
widening our circle of compassion to embrace all living
creatures and the whole of nature in its beauty. We shall
require a substantially new manner of thinking if mankind is to
survive." So what is it that we see when you look out from the
Heart -- centered in our core energy in sacred indigenous space?
Is it All Our Relations? Also see Sutra I.41 II 22. krtartham
prati nastam apy anastam tad-anya-sadharanatvat This fragmentary
state although completely destroyed (nasta) as such by the seer
who has realized integration or yoga, will none the less appear
as "real" (anastam) to others whose consciousness is obstructed
from Unity consciousness because its constituent parts are
common to both views.
Commentary: The same objects exist as-they-are or appear not to
exist in both views (whether in samadhi or ordinary fragmented
existence blinded in avidya), however they are known differently.
In the latter state the objects are perceived as separate, but
in the integrated state these are not perceived as separate
objects, but are known in a deep and penetrating universal way.
In one sense the material (relative world) does not change
according to how we perceive it, rather it remains the same
independent of our view, except that our consciousness (way of
seeing is altered). Thus the only thing that changes is the
vantage point of the viewer and in that sense then only, does
the entire world change (as the viewer is part of the whole). In
a similar but different thread of thought when we change our
thoughts a wave is generated in all of humanity just as we are a
wave in that great ocean of humanity, all of humanity changes
also. In meditation we may experience this unity consciousness
whose eternal source is unchanging, but in the disparity of
ordinary everyday experiences this non-dual "reality" may not be
reinforced, but rather the mass consciousness and energy of
consensus "reality" within a society often will amplify their
own mass prejudices, bias, provincialism, vanity, nationalism,
and sorrow and tend to draw in those with a weak mind or
intention. The wise will not be drawn in, being able to wed
oneself firmly to the heart while recognizing all the forces
that are involved in the moment, being able to wisely utilize
one's past experiences to one's own spiritual advantage, i.e.,
to empower clarity, self realization, liberation, and love. This
is a gradual process of waking up -- of harmonizing, alignment,
balance, and union. The wise balances the cit-prana in All Our
Relations so that All Our Relations bring us more deeply into
love. II 23. sva-svami-saktyoh svarupa-upalabdhi-hetuh samyogah
The ordinary false fixation (samyoga) between the component
parts of an owner who apprehends the object and the object
itself is based on the false assumption/context of dualistic
thinking. This non-distinction is called samyoga, but when one
recognizes (upalabdhi) within the transpersonal non-dual
operations (saktyoh) the unitive cause (hetu) behind what was
thought to be two apparently separate (seer, the seen, and the
true nature of self as swarupa) underlying powers (saktyoh) at
work, then"who" perceives"what" becomes clarified in the
clarification of the seeing process itself. The distinction of
the true owner (sva-svami) as comprehender and our true self
nature (svarupa-upalabdhi) as the object apprehended become
viewed as the sacred non-dual activity of the union of shakti
and siva -- of prakrti and purusa -- which by itself bestows the
power of self mastery (sva-svami-saktyoh).
Commentary: Ordinary life is governed by the severe limitations
imposed by dualistic thought through past conditioning. We
mistakenly become fixated upon an external or internal object of
perception and define ourself as the separate object that is
perceiving that object. Thus we become locked into a limited,
frozen, dualistic, and materialistic world of the senses through
false identification (sam yoga based on duality). This fixation
(samyoga) is part and parcel of the false identification of
asmita. Thus a valid yoga practice is to consistently disengage
and interrupt that limited fixation process belonging to avidya
(ignorance and the small self or asmita) and to find the
universal spirit as our true natural Self (swarupa) at all times
-- in All Our Relations. This is reality is the unity of Purusa
and Prakrti. As we let go of our false fixations (samyoga) as
they come up, then viveka, vairagya, isvara pranidhana, tapas,
swadhyaya, all occur simultaneously as one practice --as grace.
Vision (vidya) then becomes more constant while avidya is
attenuated in that special place when the seer is able to know
the cause (hetu) of seeing (swami) while one sees the object of
seeing (sva) as the union (samyoga) of Self (purusa) and Prakrti
as our true self nature (swarupa). When we view the world from
the Heart (Hridayam), then all is Grace -- no words will suffice.
True yogic power or self empowerment results by the mastery (swami)
of resolving the apparent polarities and dualities of everyday
life as-it-is (swa) into its causal (hetu) true self nature (swarupa)
by recognizing the Eternal Cause, Source, and Origin of All
Intelligence including the intelligent power (saktyoh) behind
cognition in all our everyday relationships and experiences --
in All Our Relations. Just as the spark resides in the raging
fire, it is often obliterated by the superficiality in
specificity or isolation of the appearance of the fire. But if
we see the fire as it is, then such superficial specifics vanish.
Resting in THAT unity consciousness which is devoid of the
illusion of the dualistic and contrived separation of the seer,
the seen, and the cause of the process of seeing is brought
about by synchronization with our true core essential nature
recognizing that the one who comprehends and the object that is
apprehended belong to the Universal university where Self is
beholding and revealing Self simultaneously. This non-dual world
is where the lila of siva/shakti plays. HERE our experience and
our perception of our experience become synchronized, empowered,
and enlivened -- HERE there is no longer friction between
experiential or subject "reality' and the way the mind
interprets events rather both are united in the unitive state of
authentic yoga. This is both uplifting and empowering. It is a
truism that when we reside inside our core/heart energy the "vicissitudes
of life" do not bother us, but when we are "out of synch" then
even a seemingly small trifle may cause upset, pain, and anxiety.
Although many people have experienced this, few know how to
reliably get back into synch -- into the flow. Fewer still are
those who can continuously reside in the deepest courses of
creative flow -- in nirbija samadhi empowered by the perfect
eternal embrace of siva/shakti.
See also Sutra I.41 II 24 tasya hetur avidya II 25
tad-abhavat samyoga abhavo hanam tad drseh kaivalyam Ignorance
Avidya) of this (tasya) process is the cause (hetu) of avidya.
Likewise ignorance (avidya) of our true nature is the cause (hetur)
of our fixations and false identification with separate objects
(experience of separation, duality, or polarization of an
perceived object and the one that acts as the perceiver). In
that way we continue to fracture and corrupt our experiences,
making it disjointed and neurotic (until our grasping unto it is
relinquished). Thus avidya is the first cause of all the kleshas
and when it's burdensome veil is lifted the truth discloses that
the nature of liberation is not isolation, separation,
independence, and fragmentation, but rather unimpaired direct
communion, inter-connection, and union through which an
authentic authentic yoga practice evokes, until ultimate samadhi
(freedom from separation and obstruction which is kaivalyam) is
realized. Here we identify only with pure universal
consciousness (purusha) as-it-is in its true nature (swarupa),
dissolving (hana) all prejudice, taint, and limited dualistic
views (drseh). Commentary: To sum up, the ordinary man is bound
by ignorance (avidya) which reinforces separation; i.e., asmita.
false identification, and the rest of the kleshas. From the
ignorance which is duality then false identifications become the
norm, and we do not realize whence our consciousness has become
fixated, possessed, fascinated, possessed, obsessed, extracted
to, distracted, objectified, and imprisoned to. Various
practices such as viveka, vairagya, and meditation (dhyana) then
lend themselves (tad-abhavat) to enabling us to extract and
liberate ourselves from these apparent attachments and
diversions to appearances which are seen (drseh). Thus
abandonment (hanah) of limited false identifications and
fixations (samyogah) occur more naturally. Then ignorance is
destroyed (abhavat), thus unconditional liberation (kaivalyam)
from that which is seen (drseh) eventually occurs naturally.
What follows from this natural liberation (kaivalyam) is the
natural abandonment of ignorance, fixations, and dualistic false
identification ceases.
Through the realization of nirbija samadhi (ultimate union and
integration) comes kaivalya, absolute liberation. Kaivalyam is
not a freedom from "any thing" but rather freedom from
separation itself; i.e., All Our Relations. HERE there are no
limitations because one is merged with boundless Self in the
Heart of Hearts. HERE the veil of ignorance (avidya) has been
lifted and the vrtti have become annihilated revealing the
natural self abiding self" (swarupa) -- the goal of yoga.
Without the removal (hanam) of ignorance (avidya) the false
dualistic identifications and fixations (samyogah) could not be
removed, and hence the highest synchronization of authentic yoga
could not exist (abhavat). All false and limited identifications
and ignorance are removed in kaivalyam. See Kaivalyam Pada
especially Sutra 34 for more.
II 26. viveka-khyatir aviplava hanopayah The skillful means (upaya)
that removes (hano) ignorance, fixation, and false
identification is the continuous, uninterrupted, constant, and
unbroken (aviplava) application of pure discriminatory awareness
(viveka-khyatir) -- being able to discern or notice in pure
awareness (viveka-khyatir) when duality or vrtti arises -- thus
affording ourselves the opportunity to apply the skillful
remediation process (upaya) of moving the vrtti back into the
stillness from which it came. Commentary: An unwavering self
revealing luminosity of discriminatory awareness (viveka-khyatir)
is the skillful means (upayah) which nullifies or removes (hana)
ignorance (avidya). Yet another way of saying this is that
effective meditation is achieved when ignorance is reduced or
removed through the skillful, continuous, and automatic
application of viveka-khyatir. In viveka-khyatir we notice,
observe, and become aware of the arising of the fixation/false
identification with its resultant veiling of consciousness, and
we then are able to remove or nullify it (hanopayah). Then we
let go of that fixation (vairagya) easing ourselves into the
more expansive consciousness that knows no bounds -- Eternal
Presence. In fact such fixations lose their hold entirely and
will not even arise when viveka-khyatir becomes constant and
unbroken (aviplava) through skillful means (upaya). First we
learn how to do this is in meditation practice (dhyana), but
then we can more easily apply this wisdom to everyday life in
All Our Relations. Viveka is a key process in our meditation. We
apply awareness to our process of awareness itself so that when
the mind apprehends or becomes fixated upon an apparently
separate object, we are aware that the contents of the mind has
become occupied. Through viveka we are able to disengage this
form of possession (vairagya) and return awareness back (pratyhara)
into its source (citta) which has no bounds.
Again viveka is not to be confused with the intellectual or
analytical processes of samkhya or vedanta, but rather applied
in meditation practice (raj yoga) one becomes aware when the
mind has wandered over time more easily and with less effort (through
a more consistent constant application and familiarity with the
process of self awareness). Thus one knows where the mind is (viveka)
and wandering and fluctuations of the mental processes
eventually ceases. Here Patanjali uses the word, khyater, (clarity
of illuminating wisdom) along with the word, viveka, indicating
that this is not just the application of discriminatory wisdom
alone, but a particular way of seeing through viveka-khyatir has
been gleaned through practice. Viveka-khyatir, as the pure
awareness of pure awareness -- as the clear lucidity that
discloses grows inside as an opening to the intelligent
Universal Source of Consciousness itself (ascribed to purusha in
samkhya philosophy) -- it is the citta shining through more
brightly -- the True Self our own true self nature which abides
within. So let us be clear that although we can ascribe names to
this illuminating wisdom (viveka khyatir), the light of that
light (the param pursuha) is the illuminating source which is
shining through and to which the yoga is meant to reconnect us
with as an unbroken continuity. It is because we are have become
fragmented from that continuity or Great Integrity, that we need
to practice yoga in the first place.
See commentary on viveka in Sutra II.15 above, Sutra II. 28
below, and in Pada Four: Kaivalyam, Sutras IV. 8, 15, 21, 26,
27, 29. Although Patanjali's advice is to be taken at first
within the context for the practice of meditation, we can apply
it (viveka-khyatir aviplava hanopayah) in All Our Relations as
it leads to All Our Relations II 27. tasya saptadha
pranta-bhumih prajna Thus wisdom (prajna) is applied throughout
(pranta) [to integrate and intensify this continuity of
consciousness] by discerning seven (sapta) discrete phases (bhumih)
in our yoga practice [leading to samadhi as the eighth].
Commentary: Viveka-khyatir produces a luminous clarity or wisdom
(prajna) in seven stages (bhumis) which has always been
accessible being timeless and beginningless (pranta). The
development of this self luminous wisdom is self revealing to
those who have sought spiritual discernment. It can be broken
down into seven stages. As wisdom dawns, so does ignorance fall
away. As ignorance falls away, wisdom dawns. Through practice we
see that wisdom supports more wisdom -- that elements of all the
limbs are found in each other, i.e., that they all reflect the
overall tree of yoga and are mutually synergistic. We will find
that each stage is mutually synergistic, each able to mutually
access, support, and amplify each other, while always keeping in
mind that they in reality form an interactive dynamic whole
being capable of both accessing the evolutionary Source of
Consciousness and Beingness as well as being its natural
expression. The seven connecting stages can be viewed in many
ways. One way is to discern the connections between:
1. yam and niyam
2. niyam and asana
3. asana and pranayama
4. pranayama and pratyhara
5. pratyhara and dharana
6. dharana and dhyana
7. dhyana and samadhi
Patanjali has just finished his discussion of avidya (ignorance)
with its concomitant kleshas, karma, and false identifications
Although kriya yoga, pratiprasava, dhyana, and viveka-khyatir
were mentioned as remediations, now we begin the discussion of
the major sadhana of ashtanga (eight limb) yoga, which can be
said to have seven stages or rather phases between the eight
limbs. Others say that the reference to the seven phases is a
mystical reference to correspond to the development of the seven
chakras. Vyasa and his school break this down into graduations,
each one removing another layer of ignorance, while disclosing
an underlying expansive view (vidya) ending in absolute
liberation or kaivalyam (see pada 4). II 28.
yoga-anga-anusthanad asuddhi-ksye jnana-diptir a viveka-khyateh
Through the practice (anusthana) of the following (eight) limbs
(angam) of yoga the obstructions and impurities (asuddhi) which
occlude the vision of truth are destroyed (ksaye) which in turn
allows the inherent self existent effulgent awareness (viveka-khyatir)
to shine forth (jnanadipti) revealing the intrinsic all
inclusive profound unity (the Great Integrity) more profound and
greater than the depths of the processes that ordinary
discernment can penetrate. Commentary: It is not strange that
after applying viveka (discernment) to the monkey mind, the
habit of following the monkey mind in all its wayward
discursions and dissipations becomes broken up. One learns to
abide in the light of pure awareness. A balance between vairagya
and viveka is attained and eventually new more sattvic patterns
are energized giving rise to a greater all inclusive and
intrinsic awareness which existed underneath the winds and
agitations of "normal" coarse discursive mentations of vrtti,
but was occluded by it. Through the following of eight limbed (ashtanga)
practice we start knowing more directly about "Self" and the
process of consciousness itself -- such a practice in itself is
self disclosing. In yoga, thus the fruit is known experientially,
i.e., the practice itself produces the experience which is the
fruit rather than in some other systems the approach is rather
through gathering external knowledge "about' the experience, but
the experience itself most often remains elusive and enigmatic.
Here through yogic practice the impurities that occlude the
vision of truth are destroyed allowing the immanent and
intrinsic self effulgent awareness to shine forth from within.
We become brighter as the world becomes luminous/illumined.
See Sutras II. 15 and II.26 for more on viveka.
II 29.
yama-niyama-asana-pranayama-pratyhara-dharana-dhyana-samadhayo'stav-angani
The eight limbs (asta angani) of yoga (which are yama, niyama,
asana, pranayama, pratyhara, dharana, dhyana, and samadhi) work
as mutual synergists together in order to create a beneficial
momentous whole. II 30.
Ahimsa-satya-asteya-brahmacarya-aparigraha yamah Certain
activities hinder our progress in yoga. If they are wisely given
up while their opposite qualities are nourished (yama), then our
progress will flow more smoothly and quickly. These yamas are
ahimsa (non-violence, i.e. the removal of violence from our own
life as well as others (taken in the non-dual sense, in which
the two are really one), satya (truthfulness being the removal
of the veils of deceit and falsehood from our lives including
that of self deceit), asteya (honesty, non-stealing,
non-exploitation of others, and integrity in All Our Relations),
brahmacharya (continuity, centeredness, wedded-ness, or one
pointedness to the all inclusive weave of "Source" -- harmony
and union in true Integrity while not allowing oneself to be
distracted from the spiritual goal), and aparigraha (non-possessiveness,
non-greed, non-envy, non-attachment, letting go, non-false
identification penetrating throughout the mind in meditation as
well as in all our relationships as the simplification of our
life so that we are better able to focus on the spiritual goal
latent in every moment). "Yamas and niyamas all have their root
in ahimsa (not harming living beings); their aim is to perfect
this love that we ought to have for all creatures..." From the "Yogasutra-bhashya"
2.30, by Vyasa, the oldest commentary on Patanjali's Yoga Sutras,
trsl. by J. Varenne, "Yoga in the Hindu Tradition", Univ. of
Chicago Press, 1976 Since everybody on the planet has caused
some harm to other animal forms or plants, the spiritual truth
that ahimsa points to is simply to more deeply commune and
inter-connect with the practices of non-violence, not harming
others or self, and actually removing harm to others (healing)
and self especially in the transpersonal sense where "the other"
and the self are one in our daily actions so that balance and
continuity in our authentic yoga practice is accelerated and
realized. Thus bringing ahimsa into our lives is a healing
action for "Self" as others, bringing less harm and abuse into
our own lives, while promoting healing and well beingness.
Yama is commonly mis-translated as being similar to external
Western moral dictums, proscriptions, codes, standards, and laws,
such as if you break such written or externalized rules, one
then becomes punished. But there is not any thread of similarity
to what Patanjali means by the word, yama. No where does
Patanjali hint upon Divine retribution, vengeance, or punishment.
Rather yam/niyam are the first two limbs of ashtanga yoga and as
such are practices that lead to samadhi. As such they are
offered up as guidelines or suggestions in a "take it or leave
it" attitude where one may practice any of the limbs be they
yama, niyama, asana, or pranayama, or ahimsa, or dharana, or any
other sadhana. Patanjali is stating clearly that all of the
limbs taken together for the mutually synergistic practice of
ashtanga yoga which is designed to lead one to samadhi.
Patanjali had already stated in Pada One that yoga eventually
leads to the activation of the inner seed bearing wisdom (rtambhara),
and is not even close to a process of placating an externalized
God or authoritative system nor conforming to external dictums.
The main difference between Western moral systems on one hand
and yama/niyama on the other hand is that for the average
Westerner, God wrote a list (external book) of commandments,
which if not followed lead to sin; while the yogis comprised a
list of practices which if practiced in a coordinated manner
lead synergistically to the ability to see and read the inner
law which ultimately leads to liberation. Thus the road to
salvation for the yogi is not found in some old external books
or words, it is not found in obeying rules per se, nor is it
found in conformity and obsequiousness at all; but rather yam/niyam
are indicators of that state of Divine union. They are only
tools (as opposed to absolute imperatives) which develop
increased sensitivity, awareness, inner wisdom, and which
activates one's inherent creative power. The laws of the
universe can only be distantly approximated by written words let
alone rules, as such they are not the logos itself. just as
there is a huge difference between a map and the territory. The
laws of the universe can not be written down in words, but
rather they must be realized in our intimate participation. then
as that Divine union (yoga) is integrated they are then
naturally realized and manifested in our daily life -- within
our very heart as our Heart identity -- in All Our Relations. It
is rather a serious distraction to follow anything external to
one's true Self or heart. Belief in external rules or ideologies
are what the vrtti of pramana are composed of and as such they
lead toward kleshas, not the least are aversion, pride, and
prejudice. They are an obstruction put between us and the
divine. That curtain must also be melted and annihilated.
Thus from a yogic perspective, yam/niyam are not ends or goals
in themselves, nor are they rules nor proscriptions in the
Western sense, but merely remedial processes designed to help
move us into realization of the inner eternal law (Sanatana
Dharma) of the Heart -- the authentic goal of yoga. The
following yam/niyam are discussed in greater length elsewhere,
but briefly a few points may serve clarity. Yam and niyam work
synergistically. As indicators of the Divine union of the
aligned primordial man (called Adam Kadmon in the Kaballa) or
Jivamuktan, they all are pointers pointing to the same "reality"
-- they are corollaries to the same grand underlying Great
Integrity of All Our Relations which are revealed through
effective yogic practice. As a two way street they become
naturally expressed as the result of tasting or abiding within
non-dual unity consciousness, and similarly when they are
practiced with purity they also lead us to that realization. As
such they can act as guides. They are practiced with body,
speech, and more importantly with mind and intention, and they
contain both gross and subtle levels -- both inner (antar) and
outer practices. They are powerful in identifying and
remediating wayward tendencies and activities of the body,
speech, and thought. For example using this scheme, Brahmacharya
practiced in thought, regardless of the external activity, is
far more powerful and beneficial than gross Brahmacharya
practiced physically, but without Brahmacharya of mind. This way
they are not restraints in the ordinary sense of the word,
because there becomes no "bad" tendency to restrain. This is not
to say that it is beneficial to act upon random compulsions, the
afflictions of the mind (kleshas), out of bad habits or
tendencies (samskaras and vasana), neurotic tendencies, lust,
greed, selfishness, ignorance, aversion, and the like; but
rather it is far better to remediate the Heart/Mind of these
wayward tendencies for example through realizing the fruit which
underlies the synergistic application and practice of all the
limbs of yoga. If we consider the word, yama, it can be defined
as the end, as yama is the god of death. From the Yoga Sutras we
learn that the death of one is actually an affirmation and birth
of another. Although uncommon, one may break down the word, yama,
in an unconventional way; ya meaning that which moves, while ma
represents the mother principle -- nature's/creation's nurturing
principle. Thus in this analysis yama means to bring forth and
nurture into fruition by moving with the nurturing principle.
Naturally when one activity ends, then there is energy freed to
go into another direction. Death in one sense is an illusion,
while really things morph and change; i.e., there is rebirth and
constant change. Only if "things" could be frozen in time, would
"death" exist, but we learn that time as well as death then, is
an illusion.
Thus in this way (like all the other limbs) yama does not have
to be seen as a negative, a restraint, or even a willful
practice; but rather as a natural surrender, as LOVE shining
forth -- thus as a positive affirmation. In this sense then
ahimsa does not mean to restrain violence, but rather to remove
violence and suffering as well as it's
remnants (such as samskaras). As such it is a healing
affirmation that not only removes suffering but brings forth
happiness. Ahimsa brings forth healing, kindness, gentleness,
and love not only into our own lives and that of "others" but
into/from the profound realization of our True Self -- of the
unconditional happiness that comes from the realization of the
unconditional/natural truth. So only in the larger sense the
yams are more than a counteractant to an opposite tendency, but
rather they herald in and affirm the underlying unity of All Our
Relations. Satya thus does not mean to restrain deceit as much
as to bring forth Truth; i.e., to remove falsehood, confusion,
illusion, delusion, and ignorance. It is not so concerned with "telling
the truth" externally as much as it is in its inner (antar)
esoteric meaning of removing the ingrained samskaras which
support self deceit and conceit. Thus satya when practiced with
the body, speech, and mind in All Our Relations becomes a
profound transformational practice. Brahmacharya is to reveal,
acknowledge, and act in accordance with the eternal inner
eternal teacher in All Our Relations. In All Our Relations we
are wedded to Brahma and Brahma in All Our Relations.
Brahmacharya is practiced thus not as a restraint of the body,
but within the integration of the body, speech, and mind as an
affirmation of a way of life. Asteya and aparigraha are not only
to eliminate exploitation, contradiction, deceit, self
dishonesty, greed, attachment, and selfishness, but to act to
promote integrity, honesty, generosity, trust, abundance,
fulfillment, and gratefulness, contentment, and clarity in All
Our Relations -- body, speech, and especially with an integrated
HeartMind. II 31. Jati-desa-kala-samaya-anavacchinnah
sarva-bhauma maha-vratam Applying these yams to all situations
by the practitioner, at all times, without limitations or
exceptions will turn the tide effecting closure of and sealing
off the great gate of death and dissolution, thus moving us into
greater synchronization with the transconceptional and natural
laws of universe as it is (Sanatana Dharma).
Commentary: The yams have the power to close the gate of
suffering and rebirth -- they have the power to end woe of
cyclic existence. Here the outgoing gate of distraction and
dissipation is closed -- the wheel of cyclic existence (samsara)
which causes suffering (which is the realm of the god, yama,) is
reversed. This closely corresponds to the hatha yoga bandha
activities which are applied to specific gates affecting the
granthis (psychic knots) corresponding to the various lokas
(spiritual realms). See Sutras 33-34 below.
In the essence of the yams, the essence of all the other yoga
practices can be found. Their essence can be applied in all
other yoga practices as well. Their meaning is revealed in all
authentic spiritual practices. They are multi-layered having
inner and outer, subtle and coarse, mental and physical meanings
and connotations which are revealed through practice (versus
analytical reasoning, speculation, rationalizing, or discursive
thought). Their essence is universal and inter-dimensional (sarvabhauma)
and includes no limitations (annavacchinnah) of time (kala),
place (desa), or level (jati), rather it integrates us in every
dimension of being (samaya). Taking up such a powerful all
inclusive practice in All Our Relations completes the great
circle and makes us whole -- it celebrates the Great Binding
Together (maha-vratam). Maha-vratam also refers that the
practice of the yams eliminate the outflows and distractions of
the cit-prana -- from distraction and nescience to integrity and
vidya. Maha-vratam seals the gate of creating more bad karma (acting
on nescience). Thus maha-vratam also refers to our awakening to
the deathless universal consciousness which is eternally
omni-present. Thus the yams seal as well the outward leading
gates of death and rebirth into states of ignorance. As stated
above, when we seal an energy leak in one direction, when we are
freed from the knee jerk activity of neurotic dualistic behavior,
then there is energy freed to go into another direction. Death
only exists as an illusion -- in terms of fragmentation, while
in the larger scope of REALITY, things morph and change; i.e.,
there is rebirth and constant change. Since it is an illusion to
think that things by themselves can be frozen in space and time,
then "death" as a thing also is non-existent. Again time as well
as death then, is an illusion, caused by the rigid tendency of
objectivity to artificially freeze and lock the frames of life
as if life was like a movie screen where the projector became
frozen. Yams and niyams are practices which are based on Divine
indicators of samadhi -- of the perfect yogic alignment. Thus
they help wash the bloodied hands of the bad blood and karma
already spilled and that which would be spilled and wasted in
the future. Thus yam/niyam not only seal the gate of distracted
and dissipated consciousness and energy (chit-prana), but move
also activate the innate light of the inner wisdom activating
our dormant evolutionary potential, the kundalini -- they help
us see the universal Love in All Our Relations. If we are not in
that situation of ecstatic spirited love, then we can be certain
that a vrtti or a klesha is operational blocking or distorting
our innate clear vision.
Here the yam/niyams point to the one non-dual truth of All Our
Relations where there is no separate self, no separate object,
no ego delusion (asmita), no ignorance, rather just Eternal Self
reincarnating/manifesting in infinite forms. Practicing the yams
puts an end to the downward spiral of pain filled (dukha) cyclic
existence (samsara), coarseness, ignorance, violence, etc. In
our translation we use the word, sanatana dharma, literally as
the eternal law, "Reality" as-it-is without artificial
contrivation or relative bias contaminated by dualistic subject/object
limitations -- not as a statement of any one religion, doctrine,
ideology, philosophy, or moral system. II 32.
sauca-samtosa-tapah-svadhyaya-isvara-pranidhanani niyamah Niyama
consist of saucha (purity), santosha (contentment and
peacefulness), tapas (spiritual passion and fire), swadhyaya
(self study and mastery), and isvara pranidhana (surrender to
the Universal Great Integrity of Being). Commentary: Thus the
yams are not merely restraints or counteractants, but rather
actions that bring forth. They have a strong remedial effect.
For example truth counteracts deceit, asteya remediates thievery,
etc., but the niyams reflect even more the causal value,
underlying principles, and fruition of the yams. "Ni" (as in
niyam), means that which is inherent or underneath. As such the
niyams clarify, complement, and expand upon the yams. The
niyamas thus are even more proactive actions (versus
counteractive actions such as in the yams) that Patanjali
encourages us to engender and to undertake in order to
accelerate one's success in yoga. Again yam and niyam are both
two way streets. For example, ahimsa and satya promote saucha
and swadhyaya, asteya and aparigraha lead to santosha and tapas,
brahmacharya leads to isvara pranidhana, while the reverse is
also true; i.e., that the practice of the niyamas leads to the
realization of the yams. II 33. vitarka-badhane
pratipaksa-bhavanam Qualities born from the coarseness and low
vibratory qualities of fragmented existence (vitarka) become
remediated (pratipaksa) through the application and cultivation
(bhavanam) [of these yam/niyams]. Commentary: Thus when
consciousness is agitated, unwholesome, discontinuous, and
corrupted by the coarseness produced by the ordinary discursive
cognitive faculties of fragmented materialistic thought patterns
(vitarka), it can be remediated and balanced (pratipaksa) by
questioning the basis of all dearly held beliefs and attachments
by entertaining the possibility of their opposite meanings (pratipaksa-bhavanam).
Here again the yams/niyams point to the nirvicara (beyond even
the most subtle mental contamination produced by the confusion
of a separate subject/object relationship) Great Integrity of
the sacred place of All Our Relations. Here the yams/niyams all
point to the non-dual transpersonal Great Binding (Maha-vratam)
or Unity which underlies Yoga.
II 34. vitarka himsadayah krta-karita-anumodita
lobha-krodha-moha-purvaka mrdu-madhya-adhimatra
dukha-ajnana-ananta-phala iti pratipaksa-bhavanam [The
functional practice of the yam/niyams] act as remedial
application (pratipaksa bhavanam) which balances the forces of
corruptive influences of violence (himsadayah), lobha (greed),
krodha (anger), and moha (delusion) no matter if they are
present subtly or coarsely having the latent potential that
leads us into future suffering (dukha) and ignorance (ajnana).
All these existing negative feedback loops can be effectively
balanced out and nullified (pratpaksa-bhavanam) [by the
application of yam/niyam]. Commentary: Actions of body, speech,
or mind based on coarse thoughts which in turn are based on
separateness (vitarka) result in himsha (violence, greed (lobha),
krodha (anger), and moha (delusion) lead to suffering (dukha).
They come from pain and ignorance and lead to even more pain and
ignorance unless they are remediated by the wise (through the
balancing out these negative states through the application of
yam/niyam). Coarse breath, speech, physical actions, breath, and
mental thoughts are all related. Acting upon them only brings
more suffering and ignorance. All the yoga practices help us
move from vitarka to nirvitarka and from vicara to nirvicara
until our vibrations and awareness are raised and we are moved
only by love. We will see how all the yam/niyam are all
inter-related with each other, how they all are mutual
synergists top the other limbs, how they may be applied, and how
they complete the great circle with the Heart of yoga residing
in the middle of middles -- in the Great Heart Center -- the
Hridayam. The yam/niyams reflect this Great non-dual Truth and
also bring us closer to it through aligning with these in daily
practice -- in deeds, in words, and in thought. Paramahansa
Yogananda's commentary to the Bhagavad Gita , (SRF, Los Angles,
1999 ) says in chapter VI. 37-38s: "Arjuna said: (37) O Krishna!
What happens to a person unsuccessful in yoga -- one who has
devotedly tried to meditate, but has been unable to control
himself because his mind kept running away during yoga practice?
(38) Doesn't the yogi perish like a sundered cloud if he finds
not the way to Brahman (Spirit) -- being thus unsheltered in Him
and steeped in delusion, sidetracked from both paths (the one of
God-union and the one of right activities)?
(39) Please remove forever my doubts, O Krishna! for none save
Thee may banish my uncertainties The devotee who performs
meritorious actions develops divine memory and good karma that
propel him to seek liberation in this life or the beyond. The
memory of the divine bliss of yoga practice lies lodged in his
subconscious mind. If he is not able to find full liberation in
one life, in his next incarnation the hidden memory of his past
experiences of yoga sprouts forth in spiritual inclinations."
Now Patanjali describes the five yams in detail in sutras 35-39
II 35. ahimsa-pratisthayam tat-samnidhau vaira-tyagah Thus by
establishing a firm alignment and stance with ahimsa (non-violence),
then harm, hostility, hatred, contentiousness, conflict, and
disease in our life is reduced and removed. Future seeds of
ahimsa are planted. Commentary: Ahimsa is considered the primary
yama in which all the others can be derived. There are countless
ways to derive this connection. One way is that by removing harm,
violence, pain, and suffering to "self" we commune more deeply
with that which heals -- the healing force. To cultivate ahimsa
in relation to others we see that this brings more ahimsa energy
into our own very life. After a while we become aware that in
order to bring ahimsa into our lives more, it has to be
unconditional, i.e., it becomes a wholehearted, unfettered,
automatic, and spontaneous transpersonal affirmation as we
become more certain of what we want and who we truly are.
Through the practice of ahimsa -- through our direct experience
of it, we increasingly start to see the underlying transpersonal
nature of ahimsa and where it is coming from -- its healing
Integral Source. When we merge with that innate Great Integrity,
then the healing spontaneously abides and manifests from the
inside out in All Our Relations.
Physically we refrain from hurting others physically as well as
animals, plants, and the entire Gaia-sphere. We refrain from
hurting the environment which is habitat to self and others. We
refrain from harming the future habitat as well and that of our
grandchildren's children. Every action thus considers and
consults both those yet born up until at least the Seventh
Generation as well as the elders who have come before us and
have lit the way. Our political, social, ecological, and
consumer actions also reflect this ahimsa attitude if we have
integrity (as such these are not simply rules that we parrot,
but a way of living spirit. For example where does ahimsa fit in
regarding our use of food grown with pesticides, our consumption
of electricity from nuclear power plants, our consumption of
non-biodegradable products, etc. harm our ecology, others, our
future ecology, and /or ourselves or conversely can we help
create a less
harmful world, less war, less violence, more peace, more
abundance, and more happiness? It is more powerful to know that
just attempting to eliminate himsa physically although helpful
is not causal. What all encompassing non-dual "Reality" does
ahimsa in its transpersonal sense reflect? Refraining from
harming others in speech is also valuable, so we refrain in
belittling and condemning others -- refrain from gossip and
innuendo, refrain from using words as weapons -- to hurt, punish,
exploit, condemn, or manipulate others. But it is in the ahimsa
of the HeartMind that ahimsa works its most causal magic. Here
we no longer hate others, harbor anger nor ill will toward
others, no longer desire to punish nor condemn others, no longer
disparage or judge others, no longer harbor envy nor competition,
pride nor one-up-man ship. When ahimsa of the HeartMind is
realized, saucha and santosha are also realized -- suffering,
samskara. karma, and its tendencies have become completely
remediated, The power of ahimsa in thought and attitude toward
All Our Relations is one of the most powerful of all healers.
Just to think of any one as being ill, limited, or incomplete
does the dormant universal soul potential within them an
injustice. So it is wise and less harmful to see the buddha
nature potential in all beings and address one's correspondence
by affirming THAT truth in All Our Relations. This connects
ahimsa with satya in satyagraha (see the discussion under satya).
So we go beyond simple ahimsa by no longer creating more harm or
suffering through body, speech, or mind, but actually take the
next natural step, i.e., of removing harm and suffering (and its
seeds) by healing, both self and others, and in the
transpersonal sense "others as Self". We see that the Source of
ahimsa is unrequited Love and we eventually become convinced to
wholeheartedly embrace THAT Source fully in All Our Relations.
Ahimsa is thus not a passive withdrawal, but rather it can be an
active engagement in protecting against harm and preventing it.
It can also be ferocious. Just like a mother bear who licks her
cubs wounds, feeds them, teaches, and protects them. If they
become threatened, the mother out of love protects them even if
it means fighting off a predator ferociously. Likewise, when we
act skillfully and proactively out of love and wisdom to protect
and engender life, to remove harm and/or to prevent it, that
also is ahimsa. Ahimsa together with satya, form the basis of
the satyagraha movement where truth leads to the balm of justice
alleviating much suffering. Falsehood (asatya) as well as
exploitive institutions on the other hand leads to thievery,
expropriation, alienation, ignorance, abuse, and harm (himsa).
The satyagrahi must always provide a face-saving "way out" for
an opponent if one is to champion truth. Here ahimsa combines
with satya where the goal is to discover a wider vista of truth
and justice, not to achieve victory over an opponent.
Himsa (violence) is not just getting hit in the head physically
and personally, but it is also violence for the mother to
witness her children starve to death, to go hungry and be
malnourished, to become ill, to be cold, to be exploited, and to
die due to manmade conditions, artificial scarcity, economic
policies, war, boycotts, competition, and so forth. To be
certain it is violence that occurs to people who get sick from
pesticide spraying, from impure foods, from dangerous drugs,
from unnecessary and dangerous medical procedures, from
unhealthy working conditions, from over work, by ultraviolet
radiation caused by ozone degradation, by impure air or water,
and so forth. To be free from this kind of harm one has to
discern the truth and consequences of one's actions while
ceasing to contribute to these secondary causes of harm. The
consequences of harmful actions do not always show up in one
generation. One must thus ask, what is the result of one's
actions upon future generations, the children of our children's,
up until at least the seventh generation as well as to All Our
Relations. II 36. satya-pratisthayam kriya-phalasrayatvam
Likewise by establishing a firm footing upon truthfulness and
non-deceit (satya), then obscurations, falsehood, self deceit,
and illusions are lifted and removed and we become more firmly
allied with truth and the self disclosing forces of revelation
that lift the veil of ignorance that causes repeated suffering
and abuse. Commentary: Cultivating satya has many levels of
body, mind, and speech as well. Here we not only want to speak
the truth, but also attend satsang where the truth is eternally
being spoken (in the true sanatana dharma) all the time. Our
malaise is caused by our bondage (even grasping) onto ignorance,
confusion, and delusion -- onto skew and bias. Truth destroys
this falsehood and reveals Reality as-it-is. Here boundless
awareness opens up. When so afflicted in avidya (ignorance) we
benefit from association with fellow truth seekers (sangha) who
help to reveal and magnify the truth. We benefit from living our
truth and being authentic with others INCREASINGLY as a practice
in All Our Relations. Satya destroys self deceit, ego delusion,
and the masks of false identification (asmita and avidya). Sat
implies openness, honesty, and fairness, as well as truth.
Satya thus is not applied only to telling the truth to others,
and not only in telling the truth to ourselves, but rather as an
affirmation of truth, openness, and clarity -- as the embrace of
the dynamic of clarity and pure awareness. Thus through satya we
abandon our alliance with falsity, deceit, self deceit, and
illusion altogether. We also embrace expressing our truth in All
Our Relations by not going along with other people's delusions,
self deceit, prejudice, bias, confusion, and false beliefs. In
this way even silence in the face of lies may perpetuate falsity,
where speaking one's truth may stop others from being duped,
misled, demeaned, cheated, exploited, or abused. Thus there is a
close affinity here with asteya as well as ahimsa.
The ability to see the truth (satya) in all things will destroy
avidya (ignorance) -- it will destroy all our connections with
false identifications, illusions, delusions, self deceit, and
ego delusion which our consciousness has become imprisoned, but
on the larger level our expression of satya allows All Our
Relations to come through us naturally -- as our true Self. Thus
as an internal practice satya is part and parcel of the process
where the Grand Integrity of the profound Reality becomes
revealed (falsehood is destroyed by truth -- ignorance is
removed through reality). Realizing the truth of this Integrity
is the essence of the practice of satya. Daily materialistic
life as found in the West often denies the true natural Self and
Reality as-it-is, but the practice of satya reaffirms it in the
ground of Sat -- true beingness. Thus the practice of satya can
be very deep in integrating the unitive state of Satchitananda
which is our true nature. Satya is practiced with the whole
being -- body, speech, and mind so here in the broader non-dual
sense satya practiced inwardly is expressed outwardly (the
duality of inner and outer become integrated in the non-dual
realization of the satya of satya -- the truth of truth. We
commune with SAT which destroys mara, maya, ajnana, and avidya.
Similarly the communion with Sat is most pleasing to the lord of
yogis, Siva, who brings an end to all falsehood and attachments
by bringing forth pure stainless consciousness. Durga Ma is that
greatest of all warriors who slays falsehood with truth, so that
no darkness can withstand her light. Sat is that sacred and very
basic ground of subjective beingness where we experience Reality
as-it-is in Sacred presence. When that that experience of Sat is
merged with unalloyed Consciousness (Citta), then the unity of
SatChitAnanda -- Pure Unalloyed Existence and Pure Absolute
Consciousness are merged as Pure Bliss (Ananda). When satya is
one pointed and unwavering liberation is very close at hand.
Satya in action is to bring about the truth, not only by
opposing falsehood, lies, deceit, dumbing down others, and
propaganda, but more so to tell one's truth, be the embodiment
of who you are, to let your heart shine forth. Satyagraha thus
effectively applied expresses itself so as to stop the circle of
deceit, by breaking the silence Socially and politically satya
is the fore-runner of satyagraha -- living and moving from our
center of truth in All Our Relations "With satya combined with
ahimsa , you can bring the world to your feet. Satyagraha in its
essence is nothing but the introduction of truth and gentleness
in the political, i.e., the national life.
Satyagraha is utter self-effacement, greatest humiliation,
greatest patience and brightest faith. It is its own reward.
Satyagraha is a relentless search for truth and a determination
to reach truth. It is a force that works silently and apparently
slowly. In reality, there is no force in the world that is so
direct or so swift in working. Satyagraha literally means
insistence on truth. This insistence arms the votary with
matchless power. This power or force is connoted by the word
satyagraha . Satyagraha , to be genuine, may be offered against
parents, against one's wife or one's children, against rulers,
against fellow-citizens, even against the whole world. Such a
universal force necessarily makes no distinction between kinsmen
and strangers, young and old, man and woman, friend and foe. The
force to be so applied can never be physical. There is in it no
room for violence. The only force of universal application can,
therefore, be that of ahimsa or love. In other words, it is
soul-force." (From a letter, 25.1.1920) Mahatma Gandhi II 37.
asteya-pratisthayam sarva-ratnopasthanam Having firmly communed
and practiced integrity, non-exploitation of others, and honesty
(asteya), then one no longer becomes easily distracted,
dissuaded, or corrupted from one's core energy (yoga) which is
seen as far more a precious possession than mere material gems
or ornaments. Hence evenness and balance establishes itself
where before there existed agitations and disruption. Having
learned to cultivate this place of abundance and well being
inside oneself, one feels no need to exploit situations.
manipulate others, to steal, hoard, be envious, or
misappropriate and is thus content (santosha) to leave things as
they are in one sense and in another transpersonal non-dual
proactive sense to establish abundance, to serve the Self, to
eliminate exploitation. abuse, and greed as a natural
consequence of the more advanced proactive sense. Commentary:
Like the other yams, asteya is a two way street. Contemplating
asteya and implementing it establishes harmony and leads us
toward greater integration into Unity consciousness; while
similarly the more we are spiritually connected, the more asteya
is a natural expression of Infinite Love.
Steya means to steal, expropriation, or thievery, thus asteya is
most often translated as honesty and non-stealing, and hence the
easy connection with aparigraha (which includes non-covetousness
as well as non-possessiveness), satya (truthfulness), and ahimsa
(non-violence), but if we look deeper asteya is where we do not
need to take anything in the first place (aparigraha). So asteya
is in one sense creating abundance through generosity. Asteya
thus is the realization and expression of abundance,
fulfillment, and santosha, where there is no need to take from
others, possess objects, or exploit "others" in the first place,
rather . Also inclusive under the practice of asteya, one would
have to include the elimination of cheating, exploitation,
manipulation, heavy handedness, fraud, or victimization of the "other"
to one's comparative advantage. Any type of expropriation such
as fraud, cheating another, lying, misleading, or even demeaning
another sentient being is not only asatya, but is asteya because
it serves to demean and steal away the richness of life. Thus
the act of expropriating self or others from their indigenous
spiritual connection in the eternal now is asteya. That is when
by any activity of body, speech, or mind where we further create
this spiritual alienation/expropriation, rend, separation, or
fragmentation it acts to reinforce and rigidify a spiritual and
psychic ripoff (asteya). On the other hand when we are "connected',
in union, residing in natural abundance, ahimsa, satya,
aparigraha, santosha, and the like we naturally act by
reflecting and transmitting asteya in All Our Relations. Asteya
goes far deeper than a gross material sense, when we ask
ourselves what theft is on a spiritual, emotional, and
psychological sense. Many people feel cheated, ripped off,
abused, and exploited and guess right most people are. Any
ignorance is a limitation and hence a sense of incompleteness
sets. In order to compensate for this incompleteness man through
his ignorance (avidya) often delves deeper into the kleshas
seeking compensatory neurotic substitutes in increased cravings
(raga), security (dvesa), anger, jealousy, greed, status (asmita),
and the other myriad kleshas built around that basic split/rend
from the natural unconditioned harmony and unity of body and
mind, Nature and Spirit, Shakti/Shiva - from embodiment (Sat)
and Source (Chit), from root and crown -- from Natural
Unconditioned Universal Mind. In one sense man is always
expropriating more from mother nature than he gives back, such
as from natural resources say from trees, the earth, the air,
water ... from All Our Relations because of the frozen mind-set
of his conditioned ignorance. In the sacred sense all is
borrowed, but ignorant and aloof man acts apart as an arrogant "owner".
That attitude of asmita thus is remediated by asteya, just as
asteya disappears when we realize who we truly are (in swarupa).
The average modern man is too often caught up in competition in
the dualistic and paranoid framework of coarse materialistic
life neurotically grabbing onto ersatz external objects of
gratification or consuming "things" with the hope of an ultimate
satisfaction or completion, well being, or sense of meaning and
self worth. Especially in the modern milieu the afflictions (kleshas)
of attraction, jealousy, hatred, greed, lust, hoarding,
possessiveness, consumerism, acquisitiveness, lying,
misrepresentation, exploitation, and ignorance can be very
strong because in such a corrupt/perverse society it is a symbol
of success. All such manifestations of steya manifests out of
scarcity consciousness and fear -- the ego; where asteya is
based on a natural transpersonal love -- All Our Relations --
which has become habitually abandoned and blocked. Creating
abundance, satisfaction, happiness, and providing for others is
a powerful antidote. It will also keep us on track with Self.
Practicing asteya as honesty and integrity in body, speech, and
mind will help counteract any such tendencies. It will
eventually reveal the Great Integrity -- the state where we see
the beauty and meaning of the Integrity in all life -- in All
Our Relations. Asteya as an external practice is not only being
honest to others, but not exploiting them, not cheating them,
not competing with them, not taking from others, but rather as
always giving -- as attempting to restore their connection with
eternal love and peace.
For this to have a greater positive effect in our yogic practice,
asteya must be extended not only to people but to all beings and
things - to All Our Relations. It is not necessary that one
extends "things", objects, or even temporal comfort as much as
that the spiritual bhava is reinforced generating passionately
the attitude and intention of desiring to provide for the
other's wants and suffering -- for other's happiness. This
activity of asteya can be an approximation, an alignment with,
the presentation and revelation of the path to lasting happiness
and love- where satya, saucha, ahimsa, aparigraha, isvara
pranidhana, tapas, and especially santosha all meet and are
revealed. Asteya is accomplished when the thievery of fragmented
existence, the corrupting forces of separation, the ego, of self
deceit, conceit, ignorance, cunning, and trickery have ceased.
Asteya has an inner aspect where we are honest with oneself, we
honor the integrity of our inherent intelligence, rooting out
the very tendency towards self dishonesty and self adversity. It
is the insidious habituated alliance with self deception,
conceit, self deceit, arrogance, and delusion (called ego) which
must be defeated which is revealed in meditation in order to win
mukti (liberation). HERE we do not cheat others of the Reality
of the Heart, nor do we cheat ourselves of being HERE ALL WAYS.
Abiding in the Heart everything shines forth generously as
precious jewels (sarva-ratna-upasthanam). Steya thus on a mental
level represents our fragmented state of spiritual self
alienation -- the primal split off/rip off from non-dual Self --
while it is the spiritual hero/heroine as sadhak who
reestablishes the lost spiritual integrity, fullness. and
wholesomeness -- who reestablishes connection/union in yoga.
Steya thus is also a type of dishonesty (asatya) and a
corruption (versus honesty and integrity) is actually the
opposite of satya (communion with truth). With satya we reveal
the truth and do not kowtow to falsehood, therefore we do not
augment self deceit, dishonesty, nor even other people's
illusions/delusion. In asteya we do neither create more scarcity
and fear, but rather we remind people of Shakti's abundance and
love. This way we do not spirit nor demean life. As such in this
way we contribute to stealing away from others the unbounded
limitless richness of Reality as-it-is. Steya is very closely
related to the kleshas, while the wise practice of asteya
greatly attenuates their hold. On a social level we cheat "others"
and cheapen life by not honoring and acknowledging Spirit and
Nature in All Our Relations. Thus as demean creation/creator we
demean ourselves -- we steal from others and future generations.
Like ahimsa we can evaluate the implications of our social
actions, political actions, ecological actions, and consumer
actions as how they may affect others, our habitat, and that of
future generations. In other words how we commune with abundance
and happiness in All Our Relations, without taking,
expropriating, exploiting, or destroying, will directly impact
upon our progress in realizing our true self nature. Vice versa,
when we have realized the authentic unlimited Self, then our
actions will spontaneously manifest and appropriate asteya -- we
will manifest the cessation of corruption, dishonesty,
exploitation, and expropriation. Contemplating asteya in all our
relationships can help many to remediate the energy dissipation
from their yoga practice. For example how much do we take under
consideration actions which may deprive others in a spiritual
sense of a feeling of well beingness? How often do we take into
consideration our actions as it may steal from future
generations, from future eco-systems, rivers, and habitat? Are
we habitually allowing ourselves to abandon our Heart and Core
Center in our daily actions, and is such activity wise or
helpful? On an even deeper level of beingness whose gate we will
all pass on our way to All Our Relations we realize that the
entire physical world has been given to us by Ma as Yama.
Everything we "think" that we have or own has been loaned to us,
has come from an expropriation, from some where else (from
creation). Only from the Great Non-Dual Self which embraces All
Our Relations does "All" belong to "us" as "we" to It. Only
within that context are we free in ultimate and eternal love,
abundance, happiness contentment, and trust. Further, asteya
comes into play in meditation where the wandering mind
expropriates our attention. It is the thief in the night which
sucks out our attention and energy. Thus asteya is also similar
to the practice of pratyhara where we draw back our energy and
awareness to the Hearth of Spirit within -- where our inner
spiritual wasteland and desolation becomes regenerated and
inspired. II 38. brahmacarya-pratishayam virya-labah Having
firmly established the continuity with one's core energy, not
being able to dissuade nor corrupt one's attention or desire to
that which is empty and devoid of value (brahmacarya-pratishayam),
one's vigor and strength is stabilized (virya-labah). Commentary:
Brahmacarya is best translated as integrity. It is action,
thought, and speech based on that basic incorruptible Great
Integrative state of All Our Relations where we act from the
Heart of Hearts (hridayam). This is perhaps one of the most
widely mistranslated paragraphs of the yoga sutras by life
negative, body negative, and "other" worldly academic and
religious traditions and institutions. The word's structure and
purport has no direct correlation with sexuality, i.e., it can
not be translated as sexual abstinence or the refraining from
sexual misconduct which is its most common "mis-translation".
Rather this anti-sexual connotation is the legacy of the
institutionalization of a life negative, nature negative, and
body negative so called "authoritative" tradition. Indeed
integrity goes far beyond any gross conception of sexual
continence, restraint, or repression. The word, brahmacharya,
can be derived from the two words Brahma and acharya or charya
(take your pick). Now Brahma is God as the creator or progenitor
aspect while acharya is teacher, while charya means "to be
wedded to" or "moving with". Thus one could say brahmacharya
means being wedded to Brahma or Beginningless Source (as Brahma).
Similarly one can say that brahmacharya is moving in harmony or
attunement with the power of creation and procreation. Thus one
person could say that it means "to remain connected to Source"
or to remain continuous and integral with it, hence the
connotation of continence as continuous flow, may be implied as
in being always married to Brahman (Self) without distraction.
In that marriage no distractions or corruptions can occur since
by definition one is describing this integrity. How could any
desire, greed, hatred, anger, jealousy, abuse, or harm occur in
authentic Brahmacharya? Impossible, but the "ignorant reality" (called
avidya) the normal man's non-integrative and corrupt dualistic
state still does not see nor honor this natural integrity, thus
his view requires adjustment or remediation through authentic
yogic practice. Such a practice is brahmacarya which may be
translated here as dancing (moving) with god.
Similarly if one continuously looks toward Brahm as the teacher
in All Our Relations; i.e., one is continuously focused on
Brahma. Brahm's teachings are always available in this state of
mind. Indeed both definitions can be easily integrated as the
focusing of the mind, the energy, the body, and breath upon the
Creative Source of Life -- Creator/Creation. In this sense
Brahmacharya is continence, but not in the sense of sexual,
urinary, fecal, or other such very limited ideas of retention
and control over the bodily functions, but rather continence in
the more subtle sense -- a continence of the more causal energy
and mental bodies of the sukshma sharira belonging to the
pranamaya, manomaya, and vijnanamaya koshas. This type of
communion that is called brahmacharya is far deeper than the
dualistic limitations of faith, loyalty, devotion, or belief,
but rather address the direct experience and practice of merging
as one into the creative life stream -- to honor THAT as one's
everpresent teacher. This occurs naturally when the practice of
yoga becomes continuous in All Our Relations, but for most of us
who have only too briefly tasted that unity consciousness, then
such is a practice to seek out, to explore, and embrace. So in
this practice of Brahmacharya one must honor and entertain the
potential possibility that the generative and intelligent
creative/procreative transgenerational force is present here in
our very life today, as a teacher. Then we can find the door to
Brahma is opened. Finding Brahma we can more easily find Brahman
(the true non-dual and complete imperishable Self manifesting as
Brahma/Vishnu/Siva). Acharya, as the teacher that we are seeking
out and learning from -- focusing on the eternal teacher all the
time and in All Our Relations then leads us to the true,
universal, all inclusive, and authentic Self. Brahman reveals
herself to her devotees -- true seekers. All we have to do is to
look for her. seek her, and be at one with her in all our
activities -- as All Our Relations. When we reside here, there
is self empowerment -- the cit-prana is not drained outward, but
rather it is directed toward inward flow activating the
evolutionary/creative and procreative forces and thus virya (strength
and self empowerment) builds. The accomplishment of the
energetic matrix of authentic brahmacharya then naturally
manifests in activities that are integrated with Brahman, but
the normal man lacks vision (is lost in avidya), so the natural
and spontaneous expression of brahmacharya is lacking. As in
reverse engineering brahmacharya can be effectively cultivated
once we understand its basic purpose and dynamics. The point is
that eating, walking, drinking, evacuating, talking, social
intercourse, sexual union and other such activities all can be
accomplished in continuity with authentic brahmacharya, all of
which can involve a spiritual intent and attitude (sankalpa
shakti) more than the elimination or repression of specific
natural bodily functions. In authentic yoga one does not use
force, violence, or repressive means to guide one's activities,
but rather wisdom and love. However if these same activities are
approached through dualistic ignorance (avidya), desire (raga),
aversion (dvesa), and the other kleshas then our spiritual power
and strength will become dissipated. According to this sutra
authentic brahmacharya generates virya (increases spiritual
vigor).
Another way of saying this is that acharya is the teacher, which
we continuously can "learn to learn" from at each sacred moment,
always staying open, never turning away from the everpresent and
self existing omnipresent teacher within. This is sometimes
called asking for guidance. As such brahmacarya very closely
aligns and adjuncts with the practice of isvara pranidhana. Thus
in reality anyway one looks at it, Brahmacharya is the
affirmation of the sacredness of life -- Sacred Presence --
Eternally HERE and Now. "Those who follow the path of service,
who have completely purified themselves and conquered their
senses and self-will, see the Self in all creatures and are
untouched by any action they perform. Those who know this truth,
whose consciousness is unified, think always, 'I am not the
doer.' While seeing or hearing, touching or smelling, eating,
moving about, or sleeping; breathing or speaking, letting go or
holding o, even opening or closing the eyes, they understand
that these are only the movements of the senses among sense
objects. Those who surrender to Brahman all selfish attachments
are like the leaf of a lotus floating clean and dry on water.
Sin cannot touch them. Renouncing their selfish attachments,
those who follow the path of service, work with body. senses,
and mind for the sake of self-purification. Those who
consciousness is unified, abandon all attachment to the results
of action and attain supreme peace. But those whose desires are
fragmented, who are selfishly attached to the results of their
work, are bound in everything they do. Those who renounce
attachment in all their deeds live content in the 'city of nine
gates", the body, as its master. They are not driven to act, nor
do they involve others in action" Bhagavad Gita, 5. 7-16, trsl.
by Eknath Easwaran, Tomales, CA 1985. In this way we can see
that this yama of brahmacharya practice is the counterpart of
the niyama of isvara pranidhana, the surrender to the Self -- to
our highest divinity -- to the Great Binding or Integrity. It is
also closely aligned with tapas. pratyhara, bandha, and
swadhyaya practices (see commentary to sutra 1).
Thus it seems that the practice of Brahmacharya in this sense is
to remain wedded to Brahma in integrity in All Our Relations and
activities, while at the same time increasing our innate power,
spiritual vigor, courage, and strength which has become
heretofore repressed/supressed.Here I must reject the
chauvinistic claim that virya refers to some male endocrine
substance which women do not possess. We also wish to be
absolutely clear that it is a mistake to take the word, virya,
as used in Ayurveda as a male endocrine substance. Rather
Patanjali means here by virya as spiritual strength, empowerment,
and spiritual zeal. This is made clear in Sutra I.20 "Shradda-virya-smrti-samadhi-prajna-purvaka
itaresham". Swami Veda Bharati in his comprehensive book on the
Yoga Sutras discusses this above subject by analyzing what Vyasa
said about virya. "We have not translated virya to mean a male
hormonal fluid, nor brahma-charya to be the preservation there
of.... virya which represents in the common mind only a certain
male fluid, the preservation of which is thought to be
continence or brahma-charya. If that were the meaning of the
word, how would we explain the brahma-charya, of ancient
brahma-vadinis, the lady sages and teachers? What do they
preserve? Does any lexicon show virya to mean a female fluid
also? That is not the case. On the other hand if virya is male
property, how do we explain the use of the word virya vali (fem.
endowed with virya) and such other express ions. A synonym of
virya, the word, retas, is also used in the context of female
personages. 'All the three daughters of Mena and Himalya were
endowed with the ascetic bodies, possessing the powers of yoga;
the divine ladies with great and high auspicious characteristics,
all gifted with a stable youthfulness. All of them were teachers
of Brahman: all urdhva-retas, they whose virya flows upwards.'
Vayu Purana III.72. 14-15 If the words, virya and retas mean
seminal fluid, how would the term urdva-retas apply to female
ascetics as above? Obviously the words, have a wider meaning."
From "the Yoga Sutras of Patanjali, Volume Two, by Swami Veda
Bharati, Motilal Benarsidass, Delhi , 2001. Earlier Swami Veda
Bharati comments on what Patanjali means by virya in sutra I.13:
"Stillness or stability (sthiti) means the mind-field (citta)
flowing pacifically when it is without vrttis. The endeavor
tending towards this purpose is virility or exertion. Practice
is the observance of the means thereto, with the will to achieve
its fulfillment... The endeavor is directed towards sthiti [a
balanced stillness] and is explained by Vyasa by offering two
synonyms: virya: virility, vigour, strength, energy, potency,
the qualities of a hero utsaha: enthusiasm, perseverance,
fortitude, firmness, exertion, vigorous pursuit. Obviously an
endeavour should be undertaken with these heroic qualities
turned inwards and their intense concentration directed at the
effort to bring the mind to stillness." from the Yoga Sutras of
Patanjali with the exposition of Vyasa, Volume I, Pandit
Usharbudh Arya (Swami Veda Bharati), Himalayan Intl., Honesdale,
PA, 1988. Here Swami Veda Bharati takes virya as having an
unexcelled capacity (samarthya-vishesha or nir-atishaya
samarthya which can be approximately compared with shakti's pure
potentiality. In a tantric sense, urdhva-retas (upward flow of
the sexual energy) is always associated with the activation of
kundalini shakti (when the ordinary dualistic pranic flows have
become extraordinarily harmonized and trans-substantialized). In
this sense the proto-tantric elements in the Yoga Sutras can be
made clear. Buddhists use virya as a paramita (perfection)
leading to wisdom, often specifically meaning "right effort",
vigor and strength as applied to sadhana, in the same way as
Patanjali does elsewhere in the Yoga Sutras (again see Sutra
1.20). In such practices there is no limited sexual meaning to
virya paramita as it is meant to be practiced by both females as
well as males, which again points away from a mere gross sexual
or physiological bias. I think it is also valuable to look into
the historical context of Patanjali's time in order to obtain a
meaningful interpretation in such terms, since the popularity of
Buddhism and its similarity to yoga in that era and clime is
well established. In other words, the ingrown academic
institutionalized interpretation of brahmacarya meaning sexual
restraint is both limited and coarse displaying an anti-female,
anti nature, and anti-sexual bias. Authentic brahmacarya goes
far beyond this coarse and limited view, which the student of
yoga is encouraged to explore.
Going further even the idea of being devoted to Brahma would
introduce a dualistic corruption or separation from Brahman --
the Large Self. Here we are taking another step from Brahma as
creator/progenitor to Brahman which is not entirely equivalent,
but the bridge is easily made after we realize that Brahman is
the Universal Self. This "reminding" of our true self -- of our
unitive state of wholeness -- both to "remind" others as well as
our selves constitutes the practice of Brahmacarya. Reminding
each other (as well as our own small self) of the fullness and
divine riches of Universal Eternal Self, then not only is the
practice of Brahmacarya, but also completes santosha, asteya,
satya, ahimsa, isvara pranidhana, swadhyaya, tapas, and
aparigraha because we no longer continue to cheat,
demean, or obfuscate other people's true identity; we no longer
through our own actions obstruct the reality of others's
completion by validating nor reinforcing the falsity, the
suffering, and other countless distractions/dissipations of
avidya (ignorance). Thus our own communion is made more
continuous, while simultaneously residues of old negative karma,
vasana, and samskaras are more quickly and thoroughly remediated.
This is the true meaning of Brahmacarya, but to practice it in
the world, we must realize it inside as well. Both practicing it
as integrity in the world as well as in our minds and hearts,
its benefits will become empowered and fructified and eventually
become spontaneous and natural. In this way, one may simply
practice brahmacarya by evaluating all one's activities in this
light, that is , while asking does this or that action which I
am contemplating or engaged upon draw me out of my marriage with
the eternal teacher/teachings -- my core feeling of integrity
and wholeness, or on the other hand, does "this" or "that"
activity draw me closer to that deep full intimate heart felt
relationship with Brahman? Then the authentic practitioner
evaluates how one may increase that marriage with Brahma more
continuously in All Our Relations. Those activities which
increase this sacred relationship, while simultaneously
providing an increased sense of self empowerment, spiritual
strength, vigor, and courage (virya) is indeed authentic
Brahmacarya. What are some examples? The common answers is to
make one's daily physical and psychic environment more in
harmony with Brahma. For example can we eliminate those things
in our lives that do not honor creation and creativity and at
the same time renew our alignment with the creator, creation,
birth, generation, the forces of renewal and regeneration.
Perhaps it is as easy as changing our mindsets toward mother
nature and how we deal with her. Is it an abusive dysfunctional
relationship or do we honor the creative force on the earth? How
do we respect and honor other life forms, animals, trees, plants,
as well as our own body? Do we see that they are all the result
of the same creative spark? Would bringing nature home "inside"
help more? Would honoring wilderness serve as an adjunctive aide?
Perhaps surrounding ourselves with other people who honor the
creative impulse (the qualities of Brahma) and serve to empower
our spiritual strength and inspire us on the path would also
help. There is much to do to remind ourselves as we are
reminding others of that great Integrity which the yam of
brahmacarya reflects.
Now how did this plain and profound sutra become so distorted by
the status quo orthodoxy? This corruption of what Patanjali said,
was done by those who had a negative body image, a negative
embodiment image, negative nature image, negative female, earth
negative, life negative, and consequently sex negative dualistic
bias, prejudice, and fear. They did not trust nature nor the
body because they were dualistic in mind. They were dualistic in
mind because they had not integrated Sat with Chit (nature with
spirit or being with consciousness, or shakti/siva), but rather
feared it choosing alienation from the generative force (Brahma).
Thus a polarization of mind from body became institutionalized
and they built upon this institution over millenniums
rigidifying their beliefs into a self serving tradition (although
in fact it only served their pride, aversion, and ignorance).
Specifically with the Yoga Sutras, the source of the
misinterpretation stems from the first well known and "authoritative"
commentator on the who "interpreted" Brahmacharya to mean sexual
continence and that "interpretation" stuck within the confines
of the institutionalized authoritative status quo anti-nature
academic tradition which attempted to co-opt/expropriate the
Yoga Sutras. Again we point out that Patanjali did not use the
word sex or continence in this sutra at all, but it is only
through the nature phobic "interpretation", that the word,
brahmacarya, has become not only synonymous with abstaining from
sex, but also as renouncing the world in these overly
objectified and heavily abstracted circles. In these perverted
realms, duality is reinforced by artificially placing "reality"
and sacredness "other" than on this planet and within this very
body. It is indeed the denial of Brahma as creator not only of
the body, the earth, and the universe, but also the denial and
demeaning of our own co-creative pro-creative function in nature
(as if procreation was something not spiritual). Rather
spiritual empowerment (virya), spiritual strength, vigor,
endurance, and enthusiasm comes from the embrace of Brahma in
this very body, not through aversion (dvesa) of the body and
nature. What brahmacarya should be associated with is the
affirmative practice of conscious engagement with Brahman in
daily life and finding spiritual vigor in such. In short the
institutionalized "authoritative" interpretation of most of the
yams and niyams in general have been corrupted by an anti-life
and nature negative prejudice -- the original words have been
perverted and corrupted to mean the opposite in many cases,
i.e., being wedded and in harmony with the creative/generative
force (Brahma), honoring it in everyday life, reflecting your
relationship with the great progenitor/creator, Brahma, and so
acting in harmony, spontaneity, and vitally (versus mechanically,
conceptually, or in contradiction). In a similar sense this yama,
brahmacharya, is the everyday practice of being focused on
Brahma and the cit-prana (where Brahma is the source of prana),
remaining centered to one's core of goodness not allowing
oneself to become upset, distracted, dissuaded, or caught up in
citta vrtti (neurotic activities).
This is not to say that the confusion that is presented to our
unprepared youth as manifested in sexual lust and propensities
in not problematical, but rather simply ignoring it or
forbidding it in most cases simply creates more tension and
armoring around it, often to a pathological point. Indeed much
compulsive violent and harmful
speech that derides, curses, and condemns others is often due to
one's defensive armoring, tension, fear, and conflict around
sexual fears that have become repressed, denied, buried, and
ignored. Because the generative urge in many youth is more
powerful than that to eat, to drink, to sleep, and in some in
par to that even to breathing, thus one may be forced to extend
this basic idea of Brahmacharya (in the opposite direction of
traditional repressive institutionalized authority) into a
tantric/agamic interpretation which this sutra hints at because
of discovering and more deeply communing with the Source of our
potency and strength (virya-labah) through the bodily
pro-creative/generative pathway. Indeed brahmacharya so applied
on a physical level is a great aid in overcoming avidya as it
directly impacts upon our neurology, generative life impulse,
attachments, dissuasions, programmed prejudice, abhinivesa (fear
of death), fear and dissolution in general. Here instead of
impregnating our youth with fear, armoring, and tension around
sexual function, the tantric approach is keep the energy flowing
in the water chakra (swadhistana) not by discharging it nor
stopping it, but rather by binding/interconnecting it to the
other chakras through pranayama, pratyhara, and samyama. As a
gate, bandhas, fill in the leaking holes where cit-prana can
dissipate. such energy then is redirected to empower the
evolutionary circuits (kundalini). Brahmacarya thus teaches
balance and harmony in all our relationships entreating us to
find the virya (strength and courage) in such. Being wedded and
intimately united to Brahma as the force of renewal, generation,
creative force, and regeneration is a healing grace and
integrity combined. This is a blessing indeed and when it
manifests in All Our Relations it is a blessing passed on. Such
practice will be in consonance both with the maha-vratam and
nirvitarka goals of the yam/niyam as put forth by the sage
Patanjali which affirms our inseparableness --our integrity and
continence in all of eternity. Detailed hatha yoga, tantric,
kundalini, or laya yoga approaches to this activity, although
perhaps somewhat problematic in many anti-nature monastic
settings, can be found in other literature as well as in Pada
III. The main point is to seek out Brahma in All Our Relations
in body, speech and mind and then act in accordance/continuity/integrity.
In the non-dual tantric sense, sexual activity is a potent
practice where both partners can increase their communion with
Brahma, by transmuting the potential of being carried away and
distracted by the physical pleasure of transpersonal experience,
but rather approaching this as an opportunity to integrate
physical passion and divine passion into a spiritual and divine
partnership, where physical, energetic, emotional, cognitive,
and spiritual union of the individual becomes an act of
renouncing short term sexual pleasure as discharge, but rather
as the generation of ojas and virya as tapas -- charging the
flow through the nadis rather than the armoring. blockage, or
constriction around them for mutual liberation and spiritual
evolution -- as an act of devotion or surrender (isvara
pranidhana), as worship, where the fire (tapas) is fed by the
inner ghee (neuro-physiological liquor) on the altar of Brahma.
This of course is not the institutionalized orthodox view on
brahmacharya, but it is put forth sincerely as a modern non-dual
tantric interpretation in light of the fact that Brahma is the
Hindu idea that most closely resembles the force of creation and
generation (and hence the pro-creative and generative powers are
also associated) -- the grammatical roots of this word (and my
own yoga practice) convince me that a deeper honoring of the
creative, vibrant, and vital living force that underlies all of
creation -- sacred and profound is being called forth to be
considered and heard. Indeed, genuine tantra practiced not as a
temporary sensual pleasure or release of dammed up energy, but
as an activity that does not distract, dissuade, nor dissipates
one's consciousness, vital energies, or fluids, but rather feeds
the eternal omnipresent flame -- as an entering into the
non-dual transpersonal integration, which is our true nature,
removing obstacles, generating spiritual passion and vigor, as a
simultaneous act of tapas, aparigraha, isvara pranidhana, and
brahmacharya appears to be more in harmony with the rest of
Patanjali's Yoga Sutras than the institutionalized anti-sexual
interpretation In this sutra, Patanjali says that by effective
practice of brahmacharya increased spiritual momentum, energy,
empowerment, strength and courage is encouraged/generated (virya).
Thus one could read that sexual activity like any other activity
without practicing brahmacharya while so engaged could thus be
dissipating and weakening. According to tantra then the
remediation of lust and distracting influences through the
conscious application of Brahmacarya on a physical or energetic
level is applied. Then to some extent Brahmacarya can be linked
to the energetics of the hatha yoga practice of vajroli mudra (especially
to its inner (internal correspondence) application where there
is natural upward flow (urdvaretas) which is activated by the
compounding of blood and hormonal juices (ojas) with cit-prana.
urdvaretas can be achieved through practice or naturally and
spontaneously through grace by one who is spiritually ripe. "The
process of offering is Brahman; that which is offered is Brahman.
Brahman offers the sacrifice in the fire of Brahman. Brahman is
attained by those who see Brahman in every action" Bhagavad
Gita, 4.24, trsl. by Eknath Easwaran, Tomales, CA 1985.
Brahmacharya thus is catalyzed by tapas and implied in isvara
pranidhana, swadhyaya, asteya, santosha, ahimsa, satya, saucha,
and aparigraha. By a similar extension it implies equanimity,
karuna, compassion, ahimsa, satya, saucha (as purity of the
heart), and jivamukti. All the yam/niyam form a great circle (maha-vratam)
and
refine our cit-prana from gross to subtle engendering (nirvitarka).
So authentic brahmacharya practiced not only in bodily actions
and speech, but more causally in the HeartMind where we are
always focused on Brahma and Brahman. "To contemplate on God in
this world is the highest Sadhana, and this automatically
implies love towards all beings. You cannot see God in all and
yet not love all people. These are contraries. You see God in
all and love all equally. It is implied, and you need not
mention it separately, and this also implies service to all. To
recognize one's own self in others and to work for the
fulfillment of this in life is a part of our sadhana. Love all,
serve all, because God is in all." Swami Krishnananda Swami
Venkatesananda says of Brahmacharya: "Brahmacharya literally
means when the whole inner consciousness flows constantly toward
truth, towards what is, towards God, Brahman. That is difficult!
And so some holy ones restricted the meaning. They asked; 'What
is it that distracts a person's attention most?' The opposite
sex [polarity]. so they interpreted brahmacharya to mean
continence, chastity. This is no doubt one of the constituents
of brahmacharya, but brahmacharya means much more than that.
Brahmacharya is also part of the search for truth. It means that
the mind is always moving in the infinite (Brahman), towards the
infinite, constantly looking for Brahman. That itself again is
meditation. When the question, 'what is truth, what is this?' is
burning in one's heart, it is then that both truthfulness and
brahmacharya are possible. It is said that the yogi who is
devoted to truth becomes completely silent; every time he wants
to say something, there is the thought, 'How do I know this is
true?' This happens also with brahmacharya in the sense of
chastity. When your mind, heart, and whole being are constantly
absorbed in this search for truth, towards enlightenment, then
craving does not arise and continence happens [spontaneously].
On the other hand, suppressing all these emotions is dangerous,
because it is violence, it is untruth, and there is no
brahmacharya there." "The Yoga Sutras of Patanjali with
Commentary by Swami Venkatesananda" pp 198 -199, The Divine Life
Society, U.P., India , 1998
In the modern world alienation, fragmentation, disparity, and
corruption has become normal. Because most people with the
widespread dichotomy of false identification (falsely
identifying with the dualistic mind, as a separate ego, or body
this "apparent" dichotomy as an institutionalized estrangement
from non-dual Self has become epidemic. Of course the physical
body dies, but this body is the result of billions of years of
intelligent evolution from beginningless Source -- which brings
in the subject of the Long Body or Brahman. It is precisely this
short sighted false identification (avidya) with a temporal and
limited "self" which attaches with it so much affliction and
pain (dukha). This small self can not be sustained and will most
definitely perish, but yoga tells us that this small self is
also a result of a limited mindset -- it is illusory. Who is "i"
in yoga such as what is disclosed in the authentic practices of
yoga such as in vairagya, dhyana, tapas, swadhyaya, isvara
pranidhana, ahimsa, or other such practices which reveals as
understanding who/where/what we are "in the greater yogic
context"? We cannot know who we are unless we know where we came
from also (Brahma). Without that practice and realization of
Brahmacharya we have a limited or distorted idea of "self" (being
lost in avidya). All "things" are on fire, they change, die, and
come into being, but in yoga we learn that we are not just this
physical body. That is, no ego, no body, no "thing" lives in a
vacuum or exists as separate; rather it is the result of limited
thinking to presuppose such a duality. When we open through yoga
to connect up with who we really are (and this usually takes
years of deconditioning) we start to see who/what we really are
in the context of transpersonal and non-dual consciousness and
beingness --as Satchitananda. Here the crown (sahasrara) and the
earth (muladhara) -- sprit and nature -- are both activated
simultaneously and the sacred temple is restored. This comes not
as a result of theory or philosophy, but as a result of genuine
yoga practice. This is why Patanjali emphasizes that authentic
practice remediates old energy patterns, tendencies, karma,
klesha, and samskara. One of the kleshas is the false self
identification with fragmentation, the ego, and pride (asmita)
while Brahmacharya is one such practice out of hundreds designed
to loosen that fixation while placing us in that greater
Implicate Integrity. The body, the trees, ocean, animals, Mother
earth, stars, Creation, -- All Our Relations- all came from
Beginningless Source, and that Source is thus contained in us --
we reflect it and at the same time we are its expression. The
separation was a result of an illusory state of mind. Since this
"we" or "i" does not exist outside of the whole in Reality -- "we"
all together becomes a tangible and deeply felt experience
eventually. As we increasingly surrender/offer up the veiled
cocoon of ignorance upon the altar of our practice, the more is
revealed of this transpersonal eternal beginningless Source in/as
All Our Relations. Our practice approximates it, attunes with it
aligns with it, or at other times we rest in deep gratitude and
santosha -- at one with Brahm.
Not that Brahm can be defined, but as a practice we can take
frequent pauses each and every day from neurotic habits, daily
agendas, and schedules and then invite THAT sacred presence
"in", not just for guidance or expression, but as an intimate
embrace like a long lost friend. The more rich and full this
expression becomes -- the more creatively empowered this
expression becomes -- the happier and more fulfilled we become
-- the more enter into the True Self. TAT TVAM ASI II 39.
aparigraha-sthairye janma-kathamta-sambodhah By establishing a
firm practice (sthairye) of simplifying our life through
eliminating our attachments to frivolous and distracting
non-essential desires and by no longer grasping at personal
possessions nor appropriating, consuming, or hoarding objects
out of neurotic false identifications (greedily hoarding because
of feelings of an inner emptiness or lack), nor to covet and be
attached to that which is transitory and ever changing, and
seeing greener fields always on yonder horizons (aparigraha),
then our ability to see into our past neurotic patterns is
disclosed (janma-kathamta sambodhah). This knowledge (kathamta
sambodhah) of the driving winds of transformation and change as
it has manifest in the past (janma), serves to replenish our
innate power to support us in eliminating further bondage and
suffering that is inherent in craving, fear, and clinging to the
future which has yet to come. Thus true integrity is achieved
and past karmic proclivities are burned up when through
authentic aparigraha we merge into greater ecstatic contentment
in the Eternal Now. Commentary: Aparigraha means non-greed,
non-covetousness, non-possessiveness, non-excess, and literally,
"not grasping -- not clinging ". Sthairye means to be firm,
steadfast, still and easeful (in the practice of aparigraha).
One reading thus is when we become firm, still, and unmovable in
not needing, when that state is easy and still, then the how (kathamta)
of our past existence -- how we got HERE (janma) is awakened (sambodhah).
HERE we remain centered in the eternal present. HERE our life
comes together through aparigraha and we are able to become
reborn free from the winds of past karma, and it is HERE (in
turiya) that all dimensions come together and become whole.
Another similar reading is that when our past (janma) is
revealed through kathamta sambodhah, then a strong natural ease
of non-craving and release (aparigraha) is naturally expressed
in our future activities. HERE we approach All Our Relations
without grasping or attachment to results. We will discuss these
ideas later, but first it may be valuable to see how aparigraha
operates in daily life. Generally it is the antidote for greed,
possessiveness, excess. clutter, excess, desire/fear, imbalance,
or attachment in general. The most apparent instances of
parigraha (grasping, clinging, or clutching) can be normally
remediated by cultivating abundance, generosity, gratefulness,
santosha, vairagya (non-attachment), and the like. How can
anything be possessed without first artificially establishing a
false identification with separation, alienation, and
fragmentation -- identifying with the ego (asmita) in the first
place? "Who" is it that grasps? After all it is our spiritual
self alienation (estrangement/rend from Self) which has caused
the circumstances for craving and desire in the first place. The
false identification of "thinking" that own a body also doesn't
help (called parigraha of possessing the body). The physical
body being temporary, this ignorance of who and what incarnates
is thus part and parcel of the process where
janma-kathamta-sambodhah creates aparigraha-sthairye. Knowing
who we truly are as the imperishable Self certainly would help,
but that is putting the cart before the horse. Aparigraha is
thus is a practice that is helpful for spiritual evolution.
Aparigraha thus as a practice in daily life can create more time
and energy for sadhana -- supporting our spiritual progress as
we clear out or propensities toward neurotic desires and
attachments. On a more subtle/mental level as thoughts of greed,
consumerism, and possessiveness come up we can let them go more
often realizing that they will not lead to any lasting happiness.
Thus the sadhu or monk owns nothing and is possessed by nothing,
and thus does not fear being ripped off, assaulted, or defensive.
He/she does not obsess or identify with such objects, but his/her
mind is free. For such a one, this aids the liberation process
helping one to free the mind of false identifications and
attachment. In a similar sense aparigraha means simplifying our
life style. That frees up our attention, energy, and time. The
average neurotic consumes external objects as a substitute for
an inner emptiness -- a lack of meaningful and fulfilling life.
We should all know that ersatz compensatory consumerism will not
provide lasting happiness or santosha. The more unhappy we are,
the more we crave. The more unhappy and the more we crave the
more we are vulnerable to advertisers to consume something that
will make us happy or satisfied. But wisdom gleaned from
practice discloses that no lasting happiness (santosha) will be
found through consuming compensatory vanity items that we do not
need.
What makes far more sense in order to eventually become free
from the dysfunctional cycle of craving, consummation/gratification,
temporary pleasure, more craving, more consumerism, and more
temporary pleasure and so forth. In that cycle the consumer
confuses desire and craving on one hand with the anticipation of
its consummation/gratification (pleasure), hence big eyes, big
desire, viagra, and greed becomes mistakenly equated with a
happy life. But in reality it is a vicious circle of craving and
greed which winds up in personal exhaustion (which is associated
with satiation), but which brings no lasting happiness or
meaningful fulfillment. Consumerism taken as a goal in itself
imprisons our life and clogs the spiritual arteries. Since what
we consume is part of a living system of which have its own laws
of sustainability, unbridled wild consumerism eventually becomes
unsustainable in itself. To contribute to the demise of natural
systems or to create scarcity for others is an act of himsa and
thus one becomes a participant in the generation of negative
karma. Without practicing aparigraha one not only risks himsa
and sacrifices santosha, but also asteya is compromised because
unbridled consumerism is a form of stealing from others as well
as future generations. The practice of aparigraha has numerous
positive benefits that clears up our karma (by anma-kathamta
sambodhah), and frees our energy and time. It is often observed
that the more one owns the more one worries about maintaining
and keeping their possessions. In that way they are possessed or
owned by the very objects that they "think" they own. This kind
of parigraha occupies and obfuscates the mind and hence
reinforces the false sense of separate "self" (ego) or delusion
(avidya). So the practice of aparigraha not only clarifies the
mind, but also there is a mind aspect or more subtle mental/psychic
practice of aparigraha when we mean to free the mind itself from
its graspings, false associations, attachment, and similar
wandering unto objects of thought. Thus in meditation there
exists a more subtle practice of aparigraha which is more
precisely vairagya.
For most people the rend of dualistic separation has become
rigidified through trauma, samskara, vasana, rigidified limited
beliefs, mental/emotional fixations, distorted attitudes,
stubborn mind sets, behavior which affect our life style,
vindictiveness, as well as psycho-neuromuscular and
physiological components, then aparigraha becomes a powerful
practice which remediates the above tensions. One may not
immediately see how powerful aparigraha is as a practice. In the
above situations a sense of personal loss of something or
someone occurs in one's thought process. This sense of loss
stems from a previous sense of attachment or grasping onto the
person or thing that no longer is present. This sense of loss
stemming from false identification, attachment, and grasping (parigraha)
can cause all sorts of further afflictions and negative karma if
not seen for what it is in truth and dropped (released). For
example grief over a past event of perceived loss can be
remediated through aparigraha. Often, revenge is due to
parigraha. One seeks to "get even" for an apparent loss, a
previous perceived injustice, a ripoff, a cheat, or even a lack
of self esteem and self worth. Revenge is energy and thought
that has been misdirected seeking discharge in folly,
dissipation, afflictive emotions, and bad karma. Awareness of
the emotional vulnerability of one's situation of false
identification would often be sufficient to entertain the
possibility of aparigraha, which in turn affirms the larger
sense of Self (Brahman). In the same way many other kleshas can
be cleared in this way when given the chance, with a far more
spiritually empowering outcome. In other words aparigraha, like
the other yam/niyam, acts as a two way street. We can simplify
our life, let go of frivolous possessions, reduce our greed,
become more generous, give up stubbornly held beliefs, change
our clinging to familiar mindsets, etc., on one hand in order to
make progress toward samadhi. On the other hand the graspings
onto the very concepts that reinforce scarcity, need, neuroses,
and separation are weakened through authentic sadhana. Then HERE
aparigraha eventually becomes naturally expressed -- manifesting
spontaneously and naturally. Once some insight is gained (through
swadhyaya, sadhana, janma-kathamta-sambodhah, etc), then one no
longer is subject to suffer from the apparition that possessing
any temporal object will produce lasting happiness, because we
have realized that happiness is a state of mind. The illusion
that is produced by the erroneous judgment that an object is "good",
desirable, or even is capable of being possessed is absent. Once
we have realized that it is a distorted mindset which has
generated the need and unhappiness (as well as the decision to
be unhappy) in the first place, then we able to understand the
spiritual malaise in which parigraha incarnates in the first
place. Then from HERE aparigraha occurs naturally and
spontaneously. On a gross physical level people too often pursue
more than they need, obsess unceasingly after compensatory
objects of attraction, and are never happy or content, because
of this false identification which reinforces an inner spiritual
lack -- the absence the sacred. Thus this is a result of a
contrived, conditioned, and artificial process of spiritual
alienation, but not the experience of our true nature or natural
Self. Most fear and physical illness including obesity is due to
parigraha. The freedom from this physical addiction is
essentially spiritual. Suffering from the affliction that says
that even more sublimation (which is a compensation for a
spiritual alienation) is better is a vicious cycle; i.e., one
new car is not enough so get two new cars; four new shoes are
not enough so we get five new shoes; yet lasting happiness never
comes this way because it is always neurotically driven. Such
objects are only symbols but not the real thing which we desire
and thus ordinary people live in in an apparitional shadow world
driven by their own inner demons.
Authentic aparigraha comes about naturally through self
realization (kathamta-sambodhah)-- realizing the innate
happiness and abundance in All Our Relations -- through a deep
transpersonal and timeless gratefulness that unconditional (non-dependent)
happiness naturally provides. So to begin with simple activities
that are helpful toward realizing this end may include
simplifying one's life, changing life styles, identifying and
discarding the superfluous and burdensome, removing clutter,
giving away things that are not necessary, not refraining from
obsessing about theft nor loss, living a more naked and open
life, meditating on physical death, the transitory nature of all
things, the nature of unconditional happiness, and the like.
Fear lies at the root of greed and covetousness, so it is
cultivating love, happiness, contentment, generosity, and
gratefulness which is useful. "When the inner light of
intelligence illumines the state of mind that has firmly
rejected greed and there is contentment with what life brings
unsolicited, there arises knowledge of the mysteries of life and
its why and how." Sw. Venkatesananda, "The Yoga Sutras of
Patanjali" On a mental level, one can be obsessed by spiritual
materialism in constant pursuit of superficial artifacts or
symbols of spiritual attainment such as malas, asanas, teachers,
robes, statutes, mantras, incense, texts, teachings, etc. This
too is a disease that is best surrendered at the foot of All Our
Relations. Thus removing the physical attachments the mind gets
clear. As the mind gets clear, it becomes that the true source
of happiness and liberation comes from an open unattached mind,
not from grasping onto (or being grasped by material objects.
When the mind is clear, then a sense of fulfillment and peace (santosha)
naturally arises. What if all was perfect right now?
Contemplation on the nature of the pre-existing Great Completion
and Perfection of Eternal Presence in All Our Relations offers a
most potent remedy. On the more subtle, mental, and energetic
levels, aparigraha is the non-grasping unto thought objects
which occur in meditation (or out of meditation for the
jivamuktan). Here the dualistic limitations of pratyaksha are
remediated. One no longer separates out limited self
identifications (neither of separate "selves" or own "self", but
rather the rich and deep innate continuity (which is yoga) shows
forth in each "apparent" object holographically, cutting through
superficial appearances and displaying its non-substantial
nature in and by itself while at the same time revealing the
innate presence and great Integrity of All Our Relations. Thus
aparigraha comes naturally to those who have realized the truth
of their own natural existence (swarupa) devoid of superficial
appearance, artifact, conceptual construct, symbolic
representation, and free from other kleshas or vrttis -- beyond
even the most subtle taint of a separate dualistic object. Here
one is complete in the unlimited fullness of Reality and needs
nothing else.
Aparigraha like the other yam/niyam, also has an esoteric aspect.
It also works in two directions. One way is that when a certain
amount of the veil of illusion (avidya) has been lifted, we are
then able to see (vidya) the past karmic propensities, vasana,
samskaric triggers, neurotic patterns, and related compulsive
mechanisms of cravings, graspings, attachment, and fear that we
have been previously unconsciously obsessed with for years. One
day we wake up and an old habit is suddenly "seen" which gives
us the opportunity to no longer feed it. Or maybe we realize
that an old vasana (habitual mechanism or knee jerk reactive
circuit) is gone and as a result we feel liberated, relieved,
and grateful. Certainly new energy becomes available because an
old dysfunctional compulsive circuit is no longer draining us.
That way we cease "chasing our tails" in one way or another
through direct insight (wisdom). We thus understand the tragic
bondage of our past and in such cases the past becomes seen as a
series of incarnations leading up to the present experience.
many years but didn't "see" it until that moment. Then when I
saw it, I was able to let it go (gratefully). Whew! This is not
very different from when someone points out in asana practice
that we my be habitually and unconsciously "holding/clutching"
at the jaw, gut, shoulders, etc., Then through such discernment,
we can start unwinding and letting go. Aparigraha , vairagya,
and isvara pranidhana are thus closely related. Then new
evolutionary energy comes into the previously dormant circuitry.
This is the birth of a new incarnation -- a new "self" becomes
energized and embodied. Maybe this is not exactly aparigraha (as
it is usually applied to daily life situations in regards to
letting go of mental/emotional fixations, beliefs, attitudes,
rigid and limited mind sets, and behavior which affect our life
style), but certainly there exists a is a
psycho-neuro-physiological component of aparigraha which affects
us even at the cellular and energy body level. After seeing
these old patterns, vasanas, and samskaras that we have been
grasping/clutching at during this life drop away a sense of
spaciousness and openness arises. Then through the power and
freedom which consciousness provides, then thought patterns that
previously tended to attach to objects or the I-it world of ego
are able to be released in the body, the mind, in our behavior
-- in All Our Relations. Old programming is dislodged and a
sacred space for authentic movement is affirmed. Then one may be
able to see further into their past lives (past the false gross
material identifications of separateness) perceiving that such
were merely new incarnations of the same lesson -- the same
karmic lesson launched in ignorance having formed a mental/psychic
energetic pattern which had not previously been resolved, but
having now completed its journey in the culmination of
integrated consciousness and realization. So just as insight
facilitates the natural expression of aparigraha, likewise, from
the other end, looking at the possibility of implementing
aparigraha in everyday life and then applying it, will provide
synergistic progress in establishing the eventual of realization
of nirbija samadhi.
The practice of aparigraha as non-grasping, non-greed, and
non-attachment is not just an attitude, but can be practiced as
an intent as well as an expression. It has
ramifications on all walks of life. If one plane is rigidified,
then tension in the other planes will ensue. For example, some
people understand aparigraha on an intellectual level, but they
have yet to get rid of bad habits or fears on the physical level
such as simplification of one's lifestyle on the gross material
plane. Whenever there is tension in our lives, it is wise to
look toward aparigraha for a remedy. We often surround ourselves
with the objects of predictability often concretizing our own
rigidified limited prisons (mental, physical, and spiritual).
This of course is self limiting but without insight such
activities are the norm. As an antidote embracing life style
changes that move us in the opposite direction (from the
illusion of safety in predictability) are often very synergistic
toward remediating rigidity and tension and bringing in new
vigor, energy, and creative change. A new world and a new life (incarnation)
can be given birth to. As such it is a form of aparigraha (non-hoarding)
and non-grasping. If we never take a chance, never risk anything,
then we can get stuck, and stagnant, and become really unhappy.
then we can blame the unhappiness on "things", i.e., " we don't
have this or we don't that, or, if only we had this or that, etc"
If we look around many people are unfortunately so driven. This
makes them worried, rigid, security oriented, fearful, and
dysfunctionally even more greedy and grasping onto more symbols
of success, status, privilege, money, appearances, and further
neurotic false identification. Is that life or death? Having
become spiritually self alienated, we get hung up thinking that
we need certain things in life, but these "things" (which are
really compensations for being with it in the now) most often
act as anchors or chains, weighing us down, preventing us from
drifting with the tides of our intuition, and inner guidance.Such
activities rooted in parigraha make things worse -- they create
more suffering. These life situations that we become involved in
(and that aparigraha can free us from) create big-time tension,
stress, depression, anxiety, etc. When we can let go of some of
this stuff, like freeing a calendar up, or saying no to certain
obligations so we have more time for ourselves, shifts happen.
We can then more clearly see the space in front of us, for we
have looked at our past incarnations and have found it stifling.
To bring success, aparigraha must be approached fearlessly in
All Our Relations. Thus the practices and realization of
santosha, tapas, isvara pranidhana, brahmacharya, etc., are very
closely aligned with the realization and practice of aparigraha.
Aparigraha finishes Patanjali's discourse on the practice of the
five yams, which are all mutually synergistic, being rooted in
ahimsa and the clear realization in which the establishment of
vairagya is founded.
Now Patanjali describes the five niyams in detail in sutras
40-45 II 40. saucha svanga-jugupsa parair asamsargah II 41.
sattvasuddhi-saumanasyaikagryendriya-jayatma-darsana-yogyatvani
ca Through the practice of physical purity, attachments to
toxins and corruptive forces disappear naturally. Also through
internal and external purity (saucha) both of the body, psychic
environment, and of removing the occlusions of consciousness,
there is achieved balance, cheerfulness, one- pointedness,
harmony of the senses, and yogic vision. HERE one is no longer
attracted by corruptive influences because one has established
(and is happily rooted within) a intelligent self empowering and
self regulating innate energetic freedom. Commentary: Purity (saucha)
is one of the niyams. It can be interpreted many ways. Some
yogis take it to mean keeping the inside of the body clean (annamaya
kosha) and healthy, the nadis open (pranamaya kosha) and energy
unobstructed, while the body is affected by being less burdened,
open, and light. Another inner application of saucha is keeping
the mental thoughts (manamaya kosha) free from kleshas,
samskaras, and vrttis. Yet another application of saucha may be
applied to our belief systems whether or not they may be tainted,
and thus be a source of taint, impurity, and affliction to our
consciousness (until purified). In this sense transformation and
rebirth is an action of purification. Yet another manifestation
of saucha is in our motivations and actions. But since actions
follow thought and consciousness (or lack thereof) it seems that
the purification of consciousness is more causal to this process.
So on a physical level, not poisoning the body or burdening it
with afflictions that it can not digest, assimilate, or
eliminate easily will unburden not only the digestive system,
but the elimination and immune systems thus creating more
available energy for the process of evolutionary circuitry and
higher consciousness to unfold. In one sense poor food habits
(and inability to digest, assimilate, and eliminate food) is an
energy drain and sedation of the kundalini, taking energy away
from the "other" super-psychic activities or spiritual projects
unless we were already very open in this direction and were not
negatively affected by dietary choices. The key however is the
development of our innate wisdom, instinct, or intuition to know
which of the food options are best for our own unique
constellation of body/mind at the moment achieving synergistic
balance, well being, and synchronicity. This is where the rest
of the yoga practice acts synergistically with diet -- and in
turn, diet with the overall integrity which is the yogic process.
Here also is where the hatha yoga kriyas or sat karmas (external
cleansing activities) can also help as well as reduce irritation,
thus creating more peacefulness (santosha) and being adjunctive
to the allied processes of aparigraha, tapas, pranayama,
pratyhara. concentration, meditation, and isvara pranidhana. On
an energy level we are purifying the energy body -- free some
psychic signatures due to past samskaras and karma. On a mental
level, meditation is the best practice of saucha i.e.,
purification of the mind and the removal of the obscurations of
consciousness. As we study the yam/niyams we will see the
mutually synergistic inter-relationships between ahimsa, satya,
asteya, brahmacharya, aparigraha, saucha, santosha, tapas,
swadhyaya, and isvara pranidhana disclosing the underlying all
inclusive integrative wholistic principle. II 42. santosad
anuttamah sukha-labhah By establishing a connection with the
energetics of fulfillment while being at peace with one self in
the present moment (santosha), then communion with a boundless
joy (sukha) manifests and deepens. Commentary: Santosha simply
means contentment and abiding in great peace. It is a natural
expression of the deepest samadhi (a profound state of
integration and completeness). This completeness and great
satisfaction is unconditional (not depending upon a separate
object of gratification or attainment. It is beyond the
disturbances of raga (attraction) and dvesa (repulsion) and thus
it transcends craving (dukha). As a practice it points to this
samadhi. Santosha becomes a new non-conflicting and stress free
way of wellness and thriving which becomes natural, When it is
disrupted, absent, or made discontinuous, we become aware of it,
and then we naturally apply the balancing and centering remedy
of santosha. We cultivate the completeness in All Our Relations.
Santosha is contentment, fulfillment, completion, and peace. As
such denotes abundance (not scarcity), happiness (not discontent),
and in a deeper sense especially deep gratitude, for if we are
deeply grateful how can we be can be unfulfilled? By gratitude,
one does not need to be grateful to anyone person or event, but
rather it is the deep heart felt sense of unconditional
gratitude in All Our Relations which when catalyzed, heals.
There is so much to be grateful to if we truly "re-member" --
the Great Binding (maha-vratam) -- the Great Integrity and
Completion -- the Great Natural Perfection -- that direct
connection with all mothers and fathers, the earth, stars and
sun -- the rain and winds, the trees and birds, the DNA and the
eternal Source -- all our elders and All Our Relations. As such
gratitude is a bridge from separation to Integration -- to All
Our Relations. It is the completion of ahimsa, aparigraha and
asteya. It is the end to disconsolateness. If dukha (which is
incompleteness or suffering) is really a state of craving or
unsatisfactoriness, then santosha would appear to be the natural
result or symptom of having removed the suffering of the kleshas
whose root is ignorance (avidya). Hence santosha becomes
spontaneous and natural when we feel deeply connected with our
natural uncontrived true and unconditioned beginningless true
nature. Likewise, by practicing santosha we are affirming and
moving toward that profound and sacred direction. Santosha is
practiced as peace and happiness -- as love. We commune with
peace and abundance and give it forth -- manifest it. When greed,
lust, conflict, war, trickery, competition, himsa (violence),
pain, thievery, deceit, corruption, falsity, and ignorance are
defeated -- when invincible Durga is victorious - then Santosha
reigns supreme! In the meanwhile we must attempt to assess our
allegiance with grief, war, conflict, anger, hatred, jealousy,
hurt, and fear -- be willing to surrender them unto the altar of
peace and lasting happiness. The Great Perfection awaits us. In
objectless meditation free from subject/object duality the
restlessness of the mind, the mental agitations, internal
conflicts, desires, aversion, contempt, defensiveness (in short
the kleshic propensities) eventually are stilled (nirodha)
bringing about the great open space and peaceful freedom of the
boundless and complete universal mind whose full nature emanates
peace. Great peace of mind, effects peace in All Our Relations.
II 43. kayendriya-siddhir asuddhi-ksayat tapasah Through the
purifying burning fire of tapas all the sense organs of the body
are perfected (kayendriya-siddhir) by the destruction (ksayat)
of all impurities (asuddhi). Commentary: The functioning of the
sense organs, the bodily functions, as well as the evolutionary
circuitries (sixth sense) are perefcted by repeated applications
of tapas (the generation of spiritual fire or passion) which
will also burn up and destroy all residue impurities creating a
radiant light body. Tapas is thus the heat that purifies and
fires the vehicle coarse vehicle of the body and refines it, so
that it is capable of being a loving/living evolutionary
container, manifestation, temple, and emanation for pure Spirit
and consciousness.
Now the question might arise, what is this tapas and how is it
applied? Where Brahmacharya is the most widely mistranslated
yama, tapas is the most widely mistranslated niyama --
mistranslated habitually by the same alineanted, academic,
authoritarian, anti-nature, and anti-body (read alien)
institutionalized traditionalists and control freaks, and for
the same reasons; i.e., they fear the natural and spontaneous).
Although the roots of the Sanskrit word, tapas, has nothing to
do with austerity, self abnegation, penance, or sacrifice, that
mistranslation has stuck because of this institutionalized bias
cast in precedence has become dominant in the vast morass of
unthinking parroting that one finds rampant in traditional
translations. As an unfortunate result there exists some cults
who pride themselves on how much harm they can inflict upon the
body, how much pain they can withstand, how much suffering they
can endure mistakenly hoping to "overcome" samsara this way --
mistaking this to be control over maya and freedom from
suffering which will lead them to samadhi. But simply inflicting
wounds upon the body, does not win wisdom, liberation, nor the
fruits of yoga. Authentic spiritual realization can not shine
through being lost in dvesa (aversion). Indeed there exists an
element of renunciation in the activity of tapas, but it is not
simply a renunciation as an goal in itself, but rather as an
acknowledgement, recognition, and affirmation of our spiritual
evolutionary process -- an effort to turn up the heat in a
stagnant practice -- engaging more deeply into the sacred dance
and prayer. The Sanskrit word, tapas (whose root maens heat,
connotes fire, passion, zeal, or fiery enthusiasm). Tapas is
both the result of abhyasa, sadhana or vairagya (applying yogic
practices such as pratyhara, pranayama, asana, dharana, and so
forth applied in a consistent manner (abhyasa) without
attachment (vairagya) and its motive causal flame at once. I say
this because tapas is eminently practical. It's both effective
expereintially and makes sense logically. In the practice of
tapas, one is not engaging in dissipating activities that suck
one's energy, but rather the energy is conserved (a
revolutionary concept in a gas guzzling society). If we have no
left over energy, then we can not direct it very well of course.
So tapas is more concerned in what we do not do, e.g., not
wasting our attention (cit) and energy (prana)l i.e., the
cit-prana, than in what we do (like in positive sadhana or
abhyasa).
Tapas is the specific practice which simply illumines the fact
that when we stop engaging in neurotic activities, then one will
have more energy left over to engage in spiritual practice (sadhana).
It makes perfect sense if you contemplate that, although
ordinary materialistic people's minds and energy as well as
bodily actions wander quite a lot being nabitually fixated on
external form (duality). That is why Shankaracharya said that
even beyond fasting or silence (mouna), the highest tapas is
meditation (dhyana) -- the stilling of the mind.
Patanjali very clearly said earlier in Pada II.2 above that
tapas attenuates the kleshas and provides the fuel for samadhi
ny making the vehicle (the temple of embodiment) light and
radiant -- free from dross. Without a working conscious
knowledge of such mechanism, success in yoga (samadhi) is not
possible. The trick of course is know how to ramp up the heat/fire
in one's practice. Eventually one finds oneself seated in a
circle of a billion fires (infinite source). This leads back to
the original yogic quest. i.e., finding what works for the
individual sadhak. If we follow the prana (shakti), thus
avoiding the tendency for the logical mind to delimit the
possibilities. That is why yoga practice is so valuable. The
point that this is supposed to change and evolve as we evolve
alongside in partnerships with the evolutionary energy as
teacher. Other wise we do not learn any lessons. Freeing our
mind-body-energy systems from dissipating distractions leading
toward fragmentation and dissolution, thus reclaiming and
reorganizing them through pranayama, pratyhara, dharana, and
dhyana practices is the correct application of tapas. The
authentic practice of tapas is generated by ceasing any activity
that is neurotic, habitual, material, ingrained, superficial, or
ties up our energy, freeing up that previously committed energy
that is normally committed/bound to a previously specific
endeavor, habit, or energy pattern. That particular energy that
is thus liberated can then be recycled and applied into
evolutionary activity (feeding the fires of divine passion and
providing tremendous strength). Thus tapas has two parts, only
the first part contains the energy of renunciation (giving up a
distraction, old habit, neurotic tendency, or corruptive
activity) while the second part is an affirmation which fires
up, speeds up, and accelerates the integrative spiritual
function. At first this previously trapped energy when first
liberated may just "sit there" and we can just be and breathe
with it, then as it builds up, it can be directed and used as
fuel on the sacred fire (and is thus associated with agni or the
fire ceremony). As such, the kundalini yogis say that tapas
feeds lady kundalini. Like the other yam/niyams they can be of
the body, speech, and mind -- coarse and refined (subtle) --
outer and inner (antar). The physical practice of tapas is often
associated with fasting from neurotic eating or fasting from
superfluous talk (mouna) as both activities can consume an
unnecessary and wasteful amount of time and energy as well as
contain many habitual patterns and propensities (Samskaras and
vasanas). However it is meditation that is considered to be the
highest form of tapas. Tapas is also strongly associated with
the other limbs, especially pratyhara. Tapas can also be
associated with various tantric practices as well as approaches
to life in everyday life -- in All Our Relations.
On a physical level (annamaya kosha), tapas is associated with
the hatha yoga bandhas. On an energetic level (pranamaya kosha)
tapas is associated with pratyhara, and on the mental levels (manamaya
kosha) it is associated with meditation. For more on tapas see
the discussion above in Pada II - Sutra I and in "Tapas as a
Spiritual Practice". Notice that tapas, swadhyaya (the next
niyam), and isvara pranidhana (the second following niyam) were
discussed in the beginning of Sadhana Pada as the three
synergistic activities that constitute Kriya Yoga. II 44.
swadhyaya ista-devata-samprayogah Through self study (swadhyaya)
knowledge of our true self is disclosed completing the yoga that
reveals our true sacred nature (innate divinity or ishta devata
which resides inside all beings). Commentary: Here all
activities have the potential of connecting us up with Source,
such as our asana practice as well as daily life experiences if
we learn how to observe ourselves in witness consciousness.
Swadhyaya can be a profound yogic process carried out all the
time. It too has an inner aspect such as the realization of the
purity and unity of "self'" in meditation (undifferentiated
aspect of consciousness) as well as the co-evolutionary aspect
of all created objects (the divine creatix or differentiated
aspect of beingness) which is completed in functional meditation
practice. Swadhyaya means self study. In the larger sense it
means study of the Self or Brahman. As such it is wedded to
brahmacharya, just as brahmacharya is wedded to aparigraha,
tapas, and ahimsa. Swadhyaya does not mean the study of books,
scriptures, or holy texts, although that has become the most
common interpretation. Although external books and teachers may
be of some value, this value exists only to the extent that one
finds the indwelling spirit -- revealing one's own true nature
within. If these external teachings/teachers lead to an inner
alignment with the collective universal core/heart -- the
hridayam -- resonating simultaneously in our hearts, only then
can the external teaching be considered non-dual,
non-distracting, and not corruptive. In modern ashrams daily
time is set aside to the study of inspired or revealed teachings
-- discourses of sages and realized yogis. Because in these
modern times, where the average student has already suffered
from over objectification it is valuable to keep all such
practices in synergistic balance.
The common man is not interested in how his mind works, how it
colors his life, who he is, and how to seek the truth. Rather
the common man doesn't know who he is and doesn't care. He seeks
out compensatory self gratification and meaning in externals --
in objects which he attempts to possess and identify with on one
hand, or escape, avoid, and flee from on the other. The inner
world of the mind and body is often left as an unsolved riddle.
Some men become interested in the hands and feet in order to
work better -- to obtain these objects. Some people become
interested in their genitals so as to feel more pleasure. Such
are approaches to the body/mind in order to touch the external
world. better. Care of the eyes, ears, and health in general is
thus relegated to such external functionality, but knowledge of
Self rarely becomes the issue outside of this superficial
extrinsic fascination (as a neurotic compensation for spiritual
self alienation) with the objective world. Thus the ordinary
man's interest in the inner workings of the instrument of
perception, cognition, consciousness and self rarely goes deeper.
In yoga for example taking up asana practice is seen as the
first step in getting in touch with the vital life force (prana)
and the subtle inner body/mind mechanisms which are more causal
toward affecting stress or wellness, tension or release, disease
or health., etc. Going deeper the mind/body relationship is
uncovered, the nature of the life energy is revealed, the
meaning and true nature of the mind, creation, and existence is
disclosed. This all requires attention, direction, concentration
of effort, dedication, devotion -- in short the self discipline
called swadhyaya. This will allow divine intention (bhava) and
grace to actualize. This is what authentic yoga is about -- how
to ramp the practice up so that these deeper relationship with
All Our Relations is revealed and as such the neurotic self
gratifications, over indulgences, consumerism, and symbolic
fascinations of man cease. Here meditation becomes the daily
opportunity for man to look inside and to see how his mind works,
rather than to chronically and neurotically avoid, escape, and
run away from it in his many masks of arrogance, aloofness,
delusions, lies, and other insecurities and false self limiting
identifications which is summed up by the word, ego.
The fear of looking inside to see how we work and who we truly
are is created by the denial of the ego -- the desire of the ego
to maintain its own delusion and rule -- its own life so to
speak. After one has become conditioned and accustomed to the
many masks of the ego, the ego reasoning goes if the ego dies,
then "I" die. Thus any truth that discloses this delusion (which
lies at the heart of neuroses) is seen as a threat to ego
identification and dominance -- as a threat to "self". This
threat is usually perceived unconsciously and dealt with by the
ego mechanisms of pride, arrogance, aloofness, hatred, scorn,
condemnation of the messenger, demonization, marginalization,
and even violence desiring the destruction of the threat. It
doesn't take a genius to see the socioeconomic and other
behavior consequences once man gets in touch with who they are
-- reestablishes a healthy relationship with All Our Relations.
Here truth (satya) is the threat to falsehood and delusion (avidya),
so the solution is easy -- man must wake up to his true
authentic self (swarupa). This is done through swadhyaya of
which meditation is the best purveyor. One essential step is to
throw away the mask. But the catch is that man must first has to
establish some meaningful security with true self -- with All
Our Relations in order to make this leap. This is what yoga
practice can provide when presented in this light. So functional
yoga practice in this regard gets man to trust the innate
intelligence inside -- in his body and as a an intimate part of
the earth, the universe and creation. One here relearns to trust
their instinct and intuition -- the inner wisdom and innate
teacher starts to shine forth eventually revealing itself in All
Our Relations. Meditation lets one step into the workings of
one's own mind and then eventually to set ourselves free from
ego's neurotic mechanisms of externalization and false
identification. Thus meditation reverses the extrinsic spin
toward self gratification in extrinsic things and objects. One
eventually sees that as an escape -- a neurotic substitute for
being presence with sacred presence -- for being HERE. In this
increasing clarity of mind and lucidity the meditator eventually
learns to trust his own ability to know by himself without
external authorities or validation. This attunement with
creation/creator creates great self confidence and sparks the
creative impulse. Only here can true freedom (kaivalya) be
spoken about. The inner, more causal and refined meaning of
swadhyaya is realized through meditation where the true nature
of the universal timeless Self is realized -- it not being found
in any book, words, concepts, belief, nor human language. See
commentary for tapas in Pada II. Sutra I. II 45. samadhi-siddhir
isvara-pranidhanat Samadhi is perfected (siddhir) through
letting go the limited matrix of a separate self while
surrendering to isvara (the all inclusive aspectless and
unconditioned great universal integrity or the underlying motive
power behind the principle of Infinite Mind).
Commentary: This is an affirmation that we must let go of the
limited matrixes of prejudice, preconceived, predilections, and
attachments to present beliefs in order to move into the
fertile/organic territory of Reality (which knows no such
artificial bounds or impositions). Here we surrender to the
highest self which is found as our highest innate potential --
Buddha nature. Isvara pranidhana means the surrender to the
highest Self - our highest potential which simultaneously exists
in the inherent unity of the three worlds (beginningless source,
never ending future, and the eternal present). In pada I we see
that Patanjali identifies Purusa, Isvara, and swarupa. As a
practice isvara pranidhana is closely related to Brahmacharya (see
above), but specifically invokes the energy of self surrender to
Self (purusa). In the Western context, it affirms the stance of:
"Thy will be done, HERE as in heaven".It must be noted that the
word, isvara is a generic term for "that which is beyond form,
attribute, or symbolic representation, i.e., the highest Self
where words such as Brahman can not penetrate. Isvara pranidhana
when practiced invokes and affirms sacred presence. Thus all the
yam/niyams will eventually be seen as being interconnected (especially
by the principles of ahimsa and vairagya). As self realization
gradually dawns (their practice being self disclosing) the
practice will become very natural and spontaneous as the inner
love and wisdom is awakened and manifests from the inside out.
Through the practices of the yam/niyams a mutual synergy will
gradually be established leading the practitioner naturally to
the underlying principle and motive power of yoga which lies
behind these practices and supports the Heart. Moving toward
isvara is also the bhava of divine intention -- it is the "good
mind" seeking out the highest good in All Our Relations. As such
it involves the generation of the mind of lasting happiness and
enlightenment for all beings, the bodhi-citta. The incorporation
of these yam/niyams into our daily lives will serve as
guideposts to show us where we go astray and where we can better
connect up more completely and continuously with Source. These
guidelines of ahimsa, truthfulness, integrity,
non-possessiveness, continuity, purity, peacefulness, divine
passion, self study, and surrender can also be expediently
applied to our daily asana practice to accelerate its highest
accomplishment as well.
Vairagya (non-attachment or letting go) which was introduced in
Pada I and the practice of isvara pranidhana form two sides of
one coin. They are mutually synergistic and incorporate the
fruition of sankalpa shakti which facilitates success in the
path of yoga. The physical or speech practices of isvara
pranidhana such as ceremonial or devotional practices devoid of
realization (as found in ritual, chanting. prayers, ceremony)
remain superficial and can not succeed without realizing the
HeartMind practice -- surrender to Universal Eternal Self in All
Our Relations.
All the niyams have the inherent power of accomplishing yoga,
while isvara pranidhana is perhaps the most powerful. In a
second it can destroy willfulness, asmita, all the other kleshas
-- all ignorance as well. It has the power of divine grace and
guidance. It contains the most ancient teaching: "Thy Will be
done on earth as it is in heaven". It must be made clear that
one cannot nor should not surrender to some one or thing that
they cannot trust. Without fundamental trust in something, then
isvara pranidhana cannot work. here we are not addressing
obedience as trust, but rather at the minimum something reliable
wherein we can rest, abide, and go toward. That can be simply be
our affirmation and invocation of our innate higher potential --
that which is around the corner. Even if we have difficult
issues of trust, we can surrender at least to this. Constant
strife, chronic self defense, hyper vigilance, and stress
creates while fighting for separate "self" is tiring sapping our
strength. It requires putting out too much energy, while
surrender to isvara bathes us in regeneration renewing the Self.
In THAT the war is over. The common man does not know how to
rest in trust or surrender. so they often need a segue like
surrender to a good teacher, priest, church, religion, ceremony,
ritual, and so forth. That can be a trap however, but isvara
pranidhana as All Our Relations is implicate, innate,
omnipresent, eternal, and universally available. Also see the
discussion of isvara in Pada II Sutra 1 (above) and Pada I.
Sutras 23-27, and the closely related practice of brahmacharya (Pada
II. Sutra 38) Here ends the discussion of yama and niyama, while
the discussion of asana and pranayama begins. II 46.
sthira-sukham asanam Asana should be self supporting, balanced,
(sthira) and joyful (sukham). Asana should be balanced and hold
itself up by itself. Our stance and position in life (asana)
should support us raising us up joyfully. Commentary: This sutra
can also be interpreted that as we sit in meditation we rest
upon our stable seat (asana) in steady joyousness. This can be
our always obtainable joyful base on or off the meditation
cushion or asana mat. This sutra says that while sitting in
asana for meditation one should remain strong and straight (sthira)
and joyful (sukham). This should be clear that effort, stress,
strain, or being pained or uncomfortable is not asana defined by
Patanjali. The next sutra Patanjali defines asana further as
being effortless (prayatna-saithilya).
That is the short and to the point translation, but today with
so much attention placed upon hatha yoga asana practice more
commentary may be helpful. Firstly let us simply call asana our
always accessible base position which has the quality of steady
joy. Secondly we remain so centered in this base while
meditating. Thirdly this joyful base should be balanced and hold
itself up by itself as in being inherently self supporting in
All Our Relations where we will include of course hatha yoga
asana practice as well. This joyful stable and strong base (sthira)
depends on two opposing forces being balanced out perfectly so
that all torque, vectors, or force is balanced out or stilled --
all resistance is eliminated. Here All Our Relations should be
self supporting, raising us up joyfully as we move into that
joyful self supporting alignment which is authentic asana. Thus
asana should support joy, while joy supports the asana. Asana
provide then a firm ground for joyful experiences as well. In
other words, according to Patanjali, you can't take the joy out
of asana and still call it asana, by his definition. Despite the
controversy about hatha yoga being hard work (as interpreted by
pleasure fearing nihilists), Patanjali did not say that the
asana should be merely comfortable, but rather that it should
connect us up with joy. The Sanskrit word, sukha really means
joy or happiness. But austere religious people who are
disinclined to mix religion and enjoyment continue to translate
the word sukham, as merely being comfortable. In other words,
according to Patanjali, you can't take the joy out of asana and
still call it asana, by his definition. Really I think Patanjali
was on to something. Here and in the next two sutras on asana,
the idea of no effort, but rather of receiving support through
balance, synchronicity, and release is presented. Strength and
ease are both present. The qualities of engagement are
complemented with letting go, but Patanjali says that this let
go is not a droop or sag, but should have the quality of
strength and stability (sthira). Thus our seat (asana) in the
muladhara provides the stable foundation for spiritual uplifting
-- we must take care of the root in order to feed the crown, an
important non-dual both/and teaching rather than an either/or
fear oriented affirmation.
This is accomplished by keeping the nadis open and balanced and
the prana flowing. Balance is achieved in yoga when the crown
chakra (sahasrara) and earth chakra (muladhara) are
synergistically synchronized and aligned. This occurs in the
central non-dual channel or nadi called sushumna. In successful
asana practice, this balance and natural tonality are firmly
established and as such it provides a stable foundation or base
for success in meditation. The foundation or root chakra is the
one we sit on, the muladhara chakra. This is where the prana is
balanced and brought into a mutual synchronicity awakening the
dormant evolutionary energy (kundalini) and circuitry (chakras).
Asana meaning seat, foundation, or base; it becomes the way sit
and touch the earth in meditation and it is this connection
between body and consciousness, earth and sky, nature and spirit,
ida and pingala, root and crown which must be made continuous.
Here Patanjali means by the word, asana, on a coarse level the
way the body sits for meditation, as well on a more subtle level
as our stance or perspective in life, our attitude (free from
slant, bias, prejudice, or vrtti). When this bias or vrtti are
remediated and balanced out, then the asana so re-aligned and
activated becomes the universal ground of pure beingness --
ultimate being. It is this ultimate asana of universal being
which brings in universal and ultimate consciousness free from
any bias, limitation, or vrtti. In meditation thus we place the
body in a strong, stable, and energetic connection with the
earth which forms the grounding pole for spirit to animate,
enliven, empower, inspire, and strengthen us. This earth
connection at the muladhara chakra which when activated and
harmonized unifies the female/male energies, forming as such a
ground rod for the sky energy to be conducted but at the same
time a link from the earth in which to touch the sky. In reality
this flow is not linear - one way up or down -- but non-dual
both up and down and neither up and down. It is not within the
realm of three dimensional definitions. Here the ida/pingala and
thus the kundalini flows through the central column of sushumna
linking earth with sky, mula with sahasrara, nature with spirit,
dissolving all tension and polar opposites. It is valuable to
know that a bandha is not a physical contraction, but rather it
is an energy redirection that allows for flow preventing energy
from being dissipated outward or energy from being inhibited
entirely. As such mulabandha is a specific bandha which forms
the energy valve in the earth chakra so that front and back,
left and right, top and bottom are unified so that the energy is
supported and flows in this life supporting vital center. In
mulabandha the energy between pubic bone and the tail bone are
linked (bound together) to form a connection and uplifting
energetic which supports the pelvis providing a stable and
joyous base for the spine and the rest of the body. Energy hence
is prevented from being dissipated, but rather is utilized to
support the body, neurology, breath, brain, and deeper
holographic trans-dimensional energetic alignment available at
the more subtle levels, deeper pulsations of existence, and
higher vibratory frequencies of consciousness. This supports the
asana and allows us to sit upright in meditation joyously for
long periods of time without dissipation or discomfort. Here our
connection with the earth must be made continuous in meditation
throughout the sit so that heaven and earth remain balanced and
connected through direct uninterrupted communion.
It is a misinterpretation of Patanjali to suppose that this
word, asana, applies to the hatha yoga definition of asana, such
as found in the multitude postures used hatha yoga asana
practices. Patanjali did not teach or practice hatha yoga, but
rather raj yoga (meditation). This is not to say that raj yoga
and hatha yoga are incompatible (they are not incompatible at
all) but more important it should be made clear that what
Patanjali says about asana is meant to apply to meditation
practice. Thus this sutra pertained to the way one prepares for
meditation, not hatha yoga type asana practice. For more on the
differences between hatha yoga and Patanjali's raj yoga see Sri
Pungaliya's scrupulous essay. Sthira does not mean controlled or
rigid, but connotes strong, steadiness, continuity, easeful,
still (as in non-agitated) but not dead, supported and strong
with spirit, self sustaining and self supporting, empowered, and
as such connotes strength, activation, animation, energization,
alertness, instilled presence, endowment, uplift, endurance, and
inspired -- instilled with prana (with the continuous flow of
the chit-prana or chit-shakti) as in an alert and alive
embodiment. It is the opposite of a sagged out, numbed out,
droopy, slack, drained, blocked, imbalanced, dead, or fragmented
and distracted inattentive state. Just like sukha is often
mistranslated as comfortable, sthira too is often mistranslated
as a rigid or inert stillness, but when that is applied to the
body too often one interprets that as a kind of tightness,
contraction, tenseness, and frozenness, having become afraid of
letting the body move. Sthira does not mean tight or rigid, but
rather it implies an easy continuous flow, a peaceful
non-agitated stillness and restful position, resilience,
endurance, and a steady continuity connoting the successful
resolution of any unbalancing or disturbing forces eventually
producing a natural adamantine steadiness in meditation
effecting the eventual stillness of the vrtti. In graduated
stages of sitting in asana a great natural peace, ease, and
stillness of both body and mind gradually arises unless tension
or rigidity prevents it. After consistent practice (abhyasa)
grace arises, and then this joyous state becomes continuously
and steadily accessible, within reach, always at hand -- it
endures and becomes continuous.
If we investigate the very nature of the living body in any
position, we will see that we can not control or hold it still.
Even a dead body is moving and decomposing. Not only do we want
the body to move with pulmonary respiration such as the chest
and diaphragm, but we also want the heart to continue to pump,
the lymph flow, the peristalsis to continue, the cell mitosis,
the millions of glandular and cellular functions all to flow and
support the body while we are in asana. At the same time the
earth is moving, mountains are moving, the planet rotates and
spins around its axis and circles the sun. The entire solar
system is moving in the Milky way, and all the galaxies ate
moving around the core/heart center. So we do not want to expend
unnecessary energy in a futile attempt to resist this natural
movement, rather what we do want to do is to move the spine in
synergistic alignment with the core/heart of the universe --
with the central pillar of stillness which by itself does not
move, but from which all is in flux. When we practice we will
notice that sometimes it takes some movement in order to move
into this balance and synchronicity. Nay, it always requires a
movement when we move from duality into unity -- there occurs a
shift. To hold the body and energy static would to be to hold
back this shift. Therefore, one who meditates should not get
tight, rigid, or contracted; rather Patanjali says it should be
joyful. Why is that so, because the nadis remain open, the
chit-prana is balanced and harmonized -- the wavering of the
mind (cit-vrtti) are stilled and quieted (nirodha). Thus in the
correct application of this sutra, sthira and sukha are allowed
to manifest in asana also brings on great peace effortless and
joy without droop. It is important enough to repeat that sthira
is not rigidity, tightness, hardness, or holding still. The body
can never be held still -- it is impossible and to try is to
cause tension and conflict which we must learn to release. The
blood, lymph, and prana must flow, the heart must beat, the
craniosacral fluid, peristalsis, cell mitosis -- all must be
allowed to continue. However it is possible in yoga is to reach
that center where we witness the flow of the Great River -- all
that is on fire, all that is temporary, all the dynamic relative
world of creation as moving -- being in flux. That innate
stillness of infinite mind that self exists deep within at our
core center -- the axis mundi -- the tree at the center of the
world -- the hridayam. Thus when consciousness and beingness are
merged in sthira sukham asanam, stillness is achieved yet the
body although aligned with spirit/creator, being part of the
created world is allowed to move with the variegated ebb and
flows of life and creation. Sukham means more than happiness,
but joyfulness. It is much more than simply being comfortable.
Thus we must find a happy spot, be joyful, find that alignment
with Satchitananda and sit there. That is asana. So of course we
avoid tenseness and rigidity, moving out of those tight places
to that more expansive state of consciousness when we sit in
meditation practice (asana being the third limb of astanga
yoga). This type of seat feels like "home". It is a continuous
and happy alignment between the apparent poles of consciousness
(spirit) and beingness (nature) -- the crown and earth chakras
-- in the body through which these two polar energies are united
and flow. It is the opposite of being "uptight", tense, rigid,
contracted, and blocked.
Thus it is futile to try to arrange the body into a fixed,
motionless, lifeless, and rigid position (rigor mortis), but
rather allow it to move, align, synchronize and attune its
body/mind and energy channels between the highest heaven and the
center of the earth. Then when the fundamental principle and
source of consciousness (spirit) is
harmonized and merges with creation through your own embodiment,
then the body becomes steadfast in that union spontaneously --
then the body can go into suspended animation. However to try to
freeze the body prematurely in order to bring about the
spiritual state is taking the cart before the horse…. The
ordinary body must first be allowed to become alchemically
transmuted through the spiritual-physical practice of authentic
meditation.This stage is greatly catalyzed by the practice of
the yams/niyams (especially authentic tapas) and also by the
gradual integration of the pranayama, pratyhara, (dharana)
concentration, and meditation (dhyana). Further one may just as
well take the word, asana, as seat, and then extend that
definition as to what is the seat of spirit -- the sacred temple
-- the abode of love? "The body is my temple and asanas are my
prayers." BKS Iyengar Regardless what technique, if any, that we
may implement in sitting in meditation it is useful to find
sthira and sukha (supporting joy). This, like all the other
limbs, can be extended in other practices in asana for example
as well as In All Our Relations. II 47.
prayatna-saithilyananta-samapattibhyam This profound state of
balance and synchronicity (samapattibhyam) is accomplished
through progressive and continuous relaxation (prayatna-saithilya)
by aligning within the great self existing, self supporting, and
self animating (ananta) endless Flow and Intelligence which
always awaits the true seeker as the Great Continuum (Infinite
Mind). Commentary: Saithilya means being loose, not tight,
relaxed, while prayatna means effort, striving, or a state of
tension. Here Patanjali is clearly stating that in asana one
must make an effort to relax effort -- to relax the tensions in
order to move into a balanced and synergistic self sustaining
state. This is not thus a dead relaxation into a collapse but
rather an energization. Rather that the relaxation (saithilya)
of effort and striving (prayatna) removes the expenditure of
energy, self effort, and any other energy suck as we move into a
greater shower and blessings of a physical and mental attitude
which is in balance and harmonious alignment with the universal
core/heart.
True asana (versus an ordinary position), thus moves us into an
infinite (ananta) unity (samapattibhyam). In meditation we have
to avoid this stasis of tension/tightness where energy is
vectored in one direction or the other requiring resistance in
either the body or the mind to sit upright or else our energy
will be dissipated in the reactive contraction of the body,
muscle spasms, and other tensions. The body or energy channels
may tighten up or contract, thus necessitating that we release
that tension and energy blockage or else become drained by it.
In a parallel way the mind also may tend to contract itself, and
mental tensions spill over, thus one must make an effort to
release the contracted spin of the energy through awareness of
alignment -- the principles of the interconnected mandala of
body, speech (energy), and mind). Otherwise our mental and
physical effort will suck energy and attention away from the
meditation process of union if we allow it through lack of
awareness (ignorance). One result of functional meditation is to
de-stress, relax, and abide in the great peace that samadhi
brings -- to connect up with the transpersonal imperishable
infinite mind. The only effort we have to do is to show up --
sit or similarly we make an effort to be less than effortless.
Another result of an expedient meditation is that we leave more
connected and energized -- more integrated and feeling vitally
whole. Practically when we sit we can become aware of the body
if it tends to harden, contract, tense up, and go into spasm
after awhile so that we have to soon we feel pain and feel the
need to get up and stretch, but we can learn how to keep the
energy and consciousness flowing through the channel of the
body/mind continuously through effective asana so that any
stagnant energy can be shifted -- so that the energy connection
stays open and softens (yet does not droop). Here we are
relaxing effort, letting go of tension and hardness, and letting
go of rigidity of mind as well. Here we are allowing the mind,
the energy, and the body to remain in continuous and harmonious
flow. Staying in that balance is synergistic to balancing the
energies discussed in the previous sutras. Thus when we sit we
can apply the techniques that Patanjali recommends like pure
thoughts and intents (yam/niyam), correct asana, pranayama,
pratyhara, etc. Here correct asana involves samapattibhyam which
is a balancing act, a harmonization -- an integration into the
world of All Our Relations. This is the perfect position.
Samapattibhyam means coming into balance and harmony -- aligning.
Here it means aligning with Infinite Source. Ananta means
birthless, deathless, endless, or infinite. Ananta is also the
Great Serpent that Vishnu rests upon as such it is apropos to
any discussion of asana. Asana could thus be looked at as
relaxing all effort and connecting up with infinite source like
Vishnu relies/relaxes upon Ananta. This relaxation of effort and
synchronistic alignment with continuous flow comes up in asana
with conscious practice. Albeit these are more subtle (sukshma
sharira) aspects of asana, they are also more causal and thus
affect the practice more powerfully.
In this manner providing a kundalini or tantric interpretation,
then sutra 49 when combined with sutra 48, could be translated
as: "through the withdrawing of effort in asana while
contemplating the never ending continuum of our true nature,
then the bipolar afflictions of duality vanish and the asana
forms a balanced (samapattibhyam) and self supporting (ananta)
energetic creatix." Here kundalini located at the muladhara --
the seat or root (asana meaning seat) is able to become
activated through this synchronicity and harmonization of any
tension in the psychic nervous system (nadis) and then that
juice flows through the sushumna activating the highest chakras
and manifesting in union (sahasrara and muladhara are united/synchronized
by the flow of the kundalini (serpent power) in the central
nerve. II 48. tato dvandvanabhighatah Asana resolves opposition.
Commentary: This way the polarities (dvandva) support each other
(creating ascension in the central channel-- holding the spine
erect by itself). Here lightness is achieved and gross heaviness
and coarseness is replaced with increasingly more subtle
qualities of effortlessness until the never-ending absolute is
touched. A literal translation is: "From asana practice which
rests in steady joy and relaxed synchronicity (tato) one becomes
invulnerable from the assaults (anabhighatah) of duality (dvandva)".
This is another characteristic our true support base (asana)
along with steady joy and balanced synchronicity. This is our
seat of support to be accessed in meditation as well as in
everyday life. Stress, tension, and conflict are thus resolved.
It is also accessed in hatha yoga asana and pranayama practice
as well. If we were to apply this to what a successful asana
practice would look like, there would be a mutually uplifting
self supporting synergistic balance which is realized where the
apparent conflicting dualistic energies are harnessed and
synchronized effortlessly acting as harmonious team or whole so
that the position becomes effortless, self supporting, self
sustaining, and self animating. How are the poles of opposition
balanced; how are imbalances resolved; how is tension, conflict,
stress and strife relaxed? Obviously this imbalance or polar
tendency to swing to or fro is due to not being aligned. Here we
are not speaking merely of aligning the bones and joints, but
also the energy centers, the breath, spirit, mind, and wisdom --
our overall position mental, spiritual, energetic, and physical
with the created world, the force of creation, and timeless
spirit. here one may say that the central theme of this sutra is
alignment and for this to happen we will also suggest strongly
that the five koshas are to aligned here as well.
Not being swayed to or fro the energy is balanced and in terms
of kundalini it is thus collected in the central column and
rises up effortlessly in the sushumna nadi so that levitation
and timelessness (ananta) is realized. So on a subtle and more
causal level Patanjali is addressing internal processes here.
Although Patanjali did not practice or advocate hatha, kundalini,
laya, kriya, or tantra yoga explicitly, which developed after
his time, it is evident that he experienced these energetic
transformations and was able to lay a foundation for its future
development by articulating it utilizing existing philosophical
terminology. Dvandva clearly means the pair of opposites and as
such the idea of balancing ida/pingala or siva/shakti becomes
invoked. Here polarity does not distort nor assault (anabhihatas)
the practitioner, rather they are utilized, balanced, harnessed,
and used for support No matter what technique is employed, here
internally the left and right, ida/pingala, apana/prana, tha and
ha, mula/sahasrara -- all constituent energies become balanced,
aligned, and synchronous. Here the physical body, mind, nervous
system, psychic channels, energy body, etc., all are placed in
non-dual synchronicity acting as a support to sustaining samadhi.
This also can be extended to all other yogic practices such as
hatha yoga -- in All Our Relations. II 49. tasmin sati
svasa-prasvasayor gati-vicchedah pranayamah [After establishing
a firm foundation or seat for spirit, balance, and a
synchronicity of freedom from duality in asana] then (tasmin)
the foundation for the next stage is established (sati) which is
called called pranayama or the bringing forth and extending the
life energy in this embodiment (sati). Pranayama is accessed
through breaking down and analyzing (vicchedah) the procession (gati)
of the individual aspects (vicchedah) of the dynamic motions and
energetic processions underlying the heretofore unconscious (gati)
processes of inspiration (svasa) and expiration (prasvasayor) [as
these dynamics operate and flow through the body/mind matrix].
Commentary: A more succinct translation is that from success in
asana there (tasmin) is established a firm foundation (sati) to
observe and analyze (vicchedah) the processes (gati) of
inhalation (svasa) and exhalation (prasvasayor) in order to
effect the flow of prana more extensively (in the body/mind).
But what must be emphasized here is that prana means energy, not
breath, so at best we can see that the observation of the breath
is a coarse method to get us more in touch with the more subtle
energy and wholistic neurologic processes underlying the
breathing process. In short pranayama is to proceed from this
steady joyful self supporting non-dual base. After establishing
asana as the steady, joyful, and balanced seat of Infinite or
Boundless Mind, now then in pranayama the yogi learns how to
extend and spread spirit throughout the body, the breath, energy
channels, and Mind in a multidimensional transpersonal way --
All Our Relations. Here shakti as prana shakti activates the
dormant centers in the sadhak.
Simply and concisely this sutra describes a yogic practice
called pranayama where one starts off by first taking asana as
described immediately previously, then placing one's attention
upon the inhalation and exhalation of the breath in order to
extend and refine (ayama) the prana. Here Patanjali is explicit
that pranayama is an awareness/observation practice, not a
mechanical willful practice. We will thus break this key sutra
down into its component parts and then reconstruct it. First the
reader should know that the most common mistranslation of this
sutra usually reads: "pranayama is the control or regulation of
the inhalation, exhalation, and retention of breath". That
mis-translation reflects two common mistakes. The first is more
common -- the misinterpretation of the word, prana, as breath,
which would make the translation redundant as well as misleading.
Rather we shall translate pranayama as the extension, spreading,
thinning, refinement, or expansion of energy, where prana is
best translated as life energy (not breath) and "ayama" is
translated as expansion, thinning, rarefaction, or extension. Or
one can break the word, yama, down differently as in "ya" (to
bring forth) and ma (to nurture). On the other hand the
definition of yama as control or regulation, reflects an errant
school of hatha yoga which believed that liberation could be
attained through forcefulness and control of the body, breath,
and mind. The word, control, thus reflects another assumption
made by repressed and over objectified left brain dominant will
oriented top down intellectuals and ideologically based
religionists, just as these very same dualists mistranslate
nirodha as control, tapas as self abnegation, swadhyaya as
scriptural study, or brahmacarya as sexual restraint where there
exists no objective or experiential basis. Secondly no word
meaning retention, control, or suppression of the breath (kumbhaka)
is present in this sutra (see sutra 54 for more). Vicchedah
means making to break or cut apart, not control, restraint, or
stoppage. It is conjoined to the Sanskrit word, gati, which
refers to the procession of the breathing process. Thus we learn
to expand and refine the prana by observing and breaking apart
the movements of the breath as it occurs in inspiration and
expiration so that it is no longer controlled by the unconscious
winds of karma and unconscious habit, but rather it comes into
the light of consciousness -- vicchedah being an act of
consciousness not individual control over the breathing. In this
way our energy and mind changes as well as our karma. This will
be made even more clear in in next sutra (50) where Patanjali
introduces the very pertinent technique of paridrsto which means
to behold or to overview.
Patanjali is mainly telling us that pranayama can be approached
at first as the process (gati) of becoming aware of our energy
by breaking it down into its gross external components as
manifest in the profound linkages between mind and energy
inherent in the breathing process -- how the energy enters our
body/mind,
how it leaves it, and how it becomes discontinuous or inhibited.
Through this break down of these energetics (utilizing the
breath as its coarse tangible representative), then we obtain
awareness of how the energy is extended, refined, and made more
subtle so that we open up the nadis (the container of the prana)
which activates the body's higher circuitries and potential (the
manifestation of brahman in this very body as the Jivamukti).
With this awareness we can sit in asana so that the meditation
is energized without dissipation to activate its highest
potential (in an accomplished samadhi). This awareness (of the
cit-prana) is at first coarsely perceived through asana and/or
breath awareness, but that is so that we can eventually become
conscious of the energy, its various directions, and how to
redirect and harmonize it for spiritual evolution. Prana (with a
capital "P" permeates all of the Universe without it nothing
moves, but also prana with a small "p" denotes the vital energy
(prana) as it permeates the physical body. It is strongly
associated with the breath as the animating principle -- as the
sustainer -- linking creation with Infinite Source. When the
cosmic matrix is meshed and synchronized with the human matrix,
then Spirit's gifts become potenized in the now. Indeed
breathing is the most primal activity of human life, performing
a bridge between the unconscious (autonomic) and conscious (central)
nervous systems. In hatha. kundalini, and tantra yoga pranayama
is not just a powerful awareness tool, but a focused practice
capable of balancing and synchronizing not only the autonomic
and central nervous systems, but also the afferent and efferent
nervous systems and the sympathetic and parasympathetic nervous
systems as all polarities can be accessed through the breath.
Similarly, hatha yoga tells us that by becoming aware of and
accessing the breath consciously in these ways we can also
access directly into our psychoneurology, the biopsychic
pathways, nadis, matrices, energy cysts, and cellular and
energetic imprints which hold the samskaras in place, thus
breaking them up, breaking up past karma, kleshas, and hence
vrtti. Thus the various pranayama exercises of exploring the
energetic processes of inhalation, exhalation, and stoppage of
breathing within hatha yoga are given to us in order to achieve
this awareness, observe this process, and thus eventually
achieve liberation (from karma and vrtti). The goal is not the
control of the breath, but rather it is the awareness of the
subtle and more causal intelligent primal operations of prana
shakti or kundalini shakti who further instructs.
In many practices of hatha yoga , laya yoga, and prana vidya,
the interruption of the normal flow of the breath are given in
order to both provide awareness and communion, but also to
disrupt old mental patterns (vrttis) and karma harnessing the
previous dormant or energy to activate dormant evolutionary
circuitry. A salient point is that this is not really vicchedah
as meant by Patanjali, but rather through these innumerable
pranayama practices one has the opportunity to investigate the
action of these many types of breathing patterns upon on our
energy field and thus becoming aware of the breath processes (vicchedah),
then one becomes more aware and integrated with primal Prana. "Normal"
subconscious habitual breathing is thus called karmic breathing,
while pranayama practice not only breaks up (vicchedah) old
karma, but burns it up establishing the practitioner in a karma
free zone. Here various pranayama practices using the breath can
be used for healing, but pranayama here as presented by
Patanjali is meant to propel the practitioner beyond their past
conditioning and karma altogether. Just simple breath awareness
helps us to free the dissipations of monkey mind (vikalpa) and
concentrates the cit-prana, but pranayama practices in hatha and
tantra yoga go deeper and work faster combining, pranayama,
pratyhara, dharana, mudra, and asana as one integrated practice
that is used to jump start dhyana (meditation) and samadhi.
Pranayama as described by Patanjali (as raj yoga) is often
confused with the more elaborate pranayama as described in hatha,
kundalini, and tantra yoga, but they are not contradictory. Here
in this sutra, Patanjali is not directly addressing those
variegated and sometimes forceful pranayama techniques as found
in hatha yoga, rather he is addressing observation of the breath
and the refinement of the prana in the context of meditation.
Only in the next sutra he goes into methodology, albeit there
are those who translate vicchedah as the cutting off the breath
which this translator takes as a control freak's bias. Again
vicchedah is the conscious analysis of the breath which
admittedly hatha yoga pranayama practice can indeed enhance. In
simple meditation we can simply notice the changing qualities of
breath according to how the mind becomes distracted or focused.
We bring our awareness to the breath and refine and extend it if
it has become coarse or restricted. After practice this
relationship between the empty and quiet mind and the breath
becomes understood and a doorway opens into the operations of
the cit-prana and the operations of the mind. Then eventually
the origin of mind, the Infinite Mind, or simply the Natural
Unconditioned Mind is revealed through at first the very simple
method learning how to observe the breath and how it changes.
Then one learns how to balance and direct the cit-prana, the
mind, and the breath all at once effecting flow toward samadhi.
In more advanced pranayama practice as taught in hatha yoga, one
(out of many) simple practice is called sushumna breath where
the inhalation (prana) energy with the exhalation (apana) energy
are equally balanced both in duration and intensity, generating
a spiritual synergy (in the central column called sushumna) of
supreme effortless (sunya). Here the individual will and
Universal Will have merged. Pranayama brings us into awareness
of the polar opposites, the expansion and the
contraction of the divine pulsation of siva/shakti (spanda), the
movement of spirit as it inspires, and eternal dance of love
through the expiratory medium of the living temple. This is a
powerful but subtle pranayama method to jump start an align a
sitting meditation (dhyana) session. II 50.
bahyabhyantara-stambha-vrttir desakala-samkhyabhih paridrsto
dirgha-suksmah Through over-viewing (paridrasta) and analyzing (samkhyabhih)
the rapidity, the place or location (desa) and the duration or
length (kala) of the inhalation (abhyantara) and exhalation (bahya)
of the breathing operations (vrtti) in relationship to its still
points (stambha) and/or its spinning/movements (vrttir) the
energy is extenuated and becomes more refined and subtle (dirgha-suksmah).
A similar reading is: That through over-viewing (paridrsto) the
oscillations between the spinning patterns (vrttir) of the
inward and outward characteristics of the breathing process and
its operations of stillness (stamba) in regard to duration (kala),
location (desa), and the number of repetitions (samkhyabhih), as
to its degree of subtleness (suksmah) and extenuated fineness (dirgha)
while the breath spins internally, externally, or comes into
stillness (stamba) [pranayama is practiced]. Commentary: Here
Patanjali goes into more subtle detail, extending the previous
sutra. This is the gold for meditators to look for. Becoming
sensitive to, familiar with, and beholding (paridrasta) the
breath acting as a gateway to the source of prana allows us to
energize the psychic pathways, which in turn allows access to
the purification of our deepest internal body/mind circuits,
psycho-neuro-physiology, and bio-psychic energetic processes, as
well as allow us to harmonize and align with the infinite
non-dual Source of Prana. As the subtle process between the
breath and energy (prana) becomes revealed and refined, the
citta (mind stuff) becomes refined and thus the citta-vrtti are
attenuated.
Some say that Patanjali is referring to the operation of three
types of breathing: inhalation (abhyantara), exhalation (bahya)
and retention (stamba) of breath. Others say that he is
referring to the hatha yoga techniques of internal retention,
external retention, and sahaj kumbhaka, referring to the flow of
prana in the pingala, the ida, and the sushumna nadis
respectively. However since retention of the breath in Sanskrit
is kumbhaka, not stamba, we will assume here he means stillness
as the breath increasingly becomes extended, refined, thinned,
and more subtle as the prana becomes more subtle and refined
leading up to the increased possibility of sahaja
(natural) kumbhaka ( kevala kumbhaka) or setting its stage where
such occurs spontaneously in meditation. A point that
experienced practitioners all know, but here beginners may save
some time and avoid confusion, is that the techniques of sahita
(technical) pranayama exist not as an end in itself to master,
but as tools to explore the operations of the breath and prana
-- to harmonize and make more subtle the prana and the citta (collectively
the cit-prana) so that it is allowed to move into the central
column (sushumna) naturally. As such when the pranas stop
flowing in ida and pingala as prana and apana, then it is
automatically and naturally drawn up into the sushumna. Thus the
techniques (sahita) reveal the subtle actions of prana to our
consciousness so that we can merge, re-connect, or reintegrate
with our unconditioned natural true self (swarupa). When this
latter happens it is accompanied by sahaj kumbhaka and is thus
called called sahaj (natural) pranayama (as distinguished to
sahita pranayama). So to avoid confusion, yes the techniques
such as given in sahita pranayama is a prerequisite for the
completion which is accomplished in sahaja. Let it be said that
pranayama in hatha, kriya, kundalini, and tantra yoga is a
profound practice which can also be quite elaborate. In swara
yoga, which pranayama is a subdivision, and to a great degree in
hatha and tantra yoga, there exists an emphasis placed on the
location of the breath, its distance from the nose and lungs,
its characteristic strength/amplitude or force, the
characteristics of its spinning and swirling motion in the nose
and lungs, its rapidity, thinness, smoothness, evenness between
nostrils, etc. Swara yoga is considered to be the master science
which pranayama is derived and it appears that Patanjali was
well aware of this. Many books and oral teachings have pranayama
and swara yoga as subjects, but here we will focus on the raj
yoga aspects (in meditation) which we will assume is the point
of Patanjali's meaning. In the sitting meditation of Raj Yoga,
the first and essential stage is awareness or observation (paridrasta)
where we do not try to change the breath, but simply notice and
become aware of what is happening with the characteristics of
breath, how it changes with the thoughts (vrtti), and come back
to a smooth, subtle, and long breathing. Sometimes the mind will
come into stillness and there one may notice that the breath
also has become very long and subtle or even appear to be still
as well. When the mind wanders we can thus bring the attention
back to the breath noticing all the characteristics of the
breath and their relationship to the wandering or steadiness of
the energy and mind (the cit-prana or cit-shakti). In this way
the breath, the prana, and the mindstuff (citta) become refined
and more subtle eventually entering into an unwavering
non-agitated stillpoint (stamba) .
When sitting we can notice to advantage where the breath is
concentrated, how the breath stops, becomes ragged, becomes deep,
long, short, interrupted, flows freely, fluctuates (vrttir),
wavers, becomes coarse or subtle, rapid or slow, imbalanced/balanced,
and so forth related to mental, emotional, and physical
correspondences which we become aware of, acknowledge, and
observe (paridrsto). We observe it according to many
characteristics moving from the gross and coarse into the most
subtle -- moving into the energetics of the breath and self
awareness of the internal energetics that are both inside and
outside so that we can align and harmonize this very body now
with the cosmic soul (param purusha) in the yantra of bliss (anandamaya
kosha or causal body). Thus we move from the coarse body (sthula
sharira) found in the annamaya kosha (or nirmanakaya) to the
causal body (karana sharira) which is found in the anandamaya
kosha or dharmakaya) through the working the energy or subtle
body (sukshma sharira) found in the pranamaya kosha or the
sambhogakaya). Thus through breath awareness, then energy
awareness, then pre awareness, we move from the coarse, to the
subtle, to beyond even the most subtle (nirvicara), and thus
learn how to commune with and stay in our core energy because of
the simple truth that the breath will reflect what is in the
body/mind. The breathing thus is more so a gateway furnished
through awareness provided by the activation of the energy body
(suksmah sharira) found in the pranamaya kosha) to the causal
body (karana sharira) or dharmakaya to unconditional formless
Source. In a more subtle sense then Patanjali is saying that a
subtle extenuation and refinement (dirgha-suksma) of the breath
also effects a corresponding pranayama (as an extenuation and
refinement of the prana) and hence the mind. Certainly
neuro-psycho-physiology and Psycho-neuroimmunology (PNI)
indicate that when the breath is long, thin, and subtle the
system is operating at a reduced level of stress, well being,
and health. In simple sitting meditation (dhyana) in the
beginning we at first simply just come back to the breath with
out analyzing it if the mind has wandered. In pranayama practice
proper we focus on the energy behind the breath as a
concentration exercise (dharana) and hence pranayama can be
considered a dharana as well as pratyhara (see sutra 54).
Through subtle awareness we learn how the breath eventually
kindles the inner light which destroys the veil of ignorance (see
sutra 52).
In hatha and tantra yoga we augment this self awareness through
various conscious breathing processes which variously regulate
the length of the inhalations and exhalations, rate, intensity,
degree of subtlety, and location of the prana through exploring
the multitude positions of the breath in relation to location,
time, or other qualities and quantities for various permutations
and durations of time -- through becoming aware of the
subtleness of the breath, and through myriad and varied
combinations of the above.
Eventually we find that this awareness exercise allows us to
break up old previously unconscious karmic patterns of breathing,
breaking up old dysfunctional body/mind patterns, while allowing
us to more continuously align with prana's infinite Source
through the prana-shakti siddhi. In beginning hatha yoga we
learn how to balance the ida and pingala energies through
experimenting with the breath in each nostril while exploring
the mores subtle energetics governing these gross movements.
Direct conscious access to the psycho-neurophysiology is
established, its circuits become opened, activated, and
harmonized through pranayama. Through consistent expedient
pranayama practice and meditation these connections of the
breath, prana, mind, subtle body (suksmah), and causal body (karana
sharira) become revealed. Here the past conditioning,
programming, habits, and karma is destroyed and hence the sadhak
is made fit for meditation. In hatha yoga through various
exercises we learn where to concentrate the force of the breath
and the flows of the energy in order to accomplish
transformation of the body/mind. Pranayama practice should
proceed first as an awareness practice. Only after establishing
that awareness and sensitivity first, then experiments can be
undertaken and gauged in that light. Such must be slow, natural,
and not forced. It should not be rushed nor mechanical, because
it is very powerful to work with the causal energies within.
Without sensitivity and awareness, suffering will result.
Emphasis must be put on opening the nadis and balancing the
energy. Thus it is best to avoid pranayama unless one has
already become sensitive to and has learned to recognize.
respect, and honor the body/mind energy. If this awareness of
prana is not reached through a breath oriented kinesthetic asana
practice, then an experienced, wise, and accomplished selfless
teacher is the only other alternative worth pursuing. When the
nadis are open and balanced, then karmic breath is destroyed --
past karma becomes vanquished also. Pranayama siddhi also can
come about naturally through grace without formal practice (the
prana-shakti permeates our entire being). Thus it is debatable
whether or not Patanjali was recommending meditators to do a
formal practice pranayama as an external discipline like as
found in hatha yoga, or rather he was describing the processes
in which the breath changes in meditation and the methods that
can be used to bring about synergy. Certainly swara yoga and
other tantric practices are an advanced and elaborate extension
of pranayama which focus on the most subtle aspects of the
breath, its location, and types of swirling motions throughout
the day, according to various seasons, astronomical alignments,
etc. Swara yoga as an elaborate science will not be discussed
here.
In general it is well worth repeating that prana means energy,
and ayama means to extend; so that through pranayama one extends
the Infinite Source of energy throughout the body so that every
cell in the body is unified with cosmic source -- so that the
nadis are open, balanced, and aligned. Thus in meditation we can
consciously keep the nadis open and the breath energetic, deep,
balanced, and nourishing. If this is not discontinuous then the
body will never become tight, tired, painful, or droop. II 51.
bahy-abhyantara-visaya-aksepi caturtah Then the fourth (caturtah)
realm (visaya) of successful pranayama, occurs when the prana is
withdrawn and ceases to move (aksepi) either internally (abhyantara)
or outwardly (bahya). Commentary: Concisely we can say that when
the breath and prana become so refined, subtle, and refined the
prana then changes from most subtle to beyond even the most
subtle (nirvicara). Here too then the prana ceases to flow in
the dualistic pathways of ida and pingala, but rather withdraws
into the central nadi (sushumna) as kundalini. In nirvicara
samadhi the dualistic winds that drive the distractive thought
processes (chit-vrtti) cease (nirodha). This is the gateway to
nirvicara samadhi or turiya (the fourth). In the previous sutras
we see that on a gross level through observing the energy during
the conditions (visaya) where the breath is moving inward,
outward, or is steady (stamba) and not moving constitutes the
three gross previous stages of pranayama (all of which have
corresponding psycho-neurological energetics and biopsychic
qualities not delineated here. But in this sutra Patanjali is
saying that there exists a fourth (caturtah) stage where the
breath exists zero-point space (visaya-aksepi) regardless if it
is at the end of the exhalation before the inhalation begins, at
the end of the inhalation before the exhalation begins, or
somewhere in the middle. In fact Patanjali is saying that
visaya-aksepi occurs separately from the previous three methods
when the fourth and final dominion (visaya) of pranayama is
achieved. Thus not necessarily during inhalation, during
exhalation, at the end of the inhalation before the inhalation
is withdrawn, nor at the end of the exhalation before the
exhalation is withdrawn, but at some other time (caturtah) or
rather at anytime in-between through the awareness of the
energetic quality existing in these spaces -- at this fourth
moment, a profound reality -- the fourth or turiya is revealed.
Such can happen spontaneously in meditation and thus occurring
in the realm of natural and effortless (sahaj or kevala kumbhaka)
suspension or (visaya-aksepi) of breath, or rather more
importantly on the more subtle level the effortless suspension
of dualistic energetic motions (ida/pingala) without effort.
Here Patanjali is not talking about breath retention in the
ordinary sense, but rather visaya-aksepi as condition where the
energy (prana) is withdrawn from the energetic processes of
outward and inward tendencies and effortlessly by itself moves
into the integrative state in the central channel (which the
hatha yogis call sahaj kumbhaka). Here the energy no longer
flows dualistically in/out or up/down. Notice that Patanjali
does not mention the word retention here either, nor does he
indicate that this process of pranayama has anything to do with
active control or force (often associated with kumbhaka). Rather
it must be pointed out that the word, aksepi, means casting
aside or withdrawing from (withdrawing being actively passive).
It just happens by itself or as a result of cessation of effort
(aksepi). Here prana as energy (as well as the cit-prana) ceases
to spin inwardly (in the ida) as well as ceases to spin
extrinsically (in the pingala). Here the ida and pingala are the
two nadis or channels for intrinsic and extrinsic energy flows
in the energetic and psychic bodies. Here in the fourth stage,
Patanjali says the energy is withdrawn from normal dualistic
polar functions. It is attenuated, thinned, refined and made
extremely subtle. Rather this is taken to mean in Hatha,
Kundalini, and Tantric interpretations that the cit-prana is
withdrawn from duality into the non-dual channel (sushumna).
Esoterically when the kundalini is activated the yogi can move
into the fourth realm which is also designated as turiya. This
is the fourth (caturtah) practice of prana awareness (at first
brought to awareness through breath observation) where the
dualistic patterns of prana stop (as "in" and "out", but rather
through their balance and synchronization at zero point, then
the non-dual energy is experienced as it is now allowed to enter
the central nadi (sushumna) as kundalini. Patanjali points out
that we can observe and utilize four types of energetic
processes, i.e., the energetic process behind the inhalation,
the exhalation, the disruption of the inhalation or the
disruption of the exhalation, and fourthly the deepening
awareness at the energetic space which occurs at the beginning
of exhalation or inhalation processes where an effortless
natural suspension of the breath occurs which in turn leads us
to the siddhi of balancing and harmonizing the polar aspects of
prana (energy) leading it into the non-dual (sushumna). On the
gross level we can at first utilize breath techniques that
allows us to deepen our awareness of manifold activities of
prana. As we advance we see them simply as energy awareness
techniques. Only at their culmination do we see these techniques
as reflecting natural law. Hence the innate intuitive awareness
(prajna) is activated and no further practice is needed.
On a practical level we can simply state that at these
increasingly more subtle and effortless "zero points" of breath
the prana and apana running through the ida and pingala can be
observed to meet and thus it is here that they lend themselves
most easily to reveal themselves and facilitate their self
synchronization. Since breathing in
and out happens all the time, there is no need to "hold" the
breath, but rather we have to hold our attention (cit-prana) to
the process. We are educating the conscious mind and aligning it
with the energy body, while working with the cit-prana directly.
When we hold the attention, then the effortless and natural maha
kumbhaka, sahaj kumbhaka, kevala kumbhaka, or what the Buddhists
call the jnana kumbhaka (the effortless holding of the energy)
occurs naturally -- as the jnana prana is spontaneously
experienced as-it-is by the natural mind. Thus at this phase the
effort in pranayama practice is eventually totally relaxed as
the maha kumbhaka breathes us. One practice in hatha, kundalini,
and kriya yoga the sadhak listens to the mantra (deep energetic
messages) of the breath. Frequently hatha yoga uses the hamsa
and soham ajapa mantras to help effect this profound awareness.
In more elaborate schools of hatha yoga the internal stoppage of
the breath after inhalation (puraka) called antar kumbhaka or
puraka kumbhaka, and the energetic quality behind holding the
breath out after exhalation (rechaka) called bahir kumbhaka or
rechaka kumbhaka are also explored revealing further subtleties
until the maha kumbhaka is achieved which is a stillness of the
prana and apana (dualistic flows) and the arising of the
kundalini which has now been directed to the door of the central
nadi (sushumna) whose gates have welcomed it and drawn it home!.
We have to realize that pranayama is an ever increasingly subtle
process where on no longer is dealing with the breath, but
rather the breath reveals the energy. Then one's awareness
shifts to the prana dealing with that directly. Here prana no
longer runs in the dualistic circuitry of ida/pingala, but
rather no longer flows at all. Rather these two pranic currents
combine as one, activating the flow of kundalini in the sushumna
nadi (also called the madhya-nadi).When the prana ceases to flow
through ida and pingala, it is because the energy has become
synergistically synchronized into kundalini which flows in the
central column (sushumna) destroying the covering of ordinary
dualistic thought and awakening the sadhak into an ever-new
awareness beginningless time. "The mind functions through prana,
It is from prana that everything proceeds". CHANDOGYA UPANISHAD
No thing nor the mind can move without energy, force, or
direction. Never force pranayama but use it to investigate the
nadis and the awareness of prana as it flows in the nadis.
Through that intimate knowledge, self knowledge will dawn,
knowledge of the Source of prana is known , and from all that
liberation follows. Thus when the prana is perfectly balanced,
so is the mind. Here the vrtti are balanced out and remediated.
This perfectly balanced mind (in perfect sattva) is coaxed into
manifesting into its highest evolutionary potential (as
kundalini) where then it spontaneously co-arises. Once brought
to the gate through the maha kumbhaka, then the energy flows
effortlessly as an expression of jnana prana beyond karma and
death.
Here much regarding pranayama that has been left unexplained. It
is presented here without elaborations on the swaras, sahaj
kumbhaka, kevala kumbhaka, the jnana prana, and other such
esoteric terms which are part of the oral tradition. Pranayama
as a hatha, kriya, or tantric yoga practice is very powerful and
should be learned from an adept, however if practiced as an
awareness exercise as described above no harm will entail. II
52. tatah ksiyate prakasa-avaranam From that (tatah) [successful
practice of pranayama] the obscuration which is the veil (avaranam)
of the inner light (prakasa) is dissolved (ksiyate). Commentary:
Eventually liberation is gained through conscious awareness or
grace. HERE the yogi communes with the infinite Source of prana,
and thus, simultaneously, the heretofore suppressed inner light
which has been covered (avarana) by the veil of ignorance is
released into spontaneous self effulgence. Here the cit-prana is
no longer dissipated and extracted outward, but rather the
practitioner is firmly wedded to the path -- the pathways are
opened and energized. As a result of pranayama practice, the
heretofore obscured or latent potential of inner light is
disclosed as the embodiment of the kundalini. Through the
activation of our innate creative evolutionary power (kundalini)
the dormant circuitry including the chakras (wheels of light)
are activated. From here, the innate power and intelligence of
the life force (prana) as it flows throughout our embodiment is
acknowledged, starts to take over, and instruct. II 53.
dharanasu ca yogyata manasah and (ca) the ordinary mind (manas)
[and nadis] thus become purified and functionally prepared (yogyata)
for successful concentration (dharana) practice. Commentary: As
the mind rides the waves of prana, so too does prana become
altered by our thoughts. When the awareness and the energy is
united as one coherent agency -- when we are conscious that
where we place our awareness, we also place our energy, then we
then are able to focus our energy in special ways to effect
specific purposes (utilizing dharana, cit-prana, and prana vidya).
Here Patanjali is really linking pranayama, pratyhara, and
dharana as one practice, but we will explain that later. In one
sense pranayama itself is a dharana (concentration) practice,
here focused on the universal prana. In turn through dharana
(the yogic practices that utilize concentration of the mind,
visualization, and focusing techniques), the mind becomes
stabilized and prepared for dhyana (meditation). After one is
able to feel, recognize, and work with the cit-prana consciously,
then the mental energy and attention can no longer wander far
and be dissipated. Through this attainment one is empowered to
balance one's prana and thus easily focus one's energy and mind
successfully. Pranayama will purify and open the psychic
channels (nadis) for prana to flow through the dormant
circuitries or chakras (wheels of light), thus the dharanas
utilizing the chakras can be performed and/or the mind can be
focused toward meditation much more successfully. In hatha,
kundalini, tantra, and laya yoga this refers to the practices of
mudras, dharanas, mantras, visualization, yantra, or prana vidya.
In fact asana, bandha, pranayama, visualizations (dharana) form
the basis of the advanced hatha yoga mudra practice.
Contemplation is also included as a specialized type of dharana
because the mind concentrates on a specific mental theme -- an
object of contemplation. In fact asana, bandha, and pranayama
are a form of dharana (concentration), when it is based on
focusing upon the source of prana-shakti. Successful pranayama
and dharana also includes pratyhara (as is defined in the next
sutra). A mature practitioner knows that pranayama, pratyhara,
and dharana mutually combine as one practice. Eventually Prana
Shakti becomes the self instructing guide throughout All Our
Relations -- acting as the breath that breathes us. II 54.
sva-visaya-asamprayogae cittasya-svarupa-anukara ivendriyanam
pratyharah Through pratyhara the matrix of apparent separateness
between the object that is viewed, the viewer, and the process
of viewing is laid aside and disengaged from (asamprayoge), thus
allowing the heretofore static and dissipated energy to gather,
ascend, and flow internally producing complete liberation from
sensory false identification (anukara) with appearances or
misperception and thus allowing ascension into the creatix of
the heart -- our true nature.
Commentary: Pratyhara (the fifth limb of astanga yoga and the
next one after pranayama) is most often mistranslated as the
control of the senses or its withdrawal, thus often being
associated with repression. aversion, or catatonia. However what
is really going on is that in man's common corruptive overly
externalized state of avidya, his mind has become overly
objectified (lost in the objects of the sense world). Thus the
cit-prana has been drawn out and devitalized. In pratyhara we
reclaim that distracted and dissipated cit-prana and pull it
back into our core (heart) center. Thus mastery of pratyhara is
also at the same time freedom from coarse (vitarka) pratyaya
(the process of the dualistic mind toward fixation upon objects).
It is thus the natural mastery of the cit-prana where the
cit-prana is no longer distracted and dissipated into the gross
external world of the five senses -- into the illusory world of
I-It abstraction and over objectification. Here pratyhara means
turning back of the distracted cit-prana toward its Source. The
senses (indriyanam) thus cease their dualistic fixation with
separate objects (visaya-asamprayoge), then the mind's (cittasya)
true self nature (swarupa) is reflected back upon itself (redirected)
like a mirror (anukara) -- thus having the potential to reveal
the true natural self as swarupa. Even deeper, pratyhara is the
practice of withdrawing the mind's attention and energy (cit-prana)
from distraction and dissolution (through the nine gates of the
body). It is a means of redirecting the externally flowing
cit-prana to activate the core energy and eventually one's
dormant evolutionary energy, the kundalini. Thus pratyhara is an
essential element which links pranayama and dharana in the
practice of the advanced mudras, yantras, mandalas, and dharanas
of prana vidya which is the normal domain of hatha, kundalini,
tantra, and laya yoga. Basic pratyhara stabilizes the cit-prana
thus enabling one for successful dharana and meditation.
Accomplishing pratyhara as a technique also completes the
practice of vairagya (non-attachment), viveka, and tapas
remediating any residual "I-it" dualistic thinking (samyogah).
Raga can not exist within the energetic modality of successful
pratyhara implementation. Pratyahara also completes tapas, but
does not replace it. Normal consciousness is fragmented in the
dualistic world of I-It separateness, i.e., there appears to be
separate objects (sense objects) and a separate "i" (small self)
who is perceiving them. Pratyhara takes our attention and energy
away from this type of corruption and dissolution -- away from
the dualistic fragmentation -- and brings it back within --
reuniting with Self. Here in All Our Relations energy and
attention are harnessed for dharana (concentration) and (dhyana)
meditation. II 55. tatah parama vasyatendriyanam Then (tatah)
the need to surpass the senses (vasyatendriyanam) is completely
over come (parama) (or surpassed itself).
Commentary: Here there is no fear, aversion, tension, or
conflict between the sense world and the spiritual world as this
dualistic tug has been remediated. When pratyhara is successful,
the cit-prana is available to focus the mind at will, and thus
one experiences a huge jump start in meditation. Daily life also
becomes less dissipating and distracting. The dualistic tendency
itself is dissolved. Pratyhara is the energetic awareness (the
process of drawing in and up of the energy of consciousness and
beingness that is evoked in revealed in pranayama) in which we
no longer observe the sense objects in the world as individually
arising or existing separately, but rather experience that they
exist inside the purified heart (being accessible within) -- as
are all created things interconnected, non-dual, and inseparable.
By bringing our attention as cit-prana sufficiently inside we
find THAT deeper core space which is outside as well -- which is
all and everywhere. As such pratyhara is just the tip of the
iceberg.
When in pratyhara the vital energy and energetic Source of
consciousness are no longer dissipated or drawn outside into a
fragmentary isolated dualistic relationship, but rather they
have become concentrated, refined and made available for the
higher practices of one pointed concentration and true devotion.
Pratyhara is the dynamic motion of reunification and self
empowerment which takes the extrinsic spinning of the cit-prana
and turns it back inside where cit-shakti and prana shakti
unite. This is also the evolutionary creative energy (kundalini-shakti)
is activated in the the realm of non-duality-- where the inner
and outer energies are balanced, harmonized, and unified. It
harnesses and helps activate the fire that feeds successful
dharana (concentration) and meditation (dhyana) which leads us
to success in samadhi. Some say that pratyhara is simply a
refined aspect of pranayama. As such it is said that pratyhara
is fructified by dharana, dhyana, and samadhi, which is the
major focus of Pada III. End of Chapter II -- The Sadhana Pada
of Patanjali ends completing discussion of the fifth limb (pratyhara)
of astanga yoga, while Pada III begins with the sixth limb,
concentration or dharana, followed by dhyana (the seventh limb),
and then samadhi (the eighth). Chapter III. Vibhuti Pada: The
Proficiencies or Adeptness (through the Process of Samyama)
Vibhuti chapter places much emphasis on the combined effort of
the sixth (dharana), seventh (dhyana), and eighth (samadhi)
limbs of ashtanga yoga which applied all at once is called the
three fold process of samyama which in turn leads to various
perfections, abilities, masteries, and of supra-personal states
of awareness variously called siddhis. In Vibhuti Pada also the
application of the three major parinama (transformations) are
described as well are many other practices and states of
realization.
Patanjali's Third Chapter: Vibhuti Pada -- On Adeptness,
Completion, Fruition, Ability, Perfection, Boons, and "Mystic
Powers" that a Functional and Proficient Sadhana Creates The
Transition Between Pada II and Pada III: Introduction The Yoga
Sutras are presented as a mutually synergistic system. Chapter
One (Samadhi Pada) provides context and an overview. Chapter Two
(Sadhana Pada) gives the practices (sadhana). Toward the end of
Sadhana Pada, the first five limbs of ashtanga (eight limbed)
yoga were introduced. Then it begins to elaborate upon each limb
one at a time (to an extent), but the Pada II ends with
pratyhara (the fifth limb). Vibhuti Pada (chapter 3) begins with
dharana (concentration) which is the sixth limb. Thus dharana,
dhyana (the seventh limb), and samadhi (the eighth limb) taken
together compose samyama (which is the dominant theme of Vibhuti
Pada) and as such chapter three acts as a continuation of
chapter two. Many historians postulate that the four padas (chapters)
of the Yoga Sutras were first written down as one document, and
then posthumously divided into four separate partitions (padas).
What is clear however is that the presentation becomes
increasingly more subtle and inner as one proceeds. It is
noteworthy that the word, vibhuti, does not appear once in Pada
III (except the title given to it). Vibhuti can mean the
extinction of the gross elements (bhuti) into their most subtle
refinement or essence which is often symbolized by sacred ash
that often mysteriously appears in the presence of a siddha (accomplished
one). Some say that the appearance of vibhuti is itself a result
of siddhi (perfection). Vibhutir is often translated as the
personification/manifestation of powers, their fruition, and/or
opulence; while bhutida is the giver of powers and opulence.
Bhuti-vistara is the expander of powers and opulence. Note that
Chapter 10 of the Bhagavad Gita is titled, "Vibhuti Yoga"
The central theme of the Yoga Sutras in general is how to
realize samadhi -- which no matter how many words scholars use
to define or distort it, ultimately one will have to agree with
Patanjali that words serve to obscure samadhi -- eventually they
have to be given up. It is difficult to use words to defeat
words, but Patanjali does this very well. Patanjali says that
samadhi appears when we are able to let loose of our mental
machinations, samskara, klesha, karma, vasana, and other
habitual impositions of conditioning and conditioned belief
systems which support the vrtti. This is realized in meditation
(or better the meditation of no meditation where we are doing
nothing at all) and involves the dawning of an extraordinary
transpersonal (more rarefied than the most subtle) consciousness
which can not be brought about without the complete stilling (nirodha)
of the ordinary mind which is constantly being modified, colored,
and disturbed (yogash citta-vrtti-nirodah). The profound and
sacred trans-rational and all encompassing truth of
Reality-As-It-Is is self disclosing. This non-dual "IT" which is
not a separate "it", is inherent and indigenous beneath the
vrtti, which when dissolved (nirodha) shines forth on its own.
It's also seductive (like taking the cart before the horse) to
think that it is necessary or important to practice yoga in
order to understand the Yoga Sutras. Granted the Yoga Sutras can
not be understood without some insight (of which yoga practice
provides), but more important we study the book (the Yoga Sutras)
in order to practice yoga successfully so that we can realize
the fruit and completion of yoga/union called samadhi. This may
seem like a small point to some, but actually the state of
spiritual alienation can reinforce the illusion of this
dichotomy. Too many people are already attempting to find "god"
in ancient books or whose spiritual practice has become reduced
to studying and thinking about these books. In other words for a
real yogi the truth or spiritual realization is not found in
some ancient scripture written down in a holy book, but rather
the truth is living -- it is to be realized inside -- in ALL OUR
RELATIONS -- in this very life. Thus it is emphasized that the
Yoga Sutras simply are a guidebook to yoga/samadhi complied by
Patanjali from the ancient oral traditions that preceded his
days. Although samadhi is not conditioned (by definition), the
guidebook itself necessarily must address the language,
symbolism, and prejudice of its time. It addresses the spiritual
malaise and fragmented conditioned milieu of that time/place
attempting to communicate a timeless and universal underlying
Presence. It is to Patanjali's credit that he does not buy into
those prejudices and tradition (pramana) which are themselves
vrttis (disturbances creating obstacles), but rather he
addresses these obstacles and remediates them. Those predisposed
to intellectual reductionist thought, tradition, and philosophy
mistakenly thought that Patanjali advocated such. All because
Patanjali addressed the ignorance of his day does not mean that
he bought into it. Because he used samkhya philosophical
terminology (the philosophical terminology of the day) it does
not mean that he was a samkhya adherent, rather it is clear that
Patanjali was a yogi, not a philosopher.
But intellectuals and academicians in India and elsewhere will
not let go of their mistaken idea that Patanjali's system
belongs under the aegis of philosophy and is subject to
intellectual scrutiny. This self gratuitous institutionalized
tenacity by an entrenched academia is self serving in so far
that by so misrepresenting Patanjali, they attempt to own him
and also yoga, thus self appointing themselves as the authority
in a realm which otherwise they would be outcastes. Thus the
prevalent institutionalized misinterpretation of the Yoga Sutras
is explained, which in turn explains the prevalent morass of
unreadable translations and its resultant inaccessibility to
readers other than scholars. A simple straightforward reading of
Patanjali will prove that he wrote down the oral teachings of
Yoga for yoga practitioners in order to aid their practice,
rather than for philosophers to debate. Patanjali starts off
from the cultural time/place prejudice, bias, and milieu of his
day and from there leads the reader into the increasingly more
subtle -- into the "real" -- the universal and timeless -- which
can only be understood through inner experience either from
authentic spiritual practice (sadhana) or grace. The Sutras have
value then only as a written aid to our practice just as oral
instructions were intended. Although yoga can be interpreted or
described through samkhya philosophical terms (just like the Old
Testament can be paraphrased in English or Greek, or just like
quantum physics can address Newtonian ideas, the yoga of
Patanjali as he describes it aims at going far beyond symbolic
representation, philosophy, concepts, words, or other manmade
anthropocentric limitations. So here Vibhuti Pada begins with
the profound non-dual context of samadhi. It completes the eight
limbs of ashtanga yoga, by elaborating on the last three limbs (dharana,
dhyana, and samadhi) and puts them together in what is called
the three fold practice of samyama. Then it details how the
various applications of samyama can lead to the siddhis (accomplishments,
abilities, masteries, and powers but they are not to be seen as
attainments because who is it that attains it), and then the
latter part of Pada 3 elevates the discussion to the ultimate
spiritual accomplishment. The Siddhis: The Boons, Proficiencies,
Abilities, Talents, Powers, Perfections, and Adeptness This
chapter is often a stumbling block for many students mostly
because of the poor translations, but also because here in
Vibhuti, Patanjali tells us about the pitfalls of the siddhis (powers
and abilities) that are presented to a yoga practitioner (sadhak).
(See verses III. 37 III. 50, 51, and 52.) Much of the confusion
stems from the lack of a coherent context of the word, siddhi.
Here we are not talking about black magic, witchcraft, or
sorcery in the Western dualistic sense. That's not the kind of
power that Patanjali addresses.
It should be clear that by the word, siddhi, Patanjali does not
mean power or control over others, comparative advantage, power
as in the sense of black magic, or power in the separate sense
of ego. As our practice matures so does our awareness and
connection points -- previously dormant energy circuits become
activated and hence evolutionary abilities that were previously
repressed manifest. In yoga, power or ability is not bad, nor
should it be feared, yet it is not something to strive for by
itself. Most these siddhis come naturally by themselves. Even
GOOD powers (like maybe you might see in White Magic such as in
the Lord of the Ring Trilogy for example) can be dissipative and
distracting. In pada three, Patanjali addresses the natural
latent innate powers within and how to evoke them for liberation.
Of course without non-dual transpersonal wisdom, one can do much
harm, so this invocation of the powers must go hand in hand with
the development of the latent innate wisdom in order to realize
true happiness and fulfillment. In other words, through a wise
balanced practice (sadhana) we gradually realize the requisite
wisdom, ability, and passion to succeed while heightened powers
abilities, freedoms, and latent talents become progressively
activated. Wisdom and wise practice leads to more wisdom and
more effective practice, and so forth. Obstructions are removed
and liberation eventually realized. So "siddhi" in the non-dual
transpersonal context of yoga is simply intermediate fruits of
yoga practice; i.e., various levels of perfections and adeptness
naturally come forth, evolve, and manifest as a result of our
sustained practice. We become more proficient and more able as
our horizon upon self deepens and expands -- as we become more
aware and conscious. Here we do not focus on attaining the
powers as a goal; but rather in a balanced sadhana the seductive
dangers of power misinterpreted by the dualistic ego are
overcome by the antidotal activation of the non-dual
transpersonal wisdom -- latent healing energy and compassion.
Although Patanjali warns us about the dangers of pursuing or
becoming seduced by the siddhis, he does not say that they are
bad or evil in and by themselves. As a matter of fact throughout
the Yoga Sutras Patanjali never uses the dualistic terminology
of good or bad (to his credit), but he does address distraction,
dissuasion, dissipation, and fragmentation. To avoid the
seduction of the siddhis we need to focus on and be dedicated to
liberation itself, which discloses itself within the context of
a transpersonal integrated context. This intent and bhava (mood)
of our sadhana provides the directed vector and requisite focus
in order to create success, thus avoiding the siddhis feeding
the diversionary side trip of fragmentary existence (the
illusory belief in ego or separate self).
This potential seduction of the siddhis is reinforced when this
integral context of "ALL OUR RELATIONS" is diminished or
forgotten. In that fragmented state, if we did (prematurely)
succeed in obtaining some siddhis, it would feed our sense of
separateness (asmita) or self pride (one of the kleshas) and
thus hold our spiritual progress back (it would take us away
from the whole). We will get into this more in
detail later when we study verses III 37, 50, and 51, but
suffice it to say, some siddhis will come by themselves, but how
we deal with them (as a benefit or an impediment) will depend on
the strength, intent, and sincerity of our practice and
preparation. All power (Shakti) comes from an Intelligent Source
(source of All Intelligence) -- from "THAT" which can not be
adequately named and which is ALWAYS present (doesn't change).
When "connected" (in yoga) - in grace -- in alignment we become
those arms and legs -- fingers and toes -- eyes and voice. In
that sense there are no individual siddhis that are capable of
being possessed, but if one "thinks" that an "I" (as a separate
self) have accomplished this, that this comes from "me" alone,
that "I" own this, then they disown the great "Self" and
eventually (unless grace comes back to them) continue to
fragment in dissolution (fall from grace). Thus in this way
there is no problem or fear in manifesting the powers as long as
we know where it is coming from -- as long our intent is clear,
i.e., what we are doing in context with ALL OUR RELATIONS -- all
of creator/creation (siva/shakti). Playing with fire is only
dangerous to some one who does not understand its nature and the
potential consequences. Thus it is grace that great power is not
given readily to those who may use it for destruction or
destruction of self. Power exercised without knowledge is thus
better not possessed at all (saving one from this burden). Now
many people understandably feel disempowered/powerless and
disconnected from their creative/evolutionary core dynamics.
This is the everyday lot of the neurotic consumer mentality; and
as such it is "normal" (but not natural) for these people to
thirst for power. Fearful and confused they seek security, order,
control, and power outside of themselves, but what they really
need is "connection/yoga" inside --to live in harmony with the
natural self existent order -- their true nature. THAT larger
whole is empowering and fulfilling. This "self" acceptance of
our own inner natural power may be a large leap for a lot of
people who have been brought up dysfunctionally (to fear and
disown their power). Thus authentic yoga should empower (bring
us into self empowerment), not further lead one to dependence
upon external authority, priesthood, or scripture. "Good or evil"
is a difficult trap for Westerners to let go of (which is mostly
cross cultural in nature and rooted in the dualistic mind), but
it is true that many abilities can be very helpful as long as
they do not feed the ego.
Now if we state preferences, we an get into the trap of "desire"
and attachment; while in yoga practices we learn (sooner or
later) to focus our passion/love away from the subtle
attachments/desires which impose bias upon reality-as-it-is such
as preference, while placing more energy toward divine
acceptance -- toward liberation. This is what Patanjali is
saying -- Liberation requires one pointed passion and dedication
-- when your whole being gets into this direction -- there you
go -- no problem. When we have inner conflict our energy (and
success) is thwarted. Progress in yoga is stagnant. Ultimately
we wake up to the simple and yet profound truth that let us see
how we create our own dramas, problems, and have been stepping
on our own toes. Then we surrender that on the altar of divine
love. Simply sitting in meditation, the prejudicial mind becomes
purified by itself -- preferential thinking modalities gradually
are gladly abandoned/surrendered. Patanjali says in Samadhi Pada
(chapter I) verse 3: "tada drashtuh sva-rupe'vasthanam" After
the vagaries and disturbances (vrttis) of consciousness (cit)
cease (nirodha), then Yoga is accomplished. Then we abide into
our natural (swarupa) unconditioned state (verse IV). When the
vrtti cease the mind-field is silent and liberated, allowing
space for a greater wisdom to dawn. In tantric terminology here
the kundalini citta is activated. Yoga thus is the liberation of
the individual mind from its habitual illusory prison and
conditioned fragmented imprints of the discontinuous experiences
frame in duality and separateness; so it can fly again and dwell
in its rightful spotless natural abode (swarupa). The practice
of yoga evolved as the process of clearing out the pathways (the
psychic channels called nadis) within the body/mind and pranic
sheaths, the false beliefs of the vijnanamaya kosha, the
afflictive emotions based on negative beliefs (kleshas), the
samskaras (past cellular imprints and negative conditioning),
and negative karma through the purifying and vivifying agency of
the cit-prana or cit-shakti, thus allowing a gradual opening up
to and a communion with the source of consciousness and life --
of unconditioned citta or principle of primal consciousness to
evolve and manifest. In the broader context of yoga (which is
ALL OUR RELATIONS) a three fold "potential" burden of the
siddhis can thus be discerned and avoided (all of which are not
necessary for the successful practice of yoga). 1) As above, we
can become preoccupied in pursuing them, and thus ignore/miss
where they really come from -- being distracted we remain
imprisoned in the veil of suffering. 2) As above, we can misuse
the powers and cause ourselves (and/or others) harm if we are
not ready with most likely leading to further negative
consequences. In Indian and Tibetan literature, there exists
many stories of the misuse of power and the generation of
negative consequences (bad karma)
3) A third negative consequence is that our intention may be
relatively pure at first (or at least sattva may dominate) but
after realizing a siddhi or two (minor or major) this may
reinforce one's pride saying "I did this or that -- I am better
than others", and so forth which will reinforce the negative
tendency toward fragmentation (versus
union/yoga), and thus such has the potential to act as a severe
impediment toward final liberation (Kaivalya). Patanjali says:
III 37 "te samadhav upasarga vyuthane siddhayah" which is
translated by Swami Venkatesananda, in Enlightened Living "But,
even such excellent sensations and feelings and all the psychic
powers discussed so far, which on the surface appear to be
desirable and encouraging aspects of perfection are in fact
impediments to enlightenment as they, too, distract and
externalize the attention." Overview of the Rest of Vibhuti Pada
One could also say that the student of the Yoga Sutras could
skip the entire Vibhuti Pada entirely as it on the surface may
appear that it simply caters to those who thirst for siddhis,
but careful analysis will prove its value. For example the
beginning and the end of Pada III) can be considered both
quintessential and profound and do not deal with mundane siddhis
at all. Even in the middle part which undergoes the most
misunderstanding (as long as the yogi does not get distracted)
these abilities can help us on the path just as any of the other
sadhanas are limbs of the great of tree of yoga. So Pada III
starts where Pada 2 leaves off, thus completing the first five
limbs (angas) of ashtanga yoga with a terse exposition of
dharana (concentration), dhyana (meditation) and samadhi. These
taken together as a simultaneous practice is defined as samyama
(which is also the major underlying topic of chapter 3). In
other words samyama can be applied to specific objects (physical
and mental) as well as processes. Samyama is not only how
various powers can be accomplished (which Patanjali warns may
wind up as an impediment and distraction if we mistakenly take
them as an end in themselves), but samyama is to be used for
liberation. Samyama lets us commune with a chosen object or
process of communion as-it-is without a filter. It lets
intimately know that process or object in an objectless
(non-separate way). Again in other words the siddhis do not have
to be a trap, but only that it is counterproductive to be
seduced into wasting time/energy to attempt to possess them
willfully as individual possessions in the ego sense. Besides
the valuable technique of samyama, the delineation of the three
kinds of parinama (movement or change) i.e., nirodha, samadhi,
and ekgrata is usefully presented in III 9-12..
Parinama (transformation) especially may be a difficult term
because for some change (parinama) is judged "good" and to
others it is judged "bad" or feared. To clarify it may be
helpful to distinguish between parinama as a transformative
process from that of the fluctuations (vrtti) of the citta. Yes,
yoga aims at eliminating (nirodha) the agitations and
disturbances (vrtti) of the citta, but change or transformation
(parinama) from a constricted and obscured state of
consciousness to an expanded state of clarity is desirable in
yoga. First a definition of Parinama as: transmutation, mutation,
transformation, oscillation, movement, changes of state. So yes,
in regards to the mind, in meditation, or in samadhi such
fluctuations are a disturbance, so in practice these
disturbances are stilled. But for the average practitioner,
their pre-existing mind sets are stuck and frozen -- their karma
is a heavy burden that is smothering them. These practitioners
need to utilize transformative practices. Ultimately in the
absolute sense there is stillness (or Siva), but in the relative
sense all things are interdependent, moving, and dynamic (or
Shakti) -- the only constant is change and morph-ability. One
may distinguish between favorable and unfavorable changes, but
the process of judgment itself gets in the way and is not
necessary, because it creates fear of change (change being "bad"
or undesirable). From our point of view movement and change by
itself may or may not be "undesirable", but it is dependent upon
"what" it is that is moving and/or rather more so in what
direction it is moving, that may be either deemed helpful or
destructive to our yoga practice. Indeed to become frozen in
fear, grief, trauma, the past, or immobility is not helpful, but
rather to mobilize the prior rigidity of the body or the mind
will, if skillfully done, lead to liberation. To be able to
become aware of these changes and to be able to effect (siddhi)
and liberation (kaivalyam) is desired in yoga. The
practitioner's point of view thus becomes key when it comes to
understanding parinama. Thus in III-9-12 one may easily
interpret that Patanjali describes parinama as a transformative
technique to apply in meditation to still the wandering mind (nirodha
parinama), then samadhi parinama, and lastly ekgrata parinama.
Notice that the direction is one of refinement coming from the
coarse and discordant into the subtlest and unitive. This
direction of transformative energies accomplishes yoga (unification/integration).
Thus it is noted here that even a practice that leads eventually
toward stillness is itself transformative until the final
conclusion is integrated.
From Sutra 13-16, Patanjali changes direction assuming a
different viewpoint (which is no individual viewpoint at all,
but rather a universal, transpersonal, non-dual, changeless,
eternal, and all encompassing). From this unitive viewpoint of
ALL OUR RELATIONS that is realized via samadhi and ekgrata
parinama, then "isolated" changes of state can not independently
exist as such, but rather all flows as a unified and liquid
whole; i.e., no single thing changes. Thence from the point of
view of Sanatana Dharma or eternal law, nothing changes, but
rather what appears as potential energy, manifest energy as
matter, decay or even undefined and unclassifiable -- all
reflect a unifying interdependent causality. This is the dance
of Shiva/Shakti. A trans-rational one taste permeates the soup
in that nothing changes, but at the same time everything is in
flux. This might appear mystical to the probings of the
intellect, but is familiar fare to the meditator. This is why
Patanjali says in IV. 7, that the actions of yogis are
inscrutable by the intellect -- the causes of their actions lie
outside of linear time and space -- outside of duality. Many
traditional translators confuse the word, parinama (transformation
or change) with that of vrtti (perturbation, vagary, agitation,
turmoil, disturbance, modification). Let us focus on vrtti more
succinctly. It should be clear that vrtti refers to the
variegated "patterns" of the various modified states of
consciousness. The vrttis thus obstruct and color our perfected
unbiased universal view of Reality as-it-is. But vrtti is not to
be confused with change itself. Parinama is different, as it
simply connotes the process of change or transformation itself,
not the patterning upon the citta. Similarly, samskaras are the
imbedded patterns of past experiences which activate latent
tendencies or syndromes (called vasana). Samskaras are imbedded
in the body/mind , cellular memory, psycho neuro-physiology,
neuromuscular system, and energy body or as John Lilly says
inside the programming of the "human bio-computer". As long as
they are not deprogrammed they will create vrttis and other
unfavorable changes of consciousness. Most effective yoga
techniques aim at destroying and uprooting the samskaras
(negative past conditioning) -- and as such yoga is designed to
reprogram these patterns -- remediate conditioned consciousness
back into its unconditioned natural state. Thus sutras 1-15 of
pada III (especially III -12) may be helpful in understanding
the valuable practice of samyama (three part communion). The
action of parinama (applied transformation) which may be defined
as parts of our sadhana (part of our spiritual practice) is
discussed in III 9-12 as the application of the three main
process of nirodha parinama, ekgrata parinama, and samadhi
parinama), while III-13-16 discusses parinama from the non-dual
viewpoint of interconnectedness where the absolute and relative
perspectives are unified and not disparate. III 16-48 (the
middle part of Pada III) is often characterized as a sketchy
list of abilities/powers (siddhas) with their associated means
of attainment (usually through samyama), however this
translation will treat these as practical yoga sadhana.
Toward the end, Pada III becomes very lofty delineating such
practices as a spiritual means for complete liberation (from
sutra 49 onward); while the ending of chapter 3 leads us to the
grandeur of kaivalyam (absolute liberation) as discussed in
chapter four. So, yes, Vibhuti Pada (Chapter III) although
generally judged to be the least important and least useful of
the four chapters (it could be skipped entirely without
lessening the purport of the sutras); it is strongly suggested
that the profundity of samyama and parinama alone may well make
the chapter well worth studying. The reader is always encouraged
to do a deeper reading than what the most common translations
offer. One finds that after abhyasa (consistent practice) that
various insights and abilities come by themselves. Vibhuti Pada
attempts to explain these as well. Thus refreshingly, this
translation will not be based on the so called authoritative
academic tradition, but rather on meditative experience and
contemplation. From Swami Venkatesananda ("Enlightened Living"):
III -54 "Such wisdom born of intuitive understanding is the sole
redeemer. It is everything. It has everything. It encompasses
everything. It is the unconditioned and undivided intelligence
spontaneously functioning from moment to moment in the eternal
now, without sequential relationship." III -55 "When thus there
is pure equilibrium which is non-division between the indwelling
consciousness and all objective existence, between the nonmoving
intelligence and the ever moving phenomena, between the
unconditioned awareness and the rise and fall of 'The thousand
thoughts' -- there is freedom and independence of the infinite (kaivalyam)".
After putting Vibhuti Pada (this chapter on the abilities/siddhis)
aside, we can enter the last chapter, (Pada IV) Kaivalyam (Absolute
Liberation), which is by far the shortest, but also the most
lofty. III. 1 desa bandhas cittasya dharana Concentration (dharana)
consists of directing the consciousness (cittasya) with
attention within a chosen field, place, or point of focus (desa),
without distraction of the energy (bandha), but rather by
allowing the psychic energy (cit-prana) to flow into and
activate the nadis (psychic energy channels). Commentary:
Dharana is unifying, focusing, collecting, and binding together
(bandha) the consciousness principle that exist in the mind (cittasya)
and then focusing it (bandha) upon an object (desa). The place (desa)
can be internal (antar) or external (bahya) or it can be very
subtle (suksma) or secret (gupta).
Since the mind is directed by energy and energy is directed by
mind, one follows the other. We call that cit-prana or
citta-shakti. This concentration of and focusing the cit-prana
upon an external or internal object not only focuses the mind,
but also the energy. This focusing calms the mind and makes it
fit for dhyana (meditation). Physical focusing (dharana) with
the eyes is often called dristhi or tratak of which the most
subtle is on the internal light. Dharana may also be utilized
upon listening to the eternal sound (as in sabda or nada yoga),
visualizing mystic diagrams (yantras), or other such
combinations of concentrative practices such as utilizing
mantras, visualizations, breath, etc (sometimes called laya yoga
and/or prana vidya). Later in this chapter, Patanjali does
discuss some of these laya yoga practices in samyama (discussed
further on in this chapter) , however here he is discussing
dharana to steady, calm, and focus the mental distractions of
the ordinary mind as a precursor to dhyana (meditation). Since
concentration requires an object to focus upon and thus in the
Western sense it can be called, "focusing". This direction
allows one to get in direct contact with two fundamental
dynamics that are to be intimately linked; i.e., consciousness (cit)
and energy (prana) ort what is called the cit-prana. This
depends on the mental principle that says that wherever our
consciousness flows, so does our energy follow. Wherever our
energy is directed, so does the physical also follow. As we will
show later, this principle is put to work throughout chapter
three and especially in healing work, asana, pranayama, and
pratyhara practices. In hatha yoga, directing the cit-prana in
the body is accomplished through the energy valves (bandhas) and
the mudras (which combine dristhi, asana, pranayama, bandha, and
visualization all together. In hatha yoga pranayama, pratyhara,
and dharana (as visualization) are utilized to direct the energy
and consciousness (cit-prana) in the advanced practices which
are called prana vidya or the dharanas. laya, tantra, hatha, and
kundalini yoga take this sort of concentration internally often
utilizing the internal energy circuits, nadis, chakras, yantras,
and/or mandalas eventually creating a sympathetic resonance with
the inter-dimensional realms or lokas. In functional hatha yoga
practice, even asana practice is more than physical exercise,
but rather as a method of focusing on the life force (prana) and
awareness (cit-prana) eventually allowing us to access the
workings of karma within the body/mind. Pranayama of course is
also a way of focusing (dharana) on the breath and life energy
combing again the principles of cit-prana. At first most
practitioners are given elementary practices such as tratak or
dristhi which first teaches us how to focus upon physical
objects utilizing the eyes. Objects can be as simple as a candle,
a color, symbol, or picture, or as complex as the Sri Yantra.
This stabilizers the cit-prana and in the case of symbols and
yantras directs the cit-prana. Practitioners may also be given
sounds to listen to (such as the pranava (om), or mantras to
repeat (japa) such as hamsa, soham, etc.). Later as one
progresses in getting in touch with the more subtle (vicara)
inner lights and chakras, one learns to effect profound change
in the body/mind organism. Much of chapter three utilizes the
powerful practice of samyama of which dharana is an essential
ingredient.
So if we focus on a philosophical concept, esthetic, or
spiritual principle that object of thought can also be called
dharana. Here then, it is obvious that this kind of
concentration can also be called contemplation. Many people
confuse contemplative techniques as being meditation (dhyana),
but contemplation on a specific theme, an object of thought, a
specific idea, principle, intent, or concept is more correctly
the practice of concentration (dharana) because it focuses on
that mental/spiritual object. Where dharana is the process of
gathering up and objectifying upon an object within the
framework of object relations. meditation (dhyana) on the other
hand is the process that allows us to drop all such object
relationships entirely -- all sense of I/it duality, all limited
self identifications including attachment to themes, concepts,
ideas, or thought itself. It is simply an semantic trap (of
inexact definitions) where one school may define the English
word, "meditation", as concentration practice (such as a chakra
meditation, a meditation on some specific subject, etc.), while
defining "contemplation" how Patanjali defines dhyana. So I hope
that this short discussion will avoid those semantic confusions
translating dharana as concentration and contemplation with
objects) while translating dhyana as meditation (without
Biodetoxification or referents). In raj yoga, dharana as
concentration is learned in the beginning in order to stabilize
the cit-prana and still the mind. It is used as a precursor to
meditation (dhyana) where the "i-it" dualistic relationship
between the one who sees and the object which is perceived (pratyaksa)
is eventually dissolved revealing the underlying transpersonal
non-dual light of samadhi. III. 2 tatra pratyaya-ekatanata
dhyanam From there (tatra) [after the mind has been settled in
dharana], then, it's contents of an object and the observer (pratyaya)
is one pointedly extended (ekatanata) to merge with pure
non-dual Mind itself, so that the duality or separation inherent
in ordinary dualistic objective thinking processes (pratyaya)
cease. This cessation process os called meditation (dhyana).
Commentary: When the tendency to extend (tanata) consciousness (citta)
to an external object (physical) or internal object (mental),
which is called pratyaya, is stretched/extended to its ultimate
limit (tanata), then limited objectification processes (internal
or external) cease. This extends dharana (focusing on a specific
object (physical or mental) to the practice of meditative
absorption (dhyana). Dhyana thus occurs when dualistic processes
of the mind cease (pratyaya-eka-tanata).
Thus the limiting predilections of the ordinary dualistic
conditioned mind with its perceived contents (pratyaya) are
eliminated (no longer objectified as referents), then when those
arising thought processes which direct consciousness to an
object (pratyaya) also cease. Therein one resides in dhyana
(meditative absorption). Pratyaya as was defined in previous
sutras refers to the ordinary dualistic cognitive functions (carried
out in the frontal lobes or cerebral cortex) where there is
discerned an object of observation, a separate observer, and the
process of observation. Here we go beyond the dualistic results
of this function of the non-integrated human neuro-physiology to
the transpersonal non-dual synergistic intelligence that
animates all of existence and non-existence (ekatanata)
including the inner ecology of the brain, neuro-endocrine
system, neurophysiology as well as the external ecology and all
of externality. This is the non-dual bridge of simultaneous
inner and outer synchronization that meditation (dhyana) affords.
This is the non-dual and non-directional bridge which ekatanata
denotes. Where dharana (concentration/contemplation) in the
previous sutra involved gathering together and focusing on an
object, here dhyana then starts the process of expansion of
consciousness -- the field of consciousness is thus extended (tanata)
into non-dual unity (eka tanata) eliminating the artificially
dualistic separations of the fabricated mind that fragment the
object of consciousness, the observer, and the process of
observation dissolving ordinary dualistic "I-it" ego separations.
Thus meditation (dhyana) is the process that allows us to move
beyond a limited focused object of concentration (dharana) or
any constructed/contrived artificial field of consciousness at
all. Here through dhyana the universal unbiased Mind is
approached. Indeed there is no object in dhyana except at the
start, but such fields then become expanded. Thus the I-it
duality of that is produced by ordinary cognition (pratyaya)
based on observed events or ordinary objectivity based on sense
perception which is digested and processed by the frontal cortex
of the brain) is eliminated. Rather through meditation we no
longer remain addicted to pratyaya (apparent separate objects or
contents of the mind), but extend our range of experiencing and
knowing. Thus there can be said to be three separate and
distinct practices of dharana and dhyana; i.e., concentration on
external (bahya) objects, concentration on internal (antar)
objects, and concentration on nothing -- the process of voiding
or rather the cessation of the objectification process entirely.
This last technique is a decent definition of meditation.
How is this done? Dharana is useful in the beginning only, in
order to gather together the wandering outward flowing energy
and consciousness and bring it back within to the heart (yam,
niyam, asana, pranayama, the breath, and pratyhara all are
synchronized and combine in one dharana). The synergistic
combination of this pratyhara/dharana allows us to let go of the
distracting and dissipating outflowing cit-prana, thus
establishing a state of peaceful vairagya all at once
accomplishing all the other limbs up to and including dharana.
This dharana/pratyhara activates/synergizes a trans-dual state
deep inside which establishes the steady base that ripens the
mind for meditation (dhyana). HERE through pratyhara and dharana
vairagya is accomplished instantaneously while at the same time
an awareness of the presence of the All and Everything is
approximated. Through this shortcut (of pratyhara/dharana) one
can sit in meditation with far less wandering or monkeying of
the mental processes. HERE consistent meditation (dhyana) for
loosens up and removes the more subtle mental impediments and
limitations. As Patanjali says, dhyana is the process where all
objects (contents) of the mind (pratyaya) are emptied -- where
the artificial limits imposed by the limiting contents of the
mind are freed. This is extension is thus obviously accomplished
by emptying the contents. So where dharana was a process of
gathering, there is an element of emptying and releasing in
dhyana that is culminated in Sutra III.3 (samadhi). So part and
parcel of the technique of dhyana involves learning how to drop
all intent and object relations upon separate things (vairagya)
-- HERE occurs simple but profound abiding. The limited contents
of the ordinary mind that was mired in duality and self
limitation is extended out in all directions to the pure light
of the great unconditioned true nature of mind which is allowed
to shine forth. A circle is completed in the process, for it may
be realized in the end that the underlying Source of the
individual intelligence and consciousness resides in a
transpersonal all inclusive and encompassing Reality
simultaneously co-existing non-dually within and without. In
other words dhyana leads us to samadhi.As a process it
transcends and self liberates itself. Meditation goes beyond the
veil of ordinary knowledge, the process of differentiated
thought, or ordinary mentation which creates a limited view and
content (pratyaya). As we saw in chapter one, pratyaya pertains
to the process of ordinary cognition a process of
objectification governed by the cerebral cortex (frontal lobes).
Such cognitive processes are useful in certain applications but
are self limiting in the spiritual pursuit which yearns for
direct communion with the innate transpersonal spirit with in
all. Limited views are anchored in dualistic and comparative
thought processes, reductionism, distinction, differentiation, a
process of weeding out, analysis, and separation. When these
thought processes, fixations, and ordinary mentation processes
(the monkey mind) end as if all thoughts are gathered up as one
large thought (pratyaya-ekatanata), then they can be surrendered
and dissolved. HERE meditation is fructified -- the thoughts
cease coming. HERE the intrinsic clear light of consciousness
dawns in glimpses of samadhi.
While concentration requires an object to focus upon (a specific
content of the mental field is thus structured and delimited),
dhyana on the other hand is the process of
moving into a far more expansive (tanata) whole. When we get "there"
at the end of meditation, then the process of expansion itself
stops by itself. Here universal non-dual consciousness itself,
the unfabricated natural mind or Infinite Mind dawns as the
great expanse of consciousness. Through consistent practice of
dhyana a deeper non-dual awareness is amplified eventually
disclosing that even the objectification of a an apparent
separate meditator who is meditating is dissolved as the
hallucination of limited dualistic thinking, Even the process of
meditation becomes a contradiction -- superficial and illusory.
Dhyana is the gateway to transpersonal and universal
supra-wisdom -- it is not conceived nor contrived, but
trans-rational, natural, spontaneous, and unlimited. It is not
dependent upon the artificially imposed activities of dualism
and separation, but rather the cit-prana is now redirected and
gains momentum toward the Great non-dual integrity -- toward
union. The key in understanding the intent of this sutra is to
understand the specific limits of pratyaya (ordinary cognitive
processes and their results), and the value of meditation that
allows us the ability to extend beyond that limitation and bias.
Thus dhyana goes beyond the inherent duality of pratyaya which
always has an I/It referent or subject/object (duality). Here we
define pratyaya as being the relational and comparative contents
of the fixated dualistic mind-set -- the view of the ordinary
dualistic mind in terms of external objects -- the "normal"
realm of I-it separation -- the tendency for the cognitive
functions to hold us prisoners in habitual objective extraction,
abstraction,a nd spiritual self alienation where it appears that
objects (mental or physical) are possessed or fixated by the
mind. This is the realm of "normal" perception which occurs in
the corrupted/fallen state where separate objects appear to be
solid and real, while the observer appears to live in a
chronically estranged and disconnected world detached from the
apparent separate objects as a separate viewer which defines the
biased context of ignorance of the true nature of mind --
Satchitananda. Through authentic practice of
virama-pratyaya-abhyasa (see Sutra 1.18) in meditation, we begin
to see how this fragmented dualistic and relativistic view has
become artificially acquired through negative conditioning and
then we are able to let it go. It is of value to note that
pratyhara is the transformative energetic remediation of
pratyaya, thus this will give us a good preliminary feeling for
how pranayama, pratyhara, dharana, dhyana, and samadhi all
combine in the main practice of Vibhuti Pada, which is samyama.
(See Sutra 12, 19, and 35 for more on pratyaya). Through
meditation the chitta-vrtti ceases, and what shines forth is
pure unimpeded primordial consciousness as our natural
unconditioned true nature (swarupa).
"Some great meditators say that mind's nature is difficult to
grasp. It is not at all difficult. The error is in not
understanding meditation. There is no need to seek meditation
and there is no need to buy it. There is no need to make it and
no need to go for it. There is no need to work at meditation. It
is sufficient to remain in the state of allowing the free
arising of whatever occurs in the mind. From the very beginning
your mind has been present and so there is no need for losing or
finding, having or not having. The mind has been present from
the very beginning, so whether thinking when thinking or not
thinking when not thinking, this mind is just itself. For
whatever arises in the mind it is sufficient to remain without
artificiality, calmly and unwaveringly on whatever is occurring.
Happiness and ease will come without effort." Patrul Rinpoche,
Self-liberating Understanding, translated by James Low in "Simply
Being. Texts in the Dzogchen Tradition", Vajra Press, London,
1994. pp 97-98. So dhyana (meditation) can be also defined as
the discipline of surrender to our true nature or unconditioned
state beyond the the bias of the vrttis. Natural (sahaj)
meditation as grace can and does happen, but for most of us it
occurs only after making an effort in sitting for meditation
where the vrttis are given opportunity to unwind and settle
down. All of us have experienced samadhi to some degree. Little
children do so often subjectively, but they have no conscious
awareness of their experience and can not integrate nor repeat
it reliably. At first in meditation we get small instances of
stillness, emptiness. and openness where the nadis, chakras,
dna, body, and mind are aligned with the entire universe. Such
periods of grace bring us into a deep heart felt harmony which
cause a positive imprint (samskara). These moments increase in
depth and moment through consistent meditation and samadhi
experiences. Then samadhi may last two seconds, ten, 15 seconds,
maybe 5 minutes, etc. Eventually this pathway into grace becomes
broadened out and made more accessible via consistent meditation
practice which leads to consistent samadhi experience. As the
old programming becomes deconditioned, the pathway to Grace
becomes more effortless and more natural and spontaneous.
Eventually through consistent practice (abhyasa) then, samadhi
as grace becomes a natural and spontaneous (sahaj) inclination.
Sutra I.39 describes spontaneous dhyana as being drawn into a
natural agreeable meditation. Also see Sutra II.11 for more on
dhyana as a practice for its benefits. III. 3 Tad
eva-artha-matra-nirbhasam svarupa-sunyam iva samadhih Samadhi is
realized when the artificial separations between the object (artha-matra)
being meditated upon (the observed), the meditator (the observer),
and the process of meditation (observation) are voided (sunya)
completely such appearances having disappeared into its true
state as it is. Here the true nature of seemingly separate
phenomenal objects (artha-matra) as well as the separate nature
of the observer who observes these objects are known as being
empty (sunya) of any separate essential nature (swarupa). Then
the natural self existing effulgent source of the luminosity (nirbhasam)
of the object in its natural unbiased universal place in all of
existence as-it-is (swarupa) is known as effulgent clear light
luminosity -- its ultimate natural unconditional precondition.
Swami Venkatesananda deftly translates this sutra as: When the
field of observation and the observing intelligence merges as if
their own form is abolished and the total intelligence shines as
the sole substance or reality, there is pure choiceless
awareness without the divided identity of the observer and the
observed – that is illumination. Commentary: In samadhi all
prejudice and limited consciousness not only are illuminated but
are also dissolved in the implicate self effulgent light of
ultimate truth which is our true nature (natural precondition).
Just as sutra two above signals the end of dharana (concentration)
and the beginning of dhyana (meditation), sutra three signals
the end of dhyana and the dawning of samadhi. This is where
dhyana leads. Eva means precise, thus (tad) this is the precise
and self effulgent (nirbhasam) meaning (artha-matra) of samadhi
which is, in Patanjali's own words is "nirbhasam-svarupa-sunyam"
is the shining forth in clear lucidity and luminosity (nirbhasam)
of the true nature of self (svarupa) which is devoid or empty (sunya)
of a separate self. Such occurs upon the non-dual realization
that all objects are empty of separate self (svarupa-sunya).
There is no separation in ALL OUR RELATIONS as everyone is kin
in the larger family of Universal love. there is no reality
behind subject/object duality except for ignorance of our true
nature. Sunya can also be seen as empty and open -- the pathways
of the nadis then are able to transport prana and light where
before they were blocked (dense, filled up, and obstructed).
Sunya is known as the central nadi (sushumna) by the mahasiddhas.
For them samadhi was that simple (allowing the central energy to
fill their vessel to its brimless brim). This indeed denotes the
full extension of the rainbow bridge as the self luminous
god-filled true nature of all things in the truth of ALL OUR
RELATIONS.
Notice how this has integrity with Samadhi Pada (chapter 1),
Sutra 4 where Patanjali defines the fruit of yoga as "tada
drastuh svarupe vasthanam", which means; "Then the seer/observer
rests in that profound light of our true unconditioned original
self nature" or "Suchness". There in Sutra I.4. Patanjali tells
us that the goal of yoga is to reside in our true natural state
-- swarupa/suchness and that this occurs upon the cessation of
the vrttis (spinning out of the mind). did not then expand upon
swarupa but rather directed pada one toward nirbija samadhi as
the summum bonum of yoga. Now however in this definitive sutra,
Patanjali links samadhi and swarupa. Samadhi can be translated
as absorption or mergence, but in the context of English, there
is no suitable equivalent single word, because even mergence
assumes two separate things in the first place, where yoga
affirms that our true nature (in Reality) is non-dual,
transconceptual, -- inseparable, unlimited, and eternal. Thus
Patanjali uses the word, sunya (empty) where nothing exists by
itself, but rather everything is real only in context with the
whole -- when the obstructions are removed and pathways are
open. This is not a nihilistic statement, but rather a non-dual
affirmation of the fecund reality of ALL OUR RELATIONS. From
"The Lesser Discourse on Emptiness", The Collection of The
Middle Length Sayings of the Buddha, Vol III, translated from
the Pali by I. B. Horner "And again, Ananda, a monk, not
attending to the perception of the plane of no-thing, not
attending to the perception of the plane of
neither-perception-nor-non-perception, attends to solitude
grounded on the concentration of mind that is signless. His mind
is satisfied with . . . and freed in the concentration of mind
that is signless. He comprehends thus: ‗The disturbances there
might be resulting from the perception of the plane of no-thing
. . . from the perception of the plane of
neither-perception-nor-non-perception do not exist here. There
is only this degree of disturbance, that is to say the six
sensory fields that, conditioned by life, are grounded on this
body itself. He comprehends: ‗This perceiving is empty of the
plane of no-thing . . . empty of the perception of the plane of
neither-perception-nor-non-perception. And there is only this
that is not emptiness, that is to say the six sensory fields
that, conditioned by life, are grounded on this body itself.' He
regards that which is not there as empty of it. But in regard to
what remains there he comprehends, ‗That being, this is.' Thus,
Ananda, this too comes to be for him a true, not mistaken,
utterly purified realization of (the concept of) emptiness.
And again, Ananda, a monk, not attending to the perception of
the plane of no-thing, not attending to the perception of the
plane of neither-perception-nor-non-perception, attends to
solitude grounded on the concentration of mind that is signless.
His mind is satisfied with, pleased with, set on and freed in
the concentration of mind that is signless. He comprehends thus,
‗This concentration of mind that is signless is effected and
thought out.[ 13 ] But whatever is effected and thought out,
that is impermanent, it is liable to stopping.' When he knows
this thus, sees this thus, his mind is freed from the canker of
sense-pleasures and his mind is freed from the canker of
becoming and his mind is freed from the canker of ignorance. In
freedom is the knowledge that he is freed and he comprehends: ‗Destroyed
is birth, brought to a close the Brahma-faring, done is what was
to be done, there is no more of being such or so.' He
comprehends thus: ‗The disturbances there might be resulting
from the canker of sense-pleasures do not exist here; the
disturbances there might be resulting from the canker of
becoming do not exist here; the disturbances there might be
resulting from the canker of ignorance do not exist here. And
there is only this degree of disturbance, that is to say the six
sensory fields that, conditioned by life, are grounded on this
body itself.' He regards that which is not there as empty of it.
But in regard to what remains he comprehends; ‗That being, this
is.' Thus, Ananda, this comes to be for him a true, not mistaken,
utterly purified and incomparably highest realization of (the
concept of) emptiness. And those recluses or brahmans, Ananda,
who in the distant past, entering on the utterly purified and
incomparably highest (concept of) emptiness, abided therein . .
. all these, entering on precisely this utterly purified and
incomparably highest (concept of) emptiness, abided therein. And
those recluses or brahmans, Ananda, who in the distant future,
entering on the utterly purified and incomparably highest (concept
of) emptiness, will abide therein . . . all these, entering on
precisely this utterly purified and incomparably highest (concept
of) emptiness, will abide therein. And those recluses or
brahmans, Ananda, who at present, entering on the utterly
purified and incomparably highest (concept of) emptiness, are
abiding in it . . . all these, entering on precisely this
utterly purified and incomparably highest (concept of) emptiness,
are abiding therein. Wherefore, Ananda, thinking: ‗Entering on
the utterly purified and incomparably highest (concept of)
emptiness, I will abide therein' . . . this is how you must
train yourself, Ananda. Thus spoke the Lord. Delighted, the
venerable Ananda rejoiced in what the Lord had said." Here we go
beyond the process, act, and/or technique of both dharana (concentration)
and dhyana (meditation) into samadhi (non-dual integration --
the intimate experience of transpersonal sacred integrity).
Meditation becomes accomplished in a profound simple abiding
where the seer perceives herself in all that can be seen within
a universal non-dual context -- when THAT smiles back at Self as
Self. Meditation is a technique, not the end. One must step out
of the boat in order to step upon the further shore. Only when
the distinction between the meditator and the meditation is
removed -- when the meditator no longer looks down at himself as
meditating -- when that becomes also voided (sunya) as a
separate object -- then the dualistic veil of ego is dissolved
--then one sees, thus all is known, the meditation is over and
samadhi is achieved -- Grace becomes self actualized. Ho! It is
sacred!
Vibhuti Pada (III), Sutra 4 and 5 continue defining the
technique of samyama:
4. trayam ekatra samyamah 5. taj-jayat prajna-alokah Taken
together as a three part whole (trayam ekatra), that is, when
dharana (concentration), dhyana (meditation), and (samadhi) as a
mutually synergistic and simultaneous process is synchronized (trayam
ektra) such is called samyama. From the success in samyama (taj-jayat),
true and authentic vision and wisdom (prajna) without prejudice
or bias bathes us in its effulgence (alokah). Commentary:
Everywhere the self effulgent limitless wisdom shines forth in
ALL OUR RELATIONS. Mastery, success, or victory (jaya) in
samyama provides the gateway into a non-dual transpersonal and
trans-rational wisdom space. Here the inner and outer dynamics
are perfectly balanced, harmonized, and synchronized. In mature
samyama practice mergence/communion with any object can be
achieved by stepping out of the dualistic world of separateness.
We can not truly know some thing from outside of it -- from a
fragmented view, rather in dualism our perspective is biased and
prejudicial. But through success in samyama we approach any
specific object of attention in a different "light". Through
success in samyama we see reflected the light of universal
wisdom in all things/beings. That is called true insight (prajna).
Thus by applying samyama as the synchronization of concentration
(dharana), meditation (dhyana), and absorption (samadhi), to any
process or object, intimate knowledge of "that" through union/communion
with it is truly known without bias or distortion, in the great
overall perspective that we are one! Eventually by mastering
samyama we are able to merge into the trans-rational and
transpersonal holographic reality at will and from that realm
where the veil of duality has become lifted and dissolved, the
true nature of reality is known in ALL OUR RELATIONS. Samyama is
a powerful practice. First the object of concentration is fixed
upon (dharana), Then the duality of the object and the observer
is dissolved in non-dual oneness extending into ALL OUR
RELATIONS (dhyana). Then one merges into absorption with the
object non-dually, void of subject/object duality (in
sabija-samadhi). This is the way to know all things as they are
without prejudice, bias, or distortion (citta-vrtti). III. 6
tasya bhumisu viniyogah Tasya (dharana, dhyana, and samadhi) are
thus applied together as one interconnected whole, but are
usually learned and applied in graduated sequential (viniyogah)
stages (bhumi).
Commentary: First you practice dharana and then focus the energy
and intent, being enabled to sense the flow of cit-prana and
empowered to redirect it. Then through dhyana (dissolving the
separation), the mind shines forth uninhibited in its innate
self effulgent lucidity, thus the state is set for samadhi. In
samadhi the apparent separate distinctions between a separate
object and observer is voided (sunya) while the universal light
is recognized in ALL OUR RELATIONS. After regular practice over
time, these parts or segments of samyama (dharana, dhyana, and
samadhi) are simultaneously and spontaneously deepened and
integrated together as an instantaneous coherent action that is
applied non-dually and effortlessly. This (tasya) wisdom light
and luster (prajna-alokah) that is produced by samyama is to be
used and directed to all dimensions of our experience (bhumisu)
thus acting as a spiritual eye gradually becomes acknowledged as
our everyday experience. Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says:
"Concentrate on the Chitta Vrtti. After the mastery over the
Chitta Vrtti, the other subtle objects are concentrated upon and
Meditation and Samadhi are also mastered. You attain yoga within
yoga. Yoga leads to yoga. And yoga dwells within yoga." III. 7
trayam antarangam purvebhyah Their distinct phases (purvebhyah)
of these three (trayam) limbs (angam) [dharana, dhyana, and
samadhi taken together as samyama] become increasingly subtle,
rarified, and internalized (antar). Commentary: No longer are
their distinctions as separate limbs (angam) made as in
beginning samyama as a coarse or external sequenced practice,
but eventually samyama happens altogether as a whole
effortlessly as an internal spontaneous process (antar).
Most commentators have this sutra comparing the last three limbs
of ashtanga yoga (dharana, dhyana, and samadhi) with the first
five limbs (yama, niyama, asana, pranayama, and pratyhara) as
being grosser, more physical, less subtle, less mental, or
lacking in inner or esoteric aspects. But it has been shown that
all the limbs of the ashtanga tree have subtle, esoteric, mental,
inner, and esoteric meaning. All the limbs are concerned with
harnessing and gathering the biased outward and distracted flows
of pranas toward the center (inward), albeit sabija samadhi is
the only stage where this sadhana (practice) is no longer called
for.
Although the eight limbs of ashtanga yoga can be presented in
stages, it is not my belief that Patanjali intends such a
discursion here. Albeit in particular we have shown how
pranayama and pratyhara become two aspects of dharana (concentration),
once that is mastered having activated the inner flows through
the nadis so they stay centered toward the central channel, then
the comparatively even more subtle and inner (antar) practices
of samyama become successful, these distinct phases (purvebhyah)
are to seen in the light of ashtanga yoga as an integrated whole
-- increasingly more subtle (antarangam) so that the sequenced
distinctions fade away beyond all subtlety . III. 8 tad api
bahirangam nirbijsya In comparison to the seedless (nirbijsya)
goal of enlightenment (nirbij-samadhi), even samyama is to be
viewed also as a coarse and external (bahir) practice or
technique (no matter how powerful or subtle).
Commentary: In other words, Patanjali is attesting to the power
of samyama, but also warning us that samyama is only a technique
and practice (sadhana), not the end. It is samadhi with seed (sabija
samadhi). Only in nirbija-samadhi (seedless samadhi) even the
most subtle, esoteric, and most internal effort ceases. That is
the end of striving and practice. In nirbij-samadhi there is no
object, no samyama, no meditator, no effort and no separation.
Practice falls away to an all inclusive integrative experience
devoid of even the most subtle object (nirvicara). Now begins
the discourse on the three Parinamas (transformative practices)
that of nirodha-parinama, samadhi parinama, and
ekagrata-parinama. All the parinamas condition/transform the
samskaras (old imprints capable of being triggered from latent
tendencies to kleshas (negative emotions) or vasana (bad habits).
III. 9 vyutthana-nirodha-samskarayor abhibhava-pradhurbhavau
nirodha-ksana-chittanvayo nirodha-parinamah Nirodha parinama
occurs when the the stillness of the thought waves is achieved.
Commentary: Here Patanjali brings up the powerful practice of
nirodha parinama. where one can instantaneously transform the
outflowing of the mind entering into stillness (nirodha).
Nirodha parinama is a technique that stills the mind. It is
normally applied in meditation. It occurs when the samskaras (mental
imprints) which trigger the mind's outflowing distractive
tendency (vyutthana) are blocked and cease (nirodha).
Simultaneously this supercedes and overpowers the further
arisings, cessations, and permutations (abhibhava-pradhurbhavau)
putting an end to any further successive associative changes of
the wandering monkey mind (nirodha-ksana-chittanvayo). In this
one sutra Patanjali uses the word, nirodha (cessation), three
times successively. The movements (parinama) of consciousness (chittanvaya)
-- the monkey mind -- cease (nirodha). Changes in state (parinama)
which are created by past programmed imbedded psychic
impressions and latent tendencies (samskarayor) cease (nirodha)
at the same moment (ksana) that the outward arising energy of
consciousness (vyutthana) cease (nirodha). Thus when one sits in
meditation one may allow for the still moment (ksana) wherein
the arising thought wave and the receding thought wave cancel
each other out (as in an absolutely still wave). This is truly
being present allowing for sacred presence). That could be
termed the application of nirodha-parinama (where the
transformations of the chitta are stilled (nirodha) which in
turn create the opposite wave of the samskaras (conditioned
impressions, negative programming, and tendencies) destroying/deprogramming
them over time. See III.18 following for more on samskaras. Thus
meditation is a two way street i.e., the samskaras create the
oscillations and permutations (parinama) of consciousness (chittaanvayo)
which create the obstructions to meditation, but also meditation
reverses the wave process (parinama) where the samskaras become
annihilated (nirodha). This is what is meant by the application
of nirodha parinama. Here ordinary karmic mentation ceases and
the profound great silence can arise. Nirodah parinama (the
first transformative technique to be learned) is itself first
learned to be applied in meditation, but one eventually learns
how to apply it at any time. First we learn how to "be present",
through nirodha parinama. When one's mind is quiet we are able
to hear the more subtle sounds. We apply this increased
awareness back into our own mental process. This inner stillness
and emptiness hence creates the foundation for increased
awareness and thus prepares us for the applications of the next
two following parinamas (samadhi parinama and ekgrata parinama)
in order to be filled with the source of consciousness itself --
in sacred presence. III. 10 tasya prasanta-vahita samskarat
Although it may seem like an effort at first to apply the
antidote to arising thoughts (nirodha parinama), this action
eventually becomes effortless as the negative samskaras become
subdued and eliminated. When the samskaras are thus eliminated,
the practice becomes not only effortless, but tranquility, peace,
and lightness appear spontaneously.
Commentary: Of which (tasya) from the previous practice of
nirodha parinama samskaras which produced discursive thought are
destroyed and cease (nirodha). This
stillness produces a beneficial imprint (samskara) which was
realized through the sustained implementation of nirodha
parinama. This positive imprint (samskara) of calmness flows
forth effortlessly (prasanta vahita). At first in meditation,
when thoughts appear (as the result of past samskaras) the
beginner will get lost in them and the ordinary dualistic mind
will wander in agitation. These imprints must be annulled --
their disturbing thoughts cease. Normally by continued
observation and the application of awareness in meditation, the
average meditator will awaken to an awareness that their
attention has drifted. Then at that point they go back to
bearing witness, watching and pure abiding again -- cultivating
purusha consciousness, until the mind usually wanders again upon
another object of thought. Such is the common plight of the
beginning meditator, but such is not to be his/her fate. After
some practice, the meditator will begin to catch a thought at
the beginning of the thought process (vrtti) and then let it go
(vairagya) and cease (nirodha). First maybe after a paragraph or
two, then after a sentence, then after a word. then before the
first word, then even before the impetus of a thought -- such
ceases. In other words after some practice (sadhana) proficiency
occurs. Then the subtle tendency of the ordinary discursive
thinking process (cit-vrtti) itself is eliminated in nirodha
parinama. Abiding in this stillness/cessation in itself creates
a positive imprint. See III.18 below for more on samyama on
samskaras. After much awareness through consistent practice,
awareness is increased, the process of nirodha parinama is
learned, becomes implemented more effectively eventually
becoming instant, natural and effortless. This sutra thus
explicitly attests to its application as such -- to be applied
instantaneously with no effort -- naturally and all at once. No
energy is thus wasted or dissipated in wandering thoughts, but
rather the energy is freed to uplift us, creating a feeling of
completeness and tranquility (prasanta). This accomplishment is
called nirodha parinama which brings success (jaya). III. 11
sarva-arthata-ekagratayoh kshaya-udayau cittasya
samadhi-parinamah After stillness of the mind field (nirodha
parinama) is achieved, then room has been made for the more
subtle awareness -- the awareness of the source of awareness
dawns in samadhi-parinama (integration/union) where one is
always aware of the integrative state, although the integration
itself may not be complete.
Commentary: Here Patanjali brings up samadhi parinama. Samadhi
parinama is a transformative tool when learned like nirodha
parinama it can be applied to eradicating the arising (kshaya-udayau)
of the tendencies of the mind's (cittasya) , it's habitual
objectification of I-it duality and fixation tendencies (sarva-arthata)
which in turn disturb the mind's one pointed intent (ekagratayoh).
Samadhi then is achieved through the gradual settling out and
eventual calmness of the rising and receding waves of mental
distractions where the dualistic forces of alienation,
extraction, or separation causing the milieu of objectiveness (sarvarthata)
ceases altogether, so that one becomes one pointed in the source
of consciousness and bliss (sat chit ananda) abiding in samadhi.
Here consciousness (chitta) is no longer enslaved serving
separate objects, but all is experienced in the living union of
the all inclusive matrix -- of ALL OURRELATIONS -- with
universal integrity. This is the change of state (parinama)
which when applied brings forth samadhi. Here again
sarva-arthata (the tendency of the mind to objectify a separate
I/it referent reality) is destroyed (ksayah) through the
technique of directing the mind one pointedly (ekagratayoh) as
cittasya samadhi parinama. Samadhi parinama destroys the
dualistic tendency to objectify (sarva-arthata). Samadhi
parinama when implemented consistently over a period of time --
with practice, creates a positive imprint on the mindstuff (citta)
acting as a positive samskara that transforms old negative
samskaras, eventually paving the way to non-dual integration in
nirbija samadhi. See Samadhi Pada Sutra 50. III. 12 tatah punah
santa-uditau tulya-pratyayau chittasyai-ekagrata-parinamah Here
Patanjali brings up the powerful practice that achieves ekgrata
parinama. In this way (tulya) by balancing out (in equipose or
canceling out the opposites) of the energy of the arising
distracting centrifugal thoughts (udita) with the energy of the
subsiding (santa) centripetal thoughts, a stilling and balancing
wave transforms and remediates (parinama) the apparently
discrete separate objects which form the contents of the
ordinary dualistic mind (pratyaya) into a one-pointed
unification/integration (ekgrata) consciousness (cittasya). Here
in ekgrata parinama a state no effort and no movement (nirodha
parinama) is realized -- one rests in the synergistic balance
and is embraced in the non-dual harmony, supported by the
ineffable. Ekgrata parinama is usually applied in meditation,
but can be applied at any time as well as arise spontaneously.
Commentary: Once ekgrata parinama is accomplished as the
fruition of nirodha and samadhi parinama, as such it is the end
of parinama itself, as no other transformations are needed.
Ekgrata occurs through the exercise unified intent upon and
eventually of our authentic self -- our true nature. It is like
implementing an instant reminder or an instantaneous wake up
call that transforms all opposites, dualistic and polar thought
process. Here there is nothing more to transform, because
dualism itself has become transformed in the success (jaya) of
ekgrata parinama. The citta-vrtti has become stilled (nirodha).
In the previous sutra the sequential arising of linear thinking
has been quelled, one enters into the ability to know things as
they are through focusing on an object or thing (dharana) be it
an object of thought or a sensory object, then absorbing oneself
into that that without distinction for subject/object duality (dhyana),
and thus through this dissolution of separation, merge the
observer with the object and the process of observation (awareness)
as one integral process revealing the universal timeless
unbiased true nature of any phenomena. III. 13 etena
bhuta-indriyesu dharma-laksana-avastha-parinama vyakhyatah By
these former processes (etena) [through the accomplishment of
first nirodha parinama, then samadhi parinama, and then ekgrata
parinama], then the causative laws (dharma) that underlie the
process of transformation (parinama) itself reveal the essential
true nature of all creation -- the way the senses perceive the
elements (bhuta-indriyesu) are fully revealed (vyakhyatah)
whether they be transformations of the sequences of events (laksana
parinama) -- transmutation of the limitations of straight line
sequential time, or if by avastha parinama (knowledge of and
transformation of the limitations of the processes of decay and
evolution -- of parinama itself). HERE the limitations of the
sense organs (indriyas) and elements (bhutas) are overcome and
fully integrated while their apparent discontinuity and
unconnectedness are transmuted and remediated . One's entire
being becomes spiritually integrated and united as the power of
ekgrata parinama (as unified intent of the authentic self)
shines forth as a revelatory (vyakhyata) effect. Commentary:
This is often misinterpreted as another parinama practice, but
rather it seems that Patanjali is clearly stating that the
consistent application and accomplishment of the first three
parinamas will effect dharma-laksana-avastha-parinama. One could
just as easily say that dharma-laksana-avastha-parinama comprise
a transformative exercise when taken as a whole. Regardless the
aspirant must transform the previous disparate elements of
"self" into the overall unitive whole -- in ALL OUR RELATIONS.
Thus through the power effected by the previous parinamas up to
and including ekgrata parinama (as unified intention) instead of
analyzing phenomenal analytically -- all of nature is known
through that one universal all pervasive spirit which
inter-connects us all. HERE Patanjali goes beyond even the need
for any further implementation of parinama as a willful
technique. After all parinama as a technique assumes that there
exists something desirable to be transformed. Here however the
need of parinama as an applied transformational technique,
attainment, or practice is obviated. So from the perspective of
ordinary dualistic consciousness the word, parinama, refers to
the process how normally the mind objects or contents of the
mind (pratyaya) change (parinama) and are in the process of flux,
but when the dualistic mind is emptied and opened through yogic
practice, then all temporal existence is viewed as the sacred
river. Parinama is often defined as a negative transformation (parinama)
pertaining to the ordinary wandering/discursive mind that is
undergoing constant change devoid of ekagrata. As the latter it
fluctuates and spins in patterns of bias (vrtti). Of course in
that stage of constant transformation, the ordinary plastic mind
can not know the true nature of Reality as-it-is. There the mind
moves from symbolic fixations on objects, symbolic
representations, various patterned sequences, and all sorts of
such agitated movements in inefficient dualistic and distracted
"meditation". But as one becomes more aware by observing, we can
then find and rest inside the intrinsic underlying unitive
Reality which is self existing as our true nature (swarupa).
Here then efficient meditation becomes a positively
transformative process where pre-existing negative samskaras
Imprints) are transformed and cease through nirodha parinama,
samadhi parinama, and ekgrata parinama. From there (as a result
of ekgrata parinama) everything (all temporal phenomena) appear
to flow like a river when we are centered and focused in that
universal still core center of the Heart (hridayam) --when our "viewpoint"
no longer changes with that which is viewed. In this sacred
place, the limits of relativity (of time and space) no longer
constrain us in a flat line existence. In that sacred context of
ALL OUR RELATIONS all the transformations of nature, the
elements, of all of creation can then leave a positive imprint
as well. As one continues to meditate through effective practice,
one masters in sequence all the parinamas, up to ekgrata
parinama. Then various insights as to the true nature of the
sense objects (indriyas), elements (bhuta), their essential
nature (dharma), the process of qualitative distinctions, time,
state, and evolution (laksana-avastha) become clear and revealed
(vyakhyatah) through direct experience. Simply put we see ALL
OUR RELATIONS through awakened eyes. With that insight, we are
empowered to interact more expediently, harmoniously,
synergistically, and creatively, thus remaining free from error.
Notice this ability does not arrive through intellection or
analytical effort, but from first applying ekgrata parinama, in
meditation, eliminating the negative samskaras, and then through
that grace being able to apply it in ALL OUR RELATIONS as the
play of the Divine Leela. III 14
santa-udita-avyapadesya-dharma-anupati dharmi [Thus through
these transformations via samyama] the dharma holder (dharmi)
beholds all processes as it corresponds (anupati) in their true
interconnected nature (dharma) whether or not they are resting,
arising, ceasing or not. Commentary: The dharma in its ordinary
sense is defined as that underlying causative energetic pattern,
principle, blueprint or substratum that underlies the common
properties of temporal phenomena, whether they be latent or
quiescent (santa), uprisen and manifest (udita) or undenotable,
impossible to describe or grasp or understand through the senses
or cognized (avyapadesya). Such is the definition of the dharma
of "individual separate things". But in truth they do not truly
exist as separate things. When the causes are really known then
we intimately know the underlying laws and principles of of the
universe, or the Santana Dharma -- Eternal Law within the
context of ALL OUR RELATIONS. In the non-dual or extraordinary
definition then, Dharma with a capital "D", is the essential
underlying true nature of all phenomena in the unitive sense (not
as being unconnected or separate). That Dharma is unbiased and
universal truth and reflects the law of reality as it truly is
in it's true nature- Suchness. Then from that perspective "things"
are thus revealed and unmasked revealing the underlying (and may
we add over-riding) Dharma -- as the underlying connective (anupati)
causative characteristic, substratum, or unitive "nature" which
does not change as the temporal world of sense objects go
through their continuous changes (anupati). Only through samyama
(not through objectification) utilizing the combined technique
consisting of dharana, dhyana, and samadhi can the true non-dual
awareness of phenomena be known. Why do I say non-dual, because
non-duality is the nature of dhyana and samadhi -- because
samyama is doomed to failure if applied within s dualistic
fragmentary approach. An object is known only by the entire
constituents of its parts and how they differ from all other
constituents in the entire universe. This is how reality is
known. Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says: "The dharma is the
power underlying the principles of shanta, udita, and
avyapdeshaya.. The shanta nature is the state when the present
characteristics have been transformed to the real nature of the
objects; udita is the state when the real nature is transformed
into a manifested form of the objects; and avyapdeshaya is the
state when the manifestation has not yet taken place and exist
in the form of an energy, and could not be stated in clear terms.
In whatever state, the dharma of the object remains one
undifferentiated." Swami Venkatesananda says of dharma:
"... a substance itself is put together and recognized as such,
and is non-different from a particular characteristic, which may
be in a dormant state, in an emerging state, or in an uncertain
or potential state." In general the word, "dharma" is used as
the underlying, causal, and governing principle. Dharma is the
characteristic that remains the same in the potential stage, in
the manifesting stage, in the manifest stage, or in the
undefined ineffable stage and as such as it relates; to nature,
dharma is the substratum or matrix that has a seminal stage, a
becoming stage, a manifest stage, and a mysterious stage and is
also subject to dissolution. In the dualistic/materialistic view
is not an immutable essence if such can be attributed to any one
phenomena, it is the patterned result of causes (karma). This
kind of temporal definition of dharma is subject to the rules of
cause and effect itself. Although it appears to be causative, it
is not ultimately causative, unless we trace it back to the
causeless cause -- the Source. There Dharma then takes on a
different meaning.
Another way of using the word, Dharma, can also be translated as
our nature. For example, in India one may say: "there is no
reason to say, "thank you", rather it is my very nature to serve
you, this is simply natural, it is my dharma ". As such, the
word, dharma, is meant to be a natural manifestation or result
of a cause, but in Yoga we look to the cause of the cause until
all karma is annihilated (nirodha) and final liberation (mukti)
is achieved. At that "time", what is it that manifests, but pure
and eternal Dharma, is it not? Here Patanjali is getting to what
is called Sanatana Dharma in Hinduism or simply "The Dharma" in
Buddhism. So in the pure context, Dharma with the big "D" means
the immutable law of Reality as-it-is -- natural law
unconstructed or modified by the mind, and thus he/she who knows
the true Dharma, knows Reality. It is noteworthy to point out
that Patanjali in the next seven sutras talks about sequential
activities (kramah), death, samskaras, and karma, which in turn
can all be correlated to dharma. Again in Sutras 13-16 Patanjali
does not present parinama as a practice, but rather as temporal
phenomena or the flux of creation/creativity. See discussion
above on parinama for more. III. 15 krama-anyatvam
parinama-anyatve hetuh This constant reordering or changing (parinama)
of the various sequences (krama) of the above phases (anyatvam)
is the cause (hetuh) for all the myriad differentiations and
variegations (anatve) [of creation and evolution]. Here the
inherent order underlying the differentiated relative world is
disclosed and revealed. That evokes the knowledge of our kinship
with all of creation-- the wisdom that surpasses all
understanding -- that which is the operating modality in ALL OUR
RELATIONS, that which explains all, as it resolves all.
Commentary: Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says: "Many
characteristics of a manifestation result in many successions,
which in turn result in manifold evolution. This multiplicity of
manifestations (of the one undifferentiated) leads to
non-attachment to the phenomenal world" (and success in yoga)."
Commentary: The yogi is focused on liberation and as such he/she
observes the underlying interconnectedness of all phenomena (dharma)
underlying all changes of state -- all of creation/evolution (like
a river on fire) when viewed from the still center of Source or
samadhi. Abiding in that unitive place, we are instantaneously
free from prisons of habit, limited identifications, and karmic
waves and propensities. Differentiated reality can only be known
in the integrity of its completion -- when it is married to the
undifferentiated absolute -- when it is known unbiased from a
universal viewpoint. This, when maintained, unswayed, and
undismayed, is authentic brahmacharya and here all of nature
instructs as the divine play (leela) of siva/shakti (creator/creation).
III. 16 parinama-traya-samyamad atitanagata-jnanam The siddhi of
the knowledge of past and future (atitianagata-jnanam) is
accomplished through samyama (the synchronization of dharana,
dhyana, and samadhi) upon the three (traya) transformations (parinama)
i.e., nirodha parinama, samadhi parinama, and ekgrata parinama.
Commentary: Here we can say that Patanjali sums up sutras 9-15.
Just as well one could say that this knowledge is the result
through samyama on dharma parinama, lakshana parinama, and
avastya parinama as they relate to evolution and the dimensions
of time; but since their success is due to success in nirodha,
samadhi, and ekgrata parinama, they are mutually implicit. Here
Patanjali is connecting everything together as it is not just
the past and the future, but also the nature of cause and effect
that becomes clarified as the fruits of proficient authentic
sadhana become integrated. The past limitations of three
dimensional time and space become replaced with the awareness of
the holographic/wholistic fourth dimensional reality called
turiya.
Just as when ekgrata parinama siddha is realized wherein the
arising of linear thinking has ceased (nirodha), one abides in
the ability (siddha) to know things as they are through focusing
on an object or thing (dharana) be it an object of thought or a
sensory object, then absorbing oneself into that object without
distinction for subject/object duality (dhyana) -- becoming that
so to speak, and thus through this dissolution of the illusion
of separation separation, thirdly merges the observer with the
object and the process of observation (awareness) as a samadhi
-- as one integral conscious process revealing the universal
timeless unbiased true nature of any phenomena free from time/space
bias or prejudice. These practices take practice. The most
difficult part is that the practitioner does not understand that
the process is not intellectual or willful. Albeit dharana is
necessary at the beginning, mastery of dhyana (non-dual
meditative absorption) is necessary. Here one has to understand
the empty nature of subject/object duality and thus be able to
dissolve it while remaining conscious of that process. Here the
artificial/arbitrary thee dimensional boundaries of time and
place are dissolved and phenomena are known as they are without
the individual bias of a separate observer or point of view.
Things are known from the universal timeless deathless Source or
are known as illusion. Once ekgrata parinama is mastered, one
can then enter into other specific samyamas which reveal the
timeless spirit in ALL OUR RELATIONS with little effort. III. 17
shabdartha-pratyayanam itara-itara adhyasat samkaras
tat-pravibhaga-samyamat sarva-bhuta-ruta-jnanam The meaning of
sacred sounds, prayers, mantra, and music of the spheres is
heard and understood -- the siddha of all sounds (ruta-jnanam)
is accomplished through samyama on distinguishing (pravibhaga)
and giving sounded/phonetic words and meaning to all individual
objects and processes of attention that had previously become
co-mingled, undifferentiated with sound, or confused (samskarah)
creating a predisposed limited mental fixation (pratyaya) which
had not yet been assigned reciprocal relationships (itara-itara),
thus one became deaf to the intrinsic ongoing and continuous
sacred song and divine symphony. Commentary: The above
translation attempts to be literal, but is difficult perhaps to
access. Succinctly, the process of such phonetic naming clears
confusion and provides clarity and liberation in relationship to
sound and meaning. Here through samyama the yogi goes beyond the
limitations imposed through limited conceptual impositions and
analytical comparative relationships based on duality,
separateness, fragmentation, and objectivism (pratyaya), but
rather the sounds are seen as integral parts of the song -- the
melody reveals the ongoing overall orchestra/orchestrator. III.
18 samskara-sakshatkaranat purva-jatijnanam Knowledge of the
cause of births (purva-jatijnanam) and knowledge of past life
forms is accomplished when one applies samyama on the workings
and causes of one's samskaras (imbedded latent tendencies and
impression) which in turn activates the power of penetrative
awareness (sakshatkaranat).
Commentary; The creation and the destruction of the samskaras
are associated with kleshas and karma. When samyama is applied
to the samskaras we are able to know their cause and eliminate
them thus liberating our self. See the discussion on applying
nirodha parinama, samadhi parinama, and ekgrata parinama in
order to create positive samskaras especially III.9 and III.10
above. III. 19 pratyayasya para-chitta-jnanam Samyama on the
contents of the mind (pratyaya) provides knowledge (jnanam) of
the transpersonal, universal, non-dual infinite consciousness
(para chitta) which when accessed provides knowledge of all
minds. Commentary: This is simply practicing self inquiry and
mindfulness, by asking where is my mind now -- what am I
thinking of? When our field of consciousness is clear,lucid, and
present, we are also able to notice the mind contents of others
who are not. By placing our attention back into the contents of
our own minds, its mental field and field of consciousness,
etc., then those contents no longer will color our perception,
i.e., clarity of perception and instantaneous awareness becomes
available not only of our own mind, but we are able to perceive
the operating principles at work in others as well -- what it is
that is occupying and occluding their stream of consciousness.
In that way of true listening we are able to avoid skew and bias.
We can help bring others back home -- present the opportunity to
be fully present or clear as well. We are able to avoid skew or
bias. Here also able to listen and see with clarity others. III.
20 na cha tat salambanam tasyavishayi-bhutatvat Swami
Venkatesananda says: "However this does not imply particularized
knowledge of the others' personalities --e.g., the motivations,
the conditioning, or the background of the others' minds -- for
knowledge of the others' mind is impersonal and devoid of images
and details." Commentary: Samyama on pratyaya allows us to
understand and know the contents of our own minds so they will
not color us or create bias/prejudice. Then we know that we can
apply that knowledge to situations with others -- we can be
unbiased and recognize and understand the minds of others from
this place as well as understand the operating principle
underneath their actions. But this sutra does not explicitly say
(which many interpret) that we will know all the particular
facts about others, nor is Patanjali saying that this will allow
us to enter their minds and bodies as some commentators
interject.
III. 21 kaya-rupa-samyamat tad-grahya-shakti-stambhe
chakshuh-prakashasanprayoge 'ntardhanam
Normally we look on only the form of bodies (kaya rupa). But if
look more deeply with the inner eye utilizing samyama we know
that form to be mere appearance. Thus we are allowed to suspend
(stambe) the imposition of such a coarse modality and thus allow
the causal intelligent energy (shakti) which is the essence of
the body (and all creation) to be revealed (if only we look for
it in samyama). Commentary: When we are not caught up in
appearances, hut learn to look more deeply, we utilize the
ability to read between the lines. When we look with wisdom we
see all things in integral context with the whole of which we
are also a part. This way of seeing reveals the Reality of "ALL
OUR RELATIONS" and thus allows to see through limited
appearances. The whole world is alive and connected and this
context all of creation is our kin. III. 22 sopakramam
nirupakramam cha karma tat-samyamad aparanta-jnanam arishtebhyo
va Karma may be dormant (nir-upakramam) or manifest (sa-upakramam)
-- it arises, rests, and ceases. Samyama on how that arises,
rests, and ceases and on the signs and omens of nature which
portend good or ill, and of our own temporal nature will reveal
knowledge of the physical death and final conclusion of the body
(aparanta-jnanam). Commentary: Our life is shaped by karma and
so of course is its end. Yet the contemplation and communion
with all this allows us to be free from karma. Through
understanding its workings we liberate ourselves. We see the
eternal spirit (that which never dies -- which was never born --
which always is) in all things and events as a practice which
brings about joyful fulfillment and completion being able to
identify with that living imperishable spirit which is eternal
and universal HERE while embodied. III. 23 maitry-adishu balani
By communion with the nature of friendliness and kindness (maitri),
and the alike (adishu), their strengths (bala) and powers are
increased in us. Commentary: Thus accelerated spiritual
purification can be promoted through this type of samyama. . III.
24 balesu hasti-bala-adini Samyama on the strength (bala) itself,
such as the strength of an elephant (hasti) and others (adini),
the power of strength (bala) itself is known.
Commentary: Here (bala) strength and power is not limited to
physical strength, but also mental, psychic, and spiritual. III.
25 pravritti-aloka-nyasat sukshma-vyavahita-viprakrishta-jnanam
Through samyama upon (nyasat) the activities of the inner lights
(pravrtti-aloka), knowledge (jnanam) of the subtle (sukshmah),
the vyavahita (the secret and hidden), and the remote (viprakrishta)
is revealed. Commentary: Another way of translating this is that
by calming down or settling out (nyasat) the mental processes
that produce the agitations of the mind (pravrtti), then the
inner energy and light that becomes freed up by that process can
be directed to (aloka) reveal knowledge (jnanam) of what has
been previously subtle, hidden, and remote. A third
interpretation is by directing samyama upon (nyasat) the
activities of the inner light (pravrtti-aloka) knowledge of the
subtle, veiled, and heretofore unobtainable becomes realized.
Again Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says: "Samyama on the inner
light (by prãnãyãm), one gets knowledge of sukshma (subtle),
vyavahit (hidden) and viprakrishta (far distant) objects and
phenomena." III. 26 bhuvana-jnanam surye samyamat Samyama on the
solar principle (surya) within as well as the sun provides
access to the universal order of all the elements -- the
physical constellations -- or macrocosm -- both the outer and
inner universe including the chakras (bhavana-jnanam).
Commentary: Here the hatha, tantric, laya, or hatha yogin may
perform samyama on the function of the solar nadis (pingala) and
solar energy, but it helpful to the yogi to note that in terms
of non-duality -- the solar energy exists within the overall
context of unity of both the macrocosm and microcosm -- the both/and
non-dual reality where THAT which is outside is within as well.
The solar energy flows in the pingala nadis and is associated
with the right side of the body, the right nostril, and the left
brain functions (motor functions, activity, intellectual thought,
external thought, outward motion, centrifugal motion, objective
consciousness, etc.). Surya is thus the energy of external or
physical existence, so here the samyama focuses on the macrocosm,
of which the body, the organs, nervous system, brain, and atoms
are also included.
III. 27 chandre tara-vyuha-jnanam Samyama on the moon elements (chandre)
and stars (Sara) both within and without accesses knowledge of
order of the entire logos or divine Creatrix (vyuha-jnanam), the
microcosm or blueprint which forms the underlay of all existence.
This includes the body, the cells, the dna, chakras, and nadis
as well. Commentary: The firmament and moon are visible and
dominant at night. Just like 28 above the yogi can apply samyama
inside to the ida nadi and its function as the moon energy which
is associated with the right brain, the left nostril, and the
left side of the body. This is the right brain energy of
receptivity, innate wisdom, intuition, instinct, microcosm,
sensory nerves, restfulness, para-sympathetic nervous system,
female, earth, nature, and similar). Again the yogi is reminded
that in the great balance of REALITY -- where yoga is
accomplished -- the microcosm and macrocosm are bound together
in the state of ALL OUR RELATIONS, i.e., we are not separate,
but rather united. The Sun and Moon are simply used as methods
of focus upon the polar opposites -- siva/shakti who are in
terms of non-dual Reality eternally inseparable. Vyuha is a well
discussed term in both Hindu and Buddhist philosophy. The
fundamentalists say that vyuha is not knowable by humans, but
rather one must rely on scripture, however yogis say that all is
accessible within and must be experienced.
Vyuha connotes that in each "part" of the whole, the entire
whole can be accessed and known -- within a holographic Realty (see
for example the work of Dr. Stan Grof, M.D. author of "the
Holotropic Mind" , founder of holotropic breathwork, and
transpersonal training). Vyuha can be found to non-exclusive
from the modern western idea of morphic resonance, morphic
fields, and morphic genesis as presented by Dr. Rupert Sheldrake
(See his dialogue with Matthew Fox (the founder of Creation
Spirituality), the Physicist David Bohm (River of Truth) and
also Bohm's dialogue with Krishnamurti, Joanna Macy, Fritjof
Capra, and many others. III 28. dhruve tad-gati-jnanam Samyama
on the polestar (dhruve) and the highest spiritual position (sahasrara)
which lies within, provides access to the knowledge of the "causal
movement and flows" of prana (gati-jnanam) of the logos and
their integration/harmonization with the patterns of the nadis
inside and outside of the body (tad referring to sutra 27).
Commentary: Here the yogi may perform samyama also to the
brahmarandhra (the vertex of the crown) -- the point where
Source consciousness enters and leaves the physical body. This
integration/harmonization of the causal principle through
gati-jnanam is realized after sustained practice (abhyasa) as
part of the manifestation of the non-dual unity of microcosm/macrocosm
embodiment (the evolutionary process later called kundalini).
III. 29 nabhi-chakre kaya-vyuha-jnanam Through samyama upon the
workings of the navel chakra (called variously nabhi or
sometimes manipura). The inner knowledge (kaya-vyuha-jnanam) of
how all the nadis (energy channels) of the body and their
interrelated dynamics are revealed.
Commentary: In yoga and Ayurveda all the nadis and marmas (psychic
and energy channels) come together at the nabhi/manipura center.
This terse statement about the importance of the nabhi chakra
can be expanded as a system of actively performing energy
healing not only in the well known and ancient eastern systems
of Ayurveda, acupuncture, chi gong, hatha yoga, kundalini yoga,
laya yoga, Tibetan medicine, psychic healing, and similar where
energy is brought into the navel center, but also in the more
modern day wholistic healing systems, of Chi Nei Tsang, Reiki,
Pranic Healing, BMC work, Postural Integration, Core Energetics,
Hakomi, and others where techniques are used to clear, energize,
and direct the energy at the navel center so that it can be
moved throughout the body for healing and activating our
creative and evolutionary potential (kundalini). Also see sutra
40 as a further evolution of this process.See also sutra 40. III.
30 kantha-kupe kshut-pipasa-nivrittih Samyama on the throat
chakra (vishudda), one is able to be liberated from thirst and
hunger. Commentary: Literally kantha is the throat and kupe is
the notch above the sternum, thus the energy of jalandhara (the
abode of water) bandha is utilized to move the energy to connect
body with head through the throat, by softening the throat,
lengthening the cervical spine, and removing any obstructions at
the vishuddha (throat) chakra. By preventing the outflow of
energy at this chakra which connects the head with the heart,
outward desire is turned inward toward divine passion and
reunification. III. 31 kurma-nadyam sthairyam The power of
strength, steadiness, and balance (sthairyam) is revealed
through samyama on the kurma nadi (the energy that runs in the
psychic nerve between the eyes and the navel).
Commentary: Through samyama on kurma nadis one is able to remain
centered and connected to their core energy no matter how strong
the external distraction or noise may appear to others. Kurma
literally means, turtle. In Ayurveda it refers to the pranic
dynamic air associated with the eyeball movements (and the head
energies in general) which flow through a tube connecting the
head with the belly closely associated with the esophageal/pharynx.
This energetic also has a subtle psychic aspect as well as
physical. However in the tantras and agamas, but especially in
the Bhavana Upanishad of the Sri Vidya tradition, kurma is
associated with the muladhara chakra while in the Jnanasankalini
Tantra, kurma is situated in the chakras. It is well worth
mentioning that in Hindu wisdom stories (the Puranas) Vishnu
assumed the form of a tortoise (as Lord Kurma) and took the
newly created earth on his back in order to render stability to
the trembling globe. It is believed that even to this day the
earth is supported on the back of this tortoise, A more
elaborate recount of the legend is that at a very remote period
when the gods felt their powers weakened and were desirous of
obtaining amrita the beverage of immortality, Vishnu directed
them to churn, together with the demons, the ocean of milk. For
this purpose they took the mountain Mandara as the churning
stick. But they could succeed only when Vishnu himself consented
to support the mountain on his back; after having assumed the
shape of a gigantic tortoise. From the churning of the ocean, in
addition to the ambrosia of immortality, the following
substances came forth: 1). Dhanvantri, the physician of the gods,
2). Lakshmi, the goddess of fortune, 3). Varuni, the wine
goddess, 4). Soma, the sacrificial elixir, 5). Apsaras, the
celestial nymphs, 6). Uccaihshravas, the divine horse, 7).
Kaustubha, the celestial jewel, 8). Parijata, the celestial tree,
9). Surabhi, the wish cow, 10). Airavata, the royal elephant,
11). Panchajanya, the conch, 12). Sharanga, the bow, and 13).
Halahala, the poison.
See Kurma, the second Avatar of Vishnu for more. There thus
exists a a correspondence to an American Indian story about the
earth being a turtle island The Siva Samhita in Chapter V 43-45
43 it is said: "43.Let the Yogi seat himself in the padmasana,
and fix his attention on the cavity of the throat, let him place
his tongue at the base of the palate; by this he will extinguish
hunger and thirst. 44. Below the cavity of the throat, there is
a beautiful nadi (vessel) called kurma; when the Yogi fixes his
attention on it, he acquires great concentration of the thinking
principle (chitta). 45. When the Yogi constantly thinks that he
has got a third eye – the eye of Shiva – in the middle of his
forehead, he then perceives a fire brilliant like lightening. By
contemplating on this light, all sins are destroyed, and even
the most wicked person obtains the highest end." Thus one
differentiates between the kurma prana and the kurma nadis. III.
32. murdha-jyotishi siddha-darshanam Samyama on the light (jyotishi)
that appears in the crown of the head (murdha) during meditation,
one has the vision (darshan) of the siddhas (realized beings --
those who have obtained perfection in union). The eternal ones
are always HERE to help us. III. 33. pratibhad va sarvam Or (va)
these can happen spontaneously and naturally all at once (sarvam)
like an intuitive inner flash of light (pratibhad). Commentary:
By opening the intuition the inner wisdom, teacher, and
teachings are revealed -- HERE all is known. All such siddhas,
knowledge, or abilities (sarvam) can appear through the
activation of the inner light, inner wisdom, intuition, the
normally dormant inner self abiding teacher in all which not
only produces temporary flashes or glimpses into the true nature
of the whole of creation, but always exists in truth as the true
nature of Universal Natural Mind when it shines forth
uninterrupted in grace. Likewise samyama on the inner light,
inner most teacher, inner wisdom (pratibhad), the true authentic
self, etc., can augment and activate this process. All we need
is for the inner wisdom/teacher to be activated bringing the
cit-prana to zero in onto the subject. This can occur as grace
through practice or simply grace (through past karma) as well.
III. 34. hridaye chitta-samvit By the practice of samyama on the
spiritual heart (hridaya) knowledge of the heart-mind (hridaye
chitta-samvit) -- the origin of transpersonal all inclusive
consciousness itself is known. Commentary: The hridayam center
is the heart of hearts -- the holy of the holies -- the sacred
temple -- the seat of God Source -- the holographic axis mundi,
or what can be called our core heart center is realized when we
arrive at an integrative realization (samvit) of the true nature
of citta as the true nature of the inherent intelligent
consciousness principle. This understanding is accompanied by
true vision (samvit) and is beyond ordinary understanding based
on words or objectification/cognition processes. It normally
remains ineffable and elusive toward articulation. It is fitting
that Patanjali brings up the hridayam after the crown chakra
which in turn is preceded by the central channel and the other
higher chakras. When we act from this heart center our actions
embody the essence of all the yam/niyams -- all the limbs of
yoga manifest naturally. This then is the heart of the practice
-- to be centered in our core/heart energy -- to realize our
true Self nature -- to embody that in ALL OUR RELATIONS. III. 35
sattva-purusayor atyanta-samkirnayoh pratyayavisesah bhogah
pararthavat svartha-samyamat purusa-jnanam By samyama on the
origin and true nature of intent and samyama itself (svartha-samyamat),
the false distinction (asamkirnayoh) between perfect sattva (absolute
beingness) and pure purusha (absolute consciousness) ceases to
be experienced (bhoga). Through this realization (called
purusa-jnananam) this unity of sattva-purusayor is everywhere at
once experienced (bhoga) as the Eternal Self (as purusha) in all
things and beings, as it truly exists, and as it always has been
(atyanta) -- as the true knowledge and untainted absolute
consciousness (the realization of purusha-jnanam). Here our
intention and directions of thought (pratyaya) no longer wavers
(avisesa) from this realization of self (purusa-jnanam) with the
unification of sattva and purusa (sattva-purusayor). Commentary:
By samyama on the highest (para) purpose and meaning in life (para-arthatvat)
we experience the state (bhoga) where we no longer confusedly
make false assumptions and artificial arbitrary discrimination (asamkirnayoh)
thus separating ourselves from the eternal true nature of all
things (atyanta) in the sacred space of ALL OUR RELATIONS. Then
perfect beingness (sattva) and highest self (purusa) in
sattva-purusayor is experienced (bhoga).
Atyanta means beyond any end or beginning, unbroken, continuous,
absolute, or perfect. Asamkirnayoh means no longer confused,
mixed up, or rather pure. Svartha-
samyamat means performing samyama for its own purpose (svartha).
Thus one may say that by performing samyama upon samyama itself
brings about the experience which resolves the confusion between
the doer and the deed -- between pure beingness (sattva) and
pure consciousness (purusha). In other words it reveals their
unity in satchitananda -- pure beingness -- pure consciousness
and pure bliss. This is another place which can't be experienced
via the intellect, but only through experienced through practice.
In a profound sense then purusha really exists only where there
is no separation between beingness (sattva) and consciousness
(in sat-chit-ananda). For example in that deep state of
stillness -- of non-doing, only then do we rest in pure
receptivity (non-doing) beingness. At the same time in this
non-doingness, we are absolutely receptive. To be absolutely
receptive is to merge with absolute awareness and consciousness.
So here through perfect and absolute beingness (sat) we merge
with absolute consciousness (chit) whose nature is bliss (ananda)
-- in Satchitananda. HERE and only here does pure and absolute
subjectivity and pure and absolute objectivity merge as one.
HERE in purusha-jnanam, is purusha is at once absolute and
universal Being and absolute and universal Consciousness. Swami
Venkatesananda says: "The external object is totally distinct
and different from what the experiencing personality thinks it
is. When, in a state of ignorance, the personality forgets this,
and as the object is imagined to be external for the enjoyment
of another (which is the enjoyer), he experiences pain and
pleasure. However when samyama is directed at the essence of
this (false) self or personality, there (eventually) arises the
knowledge (jnana) of the INDWELLING intelligence, (disclosing
its previously) obscured conditioning (which is ignorance)." III.
36 tatah pratibha-sravana-vedana-adarsa-asvada-vartah jayante
Since knowledge of ignorance is the antidote for ignorance, when
the innate intuitive intelligence (pratibha) that comprehends
the mental conditioning which then becomes deprogrammed, then
self luminous flashes of psychic or transcendental hearing (sravana),
feeling (vedana), seeing (adarsa), tasting (asvada), and
smelling (vartah) self arise (jayante) -- free from the normal
contaminating distortions, limitations, and dissuasions (perversions)
that are the products of ignorance. Hence is born spontaneously
an evolved natural and intuitive non-dual and trans-personal
form of hearing, touching, seeing, tasting, and smelling not
dependent upon individual cognitive functions (such as pratyaya,
pratyaksha, samprajnata, etc.). Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says:
"By performing the above described samyama, the knowledge of the
six super sensory perceptions are evolved:- 1. Pratibha =
clairvoyance; 2. Shravan = super sensory hearing capability to
hear divine sounds; 3. Vedana = super sensory sense of touch; 4.
adarsha = ability to see the divine beings; 5. asvada = ability
to sense subtle tastes; 6. Varta = super sensory capability to
smell divine fragrances. By doing the above Samyama, all of
these sensory perceptions become Nitya (permanent)." III. 37 te
samadhav upasarga vyutthane siddhayah Although to the worldly (vyutthane)
these samadhis (samadhav) appear as perfections or attainments (siddhayah),
they are the cause of impediments (upasarga). Commentary: The
goal of yoga being total transpersonal integration, a wise yogi
stays focused on the goal and avoids the possible temptation of
the siddhis as mere side trips to be avoided. Others become
infatuated by them or worse mistakenly think that they do not
come from universal Source but rather from individual will. Such
pride and confusion eventually creates a separation from Source,
Grace, and the Natural Mind and thus these aspirants eventually
fall back into the hell realms through ignorance and the
negative karma generated by acting on such ignorance. The more
powerful the action, the more potential negative karma. Swami
Venkatesananda warns us that little children should not play
with matches. "But, even such excellent sensations and feelings
and all the psychic powers discussed so far, which on the
surface appear to be desirable and encouraging aspects of
perfection are in fact impediments to enlightenment as they, too,
distract and externalize the attention." from Swami
Venkatesananda "Enlightened Living" III. 38
bandha-karana-saithilyat prachara-samvedanach cha chittasya Thus
by loosening (saithilyat) the bonds (bandhas) of the causes (karana)
of ignorance because of the coming forth (prachara) of knowledge
(samvedanat), consciousness of self and of others (chittasya)
come forth.
Commentary: It is from this sutra that many interpret Patanjali
as saying that this process pertains to the way of entering and
controlling the consciousness and body of other beings, but here
he is simply saying that as one understands how to loosen one's
own bondage unraveling its causes, one also instantly
understands the causes of bondage operating in others, and thus
one is able to help direct them toward liberation if favorable
karmic opportunities arise. Here simply being in the presence of
a highly realized being is often enough to directly assimilate
that state. Here bandha refers to a gate process which can
either prevent something from entering or to hold something that
may wander off in distraction inside or redirected. Here it is
used in the former sense, to let something in. III. 39
udana-jayat-jala-panka-kantaka-adishu asanga utkrantis-ca
Through knowledge of how the energy of upward motion (udana vayu)
occurs in the nadis, freedom (asanga) from material and earthly
attachments (imperviousness to mud (panka), water (jal), thorns
(kantaka), etc. (adisu) and even the ability to rise up or
levitation (utkrantih) occurs. Commentary: Udana is the upward
moving energy vector in the body operating from the region of
the navel upwards to the head. III. 40 samana-jayaj jvalanam
Self effulgent radiance shines forth (jvalanam) by itself when
the yogi masters (jayaj) samana (the knowledge of how the energy
located in the navel region and which is responsible for the
fire of digestion) operates in the nadis. Commentary: Samana
prana is the centripetal energy moving from the periphery of the
body into and towards the interior centered at the navel and
which is responsible on a multidimensional level for digestion
and integration; i.e., physical, mental, emotional, energetic,
and physical, It is literally translated as the balancing and
equanamous air. Here nourishment and charisma pervades the
body/mind of such a being. Also see commentary on sutra 29. III.
41 srota-akasayoh sambandha samyamad diviam srotam Samyama on
both the connecting valve (sambandha) between the area behind
the ear (strota) and the seat of akasha (the ether/akasha center
is located at the throat - vishuddi chakra), hence establishing
(chit-prana or conscious energy flow through the nadis),
activates the supra-mundane divine hearing (diviam srotam) or
clairaudience which thus becomes awakened.
Commentary: Specifically we can hear the conversations of the
enlightened ones, the subtle mental conversations of others, the
celestial music, and receive messages through the ether both
awake or while asleep, as if they were spoken or whispered
whether or not they exist through the medium of sound waves as
such. Likewise we can hear the language of all beings and things
(past, future, or present), but not in the terms of the human
language which we have learned, but rather they speak to us in
their energetic/spiritual terms which our subtle inner ear has
to become attuned to. Just as the activation of the third eye
allows for the seeing of the non-physical realms, the activation
of the spiritual nose for the supra-mundane smelling, so does
the opening of the spiritual ear allow for the immersion into
the divine sound energy (sabda) and the realization of the
divine name. III. 42 kaya-akashayoh sambandha-samyamat
laghu-tula-samapatteh ca akasagamanam By communion (samyama) on
the connections (sambandha) within and between the etheric body
(kaya-akashayoh) - while opening up that connection -- one
becomes absorbed (samapatteh) in the power of the upward (laghu)
etheric motion (akasa-gamanam) and is able to raise upward like
a single cotton fiber (tula). The power of weightlessness and
lightness is achieved through such samyama/communion. III. 43
bahir akalpita vrttir maha-videha tatah prakasa avarana-ksayah
In this way the etheric body (kaya-akashayoh) provides the
portal for the removal of the habitual processes of externally
directed (bahir) conceptual thought (akalpita) which cause the
fluctuating patterns of thought waves (vrtti) allowing them to
be dissolved. Thus the veil (avarana) which occlude the
effulgent light of consciousness (prakasa) is thus pierced (ksayah)
revealing the great formless incorporeal body (maha-videha).
Swami Venkatesananda says: "Beyond all these is the state of
consciousness which is not the product of thought: and that is
the cosmic intelligence which is independent of the body (or
bodies - physical, astral and causal}. By communion (samyama)
upon that, the veil that covers that light of cosmic
intelligence is removed."
Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri translates this as: "The
externalized thought waves of the mind which is attached to the
body and the ego is illusory, whereas the internalized thought
waves generated in the mind without the attachment of the body
and ego are called Mahãvidehã. By making a samyama in
that Mahãvidehã, the shell obstructing the inner light is
destroyed, and all hindrances are removed." III. 44 sthula
svarupa suksma anvayarth-arthavattva samyamad bhuta jayah
Samyama on the underlying essential true nature (swarupa), both
gross (sthula) and subtle (suksma), of the correlative
interactive connections (anvaya), and their specific qualities
and functional processes (arthavattva) leads to successful
understanding (jayah) of the creative elements (bhuta) that
constitute all existence. Commentary: Mastery of elemental
matter is achieved after samyama on the true nature which
connects and underlies it all, rather than upon separate
isolated phenomena. After much meditation one perceives that all
coarse (sthula) matter is in motion -- dancing in its
characteristic pattern in its place with all of nature. The rock
is dancing energy. The heretofore mystery of energy and matter
is revealed as part of the Divine dance of shiva/shakti. The
yogi no longer is fooled by gross physical appearances nor
subtle superficialities, but rather knows "Self" to be the
unitive flow of that dance and dancer. It is said that such
understanding will allow a yogi to change form/shape at will.
HERE the yogi has entered into the Tandava (Siva's dance which
reveals the underlying emptiness of the constituents of material
temporal existence which are always in the stage of flux, thus
removing such obscurations.) As our consciousness becomes more
clear, the more subtle (suksma) relationships occurring within
the etheric body are revealed and hence also ALL OUR RELATIONS.
III. 45 tatah anima-adi-pradurbhavah kaya-sampat-tad
dharma-anabhighatas ca From that follows (tato) the ability to
become as small as an atom (animah-adi) and similar abilities to
change visible appearances (pradurbhava) of the body (kaya) so
that bodily invulnerability or unassailability of the body (dharma-anabhihatas).
The perfect body is achieved (kaya sampat) from where one
remains free from the onslaught of the variegated laws of nature
(dharma) such as the five elements etc. Commentary: The true
omniscient Self is everywhere -- in all things. The dance
continues -- large or small -- light or heavy. As a progression
from the understanding gained in the previous three sutras about
the etheric body, lightness, and levitation, but all the
previous sutras can be seen as a steady progression. We are
moving here into increasingly more stages. Not only is the
physical body perfected, but the rainbow or vajra body free from
destruction of the elements is achieved (adamantine and
impervious). Besides the kaya-sampat and dharma-anabhighatas
siddhis listed in sutra 45, it is traditional here to list the
eight major siddhis which are: 1. Anima: power to become very
small; 2. Laghima: power to become very light; 3. Mahima: power
to become very large; 4. Prãpti: power to obtain anything. (These
above four are achieved by samyama on the sthula or gross
elements). 5. Prãkãmya: fulfillment of any desire at will; This
is attained by the samyama on the Svarupa (the characteristics
of the gross elements). 6. Vashitva: control of all the gross
elements and their material manifestations. This is attained by
the samyama on the sukshma rupa (subtle bodies) of the elements.
7. Ishitritva: power to create and destroy the gross and
material manifestations; This power is attained by the samyama
on anvayaya. 8. Kãmavashãyitva: fulfillment of what is
determined by the yogi. This power is attained by the samyama on
the arthavatva. III. 46 rupa-lavanya-bala-vajra-samhananatyani
kaya-sampat And as a result then, beauty (rupa), grace (lavanya),
strength (bala), and indestructible endurability (vajrasamhananatyani)
manifest spontaneously as attributes of the body of perfection (kaya
sampat). Commentary: As a natural result of the previous
practices, accomplishments, and harmonization we become
permeated with shakti's divine grace, form (which is beauteous),
and strength regularly. In grace the yantra of the integration
of body, mind, spirit, nature, and breath shines forth from the
inside reflecting the universal truth of Creation/Creator as
omnipresent. As such it must exist inside us as well. III. 47
grahana-svarupasmita-anvaya-arthavattva-samyamad indriya-jayah
Samyama on the sense objects, on their their grasping (grahana),
their qualitative nature as they are (svarupa), their
fragmentary appearance as separate objects (asmita), their
mutual or comparative co-relationship (anvaya), and their
projected or ascribed significance given to it (arthavattva) in
relation to the non-dual indwelling intelligence (without which
they would be unable to function) will bring forth a complete
direct understanding and hence proficiency and mastery over the
function of sense organs (indriya-jayah) i.e., freedom from
their bias ensues. Commentary: Although Patanjali is not
tarditionally categorized as being a tantric yogi, this sutra
lays the foundation of tantric practice where the yogi
investigates the created universe, the elements, the bodily
functions, etc. all as an integral part of the all inclusive
unbiased non-dual whole -- as a path back to total integration
with creator/creator (siva/shakti). When perception through the
human faculties of eye, ear,
nose, throat, tongue, and touch becomes clarified through
samyama (through their modalities) then the anthropocentric
prejudice of such organs become refined so that we may see
things as they really are without the ordinary limitations of
the five senses -- through a multidimensional and holographic
universal perspective (through the sixth sense), When we have
understood the limitations of the five senses by practicing
samyama on their functions then a deeper awareness (often called
the sixth sense) arises -- beyond the temporal limitations of
time/space. Then we are centered beyond bias or skew, but rather
in the light of Universal Intelligence (Infinite Mind) -- the
context of ALL OUR RELATIONS. III. 48 tato manojavitam
vikarana-bhavah pradhana-jayash cha Thus (tato) when such
understanding has been gained, the senses function with the
coordinated and integrated frictionless swiftness (javitvam)
quickening the mind (manas), and thus there is direct perception
without the need of intermediary instruments (even the sense
organs) creating supramundane sensory awareness and ability (vikaranabhavah)
and more importantly realization of oneness with the one's
essential cosmic nature (pradhana). Commentary: Here the
limitations of the five senses are liberated (vikarana)
bestowing victory to the original Source or Spirit (pradhana-jayash)
which in turn amplifies and quickens the mind (manojavitam) so
it is said that one is functioning in a supersensory mode (vikarana-bhavah).
Body, mind, spirit are HERE integrated. HERE in this
transpersonal integrative state one has transmuted the ordinary
mind and sense perception rooted in the separateness (Sutra 47)
and thus it is figuratively said that one is seeing with the
sixth sense (or through third eye). One is permeated by spirit
and animated by shakti recognizing Self in all -- divine
presence is experienced unto the tips of the toes, the spaces
between the atoms, and throughout the furthest reaches of the
universe. HERE one acts spontaneously, naturally, fully,
completely, unrestrained, hindered, joyfully, and creatively.
Not only is the timeless heart sensitivity awakened. but this
awakening simultaneously amplifies the other five senses acting
as a catalyst. Then (after Sutra 47) The non-dual transpersonal
Reality of ALL OUR RELATIONS -- of Shakti shining through all of
Creation becomes revealed and even apparent. Yogiraj
Shyamacharan Lahiri says:
"By the mastery of the sense organs, one attains the mastery
over the Nature by: Manoja Vitvam = becoming as fast as the mind
(by the samyama on Grahana); Vikarna Bhavah = manifestation of
the power of sensory perceptions in acquiring information which
is beyond the scope of the body (by the samyama on Svarupa);
Pradhãna_Jayah = control over all manifestations of the Prakriti
(by samyama on AsmitManoja_Vitvam Vikarna_Bhavah Pradhãna,
Anvaya, and Arthavatva)." III. 49
sattva-purusa-anyata-khyati-matrasya sarva-bhava-adhisthatritvam
sarva-jnatrtvam ca The self knowledge of being a knower (jnatrtvam)
is grasped by making the distinction (anyata) between purusa (witness
consciousness) and sattva (the pure and balanced wave of pure
beingness). These two poles of consciousness and beingness --
Self and Nature -- Source and Creation form between them the
unitive basis of all knowledge. they are indeed one in
satchitananda. Swami Venkatesananda says about this esoteric
sutra: "The direct realization of the independence of the
indwelling intelligence from the mind, that is from the
conditions to which the psychic and the physical nature is
subject, brings with it superintendence over all states of being,
an omniscience." Commentary: "Everything" appears to exist
between the two poles of pure consciousness and pure beingness
-- between unmanifest absolute witness consciousness (purusha)
and manifest creation -- between creator and creation. These are
the two poles of existence which are married as one in the
creative process -- the unity of siva/shakti -- the sky and
earth, the crown and earth chakras -- the same uncreated self
nature of the absolute undifferentiated and formless
consciousness on one hand and the myriad forms of differentiated
creation on the other. Within these poles all that can be
grasped or known exists. Here Patanjali discusses the first step
of our journey from corruption to integration -- from
fragmentation to unity, that of recognizing the difference,
i.e., first to discriminate between the seeming disparity
between these two primary forces of sattva and purusha (pure
beingness and pure consciousness) in our ordinary or normal
every day dualistic and fragmented existence where the illusion
of a known and he/she who knows exists. This is our normal (but
unnatural) pre-existing milieu where theory and practice do not
harmonize and synergize. From this recognition of their present
fragmentation and disparity, we begin to see with clarity,
eventually becoming able to consciously consummate their divine
marriage in absolute liberation (kaivalyam) in Sutra 55.
The meaning of this sutra is inscrutable only when it is studied
out of context with the following five sutras. Here the gross
impediments of the fragmentary way of seeing and being are being
purified, as we move from power struggles and attachment over
objects and toward things (from the dualistic fragmented world
of separation) into the non-dual, non-linear, and egoless world
of an unconditioned natural pre-existing unitive living
consciousness -- where struggle, strife, and slavery is nought.
In other words the separation of shiva/shakti is the illusion,
while in Reality they are married/united. Separate things appear
as real in making the dualistic distinction between purusha and
sattva -- consciousness and beingness -- spirit and nature --
creator/creation or just plain shiva/shakti. In truth Purusa is
the great being (Param Purusa or Jnanam Purusha (see III.35
above). this realization leads to absolute liberation (kaivalyam).
See below (III.55, the final sutra in Vibhuti Pada ) and
Kaivalyam Pada. Sutra 34 (the final Sutra of the Yoga Sutras).
III. 50 tad-vairagyad api dosa-bija-kshaye kaivalyam Through
non-attachment (vairagyat) [to the difference between sattva and
purusa] the seed causes (bija) of diseases and imbalances (dosa)
cease (ksaye). What remains is absolute liberation (kaivalyam)
-- complete integration/unification in oneness without
limitation -- the experiential Reality of ALL OUR RELATIONS.
Swami Venkatesananda says: "When there is no craving or
attraction (vairagya) even for such supremacy and for such
omniscience, all of which suggest a division in consciousness,
and when the sense of duality which is the seed (bija) for
imperfection, impurity, or conditioned existence ceases (ksaye),
there is total freedom and a direct realization of the
indivisibility and hence the in-dependence of intelligence (kaivalyam)."
Likewise, Yogiraj Shyamacharan Lahiri says: "When one has
vairãgya (non attachment) even for these attainments, all the
seed of any sort of weakness are destroyed -- and then the
Kaivalya is attained."
Commentary: It may be worth pointing out that Patanjali places
an extremely high value on vairagya -- letting go (or
non-grasping) -- as being capable of leading us to kaivalyam
(ultimate liberation as the summum bonum of yoga. Although it
may be implied that Patanjali is referring to not being attached
to the siddhis in general, it appears that he is referring to
non-attachment to any object in general and specifically to any
specific qualification whatsoever, especially it must be applied
to the immediately preceding sutra (49) to the cessation of (non-grasping
upon) the process of making distinctions (anyata) between sattva
(beingness) and purusha (absolute consciousness). In other words
Patanjali is saying that beyond the boundary called knowledge,
there exists a non-dual unitive stage beyond the dissonance
between the
cognitive state and our experiential state -- between theory and
practice which he makes clear in sutra 55, stating quite clearly
that one must transcend viveka in order to realize absolute
liberation (kaivalyam) by realizing the pure unitive state (suddhi-samye)
of sattva-pursushaye (the profound uncontrived marriage of
absolute beingness and absolute consciousness). III. 51
sthany-upanimantrane sangha-smayakaranam punar anishta-prasangat
Decline (akaranam) to display or identify (sanga) with [your]
accomplishments in yoga, even when invited by (upanimantrane) a
respected source (sthani), because such has the potential of
reinforcing one's sense of separate self -- the small self, ego
sense, pride, or arrogance (smaya) which in turn (punar) is an
impediment (anista) toward further spiritual unfoldment; [but
rather it is more productive to attribute it to the grace of the
causeless Source of all.] Again Swami Venkatesananda: "Invitations
that involve the demonstration of such powers or of the
characteristics of enlightenment, even when extended by those in
authority whether on earth or in heaven are summarily rejected
without being swayed by attachment or even curiosity. Otherwise,
undesirable consequences may arise again, by the revival of
duality, superiority, hope and despair, etc." Again Yogiraj
Shyamacharan Lahiri: "One should not get allured or flattered
when tempted by the many, once the respective stages of yoga
have been attained by yogis." Commentary: Here this sutra says
that there can exist no draw, no seduction, no attraction, and
no momentum back into the realm of attachment and pride once one
has become well established (sthani) once the taste of kaivalyam
has been reached (see sutra 50).
Patanjali gives us warning that the powers do not come from
separateness, fragmentation, or the small "self". Rather any
such achievements are to be attributed to the process of yoga (integration)
itself that discloses the non-dual transpersonal reality -- the
Sat Guru. The trap that Patanjali is warning us about is that if
a practitioner is seduced into attributing siddhi to individual
effort, then that has the potential to reinforce or increase
one's identification to (sanga) ego pride and arrogance (smaya),
thus perpetuating an eventual fall into corruption (note that
accomplishment in yoga by definition comes from integration, not
fragmentation). Similarly even attributing success to your guru,
lineage, teaching, cult, religion, or practice in many cases
harbors the undesirable identification with a group pride -- an
attachment and imprisonment to separateness, aloofness, or
similarly contribute toward fortifying arrogance and thus serves
to holds the practitioner back from ultimate liberation. Here
one must be clear to avoid reinforcing the insidious
ossifications of pride or ego, yet still be able to be
instructive to some one who is genuinely seeking instruction
upon the spiritual path. To this end the application of the
non-dual transpersonal wisdom and its realization is most
helpful, while the one who instructs as well as animates us all
is, in reality, the union of Source and Creation (siva/shakti).
In the non-dual yoga framework then any such instruction is a
gift to both the "instructor" and the "instructed" -- both can
identify as a spiritual friends and fellow seekers who are
dedicated to the process of spiritual exploration -- a further
journey into the large all encompassing"Self".
So in this way we can thus revert back again to the discussion
of the development of the siddhis as a perverted end itself
within the fragmented context of separateness (ego) on one hand,
and that of siddhis as a natural evolution of consciousness in
the transpersonal non-dual context of what is called the Long
Body of the Iroquois Nation, or the Long Body of the Great
Integrity, the all encompassing body of Hatha Yoga, the
Visualization Sadhana of the Kalachakra Tantra, or the Self
Woven body of the Nirmanakaya in Vajrayana Buddhism (caution:
this last document is large, in PDF format and is an advanced
treatise on the manifestation of transpersonal space). To sum up
this process, as a certain amount of obscurations are removed
from the field of consciousness, then simultaneously the field
of consciousness proportionately becomes illuminated and thus
revealed. What previously was called extra sensory or super
sensory perception and powers become revealed in the light of
the greater expanse as the underlying reality of "what-is".
However these revelations are not revealed to the viewer in the
framework of duality, i.e., they are not individual powers that
can be possessed or even borrowed, because the very point of
view of duality and separateness veils and obscures it.
Thus it becomes clear that in the non-dual context of yoga,
seeking the siddhis as an end in itself is a counterproductive
folly. So Patanjali says to avoid flattery or praise from anyone
even if they claim high authority (even if they appear as gods).
Avoid invitations by others (even if they appear to be well
meaning) to show off your powers, list your qualifications, or
even espouse your accomplishments or achievements for such has
the potential to feed your sense of separateness and pride, and
thus eventually create obstacles toward ultimate integration (samadhi)
and liberation (kaivalyam). Patanjali's advice should be taken
to heart on an every day basis as well. For example when some
one asks you how long you meditate, how long you practice, can
you wrap your legs around your head, who are your teachers, what
books have you read, or any such questions that may be
attributed to "personal accomplishments", Patanjali suggests
that this snare be side stepped in order to avoid undesirable
effects (anista). III. 52 kshana-tat-kramayoh samyamad vivekajam
jnanam Thus letting go of all that, one then practices samyama
upon vivekajam jnanam itself allowing one to destroy the
limitations of straight line reality, third dimensional thinking
of time and place, and thus enter the sacred instantaneous
moment (kshana) of the eternal now. Again Swami Venkatesananda "Undistracted
by these, one should proceed to transcend time. By the practice
of the three-fold discipline in relation to the truth of the
moment, without the interference of thought which creates the
false sequence of time, there arises understanding which is born
of the faculty to perceive the false as false and hence truth as
truth." Commentary: Ordinary or coarse knowledge of apparently
separate things (the dualistic I-It world) is an artificial
imposition of sequential ordering upon the profound non-arisen
and unobstructed instant presence. This profound sacred presence
can not be talked about successfully with words, but must be
experienced through functionally applied yoga practice (abhyasa).
This is not a mere intellectual concept that can be reached
through philosophical inquiry. memorization, or logic, but
rather it is the summum bonum of meditation. Samyama on the
profound instantaneousness of each moment -- being in the sacred
moment -- being truly present --here --living in the moment, the
profound knowledge (jnanam) of the processes that transcend the
application of discriminatory knowledge (vivekajam) blossoms
forth. At the beginning of our meditation practices viveka (watching
the mind) in order to prevent it being distracted and dissipated
is necessary, but we also can apply samyama to achieve similar
goals and even to direct the mental, physical, energetic, and
wisdom bodies so that they align up with the holographic reality
that is not bounded by linear time or three dimensional space --
turiya. Some translate this as the realization of the siddhi of
time travel through the seeing through (by samyama) of the
illusion of time or the illusory and arbitrary ordering of
sequential linear events. Thus this can also be translated as
the observance of the eternal spirit or sacred unborn eternal
unending presence. See also sutra 49.
Samyama on discriminatory awareness itself frees us from the
limitations of linear straight line thinking. Here we enter into
the holographic transpersonal inter-dimensional timeless realm
called turiya- ALL OUR RELATIONS.
III. 53 jati-laksana-desair anyata-anavachchedat-tulyayos-tatah
pratipattih From Swami Venkatesananda "From such understanding
flows knowledge or the natural ability to distinguish between
reality and appearance, even where they do not have other
obvious distinguishing marks related to their species,
characteristics and location and hence seem to be similar. The
possibility of confusion is thus completely overcome."
Commentary: Having first understood the difference between the
object being observed and the one who observes it, then one
understands the limitations of comparative knowledge itself
through realizing that no two apparently individual things or
objects can be fully known through mere reductionist comparative
processes (just as the blade of grass in the valley cannot be
fully understood without the knowledge of the valley floor, the
rain, the sunshine, photosynthesis, the air, etc. Thus the
dualistic veil is lifted. A revelation between limited
appearances and reality is realized (pratipattih). From the
non-dual context "things" are not limited by differences (anyata)
be it of: origination or genetic matrix (jati), ascribed
appearances, manifested qualities, or symbolic representation (lakshana),
setting or context (desaih).
Although the ability to separate and discern still exist, it no
longer dominates or occludes the mind. The practitioner is no
longer seduced into the disparate dualistic linear temporal
world of illusion/confusion, but rather observes the sacred in
all -- residing in the non-dual all inclusive universal
beginningless/never ending realm of ALL OUR RELATIONS (anavacchedat)
in the eternal moment. III. 54 tarakam sarva-vishayam
sarvatha-visayam-akraman ca-iti viveka-jam jnanam Viveka-jam
jnanam is a integrative (taraka) wisdom (jnanam) that allows us
to go beyond viveka (the process of discriminatory awareness),
which allows us to join up with a universal unitive perspective
(which has no limitations in respect to place, setting, or time)
--which is not limited by reductionist/analytical thought --
which simultaneously encompasses all objects (sarva visayam),
processes, or conditions (visaya) -- reaching beyond all endings
(sarvatha) where all impositions and limitations of sequential
time or linear thinking (akrama) are liberated.
Swami Venkatesananda says:
"Such wisdom born of intuitive and immediate understanding is
the sole redeemer. It is everything. It has everything. It
encompasses everything. It is the unconditioned and undivided
intelligence spontaneously functioning from moment to moment in
the eternal now, without sequential relationship." Commentary:
Here we are not addressing ordinary discriminatory wisdom --
comparative knowledge of "things", dualistic objects of thought,
or processes as compared to other things, objects, and processes
to which those who are slaves to reductionist modes of logic are
addicted, but rather the broadening (taraka) of ordinary
discriminatory awareness (viveka) and three dimensional linear
ways of thinking, toward an intimate, non-linear,
multi-dimensional direct knowledge of the process of this
awareness itself (viveka-jam jnanam). HERE in this way we move
from the fragmentary, corrupt, dual and linear straight line
contexts of separate objects visayam akraman) into the circular
open-ended boundless context of non-dual wisdom which provides
in itself knowledge (jam jnanam) and understanding of the
relativistic limitation of the processes of viveka (analytical
discrimination). Thus this special liberatory wisdom (tarakam)
provides its own remediation to to the boundaries of ordinary
discriminatory thought (which is based on objective comparison
and isolation) because it has lead us to abide in the intrinsic
light which is all inclusive, non-sequential, non-linear, and
unbounded. Risking repetitiveness, this nonlinear transcendental
wisdom (tarakam) should not be confused with ordinary
discriminatory knowledge (viveka), but rather the all inclusive
integrative wisdom (taraka) which is the result of the direct
non-dual experience of ALL OUR RELATIONS. In other words by
applying viveka with pure awareness, we become aware of the
principle of awareness itself which illumines the process of
discrimination which obviates its need. In a parallel way, in
hatha, kundalini, laya, and tantra yoga, one practices pratyhara,
by withdrawing attention and energy from the duality of "i-it"
consciousness -- the "appearance" of independent sense objects
-- the artificial dualistic illusion of a material reality, and
then enter into a deeper non-dual awareness which binds all
things together -- thus the practitioner abides inside of and is
embraced by the Great Implicate Integrity of All things by
embracing "IT". HERE as a separate object (visayam) the
practitioner (as ego) must get out of the way in order to
experience (bhoga) sacred presence. See commentary under Sutra
52. III. 55 sattva-purusayoh shuddhi-samye kaivalyam
By perfectly balancing (samye) pure beingness (sattva) with pure
undifferentiated universal consciousness (purusa) the
obstructions are removed (shuddhi) thus disclosing and opening
the gate to kaivalyam (absolute liberation).
Swami Venkatesananda: "When there is pure equilibrium (shuddhi-sumye)
which is non-division between the indwelling consciousness and
all (objective) existence, between the nonmoving intelligence
and the ever-moving phenomena, between the unconditioned
awareness and the rise and fall of the 'The thousand thoughts' -
there is freedom and independence of the infinite -- it is no
longer confined, restricted, or bound." Commentary: HERE
Patanjali addresses the profound power of balance and
synchronicity in yoga. HERE the purity (shuddhi) of purusha (consciousness)
and beingness (sattva) are synchronized (samye). This is the
point of III.35 and III.49 (the union of absolute beingness with
absolute consciousness in Sat-Chit-Ananda). HERE all dissonance
between the cognitive "reality" and experience is eliminated.
HERE the vrttis are annihilated. Purusha (as pure universal
witness consciousness) does not move and as such it is usually
identified with Undiminished Source -- Siva -- Eternal and
Absolute Reality. HERE, the word, shuddhi is used for, purity;
while by sattva, Patanjali means the synchronistic ground of
pure beingness, embodied existence, and/or creation which is
always moving in harmony with purusha. Thus when eternal spirit
or pure undifferentiated consciousness (purusha) is allowed to
merge into its natural state of balance, harmony, synchrony and
unity (samye) with and as pure absolute beingness, pure
existence, pure subjective experiential reality -- when nature/creation
in the overall non-dual context of the unity of siva/shakti ---
heaven and earth -- prana and apana, inhalation and exhalation,
sahasrara and muladhara chakras are married into a profound
synchronicity in authentic yoga, then ascension has occurred in
a liberation that knows no bounds (kaivalyam) -- total or
absolute freedom is realized while alive (jivamukti). In tantric
practice the yogi learns how to balance and synchronize the
pingala and ida energies and thus allow them to meet at the
mouth of the sushumna in the muladhara chakra thus activating
one's highest creative/evolutionary potential symbolized by the
awakened goddess, lady kundalini, or kundalini shakti. Aligning
mother earth with father sky -- the divine will and individual
will are in synch, heaven and earth. muladhara and sahasrara,
consciousness and beingness, and as such the prana shakti
reaches its highest state of expression (the goddess kundalini
blossoms forth) manifesting in this very body as embodied love!
HERE Patanjali ends Pada III with the word, kaivalyam, which
means ultimate liberation, not surprisingly the title/subject of
the loftiest and final chapter, Pada IV where this subject is
elaborated upon.
Pada Four: Kaivalyam: Ultimate Liberation – Freedom without Negation or
Qualification When at first we practice meditation (dhyana), we
see how deeply entrenched the monkey mind‘s attachments and
propensities have become, how conditioned the mind has become,
our accumulated imprints (samskaras), tendencies (vasanas), and
the like, and how all these are connected to karma, to ignorance
(avidya) and to desire/aversion (raga/dvesa). Thus at first
meditation is a bit rocky, interspersed with periods of calm
lucidity which gradually deepen and lengthen between periods of
wandering/restless mentations (vrtti). With continued applied
practice (abhyasa) and the practice of authentic self study (swadhyaya)
eventually these revelations produce more continuity of clarity,
calm, strength, and creative insight into our everyday life as
well. In yoga the inner work which is produced from practice and
experience, rather than from books, external teachers,
intellectualization, logic, memorization, or conformity starts
to bear fruit. We gradually realize the underlying truth which
has been in front of our faces all our life – during sleep and
waking – before birth and after death – residing in the great
continuum which is yoga. This unbiased unconditioned universal
Reality in turn reveals the workings of the relative world of
cause and effect -- all things come together into an organic
synchronicity ( in ALL OUR RELATIONS, because the cobwebs and
obscurations of the mental process have now been cleansed.
Meditation thus brings direct insight – it activates the inner
wisdom and our dormant creative/evolutionary potential. Thus
through yogic practice (sadhana) we gradually awake and emerge
out of the sleep of dualistic ignorance. This awakened power,
instinct, intuition, insight, awareness, inner wisdom, and/or
authentic knowledge of Self has many names, but it is not at all
the same as knowledge memorized from books or from external
authority. Rather self realization has to come from inside --
from our own direct experience. In yoga only this experiential
approach is authentic, self empowering, and brings authentic
self confidence, security, fulfillment, and peace. Generally
speaking, we start off in a comparatively insensitive, coarse,
gross, materialistic, and low vibrational state of awareness (savitarka,
savicara, saguna). A wisely applied and consistent yoga practice
over time (abhyasa) gradually purifies and removes the denseness,
coarseness, and occlusions from the field of consciousness (ignorance)
so that the obscuring tendencies gradually lose power and
validity, and fall away (the reality of nirvitarka, nirvicara,
and nirguna). The mind becomes clear and self luminous as the
old impurities, afflictions, blockages, and compulsions (klesha,
samskara, negative karma) are liberated --citta-vrtti-nirodah
begins to dawn. The process is not complex, but rather it is a
profound simplification -- a gradual waking up from a dross
sleep contaminated by confused habituation -- as a purification
through the means of a functional practice so that our intrinsic
true nature spontaneously is revealed (swarupa). Spiritual
change happens by itself -- self actualizing -- in the process
of authentic yoga, albeit one will meet with resistances. In
what has been termed, the raj yoga system, as written down by
Patanjali, the general focus and primary means to melt down this
resistance is meditation (dhyana) which denotes raj yoga (the
other practices mentioned by Patanjali being supplemental to
meditation). We also must realize that meditation is the
technique, while the goal is the absolute liberation, kaivalyam
(the purport of this final chapter of Patanjali's Yoga Sutras).
Thus we learn about our own mind which has become conditioned
and how to uncondition/reprogram it. We do not have to memorize
the specific pathologies or modalities of the mind, like
studying for an academic test at school in order to attain
authentic spiritual knowledge. Neither does one have to study
books of grammar, philosophy, semantics, and the like, but
merely to become acquainted inside, to recognize what is
wholistic and functional about the nature of awareness itself,
recognizing the underlying Source of Intelligence and
Consciousness and use these inner eyes whose cobwebs have become
cleansed to ―see‖. This is vidya or jnana which is the
antitheses of and antidote to avidya (ignorance).
An analogy here might be that Pure Universal Consciousness (cit)
is like the Sun while the individual mind (manas) is like its
rays. Sometimes the rays get cloudy, refracted, distorted,
dissipated, or even blocked out. Yoga teaches us how to keep the
pathways, open, light, bright, and in delight. This way we
commune with, embrace, and form an ever more intimate
relationship and alignment with Source and become
trans-substantiated -- in tune with the transconceptional,
transpersonal, non- dual, unconditioned, infinite universal
mind, – the true Self, naturally as an authentic natural, and
organic teaching occurring from the inside out that has become
activated through authentic yogic practice. Again this is
process is to be juxtaposed to ordinary knowledge, which is
imposed from the outside through external authority, tradition,
book knowledge, and acquired beliefs, which too often reinforces
the very boundaries and prisons that yoga is designed to remove.
This is a valuable distinction to emphasize because most
students mistakenly think that the purpose of studying the Yoga
Sutras is to understand the text, but rather the opposite is
true (we study the Yoga Sutras to help understand the Self). For
many centuries prior to Patanjali's birth authentic Yoga
teachings were made available through a living oral tradition.
there was no studying texts on yoga, because none existed,
rather the study was the nature of the mind and existence and
the removal of suffering (Satchitananda). The Raj Yoga yoga
tradition taught the art of meditation which is essentially the
art of self study -- of knowing the mind beyond its most subtle
and minute manifestation. Patanjali intended the Yoga Sutras to
be a means toward that rather that limb in the tree and then
realize total integration, samadhi -- ALL OUR RELATIONS. Instead
in modern academic and overly intellectual approaches circles,
the study of the book has become the misplaced end in itself,
while direct experience has taken the back seat. Patanjali was
aware of the possibility of this perversion and that is why he
categorized pramana as a vrtti, but the ordinal purport of the
text has become expropriated and distorted. The Yoga Sutras
point to a way to authentically ―own‖ and integrate true
spiritual teachings -- a message still valid today; while at the
same time as Patanjali says, external authority, words,
tradition, the reductionist mind, inference, ordinary methods of
dualistic perception, distractive modalities of thought, stupor,
torpor, and past impressions (in short pramana, vikalpa, nidra,
and all the rest of the vrttis) join together with samskaras,
vasana, klesha, karma, desire, aversion, and avidya (ignorance)
to create dukha (suffering). Tellingly, one can not find in the
Yoga Sutras any instance where Patanjali has even suggested
studying scripture, worshipping deities, following gurus, or
conventional moral codes (see the commentary in Pada II
regarding the true meaning of yama/niyama including isvara
pranidhana). Precisely, nothing replaces direct realization and
this is what Patanjali advocates, i.e., samadhi. From the
increasingly deepening glimpses that authentic practice affords,
one naturally gains confidence of the true nature of mind.
Having explained the general assumptions in Pada One (defining
Yoga and Samadhi as a transconceptional alignment, communion,
harmonization, transubstantiation, and wholistic transpersonal
non-dual integration); explaining the practices (sadhana) in
Pada Two; the attainments (Vibhuti) in pada Three; here in Pada
Four (Kaivalyam) Patanjali describes the ultimate liberation
which is a self liberation without qualification as realized in
nirbija-samadhi (seedless samadhi). Kaivalyam: Ultimate or
Absolute Liberation In this fragmented and spiritually alienated
society surrounded by dualistic religionism and philosophies the
non-dual yogic idea of liberation and happiness often becomes
perverted or at best widely misinterpreted. When yogis speak
about happiness, they do not mean relative happiness -- a
freedom from, transcendence of, escape or alleviation from
suffering in a relative sense, but rather yoga is about
attaining and abiding in a lasting and ultimate absolute
happiness and freedom -- an unconditional, unqualified, true,
and lasting happiness without falling back into the illusion of
suffering which is termed nirbij (seedless) samadhi. We shall
see that this authentic and lasting happiness is not dependent
upon "things" or temporal conditions -- it is not due to absence
in any sense -- but is only due to a realization of a totally
integrated all inclusive Universal Self -- a life that both
acknowledges and is filled with sacred presence. This
realization can not be obtained with the manipulation of words
or the intellect, because by its nature it can not be defined in
human terms/words. That which is all inclusive contains us. We
can only contain it when we become "it" -- when we identify with
the Great Integrity as-it-is. This Great Integrity defines the
human world, all other worlds, times, and dimensions, as well.
Humans can do well with philosophical systems, but it is
valuable to know the limitation of such systems, i.e., where
philosophy, ideology, and religionism ends and where authentic
yoga begins. Thus the intellectual translations (which forms the
vast bulk of the translations) contain a common mistranslation
of the word, kaivalyam, as being an isolation, a withdrawal, or
transcendence. It is an error of dualistic thinking -- of the
ego sense (asmita) stemming from habituated separateness and
confusion (avidya) that proposes that kaivalyam is isolation.
Kaivalya can not be seen in terms of freedom from anything, in
terms of escape, fear, transcendence, aversion, or even striving
for an attainment (terms which all stem from duality as their
basis). In kaivalyam (as an absolute and unconditional
liberation versus a relative liberation) there exist no
conditions of a relative (normal) freedom from anything -- there
is no where to go, no where to hide, nothing to be separated
from, rather yoga occurs, at its end, in abiding in one's true
natural self (swarupa).
Thus in pada four Patanjali evinces the end of striving where
our mind is no longer occupied by the distinctions of a separate
object of concentration be it physical or mental where all
apparent differentiated phenomena cease to be as such (sunya),
and as such this is the end of endless relative and comparative
objectification (in nirguna). As such it is not reached by
objectification or differentiation, but rather by its release.
It is not realized by the intellect, by manas (the ordinary
mind), by will, by separateness (asmita), or by any other klesha,
but rather dualism is instantaneously realized when we have
finally given all these up - released them. Again we do not give
these up as an intellectual decision and it is not the ego who
gives up anything, rather this surrender occurs simultaneously
with the genuine spiritual experience, from the expansion of
conscious wrought from authentic realization. Thus philosophers
in their special way of analytical logic and reductionism have
attempted to define kaivalya as an isolation rather than as
union. Taken to its logical end (as is true with all fragmented
thought), they wind up with absolute withdrawal or catatonia.
Indeed, this is often how Western philosophers have "understood"
samadhi. In one sense only can this absurdity be said to have
any merit. They are correct only in the sense that nirbij
samadhi (as the ultimate integration) is dependent upon first
separating the cit-prana from separation itself -- from false
identification with a separate self (asmita) which is called
egoism but rather it includes embracing the transpersonal
non-dual all encompassing Integrity. So then an isolation from
isolation (separation) in reality brings on an integration (which
is nirbij samadhi) when the yogic context is not corrupted, but
rather acknowledged and honored. Indeed the means of how this
non-dual liberation (which is not a separation) is accomplished
forms a central theme throughout Pada Four -- Kaivalyam. In
authentic yoga playing with words is not only not necessary, it
most often becomes counterproductive, unless it is used to
defeat the tendency to play on words in the first place. Thus,
within the scope of authentic yoga, kaivalyam, or ultimate
liberation, is not an escape from any "thing"; it is not an
aversion, hatred, a fear, a dislike, or even a desire in the
common usage of the word (as all kleshas and karma are
eventually burned up through yogic practice). It is not a
relative isolation, avoidance, control over, repression,
transcendence from, an overcoming of, nor denial of anything in
any form. Kaivalya is not achieved through strife, from control
over anything, aloofness, nor transcendence. Indeed
transcendence has to be given up as well. Simply one abides in
the Uncolored Universal without striving. All analogies or words
are by definition inadequate when one attempts to describe the
boundless and immeasurable -- the Infinite Mind. One such image
is the mahamudra, the open sky or clear heart space -- the Great
Intrinsic All Pervading Perfection -- a simultaneously occurring
synchronicity of holographic multi-dimensionality. Another "image"
is the multidimensional unification of the microcosm and
macrocosm as in the symbolic representation of the hologram
often drawn as the Sri Yantra (mystic diagram). Distinctions
between the terms yoga, swarupa, nirbija samadhi, kaivalyam,
purusha, and isvara. are not necessary once we enter the sacred
mandala. But to Patanjali's credit, he does not get lost in
symbolic representation, analogy, nor images.
Surely in ordinary dualistic contextual systems, freedom is
defined as a freedom from something, and thus in many religious
systems the idea of transcendence over or freedom from
afflictions, suffering, past karma, and even ignorance (avidya)
are expounded. However such a tactic has the danger of
reinforcing aversion and desire unless it moves into the
unconditional and non-dual realms. Only in the non-dual both/and
interpretation will the alienation of heaven and hell, spirit
and nature states, mind and body, etc., be resolved. Thus in
order to cut through the confusion surrounding the dualistic
interpretation of kaivalyam, it is wise to ask absolute
liberation from what? Does one disappear completely or just the
ego bias (the illusion of referencing the universe from a
temporary separate self)? Simply our bias and point of view
shifts to unbiased universal heart ... not to worry about losing
anything of value except our prejudices, fears, and narrow
minded views. In an embodied, non-dual tantric and wholistic
interpretation of kaivalya, we can take the all inclusive both/and
(versus either/or) approach to advantage and ask, where is it
that Brahman does not exist except in the illusory (dualistic)
mind? Here we will assume the non-dual tantric assumption that
Patanjali implied, i.e., the difficulty on how liberation can be
embodied (jivamukti) in an awakened body/mind who has aligned
their entire being and opened up the light pathways for the rays
of the sun to shine. By first differentiating between the
striving for freedom as an escape from something as opposed to a
state of ultimate liberation (the end of sorrow or nirbija
samadhi), we can approach the profundity of the freedom of
freedom. Ultimate liberation is not from the body and Patanjali
never says or indicates that it is other worldly or transcendent
(even though as has been pointed out scholars, religionists,
dualists, and intellectuals, want to impose that type of
institutionalized and sterile conclusion), rather liberation is
in the acceptance and integration of the eternal Present HERE
and Now. To get HERE one must be able to drop all fear, aversion,
clinging, preconception, conditioning, samskaras, and ignorance
(avidya). A careful student will find that it is here in Pada
Four that the sophistry of the numerous academic philosophic
interpreters of Patanjali is taken to its most absurd heights.
One will find (should one engage in a comparative study) that
institutionalized and self serving academia have misinterpreted
sutra after sutra (which was originally intended to be a
meditation manual in order to realize samadhi) having reduced it
to trivial, useless, and irrelevant philosophical and
metaphysical speculation and abstractions.
Now again if we look at the Yoga Sutras as a meditation manual,
then we can see that Patanjali is referring to ultimate
realization in meditation or samadhi. Once samadhi is realized
in yogic practice, as jivamukti, then it is to be embodied in
ALL OUR
RELATIONS – at all times. Any action coming from that very
sacred and profound non-dual Clear Heart Space which manifests
in the world (as behavior) is profoundly altered -- it has a
touch of divine love to it. Patanjali thus is not attempting to
give us a moral code, rules, techniques, formulas, or even
methods of attacking the world, but rather ways of first getting
clear and free ourselves (reestablishing connection with Source)
in successfully realizing the "fruit" of meditation. From that
place of intrinsic knowing, non-dual and trans-rational action
naturally follows. This reflects the enlightened view that we
can not help others out of ignorance, but only out of wisdom
which follows that we strive for enlightenment IN ORDER to help
"Self" – in order to heal self as others -- in the non-dual and
non-separate sense as all other beings. This type of wise action
is manifested in natural love, empathy, compassion, and
equanimity which are called upaya, or skillful means, in
Buddhism. Meditation is simply a practice which Patanjali is
trying to help us understand (and master) which brings this
realization home. Liberation while alive or Jivamukti is a big
topic in itself, but the important point is that meditation
practice not be seen as an escape, withdrawal from, or
transcendence of the world (like many externally oriented
materialists say), but rather as a renunciation of dualism,
separatism, ego, and self imposed limited belief systems. As we
study Kaivalya Pada (chapter Four) we will see that Patanjali is
describing yoga as a pathway of connection between the absolute
and the relative, Spirit and Nature, Mind and Body --
Consciousness and Being – the unification of the objective world
with the subjective world -- the integration of ultimate truth,
happiness and freedom in order that it will become embodied and
expressed. As such Patanjali presents yoga as unification and
integration -- as the process of disclosing the underlying all
inclusive non-dual self existent integrity between consciousness
and being, sky and earth, crown and root as Swarupa -- our
natural unconditioned authentic true ―self‖ which is the
completion of yoga. Isn't the difference between the eternal
present and time -- eternal and temporal -- absolute and
relative just artificially delineated (separated)? Is it not
simply a programmed, conditioned, and acquired process, rather
than a reflection of Reality-As-It-Is. Reality and Truth becomes
"heavy" to deal with just because of our false conditioning;
while it is that very conditioning which meditation attacks,
disrupts, and frees us from. And it is that meditation which
transcend the words completely, which go well beyond the process
of human mentation and contrivation which Patanjali eloquently
attempts to describe (in words).
Kaivalya is not conditioned nor contrived, hence it is ALWAYS
present. It is not separate from embodiment, rather ingrained
and programmed ignorance (avidya) makes it seem so. When we find
ourselves more "connected", our conscious awareness of ―THAT‖ –
of all things in all things -- which intrinsically exists by
itself without avidya or ignorance is naturally increased a
thousand fold. Knowledge and insight (jnanam comes by itself and
with it siddhis are gifted without ever striving for them. When
we are able (ability is another word for siddhi) to commune
deeply with nature or even inanimate objects such as rocks
onepointedly in samyama, then naturally knowledge of their
nature is communicated. This can happen with herbs (as an
herbalist/shaman) or with patients (as a doctor/shaman), or with
our "self" as self knowledge, etc. In a sacred and powerful
place, Grace cautions us to be careful about what to ask for;
and thus as we increasingly focus in the process of yoga,
kaivalyam becomes realized. Thus ultimately in Pada Four
Patanjali answers the question of what is ultimate liberation
through the processes of yoga (in the context of yoga which
means to join together -- or to merge as one) , Thus, Kaivalya
includes the freedom from "limited" identification- from
separateness itself -- from ego – the freedom from separateness
and here it becomes ultimate freedom because only in ultimate
unity – within the Great Integrity of all ALL OUR RELATIONS is
there no longer a possibility of being separate – no longer a
possibility of being ―free from‖ any thing else. Here all fear
and desire have become remediated. This is the freedom of
freedom a natural state. Thus Kaivalyam is isolation (freedom
from) only in the sense that it dissociates itself from the
process of aversion, isolation, duality, and separateness or ego
itself. Yoga is thus culminated with the realization of
nirbij-samadhi where any separate self is seen as part of the
illusory process and is no longer drawn into it, hence all vrtti,
all bias, all perturbations and agitations of the psychic field
rests in the empty field of separateness -- Kaivalyam being our
natural state. Patanjali says in the first verse of Pada 4 (Kaivalya)
Sutra 1 janma-osadhi-mantra-tapah-samadhi-jah siddayahsamadhi
Siddhi (attainment) can come because of inborn traits from karma
and genetics (janma), from herbs (aushadhi), mantras, the
kindling of the psychic fire (tapas), and/or from samadhi.
One witnesses that one may gain siddhis increasing thence one's
latent abilities become enhanced through the wise utilization
and communion with nature's medicines and elixirs (aushadhi)
which in turn trigger/activate the inner evolutionary circuits (including
the body's neuro-endocrine system), clear out obstructions in
the nadis, and in general remove obstructions both in the
cellular memory and neuro-psychic pathways. The wise use of
certain herbal combinations are known to the tradition of yoga
to stimulate/catalyze the production of inner elixirs (soma,
amrita, etc.) which are also activated by other factors. Just as
in chapter three samyama brings forth many abilities (siddhas),
so too is the process enhanced through inborn traits, the wise
use of herbs, mantra, tapas, and meditative absorption (samadhi).
Chief among the producer of siddhis is the state that samadhi
offers. From samadhi, the third eye, transcendental knowledge,
and transensual perception become accessible as if the body/mind
were plugged into a huge main frame computer which encompassed
all the data since beginningless time. Parents notice that
children are born with innate propensities, wisdom, personality
traits, and abilities. These inborn/innate abilities (janma) are
due to karma and genetics. All beings have inborn traits and
special abilities, certain propensities to attain the highest
realization (Buddha nature) but few realize it in their
incarnation. Similarly, our genetic constitution at birth is the
result of past karma. One who has looked into the situation
fully knows that infants are born into this world with their
unique karma, some possessing amazing advanced abilities (siddhis)
right from birth, while others may be severely blocked or
lacking either physically and/or psychically. These latent
abilities can be enhanced and awakened through the practice of
tapas (see II.1 II.43) because tapas eliminates and redirects
the outward flowing misdirected and dissipating energetics of a
distracted dualistic mind thus providing the fuel to catalyze
the latent but natural evolutionary inward flow (kundalini)
which is our natural evolutionary potential. Tapas thus is an
important practice in quickening our success (vibhuti). Likewise
the practice of focusing upon the specific dynamic energetic
qualities of specific sound vibrations (mantra) will open up
previously dormant pathways that activate heretofore hidden
abilities. Lastly the understanding of nature's botanical and
mineral energetic potential (osadah) allows the yogi who
understands her to join into a mutual synergistic partnership
which activates various psycho-neurophysiological processes
precipitating in liberation from illness, increased strength,
power of concentration, wisdom, and other heightened abilities.
Although specific techniques have been developed for specific
abilities, Patanjali recommends that the wise sadhak does not
become sidetracked on specific siddhis, but far better focus
upon developing ultimate liberation -- freedom from spiritual
obstructions to nirbija (seedless) samadhi. See III. 37. IV
Sutra 2 jati-antara-parinama prakrty-apurat
The diverse new embodiments (of spirit) jati-antara) are
conveyed through the ever abundant flux of creative natural
evolution. Spirit, as such, is an intrinsic
part of our essential nature, although hidden by ignorance in
the “normal” condition. Commentary: "We" exist not in a fixated
state, frozen in time and space. Rather phenomena is ever
changing (parinama) as diverse multitudinous creative
manifestations or evolutionary (prakrti) flux of the divine
Creatrix (prakrti). As such in Reality, WE collectively, are
THAT -- whole, since in non-dual Reality WE are not separate
entities (egos) and phenomena as such does not exist apart. Here
we have the ABILITY to channel this infinite abundance into many
avenues of creation -- giving birth in embodied love (jati-antara-parinama).
Here we take "prakrty-apurat" as the innate abundant (apurat)
power of nature (shakti) while "jati-antara-parinama" is the
ability to give birth to our highest transformative potential.
Spirit, as prana, naturally is imbibed (apurat) inside all
generated forms (jati-antara) as the intrinsic source of
spiritual inspiration. When we are allowed to see and
participate in this natural innate process consciously (when we
approximate or align with our intrinsic natural state), then
Infinite dawnless Source thus manifests as the diverse and rich
expressions of the one Spirit – within the overall boundless
transpersonal context of intrinsic kinship and unity of ALL OUR
RELATIONS. Although there exists only One formless eternal and
absolute Beginningless Source (creative Spirit), THAT manifests
in terms of a continuous creative evolutionary act of creation
which appears within temporal space and time, as evolution. This
great creative force is our greater identity which we have
dissociated (dismembered) from through negative conditioning --
through the acclamation/distraction of avidya. In this way
reincarnation is also explained and is at the same remediated.
IV Sutra 3 nimittam aprayojakam prakrtinam varana-bhedas tu
tatah ksetrikavat Through our daily intercourse and experience
with nature/creation the coverings (varana) which are obstacles
to the realization of the Great Integrity and continuity of THAT
manifestation are removed (bhedas) naturally without
necessitating force; but rather can occur naturally like a
cultivator with a green thumb who naturally gravitates toward
cultivating both the soil and the plants as part of one’s larger
family or kin – as a partner or co-creator.
Commentary: tatah means, from that. Bhedah means, to remove or
separate. Nimittam means causal ground or overall motif.
Ksetrikavat is one who cultivates the soil or literally a farmer
of a land (in this sense one who cultivates samadhi). Thus in
yoga it is the practitioner's wholistic non-dual identification
of body/mind/spirit which is the territory and thus the field
that is being attended to and cultivated by the sadhak (practitioner).
Aprayojakam means without imposing force -- without artifice,
but naturally through establishing a harmonious interactive
co-creative relationship.
This is the natural enfoldment or evolution of consciousness
without interference, resistance, or attachment such as some one
with a ―green thumb‖ goes about working in a garden as kin – as
mutual participants in the non-dual reality of the eternal
gurukula in ALL OUR RELATIONS. Thus this sutra assumes that like
an inspired or talented gardener, the practitioner acts in
harmony with an organic process, as a co-creator with
beginningless Spirit which if cared for wisely is allowed to
bloom and bear fruit within this very field (ksetrikavat)
naturally. Like a master gardener one removes (bhedah) the
obstructions (varana) and noxious material allowing the abundant
natural potential to flow forth, bloom, and bear fruit. Here
Patanjali says that a wise man does not mistake the process of
removing of the obstacles to attainment, with the natural
tendency toward its innate attainment. The light illumines
itself (it is self effulgent). IV Sutra 4 nirmana-cittani
asmita-matrat Consciousness becomes bonded and limited to an
apparent material form which creates the error of materialism --
the false assumption that only coarse form (nirmana) the only
true existence (nirmana). This limited way of perceiving
existence (nirmana-cittani) is due from the more fundamental
afflictive emotion of asmita (the false identification of a
separate and limited self). Commentary: Consciousness evolves
naturally (as in Sutra 3 preceding) as the flooding of prakrti
except for the interference of asmita (the assumption of the
reality of separate self and things) where it then appears
exclusively bound to form, bounded, coarse, gross, and inert.
Nirmana is the realm of form or material reality. It can also be
defined as pertaining to that which is fabricated/created.
Matrat means limitation, boundary, or exclusion. Asmita
(separate ego sense) is one of the five kleshas which are the
afflictions or poisons which consist of avidya (ignorance),
asmita (egoism), raga (desire or attraction), dvesa (repulsion
or aversion) and abhinivesah (fear of death or transformation).
Samadhi destroys all that Thus "form based" mental fabrications
arise from asmita (the error of egocentric fixations). Thus in
our meditation practice (sadhana) our attempts to transform the
mind and cultivate samadhi through the fabrications stemming
from asmita are doomed to failure. All such schemes must
eventually surrender to the flood gates of prakrti (shakti). At
least this is the advice of sahaj yoga and the siva/shakti
practitioners. See Sutra 34 "kaivalyam svarupa-pratistha va
citi-saktir iti").
It should be clear that here, Patanjali is not only addressing
the affliction of separate or small ―self‖ in creating a severe
limitation of ―reality‖ as a false identification and an
affliction, but also the affliction of asmita as applied to any
separate thing which as
such creates discontinuity from the world of ALL OUR RELATIONS–
from the non-dual transpersonal Great Integrity which is the
realization of our natural unfabricated state (swarupa) -- the
true Universal ―Self‖. Here Patanjali is directing us to the
highest power of consciousness (citi-saktir) -- our larger
natural Self. Nothing exists in a vacuum, i.e., even the vacuum
tube or vacuum in reality exists inside a room -- in context
with the rest of the universe; while to view it out of context
would distort its "reality". Form surrounds form, but the
boundless mind simultaneously surrounds all and is inside of all
-- all pervasive, universal, and eternal. IV Sutra 5
pravrtti-bhede prayojakam cittam ekam anekesam Although there
can be distinguished (bhede) apparently separate multitudinous
and and apparently diverse (anekesam) activities and
modifications (pravrtti) of spirit and consciousness, the
underlying causative source (prayojakam) of these "states of
mind" or "fields of consciousness" (cittam) will be revealed in
the end as to be non-dual, not born of separateness. Rather in
reality they are intimately interconnected as one (ekam).
Commentary: Prayojakam means causative precursor or causal and
necessary factor which has created the present situation.
Through the power of the kleshas, of ignorance (avidya), and
negative programming (negative karma) the common man finds
himself in a fragmented, disconnected, and confused world where
he is not aware of the true nature of his mental or emotional
states and seems unable to find lasting happiness. In reality
however, the All comes from All. What is born from meditative
absorption (samadhi) is stainless and pure. Patanjali says that
we must rejoin the stream of fresh pure water and bathe within
its golden waters and thus the stains of the mind will be washed
away -- the agitation (pravrtti) of the waters will become
stilled, thus the innate overall single Source of consciousness
(prayojakam cittam ekam anekesam) will be self revealed by
itself as it is. Again Patanjali reiterates in different ways,
the Reality of ALL OUR RELATIONS while summing up Sutras 2-5.
Swami Sivananda in ―Light of Yoga‖ says: ―Yoga is the method by
which the finite self or the individual soul is united with the
Infinite Self or the Supreme Soul. Yajnavalkya defines Yoga, "Samyoga
yoga iti ukto jivatma-paramatmano iti—the conjunction of the
individual soul and the supreme soul is called Yoga." IV Sutra 6
tatra dhyana-jam anasayam In that milieu (tatra) it is
meditation (dhyana) that frees us from the residues of past
impressions (anasayam) Commentary: So how does fragmented
existence become remediated and made whole and interconnected
again? How does the vrtti become stilled? Patanjali here
recommends meditation (dhyana). Anasayam means free from
residues and impression i.e., devoid of samskaras. Dhyana-jam
means literally, ―born of meditation‖. Here Patanjali prescribes
meditation as the cure for the residues of samskaras and hence
with the samskaras destroyed through meditation, the kleshas,
vasana, and negative karma are broken up -- asmita is destroyed,
thus restoring the ―self‖ to final integration (in
nirbij-samadhi) with the ―Big Self‖ – Brahman or the Great
Integrity without end or beginning – Infinite/Boundless Mind. In
ashtanga yoga, dhyana (meditation) comes after dharana (concentration
and contemplation). In dharana one focuses on an object, but in
dhyana the observer and the object of observation are not
separated. Source is found as an innate continuous presence
which success in dhyana (practice) reveals. Hence in that way
Sutra 6 follows as a natural evolution from Sutras 1-4. IV Sutra
7 karma-asukla-akrsnam yoginas trividham itaresam The actions
(karma) [of a yogi who has thus rid himself from the residues by
mastering meditation] are no longer able to be measured (neither
white nor black, pure or impure, etc) in ordinary relative terms
– his or her actions are no longer caused in turn by the winds
of karma; while the actions of ordinary non-meditators can be
judged to be three-fold (trividham) -- pure, impure, and mixed.
Commentary: Yogis (those who practice yoga and meditate) have
burned off their karma. Thus their actions are not dependent
upon past actions, thus their actions do not depend on effects
of past causes. Their actions can not be judged in temporal or
material terms like that of others who are governed by the winds
of the vrttis composed of karma, dvesa, raga, klesha, and
samskara, and vasana. They can not be evaluated within the
framework of conditioned space or duality (black and white).
Here the originless beginningless unconditioned cause arises
spontaneously. Such actions are through Grace -- the play of
Lila. So in ordinary life, there is an action and a result
(karma). That is the simple situation, but it can become complex
when these results act as causes for future actions, and/or when
many results combine together to influence future actions --
become causes for future causes. The main point pertaining to
karma to keep in mind is that past karmic shells which occlude
the present and tend to dictate and impose a future, creeps up
upon the ordinary man unconsciously, out of ignorance. That
ignorance then displaces the creative potential in the organic
freshness of the moment. By abiding with this process of karma
and accepting it as-it-is, in the moment as it arises without
ignoring or denying it allows us to discern its previously
occluded influence. Eventually like the cultivated garden, it
will bloom in concert with the natural true spiritual self --
swarupa -- our intrinsic potential Buddha (the Tathagatagarbha).
This way the momentary fragmented excursions into disconnect
will be naturally eliminated. IV Sutra 8 tatas
tad-vipaka-anugunanam eva abhivyaktir vasananam Those being
propelled on the waves of karma, their vasana ripen according to
conditions and environmental factors which are conducive, or
they do not ripen according to external circumstances which are
non-conducive. Commentary: Vasananam are latent tendencies and
propensities in the forms of compulsions, negative habits,
reflexive patterns, etc. They are like an electronic circuit
which performs a function or a computer program which performs a
task. It sits in wait, waiting for the program call to be
activated (by a samskaric residue) or the switch or button of
the circuit to be completed. These switches, buttons, or "calls"
of the program (karma0 are samskaras (latent imprints in the
cellular memory like the doping of a computer chip waiting for
the current to be switched on). These circuits when energized
form vasana (negative habits), which can be activated through
external conditions and sensory input when karma (external
situations of cause and effect ripen or come together) or they
may be activated by mental/emotional conditions (karma). Thus
―the buttons" of reflexive habit patterns, conditioned responses,
compulsions, and even the seeds of dormant and potential future
karma become pushed -- vasanas, as a result, become activated.
So when karmic conditions ripen, a vasana will manifest (due to
past karma).
Such is a two way street, i.e., past samskara and karma create
vasana and klesha and also acting on klesha and acting out in
vasana can in turn create even more negative kleshas and karma.
They are to be eliminated through sadhana (here specifically
meditation) or failing that by applying conscious awareness (viveka)
upon the contents of the mind (pratyaya) and emotional contents
to determine if a vasana or klesha triggered by a samskara or
past karma has disrupted our energy and attention (cit-prana)
out if our core/heart center. This is also the practice of
authentic swadhyaya (self study). This conscious abiding with
our process eventually will reveal and dislodge the underlying
biopsychic imprints and energy signatures of the more subtle
samskara itself. Then one applies vairagya, tapas, isvara
pranidhana, or other such remedies. Less subtle than viveka, is
dharana and samyama when one concentrates/focuses on the breath,
the chakras, or other upon specific objects of concentration as
reflective aids such as found in the previous padas. In daily
life then, we often carry around with us "baggage" and issues
from the past which become triggered again and again until we
stop ignoring, denying, or running away from the mechanism.
Vasana can be remediated or nullified by creating positive
sattvic conditions in the home, by associating with sattvic/spiritual
people, by living in a sattvic spiritual environment such as a
forest ashram, peaceful power spots, holy places of pilgrimage,
near enlightened beings, by sadhana (spiritual practice),
cultivating compassion, loving kindness, equanimity, wisdom, and
so forth. Tantrics on the other hand believe that the former
method may simply create a temporary state of dormancy for the
vasana, which is still capable of coming out in the future
through dreams, in the bardo after death, in future lives, or
other karmic events when conditions ripen (karma) and so on.
Tantra proposes methods to root out the vasana by creating
conditions which bring it to the surface in order to exorcise it
and attain catharsis, purification, and exorcism. Vasana,
samskaras, past negative karma, and the kleshas are all like
hidden ghosts, shadows, or inner demons carried around by people
like dark clouds in their aura preventing them from having a
creative and happy spontaneous and open life. In hatha yoga
these demons can be accessed and exorcised via the body, breath,
neuro-physiology, energy circuits, and penetrative wisdom. IV
Sutra 9 jati-desa-kala-vyavahitanam apy antantaryam
smrti-samskararayor eka rupatvat The psychic imprint (samskara)
and the cellular memory of the event which produced the samskara
often are associated together as one event (ek rupa) in the
ordinary conditioned mind. Thus a desire which is not fulfilled
in the past forms a samskara (a repressive or reactive imprint
and tendency) which can manifest in the future as a neurosis
whose reactive mechanism is hidden as in a fog, or occluded and
confused cloud formation even though this same compulsive
unconscious mechanism may recur repeatedly (jati-desa-kala-vyavahitanam
spy antantaryam) -- even through many lifetimes until one is
awakened from the reactive mechanism.
Commentary: When we awake to our true nature – real true self or
Buddha Nature (Tathagatagarbha), then vasana, samskara, klesha,
karma, and vrtti are destroyed.
Here Patanjali recommends meditation as the major remedy.
Without realization, the consciousness is bounded subject to the
vrtti. We will see that the bad habits as vasana are all built
up by samskaras, klesha, and karma which are annihilated through
functional yoga practice. It is a well recognized pathological
mechanism in the psychology of trauma that a symbol will remind
us of the pain of a past unresolved event to the point that the
symbol creates pain and becomes misidentified as a cause of pain,
while in fact it is the old unhealed memory which is the cause
of the pain. Thus a specific color, taste, sound, tonality,word,
smell, object, series of events, etc., may trigger such a
reaction and re-traumatization. Since the trauma victim can not
easily recognize what is going on they can easily confuse and
project that the symbol or representation is threatening them or
causing them harm. In this misidentification one shoots the
messenger and is ruled by the demons of one's shadow world. The
remediation of course is to confront one's demons as self
projections and thus fear is also destroyed. We will see that
much of Kaivalya Pada is concerned on how to remove these
samskaric triggers from past trauma from our cellular memory and
thus become liberated from compulsion, false identifications,
and unconscious activity. Here Patanjali makes a cogent
observation; i.e., that memory and samskaras are of one form (smrti-samskarayor
eka rupatvat). IV Sutra 10 tasam anaditvam ca asiso nityatvat
These mechanisms (tasam) such as vasana, samskara, and karma)
have no ultimate cause (anaditvam) in themselves, [but rather
are the result of a fragmented mentality (as described in Sutra
9 above)] as all phenomena must be viewed as a continuous
process and integral (in context) with eternity (beginningless
time and the never-ending co-existing in the eternal now). When
we lose that connection between Infinite Source or Boundless
mind, our true present condition, then in that predicament there
arises desire, craving, anguish, suffering, and thus the
manifold neurotic compensatory mechanisms to assuage or fulfill
the gap/absence -- assuage the pain of this suffering. Thence
the habituation to continual craving and mechanisms of
compensatory consumerism manifest (asiso nityatvat).
Commentary: This is the first noble truth of Buddhism, i.e.,
that ordinary dualistic life creates craving and suffering
because it abides in a dualistic and artificial place and time
that is defined as being separated/alienated from the Source of
nurturance. Such an artificial mental construct creates a
disharmony and discontinuance, albeit the common malaise. Thus
in trauma, a rend or split occurs where the experiencer
dissociates from the pain and suffering, numbing that part off
from the whole which in
turn creates a sense of lack, absence, longing, craving, or
desire which results in a steady state of unfulfilled familiar
discomfort (asiso nityayvat). Remediation back into wholeness
then is being able to own all our experiences in continuity.
Thus santosha (complete fulfillment is experienced in each
moment even though we are still actively propelled by love. To
realize that goaless goal -- that complete remediation,
meditation (sadhana in the form of dhyana) is practiced. So
according to the above, in the relative world of cause and
effect (pratityasamutpada) all things/beings are in Reality
interconnected and whole, but the normal man who is lost in
fragmented consciousness does not see it as such. Rather the
ordinary dualistic view is that separate phenomena is "real",
independent, fragmented, and hence disconnected. In that
fragmented and corrupt milieu thus often mistakenly defines
oneself also as separate and independent, and craves what is
lacking/absent.This craving can not be adequately compensated
for in terms of substitutes. Only the reconnection to Source
will so suffice. So here Patanjali is saying that such a
disparate view of separation or dualistic existence causes us to
fall into discontinuous, disrupted, and fragmented consciousness
as well which in turn allows the negative karma to operate upon
us without our knowledge as we ignore/deny it in avidya (ignorance)
or just call it unconscious dualistic unawakened existence. In
meditation we bear witness to these mechanisms without coloring
them with judgments (good/bad, horrible/welcome, ugly/beautiful,
desirable/undesirable or feared, painful/preferred, etc). We
realize through practice that it is counterproductive to
incessantly analyze the cause of these judgments just as it is
dysfunctional to try to inhibit them, but rather to simply
acknowledge the composite of these mechanisms as they arise (as
vrtti), then release them as such and let them go; while going
back to the Great River of Continuity – of the Great Integrity
-- of ALL OUR RELATIONS which exists in the Sacred Present/Presence.
From that perspective of the Great Integrity which is no place
at all, we no longer have a need to analyze the source of the
thoughts because we have arrived at the Source or rather we
realize that "WE" in the non-dual and wholistic identification,
are the Source. Swami Venkatesananda says: ―However, it is
difficult to determine their exact operation, and it is futile
to analyze them.‖
Confusion, by definition, does not make sense. Following
confusion with the intellect or analytical mind only leads to
further fragmentation and dissolution. It does not lead to
consolidation/integrity or wholesomeness. It should suffice that
its general cause is a primal ignorance (avidya) and false
identification which gives birth to what appears as a primal
desire. But realize that this ignorance and desire is not
eternal nor beginningless, rather it is the result of a primal
split/fragmentation or corruptive process.
IV Sutra 11 hetu-fala-ashraya-alambanaiha sangrahiitatvat esham
abhave tad-abhavah Vasana and samskara arise out of (asraya) and
are supported (alambanaih) by causes (hetu) based on ignorance
and as such having ignorance as its cause) must be abandoned and
dissolved back (abhave) to whence it came. Ignorance exists in
ignorance, so a wise man allows such mechanisms of ignorance to
dissolve by themselves (abhavah) when allowing the innate wisdom
to perform this task (allowing it to melt in the light of innate
wisdom – our true self nature by cultivating that (swarupa).
Commentary: From Sutra II.4 we see that the primary cause (hetu)
of suffering is avidya (ignorance or confusion). It is self
defeating or futile to try to figure out confusion with the
ordinary analytical mind or intellect because such is built upon
the dualistic illusion of separateness (a basic fallacy) – it
thus lacks integrity. Ignorance can not reveal ignorance. Thus
analyzing the cause (hetu) and effect (phala) samskaric milieu
that is based on an illusion only enhances the illusion. Such
will not make sense or lead anywhere productive. What is being
advocated here is that one has to let go completely of such
grasping (abhave). This is not to beconfused with contemplating
the laws of karma (the world of cause and effect) which
discloses the intrinsic unity of the temporal nature of the
relative world with that of the ultimate or absolute eternal as
the ever present Reality as-it-is. rather when one realizes this
relative truth of inter-dependence of all things (pratityasamutpada)
then the limitations of the dualistic mind melts. What is
revealed is beyond the realm of ego delusion, separateness, or
ignorance, thus the Reality of Ultimate truth is entered upon.
On the other hand, ignorance, karma, habitually attempting to
seek pleasure in the grasping unto or running away from the
continual rising and falling of "external" phenomena by the
fixation upon seemingly solid sense objects and the processes of
inhibition, fear, desire, and the rest only serve to feed and
support vasanam. Such is ruled by psychic imbeded imprints (samskaras)
and vasana. Swami Venkatesananda says: ―Yet, since these
tendencies have acause-and-effect relationship with ignorance (that
is, they are the result of ignorance and also the cause of its
perpetuation) they disappear when the cause (ignorance of the
spiritual truth) is dispelled, and vice versa: they support and
promote each other and are bound to each other.‖ IV Sutra 12
atitanagatam svarupato 'sty adhva-bhedad dharmanam
The past (atita) or that which has occurred and that which is to
come in the future (anagatam) are not really separate states,
but exist (asti) as they truly are
(swarupa) when seen as a continuity (adhva) [in their inherent
Integrity], but the ordinary mind tends to break them down,
separate, fragment, and reduce them (bhedat) classifying them
into countless qualities (dharmanam). Commentary: The citta
(mind) under the influence of the vrttis (cit-vrtti) ordinarily
rides the winds of karma. It tends to be colored and pulled to
the past or future as if they existed within the confines of
linear time, but here Patanjali is clearing the ground to
expound on effective meditation which brings forth samadhi where
such artificial distinctions, limitations, and separations are
no longer habitually imposed. We will again see how past traumas
as samskaras hold us to the past and color future experiences.
Our conditioned concepts of linear time and hence succession
become a severe limitation in experiencing the Reality of the
timeless moment – the realization of samadhi or turiya. In
Reality separate incremental events do not exist outside of the
all inclusive Great Integrity -- in fact they are intimate parts
of ALL OUR RELATIONS. IV Sutra 13 te vyakta-sukshmah gunatmanah
These manifold tugs on the mind (vrtti) may be subtle (suksmah)
or coarse (vyakta). They may be described through as the
operation of the gunatmanah. Commentary: We have seen how the
vrtti are dissolved in meditation through dissolving the
limiting thought patterns of samskara, vasana, karma, linear
time, etc. all held together overall by ―ignorance‖ (avidya).
Now Patanjali uses the philosophical terminology of his day (samkhya)
to tell us that the vrttis can be broken down as to
individualized (atmanah) characteristic qualities (gunas). It is
not necessary to understand the morass of Samkhya philosophy (which
elaborates upon the gunas) to understand what Patanjali is
saying here in the yogic sense. It is sufficient to know that
the three gunas (sattva, rajas, and tamas) simply represent
three (triadic) primary constituent forces in nature much like
the yin and yang in the dualistic Chinese system. In this
framework rajas and tamas are polar opposites, while sattva is
balanced and pure. IV Sutra 14 parinamaikatvad vastu-tattvam The
gunas themselves travel on the winds of change (parinama) and as
such the manifest world of objects (vastu) exist as they are (tattvam);
yet they arise from the same Great Integrity (ekatvad).
Commentary: The gunas are the qualitative filter or
philosophical framework which samkhya philosophers use to break
down the phenomenal universe (in this case into a triad i.e.,
tamas guna, rajas guna, and sattva guna). Simply stated the
world of form (gunas) is created. It is dependent upon cause and
effect and is the result of karma. Regardless, how it is
differentiated, the phenomenal/temporal or relativistic world is
on fire, inter-dependent, ever changing, and in constant
vibratory flux. Causes create effects, effects create new causes,
and so on. Just so even the mountains and stars move subtly even
now and even more grossly over time. Although in the relative
sense, objects appear to the sense organs as real and
substantial (indeed in the relative sense they only appear "real"
if time and space could be frozen), but such frozen frame
"reality' is the not the case. Thus it is a severe limiting
mistake (an illusion) to mistake that limited perception
artificially stepping out of the integral continuum as being
real, placing it (pratyaksha) out of context with the intrinsic
unity of timeless absolute truth, i.e., that any object has any
inherent existence of itself -- out of context from the absolute
whole of the Great Integrity. That error is the all too common
mistake of corrupted and fragmented ordinary dualistic thought
patterns, mind sets, and conditioned belief systems which is
based on the shaky foundations of illusion (the fragmented
mistake of separateness) which Patanjali is addressing and
therein lies the repetitive error of ignorance. Indeed there
exists infinite diversity, but it exists as-it-is without
distortion only within its true context -- only in the profound
wholistic non-dual integrity which affirms the unity of being
and consciousness -- nature and spirit. Both worlds, relative
and absolute are integrated as an organic continuity only within
the overall organic context of the Great Integrity. In the
non-dualistic context of ALL OUR RELATIONS all created things
are sacred -- bound together and Whole; hence the non-dualistic
"wholographic" context of samadhi is gradually integrated
replacing the ordinary dualistic mind patterns and fractual
corrupted frameworks based on static isolation, partial truths,
sophistry, and similar discontinuities. This is also the same
basic idea of the sunyata of the Buddhists -- the inherent
egolessness or emptiness of all things an beings -- that they do
not exist as separate in themselves. See sutra 34 (the last
sutra of kaivalya pada) for more on sunyata in this context. IV
Sutra 15 vastu-samye chitta-bhedat tayor vibhaktah panthah Due
to habitually fragmented consciousness with its reductionist
tendencies (chitta-bhedat) the same object or phenomena (vastu-samye)
will be perceived differently (tayoh-vibhaktah) depending upon
the position/bias of the viewer (panthah).
Commentary: Everyone has their individual ―view‖, i.e., it is
valid to them and appears real. One person‘s view or path (panthah)
is not better or worse than
another‘s, only different (vibhaktah). Thus another pull of
consciousness or vrtti (chitta-bhedat) is identified and
remediated. All the many paths of our spiritual journeys will
hopefully lead us to the realization of the Great Integrity –
where the paths all merge as One. HERE in non-dual sacred
presence the path and journey is over, completed, and fulfilled.
Only Universal Consciousness – Infinite Mind – is capable of
viewing Reality uncolored and complete -- as-it-is – without
bias or prejudice that stems from the relative positioning of
the viewer – the dualistic and confused world of I-it or asmita
(ego). This occurs when the vrtti cease (in nirodha) -- when all
fragmented spins become stilled. Notice how this coincides with
Einstein‘s theory of relativity and time. This is where we
reside in deeper meditation. Thus in meditation the futility of
defining a distinct object is recognized and let go (vairagya)
of increasingly through viveka (vigilantly recognizing the
difference). In the beginning a dualistic thought might creep in
and last for a long while, it may distract us. Through viveka we
recognize that the individual consciousness has become carried
away by the monkey mind into a dualistic fixation. Then we are
able to let go by relaxing the fixation -- redirecting the
cit-prana -- while we go back resting in the larger light of the
all encompassing transpersonal non-dual universal Self. This
larger light starts to be recognized increasingly through
repeated practice. With intermediate practice achieved, the
dualistic thought‘s start to arise, but before the process is
completed it is recognized as such and not followed. The
non-dual state is thus amplified through such practice, and
after awhile, the distractions die away by themselves, so that
new thought processes (vrttis) do not even arise. For example
the counterproductive illusion of the separateness of the one
who is meditating and the room or objects in the room, or the
rigid dualistic separate sense of self from that of nature, or
the dysfunctional and counterproductive sense of a separate self
who is meditating, the illusion of a separate object of the
meditation, and the illusion of even the meditation itself --
all such limitations of separate fragmented illusions die down
by themselves as non-dual wisdom spontaneously arises.
"Homage to Manjushri The understanding of ordinary people is
defective. Recognition itself is not disclosed by words. Turning
from what draws you in, Grasp the refinement of what is to be
done; Doing thus, the facticity of mind is recognized. Thought
formation is not bound by tenseness; Likewise the fundamental
continuity is self-contained, Since action, exertion, and the
matrix of purposeful grasping do not exist. Doing thus is the
ongoing meditation. Because the realm of voidness is like the
clouds, All the various thought formations are like their ebb
and flow, When pacified through lack of benefit or injury. Doing
thus is self-liberation. This is the teaching of the essential
point in three words. By experiencing within, one understands."
By Mipham Rinpoche IV Sutra 16 na ca-eka-citta-tantram vastu
tad-apramanakam tada kim syat [In this habitually fragmented
state] one individual weave of consciousness (eka-citta-tantram)
is not capable of determining (apramanakam) a solid belief of
the reality of any object (vastu) or phenomena as-it-is, for
what would become of a so-called separate object or phenomena
when the weave of individual consciousness is withdrawn?
Commentary: The above is a statement of a double negative as it
starts with the word (na) which is translated as nor and
contains the word, apramana, which means devoid of belief.
Because it ends in a question and is thus rhetorical, such makes
it difficult to translate. Another translation could be ―No one
train of thought or belief about the reality of phenomena can be
all authoritative, determinate, or truly accurate to coincide
with the actual reality of such phenomena, rather it is simply a
belief." All this sutra says is that despite disparate views,
the reality of an object is independent upon what the mind may
make it out to be; i.e., whether or not we believe a grape to an
orange or another person believes the grape to be an apple, such
does not change its intrinsic nature as a grape. In other words
all because people can not agree, conventional and consensus
reality is prejudicial, or because some one is biased (influenced
by vrtti), it does not mean that unbiased universal Reality does
not exist as-it-is. Whether or not the mind views it or not,
phenomenal objects exist as they are unchanged in themselves.
Another similar way to translate this sutra (more common) is as
follows. Just as consciousness does not depend upon separate
objects, the reality of separate object does not depend upon
consciousness itself or even any individual consciousness. "Things"
exist as they are, regardless of our beliefs about them or state
of consciousness. This latter "interpretation" however may be
more an indulgence toward the Hindu academic quarrel with the
mind-only Buddhist sect of the early first millennium about
whether or not "reality" depends on the mind or not. Such
counterproductive quarrelling occurred up until the 13th century
AD when the ―evil‖ Buddhists were exterminated by the invading
Moguls and does not concern us here.
Avoiding double negatives, a positive non-dualistic translation
could read: "Is not the dualistic appearances and beliefs in the
fragmented/separate phenomena (vastu tad-apramanakam) remediated
through the integrated weave of consciousness (eka-citta)?" In
short, Patanjali is amplifying the reality of ALL OUR RELATIONS–
that we should not become dissuaded into a fragmented/discontinuous
world of apparent separateness –we should not allow ourselves to
become corrupted by the forces of avidya, neither have our
consciousness become colored by fragmented appearances, nor be
very concerned about having the world conform to our beliefs.
"In terms of your own mind, as is the case with everyone,
Samsara and Nirvana are inseparable. Nonetheless, because you
persist in accepting and enduring attachments and aversions, you
will continue to wander in Samsara. Therefore, your active
dharmas and your inactive ones both should be abandoned. However,
since self-liberation through seeing nakedly by means of
intrinsic awareness is here revealed to you, you should
understand that all dharmas can be perfected and completed in
the great total Self-Liberation. And therefore, whatever (practice
you do) can be brought to perfection within the Great Perfection.
SAMAYA gya gya gya!" Excerpted from Self-Liberation through
Seeing with Naked Awareness by John Myrdhin Reynolds, 1989 and
2000 IV Sutra 17 tad-uparagapeksitvac cittasya vastu jnatajnatam
[In the ordinary dualistic dysfunction] ordinary consciousness (cittasaya)
governed by avidya is colored (uparaga) by preference, prejudice,
expectation, or tends toward a predisposed attraction (apeksitvat)
to an apparently separate sense object or phenomena which in
this state can not be known correctly as it is (jnatajnatam). It
is rather known for what it is not. Commentary: We see this
phenomena in dualistic reality all the time, where different
people suffer from misconceptions and prejudice, are fooled by
unrealistic expectations (apeksitvat), suffer from
disappointment, become happy or sad by the various
manifestations of uparaga. Likewise it is wise to defeat uparaga
before meditation and thus not to fall victim or be distracted
in determining the correct appearance of disparate phenomena.
Such is also a futile distraction as the underlying dualistic
assumption itself is an illusion, being based on a false
identification or avidya. IV Sutra 18 sada jnatasth
citta-vrittayas tat-prabhoh purushasyaparinamitvat
All the citta-vrttis are revealed (jnatasth) from the changeless
nature (aparinamitvat) of purusha (the process of eternal,
undifferentiated, pure, and absolute consciousness) which itself
is unmoving and ultimately determinate (prabhoh) from which
everything unceasingly revolves from as flux) Commentary: When
we know how the our mind works as a manifestation of Infinite
Mind – of pure undifferentiated and eternal consciousness (purusha),
then all the modifications disclose themselves. Thus it is
futile to try to figure out all the manifold individual
modifications of the citta-vrtti) ordinary consciousness) from
the basis of duality, but rather instead focus on the Supreme
Identity (prabhoh) -- the Great Integrity – the true innate
spiritual authority which exists within the context of ALL OUR
RELATIONS. Purusha thus provides the sacred context and thus we
should recognize when we are ignoring it – when it is absent and
then remediate the malaise and/or cultivate its presence through
yoga practice (sadhana). Purusha is the Samkhya way of
attempting to name the Great Integrity. Purusha as Pure
Universal Consciousness does not move or change. It exists as
the Axis Mundi at the core/heart center of the universe (the
Hridayam) where the entire creation is in flux. From HERE the
river flows. "By having the single yoga, All mandalas are
accomplished. Therefore this itself Develops as well as perfects
The realm of Samantabhadra. Moreover as above, In regard to
elaboration, There are complex and very complex, and also
supremely complex. Inconceivable to thought, the limitless
mandalas Become spontaneous presence." THE GREAT PERFECTION: THE
NATURE OF MIND, THE EASER OF WEARINESS, by Longchenpa IV Sutra
19 na tat svabhasam drishyatvat [The ordinary
dualistic consciousness agitated by citta-vrtti] is not
effulgent -- it is not alive, it can not truly see. Rather this
self illuminating light (svabhasam) stems from pure
undifferentiated consciousness itself (purusha)-- the absolute
ultimate union of the seer, seen, and process of consciousness
which bestows the self luminous (svabhasam) light of
consciousness and animates our vision. Thus (tat) the [citta-vrtti]
is not (na) self luminous (svabhasa) because of the nature of
what is seen (drshyatvat). Commentary: An object is not knowable
by itself, but rather is known only through its integrity
as-it-is in relationship to everything else -- in ALL OUR
RELATIONS. One should thus not become fooled by appearances
where the consciousness "appears" as the object of consciousness
or as an apparent separate "I". Svabhasam is self luminosity or
effulgence which is does not exist in separateness, but rather
is non-dual and holographic. It arises simultaneously as self
recognition within the context of the greater whole. This is our
true nature (swarupa) which is intrinsic and self existing.
Through functional meditation we increasingly learn to recognize,
recall, and abide in this innate transpersonal non-dual Self
continuously (without disturbance). Honoring the light, we seek
it out where meditation, worship, passion, and practice merge as
one motion in ALL OUR RELATIONS. Just as buddhi, the intellect
is intelligent, it‘s light is lit by the Purusha or pure
undifferentiated consciousness – pure citta (―citi-sakter iti‖)
as such individual consciousness stands only as a reflection (poor
as it is in its normal state) of Universal Undifferentiated
Consciousness (Purusha). In the tantric sense then attempting to
bridge the two systems of Samkhya and Tantra, then one may say
that Prakrti thus represent differentiated consciousness (Cit-sakti)
– the two being united as one in Shiva/Shakti. (see also III.35
and III.49 for the unity of absolute beingness and absolute
consciousness).
"Non-dual Samsara/ nirvana, is one within the mind: A variety of
rivers are one within the ocean. All has the equal taste of
single co-emergence. The change of the four elements is one in
the state of space, One in freedom from mental negation or
assertion, One because whatever arises is liberated, One in the
purity of non-duality. The play of waves is one with the water
that is their substance. Whoever realizes this can be said to be
sagacious.Here all dharmas are not grasped as different. These
reflections have the nature of non-duality. This play has no
good and evil, accepting or rejecting. Let us rest where the
mind does not fixate duality. Fixed objects do not arise when
there are no reference points. Insight without fixation is the
completeness of being, The nature of the great perfection, the
natural state."
from THE NATURE OF MIND, THE EASER OF WEARINESS, (called the
Great Chariot) by Longchenpa IV Sutra 20 eka-samaye
chobhayanavadharanam And (cho) ordinary dualistic consciousness
colored by vrtti can not perceive simultaneously subject and
object. Both (ubhaya) that which is seen and the seer should not
be identified (anavadharanam) as one and the same (eka-samaye).
Commentary: When one pointed Unity consciousness is disturbed,
the ordinary mind thus perceives an apparent disparity and
disunity between the objective and subjective states. Here
objective reality and subjective experience are not aligned or
synchronized. This is the antithesis of yoga (it is non-joining,
non-union, fragmentation, or disharmony), but rather the milieu
of cit-vrtti -- the ordinary malaise of the dualistic mind.
Although it is often of value to discern one thing from another
avoiding confusion in that sense, it is also a mistake of
corrupted thinking to reduce things into its parts while losing
the sight of the overall context of the whole. This is
dysfunctional as it breaks up our concentration (dharana) upon
the Great Integrity while dissipating our consciousness into
disparate fragmentation. Yoga addresses the profound non-linear
―Reality‖ of Unity where subject and object appear BOTH
differentiated AND unified at the same time. This realization
and much more is the result of meditation, not the discernment,
reductionist thought, nor the intellect (buddhi). IV Sutra 21
cittantara-drisye buddhi-buddher atiprasangah smriti-sanskaras
ca If one focuses one’s attention to the process of
consciousness itself, thus recognizing its source, then
liberation can be attained. But if one points it to the
externalized outgoing individuation of the consciousness as
manifested in the intellect (buddhi) and fragmented existence --
then directing that dualistic and limited awareness to the
previous process -- then a fixation of externalization or
objective dissociation occurs. The valley can not be seen from
the bottom of the well. At best one becomes aware of being aware,
but then only a convoluted self centered regression (atiprasangah)
sets in (frozen in ordinary limited "self" consciousness) which
reinforces a limited dualistic reference structure which in turn
maintains psychic imprints (samskara) upon the memory (smrti) [which
is to be avoided].
Commentary: Here Patanjali describes a common trap which occurs
both in everyday life and also in meditation , i.e., ordinary
self centered consciousness, being ―self conscious‖, of being
aware that you are aware of being aware of oneself and so on.
Again we are to be reminded that buddhi, intellect, is a
function of manas and the separate self (belonging to the small
self). It's filter must be removed, for us to see the underlying
transconceptional Intelligence as Universal and Omnipresent
Immeasurable Sacred Presence -- Buddha (vs buddhi) is of a
trans-personal, non-dual and universal nature. Buddha is found
within all things. Being self-conscious of a separate self as
the focus i.e., as being afflicted by asmita (ego), we not only
become self engrossed, but we wind up in a regression of being
aware of self being aware of self, ad infinitum. Although in
this milieu one may become aware of one‘s physical actions, we
certainly are not aware of the true nature of our thought
processes, the surroundings, nature, and our higher Self. This
is the very narrow, limited, and convoluted contracted state of
self consciousness which is to be avoided. This is to be
contrasted with the expansive state that we find in yoga when we
talk about consciousness, transpersonal awareness, awareness of
our true non-dual nature, and so forth. Especially in meditation,
the beginner may waste time sitting being aware that one is
sitting. Thinking and being aware that we are thinking, or even
worse being aware that one is aware that one is thinking,
meditating, or similarly obsessing on our individual mentation
process exclusively creates a very limited boundary of
consciousness -- a diversion which is to be avoided. In that
state meditation has not yet begun. This malaise is made
contra-distinct by the next sutra. We will see later that the
correct application of viveka will avoid this possible
difficulty. Viveka is neither lax awareness nor is it
hypervigilence. Rather viveka points toward a balanced (sattvic)
awareness of the Source of awareness, consciousness of the
Intelligent Source of all Intelligence, or Universal Purusha
Consciousness and as such will not be confused with nor
reinforce the limitations of buddhi (individual intellect),
manas, asmita, or dualistic consciousness. Swami Venkatesananda
translates Sutra 21: "If it is assumed that there are two minds
the observer and the observed - this would result in logical
absurdity (since both are based on the same intelligence, who
designates the distinction?) and also confusion of memory or
universal schizophrenia, which is not found to be the case." IV
Sutra 22 citer apratisankramayas tad-akarapattau
svabuddhi-sanvedanam When we reside in the effulgent
light of that unchanging universal witness consciousness (citer
apratisankramayayas) then the true nature of the machinations of
the intellect (svabuddhi) as well as the objects of
consciousness and the processes of consciousness is known.
From here all vrttis can and are to be avoided. Commentary: From
the universal transpersonal non-dual consciousness (citta devoid
of vrtti) – from the state of swarupa (true self), all
aberrations of consciousness cease on their own [without
ancillary compensatory efforts]. From the top of the mountain
can the entire valley be seen, while the bottom of the lake can
only be explored by those who can dive deeply. Likewise the
individual intelligence and intellect (buddhi) is only a dim
reflection of this universal supreme unbiased intelligence, thus
our true self self nature (swarupa) can only be known thoroughly
(realized) when one has stilled the wanderings of the citta (citta-vrtti-nirodha)
and can abide in the universal unchanging light of consciousness
(citer apratisankramayas). For perspective Patanjali reminds us
of the goal of yoga as stated in Pada One, Sutra Three. Our
sorry (dukha) ordinary state is due to false and limited
identifications (akarapattau) we impose upon what-is (reality)
as coming from an intellect (buddhi) which possesses a separate
intelligence from the universal Self, but in fact the intellect
and individual motive power are charged by the Universal Source
from which they can not stand apart except in illusion. So when
we ordinarily see, we identify the process of seeing as being
from our eyes and intellect toward a separate object, then we
are lost in dualism and false identification, but spiritual
vision involves the awareness of that greater power of seeing --
our higher potential so that when we gaze at a seemingly
separate object we know in a deeper non-dual sense that is a
Self rememberance -- that it is Self knowing Self -- love loving
love in the Integrity and Great Binding together of ALL OUR
RELATIONS. IV Sutra 23 drashtri-drishyoparaktam cittam
sarvartham When we abide in this light where the seer (drashtr),
the seen (drisya) and the process of seeing are known to be part
of the same universal interconnected overall integral process of
infinite all encompassing consciousness (sarvaartham), then this
consciousness (belonging to the true omniscient universal self
or purusha) is no longer colored, tainted, biased, or impure (uparaktam).
Commentary: In ordinary dualistic consciousness, the object of
consciousness colors the individual consciousness. Even the
process of seeing as well as the seer and the seen are seen as
separate phenomena, but the truth is that they are all products
and players of the universal Self (purusha). Through practice
one learns how to see and be through the light of this universal
consciousness. Normally, the preexisting colorings and bias of
the individual consciousness, then colors the way we see the
object, thus Reality as-it-is is not known and it is said that
truth is not known, for it is fractured and tainted. This
ordinary dualistic way of seeing is dualistic and corrupted, as
well as only relative; while only through a universal
perspective can we see Reality as-it-is unbiased, uncolored, and
untainted. Liberation (kaivalya) in both Samkhya and Yoga is
neither the acquisition of a new or cultivated state, nor merely
the destruction of an old one, because either are merely framed
or colored by the mind as something other than "Reality". Rather
liberation (kaivalya) arises by itself (self arises)
spontaneously as-it-is (as swarupa) as the disappearance of the
conditioning factors i. e. the removal of the self imposed
limitations of time/space (the limited postulation of three
dimensional succession and form as a filter to explain our
subjective experience). Kaivalya then occurs to disclose the sky
in its own true form after the clouds (colorings) are lifted. It
discloses Purusha (as pure undifferentiated universal
consciousness - pure receptivity and awareness) which is no
longer colored or obscured by dualism or fragmented existence.
this again is where pure and absolute beingness (sattva) merges
with pure and absolute consciousness as shiva/shakti), which is
another way of saying that the Prakritic mirror no longer
obscures nor substitutes for Purusha because All and Everything
-- eternal and temporal - the absolute and the relative --
Consciousness and Experience -- Spirit and Nature -- objective/subjective,
or Shiva/Shakti -- ALL are put into their natural synchronicity
once again. HERE the "self" ceases the false and neurotic
identifications with objective realities outside this central
unitive context of the Great Integrity -- of ALL OUR RELATIONS.
IV Sutra 24 tad asankhyeya-vasanabhish chitram api parartham
sanhatya-karitvat Even though (api) [the consciousness of the
untrained yogi] is pulled at every junction by the
aforementioned diverse and manifold vagaries of reactive,
conditioned, and compulsive habits (asankhyeya-vasanabhish
chitram), at the same time (sanhatya) [the consciousness of the
trained yogi] has activated an intrinsic power to act in concert
with his/her highest potential, i.e., one acts from their core
energy self empowered. Commentary: At this stage the vasana,
samskara, old karma, and klesha have become over powered; the
new pathways of light from the Source are open and flowing; and
harmony, unity, and integration acts as the dominant symphony.
IV Sutra 25 visesa-darshina atma-bhava-bhavana-vinivrittih
One is no longer fooled – no longer swept away by the artificial
distinction (visesa) introduced by being absorbed in a disparate
relativity and bias that is maintained in the dualistic
perception of a separateness of seer and seen. Then one can
attain self realization (atmabhava) which requires no further
psychic cultivation (bhavana). When the seer (atma) knows that
he/she is seeing from the power of the true Universal
consciousness (Brahman) and not from some individual or separate
power, then the veil of duality become lifted, the vrttis are
undone (vinivritti), and the true vision (darshina) of our true
nature (on swarupa) is realized. All seemingly individual
consciousness and intelligence stem from the Great Integrity of
which we are its eyes and ears, arms and legs, and so forth.
Swami Venkatesananda says; "One who sees this completely and
clearly is freed from the false and imaginary of self." IV Sutra
26 tada hi viveka-nimnam kaivalya-pragbharam cittam Inclined (nimnam)
towards this method of non-dual discernment (viveka), then
consciousness (cittam) gravitates and is propelled toward (pragbharam)
kaivalya (liberation). Commentary: With viveka (vigilant
awareness) one can only move toward Kaivalyam, approach it, and
knock on its door so to speak; but it can not be entered into
because viveka still employs dualistic cultivation albeit subtle.
The word viveka is often misunderstood because its use in the
yoga is very different from that used in the samkhya context. It
is also very different from that of the more popular vedantic
definition of viveka (say that of Sankaracharya which occurred
1000 years after Patanjali). In the modern day popular
definitions viveka is most often translated as discriminatory
awareness for example, making the distinction between the real
and the unreal, knower and that which is known, subject and
object, and other dualistic and comparative analytical
techniques/methodologies. This misunderstanding is also
compounded by the samkhya definition of viveka (which
approximates that of Vedanta).
However one of the signal differences between Yoga and samkhya
is that samkhya's "enlightenment" is based upon philosophical
abstraction and isolation (as is most popular schools of Vedanta),
while that of yoga is based on integrative experience or union (samadhi).
Yoga (versus samkhya) thus defines the word, viveka, as a
meditation tool to practice over time (abhyasa) in order to
experience the fruits of yoga practice (sadhana) -- as an
elementary means of awareness where one is aware of the citta
wavering and thus allowing the practitioner to refocus the
awareness back to the awareness of awareness.
After consistent practice over time then one develops the
ability of viveka-khyatir (the self illuminating wisdom of
discrimination) where this awareness of awareness shines forth
more steadily and continuously. Thus the meaning of viveka for a
meditator who is practicing raj yoga is very different than one
who engages in the discipline of philosophic inquiry or analysis
(which is reductionistic).Thus in samkhya and Vedanta, viveka is
interpreted as an intellectual or discriminatory tool within
what is generally termed as jnana yoga (philosophic or
intellectual inquiry into "self"), rather than as a self
luminous innate awareness found in an authentic raj yoga context
which is used in dhyana. Here viveka is a pointer that brings
about a realization/recognition of the innate light (the param
purusha). Dhyana (meditation) practice is utilized
experientially within an overall objectless/formless context,
where even the most subtle object of thought or activity of
mentation (vrtti) must become still (nirodha). Viveka wakes us
up that the awareness has become distracted and then points us
to the eternal Source of that awareness -- to the awareness of
that awareness. In the previous padas, Patanjali addresses
dharana (concentration), samyama, and pratyaya where the mind
still has objects of concentration be they subtle or coarse.
Viveka meant here thus is the application of awareness or
vigilance which grows through consistent meditation practice, so
that the practitioner (sadhak) becomes increasingly aware of the
contents of the mind (pratyaya) when it wanders and as soon as
it begins to wander, eventually learning how to recognize even
the very beginning tendency of vrtti, and hence being able to
empty those contents freeing the mind (cit-prana) before they
even arise. In dhyana, unlike dharana or samyama, in classical
raj yoga meditation, the sadhak does not bring the awareness
back to an object (be it the breath, the energy centers, or even
subtle thought processes), but rather no object -- just pure
awareness -- awareness of awareness leading up to viveka-khyatir
(self revealing luminosity of discriminatory awareness). At the
beginning of meditation, it is a time to experience and rest in
the empty mind. Then as the sword of viveka becomes sharpened (through
abhyasa), then distraction, agitations, and dissipation (vrttis)
eventually cease. We follow this awareness back to its Source (see
pratiprasava in Sutra 34) .
In normal beginning practice we become aware that the mind has
wandered and we simply notice that occurrence and tendency, and
return to focusing upon watching, observing, and witnessing the
individual mind itself as an object -- the process of
consciousness itself rather than watching the object of the
mind. This type of sharpened pure awareness (vigilance or viveka)
opens the door to purusha, consciousness without an object and
as such it is not the same technique as the discriminatory
awareness or discernment which is advocated in vedanta or
samkhya philosophical processes. In either practice we must have
patience and show loving kindness -- honoring our intent by
flooding it with healing energy, albeit, viveka as awareness is
an extremely valuable tool in meditation sadhana, but it, like
all "techniques", must eventually be given up like a boat, in
order to cross over to the yonder shore (samadhi). A special
grace of viveka is that it discloses the nature of the wandering
mind through its own application by focusing on the intelligent
principle underlying consciousness itself. It thus makes space
for the transpersonal non-dual primordial awareness of universal
undifferentiated conscious (the purusha) to enter. As such it
gets out of its own way. Repeated application of viveka is
needed at first in order to take us across the river, but it too
must also be left at the shore, like a boat and its oars, in
order to step upon the shore. This is where yoga practice and
even meditation ends. HERE we are no longer locked into the
world of form, there is no longer the separate object of the
meditation, no meditation, and no one who is meditating. Then
there is non-dual integration in nirbijah samadhi. In other
words this sutra says that viveka is used to prime the pump of
the refocusing process upon kaivalyam, then the new awareness
takes off by itself but is hindered until the past samskaras are
completely eradicated. Swami Venkatesananda translates Sutra 26:
Then the whole mind flows towards wisdom and the realization of
complete freedom or liberation. IV Sutra 27 tach-chidreshu
pratyayantarani sanskarebhyah The disruption/interruption of
that (tach-chidreshu) propensity toward kaivalyam arises (bhyah)
from old samskaras. Old samskaras may still arise causing
interruptions of this process toward kaivalya and thus the field
of consciousness will remain limited (pratyaya). Commentary: The
word, pratyaya, is used to describe the total content of the
mind which occupies the field of consciousness at a particular
time. The ordinary mind perceives objects as contents (physical
or mental objects). Pratyaya is thus a limited dualistic mindset
through the action of karma, klesha, vasana, and samskara.
Pratyaya is also the way the ordinary person conceptualizes and
ascribes meaning while identifying self as separate. It is a
limited cognition establishing one‘s limited world view,
viewpoint, or discolorations which produce what we call the
contents of the mind.
This sutra then pertains to the process of cleansing the mirror
via meditation until kaivalya is attained and how this process
becomes interrupted. In these cases viveka is helpful in
noticing that the mind has become distracted and/or an old
samskara has been activated. Viveka allows us to recognize the
samskara, to bring consciousness toward it, and thus one is no
longer unconsciously victimized by it. Applying viveka and
awareness to its energetic dynamic (cit-prana) constantly,
samskara and vasana are deprogrammed and uprooted because their
operations are no longer ignored, denied, or run away from in
chronic ignorance (avidya). One slowly awakens out of
subconscious and limited thought processes not by incessantly
gathering facts, acquiring more objects of ordinary knowledge,
nor by analyzing such, but rather by abiding in the self
revealing Source of the knowledge itself. This is accomplished
through the power of vidya or the cit-shakti. This is likened to
the shining the Light of Grace (when the holes in the past karma
have become pierced), "Shining the Light", or opening up the
flood gates of shakti. We must begin where we are at, while
avoiding the unfortunate impatient propensity to start where we
want to be in the future. So by embracing/recognizing the
samskara, we come to terms with it, truly understand it, and are
able to no longer be reactive nor victimized by it. Eventually
the residual samskaras are dissolved and annulled ("taj-jah
samskaro'nya-samskara-pratibandhi ") through the samskara of the
Age-old Supreme Truth Bearing Wisdom (rtam-bhara prajna), See
Sutra I. 48-51. Such is the immediate precursor to Sabija
Samadhi. Then of course the recurring mental obscurations of the
mind-field will also no longer recur. Eventually even viveka
must be given up as well, as it is still a practice that is
applied to eliminating the samskaras, kleshas, ignorance, karma,
and vasana as we will see in the following. IV Sutra 28 hanam
esham kleshavad uktam Likewise those samskaras which create
kleshas (esham) can also be eradicated (hanam) by the same
previously mentioned (uktam) remediation procedures that were
used with eradicating the kleshas, samskaras, vasanas, and
avidya above. Commentary: See Sutra 30-32. Swami Venkatesananda
translates Sutra 28: "These habit-molds are also to be treated
as sources of psychic distress or disturbance and got rid of in
the manner described already." IV Sutra 29 prasankhyane 'py
akusidasya sarvatha viveka-khyater dharma-meghah samadhih
Thus free from selfish motivation (akusidasya) while abiding
steadily (sarvatha) in self luminous discriminatory awareness (viveka-khyater)
the rain-cloud of natural law (dharma-megha) is accumulated (prasankhyane)
and absorbed (samadhih). Commentary: Pure awareness or vigilance
(in viveka) applied steadily will create viveka-khyatir (luminous
self revealing conscious and lucid unbroken awareness) which is
the remedial propensity where old samskaras, old mind habits (vasanas),
and vrtti become nipped in the bud as soon as they arise or
before they arise. This does not mean that the kleshas are
suppressed or repressed, but rather that the very process of
their arising has become reversed. It is normal in meditation
for beginners to get carried away by discursive thoughts for
long durations. These durations can be measured in length as
words, sentences or even multiple paragraphs in length. Books,
volumes, and many symphonies may be written by the discursive
mind, but that greater all encompassing symphony which includes
all and everything is known to the accomplished meditator as
residing within. As our practice evolves, the sadhak notices the
appearance of the wavelike motions of these discursive thoughts
sooner and quicker (in less sentences or fewer words) through
applying vigilant attention (viveka) upon the contents and
direction of the mind and the process of consciousness itself.
Then through practice a diamond edged sharpness (viveka-khyatir)
is created where one notices before a half sentence is created,
then the beginning of word, even more subtly before any arising
of even the faintest upswelling of a word, even before the
tendency to wander appears. The awareness is then drawn back
into that Source of awareness itself. That is the operation of
viveka-khyater, not as an end in itself but as a pointer or
functional tool. Here one naturally is drawn to rest their
attention back into the intrinsic luminous source of awareness
itself. In this way one rests longer in the silence and
stillness and in such a way samskara, vasana, klesha, avidya,
and karma gradually become reprogrammed. The internal conscious
energy becomes purified, activated, and expanded, so that one
becomes accustomed to and familiar with abiding for increasingly
longer periods of time in the non-dual universal – the samadhi
where the clouds of the wandering mind (vrttis) no longer
obstruct the Pure Universal Source of Consciousness. Thus we
absorb the rain from the dharma cloud, so to speak. Swami
Venkatesananda translates Sutra 29:
Where there is no interest in or attraction whatsoever even for
the highest kind of intellectual knowledge and experience and
where there is uninterrupted self-awareness there comes a state
of enlightenment which is like a cloud that showers virtue or
order.
IV Sutra 30 tatah klesha-karma-nivrttih In this way (tatah) the
waves of karma and klesha are completely reversed and cease (nivrttih).
Commentary: The cessation of the machinations (nivrttih) of both
karma and kleshas is realized through dharma-meghah samadhi.
Through the powerful self reprogramming technique of meditation,
utilizing awareness tools (such as viveka-khyater), the roots of
the samskaras and vasana in form of kleshas and karma are
destroyed. The awareness has been pointed back toward its source
and that light now illumines all that one sees. Final liberation
is thus close at hand. Karma can also be seen as the sum of "complications",
relationships established through fear, attachment, and
ignorance (in short through acting on the kleshas) that we have
constructed through all our past actions as well as our present
desire, fear, and hope. Here the kleshas must be burned up so we
do not create more negative karma, but also the past karma must
be dissolved. Both must be annihilated. The end of karma is the
starting point of divine grace (citi-shakter iti). IV Sutra 31
tada sarvavarana-malapetasya jnanasyanantyaj-jneyam-alpam Then
all veils (sarvavarana) and impurities (mala) are removed (apetasya)
so that the knowledge of infinite mind (jnanasyanantyaj-jneyam)
is revealed which leaves little more (alpam) to be disclosed. IV
Sutra 32 tatah kritarthanam parinama-krama-samaptir gunanam Then
the dualistic differentiations appearing as the nearly infinite
combinations and transformative diverse qualities (parinama) of
the constituent elements of the created universe (gunas) cease
their apparently disparate actions disclosing their profound
interconnectedness (innate integrity), giving way to their
intrinsic completeness, wholeness, wholesomeness, and total
integration which ultimately fulfills (samaptir).
Commentary: The sharpened edge of viveka honed from years of
meditation practice bears fruit in freeing the mind from
wandering, becoming fixated, or bound upon any separate object (mental
or physical), even the most subtle. Here the awareness rests in
awareness of its true nature and source while the operation of
the gunas (defining and comparing "reality" in terms of relative
qualities to other phenomena -- saguna) becomes unnecessary
because their essential integrity, purpose, inherent order, and
meaning is directly perceived in a non-dual perspective
intrinsic order. Here the I-it world of separateness -- the
world of apparent and discrete form -- is broken asunder (nirguna)
because its underlying true nature is revealed.
When we wake up through viveka that our awareness had become
corrupted/seduced in a disjointed/distorted connection/union
into the vagary dualistic world of fragmented "reality" (saguna),
then this unsatisfactory connection is sundered and severed (sunya
produces the realization of formless or nirguna -- where we are
no longer bounded by dualistic qualities of the gunas). When we
disengage from the false identification with ego (asmita) --
when we isolate ourselves from the illusion of separate form (it-objects),
then we can join with the "real" -- a complete and lasting
integration (nirbija samadhi) is established. Then the mind
rests and all false identification ends. Thus kaivalyam is the
simultaneous co-arising isolation from asmita (from the delusion
of separate existence) on one hand, conjoined with the Greater
All encompassing interconnection with the beginningless unborn
eternal weave/weaver of All (shiva/shakti) on the other hand of
god. Here in union of pure undifferentiated consciousness and
pure instantaneous beingness, wholeness, fulfillment, and
completion in nirbij samadhi is achieved by realizing the innate
underlying Great Integrity. As such then there arises no further
need to apply the remediation of viveka while abiding the
non-dual trans-personal state of ALL OUR RELATIONS. IV Sutra 33
kshana-pratiyogi parinamaparanta-nirgrahyah kramah Abiding in
the timeless holographic undifferentiated present that is not
limited by linear concepts of time or succession, or by any
degree of separateness, limitation, or duality, one realizes the
co-arising mutuality of all phenomena from that absolute
stillness where nothing moves.
IV Sutra 34 purusartha-sunyanam gunanam pratiprasavah kaivalyam
svarupa-pratistha va citi-saktir iti Absolute liberation (kaivalyam)
reigns by remediating (pratiprasavah) all dualistic qualities (gunas)
by realizing that they do not exist individually by themselves,
separate and disparate (purushartha-sunyam), but rather our
innate true self nature (swarupa) shines forth as the intrinsic
intelligent power of consciousness itself (cit sakti).
Commentary: Kaivalyam is realized from within the profound
non-dual all inclusive scope of ALL OUR RELATIONS. Self abiding
HERE, the goal of yoga (swarupa) is fulfilled where all vrttis (distortions)
of the infinite mind-field have become annihilated, the purpose
of purusa consciousness as pure beingness in swarupa has been
achieved HERE in swarupa (recognizing itself as its own true
self nature when the differentiations (gunas) are dissolved (sunya)
and seen as temporal insubstantial. HERE All and Everything is
seen as Eternal Self. HERE all phenomena are self revealed by
the self liberation and libation of absolute undifferentiated
consciousness residing in its true nature (swarupa). Thus any
externalized false and limited identifications or fixations of
separateness are annihilated and disappear as empty illusions (sunyata)
which they truly are. Liberation from karma, klesha, samskara,
and vasana is complete. HERE, in the eternal now, all tendencies
to project a "separate self" into any external framework
composed of any separate qualities have become totally
extinguished and only the creative intelligent power of
evolutionary consciousness shines forth (citi-shakter) in all
directions (omni-directionally) simultaneously, therein Absolute
Liberation reigns by itself, unimpeded forever as it always has
and will be. End of the Fourth and Final Chapter
This is what I was talking about. So,
sense it as it is. Questo è quanto, quindi imparate a sensire le
cose come sono.
53,500,000 JEDI SEARCH
Jedi' religion most popular alternative faith (2012 )
Today's Census figures show that 176,632 people in England and
Wales identify themselves as Jedi Knights, making it the most
popular faith in the "Other Religions" category on the Census
and the seventh most popular faith overall
.
The new figures reveal that the lightsabre-wielding
disciples are only behind Christianity, Islam, Hinduism,
Sikhism, Judaism and Buddhism in the popularity stakes,
excluding non-religious people and people who did not answer.
Following a nationwide
campaign, Jedi made it onto the 2001 census, with
390,127 people identifying themselves a decade ago as
followers of the fictional Star Wars creed.
Although the number of Jedis has dropped by more than 50 per
cent over the past 10 years, they are still the most
selected "alternative" faith on the Census, and constitute
0.31% of all people's stated religious affiliation in
England and Wales.
The number of people specifically identifying as Atheists
was 29,267, while over 13.8 million refused to identify with
a faith at all, ticking the "No religion" box on the census
form.
-
Australia - 65,000
-
Canada - 9,000
-
Czech Republic - 15,070
-
England and Wales - 176,632
Source: 2011 census data 2011
Here is
the Doctrine definition of Jediism from the jedichurch website
-
Category: Information
-
Written by Temple Of The Jedi Order
Jediism is
a religion based on the observance of the Force,
a ubiquitous and metaphysical power that a Jedi (a
follower of Jediism) believes to be the underlying, fundamental
nature of the universe. Jediism finds its roots in philosophies
similar to those presented in an epic space opera called “Star
Wars”. It is a religion in and of itself.
The Jedi religion is an inspiration and a way of life for many
people throughout the world who take on the mantle of Jedi. Jedi
apply the principles, ideals, philosophies and teachings of
Jediism in a practical manner within their lives. Real Jedi do
not worship George Lucas or Star Wars or anything of the sort.
Jediism is not based in fiction, but we accept myth as a
sometimes more practical mean of conveying philosophies
applicable to real life.
JEDI BELIEVE
In the Force, and in the inherent worth of all life within it.
In the sanctity of the human person. We oppose the use of
torture and cruel or unusual punishment, including the death
penalty.
In a society governed by laws grounded in reason and compassion,
not in fear or prejudice.
In a society that does not discriminate on the basis of sexual
orientation or circumstances of birth such as gender, ethnicity
and national origin.
In the ethic of reciprocity, and how moral concepts are not
absolute but vary by culture, religion and over time.
In the positive influence of spiritual growth and awareness on
society.
In the importance of freedom of conscience and
self-determination within religious, political and other
structures.
In the separation of religion and government and the freedoms of
speech, association and expression.
THE THREE TENETS
Focus
Knowledge
Wisdom |
When used correctly, the Jedi Tenets allow us to better
ourselves and overcome any obstacle. They help us
improve the world around us and fulfil our purpose in
life as a Jedi.
Wisdom is
the sound application of accrued knowledge and
experience through patient, good judgment. Knowledge can
be acquired by focusing on the task at hand. Focus is
the art of pruning the irrelevant and pouring the best
of your mind into what you are doing. |
THE CODE
The Jedi Code comes in two versions which are different ways of
understanding the same teaching.
Emotion, yet Peace. |
There is no Emotion, there is Peace. |
Ignorance, yet Knowledge. |
There is no Ignorance, there is Knowledge. |
Passion, yet Serenity. |
There is no Passion, there is Serenity. |
Chaos, yet Harmony. |
There is no Chaos, there is Harmony. |
Death, yet the Force. |
There is no Death, there is the Force. |
THE CREED
I am a Jedi, an instrument of peace;
Where there is hatred I shall bring love;
Where there is injury, pardon;
Where there is doubt, faith;
Where there is despair, hope;
Where there is darkness, light;
And where there is sadness, joy.
I am a Jedi.
I shall never seek so much to be consoled as to console;
To be understood as to understand;
To be loved as to love;
For it is in giving that we receive;
It is in pardoning that we are pardoned;
And it is in dying that we are born to eternal life.
The Force is with me always, for I am a Jedi.
THE 16 TEACHINGS
1. Jedi are in touch with the Force. We are open to spiritual
awareness and keep our minds in tune with the beauty of the
world. We are forever learning and open our minds to experiences
and knowledge of ourselves and others.
2. Jedi maintain a clear mind; which can be achieved through
meditation and contemplation. Our minds can become unduly
troubled and concerned with the happenings of the world. We must
work on overcoming our individual issues through training and
diligence.
3. Jedi are aware of the future impacts of action and inaction
and of the influence of the past, but live in and focus on the
Now. We let ourselves flow like water through the events around
us. We embrace the ever changing and fluid world, adapting and
changing as it does.
4. Jedi are wary of attachments, both material and personal. The
obsession over possessions and people creates the fear of losing
those possessions and relationships which can cause ourselves to
be trapped in a state of depression and loss.
5. Jedi understand that well-being consists in the physical, the
mental and the spiritual. A Jedi trains each to ensure they
remain capable of performing their duties to the best of their
ability. All of these are interconnected and essential parts of
our training in becoming more harmonious with the Force.
6. Jedi use their skills to the best of their ability. We do not
use our knowledge and skill to boast or be prideful. We are
mindful of the ego and mindful of our actions, exercising wisdom
and humility.
7. Jedi understand their limitations. We recognise, and take
responsibility, for our failures and develop a level of modesty
about them. We respect the right for others to disagree and
understand that they themselves are not perfect.
8. Jedi are patient. We work on training ourselves not to
precipitate events around us. We know that becoming a Jedi is
long and hard and requires rigorous dedication and commitment.
Jedi train to act with a conscientious state of calmness.
9. Jedi have integrity. We are authentic to what we believe and
are open, honest and true to our purpose and our minds. We
remove all masks to reveal ourselves as courageous and noble of
heart. We do not hide from fear of damage to our image because
we know that our image cannot be blemished from the words and
actions of others.
10. Jedi serve in many ways. Each action performed, no matter
the scale, influences the world. With this in mind Jedi perform
each action with peace, caring, love, compassion and humility.
So it is that each Jedi improves the world with each deed they
perform.
11. Jedi are mindful of their thoughts. We recognise the beauty
in others and we provide help to those who come seeking it.
Through our benevolent actions we strengthen not only ourselves
but also our communities. Jedi act without prejudice.
12. Jedi believe that love and compassion are central to their lives.
We must love and care for each other as we must love and care
for ourselves; by doing this we envelop all life in the
positivity of our actions and thoughts. We are providers and
beacons of hope.
13. Jedi cultivate empathy. We try to view things from another’s
perspective making us sensitive listeners. We provide the
confidence people need when talking through their difficulties
and we share our learning with those who would benefit. We do
this to help create a more harmonious society.
14. Jedi are guardians of peace. We believe in helping all those
that are in need, in whatever form, to the best of our ability.
We recognise that sometimes providing help requires courage in
the face of adversity but understand that conflict is resolved
through peace, understanding and harmony.
15. Jedi believe in eternal life through the Force. We do not
become obsessed in mourning those who pass. We may grieve at
their passing but we are content, knowing that they will forever
be a part of the Force and so always a part of us.
16. Jedi make a commitment to their cause and to humanity. Our
ideals, philosophies, and practices define the belief of Jediism
and we take action on this path for self-improvement and to help
others. We are both the witnesses and protectors of the Jedi way
by the practice of our convictions.
THE 21 MAXIMS
Prowess: To seek excellence in all endeavors expected of
a Jedi.
A Jedi strives to acquire greater skill and expertise in what
they do at all times so that it may be used in the service of
the greater good, and not for personal profit. This requires
discipline, patience and perfect practice.
Justice: To always seek the path of ‘right’.
A Jedi is unencumbered by bias or personal interest. Justice is
a double-edged sword, one that protects the weak, yet also
passes judgements according to a set of values. A Jedi tolerates
that which is not Jedi and does not pass judgement on that which
causes no harm for it is just.
Loyalty: To have faith in your Jedi brothers and sisters.
A Jedi remains true to what they have learned and to their own
teachings. A Jedi always serves those who wish to learn more of
the ways of the Force and in doing so, remain loyal to the way
of Jediism and their Order.
Defense: To defend the way of Jediism.
A Jedi is sworn by oath to defend their faith and all it
encompasses.
Courage: To have the will.
To be a Jedi sometimes means choosing the more difficult path,
the personally expensive one. A Jedi knows they must make the
right choice, take the right side and that the weak they have
sworn to defend often stand alone. A Jedi puts aside fear,
regret, and uncertainty yet know the difference between courage
and sheer stupidity.
Faith: To trust in the ways of the Force.
Although the ways of the Force may seem strange at times, a Jedi
always knows their place and their role within it.
Humility: To accept the ego for what it is.
A Jedi does not boast of their accomplishments and knows that
their accomplishment is its own reward.
Fearlessness: To have no self-imposed limits.
Fear is that which prevents a Jedi from accomplishing their
duty. A Jedi learns to let go of their fears through their faith
in the Force and has no shame in admitting their shortfalls when
they occur.
Nobility: To act with honour.
A Jedi does not engage in petty, mean or otherwise dubious
activities. Acting with stature and distinction influences
others, offering a compelling example of what can be achieved by
those who follow Jediism.
Honesty: To avoid lies.
A Jedi is honest with themselves and seeks to always go beyond
appearances. There can be no honest self without the knowledge
and wisdom to see truth.
Pure Motive: To act with motive and purpose.
Without a sound motive and purpose, action has no meaning, no
destination and lacks a foundation. A Jedi moves with the Force,
trusts in its ways. A Jedi’s actions are firmly based upon a
deep motivation to be as their path dictates.
Discipline: To let the self be sole master of the self.
A Jedi’s mind is structured, peaceful, unencumbered by emotions,
physical state or external stimuli.
Focus: To select what matters most.
A Jedi focuses in the task at hand. Although a Jedi is aware of
the past, and wary of the present's impact on the future,
through discipline they know how to select and concentrate on
priorities.
Discretion: To become invisible.
A Jedi knows there is a time and place for all things. They do
not actively interfere in worldly affairs and refrain from
overtly supporting or opposing other individuals or
organizations.
Meditation: To exercise the mind.
Through regular meditation a Jedi examines their motivations,
and are certain that they are not allowing emotion, ignorance,
or passion to intrude upon them. Meditation can be used by a
Jedi to improve their mindfulness, focus, or patience.
Training: To know one's ignorance.
A Jedi knows there is always something more to learn and seeks
new lessons every day.
Integrity: To be consistent.
A Jedi lives as a Jedi at all times. Hypocrisy is their worst
enemy.
Morality: To know the danger of belief.
A Jedi knows how contradicting beliefs of what is right and
wrong can lead to devastating crimes and conflicts. A Jedi takes
a step away from the subjectivity of opinion in favour of the
peace of objectivity. A Jedi does not force their values upon
others.
Conflict: To know when to fight.
A Jedi knows the conflicting nature of the Force but they also
know its peace and serenity. A Jedi never blindly enters
conflict and always does so for the greater good.
Intervention: To know when not to act.
A Jedi knows how inaction can have as great an impact as action
and how some of the greatest lessons are self-taught. To be a
victor is also taking that victory from those you protect. A
Jedi intervenes only when a Jedi's intervention is required.
Harmony: To be connected to the Force.
A Jedi seeks to live in harmony with the Force, for that is the
reason to be a Jedi. To better understand its ways, to better
know one's place within it.
About
numbers....
Modern times comes
with modern beliefs, and what’s more
modern and trendy than the legendary
Jedi from Star
Wars, in fact
today the Jedi phenomenon has stepped
into a whole new era called Jediism.
It’s a nontheistic new religious
movement based on the philosophical and
spiritual ideas of the Jedi as depicted
in Star Wars media. This phenomenon is a
grassroots movement that was initiated
in 2001 for residents of a number of
English-speaking countries, urging them
to record their religion as "Jedi" or "Jedi
Knight" (after the quasi-religious order
of Jedi Knights in the fictional Star
Wars universe) on the national census.
It is believed the majority of
self-reported Jedi claimed the religion for
their own amusement, to poke fun at the
government, or as a protest against the
inclusion of the religion question on
the census form.
Although followers of Jediism
acknowledge the influence of Star Wars
on their religion, by following the
moral and spiritual codes demonstrated
by the fictional Jedi, they also insist
their path is different from that of the
fictional characters and that Jediism
does not focus on the myth and fiction
found in Star Wars. The Jedi follow the
"16 teachings", which are based on the
presentation of the fictional Jedi, as
well as "21 maxims".
History Although inspired by elements of
Star Wars, Jediism has no founder or
central structure.
Early websites dedicated to drawing a
belief system from the Star Wars films
were "The Jedi Religion" and "Jediism".
These websites cited the Jedi code,
constituting of 21 maxims, as the
starting point for a "real jedi" belief
system.
Temple of the Jedi Order in Texas
registered as a non-profit organization
and has promulgated a code, 'The 16
Teachings of the Jedi'.
Census phenomenon and recognition
Jediism received press coverage
following a worldwide email campaign in
2001 urging people to write "Jedi" as
their answer to the religion
classification question in their
country's census. The majority of such
respondents are assumed to have claimed
the faith as a joke.
In the 2001 England and Wales census,
390,127 respondents indicated Jediism as
their faith. 2012 census figures had
dropped to 176,632, although this was
still more common than some other
"alternative" faiths, and was the
seventh most common response overall.
The Australian Bureau of Statistics
chose not to recognise Jediism as a
religion, and the decline in subsequent
years was seen as an indication that it
was a transitory "fad". Statistics New
Zealand assigned Jedi an official
religion code, but noted that the total
was combined with groups such as "The
Church of Elvis" and "Rugby, Racing and
Beer" under "responses deemed outside
the scope of recognised religions". An
SNZ spokeswoman noted that there was no
"magic number" of followers which would
turn a census result into a religion.
The phenomenon attracted the attention
of sociologist of religion Adam Possamai
who analyzed Jediism in the framework of
what he dubs "hyper-real religion".
During the drafting of the UK Racial and
Religious Hatred Act, an amendment was
proposed that excluded Jedi Knights from
any protection, along with Satanists and
believers in animal sacrifice. The
amendment was subsequently withdrawn,
the proposer explaining that it was "a
bit of a joke" to illustrate a point
that defining religious belief in
legislation is difficult.
In 2008, 23-year-old Daniel Jones
founded the "International Church of
Jediism" with his brother Barney,
believing that the 2001 UK census
recognized Jediism as a religion, and
that there were "more Jedi than
Scientologists in Britain". In 2009,
Jones was removed from a Tesco
supermarket in Bangor, North Wales, for
refusing to remove his hood on a
religious basis. The owner justified
Jones's ejection by saying, "He hasn't
been banned. Jedis are very welcome to
shop in our stores although we would ask
them to remove their hoods. Obi-Wan
Kenobi, Yoda and Luke Skywalker all
appeared hoodless without ever going
over to the Dark Side and we are only
aware of the Emperor as one who never
removed his hood."
In 2010, a man who described himself as
a "Star Wars follower" and "Jedi Knight"
was thrown out of a Jobcentre in
Southend, Essex, for refusing to remove
his hood, and later received an apology.
The man said that "The main reason is I
want to wear my hood up and I have got a
religion which allows me to do that."
The Jedi Church A Jedi "church" has been
born in a galaxy far far away - North
Wales.
The Holyhead chapter of the self-styled
Jedi Church, which claims up to 400,000
members worldwide, has sprung up thanks
to brothers Barney and Daniel Jones,
both Star Wars obsessives.
The "church" is only one of a handful
around the planet, said hairdresser
Barney, 26, the Anglesey Order Minister,
also known as Master Jonba Hehol.
The
force: Barney
Jones 26, aka Jonba Hehol, and his
brother Daniel Jones, 21, aka Morda
Hehol, have formed the first Jedi 'church'
- in Holyhead informing dailymail.
The Jidiism teachings based is based on
the popular Star Wars character Yoda -
the 900-year-old grand master - as well
as readings, essays submitted meditation
and relaxation, visualisation and
discuss healthy eating.
The Jedi religion is about life
improvement, inner peace and changing
your lifestyle so you have a more
fulfilling existence said the same
source.
Impact Australia: In Australia more than
70,000 people (0.37%) declared
themselves members of the Jedi order in
the 2001 census. The Australian Bureau
of Statistics issued an official press
release in response to media interest on
the subject. The ABS announced that any
answers that were Jedi-related in the
religion question were to be classified
as 'not defined' and stressed the social
impact of making misleading or false
statements on the census. An ABS
spokesperson said that "further analysis
of census responses has been undertaken
since the release of census data on June
17 to separately identify the number of
Jedi-related responses". It is believed
that there is no numerical value that
determines a religion per definition of
the ABS, but there would need to be a
belief system or philosophy as well as
some form of institutional or
organisational structure in place.
The push for Australian's to declare
themselves as members of the Jedi order
was one of the first examples of a
concept going "viral" on the internet in
Australia. The website which was set up
to promote the concept was visited over
100,000 times in a five week period and
was first archived by the Wayback
Machine on the 21st of October, 2001
The 2006 census recorded 58,053 Jedi. In
the 2011 census, the numbers listing
their faith as Jedi had picked up from
the 2006 census to 65,000.
The Jedi Census phenomenon attracted the
attention of sociologist of religion
Adam Possamai who discusses it in his
book Religion and Popular Culture: A
Hyper-Real Testament. Possamai’s study
placed Jediism in the context of a
specificmethodological classification (‘hyper-real
religions’) and attempted to demonstrate
that hostility existed towards new
religions in Australia.
In the lead-up to the 2006 census, there
were reports that writing Jedi on the
2006 census could lead to a fine for
providing 'false or misleading'
information. This is despite previous
admissions by the ABS that they were 'fairly
relaxed' about the issue in 2001 and
that nobody had been prosecuted in at
least 15 years.
The Census form is strictly confidential,
and as the first page containing the
details of the citizen is removed from
their given answers it is impossible for
the Australian government to prosecute
for false or misleading answers to the
census questions, as they would have to
break the privacy act in doing so.
Canada: In
the 2001 census, 21,000 Canadians put
down their religion as Jedi Knight. This
fact has been referenced by the prime
minister's office as a rationale for
making the 40-page long census form
voluntary. In the 2011 National
Household Survey the number has fallen
to 9000. The phenomenon is rumoured to
have started in Vancouver, BC. Two radio
DJ's formerly of Jack FM discovered the
rule and announced it on air. They
further stated that if one puts Jedi
down on the census it then makes one a
Jedi Knight.
CROATIA: IN THE 2012 CENSUS 303 CROATS
PUT JEDI AS THEIR RELIGION.
Czech
Republic: The
2011 census preliminarily recorded
15,070 people answering the voluntary
question on religion as belonging to the
Jedi religion, described by the Czech
Statistics Office as "the moral values
of the Jedi knights". The office noted
that this is an international phenomenon.
As the 2011 census form did not list
religions, these having to be filled
out, the total number of Jedi is not
artificially boosted by those who were
not aware of the phenomenon prior to
filling out the census form. On the
other hand many people encouraged others
in discussions and then media to fill
the Jedi religion prior 2011 census (as
a form of protest against range, overall
cost and obligatory filling of the
census), which is probably the cause.
The highest number of Jedis were
recorded to live in Prague.
Ireland: In
a May 2012 review of the 2011 census,
the Dáil Public Accounts Committee asked
the Central Statistics Office about the
reliability of self-reported answers,
instancing people listing Jedi as their
religion. The response was "We could
probably tell you the number of people
who have declared themselves as such,
but we don't publish it".
Montenegro: In
the 2011 census in Montenegro, a group
of young men declared themselves as
"Jedi" on the ethnicity question, as
they believe that ethnicity should not
be an issue today.
New
Zealand: Over
53,000 people listed themselves as Jedi
in New Zealand's 2001 census. New
Zealand had the highest per capita
population of reported Jedi in the world
that year, with 1.5% marking "Jedi" as
their religion. The city of Dunedin had
the highest population of reported Jedi
per capita.[1] Statistics New Zealand
treated Jedi responses as "Answer
understood, but will not be counted". If
Jedi were counted it would have been the
second largest religion in New Zealand.
The percentages of religious
affiliations were:
There was a fall in the number of New
Zealand Jedi five years later, with some
20,000 people giving this as their
religion in the 2006 census. It is
unknown whether the numbers have
continued to fall as the 2011 census was
not completed due to an earthquake in
Christchurch.
SERBIA: 640 SERBIANS IDENTIFIED AS JEDI.
England and Wales: In
England and Wales 390,127 people (almost
0.8%) stated their religion as Jedi on
their 2001 Census forms, surpassing
Sikhism, Judaism, and Buddhism, and
making it the fourth largest reported
religion in the country.[24] In the 2001
Census, 2.6% of the population of
Brighton claimed to be Jedi.
It was confirmed prior to the census
that citizens were not liable for a fine
in relation to question 10 (on
religion). This was based on section
1(2) of the Census (Amendment) Act 2000,
which amended section 8 of the Census
Act 2000 to state that "no person shall
be liable to a penalty under subsection
(1) for refusing or neglecting to state
any particulars in respect of religion".
The change in the law was implemented by
The Census (Amendment) Order 2000 and
The Census (Amendment) Regulations 2000.
Jedi was assigned its own code in the
United Kingdom for census processing,
the number 896. Officials from the
Office for National Statistics pointed
out that this merely means that it has
been registered as a common answer to
the "religion" question and that this
does not confer on it the status of
official recognition. John Pullinger,
Director of Reporting and Analysis for
the Census, noted that many people who
would otherwise not have completed a
Census form did so solely to record
themselves as Jedi, so this joke helped
to improve the quality of the Census.
The Office for National Statistics
revealed the total figure in a press
release entitled "390,000 Jedis there
are".
In June 2005, Jamie Reed, newly elected
Labour Member of Parliament for Copeland
in Cumbria, declared himself to be the
first Jedi Member of Parliament during
his maiden speech. The statement, made
in the context of an ongoing debate
regarding the Incitement to Religious
Hatred Bill, was confirmed by Reed's
office to be a joke instead of a serious
statement of faith. During a subsequent
committee debate on the bill, the
Conservative Member of Parliament for
Beaconsfield, Dominic Grieve, proposed
as "a bit of a joke" to exclude Jedi
Knights from the protection of the
proposed act, along with Satanists and
proponents of animal sacrifice,
illustrating the difficulty of defining
religious belief in legislation.
Similarly, in April 2006,Edward Leigh,
the Conservative Member of Parliament
for Gainsborough, asked whether he would
be allowed to set up a Jedi knights
faith school during a Committee debate
on the Education and Inspections Bill.
On 16 November 2006, two Jedi delivered
a protest letter to UN officials in
recognition of the International Day for
Tolerance. They requested that it be
renamed the "UN Interstellar Day of
Tolerance" and cited the 2001 Census
showing 390,000 Jedi in England and
Wales.
According to 2011 census figures, the
number of Jedi had fallen to 176,632,
placing it in seventh place, having been
overtaken by Judaism and Buddhism, but
still comfortably outnumbering any other
alternative or mock religions. The
magazineMetal Hammer also encouraged
readers to mark "Heavy Metal" as their
religion, leading to over 6,000
responses.
Scotland: In Scotland, 14,052 people
stated that Jedi was their current
religion (14,014 "Jedi", 24 "Jedi Order"
and 14 "Sith") and 2,733 stated that it
was their religion of upbringing (2,682
"Jedi", 36 "Jedi Order" and 15 "The Dark
Side") in the 2001 census. The
proportion of people stating their
religion as Jedi in Scotland was lower
than that in England and Wales, at
0.277%.
In April 2009, it became known that
eight police officers serving with
Scotland's largest police force,
Strathclyde, listed their official
religion as Jedi in voluntary diversity
forms. The details were obtained in a
Freedom of Information request by Jane's
Police Review.
Criticism Some atheist groups object to
non-religious individuals answering with
any joke answer, because this would lead
to a census undercount of non-religious
people, and lessen their political
influence.
From Jediism way page
Jediism is a very personal and individualistic religion but as
you look through the website you will see there are many
different paths in Jediism. Some of the members here follow very
different paths in life though here at Jediism many of us share
similar viewpoints. First, there is only the Force. This is the
foundation of Jediism. The Force is our religion and in that, it
is not a question of belief in a God or not, for us it simply
doesn't come into play as we believe the guidance of the Force
will bring us to a course of right action. As a result some have
been guided to a belief in a God and others have not, but all
believe that the Force will set them on their best path possible.
The root of the word "Jediism" is "Jedi". To find out more about
what a Jedi is and learn what Jedi believe and do, please
continue on to the section about Jedi.
Jediism does not require prayer, worship, or other such actions
as some other religions might. Instead of ceremonies, members of
Jediism share common beliefs and ideals. One of the definitions
for religion is a sharing of common beliefs and that's exactly
what makes Jediism a religion. Our fundamental belief in the
Force is the overall common belief shared by all Jediism members.
You will also find other belief systems in the forum; however
this site is solely intended for discussing Jediism, although
all views and people of differing beliefs are welcome on the
forum and blogs and currently do participate. As mentioned
before, it is our views of the Force that make Jediism what it
is. In the Jedi Community you will find many Christian Jedi,
Muslim Jedi, Jewish Jedi, and many other faiths incorporated
with the Jedi path. What separates us all is how we feel about
the Force. There are certain core views and beliefs that must be
present for someone to be able to call themselves a Jedi that
you can learn about in the Jedi section.
What unites all of us is our beliefs/philosophies of the Jedi
path. There is definitely some room for debate in what exactly
are the Jedi beliefs and philosophies but this is not part of
the religious aspect. As you look through the website and forum
we hope that this helps you understand Jediism. If you have any
further questions please do not hesitate using the contact us
form on the homepage of the website or else post some questions
in the forum. We hope you find what you are looking for and if
Jediism can help you out that journey we welcome you!!
We at Jediism Way will never ask for money, donations (unless
donating towards a cause), will not ask you to take vows, oaths,
or any other form to be a member, if is simply a belief in only
the Force and that is the home of Jediism.
Jedi Search 11/2010 to
3/2015
Le jediisme est
un nouveau
mouvement religieux non-théiste
non-organisé basé sur les enseignements philosophiques et
spirituels des Jedi,
qui sont originellement des personnages imaginaires issus des
médias Star
Wars.
Les Jedi affirment l'existence d'une entité métaphysique
mystérieuse qu'ils appellent la Force et préconisent l'adhésion
au Code Jedi. Selon différents recensements dans certains pays
anglophones, plus de 500 000 personnes ont indiqué que leur
religion était Jedi, dans ce qui a été appelé le phénomène Jedi
de 2001. Il existe au moins trois « temples » Jedi (qui
correspondent à des églises) enregistrés et organisés aux
États-Unis et au Royaume-Uni.
Les Jedi interprètent et utilisent les enseignements
philosophiques de Star
Wars dans la vie
de tous les jours. La philosophie du jediisme est un mélange de Taoisme,
de Bouddhisme,
et des travaux d'Alan
Watts et Joseph
Campbell1.
Le jediisme partage des idéaux avec de nombreuses religions
ainsi que les aspects spirituels de certains arts martiaux.
Malgré une grande diversité idéologique liée à l'abondance de
ressources Star Wars, les Jedi partagent un ensemble de valeurs
fondamentales essentielles à leur voie. La plupart des Jedi
suivent un code de conduite similaire au code de la chevalerie,
le Code
Jedi. Cependant, parce qu'il n'y a pas de voie unique ou
de livre saint dans le jediisme, il y a beaucoup de codes, tous
plus ou moins basés sur la philosophie, codes et leçons de Star
Wars.
La Force est ce dont tout provient, ce en quoi tout existe, et
ce en quoi tout retourne. Beaucoup l'appellent un champ
d'énergie et elle
peut être comparée au qi ou
au dieu
cosmique du panthéisme. C'est l'énergie derrière l'existence
de tout ce qui est connu ou non de l'Homme, et la pensée qui l'entoure
est comparable à la théorie
du tout en
physique théorique et en philosophie. La Force ne demande ni
prière ni adoration ou autres actions similaires présentes dans
d'autres religions, cependant la plupart des Jedi pratiquent
quelques formes de méditation.
La plupart des Jedi choisissent de se concentrer sur la Force à
travers l'un des trois aspects spirituels les plus acceptés : La
Force personnelle, La Force de vie, et la Force unificatrice.
À cause des origines de culture pop du jediisme et de l'utilisation
du web pour organiser, partager et attirer les autres vers les
communautés Jedi, les organisations Jedi ont tendance à attirer
des individus assez insolites. Le site webthejediismway.org,
l'un des plus gros forums Jedi en son temps, alerte ses
visiteurs des sites web et individus « toxiques »2.
La communauté Jedi semble incapable de garder, organiser et
partager ses propres informations. La communauté semble
constamment souffrir de drames et menaces juridiques causant la
perte de sites et contributeurs importants3.
Le jediisme est souvent rapporté sur Internet et dans les
articles de presse de façon non-importante, fausse et
généralement négative. La mauvaise presse du phénomène Jedi de
2001 et un reportage de la BBC ont contribué à la création des
termes « jediism » (jediisme) et « jedi realism »3.
Deux Jedi auto-proclamés portant des robes Jedi de Star Wars
ainsi qu'une tierce personne s'étant déguisée en wookieeont
demandé que l'ONU change la journée internationale de la
tolérance en la journée interstellaire de la tolérance4.
Ce type d'actions contribue à donner du jediisme en général une
image excentrique, parfois de façon injuste.
La Church of
Jediism, une société privée à responsabilité limitée
(private limited company) établie à Holyhead au Royaume-Uni par
Daniel Jones apparait régulièrement dans les médias dans des
controverses avec Tesco (chaîne de supermarchés), Jobcentre
(pôle emploi), combat avec jouets Star Wars sur plateau TV ainsi
qu'une attaque par « Dark Vador », un homme en état d’ébriété
vêtu d'un sac poubelle noir. D'autres organisations Jedi
éprouvent régulièrement leur mépris pour cette entreprise
Ce phénomène est un mouvement qui eut lieu à partir de 2001 dans
divers paysanglophones et
qui consista, pour les citoyens de ces pays, à indiquer sur leur
formulaire de recensement que
leur religion était
« Jedi »
ou « Jedi Knight » (chevalier Jedi), dit aussi Jediisme, en
référence à l'ordre religieux de l'univers fictionnel de Star
Wars.
La campagne fut organisée en faisant circuler des courriels prétendant
que si assez de personnes écrivaient « Jedi », cette religion
serait officiellement reconnue par le gouvernement. Les
courriels demandaient parfois aux gens de dire que leur religion
était « Jedi » « parce que vous aimez Star Wars » ou « juste
pour ennuyer les gens ».
D'autres raisons ont été évoquées pour expliquer ce comportement,
comme l'esprit frivole, l'envie de protester ou de se moquer du
recensement ou de la religion, ou le désir d'affirmer ou de
prétendre qu'on est un chevalier Jedi.
Tout ceci montre que le jediisme peut être également revendiqué
comme religion de façon humoristique ou parodique, comme par
exemple le pastafarisme et
le culte de la Licorne
Rose Invisible, et non uniquement de façon sérieuse (présupposant
un respect des préceptes des Jedi), excentrique, commerciale, ou
malveillante.
À ce jour, seuls les États-Unis ont
reconnu ce mouvement comme un religionEn Australie,
plus de 70 000 personnes se
sont déclarés membres de l'ordre Jedi lors du recensement de 2001.
L'Australian
Bureau of Statistics a
publié un communiqué annonçant que toute réponse liée aux Jedi serait
classée dans la catégorie « religion non définie », tout en
rappelant que fausser la pertinence du recensement pouvait être
coûteux pour la collectivité, car les données qui en résultent
sont très utilisées
En Nouvelle-Zélande, plus
de 53 000 personnes furent
listées comme étant Jedi[Quand ?],
équivalent à 1,5 % de la population, le plus grand score dans le
monde, cette année-là. Considérée comme « Notée, mais non prise
en compte », la religion Jedi aurait été la deuxième de
Nouvelle-Zélande ; les résultats de ce recensement ayant été :
Lors du recensement de 2006,
il y eut une forte baisse de « Jedi », avec seulement 20 000
personnes l'indiquant comme leur religion.
Au Canada, 20 000 Jedi furent
comptés lors du recensement de 2001
En Angleterre et
au Pays
de Galles, 390 127 personnes (près
de 0,8 % de la population) indiquèrent que Jedi était leur
religion sur leur formulaire de recensement en 2001, faisant
d'elle la quatrième religion indiquée. Les plus grands
pourcentages venaient typiquement de villes avec une importante
population étudiante. Les pourcentages des affiliations
religieuses (sans compter les athées et
ceux qui n'ont pas répondu) étaient :
Le jediisme n'est pas reconnu comme une religion officielle dans
les pays où le mouvement a eu lieu, bien que le Royaume-Uni lui
ait assigné son propre code pour le dépouillement des résultats
du recensement. L'Office britannique des statistiques a indiqué
que le fait que « Jedi » ait son propre code ne lui confère pas
le statut de religion officielle ; cela veut simplement dire qu'il
a été enregistré comme une réponse courante.
Bien que le phénomène ait débuté en 2001, le recensement de 2011
en République
tchèque compte
15 070 chevaliers Jedi
As you may notice no up to date numbers
or statistics can be found. Very interesting....
Link to the best web site on Jediism,
publications, books, topics, etc...
http://instituteforjedirealiststudies.org/library/
Link alla struttura ed argomenti del sito anche cliccando qui
menu